JULIAN ASSANGE
Wikileaks.org
December 3, 2007
Politically substantive differences may exist in the large appendix after the glossary, however, such differences are not covered by this analysis.
gitmo-sop-2003.txt | gitmo-sop-2004.txt | |||
---|---|---|---|---|
skipping to change at line 19 | skipping to change at line 19 | |||
Joint Task Force Guantanamo (JTF-GTMO) | Joint Task Force Guantanamo (JTF-GTMO) | |||
Camp Delta | Camp Delta | |||
Standard Operating Procedures (SOP) | Standard Operating Procedures (SOP) | |||
By Order of the Commander | By Order of the Commander | |||
GEOFFREY D. MILLER | GEOFFREY D. MILLER | |||
Major General, United States Army | Major General, United States Army | |||
Commander, JTF-GTMO | Commander, JTF-GTMO | |||
Official: | Official: | |||
ADOLPH MCQUEEN | NELSON J. CANNON | |||
Colonel, Military Police | Colonel, Military Police | |||
Commander, JDOG | Commander, JDOG | |||
History. This is a revised update to | History. This is a revised update to | |||
the Joint Task Force Guantanamo | the Joint Task Force Guantanamo | |||
(JTF-GTMO) standard operating | (JTF-GTMO) standard operating | |||
procedures (SOP) for Camp Delta. | procedures (SOP) for Camp Delta. | |||
This publication has been | This publication has been | |||
reorganized and consolidated to | reorganized and consolidated to | |||
include all aspects of detention and | include all aspects of detention and | |||
security operations toward being | security operations toward being | |||
skipping to change at line 80 | skipping to change at line 80 | |||
Supplementation. | Supplementation. | |||
Supplementation of this SOP and | Supplementation of this SOP and | |||
establishment of command or local | establishment of command or local | |||
forms is prohibited without prior | forms is prohibited without prior | |||
approval of the JDOG | approval of the JDOG | |||
Commander. | Commander. | |||
Suggested Improvements. Users | Suggested Improvements. Users | |||
are invited to send comments and | are invited to send comments and | |||
suggested improvements through | suggested improvements through | |||
their chain of command to the | their chain of command to the | |||
JDOG S3 for proper consideration | JDOG S3 for consideration and | |||
and staffing. | staffing. | |||
Interim Changes. Policies and | Interim Changes. Policies and | |||
procedures will be reviewed every | procedures will be reviewed and | |||
120 days. Any interim changes | implemented every 30 days. | |||
will be signed by the JDOG | ||||
Commander and posted to the front | ||||
of this SOP until incorporated in | ||||
the next revision. | ||||
Distribution. This document, and | Distribution. This document, and | |||
any part therein, are classified as | any part therein, are classified as | |||
“for official use only” and are | “for official use only” and are | |||
limited to those requiring | limited to those requiring | |||
operational and procedural | operational and procedural | |||
knowledge in the direct | knowledge in the direct | |||
performance of their duties as well | performance of their duties as well | |||
as those directly associated with | as those directly associated with | |||
JTF-GTMO. It is the responsibility | JTF-GTMO. It is the responsibility | |||
of all personnel to protect and | of all personnel to protect and | |||
safeguard the contents of this SOP | safeguard the contents of this SOP | |||
and ensure appropriate distribution | and ensure appropriate distribution | |||
thereof. | thereof. | |||
*This Camp Delta SOP supersedes all previous editions and supplements. | *This 1 March 2004 Camp Delta SOP supersedes all previous editions and supplements. | |||
iv | ||||
x | ||||
CAMP DELTA RULES | ||||
1. Comply with all rules and regulations. You are subject to disciplinary action if you disobey any rule or commit any | ||||
act, disorder, or neglect that is prejudicial to good order and discipline. | ||||
2. You must immediately obey all orders of U.S. personnel. Deliberate disobedience, resistance, or conduct of a | ||||
mutinous or riotous nature will be dealt with by force. Be respectful of others. Derogatory comments toward camp | ||||
personnel will not be tolerated. | ||||
3. You may not have any articles that can be used as a weapon in your possession at any time. If a weapon is found in | ||||
your possession, you will be severely punished. Gambling is strictly forbidden. | ||||
4. Being truthful and compliance will be rewarded. Failure to comply will result in loss of privileges. | ||||
5. All trash will be returned immediately to U.S. personnel when you are finished eating. All eating utensils must be | ||||
returned after meals. | ||||
6. No detainee may conduct or participate in any form of military drill, organized physical fitness, hand-to-hand | ||||
combat, or martial arts style training. | ||||
7. The camp commander will ensure adequate protection for all personnel. Any detainee who mistreats another | ||||
detainee will be punished. Any detainee that fears his life is in danger, or fears physical injury at the hands of | ||||
another person can report this to U.S. personnel at any time. | ||||
8. Medical emergencies should be brought to the guards’ attention immediately. | ||||
Your decision whether or not to be truthful and comply will directly affect your quality of life while in this camp. | ||||
Chapter 1 | Chapter 1 | |||
Introduction | Introduction | |||
1-1. Purpose | 1-1. Purpose | |||
a. This standard operating procedure (SOP) | a. This standard operating procedure (SOP) | |||
provides policy, procedures, and responsibilities for the | provides policy, procedures, and responsibilities for the | |||
security, administration, and treatment of detainees in | security, administration, and treatment of detainees in | |||
custody at Camp Delta. This SOP also establishes | custody at Camp Delta. This SOP also establishes | |||
procedures for transfer or release of custody from | procedures for transfer or release of custody from | |||
Camp Delta. | Camp Delta. | |||
b. This SOP is consistent with the intent and spirit | b. This SOP is consistent with the intent and spirit | |||
of the Geneva Conventions for the Protection of War | of the Geneva Conventions for the Protection of War | |||
Victims, dated 12 August 1949, in accordance with | Victims, dated 12 August 1949, in accordance with | |||
directives from the National Command Authority | directives from the National Command Authority | |||
(NCA) and chain of command. | (NCA) and chain of command. | |||
c. All personnel will enforce all orders and | c. All personnel will enforce all orders and | |||
regulations pertaining to the daily operation of the | regulations pertaining to the daily operation of the | |||
facility and their assigned posts. Further, all personnel | facility and their assigned posts. Further, all personnel | |||
will be familiar with all facility directives, emergency | will be familiar with all facility directives, emergency | |||
plans and all special orders pertaining to their post; | plans and all post and special orders pertaining to their | |||
carry out all general orders for a sentry on post, and | post; carry out all general orders for a sentry on post, | |||
wear the prescribed uniform of the day. | and wear the prescribed uniform of the day. | |||
d. This policy is punitive in that a violation of any | d. This policy is punitive in that a violation of any | |||
provision of this policy may provide a basis for | provision of this policy may provide a basis for | |||
appropriate administrative or judicial/disciplinary | appropriate administrative or judicial/disciplinary | |||
action under the Uniform Code of Military Justice | action under the Uniform Code of Military Justice | |||
(UCMJ), or appropriate military/civilian personnel | (UCMJ), or appropriate military/civilian personnel | |||
regulations, ejection from Camp Delta, and/or denial of | regulations, ejection from Camp Delta, and/or denial of | |||
entry. | entry. | |||
e. All personnel will sign a statement of | e. All personnel will sign a statement of | |||
understanding/acknowledgement that they have read | understanding/acknowledgement that they have read | |||
and will adhere to the provisions of all SOPs for Camp | and will adhere to the provisions of all SOPs for Camp | |||
Delta. | Delta. | |||
1-2. Minor SOP Modifications | 1-2. Minor SOP Modifications | |||
a. Any personnel may send suggestions for | a. Any personnel may send suggestions for | |||
improvement of the SOP through their chain of | improvement of the SOP through their chain of | |||
command to the JDOG S-3. | command to the JDOG S-3. | |||
b. Minor revisions will be made in a memorandum | b. Minor revisions will be made in a memorandum | |||
format, appropriately staffed, and approved by the | format, appropriately staffed, and approved by the | |||
CJDOG. Example is in Appendix C. | CJDOG. | |||
c. Copies of memorandums will be distributed and | c. Copies of memorandums will be distributed and | |||
placed in the front of all SOP books. | placed in the front of all SOP books. | |||
d. The SOP will be reviewed every 120 days to | d. SOPs may be modified through a Guard Mount | |||
incorporate any changes. All suggested changes in | ||||
procedures for operations would be in writing, | ||||
endorsed by the CJDOG, and approved by CJTF. | ||||
e. SOPs may be modified through a Guard Mount | ||||
message. JDOG S-3 must approve these messages | message. JDOG S-3 must approve these messages | |||
prior to their release. | prior to their release. | |||
f. No SOP modification is valid unless in | e. The SOP will be reviewed every 30 days to | |||
memorandum approved by CJDOG or in an approved | incorporate any changes. Submit all suggested changes | |||
Guard Mount message. | in procedures for operations electronically to JDOG S- | |||
g. A copy of all Guard Mount messages and | 3 to include the following: | |||
approved memorandums will be filed by the JDOG | (1) Name of the submitter | |||
Detention Services Branch (DSB). This file will be | (2) Date of submission | |||
used to update the SOP during the revision process. | (3) If a modification, the current verbiage along | |||
After the memorandum or Guard Mount message is | with the chapter and paragraph of the text in the SOP. | |||
“N/A – addition to SOP” | ||||
(4) The new verbiage of the addition or | ||||
modification to the SOP. “Add Koran to the list of | ||||
inbound items contained in paragraph 4-20a.” | ||||
(5) The reason why this change should be made | ||||
such as “CG has directed all inbounds will now have | ||||
Korans”. | ||||
f. No SOP modification is valid unless approved by | ||||
CJDOG or in an approved Guard Mount message. The | ||||
memorandum or guard mount message must state that | ||||
it is a modification to the SOP. | ||||
g. The JDOG Detention Services Branch (DSB) will | ||||
file a copy of all Guard Mount messages approved. | ||||
This file will be used to update the SOP during the | ||||
revision process. After the Guard Mount message is | ||||
included in the SOP through rewrite, it will be placed | included in the SOP through rewrite, it will be placed | |||
in a separate file of items included in the SOP. | in a separate file of items included in the SOP. | |||
1-3. References Appendix A lists required and | h. Each manned position will train on or become | |||
familiar with one chapter per shift until the SOP has | ||||
been reviewed. | ||||
(1) Verification will be monitored by a signature | ||||
roster that is turned into the SOG and forwarded to the | ||||
respective company's training NCO for documentation. | ||||
(2) To ensure that each chapter is read and | ||||
studied, a specific chapter will be assigned to the | ||||
manned position. | ||||
(3) The roster will ensure that each individual has | ||||
read, studied, reviewed and become familiar with the | ||||
prescribed chapter. | ||||
(4) Training NCOs will ensure all soldiers are | ||||
familiar with the SOP. | ||||
(5) SOP training will be conducted with or | ||||
instead of regular block training as determined by the | ||||
block NCO for that shift. | ||||
(6) The block NCO must inform SOG of their | ||||
intention to train on the SOP in lieu of regular block | ||||
training for documentation purposes. The SOG will | ||||
then inform the CO as to each block’s intent to train on | ||||
what task for that specific shift. | ||||
1-3. References Appendix “A” lists required and | ||||
related publications along with prescribed and | related publications along with prescribed and | |||
referenced DOD and DA forms. Appendix B contains | referenced DOD and DA forms. Appendix “B | |||
all local forms. | “contains all local forms. | |||
1-4. Explanation of Abbreviations and Terms | 1-4. Explanation of Abbreviations and Terms | |||
The glossary explains abbreviations and special terms | The glossary explains abbreviations and special terms | |||
used in this SOP. | used in this SOP. | |||
1-5. JDOG Mission and Commander’s Intent | 1-5. JDOG Mission and Commander’s Intent | |||
a. The Joint Detention Operations Group (JDOG) | a. The Joint Detention Operations Group (JDOG) | |||
conducts detention and area security operations in | conducts detention and area security operations in | |||
assigned sector of the Joint Operational Area (JOA) in | assigned sector of the Joint Operational Area (JOA) in | |||
support of intelligence operations in the Global War on | support of intelligence operations in the Global War on | |||
Terrorism (GWOT). | Terrorism (GWOT). | |||
b. The JDOG Commander’s (CJDOG) intent is to | b. The JDOG Commander’s (CJDOG) intent is to | |||
skipping to change at line 255 | skipping to change at line 307 | |||
office. All personnel will be alert for security violations | office. All personnel will be alert for security violations | |||
or discrepancies and immediately report any unusual, | or discrepancies and immediately report any unusual, | |||
questionable incidents, or observations to their | questionable incidents, or observations to their | |||
immediate supervisor. Supervisors will report all | immediate supervisor. Supervisors will report all | |||
violations to the Detention Operations Center (DOC) | violations to the Detention Operations Center (DOC) | |||
and/or JDOG S3. | and/or JDOG S3. | |||
(2) Humane Treatment. Treat detainees | (2) Humane Treatment. Treat detainees | |||
humanely. Abuse, or any form of corporal punishment, | humanely. Abuse, or any form of corporal punishment, | |||
is prohibited. Verbal harassment, interrogation except | is prohibited. Verbal harassment, interrogation except | |||
by proper authority, and the imposing of physical | by proper authority, and the imposing of physical | |||
exercise as punishment is prohibited. All soldiers will | exercise as punishment is prohibited. | |||
carry the “US SOUTHCOM Human Rights Standing | ||||
Orders” card on them at all times. | ||||
(3) Professionalism. Maintain a fair, firm, | (3) Professionalism. Maintain a fair, firm, | |||
impartial, and professional demeanor toward detainees | impartial, and professional demeanor toward detainees | |||
at all times. | at all times. | |||
(4) Use of Force. Personnel will not strike nor | (4) Use of Force. Personnel will not strike nor | |||
lay hands upon a detainee except in self-defense, to | lay hands upon a detainee except in self-defense, to | |||
prevent a serious injury to a person or damage to | prevent a serious injury to a person or damage to | |||
property, to quell a disturbance, or for purposes of | property, to quell a disturbance, or for purposes of | |||
escorting, properly restraining, or searching a detainee. | escorting, properly restraining, or searching a detainee. | |||
In such cases, exercise only the amount of force | In such cases, exercise only the amount of force | |||
necessary to gain the compliance of the detainee. | necessary to gain the compliance of the detainee. | |||
skipping to change at line 298 | skipping to change at line 349 | |||
(c) Chemical components or incendiary devices | (c) Chemical components or incendiary devices | |||
(d) Knives | (d) Knives | |||
(e) Unauthorized handcuff keys | (e) Unauthorized handcuff keys | |||
(f) Drugs or narcotics without a prescription | (f) Drugs or narcotics without a prescription | |||
(g) Intoxicants/alcoholic beverages | (g) Intoxicants/alcoholic beverages | |||
(h) Currency (not on person) | (h) Currency (not on person) | |||
(i) Razor blades | (i) Razor blades | |||
(j) Obscene material | (j) Obscene material | |||
(k) Photographic equipment (unless approved by | (k) Photographic equipment (unless approved by | |||
proper authority) | proper authority) | |||
(l) Recording devices (unless approved by | (l) Personal mail/parcels. | |||
(m) Recording devices (unless approved by | ||||
proper authority) | proper authority) | |||
(m) Extra clothing not worn on the job site | (n) Extra clothing not worn on the job site | |||
(n) Food products (unless being consumed by | (o) Food products (unless being consumed by | |||
individual) | individual) | |||
(o) Cell phones (unless approved by proper | (p) Cell phones (unless approved by proper | |||
authority) | authority) | |||
(p) Handbags, duffel bags, and book bags (unless | (q) Handbags, duffel bags, and book bags (unless | |||
required by mission and approved by proper authority) | required by mission and approved by proper authority) | |||
(q) Non-government laptops (unless approved by | (r) Non-government laptops (unless approved by | |||
proper authority | proper authority | |||
(r) Reading material other than military | (s) Reading material other than military | |||
publications such as FMs, ARs, TMs, etc. | publications such as FMs, ARs, TMs, etc. | |||
(t) Electronic devices such as DVD players, CD | ||||
players, tape players, headphones, etc. are not | ||||
authorized for guards. | ||||
(u) Personal Digital Assistance (PDA) unless | ||||
authorized per access roster. Personnel who have been | ||||
issued PDA’s will adhere and conform to the standards | ||||
of conduct, relative to policy set-forth by J6. PDA’S | ||||
will be secured at all times by their owners. In the | ||||
event a PDA is left unattended, the PDA will be turned | ||||
into the DOC NCOIC, accompanied by DA Form 2823 | ||||
and DA Form 4137. The S6 will confirm identity of | ||||
the owner through serial number and hand receipt and | ||||
will return the PDA to the owners commander. | ||||
(7) Social Contact. Personnel will only interact | (7) Social Contact. Personnel will only interact | |||
with detainees on official business that is essential for | with detainees on official business that is essential for | |||
mission accomplishment. Personnel will not fraternize | mission accomplishment. Personnel will not fraternize | |||
with detainees nor accept personal favors or services. | with detainees nor accept personal favors or services. | |||
This includes idle chatter and small talk conducted | This includes idle chatter and small talk conducted | |||
with the detainee. | with the detainee. | |||
(8) Gifts. Personnel will not give or receive from | (8) Gifts. Personnel will not give or receive from | |||
any detainee anything that could be construed as a gift, | any detainee anything that could be construed as a gift, | |||
or in any manner, buy, sell, or barter any item(s) with a | or in any manner, buy, sell, or barter any item(s) with a | |||
detainee. | detainee. | |||
skipping to change at line 321 | skipping to change at line 386 | |||
(7) Social Contact. Personnel will only interact | (7) Social Contact. Personnel will only interact | |||
with detainees on official business that is essential for | with detainees on official business that is essential for | |||
mission accomplishment. Personnel will not fraternize | mission accomplishment. Personnel will not fraternize | |||
with detainees nor accept personal favors or services. | with detainees nor accept personal favors or services. | |||
This includes idle chatter and small talk conducted | This includes idle chatter and small talk conducted | |||
with the detainee. | with the detainee. | |||
(8) Gifts. Personnel will not give or receive from | (8) Gifts. Personnel will not give or receive from | |||
any detainee anything that could be construed as a gift, | any detainee anything that could be construed as a gift, | |||
or in any manner, buy, sell, or barter any item(s) with a | or in any manner, buy, sell, or barter any item(s) with a | |||
detainee. | detainee. | |||
(9) Promises and Privileges. Personnel will not | (9) Promises and Privileges. Personnel will not | |||
extend nor promise to a detainee any special privilege | extend nor promise to a detainee any special privilege | |||
or favor not available to all detainees, nor furnish | or favor not available to all detainees, nor furnish | |||
detainees with information except through official | detainees with information except through official | |||
channels. Exceptions may be granted by the JIG | channels. The JIG Commander my grant exceptions | |||
Commander for the purpose of interrogations. | for the purpose of interrogations. | |||
(10) Privacy of Information. The privacy of | (10) Privacy of Information. The privacy of | |||
information applies to all information concerning any | information applies to all information concerning any | |||
of the detainees. Personnel will discuss information | of the detainees. Personnel will discuss information | |||
only with authorized personnel requiring this | only with authorized personnel requiring this | |||
information in the performance of their official duties. | information in the performance of their official duties. | |||
Obtain permission from the JDOG S3 or higher | Obtain permission from the JDOG S3 or higher | |||
authority to release information. Personnel will not | authority to release information. Personnel will not | |||
discuss facility activities, operations or detainee | discuss facility activities, operations or detainee | |||
information in public areas where they may be | information in public areas where they may be | |||
overheard. | overheard. | |||
(11) Appearance. All military personnel will | (11) Appearance. All military personnel will | |||
maintain a high standard of bearing and appearance. | maintain a high standard of bearing and appearance. | |||
Leaders will ensure proper performance of duties | Leaders will ensure proper performance of duties | |||
through professionalism, training, effective | through professionalism, training, effective | |||
communication, leadership, teamwork and discipline. | communication, leadership, teamwork and discipline. | |||
Personnel will set the example in conduct and | Personnel will set the example in conduct and | |||
performance on and off duty. The duty uniform for | performance on and off duty. The duty uniform for all | |||
those military personnel assigned to JDOG at Camp | military personnel assigned to JDOG at Camp Delta | |||
Delta and other JTF-GTMO detention facilities is the | and other JTF-GTMO detention facilities will be the | |||
following: | following: | |||
(a) BDUs with sew-on rank and insignia, sleeves | (a) BDUs with sew-on rank, insignia to include | |||
down. Anytime personnel are in the vicinity of | collar devices and sleeves down. Anytime personnel | |||
detainees (escorts, cell blocks, interrogation/monitor | are in the vicinity of detainees (escorts, cell blocks, | |||
rooms, medical clinic, Detention Hospital, or other | interrogation/monitor rooms, medical clinic, Detention | |||
detention facilities), the name tape will be covered with | Hospital, or other detention facilities), the nametape | |||
adhesive tape. | will be covered with adhesive tape. | |||
(b) BDU patrol cap with rank sewn on. | (b) BDU patrol cap with rank sewn on. | |||
(c) Appropriate civilian attire (select personnel). | (c) Appropriate civilian attire (select personnel). | |||
(d) Camel-bak or similar container, or stripped | (d) Camel-back or similar container, or stripped | |||
pistol belt with canteen. | pistol belt with canteen. | |||
(e) Pen and paper. | (e) Pen and paper. | |||
(f) Whistle in pocket or clipped on pocket (no | (f) Whistle clipped to the left pocket or clipped | |||
lanyard). | on belt loop (no lanyard). | |||
(g) No earrings | ||||
(12) Weapons. Unless specifically authorized by | (12) Weapons. Unless specifically authorized by | |||
CJDOG (eg., Quick Reaction Force), personnel will | CJDOG (e.g., Quick Reaction Force), personnel will | |||
not introduce, or knowingly allow to be introduced into | not introduce, or knowingly allow to be introduced into | |||
Camp Delta or other JTF-GTMO detention facilities | Camp Delta or other JTF-GTMO detention facilities | |||
unauthorized firearms, nightsticks, or any instruments | unauthorized firearms, nightsticks, or any instruments | |||
that might be considered as or possibly used as a | that might be considered as or possibly used as a | |||
weapon. Personnel are not authorized to use or have in | weapon. Personnel are not authorized to use or have in | |||
their possession unauthorized weapons including, but | their possession unauthorized weapons including, but | |||
not limited to, firearms, knives, batons, sap gloves | not limited to, firearms, knives, batons, sap gloves | |||
(lead filled padded gloves), kubatons, nightsticks, PR- | (lead filled padded gloves), batons, nightsticks, PR- | |||
24s, collapsing/expandable batons and any other | 24s, collapsing/expandable batons and any other | |||
weapons not specifically authorized. Personnel are | weapons not specifically authorized. Personnel are | |||
authorized to utilize “field expedient” weapons under | authorized to utilize “field expedient” weapons under | |||
situations of extreme danger when other efforts have | situations of extreme danger when other efforts have | |||
failed or are unfeasible and it is necessary to prevent | failed or are unfeasible and it is necessary to prevent | |||
the death or severe bodily injury to themselves or other | the death or severe bodily injury to themselves or other | |||
personnel, including detainees. The only exception to | personnel, including detainees. Only competent | |||
this policy is in the event of escape, riot or disorder and | authority may direct an exception to this policy in the | |||
then only when directed by competent authority. | event of escape, riot, or disorder. Competent authority | |||
Competent authority is CJTF, CJDOG, DCJDOG, or | is CJTF, CJDOG, DCJDOG, or the on-duty Company | |||
the on-duty Company Commander. | Commander. | |||
(13) Alcohol and other substances. Personnel | (13) Alcohol and other substances. Personnel | |||
will not consume mind-altering substances within eight | will not consume mind-altering substances within eight | |||
hours prior to assuming duty, including but not limited | hours prior to assuming duty, including but not limited | |||
to alcoholic beverages. Soldiers with prescriptions for | to alcoholic beverages. Soldiers with prescriptions for | |||
such medications should immediately notify their chain | such medications should immediately notify their chain | |||
of command and fitness for shift determinations will be | of command and fitness for shift determinations will be | |||
made on a case by case basis. The consumption of | made on a case-by-case basis. The consumption of | |||
alcoholic beverages and/or other mind-altering | alcoholic beverages and/or other mind-altering | |||
substances is sufficient cause to effect relief from duty | substances is sufficient cause to effect relief from duty | |||
and disciplinary action. | and disciplinary action. | |||
b. All violations of the Standards of Conduct will | b. All violations of the Standards of Conduct will | |||
be promptly reported to the chain of command. | be promptly reported to the chain of command. | |||
1-8. General Protection Policy | 1-8. General Protection Policy | |||
a. Give all persons detained at Camp Delta and | a. Give all persons detained at Camp Delta and | |||
other JTF-GTMO detention facilities humanitarian care | other JTF-GTMO detention facilities humanitarian care | |||
and treatment within the spirit of the Geneva | and treatment within the spirit of the Geneva | |||
Conventions. | Conventions. | |||
skipping to change at line 427 | skipping to change at line 493 | |||
matters involving both detainees and U.S. forces | matters involving both detainees and U.S. forces | |||
assigned, attached, or working at Camp Delta and other | assigned, attached, or working at Camp Delta and other | |||
JTF-GTMO detention facilities. | JTF-GTMO detention facilities. | |||
b. Following is the security force chain of command | b. Following is the security force chain of command | |||
for any given shift at Camp Delta and other JTF- | for any given shift at Camp Delta and other JTF- | |||
GTMO detention facilities: | GTMO detention facilities: | |||
POSITION REPORTS TO | POSITION REPORTS TO | |||
S3, JDOG DCJDOG | S3, JDOG DCJDOG | |||
CO S3, JDOG | CO S3, JDOG | |||
PL CO | PL CO | |||
SOG PL | SOG’S 1, 2, 3 PL1 OR PL2 | |||
BLOCK NCOIC SOG | BLOCK NCOIC SOG | |||
SP/GATE GUARDS SOG | SP/GATE GUARDS SOG 3 | |||
JIIF MONITORS SOG | JIIF MONITORS SOG | |||
ESCORT CTRL NCO CO | ESCORT CTRL NCOIC DOC NCOIC | |||
ESCORTS SOG | ESCORTS ESCORT NCOIC | |||
BLOCK GUARDS BLOCK NCOIC | BLOCK GUARDS BLOCK NCOIC | |||
DOC NCO CO | DOC NCOIC S3, JDOG | |||
CAMP 4 NCOIC FGIW | ||||
Table 2-1 | ||||
2-2. Physical Plant | 2-2. Physical Plant | |||
a. Camp Delta currently has nineteen maximum | a. Camp Delta currently has nineteen maximum- | |||
security detention areas for confining detainees | security detention areas for confining detainees | |||
individually and four medium security areas for | individually and four medium security areas for | |||
confining detainees in twelve person rooms within a | confining detainees in twelve person rooms within a | |||
forty-eight capacity building. These detention areas | forty-eight capacity building. These detention areas | |||
are grouped into 4 distinct camps (Delta 1, Delta 2, | are grouped into 4 distinct camps (Camp 1, Camp 2, | |||
Delta 3, and Delta 4). | Camp 3, and Camp 4). | |||
b. Each of the maximum security detention areas | b. Each of the maximum-security detention areas | |||
contains a block of cells having 24, 36, or 48 individual | contains a block of cells having 24, 36, or 48 individual | |||
units. | cells. | |||
c. Blocks are categorized as maximum security | c. Blocks are categorized as maximum security | |||
(individual cells) or medium security (twelve person | (individual cells) or medium security (twelve person | |||
rooms). Several maximum security areas are | rooms). Maximum-security blocks are designated as | |||
designated as Maximum Security Units (MSU), that | Segregation, designed specifically for segregation and | |||
are designed for segregation and isolation of detainees | isolation of detainees for disciplinary or intelligence | |||
for disciplinary or intelligence gathering purposes. | gathering purposes. | |||
2-3. Camp Delta Operations | 2-3. Camp Delta Operations | |||
a. The JDOG S3 Section also serves as the Camp | a. The JDOG S3 Section also serves as the Camp | |||
Delta Operations Section. The primary focus for the | Delta Operations Section. The primary focus for the | |||
Camp Delta Operations Section is the safe, secure, and | Camp Delta Operations Section is the safe, secure, and | |||
efficient operation of Camp Delta and other JTF- | efficient operation of Camp Delta and other JTF- | |||
GTMO detention facilities. | GTMO detention facilities. | |||
b. The Camp Delta Operations Section is organized | b. The Camp Delta Operations Section is organized | |||
into two distinct branches: Detention Operations | into two distinct branches: Detention Operations | |||
Branch and Detention Services Branch. | Branch and Detention Services Branch. | |||
Section I – Personnel | Section I – Personnel | |||
2-4. Duty positions described in this SOP are | 2-4. Duty positions described in this SOP are | |||
necessary for the effective operation of Camp Delta | necessary for the effective operation of Camp Delta | |||
and other JTF-GTMO detention facilities; however, not | and other JTF-GTMO detention facilities; however, not | |||
all positions are annotated in the current JTF-GTMO | all positions are annotated in the current JTF-GTMO | |||
Joint Manning Document (JMD). Non-JMD positions | Joint Manning Document (JMD). Non-JMD positions | |||
(identified with an *) will be filled via tasking to | (identified with an *) will be filled via tasking to | |||
subordinate units, or identified as Additional Duties for | subordinate units, or identified as Additional Duties for | |||
other personnel in the JDOG headquarters. | other personnel in the JDOG headquarters. | |||
2-5. Detention Operations Branch | 2-5. Detention Operations Branch | |||
a. Detention Operations Officer Assists the | a. Detention Operations Officer Assists the JDOG | |||
JDOG S3 and on-duty Commanding Officer (CO) with | S3 and on-duty Commanding Officer (CO) with all | |||
all aspects of detention operations, including detainee | aspects of detention operations, including detainee | |||
custody and control, detainee movement and cell | custody and control, detainee movement and cell | |||
assignments, internal security, mission tracking, and | assignments, internal security, mission tracking, and | |||
reporting requirements. Responsible for development | reporting requirements. Responsible for development | |||
of SOPs for both JDOG and detention facility | of SOPs for both JDOG and detention facility | |||
operations and coordination with JTF-GTMO staff, | operations and coordination with JTF-GTMO staff, | |||
subordinate units, contractors, medical staff, JIG, law | subordinate units, contractors, medical staff, JIG, law | |||
enforcement agencies, and Naval Base staff and | enforcement agencies, and Naval Base staff and | |||
support agencies. | support agencies. | |||
b. Detention Operations NCO Assists the | b. Detention Operations NCO Assists the | |||
Detention Operations Officer with all aspects of | Detention Operations Officer with all aspects of | |||
skipping to change at line 507 | skipping to change at line 575 | |||
and takes direction from the JDOG S3, and is | and takes direction from the JDOG S3, and is | |||
responsible for all aspects of the operation of Camp | responsible for all aspects of the operation of Camp | |||
Delta. Responsibilities include the day-to-day humane | Delta. Responsibilities include the day-to-day humane | |||
care, custody and control, discipline, safety, and | care, custody and control, discipline, safety, and | |||
welfare of all detainees. The CO is overall responsible | welfare of all detainees. The CO is overall responsible | |||
for the care, conduct, and discipline of the guard force. | for the care, conduct, and discipline of the guard force. | |||
Specific duties of the CO are detailed in the Special | Specific duties of the CO are detailed in the Special | |||
Orders portion of this SOP. | Orders portion of this SOP. | |||
d. On-duty Platoon Leader (PL)* Two MP | d. On-duty Platoon Leader (PL)* Two MP | |||
Platoon Leaders will be assigned for each duty shift. | Platoon Leaders will be assigned for each duty shift. | |||
PL assist the CO in the day-to-day operation of Camp | PLs assist the CO in the day-to-day operation of Camp | |||
Delta. Specific duties of the PL are detailed in the | Delta. Specific duties of the PL are detailed in the | |||
Special Orders portion of this SOP.Each PL will be | Special Orders portion of this SOP.Each PL will be | |||
assigned an area of responsibility, as follows: | assigned an area of responsibility, as follows: | |||
(1) PL1 will be assigned to Camp Delta 1 and 4. | ||||
(1) PL1 will be assigned to Camp Delta 1 and 4. | ||||
(2) PL2 will be assigned to Camp Delta 2 and 3. | (2) PL2 will be assigned to Camp Delta 2 and 3. | |||
e. Sergeant of the Guard (SOG)* Three MP | e. Sergeant of the Guard (SOG)* Four MP NCOs | |||
NCOs will be assigned for each duty shift, and | will be assigned for each duty shift, and designated the | |||
designated the SOG for their assigned area, as outlined | SOG for their assigned area, as outlined below. The | |||
below. The SOGs report to the PL assigned to their | SOGs report to the PL assigned to their area of Camp | |||
area of Camp Delta. The SOGs are the immediate shift | Delta. The SOGs are the immediate shift supervisors | |||
supervisors for Block NCOICs and Sally Port/Gate | for Block NCOICs and Sally Port/Gate Guards for their | |||
Guards for their respective areas. The SOGs are | respective areas. The SOGs are responsible for the | |||
responsible for the care, conduct, and safety of the | care, conduct, and safety of the guard force. They | |||
guard force. They enforce accountability, control, | enforce accountability, control, safety, care, and | |||
safety, care, and humane treatment of detainees; ensure | humane treatment of detainees; ensure that all | |||
that all personnel perform their assigned duties and | personnel perform their assigned duties and tasks to | |||
tasks to standard and adhere to the Camp Delta SOP; | standard and adhere to the Camp Delta SOP; and | |||
and coordinate logistical support of the guard force and | coordinate logistical support of the guard force and | |||
detainees for their shift. Specific duties of the SOG are | detainees for their shift. Specific duties of the SOG are | |||
detailed in the Special Orders portion of this SOP. | detailed in the Special Orders portion of this SOP. | |||
(1) SOG1 will be assigned to Camp Delta 1, and | (1) SOG1 will be assigned to Camp Delta 1, and | |||
will be an MP NCO, SFC or above. SOG1 is | will be an MP NCO, SFC or above. SOG1 is | |||
designated as the senior SOG for the shift. | designated as the senior SOG for the shift. | |||
(2) SOG2 will be assigned to Camp Delta 2 and | (2) SOG2 will be assigned to Camp Delta 2 and | |||
3, and will be an MP NCO, SFC or above. | 3, and will be an MP NCO, SFC or above. | |||
(3) SOG3 will be assigned to Camp Delta 4, and | (3) SOG 3 will be assigned to perform duties | |||
will be an MP NCO, SSG or above. | between Sally ports 1&8 “Camp Delta Mainstreet”, | |||
Gold, Brown and Yellow JIIF trailers. SOG 3 will be | ||||
an MP NCO, SSG or above. | ||||
(4) SOG 4 will be assigned to Camp 4, and will | ||||
be an MP NCO, SSG or above. | ||||
f. Block NCOIC* A Block NCOIC will be | f. Block NCOIC* A Block NCOIC will be | |||
assigned to each occupied cell block for each shift. | assigned to each occupied block for each shift. The | |||
The Block NCOIC is supervises all block guards | Block NCOIC is supervises all guards assigned to the | |||
assigned to the block and is responsible for all aspects | block and is responsible for all aspects of custody and | |||
of custody and control, care, shelter, feeding, and | control, care, shelter, feeding, and treatment of all | |||
treatment of all detainees housed in the cell block. | detainees housed in the cell block. | |||
g. Escort Control NCO* and Assistant Escort | g. Escort Control NCO* and Assistant Escort | |||
Control NCO* An NCO (SGT or above) will be | Control NCO* An NCO (SGT or above) will be | |||
assigned as the Escort Control NCO for each shift. An | assigned as the Escort Control NCO for each shift. An | |||
NCO (CPL or above) will be assigned as the Assistant | NCO (CPL or above) will be assigned as the Assistant | |||
Escort Control NCO for day and swing shift. The | Escort Control NCO for day and swing shift. The | |||
Escort Control NCO and Assistant NCO are | Escort Control NCO and Assistant NCO are | |||
responsible for all aspects of Camp Delta escort | responsible for all aspects of Camp Delta escort | |||
operations. | operations. | |||
h. DOC NCO and Assistant DOC NCO An NCO | h. DOC NCO and Assistant DOC NCO An NCO | |||
(SGT or above) will be assigned as the DOC NCO. An | (SGT or above) will be assigned as the DOC NCO. An | |||
NCO (CPL or above) will be assigned as the Assistant | NCO (CPL or above) will be assigned as the Assistant | |||
DOC NCO for day and swing shift. The DOC NCO | DOC NCO for day and swing shift. The DOC NCO | |||
and Assistant DOC NCO are responsible for | and Assistant DOC NCO are responsible for | |||
controlling, reporting, and tracking all aspects of | controlling, reporting, and tracking all aspects of | |||
detention facility operations. | detention facility operations. | |||
i. Detention Hospital Security Force NCO An | i. Detention Hospital Security Force NCOIC An | |||
NCO (SSG or above) will be detailed to perform duty | NCO (SSG or above) will be detailed to perform duty | |||
at the Detention Hospital. This NCO is responsible for | at the Detention Hospital. This NCO is responsible for | |||
all security provided at the Detention Hospital, and for | all security provided at the Detention Hospital, and for | |||
the custody and control of all detainees treated at the | the custody and control of all detainees treated at the | |||
Detention Hospital (in-patient and out-patient). All | Detention Hospital (in-patient and out-patient). All | |||
guards assigned to work a shift at the Detention | guards assigned to work a shift at the Detention | |||
Hospital are OPCON to the Detention Hospital | Hospital are OPCON to the Detention Hospital | |||
Security Force NCO. | Security Force NCO. | |||
j. DOC Clerk Responsibilities include, but are not | j. DOC Clerk Responsibilities include, but are not | |||
limited to, maintaining the Camp Delta Blotter, radio- | limited to, maintaining the Camp Delta Blotter, | |||
telephone operator tasks, detainee tracking, and other | radiotelephone operator tasks, detainee tracking, and | |||
duties as assigned by DOC NCO. | other duties as assigned by DOC NCO. | |||
2-6. Detention Services Branch (DSB) | 2-6. Detention Services Branch (DSB) | |||
a. Detention Services Officer* Supervises all | a. Detention Services Officer* Supervises all | |||
aspects of detainee record administration, Camp Delta | aspects of detainee record administration, Camp Delta | |||
operational records administration, detainee | operational records administration, detainee | |||
administrative and logistics support, detainee database | administrative and logistics support, detainee database | |||
management, mission tracking, and reporting | management, mission tracking, and reporting | |||
requirements. Responsible for staffing and publishing | requirements. Responsible for staffing and publishing | |||
SOPs for detention facility operations, and | SOPs for detention facility operations, and | |||
coordination with JTF-GTMO staff, subordinate units, | coordination with JTF-GTMO staff, subordinate units, | |||
contractors, medical staff, JIG, law enforcement | contractors, medical staff, JIG, law enforcement | |||
skipping to change at line 642 | skipping to change at line 714 | |||
orders and memorandums. | orders and memorandums. | |||
b. Strict control and continuous records | b. Strict control and continuous records | |||
management is critical to ensure thorough | management is critical to ensure thorough | |||
accountability of all information concerning detainee | accountability of all information concerning detainee | |||
records, other administrative documents, and | records, other administrative documents, and | |||
accountability of equipment. All personnel will strictly | accountability of equipment. All personnel will strictly | |||
comply with the Privacy Act and Freedom of | comply with the Privacy Act and Freedom of | |||
Information Act concerning divulging of information, | Information Act concerning divulging of information, | |||
either telephonically or in hard copy. | either telephonically or in hard copy. | |||
c. Much of the operational and administrative | c. Much of the operational and administrative | |||
records of Camp Delta are classified or sensitive in | records of Camp Delta is classified or sensitive in | |||
nature and will be safeguarded as such. Personnel will | nature and will be safeguarded as such. Personnel will | |||
not authorize release of information to the media. | not authorize release of information to the media. | |||
d. Records will not be removed from the facility | d. Records will not be removed from the facility | |||
without authority from the CJDOG. Requests from | without authority from the CJDOG. Requests from | |||
outside organizations will be routed through command | outside organizations will be routed through command | |||
channels for decisions. Under no circumstances will a | channels for decisions. Under no circumstances will a | |||
detainee review or have access to his records. | detainee review or have access to his records. | |||
Chapter 3 | Chapter 3 | |||
Detainee Reception Operations | Detainee Reception Operations | |||
3-1. Overview Periodically, detainees will arrive at | 3-1. Overview Periodically, detainees will arrive at | |||
Leeward Airfield to be moved to Camp Delta for | Leeward Airfield to be moved to Camp Delta for | |||
detention. The JDOG S3 will provide for specific | detention. The JDOG S3 will provide for specific | |||
instructions and training prior to the reception of | instructions and training prior to the reception of | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
3-2. Infantry Support Operations | 3-2. Infantry Support Operations | |||
a. Detainee reception operations consist of four | a. See Infantry SOP for DMO Operations | |||
phases. Outlined below are the inbound mission | ||||
phases: | ||||
(1) Phase 1 consists of preparation of movement, | ||||
the staging of personnel, securing of vehicles, and a | ||||
route reconnaissance. | ||||
(2) Phase 2 consists of the transferring of | ||||
detainees from the aircraft to JTF-GTMO, the | ||||
detainees searched, loaded, secured for transport, and | ||||
convoyed to Leeward Ferry Landing. | ||||
(3) Phase 3 consists of the detainee movement | ||||
from Leeward to Windward Landing and C3 with the | ||||
JOC and the Camp Delta DOC. | ||||
(4) The last phase consists of the detainee | ||||
movement from Windward Ferry Landing to Camp | ||||
Delta utilizing Checkpoints for movement. Detainee | ||||
Transfers to another installation is conducted the same, | ||||
but the process is executed in reverse. | ||||
b. During phase 1, the unit stages its personnel and | ||||
equipment consisting of the following requirement: | ||||
four HMMWVs with .50 Cal MGs, one 2 ½ Ton Truck | ||||
and one cargo HMMWV (38 total passengers) from | ||||
Leeward Airfield to Camp Delta. The four HMMWVs | ||||
will have a .50 Cal MG mounted on each of them. Unit | ||||
will also provide one Squad (minimum nine soldiers) | ||||
with cargo HMMWV as a Dismounted Security Force, | ||||
a (17 soldier) QRF (both lethal and non-lethal capable) | ||||
element on the 2 ½ Ton, and a minimal C2 cell. | ||||
Initially, two gun trucks and a Maintenance Contact | ||||
Team will go to the Leeward side one hour prior to the | ||||
main body departure performing a route recon. Once | ||||
on the Leeward side, both gun trucks will conduct a | ||||
sweep of the airfield and establish support-by-fire | ||||
(SBF) positions overlooking the ferry landing. One gun | ||||
truck will remain in its SBF position while the other | ||||
continues to sweep the airfield. The second gun truck | ||||
will occupy its designated SBF position once the Ferry | ||||
nears the landing. The lead gun truck will coordinate | ||||
with JTF on the flight call signs. The main body links | ||||
up with the buses and the ambulance at the Windward | ||||
Ferry Landing and proceeds across to the Leeward | ||||
Ferry Landing. Once off loaded on the Leeward side, | ||||
the convoy proceeds to the flight line. One Gun Truck, | ||||
the Security Team Cargo HMMWV, the MP Working | ||||
Dog Team, and the last Gun Truck proceed up route #1 | ||||
(West). The two busses, ambulance, and the QRF | ||||
vehicle proceed up route #2 (South). All vehicles will | ||||
stage and wait for the aircraft to arrive. The | ||||
Maintenance Contact Team moves to the Leeward | ||||
Ferry Landing and provides security of the ferry while | ||||
docked. | ||||
c. Phase 2 begins once the aircraft is on the ground. | ||||
The gun trucks proceed to positions forming a | ||||
perimeter around the aircraft. One Security Squad | ||||
Team positions itself from the aircrafts 11 o’clock to 1 | ||||
o’clock position. The second Security Squad Team | ||||
positions itself from 5 o’clock to 7 o’clock covering in | ||||
between the two gun trucks. Correct spacing of troops | ||||
in paramount. Deploy these soldiers by vehicle. The | ||||
two busses, the ambulance, and the QRF element will | ||||
then move into position to the rear of the aircraft. The | ||||
QRF dismounts with shields and batons (no weapons) | ||||
and forms a cordon from the aircraft ramp to the lead | ||||
bus and ambulance. The CO coordinates with the | ||||
Aircraft Commander to get all pertinent information on | ||||
detainees. MPs will move detainees to the busses. | ||||
Secure the detainees on the busses and then the convoy | ||||
proceeds to the ferry and loads for return to the | ||||
Windward side. | ||||
d. During phase 3, position a sniper (one soldier | ||||
from the QRF w/ two spotters) on top of the ferry | ||||
during the movement from the Leeward side to the | ||||
Windward side. QRF provides security (with | ||||
weapons) on the deck of the ferry for the crossing. The | ||||
Security squad provides security from the bridge side | ||||
of the ferry. The Sniper Team will remain in position | ||||
until the ramp of the ferry begins to deploy. Upon | ||||
docking on the Windward side, the convoy offloads | ||||
and lines up for movement back to Camp Delta. | ||||
e. During the last phase, the order of march is one | ||||
gun truck, the two detainee busses, the ambulance, one | ||||
gun truck, the QRF Element, the Security squad, the | ||||
MP working dog team, and finally the last two gun | ||||
trucks. March speed is 30 MPH. The convoy will | ||||
report all seven checkpoints (see coordinating | ||||
instructions in the OPORD) back to Camp Delta to the | ||||
JOC. The lead gun truck establishes a Blocking | ||||
Position (BP) on the road at Sally Port 1 of Camp Delta | ||||
as the buses and ambulances enter the gate. Once | ||||
detainees are in the camp and the gate is closed all | ||||
vehicles will proceed to Seaside Galley parking lot for | ||||
an after action review (AAR) and a mission debriefing. | ||||
The QRF will remain on the 2 ½ Ton Truck outside of | ||||
Sally Port #1 until properly relieved by the MPs. | ||||
3-3. Infantry Support Force | ||||
a. Team Omaha secures the airfield and designated | ||||
route to facilitate the safe and unhindered | ||||
transportation of detainees to / from the Camp Delta | ||||
Detainment Facility. | ||||
b. The mission consists of the following elements: | ||||
Quick Reaction Force (QRF), a Dismounted Security | ||||
Element (one Squad), a Mounted Security Element | ||||
(four HMMWVs w/ .50 Cal MGs), two Bus Teams, a | ||||
MP Working Dog (MWD) Team, and a C2 element. | ||||
c. The QRF comes from the Platoon currently the | ||||
QRF in Camp Delta or if the designated Platoon has | ||||
enough personnel for the mission. It consists of two | ||||
Squads and the QRF PL. This element rides on a 2 ½- | ||||
ton Truck, and carries both lethal and non-lethal | ||||
weapons. The QRF PL maintains command and | ||||
control (C2) of this element. | ||||
d. The Dismounted Security Element is a Squad. It | ||||
comes from the same Platoon designated for the | ||||
detainee Movement Operation. This squad rides on a | ||||
Troop/Cargo HMMWV, and carries only lethal weapon | ||||
systems. | ||||
e. The mounted security element consists of four | ||||
HMMWVs with .50 Cal MGs. The PL maintains | ||||
command and control (C2) of this element. | ||||
f. The JDOG provides the two teams of bus | ||||
personnel. They link up with the buses at either the | ||||
Leeward or Windward Ferry Landing. | ||||
g. The JDOG also provides a Military Working Dog | ||||
Team. They utilize an A/C HMMWV that provides | ||||
comfort to the Dogs. The Combat Camera Team will | ||||
also be located in this vehicle. | ||||
h. The C2 element consists of the CO and the | ||||
Infantry Task Force Commander. They both ride in | ||||
each of the Gun trucks from the Mounted Security | ||||
Squads. Each of these personnel has the following | ||||
responsibilities: | ||||
(1) The CO is overall responsible for the | ||||
download of detainees. He has command and control | ||||
(C2) of the QRF, the Security Squad, and the Mounted | ||||
Security Element, the two Bus Teams, the Military | ||||
Working Dog Team, and the Medical assets. He | ||||
coordinates with Air Force personnel prior to the plane | ||||
landing and the security crew on the plane once the | ||||
plane has landed. He reports directly to the Infantry | ||||
Task Force Commander. | ||||
(2) The Task Force Commander has Command | ||||
and Control (C2) of all operational assets. The CO | ||||
reports to him. He has TACON of the Port Security | ||||
Unit (PSU) boats, and reports directly to the Joint | ||||
Operations Center (JOC). | ||||
3-4. Land Movement | 3-4. Land Movement | |||
a. Follow the guidelines listed below for the airfield | a. Follow the guidelines listed below for the airfield | |||
reception of detainees. | reception of detainees. | |||
b. The JDOG will identify two NCOs to receive | b. The JDOG will identify two NCOs to receive | |||
detainee property and the manifest. NCO #1 will | detainee property and the manifest. NCO #1 will | |||
obtain the manifest from the personnel on the aircraft | obtain the manifest from the personnel on the aircraft | |||
and ride with the lead bus to Camp Delta. NCO #1 will | and ride with the lead bus to Camp Delta. NCO #1 will | |||
turn over this manifest upon arrival at Camp Delta to | turn over this manifest upon arrival at Camp Delta to | |||
the in-processing escort NCOIC. NCO #2 will receive | the in-processing escort NCOIC. NCO #2 will receive | |||
the detainee property and coordinate with JIG for | the detainee property and coordinate with JIG for | |||
custody of the property. Once this coordination is done | custody of the property. Once this coordination is done | |||
and property needed by the JIG is released to them, the | and property needed by the JIG is released to them, the | |||
remaining property will be taken to JDOG S-4 and | remaining property will be taken to JDOG S-4 and | |||
released to the Property Book Officer (PBO) for | released to the Property Book Officer (PBO) for | |||
storage, IAW AR 210-174. | storage, IAW AR 210-174. | |||
c. Utilize six MPs, including one MP with a | c. Utilize six guards, including one guard with a | |||
shotgun, per detainee bus. | shotgun, per detainee bus. | |||
d. Two MPs will receive the detainee from the | d. Two guards will receive the detainee from the | |||
aircraft escort team. They will pat down the detainee | aircraft escort team. They will pat down the detainee | |||
then turn the detainee over to the MPs on the bus. | then turn the detainee over to the guards on the bus. | |||
e. Three MPs will remain on the bus and receive the | e. Three guards will remain on the bus and receive | |||
patted-down detainee from the two MPs on the ground. | the patted-down detainee from the two guards on the | |||
They will move the detainee to his position on the bus | ground. They will move the detainee to his position on | |||
and secure him to the floor. | the bus and secure him to the floor. | |||
f. Once the bus is full, all six MPs will travel on the | f. Once the bus is full, all six guards will travel on | |||
bus to provide security for the detainees. | the bus to provide security for the detainees. | |||
g. Both buses will be loaded at the same time. | g. Both buses will be loaded at the same time. | |||
h. Infantry will be responsible for area outer | h. Infantry will be responsible for area outer | |||
security during the airfield operations and the convoy | security during the airfield operations and the convoy | |||
from the airport to Camp Delta. | from the airport to Camp Delta. | |||
i. The detainees will be in a three-piece suit. | i. The detainees will be in a three-piece suit. | |||
j. The bus guards must bring sufficient handcuffs to | j. The bus guards must bring sufficient handcuffs to | |||
secure the detainees to the chain in the bus. | secure the detainees to the chain in the bus. | |||
3-5. In-processing Security | 3-5. In-processing Security | |||
a. Periodically, detainees will arrive at Camp Delta | a. Periodically, detainees will arrive at Camp Delta | |||
to be detained until an appropriate disposition is | to be detained until an appropriate disposition is | |||
decided. The following guidelines will be followed for | decided. The following guidelines will be followed for | |||
the in-processing. | in-processing. | |||
b. The DOC will be responsible for transmitting via | b. The DOC will be responsible for transmitting via | |||
brevity code the following actions. Separate brevity | brevity code the following actions. Separate brevity | |||
codes are used for the dress rehearsal and mission for | codes are used for the dress rehearsal and mission for | |||
the following phases: | the following phases: | |||
(1) Off-loading of detainees commences | (1) Off-loading of detainees commences | |||
(2) Off-loading of detainees completed | (2) Off-loading of detainees completed | |||
(3) Completion of in-processing. | (3) Completion of in-processing. | |||
c. Two Escort NCOICs should be identified for the | c. Two Escort NCOICs should be identified for the | |||
operation of detainee in-processing. One will be | operation of detainee in-processing. One will be | |||
responsible for receiving detainees and moving them | responsible for receiving detainees and moving them | |||
skipping to change at line 872 | skipping to change at line 799 | |||
(2) Dressing room personnel will also prepare | (2) Dressing room personnel will also prepare | |||
jump suites i.e. insert shorts into bottoms and roll pant | jump suites i.e. insert shorts into bottoms and roll pant | |||
legs up at least half way. | legs up at least half way. | |||
(3) Stage trash cans with liners, one outside | (3) Stage trash cans with liners, one outside | |||
dressing room for goggles, two inside stripping room | dressing room for goggles, two inside stripping room | |||
for clothes, three in holding area #1 for mittens, | for clothes, three in holding area #1 for mittens, | |||
earmuffs, and miscellaneous trash. | earmuffs, and miscellaneous trash. | |||
(4) Two cardboard boxes should be placed in | (4) Two cardboard boxes should be placed in | |||
holding area #1 for the Air Force black boxes and | holding area #1 for the Air Force black boxes and | |||
chains. | chains. | |||
(5) Set up two tables in holding area #1 for water. | (5) Set up two tables in holding area #1 for water. | |||
MPs will use three coolers identified for their use. | Guards will use three coolers identified for their use. | |||
Detainees will use two coolers identified for their use. | Detainees will use two coolers identified for their use. | |||
Secure Styrofoam cups and coordinate with medics to | Secure Styrofoam cups and coordinate with medics to | |||
obtain ice. | obtain ice. | |||
(6) Get rubber gloves from medics. | (6) Get rubber gloves from medics. | |||
(7) Coordinate with the DOC to stage four golf | (7) Coordinate with the DOC to stage four | |||
carts, with keys, fueled up, and outside holding area #2. | Gators, with keys, fueled up, and outside holding area | |||
#2. | ||||
(8) Secure gate keys “A” and “B” from the DOC. | (8) Secure gate keys “A” and “B” from the DOC. | |||
(9) Secure at least six Saber radios from the | (9) Secure at least six Saber radios from the | |||
DOC. One for each of the NCOICs and one for each of | DOC. One for each of the NCOICs and one for each of | |||
the golf cart drivers. | the Gator drivers. | |||
(10) Shades will be closed on blocks to restrict | (10) Shades will be closed on blocks to restrict | |||
detainee’s view of in-processing. | detainee’s view of in-processing. | |||
(11) Secure two road guard vests for soldiers | (11) Secure two road guard vests for soldiers | |||
directing convoy. | directing convoy. | |||
e. Once in-processing personnel arrive, they will | e. Once in-processing personnel arrive, they will | |||
begin by sweeping holding areas #1 and #2. MPs will | begin by sweeping holding areas #1 and #2. Guards | |||
then be tasked as follows: | will then be tasked as follows: | |||
(1) Two for holding area #1 security. | (1) Two for holding area #1 security. | |||
(2) Two for mitten and earmuff removal as well | (2) Two for mitten and earmuff removal as well | |||
as distributing water to detainees in holding area. | as distributing water to detainees in holding area. | |||
(3) Two for restraint removal and preparing | (3) Two for restraint removal and preparing | |||
clothing to be removed. | clothing to be removed. | |||
(4) Two for the strip room. | (4) Two for the strip room. | |||
(5) Two for shower and lice room. Wet weather | (5) Two for shower and lice room. Wet weather | |||
gear will be provided for soldiers. | gear will be provided for soldiers. | |||
(6) Two for physical inspection room. | (6) Two for physical inspection room. | |||
(7) Two for the dressing room. | (7) Two for the dressing room. | |||
(8) Two to direct detainee convoy into Camp | (8) Two to direct detainee convoy into Camp | |||
Delta. Road Guard vests will be issued from supply. | Delta. Road guard vests will be issued from supply. | |||
(9) One to check off detainee roster inside | (9) One to check off detainee roster inside | |||
holding area #1. | holding area #1. | |||
(10) Four to six in riot gear to serve as the | (10) Four to six in riot gear to serve as the | |||
Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) team. | Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) team. | |||
(11) Remaining soldiers will be paired with an | (11) Remaining soldiers will be paired with an | |||
NCO who will sign for a handcuff key. | NCO who will sign for a handcuff key. | |||
(12) Four of these soldiers will be identified to be | (12) Four of these soldiers will be identified to be | |||
litter escorts if needed. | litter escorts if needed. | |||
f. NCO from the JDOG turns keys to black boxes to | f. NCO from the JDOG turns keys to black boxes to | |||
Reception NCOIC and manifest over to JDOG S-1 at | Reception NCOIC and manifest over to JDOG S-1 at | |||
processing area. The manifest will identify the order of | processing area. The manifest will identify the order of | |||
processing for detainees. The manifest usually will | processing for detainees. The manifest usually will | |||
designate a “Top Ten” list of the first detainees to be | designate a “Top Ten” list of the first detainees to be | |||
interviewed at the Joint Intelligence Interrogation | interviewed at the Joint Intelligence Interrogation | |||
Facility (JIIF). | Facility (JIIF). | |||
g. Processing area escort MPs move detainees into | g. Processing area escort guards move detainees | |||
holding area as they are taken off of the buses. Escorts | into holding area as they are taken off of the buses. | |||
operate as teams of two. | Escorts operate as teams of two. | |||
h. Escorts remove earmuffs and black boxes from | h. Escorts remove earmuffs and black boxes from | |||
detainees. Black boxes are staged outside of holding | detainees. Black boxes are staged outside of holding | |||
area pending return to Air Force. Four medics from the | area pending return to Air Force. Four medics from the | |||
JDOG check detainees after they are placed in holding | JDOG check detainees after they are placed in holding | |||
area. This is a check for any medical condition | area. This is a check for any medical condition | |||
requiring immediate attention (heat problems, etc.) | requiring immediate attention (heat problems, etc.) | |||
i. Escort teams move detainees through the | i. Escort teams move detainees through the | |||
processing stations. Unless otherwise specified, | processing stations. Unless otherwise specified, | |||
restraints remain on detainees. Some stations require | restraints remain on detainees. Some stations require | |||
removal of some restraints, however, at no time, unless | removal of some restraints, however, at no time, unless | |||
skipping to change at line 973 | skipping to change at line 901 | |||
into PWIS database. | into PWIS database. | |||
(7) Station 7: Photo for identity (ID) bracelet is | (7) Station 7: Photo for identity (ID) bracelet is | |||
taken in room adjacent to database interview room. | taken in room adjacent to database interview room. | |||
(8) Station 8: Move to hallway for taking of | (8) Station 8: Move to hallway for taking of | |||
fingerprints. The JDOG be prepared to provide two | fingerprints. The JDOG be prepared to provide two | |||
MPs to take fingerprints. | MPs to take fingerprints. | |||
(9) Station 9: Detainee is moved to medical in- | (9) Station 9: Detainee is moved to medical in- | |||
processing. Detainee is placed on cot for blood draw. | processing. Detainee is placed on cot for blood draw. | |||
(10) Station 10: Detainee is moved to x-ray room | (10) Station 10: Detainee is moved to x-ray room | |||
and receives chest x-ray. Medical personnel will place | and receives chest x-ray. Medical personnel will place | |||
lead aprons over MPs while MPs maintain control of | lead aprons over guards while guards maintain control | |||
detainee. | of detainee. | |||
(11) Station 11: Detainee is moved to medical | (11) Station 11: Detainee is moved to medical | |||
exam room. | exam room. | |||
(12) Station 12: Detainee is moved to dental | (12) Station 12: Detainee is moved to dental | |||
exam room. (Station 11 and Station 12 can be done in | exam room. (Station 11 and Station 12 can be done in | |||
the reverse order, depending on their availability.) | the reverse order, depending on their availability.) | |||
j. If the detainee is one of the first 10 being | j. If the detainee is one of the first 10 being | |||
processed, as identified by the manifest, he is taken | processed, as identified by the manifest, he is taken | |||
directly to JIIF and turned over to JIIF escort personnel | directly to JIIF and turned over to JIIF escort personnel | |||
at the JIIF sally port. | at the JIIF sally port. | |||
k. If the detainee is not one of the first 10 being | k. If the detainee is not one of the first 10 being | |||
processed, he is moved through the system in the | processed, he is moved through the system in the | |||
normal order. | normal order. | |||
l. Escorts provide four MPs to drive golf carts | l. Escorts provide four guards to drive Gators | |||
moving detainees to and from the blocks and medical. | moving detainees to and from the blocks and medical. | |||
An escort team will accompany the golf carts as | An escort team will accompany the Gators as detainees | |||
detainees are moved to and from the blocks to medical | are moved to and from the blocks to medical at | |||
at processing. | processing. | |||
m.Once all processing is complete, MPs will insure | m.Once all processing is complete, guards will | |||
that all handcuffs, goggles, earmuffs, leg irons, black | insure that all handcuffs, goggles, earmuffs, leg irons, | |||
boxes, and belly chains are accounted for and | black boxes, and belly chains are accounted for and | |||
assembled for return to the Air Force. These items will | assembled for return to the Air Force. These items will | |||
be picked up for return to Leeward Airfield. | be picked up for return to Leeward Airfield. | |||
n. Once all processing is complete, the processing | n. Once all processing is complete, the processing | |||
building will be cleaned and policed. | building will be cleaned and policed. | |||
3-6. Inbound and Outbound Operations | 3-6. Inbound and Outbound Operations | |||
Refer to Annex E Air Bridge Operations. | Refer to Annex E/SIPR Detainee Movement | |||
Operations (DMO). | ||||
3-7. Linguist Support | 3-7. Linguist Support | |||
The JDOG S3 will task linguists to support reception | The JDOG S3 will task linguists to support reception | |||
operations. The languages of the transferring detainees | operations. The languages of the transferring detainees | |||
will determine which linguists will be used in the | will determine which linguists will be used in the | |||
transfer process from the point of origin to Camp Delta | transfer process from the point of origin to Camp Delta | |||
and from Camp Delta to transfer location for an | and from Camp Delta to transfer location for an | |||
outbound mission. | outbound mission. | |||
3-8. Facility Support | ||||
a. Two days prior to the arrival of the detainees, the | ||||
block(s) to house the new arrivals will be emptied of | ||||
their occupants. | ||||
b. MPs will inspect the block(s) for any trash or | ||||
items left in the cells. Any items of intelligence value | ||||
will be turned over to the JDOG S-2. | ||||
c. If there is any graffiti on the cell walls or doors, | ||||
shower areas, or the exercise yard, an interpreter will | ||||
be called to interpret it and record the translation. The | ||||
JDOG S-2 will be contacted to coordinate any need to | ||||
record images of the graffiti. | ||||
d. Once JDOG S-2 is finished with the graffiti, the | ||||
R&U section will paint over all graffiti in the cells, | ||||
shower and the exercise yard. | ||||
3-9. Inbound Preparation Requirements | ||||
a. This activity requires coordination with the | ||||
following groups and/or individuals: | ||||
(1) Infantry Task Force | ||||
(2) Joint Medical Group (JMG) to include psych | ||||
staff | ||||
(3) Combat Camera | ||||
(4) Detainee Chaplain | ||||
(5) ICE | ||||
(6) Interpreters for additional linguists support | ||||
(7) J-4 for additional transportation assets | ||||
b. An access roster of personnel allowed into the | ||||
processing building will be created and forwarded to | ||||
the processing line NCOIC. Personnel on the access | ||||
roster will be issued badges. R&U will construct a | ||||
temporary barrier around the processing facility. | ||||
Unauthorized personnel will be kept away from the | ||||
processing line by the infantry. | ||||
c. Prior to the arrival of the detainees, the JDOG S- | ||||
1 will distribute the manifest to JDOG Ops and others | ||||
to coordinate their activities for the detainee’s arrival. | ||||
d. The land bridge guards will obtain the following | ||||
items from JDOG S-3 for use: | ||||
(1) Zip ties | ||||
(2) Search gloves | ||||
(3) ISO mats for the processing holding area | ||||
(4) Surgical masks for the guards | ||||
(5) MREs for the guards for lunch | ||||
(6) Two pairs of EMT scissors | ||||
(7) Two pairs of cutters (wire cutters) | ||||
(8) Three-piece suit for each detainee and staged | ||||
in the processing building. | ||||
e. JDOG Ops will coordinate with J-4 transportation | ||||
for the detainee buses and bus drivers. | ||||
f. The S-1 will stage the following items in the | ||||
processing building: | ||||
(1) Two towels for each detainee | ||||
(2) Scrub brushes | ||||
(3) Uniform and flip-flops for each detainee. | ||||
g. JDOG Ops will coordinate with J-3 operations | ||||
for additional radios with the secure long-range | ||||
frequency when there are insufficient quantities | ||||
available at Camp Delta. | ||||
3-10. Outbound Preparation Requirements | ||||
a. This activity requires coordination with the | ||||
following groups and/or individuals: | ||||
(1) JAG for the exit interview and release | ||||
agreement | ||||
(2) ICRC for an exit interview | ||||
(3) Combat Camera | ||||
(4) Detainee Chaplain | ||||
(5) JMG to include the psych staff | ||||
(6) Interpreters | ||||
(7) JIG | ||||
(8) PSYOPS | ||||
b. Prior to the departure of the detainees, the JDOG | ||||
S-1 will distribute the transfer order and manifest to | ||||
JDOG Ops and others to coordinate their activities for | ||||
the detainee’s departure. | ||||
c. JDOG Ops will coordinate the following items: | ||||
(1) Broadcast of two PSYOP messages about the | ||||
pending transfer of detainees | ||||
(2) Arranging a feast in Camp 4 for all detainees | ||||
that will occur the night before they leave | ||||
(3) Issuance of the following detainee travel | ||||
items: | ||||
(a) Prayer Beads | ||||
(b) Prayer Cap | ||||
(c) Koran | ||||
(d) Book | ||||
(e) Sports or duffel bag | ||||
(f) Jeans | ||||
(g) Shoes | ||||
(h) Socks | ||||
(i) T-Shirt | ||||
(j) Shirt | ||||
(k) Boxer Shorts | ||||
(l) Shaving Cream | ||||
(m) Disposable Razor | ||||
(n) Deodorant | ||||
(o) Shampoo | ||||
(p) Toothpaste | ||||
(q) Package of Kleenex | ||||
(r) Package of Wet Wipes | ||||
(s) Comb. | ||||
(4) The following travel items will be dependant on | ||||
the destination’s climate: | ||||
(a) Jacket | ||||
(b) Blanket | ||||
(c) Thermal underwear bottoms | ||||
(d) Thermal underwear tops. | ||||
(5) Transportation for the transfers through the J- | ||||
4 transportation office. | ||||
(6) MP escorts for the transport, lead, and trail | ||||
vehicles. | ||||
Chapter 4 | Chapter 4 | |||
Detainee Processing (Reception/Transfer/Release) | Detainee Processing (Reception/Transfer/Release) | |||
4-1. Purpose | 4-1. Purpose | |||
To in-process detainees, update and maintain the DRS | To in-process detainees, update and maintain the DRS | |||
(Detainee Reporting System) database, send daily | (Detainee Reporting System) database, send daily | |||
upload and report to the National Detainee Records | upload and report to the National Detainee Records | |||
Center (NDRC). Support other JDOG sections through | Center (NDRC). Support other JDOG sections through | |||
database research and queries. DRS is the principle | database research and queries. DRS is the principle | |||
database for detainee’s administrative records. | database for detainee’s administrative records. | |||
skipping to change at line 1053 | skipping to change at line 1092 | |||
detainee information collected during the in-processing | detainee information collected during the in-processing | |||
in theater. Use SIPRNET to send this. | in theater. Use SIPRNET to send this. | |||
d. Between 4-6 hours prior to arrival, an order list | d. Between 4-6 hours prior to arrival, an order list | |||
will arrive from the JIG detailing the order in which | will arrive from the JIG detailing the order in which | |||
they want the detainees processed. Processing line | they want the detainees processed. Processing line | |||
personnel will attempt to follow this order, however the | personnel will attempt to follow this order, however the | |||
processing mission takes precedent. If the order list | processing mission takes precedent. If the order list | |||
does not arrive, contact the JIG to confirm order. | does not arrive, contact the JIG to confirm order. | |||
4-5. Personnel Requirements | 4-5. Personnel Requirements | |||
a. Holding Area. | a. Holding Area. | |||
(1) One MP NCO assigned from a subordinate | (1) One guard NCO assigned from a subordinate | |||
MP company to control the off-loading of the busses, | MP company to control the off-loading of the busses, | |||
positioning of detainees in the holding area, and | positioning of detainees in the holding area, and | |||
security of the holding area. | security of the holding area. | |||
(2) There will be two MP escorts per detainee. A | (2) There will be two escorts per detainee. A | |||
ratio of 2:1 is required. | ratio of 2:1 is required. | |||
(3) Medical personnel: An NCOIC and four | (3) Medical personnel: An NCOIC and four | |||
medics set up and operate a first aid station. | medics set up and operate a first aid station. | |||
b. Processing Trailer. | b. Processing Trailer. | |||
(1) NCOIC: Controls traffic in the trailer and | (1) NCOIC: Controls traffic in the trailer and | |||
coordinates with all entities for smooth flow of | coordinates with all entities for smooth flow of | |||
detainees | detainees | |||
c. Undressing Room. | c. Undressing Room. | |||
(1) Two MPs | (1) Two guards | |||
d. Shower Room. | d. Shower Room. | |||
(1) Preventive medicine specialist | (1) Preventive medicine specialist | |||
(2) Medic | (2) Medic | |||
(3) Two MPs | (3) Two guards | |||
e. Cavity Search. | e. Cavity Search. | |||
(1) PA | (1) PA | |||
(2) Medical NCO | (2) Medical NCO | |||
(3) One linguist | (3) One linguist | |||
f. Dressing Room. | f. Dressing Room. | |||
(1) Two MPs | (1) Two guards | |||
g. DNA Sample. | g. DNA Sample. | |||
(1) Two CTIF personnel | (1) Two CTIF personnel | |||
h. Height and Weight. | h. Height and Weight. | |||
(1) Two Admin personnel | (1) Two Admin personnel | |||
i. Processing Room. | i. Processing Room. | |||
(1) Three processing clerks | (1) Three processing clerks | |||
(2) Three intelligence personnel | (2) Three intelligence personnel | |||
(3) Three linguists | (3) Three linguists | |||
j. Camera Room. | j. Camera Room. | |||
(1) Two admin clerks for picture and ID | (1) Two admin clerks for picture and ID | |||
wristband processing, | wristband processing, | |||
(2) Two FBI personnel for five-stage picture | (2) Two FBI personnel for five-stage picture | |||
k. Fingerprinting. | k. Fingerprinting. | |||
(1) Two to four FBI personnel; in their absence, | (1) Two to four FBI personnel; in their absence, | |||
two to four MPs | two to four guards | |||
l. Camp Rules. | l. Camp Rules. | |||
(1) One linguist | (1) One linguist | |||
m.The Linguist OIC will control interpreters | m.The Linguist OIC will control interpreters | |||
stationed throughout the processing trailer. | stationed throughout the processing trailer. | |||
4-6. In-Processing Procedures | 4-6. In-Processing Procedures | |||
a. Prior to detainee arrival, prepare and stage the | a. Prior to detainee arrival, prepare and stage the | |||
following: | following: | |||
(1) Water coolers with ice water and cups for | (1) Water coolers with ice water and cups for | |||
MPs | guards | |||
(2) Water cooler with water (without ice) and | (2) Water cooler with water (without ice) and | |||
cups for detainees | cups for detainees | |||
(3) Several boxes of latex gloves for MPs | (3) Several boxes of latex gloves for guards | |||
(4) Hand sanitizer | (4) Hand sanitizer | |||
(5) Golf carts staged and fueled for transporting | (5) Gators staged and fueled for transporting | |||
detainees to blocks | detainees to blocks | |||
(6) Keys to all gates in both holding areas | (6) Keys to all gates in both holding areas | |||
(7) Raise blinds on North side of Delta block to | (7) Raise blinds on North side of Delta block to | |||
prevent detainees from seeing new arrivals | prevent detainees from seeing new arrivals | |||
(8) Station 4, stage detainee uniforms, and | (8) Station 4, stage detainee uniforms, and | |||
footwear | footwear | |||
(9) Shut down Camp Delta with no non-essential | (9) Shut down Camp Delta with no non-essential | |||
traffic in or out and movement of detainees. | traffic in or out and movement of detainees. | |||
b. Upon arrival, with the busses staged next to the | b. Upon arrival, with the busses staged next to the | |||
holding area, the JDOG S-3 representative on the lead | holding area, the JDOG S-3 representative on the lead | |||
bus will give the manifest with notes, medical records, | bus will give the manifest with notes, medical records, | |||
Air Force shackle keys and the disk with detainee | Air Force shackle keys and the disk with detainee | |||
information to the Processing NCOIC. Pass the | information to the Processing NCOIC. Pass the | |||
appropriate information to medical and processing | appropriate information to medical and processing | |||
personnel and give the Air Force shackle keys to the | personnel and give the Air Force shackle keys to the | |||
MP’s staffing station #5, Dressing & Shackle | guards staffing station #5, Dressing & Shackle | |||
Exchange. | Exchange. | |||
c. MPs form two lines from the bus to the holding | c. MPs form two lines from the bus to the holding | |||
area entrance. As the detainees are brought off the bus, | area entrance. As the detainees are brought off the bus, | |||
the first escort from both lines will escort the detainee | the first escort from both lines will escort the detainee | |||
through the sally port of the holding area. The NCOIC | through the sally port of the holding area. The NCOIC | |||
of the holding area will station himself at the sally port | of the holding area will station himself at the sally port | |||
and direct the placement of each detainee. NCOIC of | and direct the placement of each detainee. NCOIC of | |||
the holding area is responsible for placing the detainees | the holding area is responsible for placing the detainees | |||
in the sequence requested by the JIG. | in the sequence requested by the JIG. | |||
d. Detainee entrance into holding area. Take the | d. Detainee entrance into holding area. Take the | |||
skipping to change at line 1149 | skipping to change at line 1188 | |||
masks in place after seating and securing all detainees. | masks in place after seating and securing all detainees. | |||
All detainees will be off the bus and seated prior to | All detainees will be off the bus and seated prior to | |||
processing beginning. | processing beginning. | |||
In the holding area, medics check the detainees for | In the holding area, medics check the detainees for | |||
distress and administer aid as necessary. If a detainee | distress and administer aid as necessary. If a detainee | |||
is in need of urgent medical care, he can be front- | is in need of urgent medical care, he can be front- | |||
loaded into the processing sequence or taken to the | loaded into the processing sequence or taken to the | |||
hospital where admin personnel will process him after | hospital where admin personnel will process him after | |||
processing all other detainees. | processing all other detainees. | |||
e. On direction from the Processing NCOIC, two | e. On direction from the Processing NCOIC, two | |||
MPs will escort in the first detainee to the processing | guards will escort in the first detainee to the processing | |||
trailer. | trailer. | |||
f. Any detainee requiring special treatment such as | f. Any detainee requiring special treatment such as | |||
going directly to the JIG will be frontloaded in the | going directly to the JIG will be frontloaded in the | |||
processing line. | processing line. | |||
4-7. MP Escort Responsibilities | 4-7. MP Escort Responsibilities | |||
a. A team of two MPs will escort each detainee | a. A team of two guards will escort each detainee | |||
through the entire processing line. On average, the | through the entire processing line. On average, the | |||
processing cycle will last three hours; there is no | processing cycle will last three hours; there is no | |||
provision for rest breaks during these evolutions. | provision for rest breaks during these evolutions. | |||
Escorts must be aware of this requirement. | Escorts must be aware of this requirement. | |||
b. Escorts will maintain four-point contact with | b. Escorts will maintain four-point contact with | |||
their detainee at all times unless directed to modify | their detainee at all times unless directed to modify | |||
their control by processing cadre. | their control by processing cadre. | |||
c. Escorts will assist processing cadre as directed at | c. Escorts will assist processing cadre as directed at | |||
each processing station. | each processing station. | |||
d. Escorts will ensure that the detainees ISN | d. Escorts will ensure that the detainees ISN | |||
skipping to change at line 1185 | skipping to change at line 1224 | |||
escort team at the end of processing. | escort team at the end of processing. | |||
4-8. Clothing Removal Room (Station 1) | 4-8. Clothing Removal Room (Station 1) | |||
Detainee remains shackled while clothing is cut off and | Detainee remains shackled while clothing is cut off and | |||
disposed of. | disposed of. | |||
4-9. Shower (Station 2) | 4-9. Shower (Station 2) | |||
a. A Preventive Medicine Specialist will check | a. A Preventive Medicine Specialist will check | |||
detainee for lice, scabies, and open wounds that require | detainee for lice, scabies, and open wounds that require | |||
treatment. If no treatment is necessary, lower the | treatment. If no treatment is necessary, lower the | |||
goggles from face but stay around detainee neck and he | goggles from face but stay around detainee neck and he | |||
place the detainee in the shower for five minutes and | place the detainee in the shower for five minutes and | |||
scrubbed by MPs. | scrubbed by guards. | |||
b. If treatment is required, medics will apply | b. If treatment is required, medics will apply | |||
treatment while the next detainee in line showers. | treatment while the next detainee in line showers. | |||
4-10. Cavity Search (Station 3) | 4-10. Cavity Search (Station 3) | |||
a. A Physicians Assistant (PA) will give the detainee | a. A Physicians Assistant (PA) will give the detainee | |||
a quick exam, checks for scars, markings, and tattoos. | a quick exam, checks for scars, markings, and tattoos. | |||
If there are any, take a picture of the area for FBI | If there are any, take a picture of the area for FBI | |||
records. | records. | |||
b. PA performs a body cavity search. A linguist | b. PA performs a body cavity search. A linguist | |||
will be present to communicate the procedure. | will be present to communicate the procedure. | |||
4-11. Dressing/Shackle Exchange (Station 4) | 4-11. Dressing/Shackle Exchange (Station 4) | |||
a. Kneel the detainee down on the floor or chair; | a. Kneel the detainee down on the floor or chair; | |||
remove the Air Force leg irons and place them in the | remove the Air Force leg irons and place them in the | |||
storage box to go back to the Air Force | storage box to go back to the Air Force | |||
b. Place orange pants and leg shackles from three- | b. Place orange pants and leg shackles from three- | |||
piece suit on detainee. | piece suit on detainee. | |||
c. Remove hand irons and place in the storage box. | c. Remove hand irons and place in the storage box. | |||
d. Put the orange shirt on the detainee while the | d. Put the orange shirt on the detainee while the | |||
MPs have positive control of arms. | guards have positive control of arms. | |||
e. Place handcuffs from three-piece suit on | e. Place handcuffs from three-piece suit on | |||
detainee. | detainee. | |||
4-12. DNA Sample (Station 5) | 4-12. DNA Sample (Station 5) | |||
MP’s lower surgical mask from detainee, Naval | Guards lower surgical mask from detainee, Naval | |||
Criminal Investigation Service (NCIS) personnel have | Criminal Investigation Service (NCIS) personnel have | |||
detainee open mouth and obtain the DNA swab. | detainee open mouth and obtain the DNA swab. | |||
Replace the surgical mask. | Replace the surgical mask. | |||
4-13. Height and Weight (Station 6) | 4-13. Heights and Weight (Station 6) | |||
Using a standard scale and cloth tape measure taped to | Using a standard scale and cloth tape measure taped to | |||
the wall, measure the detainee and annotate the results | the wall, measure the detainee and annotate the results | |||
on the weight register and forward to DRS personnel | on the weight register and forward to DRS personnel | |||
for processing. | for processing. | |||
4-14. DRS In-Processing (Station 7) | 4-14. DRS In-Processing (Station 7) | |||
a. DRS clerks take personal information from | a. DRS clerks take personal information from | |||
detainee through interpreters. At a minimum, record | detainee through interpreters. At a minimum, record | |||
the following: | the following: | |||
(1) Capturing Country | (1) Capturing Country | |||
skipping to change at line 1235 | skipping to change at line 1274 | |||
(5) Last Name | (5) Last Name | |||
(6) First Name | (6) First Name | |||
(7) Grade | (7) Grade | |||
(8) Nationality | (8) Nationality | |||
(9) Sex. | (9) Sex. | |||
b. JIG representatives may be present and ask | b. JIG representatives may be present and ask | |||
additional questions that the DRS processors will input | additional questions that the DRS processors will input | |||
under the Remarks field. | under the Remarks field. | |||
c. As time permits, gather additional information. | c. As time permits, gather additional information. | |||
4-15. ID Wristband/Dossier (Station 8) | 4-15. ID Wristband/Dossier (Station 8) | |||
a. Seat the detainee in front of the blue screen an | a. Seat the detainee in front of the blue screen a | |||
MP on each side. | guard on each side. | |||
b. Take a front picture. Hold the detainee in the | b. Take a front picture. Hold the detainee in the | |||
chair until confirmation of a good picture. | chair until confirmation of a good picture. | |||
c. Move the detainee to stand in front of the white | c. Move the detainee to stand in front of the white | |||
screen and take five pictures for the FBI’s image | screen and take five pictures for the FBI’s image | |||
recognition software. The five pictures are in terms of | recognition software. The five pictures are in terms of | |||
a clock: 0900, 1000, 1200, 1300, and 1500. | a clock: 0900, 1000, 1200, 1300, and 1500. | |||
d. Four detainee Dossiers are printed and distributed | d. Four detainee Dossiers are printed and distributed | |||
as follows: | as follows: | |||
(1) Used for detainee ID bracelet and ID card | (1) Used for detainee ID bracelet and ID card | |||
(2) In-processing detainee file | (2) In-processing detainee file | |||
skipping to change at line 1260 | skipping to change at line 1299 | |||
front of white screen. Instruct the detainee that if he | front of white screen. Instruct the detainee that if he | |||
removes the ID bracelet he will not be fed until another | removes the ID bracelet he will not be fed until another | |||
is made for him | is made for him | |||
f. Escort handed the detainee ID card. | f. Escort handed the detainee ID card. | |||
g. Escort gives the ID card to block after placing the | g. Escort gives the ID card to block after placing the | |||
detainee in his cell. | detainee in his cell. | |||
4-16. Fingerprint (Station 9) | 4-16. Fingerprint (Station 9) | |||
FBI personnel operate the fingerprint station and use | FBI personnel operate the fingerprint station and use | |||
their automated system and manual system. This | their automated system and manual system. This | |||
station is required to have handcuff keys. In the event | station is required to have handcuff keys. In the event | |||
the FBI cannot send technicians, MPs will operate the | the FBI cannot send technicians, guards will operate | |||
station and use the manual fingerprint forms. | the station and use the manual fingerprint forms. | |||
4-17. Camp Rules (Station 10) | 4-17. Camp Rules (Station 10) | |||
a. Post the camp rules in four languages. | a. Post the camp rules in four languages. | |||
b. If detainee cannot read, provide a linguist to read | b. If detainee cannot read, provide a linguist to read | |||
the rules to him. | the rules to him. | |||
c. The goggles are removed and placed in the | c. The goggles are removed and placed in the | |||
collection can for return to the Air Force | collection can for return to the Air Force | |||
d. Escort the detainee through the medical section. | d. Escort the detainee through the medical section. | |||
4-18. Post Processing | 4-18. Post Processing | |||
a. Collect and turn over handcuffs, leg irons, | a. Collect and turn over handcuffs, leg irons, | |||
padlocks, and goggles to the JDOG S-3 Section for | padlocks, and goggles to the JDOG S-3 Section for | |||
return to the Air Force. | return to the Air Force. | |||
b. Processing trailer cleaned and sterilized | b. Processing trailer cleaned and sterilized | |||
4-19. Reporting | 4-19. Reporting | |||
a. After securing the detainees in the holding area, a | a. After securing the detainees in the holding area, a | |||
wheels down report is due to the NDRC. | wheels down report is due to the NDRC. | |||
b. After processing the last detainee, an Action | b. After processing the last detainee, an Action | |||
Closed Report is due to the NDRC, and perform an | Closed Report is due to the NDRC along with an | |||
upload, sending all new information to the NDRC. | upload that will send all new information to the NDRC. | |||
4-20. Behavior Management Plan | 4-20. Behavior Management Plan | |||
a. Phase One Behavior Management Plan (First | a. Phase One Behavior Management Plan (First | |||
thirty days or as directed by JIG). The purpose of the | thirty days or as directed by JIG). The purpose of the | |||
Behavior Management Plan is to enhance and exploit | Behavior Management Plan is to enhance and exploit | |||
the disorientation and disorganization felt by a newly | the disorientation and disorganization felt by a newly | |||
arrived detainee in the interrogation process. It | arrived detainee in the interrogation process. It | |||
concentrates on isolating the detainee and fostering | concentrates on isolating the detainee and fostering | |||
dependence of the detainee on his interrogator. During | dependence of the detainee on his interrogator. During | |||
the first two weeks at Camp Delta, classify the | the first two weeks at Camp Delta, classify the | |||
detainees as Level 5 and house in a Maximum Security | detainees as Level 5 and house in a Special Housing | |||
Unit (MSU) Block. During this time, the following | Unit (SHU) Block. During this time, the following | |||
conditions will apply: | conditions will apply: | |||
(1) Restricted contact: No ICRC or Chaplain | (1) Restricted contact: No ICRC or Chaplain | |||
contact | contact | |||
(2) No books or mail privileges | (2) No books or mail privileges | |||
(3) MREs for all meals. | (3) MREs for all meals. | |||
(4) Basic comfort items only: | (4) Basic comfort items only: | |||
(a) ISO Mat | (a) ISO Mat | |||
(b) One blanket | (b) One blanket | |||
(c) One towel | (c) One towel | |||
(d) Toothpaste/finger toothbrush | (d) Toothpaste/finger toothbrush | |||
(e) One Styrofoam cup | (e) One Styrofoam cup | |||
(f) Bar of soap | (f) Bar of soap | |||
(g) Camp Rules | (g) Camp Rules | |||
(h) No Koran, prayer beads, prayer cap. | (h) Koran | |||
(i) No Prayer beads or prayer cap. | ||||
(5) Mail writing and delivery will be at the | (5) Mail writing and delivery will be at the | |||
direction of the J-2. | direction of the J-2. | |||
b. Phase Two Behavior Management Plan. The | b. Phase Two Behavior Management Plan. The | |||
two-week period following Phase 1 will continue the | two-week period following Phase 1 will continue the | |||
process of isolating the detainee and fostering | process of isolating the detainee and fostering | |||
dependence on the interrogator. Until the JIG | dependence on the interrogator. Until the JIG | |||
Commander changes his classification, the detainee | Commander changes his classification, the detainee | |||
will remain a Level 5 with the following: | will remain a Level 5 with the following: | |||
(1) Continued MSU | (1) Continued SHU | |||
(2) Koran, prayer beads and prayer cap | (2) Koran, prayer beads and prayer cap | |||
distributed by interrogator | distributed by interrogator | |||
(3) Contacts decided by interrogator | (3) Contacts decided by interrogator | |||
(4) Interrogator decides when to move the | (4) Interrogator decides when to move the | |||
detainee to general population. | detainee to general population. | |||
Chapter 5 | Chapter 5 | |||
Detention Facility Operations | Detention Facility Operations | |||
Section I – | ||||
5-1. Rules of Engagement (ROE) and Rules for the | 5-1. Rules of Engagement (ROE) and Rules for the | |||
Use of Force (RUF) | Use of Force (RUF) | |||
a. References. | a. References. | |||
(1) CJCSI 3121.01A ROE, DODD 5210.56 RUF, | (1) CJCSI 3121.01A ROE, DODD 5210.56 RUF, | |||
& USCINCSO SER ONE | & USCINCSO SER ONE | |||
(2) JTF-GTMO ROE/RUF 30 NOV 02 | (2) JTF-GTMO ROE/RUF 30 NOV 02 | |||
b. The physical security of U.S. Forces & detainees | b. The physical security of U.S. Forces & detainees | |||
in U.S. care is paramount. Use the minimum force | in U.S. care is paramount. Use the minimum force | |||
necessary for mission accomplishment and force | necessary for mission accomplishment and force | |||
protection. | protection. | |||
skipping to change at line 1394 | skipping to change at line 1435 | |||
fence) | fence) | |||
(7) NO WARNING SHOTS | (7) NO WARNING SHOTS | |||
(8) Fire to make the person(s) unable to continue | (8) Fire to make the person(s) unable to continue | |||
the behavior that prompted you to shoot. | the behavior that prompted you to shoot. | |||
(9) Fire with regard for the safety of innocent | (9) Fire with regard for the safety of innocent | |||
bystanders. | bystanders. | |||
(10) A holstered weapon should not be | (10) A holstered weapon should not be | |||
unholstered unless you expect to use it. | unholstered unless you expect to use it. | |||
(11) Report the use of force to your chain of | (11) Report the use of force to your chain of | |||
command. | command. | |||
5-2. Daily Reports | 5-2. Oleoresin Capsicum (OC) Use | |||
a. The CJDOG, DCJDOG, JDOG S3, CO, PL, or | ||||
SOG may authorize the use of OC pepper spray to | ||||
preclude the use of physical force by the IRF | ||||
Team/Escorts. This will be to control an unruly | ||||
detainee or detainees; to prevent the commission of a | ||||
serious offense involving violence and threatening | ||||
death or serious bodily harm; in self defense; to prevent | ||||
a detainee from escaping; or to extract an detainee(s) | ||||
involved in a riot or disturbance. Do not use OC to | ||||
respond to spitters, urinators, or water throwers. | ||||
b. Use the current issue Def Tech Mark 4 OC Spray. | ||||
Administer OC by aiming at the eyes, nose, and Mouth | ||||
when possible. Use a ½, to 1 second burst from a | ||||
distance of 36 to 72 inches away. | ||||
c. If control cannot be achieved after the first | ||||
application within 30 seconds, subsequent applications | ||||
of one-second bursts can be applied. It is not necessary | ||||
to spray just a single detainee as the spray can affect an | ||||
entire block if the situation requires it, and can be used | ||||
as a riot control agent. | ||||
d. The CO, PL, and SOG will carry OC. Certified | ||||
personnel will only use OC unless directed by the CO. | ||||
The sprayer will document all OC usage and the | ||||
incident will be reported to the CO, PL, and JDOG S-3 | ||||
as soon as possible. When practical the following steps | ||||
should be followed prior to utilizing OC: | ||||
(1) In a loud clear voice command the detainee to | ||||
follow whatever directive was given, when possible | ||||
have an interpreter present. | ||||
(2) Allow the detainee time to comply. | ||||
(3) Warn by standers and guards prior to OC use | ||||
using a brevity code word or phrase. | ||||
(4) Once the situation has been declared under | ||||
control, the detainee will be checked by medical | ||||
personnel and decontaminated by at a minimum having | ||||
medical personnel flush their eyes out with water. | ||||
(5) Have medical personnel again check the | ||||
detainee for health problems. | ||||
(6) Once cleared, the detainee should be | ||||
monitored for two hours after contamination. | ||||
(7) An IR or SIR will be completed after each | ||||
spray. | ||||
(8) Documentation of all OC Sprays, IRF actions | ||||
and the decontamination process will be done by video | ||||
and written reports. | ||||
(9) Once the canister of OC is half-empty, it will | ||||
be exchanged for a new full canister. | ||||
e. Decontamination of individuals who are suffering | ||||
either primary or secondary effects is taken care by | ||||
flushing the face area with water from a hose. Juliet | ||||
block and November block also have decontamination | ||||
stations that can be used. When decontaminant is | ||||
available, the following procedure will be used: | ||||
(1) Spray the decontaminant on the affected area | ||||
with the hairline included in this so it can trap the OC. | ||||
Do not rub or spray directly into the eyes or mouth. | ||||
You will see it start to drip and change color as it lifts | ||||
off the OC. | ||||
(2) Use the nose to bisect the face. Blot out from | ||||
the bridge of the nose toward the ears. Do not rub, as | ||||
this will exfoliate the skin. Use soft absorbent paper | ||||
towels. This will speed up the process. | ||||
(3) Flush the eyes with running cool water after | ||||
cleansing the affected area. If possible, blink the eyes | ||||
under running water to flush them clean. It may be | ||||
necessary to do this mechanically using your fingers on | ||||
lids to open the eyes. Make sure you get the entire area | ||||
that’s been affected, to avoid recontamination. All you | ||||
need to do is to get a drop back in the eye to be at | ||||
square one. | ||||
(4) If available, use baby shampoo and rinse with | ||||
cool water to finish off. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 as | ||||
needed. | ||||
(5) It takes time for the inflammation to subside. | ||||
Do not use salves, oils or creams as they may trap the | ||||
OC against the skin. | ||||
(6) For inhalation effects, move out of the area; | ||||
blow your nose and face into the wind. Symptoms will | ||||
stop in a few minutes. | ||||
Section II – | ||||
5-3. Daily Reports | ||||
a. Use an incident report when an incident occurs | a. Use an incident report when an incident occurs | |||
that is not documented by the detainee Discipline or | that is not documented by the detainee Discipline or | |||
Serious Incident Report. | Serious Incident Report. | |||
b. Anyone who finds evidence or contraband will | b. Anyone who finds evidence or contraband will | |||
complete a DA 4137 Evidence/Property Custody | complete a DA 4137 Evidence/Property Custody | |||
Document to document the chain of custody and turn in | Document to document the chain of custody and turn in | |||
of evidence or contraband seized at Camp Delta. The | of evidence or contraband seized at Camp Delta. The | |||
DA 4137 and evidence/contraband will be turned in to | DA 4137 and evidence/contraband will be turned in to | |||
the Military Police Investigations (MPI) section. The | the Military Police Investigations (MPI) section. The | |||
MPI section will determine if the items are evidence or | MPI section will determine if the items are evidence or | |||
skipping to change at line 1422 | skipping to change at line 1545 | |||
potential evidence include but are not limited to: | potential evidence include but are not limited to: | |||
(1) Evidence classified as “dangerous | (1) Evidence classified as “dangerous | |||
contraband” | contraband” | |||
(2) Videotape of IRF movements or disturbances | (2) Videotape of IRF movements or disturbances | |||
(3) Evidence seized from a suicide attempt. | (3) Evidence seized from a suicide attempt. | |||
Examples of potential contraband include but are not | Examples of potential contraband include but are not | |||
limited to: | limited to: | |||
(1) Drawings | (1) Drawings | |||
(2) Modified items of linen | (2) Modified items of linen | |||
(3) Writing on cups. | (3) Writing on cups. | |||
To be disciplined for non-dangerous contraband, the | ||||
contraband must be concealed in a manner which a | ||||
guard standing outside the cell can’t see the object. | ||||
c. DD Form 508 Report Of/Or Recommendation for | c. DD Form 508 Report Of/Or Recommendation for | |||
Disciplinary Action is used to recommend and | Disciplinary Action is used to recommend and | |||
document disciplinary actions taken against a detainee | document disciplinary actions taken against a detainee | |||
for violations of the rules. The PL will sign his name | for violations of the rules. The PL will sign his name | |||
in the Confinement Officer block. The JDOG S-3 will | in the Confinement Officer block. The JDOG S-3 will | |||
sign as the Confinement Officer. | sign as the Confinement Officer. | |||
d. The MP who is reporting the incident will | d. The guard who is reporting the incident will | |||
complete the DA Form 2823 Sworn Statement. If that | complete the DA Form 2823 Sworn Statement. If that | |||
MP is not available, the SOG will complete the Sworn | guard is not available, the SOG will complete the | |||
Sworn Statement and include the reason for the guard | ||||
Statement and include the reason for the guard not | not completing it in the witness statement. | |||
completing it in the witness statement. | ||||
e. GTMO Form 509-1 Inspection Record Of | e. GTMO Form 509-1 Inspection Record Of | |||
Prisoner In Segregation will be utilized to document | Prisoner In Segregation will be utilized to document | |||
welfare checks of detainees who are in a MSU cell. | welfare checks of detainees who are in a SHU cell. | |||
Conduct checks every 10 minutes and document on | Conduct checks every 10 minutes and document on | |||
GTMO Form 509-1. | GTMO Form 509-1. | |||
f. Use the Guard Shift Manning Roster to assign | f. Use the Guard Shift Manning Roster to assign | |||
guards to duty positions. | guards to duty positions. | |||
g. Detainee Tracking Log is used to track detainee | g. Detainee Tracking Log is used to track detainee | |||
refusals (chow, recreation, showers, etc) and travels | refusals (chow, exercise, showers, etc) and travels with | |||
with the detainee when he makes a permanent move. | the detainee when he makes a permanent move. | |||
Detainee Discipline Logs are used to track detainee | h. Detainee Discipline Logs are used to track | |||
discipline infractions and document this on the | detainee discipline infractions and document this on the | |||
discipline log. The block discipline log travels with the | discipline log. The block discipline log travels with the | |||
detainee when he makes a permanent move. | detainee when he makes a permanent move. | |||
Headcount Form is used to document results of | i. Headcount Form is used to document results of | |||
headcounts. | headcounts. | |||
h. Supply Request Form is used to request supplies | j. Supply Request Form is used to request supplies | |||
from JDOG S-4. It will be picked up each day. | from JDOG S-4 or the supply room. It will be picked | |||
i. Significant Activities Sheet is used to track | up each shift by the SOG if coming from the blocks or | |||
sally ports and turned in to the supply room. The DOC | ||||
will turn theirs into the supply room. | ||||
k. Significant Activities Sheet is used to track | ||||
significant activities in blocks for JDOG S-2. JDOG S- | significant activities in blocks for JDOG S-2. JDOG S- | |||
2 picks it up each day. | 2 picks it up each day. | |||
j. MSU Block Log is used for tracking placement | l. SHU Block Log is used for tracking placement of | |||
of detainees in Maximum Security Units. | detainees in Special Housing Units. | |||
k. ID Band or Card Request is used to request new | m.ID Band or Card Request is used to request new | |||
ID bands or Cards from medical processing. The DOC | ID bands or Cards from medical processing. The DOC | |||
admin NCO will furnish it to JDOG S-1. | admin NCO will furnish it to JDOG S-1. | |||
l. Movement Log is used to record all permanent | n. Movement Log is used to record all permanent | |||
movements of detainees. | movements of detainees. | |||
m.ICRC Tracking Sheet is a tracking sheet for | o. ICRC Tracking Sheet is a tracking sheet for | |||
ICRC escorts. | ICRC escorts. | |||
n. Medical Escort Tracking Sheet is used for | p. Medical Escort Tracking Sheet is used for | |||
tracking Medical escorts. | tracking Medical escorts. | |||
o. Reservation Tracking Sheet is used to track JIIF | q. Reservation Tracking Sheet is used to track JIIF | |||
escorts. | escorts. | |||
p. Detainee Medical Request is used to pass on | r. Detainee Medical Request is used to pass on | |||
detainee non-urgent or emergency medical requests to | detainee non-urgent or emergency medical requests to | |||
Medical. | Medical. | |||
q. DA 1594 Daily Staff Journal or Duty Officer’s | s. DA 1594 Daily Staff Journal or Duty Officer’s | |||
Log will be used by each shift to document daily | Log will be used by each shift to document daily | |||
activity. The journal will at a minimum document | activity. The journal will at a minimum document | |||
chow arrival times, headcount times and results, prayer | chow arrival times, headcount times and results, prayer | |||
call times, detainee requests to see JTF-GTMO, | call times, detainee requests to see JTF-GTMO, | |||
detainee movements and other significant operational | detainee movements and other significant operational | |||
activities. | activities. | |||
r.Visitor’s Logbook will contain the following | t. Visitor’s Logbook will contain the following | |||
information | information | |||
(1) Name | (1) Name | |||
(2) Rank of visitor | (2) Rank of visitor | |||
(3) Organization | (3) Organization | |||
(4) Escort Name | (4) Escort Name | |||
(5) Rank and Organization | (5) Rank and Organization | |||
(6) Date/Time In | (6) Date/Time In | |||
(7) Date/Time Out | (7) Date/Time Out | |||
(8) ID of Block Guard entering data. | (8) ID of guard entering data. | |||
s. Serious Incident Report (SIR) is used to report | u. Serious Incident Report (SIR) is used to report | |||
serious incidents or disturbances. | serious incidents or disturbances. | |||
t. DA 3997 Military Police Desk Blotter will be | v. DA 3997 Military Police Desk Blotter will be | |||
used in the DOC to track daily activity in the camp. At | used in the DOC to track daily activity in the camp. At | |||
a minimum, it will be used to track detainees at the | a minimum, it will be used to track detainees at the | |||
hospital, JIIF escorts, everything that happens in the | hospital, JIIF escorts, everything that happens in the | |||
camp including contractor activities. | camp including contractor activities. | |||
t. The CO will use the Company Commander | w. The CO will use the Company Commander | |||
Checklist to perform checks during the shift. | Checklist to perform checks during the shift. | |||
u. The CO will complete the End of Shift AAR at | x. The CO will complete the End of Shift AAR at | |||
the end of every shift. | the end of every shift. | |||
v. CD-S319, Observation of Self-Injurious Behavior | y. CD-S319, Observation of Self-Injurious Behavior | |||
Form; will be used to record observations of detainees | Form; will be used to record observations of detainees | |||
on self-harm watch. Document the activity of the | on self-harm watch. Document the activity of the | |||
detainee every 15 minutes on this form. | detainee every 15 minutes on this form. | |||
5-3. Camp Rules Each detainee will be given the | 5-5. Incident Reports (IR) | |||
opportunity to read the Camp Rules in their native | ||||
language. The current Camp Rules are at Figure 5-1. | ||||
5-4. Incident Reports (IR) | ||||
a. An IR will be used when an incident occurs that | a. An IR will be used when an incident occurs that | |||
is not documented via DD Form 508 or Serious | is not documented via DD Form 508 or Serious | |||
Incident Report (SIR) documentation. Required format | Incident Report (SIR) documentation. Required format | |||
for IR is at Figure 5-2. IR control numbers will be | for IR is at Figure 5-2. Detention Services Branch will | |||
assigned by Detention Services Branch. Examples of | assign IR control numbers. Examples of incidents | |||
incidents requiring incident reports include, but are not | requiring incident reports include, but are not limited | |||
limited to: | to: | |||
(1) Lost Key reporting. | (1) Lost Key reporting. | |||
(2) Occupational accident | (2) Occupational accident | |||
(3) To document an incident that requires more | (3) To document an incident that requires more | |||
documentation than a log entry or daily journal entry. | documentation than a log entry or daily journal entry. | |||
(Example- large disturbance with no discipline | (Example- large disturbance with no discipline | |||
measure taken to provide documentation.) | measure taken to provide documentation.) | |||
b. Incident Reports will be completed and turned in | b. Incident Reports will be completed and turned in | |||
by end of shift with the supporting paperwork by the | by end of shift with the supporting paperwork by the | |||
CO. | CO. | |||
c. Incident Reports will be briefed at CO Change of | c. Incident Reports will be briefed at CO Change of | |||
Shift brief. | Shift brief. | |||
5-5. SPOT Reports (SPOTREP) | 5-6. SPOT Reports (SPOTREP) | |||
a. A SPOTREP will be completed and sent to the | a. A SPOTREP will be completed and sent to the | |||
JOC Watch Officer (cc to designated individuals) | JOC Watch Officer (cc to designated individuals) | |||
within 30 minutes of end of incident listed on the | within 30 minutes of end of incident listed on the | |||
notification matrix. Required format for the SPOTREP | notification matrix. Required format for the SPOTREP | |||
is at Figure 5-3. | is at Figure 5-3. | |||
b. A SPOTREP will be sent to JDOG S3 for any | b. A SPOTREP will be sent to JDOG S3 for any | |||
contraband found in a detainee area such as a cell or | contraband found in a detainee area such as a cell or | |||
shower. | shower. | |||
A follow-up SPOTREP with additional detail will be | A follow-up SPOTREP with additional detail will be | |||
sent up within 2 hours if necessary. | sent up within 2 hours if necessary. | |||
d. The method of transmission will be as follows: | d. The method of transmission will be as follows: | |||
(1) Priority Means is SIPRNET e-mail | (1) Priority Means is SIPRNET e-mail | |||
(2) Secondary Means is Secure Telephone Unit | (2) Secondary Means is Secure Telephone Unit | |||
(STU) | (STU) | |||
(3) Tertiary Means is Runner/courier. | (3) Tertiary Means is Runner/courier. | |||
5-7. Serious Incident Reports (SIR) | ||||
5-6. Serious Incident Reports (SIR) | ||||
a. The Serious Incident Report (SIR) will be used | a. The Serious Incident Report (SIR) will be used | |||
for an incident that requires the use of force such as a | for an incident that requires the use of force such as a | |||
cell extraction using the IRF Team. A SIR should also | cell extraction using the IRF Team. A SIR should also | |||
be used on any incident that is classified as an attempt | be used on any incident that is classified as an attempt | |||
self harm by a detainee, especially when it will be as | self harm by a detainee, especially when it will be as | |||
justification for taking some type of action against the | justification for taking some type of action against the | |||
detainee (move to MSU, removing items he could kill | detainee (move to SHU, removing items he could kill | |||
himself with, etc.) | himself with, etc.) | |||
b. The CO will complete the SIR, using the format | b. The CO will complete the SIR, using the format | |||
at Figure 5-4. Once it is completed, forward the SIR to | at Figure 5-4. Once it is completed, forward the SIR to | |||
JDOG S3. It will then be forwarded to JDOG and JTF- | JDOG S3. It will then be forwarded to JDOG and JTF- | |||
GTMO. Utilize the floppy disk in the DOC to save the | GTMO. Utilize the floppy disk in the DOC to save the | |||
SIR by date. Do not save over the template. A | SIR by date. Do not save over the template. A | |||
template for the SIR is saved on a disk located in the | template for the SIR is saved on a disk located in the | |||
DOC, titled “SIR”. Double click on the file and it will | DOC, titled “SIR”. Double click on the file and it will | |||
open up to a template. Tab from gray box to gray box, | open up to a template. Tab from gray box to gray box, | |||
filling in the required information. In the “Summary of | filling in the required information. In the “Summary of | |||
Incident” are, include who, what, when, where, why, | Incident” are, include who, what, when, where, why, | |||
and how information. | and how information. | |||
5-7. Discipline Records | 5-8. Discipline Records | |||
a. In addition to Daily Staff Journal and Pass on | a. In addition to Daily Staff Journal and Pass on | |||
Book entries, DA Form 2823 and DD Form 508 are the | Book entries, DA Form 2823 and DD Form 508 are the | |||
forms used to recommend and document disciplinary | forms used to recommend and document disciplinary | |||
actions taken against a detainee for violations of the | actions taken against a detainee for violations of the | |||
rules. The forms will be used to document any | rules. The forms will be used to document any | |||
instances in which a detainee is disciplined. | instances in which a detainee is disciplined. | |||
b. A copy of DD Form 508 will be kept at the DOC. | b. A copy of DD Form 508 will be kept at the DOC. | |||
Another copy will be placed in the detainee Alpha | Another copy will be placed in the detainee Alpha | |||
Roster Binder, which is kept on the block of that | Roster Binder, which is kept on the block of that | |||
particular detainee. | particular detainee. | |||
5-8. Guard Mount | Section III – | |||
a. SOGs will arrive 45 minutes prior to shift change | 5-9. Guard Mount | |||
to speak with the off going SOG on any relevant | a. SOGs will arrive 1 hour prior to shift change to | |||
speak with the off going SOG on any relevant | ||||
information relating to the shift. | information relating to the shift. | |||
b. Guard Mount will be conducted 30 minutes prior | b. Guard Mount will be conducted 30 minutes prior | |||
to shift change. The oncoming SOGs will be | to shift change. The oncoming SOGs will be | |||
responsible for holding Guard Mount for their | responsible for holding Guard Mount for their | |||
prospective camp. | prospective camp. | |||
c. SOGs should ensure that all personnel know and | c. Companies that are coming on duty must arrive | |||
45 minutes prior to start of the shift. The SOG for each | ||||
camp will bring 1 additional soldier from their | ||||
respective unit over and above the required amount of | ||||
soldiers to run the shift. | ||||
d. The SOG will conduct Guard Mount with the | ||||
following: | ||||
(1) Open ranks uniform and equipment | ||||
inspection. | ||||
(2) Brief the troops on any changes to policy and | ||||
procedures and any information relevant to the | ||||
performance of their duties. | ||||
(3) Ensure that all personnel know and | ||||
understand where they are going to be working and | understand where they are going to be working and | |||
what they will be doing. | what they will be doing. | |||
d. During the Guard Mount formation, the soldiers | (4) Brief the Initial Reaction Force (IRF) | |||
will receive any specific changes relating to their shift. | activation word and the Visual Duress Sign of the day | |||
e. The Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) word of the | for both the primary and alternate teams. | |||
day will also be put out during guard mount both the | e. Upon completion of Guard Mount, SOG will | |||
primary and alternate teams. | announce the name of the soldier who performed the | |||
5-9. Change of Shift Procedures | best during Guard Mount, have the soldier come up in | |||
front of the formation and then release the soldier for | ||||
the rest of the day. | ||||
f. Upon completing paragraph 5-8e above, the SOG | ||||
will then supply the extra soldier that was brought with | ||||
the company and place him/her in the position vacated | ||||
by the “SUPERNUMERY” that was given the day off. | ||||
5-10. Change of Shift Procedures | ||||
a. Duty position relief will be conducted by relief-in | a. Duty position relief will be conducted by relief-in | |||
place. It is imperative that outgoing personnel remain | place. It is imperative that outgoing personnel remain | |||
at their position until relieved by incoming personnel. | at their position until relieved by incoming personnel. | |||
This insures that no detainees or posts are ever left | This insures that no detainees or posts are ever left | |||
unmonitored. | unmonitored. | |||
b. Oncoming SOGs will ensure that manning rosters | b. Oncoming SOGs will ensure that manning rosters | |||
are filled out and that personnel are accounted for | are filled out and that personnel are accounted for | |||
during the guard mount formation. The SOG will also | during the guard mount formation. The SOG will also | |||
speak with the outgoing SOG on any relevant issues | speak with the outgoing SOG on any relevant issues | |||
that may have or will occur during the past or present | that may have or will occur during the past or present | |||
skipping to change at line 1640 | skipping to change at line 1786 | |||
back in or signed out items. If there are any | back in or signed out items. If there are any | |||
discrepancies, the SOG will correct the problem. Once | discrepancies, the SOG will correct the problem. Once | |||
all on-coming personnel sign for items and relieve all | all on-coming personnel sign for items and relieve all | |||
positions, the on-coming SOG will then relieve the off- | positions, the on-coming SOG will then relieve the off- | |||
going SOG. Once the off-going SOG has been | going SOG. Once the off-going SOG has been | |||
relieved, he/she will then release all other off-going | relieved, he/she will then release all other off-going | |||
personnel. The DOC RTO will begin duty log and will | personnel. The DOC RTO will begin duty log and will | |||
conduct radio checks with all positions. Once the radio | conduct radio checks with all positions. Once the radio | |||
checks are complete, the Admin NCO will notify the | checks are complete, the Admin NCO will notify the | |||
PL. | PL. | |||
5-10. Oleoresin Capsicum (OC) Use | 5-11. Equipment Chit System | |||
a. The CJDOG, DCJDOG, JDOG S3, CO, PL, or | a. Each post that has equipment will have a | |||
SOG may authorize the use of OC pepper spray to | corresponding chit, a wooden block with the identity of | |||
preclude the use of physical force by the IRF | the post. | |||
Team/Escorts. This will be to control an unruly | b. Since all equipment is now located at the blocks, | |||
detainee or detainees; to prevent the commission of a | the chit will be given to the oncoming shift personnel | |||
serious offense involving violence and threatening | for each post. | |||
death or serious bodily harm; in self defense; to prevent | c. The oncoming post personnel, upon arrival at | |||
their post, will inventory all equipment in addition to | ||||
all other change of shift activities. | ||||
a detainee from escaping; or to extract an detainee(s) | d. If all items are fully accounted for, the on-coming | |||
involved in a riot or disturbance. Do not use OC to | shift individual will give the off-going shift personnel | |||
respond to spitters or urinators. | the chit. | |||
b. Use the current issue Def Tech Mark 4 OC Spray. | e. If all items are not accounted for, the off-going | |||
Administer OC by aiming at the eyes, nose, and Mouth | shift personnel will be responsible for locating the | |||
when possible. Use a ½, to 1 second burst from a | items or will have statement of charges prepared to | |||
distance of 36 to 72 inches away. | replace the missing property item. The only way an | |||
c. If control cannot be achieved after the first | item may be accounted for is the following: | |||
application within 30 seconds, subsequent applications | (1) The item is physically present at the location | |||
of one-second bursts can be applied. It is not necessary | (2) There is a DA 2062 for the turn-in of an | |||
to spray just a single detainee as the spray can affect an | inoperable item. | |||
entire block if the situation requires it, and can be used | f. Once all chits are turned in to the off-going PL, | |||
as a riot control agent. | he knows all positions have conducted a change of | |||
d. The CO, PL, and SOG will carry OC. Certified | shift. If a chit is missing, the identity of the missing | |||
personnel will only use OC unless directed by the CO. | chit will identify to the PL where any change of shift | |||
The sprayer will document all OC usage and the | problems are occurring. | |||
incident will be reported to the CO, PL, and JDOG S-3 | g. If there is a location where a problem is | |||
as soon as possible. When practical the following steps | occurring, the PL or the SOG will go to the location in | |||
should be followed prior to utilizing OC: | the attempt to resolve the issue. | |||
(1) In a loud clear voice command the detainee to | h. The following positions will have a chit for shift | |||
follow whatever directive was given, when possible | change: | |||
have an interpreter present. | (1) Blocks | |||
(2) Allow the detainee time to comply. | (2) Sally ports | |||
(3) Warn by standers and Block Guard s prior to | (3) SOGs | |||
OC use using a brevity code word or phrase. | (4) PLs. | |||
(4) Once the situation has been declared under | i. Camp 4, Camp Echo, Delta Block, Camp Iguana, | |||
control, the detainee will be checked by medical | DOC, and EC will also have a chit for their locations. | |||
personnel and decontaminated by at a minimum having | j. It is the NCO or senior person at the post | |||
medical personnel flush their eyes out with water. | responsibility to ensure all property that is assigned to | |||
(5) Have medical personnel again check the | that post remains at the post. No property may leave | |||
detainee for health problems. | without the proper paperwork. The senior person | |||
(6) Once cleared, the detainee should be | assigned to the post with missing items will be held | |||
monitored for two hours after contamination. | accountable for any missing undocumented items. | |||
(7) An IR or SIR will be completed after each | k. Off-going personnel may not leave their post | |||
spray. | until the chit is turned over by on-coming personnel. | |||
(8) Documentation of all OC Sprays, IRF actions | Section IV – | |||
and the decontamination process will be done by video | 5-12. DOC Operations | |||
and written reports. | a. The PL and SOGs are responsible for ensuring | |||
(9) Once the canister of OC is half-empty, it will | the completeness and accuracy of all paperwork | |||
be exchanged for a new full canister. | submitted to the DOC. Either the SOG or PL shall not | |||
5-11. Public Address System | give the DOC any paperwork from the block that has | |||
not been reviewed. | ||||
b. The DOC is responsible for ensuring the tracking | ||||
board is properly updated in a timely manner. | ||||
c. The DOC is responsible for ensuring automated | ||||
data systems are updated accurately and completely in | ||||
a timely manner. DOC crews need to correct their own | ||||
mistakes when found. | ||||
d. The midnight DOC crew will finish all work that | ||||
is started on day shift and unable to complete due to | ||||
activity on day shift. | ||||
e. It is day shift’s responsibility to list any work that | ||||
is to be completed by midnight shift on the board, brief | ||||
the PL and/or CO along with midnight shift during | ||||
shift change. | ||||
f. DOC shift change will occur at a minimum of 30 | ||||
minutes prior to the shift change time. On-coming and | ||||
outgoing crews will stay in the DOC until changeover | ||||
is complete. | ||||
g. A headcount will be conducted at the start of | ||||
each guard shift. The DOC will then call for an | ||||
additional three randomly timed headcounts throughout | ||||
the guard shift. The most amount of time between | ||||
headcounts can be three hours. | ||||
h. DOC will update R&U with a list of inoperable | ||||
cells and reason why NLT 1200 hrs each day. | ||||
5-13. Public Address System | ||||
a. The Public Address system is to be used to play | a. The Public Address system is to be used to play | |||
the call to prayer to all blocks and for emergency uses | the call to prayer to all blocks and for emergency uses | |||
only. The emergency status is to be determined by the | only. The emergency status is to be determined by the | |||
CO, SOG, PL, or JDOG S-3. | CO, SOG, PL, or JDOG S-3. | |||
b. Before any announcement to the detainees is | b. Before any announcement to the detainees is | |||
made, the script to be read must be submitted to JDOG | made, the script to be read must be submitted to JDOG | |||
for approval. | for approval. | |||
5-12. Radio Discipline | 5-14. Radio Discipline | |||
a. All soldiers who are issued radios will use | a. All soldiers who are issued radios will use | |||
“Common Language” on the radio net. All radio traffic | “Common Language” on the radio net. All radio traffic | |||
broadcast will be in a calm clear voice. All non- | broadcast will be in a calm clear voice. All non- | |||
emergency transmissions will wait until the net is clear, | emergency transmissions will wait until the net is clear, | |||
prior to broadcasting. All transmissions will be | prior to broadcasting. All transmissions will be | |||
professional and respectful. No sarcastic or insulting | professional and respectful. No sarcastic or insulting | |||
language or sounds will be broadcast. | language or sounds will be broadcast. | |||
b. In the event of an emergency a predetermined | b. In the event of an emergency a predetermined | |||
code word will be broadcast, the DOC will repeat this | code word will be broadcast, the DOC will repeat this | |||
code word, and this will clear all traffic from the net. | code word, and this will clear all traffic from the net. | |||
Only the DOC and the unit sending the transmission | Only the DOC and the unit sending the transmission | |||
will broadcast. The DOC will rebroadcast any | will broadcast. The DOC will rebroadcast any | |||
information, to include dispatching any needed | information, to include dispatching any needed | |||
personnel. All non-essential radio traffic either will | personnel. All non-essential radio traffic either will | |||
hold or will be sent via a landline. | hold or will be sent via a landline. | |||
c. After the emergency has passed, the DOC will | c. After the emergency has passed, the DOC will | |||
broadcast the “All Clear” and normal radio traffic will | broadcast the “All Clear” and normal radio traffic will | |||
continue. | continue. | |||
d. Only English will be used at any time, on the Net. | d. Only English will be used at any time, on the Net. | |||
e. It is up to the Soldier issued the radio to monitor | e. It is up to the soldier issued the radio to monitor | |||
the radio at all times, it will be the responsibility of that | the radio at all times, it will be the responsibility of that | |||
individual to use the radio correctly. | individual to use the radio correctly. | |||
5-13. Equipment Chit System | f. When giving medical problems over the radio, | |||
a. All equipment signed out by a Block Guard | state the symptoms unless a qualified medical person | |||
/Block NCO will use a chit system where an ID card | gives you the diagnosis. | |||
will be used for entry into the site, that card will then | 5-15. Building Maintenance | |||
be exchanged for the signed out items. In the case of | a. The DOC midnight crew is responsible to ensure | |||
multiple items, i.e. keys, radio, shackles, nail clipper, | the DOC is cleaned daily. Escort Control will task | |||
all will be listed on a sign out roster, and the ID is left. | escort teams to do the following tasks: | |||
The sign-out/chit will be checked prior to end of shift. | (1) Empty all trash cans in the building and | |||
b. The ID will be checked prior to entry and exit of | replace the garbage bags. | |||
site. | (2) Sweep and mop the hallways, bathrooms, and | |||
5-14. Evidence and Contraband Procedures | kitchen. | |||
b. The DOC will request all building supplies | ||||
through the Detention Services Branch required for the | ||||
DOC that are not already stocked in the supply room. | ||||
c. The DOC will submit all work orders for the | ||||
building. | ||||
d. Camp 2 SOG and PL are responsible for the | ||||
cleanliness of the room 7 in building 7. | ||||
e. Camp 4 SOG is responsible for the cleanliness of | ||||
the Camp 4 administration office and the Tower | ||||
Operations Center. | ||||
5-16. Video Camera Operations | ||||
a. At the beginning of the shift, the designate | ||||
camera operator in the DOC will check the following | ||||
items: | ||||
(1) Ensure all equipment is readily available and | ||||
where it is located. | ||||
(2) Check to ensure the camera battery is | ||||
recharging. | ||||
(3) Check the amount of battery time. | ||||
(4) Check for at least two blank DVD-Rs / tapes. | ||||
(5) Check DVD / tape in the camera as to | ||||
whether it contains training IRFs or actual IRFs. | ||||
(6) Check to ensure training IRF DVDs / tapes | ||||
are marked as training. | ||||
b. Prior to leaving the DOC to tape an incident, the | ||||
operator will perform the following actions: | ||||
(1) Check the battery charge level. If less than 30 | ||||
minutes, take the power cord in addition to the camera | ||||
so it can be plugged in at the location. | ||||
(2) Take two blank DVDs or tapes | ||||
(3) Check to see that a non-training DVD / tape is | ||||
in the camera. | ||||
(4) If the event will be in an environment with | ||||
water that could damage the camera, take the clear | ||||
watertight box to protect the camera. | ||||
(5) If the event is not an IRF, verify who to | ||||
report to and where to report. | ||||
c. When reporting to the scene, the camera operator | ||||
is part of the team. The video shot by the camera | ||||
operator is record an unbiased view of the incident for | ||||
others to review. These others can give you guidance | ||||
as to specific items to record on video. These other | ||||
individuals could include the following: | ||||
(1) JDOG Staff | ||||
(2) CO | ||||
(3) PL | ||||
(4) SOG | ||||
(5) Military Police Investigator, Forensic | ||||
personnel | ||||
(6) Guards | ||||
(7) Fire Dept | ||||
(8) Medics | ||||
(9) Interpreters. | ||||
d. If forensic personnel are in attendance, report to | ||||
their senior officer and follow his directions at all | ||||
times. If they are on their way, wait for their arrival | ||||
unless common sense and circumstances dictate earlier | ||||
action. | ||||
e. Unless the scene is still being created, e.g. fire | ||||
burning, offense still in progress, etc. Do not just take | ||||
out camera and start shooting. Instead stop and think | ||||
about what you’re going to do. Get a good and | ||||
accurate concept of the scene and its history such as | ||||
how did the scene or crime unfold, what are its | ||||
boundaries, why is the detainee out of his cell, is there | ||||
more than one detainee involved, etc. | ||||
f. Make written notes in an official notebook | ||||
showing: | ||||
(1) Time & date of arrival. | ||||
(2) Location details. | ||||
(3) Victim details (name, etc.) | ||||
(4) Names of other team members. | ||||
(5) Times of new events. | ||||
(6) Brief details of these events. | ||||
g. Plan how you will record your evidence, using a | ||||
systematic approach. | ||||
(1) Is it safe to enter scene - is it booby trapped, | ||||
etc. etc.? | ||||
(2) Am I appropriately dressed - Kevlar, BDUs, | ||||
boots, glove, etc.? | ||||
(3) Which way in (and out) - liaise with O.I.C. | ||||
Forensic? | ||||
(4) Always use the agreed safety route into and | ||||
out of the scene. | ||||
h. At the scene, watch for and take care not to | ||||
disturb: | ||||
(1) Shoe impressions | ||||
(2) Blood | ||||
(3) Fibers | ||||
(4) Fingerprints | ||||
(5) Clothing | ||||
(6) Bedding | ||||
(7) Debris | ||||
(8) Objects with potential evidential value. | ||||
i. Do not be sidetracked into other tasks by | ||||
investigators without first consulting with the OIC of | ||||
the scene. Unless urgent, finish off your systematic | ||||
evidence gathering run before being diverted to other | ||||
tasks. This includes the note taking process. | ||||
j. The following are some camera techniques to | ||||
use: | ||||
(1) Check lighting, is it daylight, artificial or a | ||||
mixture? | ||||
(2) Should the scene be lit - if so how? | ||||
(3) Every shot is important - shoot it as if it is the | ||||
most important of the series. | ||||
(4) Take your time and plan your pan, don't chase | ||||
focus or the subject. | ||||
(5) Don't scrub the scene by panning side to side | ||||
or up and down. One clean sweep is much more | ||||
professional. | ||||
(6) Before zooming to close up during a take, | ||||
zoom, focus and pull back first and then do the take. | ||||
This will avoid the awful spectacle of zooming out of | ||||
focus. | ||||
(7) Always take an exterior General View (GV) | ||||
or 'establisher' shot of the block, building, exercise | ||||
yard, etc. This will leave no doubt as to where the | ||||
scene is located. | ||||
(8) Before or after showing a Big Close Up of an | ||||
object, do a long shot or mid shot of it to establish its | ||||
location in relation to other parts of the scene. | ||||
(9) When covering a long narrow section of a | ||||
scene such as a hallway or the walkway of a tier, | ||||
consider a slow zoom from a single location and | ||||
pulling focus if necessary; rather than clumsily walking | ||||
along it (Dolly Shot) with the inevitable, disconcerting | ||||
sway and judder. | ||||
(10) If perspective has to change (i.e. you have to | ||||
see behind objects or demonstrate their separation from | ||||
each other), then use of a "Dolly Shot" may be | ||||
unavoidable. In this case use the lens at its widest | ||||
possible angle (to minimize sway and judder) and | ||||
move as smoothly as possible. Again plan your shot - | ||||
route - focusing points - etc., before moving off. | ||||
(11) In small rooms or spaces (toilets, bathrooms, | ||||
caves, etc.) use of a high camera angle from a corner | ||||
will give the maximum coverage of the area. | ||||
(12) High camera angles are also useful when | ||||
separation of objects on similar plains is required. | ||||
(13) Aim for quality, not quantity! A lot of | ||||
ground can be covered with a few well-planned shots. | ||||
Unnecessarily repeating or prolonging shots will only | ||||
bore or confuse, and won't enhance the evidential value | ||||
of the video. | ||||
(14) Think like an editor as you shoot! Let | ||||
technique master technology; don't let technology | ||||
become your master. The best equipment in the world | ||||
will never replace creativity and reasoning. | ||||
5-16a. Combat Camera | ||||
a. Combat Camera will have full access to all Camp | ||||
Delta facilities, both inside and outside the wire. | ||||
b. Combat Camera personnel do not require any | ||||
type of escort. | ||||
c. Combat Camera will be allowed to bring their | ||||
photography equipment into the wire and to any | ||||
location that their mission requires them to be at. | ||||
d. Combat Camera can photograph Camp Delta and | ||||
related facilities from outside of the wire. | ||||
Section V – | ||||
5-17. Evidence and Contraband Procedures | ||||
a. Evidence is items taken after an actual injury or | a. Evidence is items taken after an actual injury or | |||
death. Contraband is items taken during searches that | death. Contraband is items taken during searches that | |||
have not led to injury or death. | have not led to injury or death. | |||
b. All evidence and contraband that is acquired be | b. All evidence and contraband that is acquired be | |||
logged on a DA Form 4137 IAW AR 195-5. Entries | logged on a DA Form 4137 IAW AR 195-5. Entries | |||
should be typed or printed legibly in black ink. The | should be typed or printed legibly in black ink. The | |||
original copy goes to the Evidence Custodian (EC). | original copy goes to the Evidence Custodian (EC). | |||
Complete the administrative section of the custody | Complete the administrative section of the custody | |||
document, stating clearly how the evidence was | document, stating clearly how the evidence was | |||
obtained. In the Description of Articles section, | obtained. In the Description of Articles section, | |||
skipping to change at line 1772 | skipping to change at line 2108 | |||
appropriate copies. The importance of keeping | appropriate copies. The importance of keeping | |||
accurate and complete custody documents cannot be | accurate and complete custody documents cannot be | |||
overemphasized. | overemphasized. | |||
e. Anything that is NOT an issue item to a detainee | e. Anything that is NOT an issue item to a detainee | |||
is to be considered contraband and will be collected | is to be considered contraband and will be collected | |||
along with any item that is on the prohibited items list | along with any item that is on the prohibited items list | |||
contained in section 1-8g. All collected items will be | contained in section 1-8g. All collected items will be | |||
turned into the Evidence Custodian along with a sworn | turned into the Evidence Custodian along with a sworn | |||
statement about the discovery of the item(s). | statement about the discovery of the item(s). | |||
f. In the event of an incident involving death, | f. In the event of an incident involving death, | |||
serious bodily harm, and rape of any person inside | serious bodily harm, rape of any person, or crime | |||
camp delta including detainees. The Military Police | inside Camp Delta including detainees. The guards | |||
working in the facility will notify the CO immediately | working in the facility will notify the CO immediately | |||
after the situation is controlled. | after the situation is controlled. | |||
g. It is the responsibility of the CO to notify the | g. It is the responsibility of the CO to notify the | |||
JDOG S-3 of the incident | JDOG S-3 of the incident | |||
h. The JDOG will dispatch an appointed, school | h. The JDOG will dispatch an appointed, school | |||
trained, MPI to the scene. It is the responsibility of the | trained, MPI to the scene. It is the responsibility of the | |||
MPI to secure the scene upon arrival. The MPI will | MPI to secure the scene upon arrival. The MPI will | |||
ensure that the crime scene and the evidence is neither | ensure that the crime scene and the evidence is neither | |||
contaminated nor destroyed, IAW AR 195-5, AR 190- | contaminated nor destroyed, IAW AR 195-5, AR 190- | |||
30, and AR 195-2. The JDOG will immediately notify | 30, and AR 195-2. The JDOG will immediately notify | |||
skipping to change at line 1813 | skipping to change at line 2150 | |||
material, it will be turned back over to the Evidence | material, it will be turned back over to the Evidence | |||
Custodian. | Custodian. | |||
o. Photograph and turn in all damaged self-harm | o. Photograph and turn in all damaged self-harm | |||
blankets and smocks to the JDOG S4 except when the | blankets and smocks to the JDOG S4 except when the | |||
item was used in a suicide or near-suicide. | item was used in a suicide or near-suicide. | |||
p. The Evidence Custodian will forward a copy of | p. The Evidence Custodian will forward a copy of | |||
the DA 4137 to the JDOG S4 for all semi-durable | the DA 4137 to the JDOG S4 for all semi-durable | |||
goods that are confiscated for evidence. All damaged | goods that are confiscated for evidence. All damaged | |||
items that are not evidence will be sent to the JDOG S4 | items that are not evidence will be sent to the JDOG S4 | |||
for disposition. | for disposition. | |||
5-15. Investigations | q. Any ISO mat that is no longer needed for MPI | |||
incidents and is dirty, will be rolled up, placed inside a | ||||
garbage bag and then placed in the dirty laundry bin for | ||||
Camp 2. | ||||
5-18. Investigations | ||||
a. When warranted, the MPI will investigate any | a. When warranted, the MPI will investigate any | |||
alleged incident of misconduct inside Camp Delta. | alleged incident of misconduct inside Camp Delta. | |||
b. After the investigation is completed, the MPI will | b. After the investigation is completed, the MPI will | |||
review the evidence and all other investigation related | review the evidence and all other investigation related | |||
material with the Staff Judge Advocate (SJA). | material with the Staff Judge Advocate (SJA). | |||
c. If the results of the investigation are determined | c. If the results of the investigation are determined | |||
to be unfounded by the MPI, the investigation material | to be unfounded by the MPI, the investigation material | |||
will be returned to the JDOG S3 to be filed | will be returned to the JDOG S3 to be filed | |||
appropriately. | appropriately. | |||
d. If the results of the investigation are determined | d. Upon determination that the results of the | |||
to be founded, the investigation material will be given | investigation are founded, the investigation material | |||
to the CDJOG to determine how the matter will be | will be forwarded to the CDJOG through the JDOG S3 | |||
resolved. | to determine how the matter will be resolved. | |||
Section VII – Training | ||||
5-19. Drills | ||||
a. Battle drills will be conducted in Camp Delta or | ||||
other JDOG AOR. These drills will include exercising | ||||
of the Infantry QRF, and be conducted at least once per | ||||
8-hour shift, with the intent of familiarizing JDOG | ||||
guard and infantry personnel with their duties and | ||||
responsibilities. Regular drilling or Tactical Exercise | ||||
Without Troops (TEWT) will improve Emergency | ||||
Action responses and integrated operations. | ||||
b. Battle drills will be held at least once per eight hr | ||||
shift, internally, to exercise JDOG personnel and | ||||
specifically the QRF, without interrupting the normal | ||||
operations of Camp Delta. This is to familiarize Camp | ||||
Delta personnel with their duties in the result they are | ||||
needed. | ||||
c. The CO or the JDOG S-3 will initiate the drills. | ||||
These scenarios are listed on note cards on file in the | ||||
DOC. The CO or S3 officer may select scenario based | ||||
on personal assessment of unit needs and/or current | ||||
mission constraints. Sequence of events: | ||||
(1) Contact and activate of the IRF and QRF | ||||
Teams. | ||||
(2) Teams reporting to appropriate command | ||||
authority for orders in an expedient manner. | ||||
d. MESLs will be kept in the DOC with the | ||||
Company Commander having the discretion to select | ||||
those that reflect current training needs on a rotational | ||||
basis. | ||||
e. Conditions for activation of the QRF & IRF: | ||||
(1) Mass Casualty Incidents | ||||
(2) Hostile Actions/T-SCIF Alarm | ||||
(3) Destructive Weather | ||||
(4) Disturbances with detainees | ||||
(5) Power Outage | ||||
(6) Forced Cell Extraction | ||||
(7) Camp 4 Disturbance | ||||
(8) Escape / missing ISN Camps 1/2/3/4 Echo & | ||||
Iguana | ||||
(9) Other situation as determined by CO or S3. | ||||
f. The standards include adherence to the use of | ||||
force policy, Rules Of Engagement, and approved | ||||
SOPs. Commander’s assessment will be included as | ||||
part of each AAR. These exercises are not meant to be | ||||
a distracter from Camp Delta operations. Mission | ||||
dependent, the CO may choose to conduct a TEWT, a | ||||
walk through of a battle drill, or a full drill. However, | ||||
the Infantry QRF will be alerted and brought to full | ||||
readiness once per shift as per CJTF guidance. | ||||
g. Execution: | ||||
(1) Notification of an incident – defined as an | ||||
exercise | ||||
(2) Radio or telephonic contact with appropriate | ||||
forces stating “EXERCISE EXERCISE | ||||
EXERCISE…” and the mission requirement. | ||||
(3) The CO or his representative will determine | ||||
to use the actual IRF and QRF forces, conduct a | ||||
TEWT, or to verbalize response for training purposes. | ||||
(4) JDOG Staff will make notifications of outside | ||||
forces with CJDOG or his representative determining | ||||
whether to make actual calls (to gauge contact response | ||||
only. NOT to actually bring in outside forces.), or | ||||
whether to verbalize for the purposes of familiarizing | ||||
staff. | ||||
(5) When troop are actually utilized they will | ||||
take up proper positions and be able to verbalize their | ||||
duties. Officers will demonstrate their knowledge of | ||||
tasks | ||||
(6) Battle drills will take place within Camp | ||||
Delta camps 1,2,3 & 4 only and will not include Camps | ||||
Echo or Iguana as they are covered by the external | ||||
QRF. | ||||
(7) ENDEX to be announced to all participating | ||||
parties. | ||||
(8) An After Action Review will be conducted | ||||
after the drill. At a minimum, the SOG of the QRF, the | ||||
CO, and a member of the DOC will participate. | ||||
(9) Staff / Leaders review SOP for adjustment. | ||||
(10) Submit electronic or hard copy of the AAR | ||||
to JDOG S-3 or designee. | ||||
5-20. Block Training | ||||
a. Each day, each block will train on a task listed in | ||||
Appendix J Block Training Tasks. | ||||
b. The CO, PL and SOGs are responsible for | ||||
knowing the task each block is training on. | ||||
c. Each block NCO must document the training | ||||
performed. | ||||
d. At no time will training be conducted in a manner | ||||
that detracts from accomplishing the work on the | ||||
block. | ||||
Chapter 6 | Chapter 6 | |||
Cell Block Operations | Cell Block Operations | |||
Section I – Security Procedures | Section I – Security Procedures | |||
6-1. Overview | 6-1. Overview | |||
a. Fair, firm, and impartial enforcement of rules and | a. Fair, firm, and impartial enforcement of rules and | |||
regulations facilitates the control of detainees. Custody | regulations facilitates the control of detainees. Custody | |||
and control measures maintain good order and | and control measures maintain good order and | |||
discipline and protect the welfare of all personnel and | discipline and protect the welfare of all personnel and | |||
detainees alike. Supervisors must know where | detainees alike. Supervisors must know where | |||
skipping to change at line 1855 | skipping to change at line 2287 | |||
incidents, or other disturbances. | incidents, or other disturbances. | |||
c. Security is a series of checks and balances | c. Security is a series of checks and balances | |||
performed at various levels both internal and external | performed at various levels both internal and external | |||
to the facility. It requires all personnel to continually | to the facility. It requires all personnel to continually | |||
maintain an effective working knowledge of rules, | maintain an effective working knowledge of rules, | |||
regulations, and special orders; maintain constant | regulations, and special orders; maintain constant | |||
vigilance throughout their daily duties; review/evaluate | vigilance throughout their daily duties; review/evaluate | |||
procedures and initiate recommendations to proper | procedures and initiate recommendations to proper | |||
authority for improvements. | authority for improvements. | |||
d. There must be a continuous presence on the | d. There must be a continuous presence on the | |||
blocks by the Block Guards. At no time should the | blocks by the guards. At no time should the block not | |||
block not have a Block Guard walking up and down | have a guard walking up and down the block. At | |||
the block. At random times, two Block Guards will | random times, two guards will walk the block and it | |||
walk the block and it will be annotated in the pass-on | will be annotated in the pass on book. | |||
book. | e. No items will be left on block ledges, steps, | |||
causeway, or anywhere else that is within reach of a | ||||
detainee in a cell. This is of particular concern at the | ||||
ends of the blocks where items are left on ledges or | ||||
hand railings. Numerous items left in these areas have | ||||
been grabbed by detainees and taken into their cell. | ||||
f. No food or beverages are allowed in the block | ||||
shacks. Block personnel will not clean the computers. | ||||
If a computer needs cleaning, contact the JDOG | ||||
Operations. | ||||
6-2. Headcounts | 6-2. Headcounts | |||
a. Detainees will not be responsible for conducting | a. Detainees will not be responsible for conducting | |||
any part of the count. Detainees will not move about | any part of the count. Detainees will not move about | |||
during count, to include any escorted detainees to areas | during count, to include any escorted detainees to areas | |||
outside the blocks. All detainee escorts will hold in | outside the blocks. All detainee escorts will hold in | |||
place until the count is complete and cleared by the | place until the count is complete and cleared by the | |||
DOC. | DOC. | |||
b. Conduct ISN headcounts as scheduled. The | b. Conduct ISN headcounts as scheduled. The | |||
Block Guard conducting the ISN headcount will | guard conducting the ISN headcount will compare the | |||
compare the ISN number on the ID bracelet with the | ISN number on the ID bracelet with the ISN number on | |||
ISN number on the alpha roster and the picture on the | the alpha roster and the picture on the ID bracelet to the | |||
ID bracelet to the detainee. | detainee. | |||
c. To count a detainee at night, the Block Guard | c. To count a detainee at night, the guard counting | |||
counting detainees must see skin or movement. | detainees must see skin or movement. | |||
d. Conduct additional counts whenever a there is | d. Conduct additional counts whenever there is | |||
suspicion of a missing detainee, after a disturbance, | suspicion of a missing detainee, after a disturbance, | |||
after a drill or when deemed necessary by the CO or | after a drill or when deemed necessary by the CO or | |||
higher authority. | higher authority. | |||
e. Conduct a picture headcount at any time the | e. Conduct a picture headcount at any time the | |||
identity of a missing detainee is not apparent. | identity of a missing detainee is not apparent. | |||
f. Random headcounts will occur on every shift. | f. A headcount will be conducted at the start of | |||
During each two-hour block of time starting at the | each guard shift. The DOC will then call for an | |||
beginning of the shift, the DOC will call for a random | additional three randomly timed headcounts throughout | |||
headcount, and the blocks will conduct it. | the guard shift. The most time between headcounts is | |||
three hours. | ||||
6-3. Searches | 6-3. Searches | |||
a. Searching will be done technically correct and | a. Searching will be done technically correct and | |||
professionally at all times. The intent is to search for | professionally at all times. The intent is to search for | |||
safety, not harass or invade dignity. | safety, not harass or invade dignity. | |||
b. Search cells whenever a detainee exits a cell or | b. Search cells whenever a detainee exits a cell or | |||
prior to his return to his cell. | prior to his return to his cell. | |||
c. A minimum of three random cell searches will be | c. A minimum of three random cell searches will be | |||
done on day shift and swing shift. Cells scheduled for | done on day shift and swing shift. Cells scheduled for | |||
shower and recreation that day will not be included in | shower and exercise that day will not be included in the | |||
the count of cells randomly searched. | count of cells randomly searched. | |||
d. Search showers and recreation areas before and | d. Search showers and exercise areas before and | |||
after every detainee use. | after every detainee use. | |||
e. All shifts will do area searches. | e. All shifts will do area searches. | |||
f. When searching, use a systematic method to | f. When searching, use a systematic method to | |||
ensure all areas are covered. | ensure all areas are covered. | |||
g. Midnight shift, will conduct visual search of the | g. Midnight shift, will conduct visual search of the | |||
cells and detainees every ten minutes by walking | cells and detainees every ten minutes by walking | |||
through the block. Annotate every check on the block | through the block. Annotate every check on the block | |||
journal. Report all unusual activity. | journal. Report all unusual activity. | |||
h. Submit a work order any time a cell has | h. Submit a work order any time a cell has | |||
inoperable equipment. Each cell that needs a work | inoperable equipment. Each cell that needs a work | |||
order must be on a separate work order. | order must be on a separate work order. | |||
i. Search detainees at a minimum of each time they | i. Search detainees at a minimum each time they | |||
are removed from a cell. | are removed from a cell. | |||
j. Conduct physical searches by the same gender | j. Conduct physical searches by the same gender | |||
whenever possible as a matter of principle. Only | whenever possible as a matter of principle. Only | |||
during exigent conditions for security purposes should | during exigent conditions for security purposes should | |||
an opposite gender conduct any physical search when | an opposite gender conduct any physical search when | |||
no other same-gender MP is available as determined by | no other same-gender guard is available as determined | |||
the SOG. | by the SOG. | |||
k. The standard search for detainee movement at | ||||
Camp Delta will be a modified Pat Down search in | ||||
compliance with instructions received from the Camp | ||||
Delta Superintendent. | ||||
(1) You may search either side of the body first. | ||||
Use your hands to check for obvious bulges or articles | ||||
that do not belong on the detainee’s person. | ||||
(a) Start with the head and hair. Search for | ||||
anything inappropriate. | ||||
(b) Search the neck area and top of the shoulder. | ||||
(c) Search the arm from the shoulder to the | ||||
fingers. | ||||
(d) Search the back area from the neck to the | ||||
waistband on the shorts or pants. | ||||
(e) Search the side area from the armpit to the | ||||
waistband on the shorts or pants. | ||||
(f) Search the chest area from the neck to the | ||||
waistband on the pants or shorts. | ||||
(g) Search the waistband area of the shorts or | ||||
pants by running your thumb along the inside of the | ||||
waistband all the way around the detainee. | ||||
(h) Search the leg area by starting where the | ||||
bottom of the shorts are as worn by the detainee and | ||||
check down to the foot. | ||||
(i) Search the flip flop by having the detainee | ||||
raise his foot so that you may physically check the sole | ||||
and the inside of the item. | ||||
(j) Search the opposite side of the detainee in the | ||||
same fashion as you did the first side. | ||||
(2) During a search, you are not allowed to touch | ||||
or feel the detainee between the waistband of the shorts | ||||
or pants and the bottom of the shorts as worn. | ||||
(3) If the guard believes that the detainee has | ||||
placed something in the prohibited search area, through | ||||
observation or other means, the guard may search the | ||||
area. The guard must be willing to write a DA 2823 | ||||
Sworn Statement to justify his action of searching the | ||||
restricted area. | ||||
(4) In the event a detainee has concealed | ||||
contraband , the Co on-duty may request the detention | ||||
clinic perform a body cavity search. Upon notification | ||||
that a body cavity search needs to be performed the | ||||
DOC will notify the provider on duty (PA/MD from | ||||
the Joint Aid Station). The provider will report to the | ||||
detention clinic. The detainee will be escorted to the | ||||
designated room where the search will take place. The | ||||
detainee will remain restrained to avoid any | ||||
confrontation with medical staff. The procedure and | ||||
findings will be documented in the detainee medical | ||||
record with time and date of the procedure, name of the | ||||
person performing the procedure and name of the | ||||
person who requested the procedure. | ||||
Personnel selected and approved for the procedure | ||||
will be trained by JAS providers (PA/MD), and | ||||
provided written permission to perform the task. | ||||
6-4. Searching the Koran | 6-4. Searching the Koran | |||
a. To ensure the safety of the detainees and MPs | a. To ensure the safety of the detainees and guards | |||
while respecting the cultural dignity of the Korans | while respecting the cultural dignity of the Korans | |||
thereby reducing the friction over the searching the | thereby reducing the friction over the searching the | |||
Korans. JTF-GTMO personnel directly working with | Korans. JTF-GTMO personnel directly working with | |||
detainees will avoid handling or touching the | detainees will avoid handling or touching the | |||
detainee’s Koran whenever possible. When military | detainee’s Koran whenever possible. When military | |||
necessity does require the Koran to be searched, the | necessity does require the Koran to be searched, the | |||
subsequent procedures will be followed. | subsequent procedures will be followed. | |||
(1) The MP informs the detainee that the | (1) The guard informs the detainee that the | |||
Chaplain or a Muslim interpreter will inspect Koran. If | Chaplain or a Muslim interpreter will inspect Koran. If | |||
the detainee refuses the inspection at any time, the | the detainee refuses the inspection at any time, the | |||
noncompliance is reported to the DOC and logged | noncompliance is reported to the DOC and logged | |||
appropriately by the Block NCO. | appropriately by the Block NCO. | |||
(2) The Koran will not be touched or handled by | (2) The Koran will not be touched or handled by | |||
the MP. | the guard. | |||
(3) The Chaplain or Muslim interpreter will give | (3) The Chaplain or Muslim interpreter will give | |||
instructions to the detainee who will handle the Koran. | instructions to the detainee who will handle the Koran. | |||
He may or may not require a language specific | He may or may not require a language specific | |||
interpreter. | interpreter. | |||
(4) The inspector is examining to notice | (4) The inspector is examining to notice | |||
unauthorized items, markings, or any indicators that | unauthorized items, markings, or any indicators that | |||
raises suspicion about the contents of the Koran. | raises suspicion about the contents of the Koran. | |||
(5) The inspector will instruct the detainee to first | (5) The inspector will instruct the detainee to first | |||
open the one cover with one hand while holding the | open the one cover with one hand while holding the | |||
Koran in the other thus exposing the inside cover | Koran in the other thus exposing the inside cover | |||
completely. | completely. | |||
(6) The inspector instructs the detainee to open | (6) The inspector instructs the detainee to open | |||
pages in an upright manner (as if reading the Koran). | pages in an upright manner (as if reading the Koran). | |||
This is a random page search and not every page is to | This is a random page search and not every page is to | |||
skipping to change at line 1960 | skipping to change at line 2457 | |||
of the Koran while the book is closed so that inspector | of the Koran while the book is closed so that inspector | |||
can note the binding while closed paying attention to | can note the binding while closed paying attention to | |||
abnormal contours or protrusions associated with the | abnormal contours or protrusions associated with the | |||
binding. The intent is to deduce if anything may be in | binding. The intent is to deduce if anything may be in | |||
the binding without forcing the detainee to expose the | the binding without forcing the detainee to expose the | |||
binding, which may be construed as culturally | binding, which may be construed as culturally | |||
insensitive or offensive given the significance of the | insensitive or offensive given the significance of the | |||
Koran. | Koran. | |||
(9) How the detainee reacted, observation by | (9) How the detainee reacted, observation by | |||
other detainees, and other potentially relevant | other detainees, and other potentially relevant | |||
observations will be annotated appropriately on the | observations will be annotated in DIMS. | |||
block significant activities sheet as well as staff | ||||
journal. | ||||
b. Handling. | b. Handling. | |||
(1) Clean gloves will be put on in full view of the | (1) Clean gloves will be put on in full view of the | |||
detainees prior to handling. | detainees prior to handling. | |||
(2) Two hands will be used at all times when | (2) Two hands will be used at all times when | |||
handling the Koran in manner signaling respect and | handling the Koran in manner signaling respect and | |||
reverence. Care should be used so that the right hand | reverence. Care should be used so that the right hand | |||
is the primary one used to manipulate any part of the | is the primary one used to manipulate any part of the | |||
Koran due to the cultural association with the left hand. | Koran due to the cultural association with the left hand. | |||
Handle the Koran as if it were a fragile piece of | Handle the Koran as if it were a fragile piece of | |||
delicate art. | delicate art. | |||
(3) Ensure that the Koran is not placed in | (3) Ensure that the Koran is not placed in | |||
offensive areas such as the floor, near the toilet or sink, | offensive areas such as the floor, near the toilet or sink, | |||
near the feet, or dirty/wet areas. | near the feet, or dirty/wet areas. | |||
c. Removal. | c. Removal. | |||
(1) Korans should be left in the cell as a rule | (1) Korans must be transported by the detainee, | |||
(save in MSU), even when a detainee is moved to | in the event the detainee is moved to another cell or | |||
another cell or block. In principal, every cell (except | block. | |||
MSU) will have a Koran “assigned” to it. | ||||
(2) If a Koran must be removed at the direction | (2) If a Koran must be removed at the direction | |||
the CJDOG, the detainee library personnel or Chaplain | the CJDOG, the detainee library personnel, Muslim | |||
will be contacted to retrieve and properly store the | interpreter, or Chaplain will be contacted to retrieve | |||
Koran in the detainee library. The request for the | and properly store the Koran in the detainee library. | |||
librarian/Chaplain, as well as the retrieval itself, will be | The request for the librarian, interpreter, or Chaplain, | |||
logged appropriately. | as well as the retrieval itself, will be logged in DIMS. | |||
(3) If the Chaplain, librarian, or Muslim | (3) If the Chaplain, librarian, or Muslim | |||
interpreter, within the needs of the situation, cannot | interpreter, within the needs of the situation, cannot | |||
remove the Koran, then the MP may remove the Koran | remove the Koran, then the guard may remove the | |||
after approved by the DOC (who notes this in the MP | Koran after approved by the DOC (who notes this in | |||
Blotter) IAW the following procedures: | the DIMS) IAW the following procedures: | |||
(a) Clean gloves will be put on in full view of the | (a) Clean gloves will be put on in full view of the | |||
detainees prior to handling. | detainees prior to handling. | |||
(b) Two hands will be used at all times when | (b) Two hands will be used at all times when | |||
handling the Koran in manner signaling respect and | handling the Koran in manner signaling respect and | |||
reverence. | reverence. | |||
(c) Place a clean, dry, detainee towel on the | (c) Place a clean, dry, detainee towel on the | |||
detainee bed and then place the Koran on top of the | detainee bed and then place the Koran on top of the | |||
clean towel in a manner, which allows it to be wrapped | clean towel in a manner, which allows it to be wrapped | |||
without turning the Koran over at any time in a | without turning the Koran over at any time in a | |||
reverent manner. Ensure that the Koran is not placed | reverent manner. Ensure that the Koran is not placed | |||
in offensive areas such as the floor, near the toilet or | in offensive areas such as the floor, near the toilet or | |||
sink, near the feet, or dirty/wet area when doing this | sink, near the feet, or dirty/wet area when doing this | |||
activity. | activity. | |||
(4) How the detainee reacted, observation by | (4) How the detainee reacted, observation by | |||
other detainees, and other potentially relevant | other detainees, and other potentially relevant | |||
observations will be annotated appropriately on the | observations will be annotated appropriately in the | |||
block significant activities sheet as well as staff | DIMS significant activities menu. | |||
journal. | ||||
(5) The Koran shall be returned to the librarian, | (5) The Koran shall be returned to the librarian, | |||
Chaplain, or DOC (in that order). | Chaplain, or DOC (in that order). | |||
(6) Exception: Detainee in MSU may have a | (6) Korans are the property of the U.S. | |||
Koran if specifically authorized by a 508-1 or the Level | ||||
5 Block Entitlement Form. Once detainee leaves | ||||
MSU, the same handling/removing policies and | ||||
procedures remain in effect. | ||||
(7) Korans are the property of the U.S. | ||||
Government and as such will remain in the cells only | Government and as such will remain in the cells only | |||
to be removed at the CJDOG’s decision. | to be removed at the CJDOG’s decision. | |||
(7) If a Koran is damaged or destroyed by a | ||||
detainee, the chaplain in conjunction with a Muslim | ||||
interpreter will take the Koran from the detainee for a | ||||
minimum of ten days noted in DIMS. At that point, the | ||||
chaplain can reissue the Koran to the detainee. The | ||||
chaplain must ensure the block knows the Koran is | ||||
being taken to protect the Koran, not punish the | ||||
detainee. | ||||
6-5. Keys | 6-5. Keys | |||
a. Maintain all cell and sally port keys on your | a. Maintain all cell and sally port keys on your | |||
person continuously. | person continuously. | |||
b. Never leave keys unsecured and unattended | b. Never leave keys unsecured and unattended | |||
within the facility. Keys are not to be laid down on | within the facility. Keys are not to be laid down on | |||
tables, chairs, steps, etc. at any time. Keys are not to | tables, chairs, steps, etc. at any time. Keys are not to | |||
be left hanging on a hooks or the fence. | be left hanging on a hooks or the fence. | |||
c. Keys will not leave the block. They will be | c. Keys will not leave the block. They will be | |||
handed to another Block Guard prior to leaving the | handed to another guard prior to leaving the block. | |||
block. | ||||
6-6. Food Tray Slot (“Bean Hole”) Covers | 6-6. Food Tray Slot (“Bean Hole”) Covers | |||
a. Bean hole covers will be closed at all times | a. Bean hole covers will be closed at all times | |||
except when serving food, shackling, passing an item | except when serving food, shackling, passing an item | |||
to the detainee, or is required for a medical check. | to the detainee, or is required for a medical check. | |||
These bean hole covers do include the observation | These bean hole covers do not include the observation | |||
windows on the MSU cell doors. | windows on the segregation cell doors. | |||
b. Bean hole covers will be latched at all times. | b. Bean hole covers will be latched at all times. | |||
6-7. Applying Restraints (“Shackling”) | 6-7. Applying Restraints (“Shackling”) | |||
a. Shackling of detainees will follow a “minimum | a. Shackling of detainees will follow a “minimum | |||
force” policy. The intent is to create a standard for | force” policy. The intent is to create a standard for | |||
shackling without sacrificing the ability to escalate due | shackling without sacrificing the ability to escalate due | |||
to MP safety concerns. | to guard safety concerns. | |||
b. As a general rule, detainees will be shackled in | b. As a general rule, detainees will be shackled in | |||
the standing up position. It will be the block NCOs | the standing up position. It will be the block NCOs | |||
responsibility to justify the need to escalate and require | responsibility to justify the need to escalate and require | |||
a detainee to kneel to be shackled | a detainee to kneel to be shackled | |||
c. If a detainee is required to kneel, the Block NCO | c. If a detainee is required to kneel, the Block NCO | |||
will note in the block pass-on book whenever a | will note in DIMS whenever a detainee is required to | |||
detainee is required to kneel to be shackled. The | kneel to be shackled. The notation will include the | |||
notation will include the time, ISN, type of escort | time, ISN, type of escort (shower & exercise, | |||
(shower & recreation, reservation, etc.) and a BRIEF | reservation, etc.) and a BRIEF reason as to the | |||
reason as to the deviation from shackling in the | deviation from shackling in the standing position. | |||
standing position. | ||||
d. Forced cell extractions, moves in which the | d. Forced cell extractions, moves in which the | |||
detainee has required an IRF “stand to”, are obvious | detainee has required an IRF “stand to”, are obvious | |||
reasons for use of the kneeling position. | reasons for use of the kneeling position. | |||
Section II – Support Operations | Section II – Support Operations | |||
6-8. Shower and Recreation | 6-8. Shower and Exercise | |||
a. Utilize the following schedule on levels 2, 3, 4, | a. Shower and exercise will be conducted in | |||
and 5 blocks for shower and recreation call. | accordance to the published schedule listed in | |||
DAY SHIFT SWING SHIFT | Appendix B. | |||
SUNDAY NONE NONE | b. The Block NCO will be responsible for ensuring | |||
MONDAY UNITS 1-8 UNITS 9-16 | each Level 1 detainees on an Intel block receive | |||
TUESDAY UNITS 17-24 UNITS 25-32 | shower and exercise four times per week and each | |||
WEDNESDAY UNITS 33-40 UNITS 41-48 | Level 2, 3, and 4 detainees receive shower and exercise | |||
THURSDAY UNITS 1-8 UNITS 9-16 | two times per week. | |||
FRIDAY UNITS 17-24 UNITS 25-32 | c. Allow each level 1 detainee 30 minutes for | |||
SATURDAY UNITS 33-40 UNITS 41-48 | exercise and all other detainees will receive 20 minutes | |||
b. Level one blocks will utilize the below schedule: | for exercise. Allow five minutes to shower | |||
DAY SHIFT SWING SHIFT | immediately after exercise. These five minutes will not | |||
SUNDAY UNITS 1-10 UNITS 11-21 | be substituted for additional recreation time. Female | |||
MONDAY UNITS 22-31 UNITS 32-41 | guards will not escort detainees to and from their cell | |||
TUESDAY UNITS 41-48/1- | during shower and exercise. If the detainee desires to | |||
3 | shave his body hair, allow an additional five minutes. | |||
UNITS 4-14 | Shaving of body hair will only be permitted on the first | |||
WEDNESDAY UNITS 15-24 UNITS 25-34 | rotation of each week (Monday through Wednesday.) | |||
THURSDAY UNITS 35-44 UNITS 45-48/1- | Block personnel will visually inspect each razor and | |||
7 | monitor detainees shaving at all times. Detainees will | |||
FRIDAY UNITS 8-17 UNITS 18-27 | not possess nail clippers and razor at the same time. | |||
SATURDAY UNITS 28-37 UNITS 38-48 | For DELTA Block shower and exercise, refer to | |||
c. Conduct shower and recreation call in | DELTA Block SOP 30-12, dated 1 January 2004. | |||
conjunction with each other. The Block NCO will be | d. After returning from shower and exercise, offer | |||
responsible for ensuring each Level 1 detainee receives | ||||
showers and recreation three times per week and each | ||||
Level 2, 3, and 4 detainee receives showers and | ||||
recreation two times per week unless they are on | ||||
discipline measures that include no recreation. | ||||
d. Allow each detainee 20 minutes for recreation. | ||||
Allow five minutes to shower immediately after | ||||
recreation. Female MPs will not escort detainees to | ||||
and from their cell during shower and recreation. If the | ||||
detainee desires to shave his body hair, allow an | ||||
additional five minutes. Only allow shaving of body | ||||
hair on the first rotation of each week (Monday through | ||||
Wednesday.) but will NOT be done on MSU blocks or | ||||
for Delta block patients. Block Guards will constantly | ||||
monitor detainees during shaving at all times. | ||||
Detainees will possess no nail clippers while they | ||||
possess a razor. Ensure the return of intact razors. | ||||
Allow level one detainees to use a shower curtain | ||||
during their shower period. The detainee must | ||||
exchange the shower curtain for the razor. No detainee | ||||
will have a razor with the shower curtain hung up. | ||||
e. After returning from shower and recreation, offer | ||||
the detainee the use of a brush to clean their cell. They | the detainee the use of a brush to clean their cell. They | |||
will have until the next detainee on their side of the | will have until the next detainee on their side of the | |||
block returns from shower and recreation to use the | block returns from shower and exercise to use the | |||
brush. The detainee will receive no cleaning supplies | brush. Detainees will not receive any cleaning | |||
or agents to clean their cell. The last detainee who has | supplies or agents to clean their cell. The last detainee | |||
shower will receive the brush for 30 minutes. If the | who has shower will receive the brush for 30 minutes. | |||
detainee refuses shower, they will not get the floor | e. Track refusals in DIMS, search the refusing | |||
brush. | detainee’s cell. A detainee may not refuse exercise | |||
f. Track refusals in the Refusals log. Search the | time. If the detainee refuses, note the reason on the | |||
refusing detainee’s cell. | SIGACT sheet in DIMS, using an interpreter if | |||
g. Detainees may exercise in their cell as long as it | necessary. Forced cell extractions will be utilized for | |||
is an approved exercise. | non-compliant detainees and the detainee will be | |||
h. No detainee may perform any hand-to-hand | ||||
moved to the exercise yard. This applies to all blocks | ||||
except Delta block | ||||
f. No detainee may perform any hand-to-hand | ||||
combat or martial arts PT, either organized or | combat or martial arts PT, either organized or | |||
individual, in the recreation yard or in their cell. | individual, in the exercise yard or in their cell. | |||
i. Amputees will receive their normal recreation | g. Amputees will receive their normal exercise time | |||
time and any other if prescribed by a doctor. Detainees | and any other if prescribed by a doctor. Detainees that | |||
that have a walker may take the walker with them to | have a walker may take the walker with them to the | |||
the recreation yard. | exercise yard. | |||
j. Escort level one detainees to and from Shower | h. Escort level one and level two detainees to and | |||
and Recreation in handcuffs and waist belt. They will | from Shower and Exercise in handcuffs and waist belt. | |||
not have leg irons placed on them. | They will not have leg irons placed on them. | |||
i. Shower items (soap, shampoo, razors, etc.) will | ||||
not be left in the open, outside, at the back of the block | ||||
during shower and exercise. Guards will only bring | ||||
what is needed by an individual detainee to the shower | ||||
and exercise area of the block and will secure same | ||||
immediately following the detainee’s shower. | ||||
j. Each level 1 block will conduct shower and | ||||
exercise with two detainees in the exercise yard at the | ||||
same time. | ||||
(1) Detainees will be paired starting with cells 1 | ||||
and 2, 3 and 4, 5 and 6 continuing to 47 and 48. If one | ||||
of the cells in the pair is empty, the detainee will be | ||||
placed in the exercise yard by himself. | ||||
(2) The first detainee will be placed in the | ||||
exercise yard and unshackled. The guards will then get | ||||
the second detainee that is paired with that one and | ||||
take him to the exercise yard. Prior to opening the | ||||
gate, the first detainee will be told to move to the | ||||
corner opposite the gate on the far side of the yard and | ||||
to remain there until the second detainee is in the yard | ||||
and the gate is closed and locked. Once the first | ||||
detainee is in the far corner, the gate will be opened, | ||||
the second detainee will be placed in the exercise yard, | ||||
gate closed and locked and then unshackled through | ||||
the bean hole. | ||||
(3) Exercise time will start once the second gate | ||||
is locked after the second detainee has been placed in | ||||
the exercise yard. Time for exercise will be 30 | ||||
minutes. | ||||
(4) The detainee that is first in the exercise yard | ||||
will be the detainee that comes out first. To remove | ||||
the first detainee, reverse the process. The second | ||||
detainee will go to the corner opposite the gate on the | ||||
far side and then the first detainee will be shackled and | ||||
removed from the yard. | ||||
(5) Cells 1-12 will be done during schedule “A” | ||||
day shift. Cells 13-24 will be done during schedule | ||||
“A” swing shift. Cells 25-36 will be done during | ||||
schedule “B” day shift. Cells 37-48 will be done | ||||
during schedule “B” swing shift. The first day of | ||||
implementation of the policy will be day “A”, the | ||||
second day will be day “B”, the third day will be day | ||||
“A” and so forth. | ||||
(6) The schedule conducted will be annotated in | ||||
the pass on book. | ||||
6-9. Detainee Mess Operations | 6-9. Detainee Mess Operations | |||
a. SOG. The SOG is responsible for the adequate | a. SOG. The SOG is responsible for the adequate | |||
quality and quantity of food served (to include MREs) | quality and quantity of food served (to include MREs) | |||
to detainees and U.S personnel and that sanitation, | to detainees, and that sanitation, preparation, handling | |||
preparation, handling and servicing of food meet | and servicing of food meet established criteria. | |||
established criteria. Detainees will have 30 minutes in | Detainees will have 30 minutes in which to consume | |||
which to consume their meals. During times of fasting | their meals. During times of fasting or religious | |||
or religious requirements, and special diets refer to the | requirements, and special diets refer to the Chapter 19 | |||
Chapter 19 Food Service. | Food Service. | |||
b. Block NCO. The Block NCO will accept and | b. Block NCO. The Block NCO will accept and | |||
account for the plastic spoons from mess personnel. | account for the plastic spoons from mess personnel. | |||
While the Block Guards are serving the meal to the | While the guards are serving the meal to the detainees, | |||
detainees, the Block NCO will pass out the plastic | the Block NCO will pass out the plastic spoons to each | |||
spoons to each detainee. The Block NCO will account | detainee. The Block NCO will account for all plastic | |||
for all plastic spoons passed out once the mealtime is | spoons passed out once the mealtime is completed. | |||
completed. Notify the SOG of unreturned plastic | Notify the SOG of unreturned plastic spoons, and | |||
spoons, and conduct a search to locate the missing | conduct a search to locate the missing spoon. The | |||
spoon. The Block NCO will ensure no contents are | Block NCO will ensure no contents are removed from | |||
removed from MREs nor that damaged MREs are | MREs or that damaged MREs are issued. | |||
issued. | c. Guards will issue meals to the detainees and | |||
monitor them during chow. At the conclusion of the | ||||
c. Block Guards. Block Guards will issue meals to | meal, the guards will collect the trash from the | |||
the detainees and monitor them during chow. At the | detainees. Guards will inventory the return of all | |||
conclusion of the meal, the Block Guards will collect | packaging, plates, spoons, and Styrofoam cups. | |||
the trash from the detainees. Block Guards will | ||||
inventory the return of all packaging, plates, spoons, | ||||
and Styrofoam cups. If unreturned items cannot be | ||||
found, the detainee will receive his meals poured onto | ||||
a paper plate for the next three days. This is done with | ||||
the intention of reducing the amount of trash being | ||||
flushed down the toilet. | ||||
d. Food Service Personnel. When serving hot | d. Food Service Personnel. When serving hot | |||
meals, Food Service Personnel will portion the food | meals, Food Service personnel will portion the food | |||
from the Mermite containers to the plate to ensure each | from the insulated food container (IFC) to the plate to | |||
detainee has the proper proportions. | ensure each detainee has the proper proportions. If | |||
e. If a detainee refuses a meal, the refusal most be | there are insufficient Food Service personnel to | |||
noted in the detainee’s record. When the number of | perform this function, the guards will portion the food. | |||
consecutive refusals reaches nine, refer to, Section 20- | e. If a detainee refuses a meal, the refusal must be | |||
5, Hunger Strike. | noted in DIMS. If a detainee eats any portion or part of | |||
the meal, it is not considered a missed or refused meal. | ||||
Ensure all missed meals are entered in the refusal | ||||
section of DIMS. When the number of consecutive | ||||
refusals reaches nine, refer to, Section 20-5, Voluntary | ||||
Total Fasting and Re-Feeding (VTF) | ||||
f. At no time will any guard force personnel eat any | ||||
portion of a detainee meal. | ||||
g. Below is a list of the contents of the MREs that | ||||
must remain in each MRE and what will be returned | ||||
after use. | ||||
(1) For MRE #11, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers - wrapper | ||||
(b) Pound Cake - wrapper | ||||
(c) Spoon - spoon | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter - wrapper | ||||
(e) Pasta with Vegetables in Tomato Sauce – | ||||
wrapper | ||||
(f) Peaches - wrapper | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix - wrapper | ||||
(h) Salt packet – wrapper | ||||
(2) For MRE #12, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers - wrapper | ||||
(b) Pound Cake - wrapper | ||||
(c) Spoon - spoon | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter - wrapper | ||||
(e) Black Bean and Rice Burrito - wrapper | ||||
(f) Pears - wrapper | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix - wrapper | ||||
(h) Salt packet - wrapper | ||||
(j) Fruit Bar - wrapper | ||||
(3) For MRE #13, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers - wrapper | ||||
(b) Pound Cake - wrapper | ||||
(c) Spoon - spoon | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter - wrapper | ||||
(e) Cheese Tortellini in Tomato Sauce - wrapper | ||||
(f) Applesauce - wrapper | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix - wrapper | ||||
(h) Salt packet - wrapper | ||||
(4) For MRE #14, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers - wrapper | ||||
(b) Pound Cake - wrapper | ||||
(c) Spoon - spoon | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter - wrapper | ||||
(e) Pasta with Vegetables in Alfredo Style Sauce | ||||
wrapper | ||||
(f) Peaches - wrapper | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix - wrapper | ||||
(h) Salt packet - wrapper | ||||
(j) Peanuts, shelled roasted – wrapper. | ||||
6-10. Laundry / Linen | 6-10. Laundry / Linen | |||
a. Guards will exchange dirty detainee laundry with | a. Guards will exchange dirty detainee laundry with | |||
clean laundry IAW the level 1-5 shower and recreation | clean laundry IAW the level 1-5 shower and exercise | |||
schedule contained in Appendix B. Exchange all | schedule contained in Appendix B. Exchange all | |||
laundry and linen at the same time with the exception | laundry and linen at the same time with the exception | |||
of blankets. Do not allow detainees to refuse | of blankets. Do not allow detainees to refuse | |||
linen/laundry exchange. Use reasonable force to | linen/laundry exchange. Use reasonable force to | |||
complete the laundry exchange. Guards will conduct | complete the laundry exchange. Guards will conduct | |||
this in a manner to determine specifically which, if any, | this in a manner to determine specifically which, if any, | |||
detainee is missing an item (i.e. flushed in toilet or | detainee is missing an item (i.e. flushed in toilet or | |||
hiding it.) Report findings to the DOC and log | hiding it.) Report findings to the DOC and log | |||
appropriately. | appropriately into DIMS. | |||
b. Guards will have detainee hold up all items for | b. Guards will have detainee hold up all items for | |||
visual inspection prior to exchanging them for a clean | visual inspection prior to exchanging them for a clean | |||
item. Confiscate any modified item, as contraband and | item. Detainee will give the dirty item to the guard | |||
discipline will be imposed according to the discipline | prior to the guard issuing the clean item. Confiscate | |||
matrix. | any modified item, as contraband and discipline will be | |||
imposed according to the discipline matrix. | ||||
c. Guards will place no more than four uniform sets | c. Guards will place no more than four uniform sets | |||
into each trash bag. Place sheets in a separate bag. | into each trash bag. Place sheets in a separate bag. | |||
Place towels and washcloths in a separate bag. Place t- | Place towels and washcloths in a separate bag. Place t- | |||
shirts in a separate bag. Place blankets in a separate | shirts in a separate bag. Place blankets in a separate | |||
bag. Place all dirty linen in the storage sheds located | bag. Place all dirty linen in the storage sheds located | |||
near building one for Camp I and near building seven | near building one for Camp I and near building seven | |||
for Camp II. Return all clean laundry to the supply | for Camp 2,3. Return all clean laundry in mesh bags to | |||
room. | the supply room. | |||
d. Blankets will be exchanged according to the | d. Blankets will be exchanged according to the | |||
following schedule: | following schedule: | |||
(1) 1st | (1) 1st | |||
Sunday of the month: A, E, I, N, R, and U | Sunday of the month: A, D, E, I, N, O, | |||
and U | ||||
(2) 2nd | (2) 2nd | |||
Sunday of the month: B, F, K, O, S, and | Sunday of the month: B, D, F, K, R, S, | |||
V | and V | |||
(3) 3rd | (3) 3rd | |||
Sunday of the month: C, G, L, P, T, and | Sunday of the month: C, D, G, L, P, T, | |||
W | and W | |||
(4) 4th | (4) 4th | |||
Sunday of the month: D, H, M, Q, Y and | Sunday of the month: D, H, M, Q, Y and | |||
special missions | special missions | |||
(5) 5th | (5) 5th | |||
Sunday of the month (occurs twice a year): | Sunday of the month (occurs twice a year): | |||
None. | None. | |||
6-11. Barber | 6-11. Barber | |||
a. Offer detainees on a voluntary basis at least once | a. Offer detainees on a voluntary basis at least once | |||
a month. The barbers will rotate through the camps | a month. The barbers will rotate through the camps | |||
from Monday to Friday starting with block Alpha with | from Monday to Friday starting with block Alpha with | |||
a maximum of 48 detainees offered a haircut per day. | a maximum of 48 detainees offered a haircut per day. | |||
Haircuts will be the same for all detainees, i.e. styled | Haircuts will be the same for all detainees, i.e. styled | |||
haircuts not allowed. Haircuts will be simple and | haircuts not allowed. Haircuts will be a trim for routine | |||
standard. Sample monthly schedule below: | haircuts. Those haircuts given for hygienic reasons for | |||
moves to SHU will be a buzz cut. Sample monthly | ||||
schedule below: | ||||
DATE BLOCK DATE BLOCK | DATE BLOCK DATE BLOCK | |||
27Dec 02 I 21 Jan 03 I | 27Dec 02 I 21 Jan 03 I | |||
28Dec 02 K 22 Jan 03 K | 28Dec 02 K 22 Jan 03 K | |||
29Dec 02 L 23 Jan 03 L | 29Dec 02 L 23 Jan 03 L | |||
01 Jan 03 M 24 Jan 03 M | 01 Jan 03 M 24 Jan 03 M | |||
02 Jan 03 N 27 Jan 03 N | 02 Jan 03 N 27 Jan 03 N | |||
03 Jan 03 P 28 Jan 03 P | 03 Jan 03 P 28 Jan 03 P | |||
06 Jan 03 Q 29 Jan 03 Q | 06 Jan 03 Q 29 Jan 03 Q | |||
07 Jan 03 R 30 Jan 03 R | 07 Jan 03 R 30 Jan 03 R | |||
08 Jan 03 S 31 Jan 03 S | 08 Jan 03 S 31 Jan 03 S | |||
09 Jan 03 A | 09 Jan 03 A | |||
10 Jan 03 B | 10 Jan 03 B | |||
13 Jan 03 C | 13 Jan 03 C | |||
14 Jan 03 D | 14 Jan 03 D | |||
15 Jan 03 E | 15 Jan 03 E | |||
16 Jan 03 F | 16 Jan 03 F | |||
17 Jan 03 G | 17 Jan 03 G | |||
20 Jan 03 H | 20 Jan 03 H | |||
b. Haircuts will take place in the recreation area of | Table 6-1 | |||
the blocks. Postpone all recreation and showers on the | b. Haircuts will take place in the exercise area of the | |||
block receiving haircuts until all haircuts are | blocks. Postpone all exercise and showers on the block | |||
completed. MP’s working the block will provide an | receiving haircuts until all haircuts are completed. | |||
escort to the barber and a minimum of one MP stays as | Guards working the block will provide an escort to the | |||
a Block Guard while detainee is receiving a haircut. | barber and a minimum of one guard stays while | |||
Use MPs working as additional escorts in Camp Delta | detainee is receiving a haircut. Use guards working as | |||
to assist if not required for other escorts. | ||||
additional escorts in Camp Delta to assist if not | ||||
required for other escorts. | ||||
c. Barbers are responsible to PMCS their | c. Barbers are responsible to PMCS their | |||
equipment. Barbers are responsible for cleaning the | equipment. Barbers are responsible for cleaning the | |||
haircut area after each haircut. Maintain all necessary | haircut area after each haircut. Maintain all necessary | |||
supplies in the camp supply room. | supplies in the camp supply room. | |||
d. The DOC will coordinate haircut appointments | d. The DOC will coordinate haircut appointments | |||
for detainees in the hospital. | for detainees in the hospital. | |||
e. Barbers will be available from 0800-2100 on | ||||
Monday thru Friday with one barber on call from 0800- | ||||
2100 on Saturday and the other on call from 0800-2100 | ||||
on Sunday. If a need arises for a detainee to receive a | ||||
haircut outside that timeframe, contact the DOC and | ||||
the detainee to a pending list. The barber will give | ||||
these detainees a haircut first on their next available | ||||
day. | ||||
6-12. Other Personnel | 6-12. Other Personnel | |||
a. The detainee Librarian will be given sufficient | a. The detainee Librarian will be given sufficient | |||
time to perform their mission. Block NCOs will allow | time to perform their mission. Block NCOs will allow | |||
at least five minutes per detainee for issuing books. | at least five minutes per detainee for issuing books. | |||
b. Do not escort interrogators, if they have the | b. Do not escort interrogators, if they have the | |||
proper ID, in the blocks. The Block NCO will greet | proper ID, in the blocks. The Block NCO will greet | |||
them and they will have complete access to the | them and they will have complete access to the | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
c. Visitors to the blocks are not required to be in | c. Visitors to the blocks are not required to be in | |||
uniform, such as civilian interpreters working with | uniform, such as civilian interpreters working with | |||
interrogators or contractors. | interrogators or contractors. | |||
d. Each mail clerk will be allowed to issue up to | d. Each mail clerk will be allowed to issue up to | |||
five pens to detainees. These pens must be collected | five safety pens to detainees. These pens must be | |||
prior to the mail clerk leaving the block. The mail | collected prior to the mail clerk leaving the block. The | |||
clerk will keep the Block NCO informed of who has a | mail clerk will keep the Block NCO informed of who | |||
pen and number issued. If the mail clerk is unable to | has a pen and number issued. If the mail clerk is | |||
retrieve a pen from a detainee, the mail clerk will | unable to retrieve a pen from a detainee, the mail clerk | |||
immediately inform the Block NCO. | will immediately inform the Block NCO. | |||
6-13. Library Books | 6-13. Library Books | |||
a. Do not allow the passing of detainee library | a. Do not allow the passing of detainee library | |||
books among detainees. | books among detainees. | |||
b. MPs will not remove library books from a | b. MPs will not remove library books from a | |||
detainee’s cell except for disciplinary reasons. | detainee’s cell except for disciplinary reasons. | |||
c. If removed for disciplinary reasons, do not place | c. If removed for disciplinary reasons, do not place | |||
the book on top of the cells with other comfort items | the book on top of the cells with other comfort items | |||
removed. Place the library book on the block table | removed. Place the library book on the block table | |||
where the librarian will pick up the book during | where the librarian will pick up the book during | |||
rounds. | rounds. | |||
d. Notify the DOC of any uncollected books. | d. Notify the DOC of any uncollected books. | |||
e. If the librarian is unavailable to collect the books, | e. If the librarian is unavailable to collect the books, | |||
turn them into the DOC to prevent weather damage. | turn them into the DOC to prevent weather damage. | |||
f. Do not count library books that have an id that | ||||
start with an “I” are intelligence directed reading | ||||
material and as a library book. Coordinate with the | ||||
DOC when collecting these books. | ||||
6-14. Medical Appointments | 6-14. Medical Appointments | |||
a. If medical says that they must be at the | a. If medical says that they must be at the | |||
appointment, then the detainee cannot refuse and must | appointment, then the detainee cannot refuse and must | |||
go. | go. | |||
b. If medical says it can wait another day (minor | b. If medical says it can wait another day (minor | |||
medical issue), allow the detainee to refuse, however; | medical issue), allow the detainee to refuse, however; | |||
they will be disciplined for failure to obey. | they will be disciplined for failure to obey. | |||
Section III – Documentation and Reporting | Section III – Documentation and Reporting | |||
6-15. Block Documentation | 6-15. Block Documentation Detainee Information | |||
a. All documentation filled out on the block must be | Management System DIMS | |||
specific and complete. Reference ISNs when | a. All data entries via DIMS must be specific and | |||
discussing a cell occupied by an individual. All | complete. Reference ISNs when discussing a cell | |||
documentation needs to answer Who, What, When, | occupied by an individual. All documentation needs to | |||
Where, Why, and How. Annotate all visits by non- | answer Who, What, When, Where, Why, and How. | |||
block personnel in the block logbook. | Annotate all visits by non-block personnel in DIMS. | |||
b. Documentation that stays with the detainee | b. Documentation that stays with the detainee | |||
(1) Field File. Each detainee will have a brown | (1) Detainee ID card: The detainee’s ID contains | |||
field file that will contain the detainee’s name, ISN, | ||||
spoken language, and any cautionary medical | ||||
conditions (such as hepatitis or tuberculosis) on the | ||||
cover. The ISN will be on the tab. When an escort | ||||
team arrives on the block to make a permanent move, | ||||
the Block NCO will pull the detainee field file and the | ||||
escort team will carry the file with them to the | ||||
detainee’s new assigned location. This will insure all | ||||
detainee information will follow the detainee. Inside | ||||
the file will be the following sections: | ||||
(a) Page one: Detainee Information Sheet. The | ||||
detainee information sheet will contain a picture, vital | ||||
information about the detainee, and any detainee | ||||
specific information not covered on any of the below | ||||
forms; i.e. Likes to tell jokes. | ||||
(b) Page two: Detainee Supply Roster. A | ||||
current listing of authorized items a detainee can | ||||
possess according to the current block level. Use the | ||||
Supply Roster to inventory all detainee property. To | ||||
be used in conjunction with cell searches. It will | ||||
remain in the field folder until full, at which point, it | ||||
will be turned in to the DOC and replaced with a new | ||||
sheet. | ||||
(c) Page three: DD 508s. List all detainee | ||||
discipline on a DD 508. The PL will sign his name in | ||||
the Confinement Officer block. The JDOG S-3 will | ||||
sign as the confinement officer. Maintain the original | ||||
in the detainee’s permanent record and the copy on the | ||||
block. Return this form to the DOC upon completion | ||||
of discipline. | ||||
(d) Page four: CD-S341s and CD-S319. All | ||||
MSU blocks will utilize a CD-S341 to document the | ||||
welfare of the detainee. Guards will continuously walk | ||||
the block and document the conducted checks every 10 | ||||
minutes on CD-S341. PL and SOG will check the CD- | ||||
S341 throughout the shift. Any detainee on self-harm | ||||
watch will require the use of CD-S319. All self-harm | ||||
watch detainees will be continuously observed and | ||||
actions documented every 15 minutes. Turn in these | ||||
forms to the DOC when the discipline or self-harm | ||||
period ends. CD-S341s will stay on the block for | ||||
lesser of 30 days or until the completion of the | ||||
detainee’s time in MSU. The CD-S319 will stay on the | ||||
block for the lesser of the completion of the self-harm | ||||
watch or seven days. | ||||
(e) Page five: Detainee Refusal Tracking | ||||
Record. Used to document the time, date, current | ||||
location, and what, a detainee refused. When full, turn | ||||
into the DOC and replace it with a new sheet. | ||||
(f) Page six: Detainee Medical Request | ||||
Complaints Form. Kept in detainee field file and used | ||||
to document date, time, current location and all | ||||
detainee non-urgent medical requests. Includes a block | ||||
for medical personnel to document remarks and | ||||
date/time detainee was seen. Document all medical | ||||
refusals on this form. When full, turn into the DOC | ||||
and replace it with a new sheet. | ||||
(2) Detainee ID card: The detainee’s ID contains | ||||
the detainee’s picture, name, ISN, spoken language, | the detainee’s picture, name, ISN, spoken language, | |||
and any cautionary medical conditions. When an | and any cautionary medical conditions. When an | |||
escort team arrives to escort a detainee of any | escort team arrives to escort a detainee of any | |||
nonpermanent move, the Block NCO will pull the | nonpermanent move, the Block NCO will pull the | |||
detainee’s ID card and the escort team will carry the ID | detainee’s ID card and the escort team will carry the ID | |||
as long as they escort that detainee. While the detainee | as long as they escort that detainee. While the detainee | |||
is gone, fill the empty card slot with a business card, | is gone, fill the empty card slot with a business card, | |||
containing detainee’s ISN, departure time, and | containing detainee’s ISN, departure time, and | |||
destination of the escort team. Upon the return of the | destination of the escort team. Upon the return of the | |||
escort team, return the detainee’s ID card to the slot in | escort team, return the detainee’s ID card to the slot in | |||
the block notebook and place the business card in a | the block notebook and place the business card in a | |||
burn bag. | burn bag. | |||
c. Block Documentation that stays on the block | (2) Guard Mount Messages. Each block NCO | |||
(1) Detainee Behavioral Tracking. Every shift | at the beginning of shift will ensure that guard mount | |||
will fill out the detainee Behavioral Tracking form and | messages have been reviewed and briefed to all | |||
leave it in the block notebook for the on coming shift to | assigned block personnel. Examples of guard mount | |||
reference. Turn this form to the DOC every Sunday on | messages include but are not limited to additional | |||
swing shift. | menu items in DIMS. | |||
(2) Pass-On Book. Each block will maintain a | (a) Changes to showers and exercise start and | |||
pass-on book to provide a means to pass on | end times along with cells that were done | |||
information. Obtain new pass-on books from the DOC | (b) Detainee menu and meal start and end times | |||
and turn in completed pass-on books to the DOC. Use | (c) Giving and taking Comfort Items (IAW | |||
highlighters to mark pertinent information. Examples | Chapter 8, Camp Delta SOP) | |||
of activities include but are not limited to the | (d) Clothing and linen exchange conducted | |||
following: | (e) Which ISNs refused and accepted hair cuts | |||
(a) All detainee movements | (f) Library books received and/or returned | |||
(b) Shower/recreation start and end times | (g) When writing material such as pens and paper | |||
(c) Work orders submitted and completed | are received or returned | |||
(d) Discipline incidents | (h) All searches of detainees and cells. (i) | |||
(e) Detainee request for Chaplin, ICRC, or | Any time a detainee refuses to allow his Koran to be | |||
reservation | searched | |||
(f) Chaplin or Library visits | (j) All instances in which a detainee is required | |||
(g) Head counts | to kneel in order to allow guards to apply restraints | |||
(h) Visits by any non-block personnel such as | (k) All instances in which a detainee is missing a | |||
SOG | clothing / linen item | |||
(i) Cells that exchanged linen | (l) All visits to the block by any personnel not | |||
(j) Cells that went to shower and/or recreation | assigned to the block | |||
Do not use any of the following phrases in pass-on | (m) Any cells that are inoperable. Note the date | |||
books or block logs: | and time called in to the DOC | |||
(a) Suicide attempt | (n) Repair and Utility work orders initialized and | |||
(b) Suicide gesture | date / time work was completed on the block | |||
(c) Suicide ideation | ||||
Use the phrase “self-injurious behavior” in all | (o) Any repair work that is completed (reference | |||
documentation. | the original work order), and the date and time that the | |||
DOC is notified that the work has been completed | ||||
(p) All missing or non-serviceable equipment. | ||||
Note the date and time that this information was | ||||
reported to the SOG and DOC | ||||
(q) Supply requests. Note the date / time that the | ||||
request was submitted to the SOG. | ||||
(r) At the beginning of shift, the rank, name, and | ||||
unit of all guard personnel from the off-going shift and | ||||
those of the on-coming shift will be annotated. | ||||
(s) Annotate the rank, name, and unit of all relief | ||||
personnel, along with the times they arrive | ||||
(t) Physical security discrepancies and concerns. | ||||
(u) All detainee movement onto and off the block | ||||
(v) The conduct of a headcount | ||||
(w)An incident that requires discipline of a | ||||
detainee. | ||||
d. Documentation that is turned to Command Post | d. Documentation that is turned to Command Post | |||
(1) Repair and Utilities Work Order Request. | (1) Repair and Utilities(R&U) Work Order | |||
Request. | ||||
Used to document and request any repair work needed | Used to document and request any repair work needed | |||
on the block. Requests will be completed, logged in | on the block. Requests will be completed and logged | |||
the pass-on book, and turned in at the end of shift. Not | into DIMS. Note the short version of the ISN on any | |||
the short version of the ISN on any occupied cell that | occupied cell that requires repair. | |||
requires repair. Log any completed work order that in | (2) DA 2823. The guard who is reporting the | |||
the pass-on book and the DOC notified. | ||||
(2) DA 2823. The MP who is reporting the | ||||
incident (the one who was spit on, threatened, hit, | incident (the one who was spit on, threatened, hit, | |||
kicked, etc.) will complete a sworn statement as soon | kicked, etc.) will complete a sworn statement as soon | |||
as possible and have it sworn by the PL. If that MP is | as possible and have it sworn by the PL. If that guard | |||
not available (hospitalized, etc), the SOG will complete | is not available (hospitalized, etc), the SOG will | |||
the sworn statement and include the reason for the | complete the sworn statement and include the reason | |||
Block Guard not completing it. The SOG or PL will | for the guard not completing it. The SOG or PL will | |||
ensure the completeness and accuracy of the DA 2823 | ensure the completeness and accuracy of the DA 2823 | |||
before it is complete. See the example in Appendix D | before it is complete. See the example in the block | |||
for a properly filled out DA 2823. | training tasks binder for a properly filled out DA 2823. | |||
Block 4 of the DA 2823 will contain the date, time and | ||||
full ISN in the format of YYMMDD-HHMM-ISN. | ||||
(3) DA 4137. Complete an Evidence/Property | (3) DA 4137. Complete an Evidence/Property | |||
Custody Document to document the chain of custody | Custody Document to document the chain of custody | |||
and turn in of evidence or contraband seized at Camp | and turn in of evidence or contraband seized at Camp | |||
Delta. Turn in the DA 4137 and evidence/contraband | Delta. Turn in the DA 4137 and evidence/contraband | |||
to the MPI section. The MPI section will determine if | to the MPI section. The MPI section will determine if | |||
the items are evidence or contraband. Properly mark | the items are evidence or contraband. Properly mark | |||
all evidence and contraband before submission. | all evidence and contraband before submission. The | |||
Examples of potential evidence include but are not | block containing the MPR/CID Sequence number will | |||
limited to the following: | contain the date, time and full ISN in the format of | |||
YYMMDD-HHMM-ISN. Examples of potential | ||||
evidence include but are not limited to the following: | ||||
(a) Evidence classified as “dangerous | (a) Evidence classified as “dangerous | |||
contraband” | contraband” | |||
(b) Videotape of IRF movements or disturbances | (b) Videotape of IRF movements or disturbances | |||
(c) Evidence seized from a suicide attempt. | (c) Evidence seized from a suicide attempt. | |||
Examples of potential contraband include but are not | Examples of potential contraband include but are not | |||
limited to the following: | limited to the following: | |||
(a) Drawings | (a) Drawings | |||
(b) Modified items of linen | (b) Modified items of linen | |||
(c) Writing on cups. | (c) Writing on cups. | |||
(4) ID Band or Card Request. Used to request | (5) DIMS Significant Activities Sheet. Used to | |||
new detainee ID Bands or Cards. Noted in the pass-on | track significant activities in blocks for JDOG S-2. | |||
book and turned in to the DOC at the end of shift. | Examples of significant activities include but are not | |||
(5) Significant Activities Sheet. Used to track | limited to the following: | |||
significant activities in blocks for JDOG S-2. Turn in | ||||
to the DOC at the end of each shift. Examples of | ||||
significant activities include but are not limited to the | ||||
following: | ||||
(a) Assault. | (a) Assault. | |||
(b) Making Weapons. | (b) Making Weapons. | |||
(c) Harms Himself. | (c) Harms Himself. | |||
(d) Harassing Guard. | (d) Harassing Guard. | |||
(e) Banging Cell. | (e) Banging Cell. | |||
(f) Failure To Comply, or Anything The Guard | (f) Failure To Comply. | |||
(g) Deems to Be A Hostile Act | (g) Hostile Acts. | |||
(h) Extreme Emotion. | (h) Extreme Emotion. | |||
(i) Doing PT In Cell. | (i) Unauthorized PT In Cell. | |||
(j) Fasting. | (j) Fasting. | |||
(k) Showing Reverence To Another Detainee. | (k) Showing Reverence To Another Detainee. | |||
(l) Inciting Disturbance. | (l) Inciting Disturbance. | |||
(m) Leading Prayer/PT. | (m) Leading Prayer/PT. | |||
(n) Teaching/Preaching. | (n) Teaching/Preaching. | |||
(o) Verbal- Same Block/Cross Block. | (o) Verbal- Same Block/Cross Block. | |||
(p) Sign Language. | (p) Sign Language. | |||
(q) Passing Notes On Paper, Foam Cups, Etc. | (q) Passing Notes On Paper, Foam Cups, Etc. | |||
(r) Requests Interpreter. | (r) Requests Interpreter. | |||
(s) Requests Chaplain. | (s) Requests Chaplain. | |||
(t) Requests To See JIIF. | (t) Requests Reservation and reason why. | |||
(u) Refuses Meals. | (u) Refuses Meals and reason why. | |||
(v) Refuses Shower And Recreation Time. | (v) Refuses Shower And Exercise Time and | |||
(w)Refuses Meds. | reason why. | |||
(w)Refuses Meds and reason why. | ||||
(x) Lookouts | (x) Lookouts | |||
(y) Instigators | (y) Instigators | |||
(z) Visits by JDOG/non-JDOG personnel (VIPs, | (z) Visits by JDOG/non-JDOG personnel (VIPs, | |||
etc.) | etc.) | |||
(aa) Communication to detainees on other blocks | (aa) Communication to detainees on other blocks | |||
(bb) The above list is not all-inclusive. The guard | ||||
(bb) The above list is not all-inclusive. MP | ||||
should feel free to use his/her judgment and report | should feel free to use his/her judgment and report | |||
anything he/she feels may be of importance.. | anything he/she feels may be of importance. | |||
(6) Daily Block NCO Checklist. Used to ensure | (6) Daily Block NCO Checklist. Used to ensure | |||
each shift conducts all inspections, inventories. | each shift conducts all inspections, inventories. | |||
(7) Detainee Alpha Roster. Used to insure the | Checklists will be turned into the SOG at the end of | |||
Block NCO knows the total number of and the ISNs of | each shift. | |||
all detainees that he/she is responsible for when | (7) DIMS Detainee Alpha Roster. Used to insure | |||
assuming shift. | the Block NCO knows the total number of and the | |||
ISNs of all detainees that he/she is responsible for | ||||
when assuming shift. | ||||
d. The Block NCO checklist, will be collected by | ||||
each camp's SOG and turned in to DOC prior to | ||||
leaving. | ||||
g. After completing the work order form, the | ||||
Block NCOs will turn it in to work order box in DOC. | ||||
These will not wait until end of shift. | ||||
. SOGs and PLs are to spot check books to ensure | ||||
old paperwork has been turned in. COs will spot-check | ||||
the SOGs and PLs. The Detainee Services Branch | ||||
(DSB) will conduct periodic audits for old paperwork. | ||||
6-16. Passive Intelligence Collection | 6-16. Passive Intelligence Collection | |||
a. The MP Guard force is tasked with “passively” | a. The guard force is tasked with “passively” | |||
looking for items of intelligence value and reporting it | looking for items of intelligence value and reporting it | |||
via the Significant Activities Sheet (SIGACT). | via the Significant Activities Sheet in DIMS. | |||
b. The following is a list of pertinent information | b. The following is a list of pertinent information | |||
needed: | needed: | |||
(1) Associations between detainees. | (1) Associations between detainees. Who is the | |||
leader and who is the follower? | ||||
(2) Association with other detainees prior to | (2) Association with other detainees prior to | |||
capture. | capture. | |||
(3) Identity of formal and informal leaders of | (3) Identity of formal and informal leaders of | |||
each block. | each block. | |||
(4) Conversations that entail threats to US | (4) Conversations that entail threats to US | |||
personnel and/or assets. | personnel and/or assets. | |||
(5) Discussion or planning of terrorist activity. | (5) Discussion or planning of terrorist activity. | |||
(6) Discussion or planning of escape. | (6) Discussion or planning of escape. | |||
(7) Location of leaders in other countries. | (7) Location of leaders in other countries. | |||
(8) Information regarding all activity outside | (8) Information regarding all activity outside | |||
camp. | camp. | |||
(9) History of each detainee (things that can be | (9) History of each detainee (things that can be | |||
exploited by interrogators). | exploited by interrogators). | |||
(10) Do the detainees have access to outside | (10) Do the detainees have access to outside | |||
sources of information? What are they? | sources of information? What are they? | |||
(11) Anything else significant to the security of | (11) Destruction of property. | |||
(12) Anything else significant to the security of | ||||
US personnel/assets here or abroad. | US personnel/assets here or abroad. | |||
c. Collection efforts | c. Collection efforts | |||
(1) Do not question detainees, other than for | (1) Do not question detainees, other than for | |||
clarification of a statement. | clarification of a statement. | |||
(2) Do not initiate questioning, unless directed to | (2) Do not initiate questioning, unless directed to | |||
by CI Agent from JDOG S-2/J-2 JTF-GTMO. | by CI Agent from JDOG S-2/J-2 JTF-GTMO. | |||
(3) Listen to conversations while on the blocks | (3) Listen to conversations while on the blocks | |||
during an interpreter’s routine interpretation call. | during an interpreter’s routine interpretation call. | |||
(4) Do not show indication that you are listening | (4) Do not show indication that you are listening | |||
or watching for intelligence collection purposes. | or watching for intelligence collection purposes. | |||
(5) Make mental notes, or if the situation allows, | (5) Make mental notes, or if the situation allows, | |||
take written notes. | take written notes. | |||
(6) Do not hesitate to call for interpreters; they | (6) Do not hesitate to call for interpreters; they | |||
are there for your benefit. | are there for your benefit. | |||
(7) Fill out a Significant Activities Sheet and turn | (7) Be sure to include the ISN# and date time | |||
into the DOC or drop off at JDOG S-2 office. | ||||
(8) Be sure to include the ISN# and date time | ||||
group when noting a particular detainee’s activity. | group when noting a particular detainee’s activity. | |||
(9) As you spend more time with the detainees | (8) As you spend more time with the detainees | |||
than any other group, you are the best source of | than any other group, you are the best source of | |||
indicators on mood, leadership, group dynamics, and | indicators on mood, leadership, group dynamics, and | |||
antiterrorism/force protection information | antiterrorism/force protection information. | |||
(9) There is always significant activity occurring | ||||
on a block. There should be no DIMS SIGACT sheet | ||||
filled out with “Nothing to report”. | ||||
6-17. Cell Block Report | 6-17. Cell Block Report | |||
a. The Block NCOIC, or senior block guard when | a. The Block NCOIC, or senior guard when Block | |||
Block NCOIC is not present, will report the status of | NCOIC is not present, will report the status of the | |||
the block to the SOG, PL, CO, JDOG S3, DCJDOG, | block to the SOG, PL, CO, JDOG S3, DCJDOG, | |||
CJDOG, or CJTF when these individuals visit the | CJDOG, or CJTF when these individuals visit the | |||
block. | block. | |||
b. Required items to report are: | b. Required items to report are: | |||
(1) Block name | (1) Block name | |||
(2) Number of detainees assigned | (2) Level of the block | |||
(3) Number of detainees present and the location | (3) Number of detainees assigned | |||
(4) Number of detainees present and the location | ||||
of the detainees currently not on the block | of the detainees currently not on the block | |||
(4) Number of MPs assigned | (5) Number of guards assigned | |||
(5) Number of MPs present | (6) Number of guards present | |||
(6) Detainees with a self-harm history | (7) By ISN, detainees with a self-harm history | |||
(8) By ISN, detainees scheduled for reservation | ||||
and at what time. | ||||
(9) Training tasks for soldiers on the block for the | ||||
shift | ||||
(10) Any special problems or concerns such as | ||||
detainees on hunger strike or mass meal refusals. | ||||
c. The Block NCOIC will notify the DOC whenever | ||||
a VIP or DV visits the block. | ||||
d. The block will be called to attention whenever an | ||||
O-6 or the civilian equivalent arrives on the block. | ||||
Section IV – Block Maintenance | Section IV – Block Maintenance | |||
6-18. Inspections and Inventories | 6-18. Inspections and Inventories | |||
a. Conduct inspections upon assumption of the | a. Conduct inspections upon assumption of the | |||
block with the off-going Block NCO to verify the | block with the off-going Block NCO to verify the | |||
security of all the locks, the discipline documentation | security of all the locks, the discipline documentation | |||
and actions are correct (CI removed when designated, | and actions are correct (CI removed when designated, | |||
etc.) If the Block NCO signs for deficient equipment, | etc.) If the Block NCO signs for deficient equipment, | |||
the current Block NCO is responsible for its condition, | the current Block NCO is responsible for its condition, | |||
regardless of whether it occurred on the current shift or | regardless of whether it occurred on the current shift or | |||
a previous shift. | a previous shift. | |||
b. Conduct inventories upon assumption of the | b. Conduct inventories upon assumption of the | |||
block with the off-going Block NCO to verify all block | block with the off-going Block NCO to verify all block | |||
equipment is present and serviceable. Note all non- | equipment is present and serviceable. Note all non- | |||
serviceable equipment in the pass-on book and turned | serviceable equipment in DIMS | |||
into DOC with the off going shift. | ||||
c. The swing shift Block NCOICs on Sunday will | c. The swing shift Block NCOICs on Sunday will | |||
ensure all locks are functional during the shift. | ensure all locks are functional during the shift. | |||
6-19. Cell/Block Cleaning Wash out the block and/or | d. Each shift will conduct a block inspection | |||
individual cells using the water hose, a mop, and a mild | utilizing the checklist In DIMS follow directions on the | |||
cleaning solution every Sunday on midnight shift or as | checklist for any deficiencies found. | |||
necessary. | 6-19. Block Maintenance | |||
a. Wash out the block and/or individual cells using | ||||
the water hose, a mop, and a mild cleaning solution | ||||
every midnight shift or as necessary. | ||||
b. Each shift will be responsible for conducting its | ||||
portion of the block PMCS and security checklist. | ||||
6-20. Equipment Maintenance | 6-20. Equipment Maintenance | |||
a. Check the block equipment used by the MPs for | a. Check the block equipment used by the guards | |||
damage and inoperability during mid-shift. Turn in | for damage and inoperability during mid-shift. Turn in | |||
any broken equipment to the DOC and a submit | any broken equipment to the DOC and a submit | |||
replacement requisition. | replacement requisition. | |||
b. Midnight shift will oil and clean all block | b. Midnight shift will oil and clean all block | |||
equipment used by the MPs. | equipment used by the guards. | |||
Section V – Detainees | Section V – Detainees | |||
6-21. Detainee Standards of Conduct | 6-21. Detainee Standards of Conduct | |||
a. Military and civilian staff members will address | a. Military and civilian staff members will address | |||
detainees by the detainee’s cell number or ISN. | detainees by the detainee’s cell number or ISN. | |||
b. Detainees will obey promptly and fully all | b. Detainees will obey promptly and fully all | |||
instructions or orders given by civilian or military | instructions or orders given by civilian or military | |||
personnel. If orders conflict, obey the last order given. | personnel. If orders conflict, obey the last order given. | |||
c. All persons, places, and property are subject to | c. All persons, places, and property are subject to | |||
search or inspection at any time, by any staff member | search or inspection at any time, by any staff member | |||
in the performance of their duties. All property may be | in the performance of their duties. All property may be | |||
skipping to change at line 2582 | skipping to change at line 3147 | |||
Section V – Detainees | Section V – Detainees | |||
6-21. Detainee Standards of Conduct | 6-21. Detainee Standards of Conduct | |||
a. Military and civilian staff members will address | a. Military and civilian staff members will address | |||
detainees by the detainee’s cell number or ISN. | detainees by the detainee’s cell number or ISN. | |||
b. Detainees will obey promptly and fully all | b. Detainees will obey promptly and fully all | |||
instructions or orders given by civilian or military | instructions or orders given by civilian or military | |||
personnel. If orders conflict, obey the last order given. | personnel. If orders conflict, obey the last order given. | |||
c. All persons, places, and property are subject to | c. All persons, places, and property are subject to | |||
search or inspection at any time, by any staff member | search or inspection at any time, by any staff member | |||
in the performance of their duties. All property may be | in the performance of their duties. All property may be | |||
searched for contraband. Each detainee is responsible | searched for contraband. Each detainee is responsible | |||
for all items within their assigned cell or on their | for all items within their assigned cell or on their | |||
person. All suspicious items will be seized for | person. All suspicious items will be seized for | |||
evaluation as evidence. When a search or inspection is | evaluation as evidence. When a search or inspection is | |||
conducted of any area under the control of the US | conducted of any area under the control of the US | |||
Army, inside or outside the facility boundaries, | Army, inside or outside the facility boundaries, | |||
detainee(s) will not observe, view, stand, or pass by the | detainee(s) will not observe, view, stand, or pass by the | |||
search area. | search area. | |||
d. Detainees may only hang wet clothing and linen | ||||
items in cell windows so that they may dry. Once dry, | ||||
they must be removed. Blankets or sheets may be | ||||
temporarily hung up, no higher than half way up the | ||||
cell walls, to provide privacy while using the toilet. | ||||
Once the detainee has completed using the toilet, the | ||||
blankets and sheets must be taken down. | ||||
6-22. Detainee Identification Band | 6-22. Detainee Identification Band | |||
a. All detainees will be issued a picture | a. All detainees will be issued a picture | |||
identification Band. Identification bands are a part of | identification band. Identification bands are a part of | |||
the detainee uniform and will be worn at all times | the detainee uniform and will be worn at all times | |||
except when collected by a cadre member, for | except when collected by a cadre member, for | |||
accountability or safety reasons. | accountability or safety reasons. | |||
b. The badge will be worn attached to the left arm | b. The badge will be worn attached to the left arm | |||
so that the band remains visible. Detainees are not | so that the band remains visible. Detainees are not | |||
authorized to wear identification bands in any other | authorized to wear identification bands in any other | |||
manner. Detainees will exercise reasonable care to | manner. Detainees will exercise reasonable care to | |||
protect their band from damage, loss, and theft. | protect their band from damage, loss, and theft. | |||
c. Identification bands will not be switched, | c. Identification bands will not be switched, | |||
defaced, altered, or tampered with in any manner. If a | defaced, altered, or tampered with in any manner. If a | |||
badge is lost, stolen, or damaged, the detainee will | badge is lost, stolen, or damaged, the detainee will | |||
IMMEDIATELY report it to a staff member. Losing or | IMMEDIATELY report it to a staff member. Losing or | |||
damaging a badge will result in disciplinary action. | damaging a badge will result in disciplinary action. | |||
6-23. Uniform and Dress Rules | 6-23. Uniform and Dress Rules | |||
a. Detainee uniforms will be worn as a duty/work | . | |||
uniform, with the outer shirt worn untucked. | a. If a detainee uniform is damaged or does not fit | |||
b. The wearing of sleeves rolled up or worn down is | properly, the detainee must notify his guard | |||
not authorized. Trousers will be the proper length and | immediately. | |||
worn properly (waistband worn at the waist; not on the | b. Mutilation or unauthorized alteration of clothing | |||
hips or buttocks), rolling of the legs are not authorized, | ||||
and they will not be cuffed. If a detainee uniform is | ||||
damaged or does not fit properly, the detainee must | ||||
notify his Block Guard immediately. Display of any | ||||
items outside the uniform pockets is prohibited (e.g., | ||||
handkerchief). | ||||
c. Mutilation or unauthorized alteration of clothing | ||||
(i.e., tapering of trousers and cutting/tearing of T- | (i.e., tapering of trousers and cutting/tearing of T- | |||
shirts) or making unauthorized markings or lettering on | shirts) or making unauthorized markings or lettering on | |||
any part of the uniform is prohibited. Clothing will be | any part of the uniform is prohibited. | |||
worn in the manner for which it was designed. There | c. Detainees within camps 1,2 and 3, regardless of | |||
will be no additional creases in the uniform. | their discipline level or block assignment may remove | |||
d. At a minimum, detainees will be dressed in PT | their orange suit top while in their cell or while in | |||
shorts, orange suit top and shower shoes. | exercise. | |||
d. Detainees who are scheduled for any appointment | ||||
will be dressed in long pants, orange top and shower | ||||
shoes. | ||||
e. Headbands, decorative beads, earrings, threads, | e. Headbands, decorative beads, earrings, threads, | |||
symbols, etc. or decorative clothing, are not authorized | symbols, etc. or decorative clothing, are not authorized | |||
for wear. | for wear. | |||
f. Religious apparel, when worn, will be neat and | f. Religious apparel will be neat and conservative, | |||
conservative, approved by the CJDOG, and concealed | and concealed inside of the orange shirt at all times. | |||
inside of the orange shirt at all times. For operational or | For operational or safety reasons, the CJDOG may | |||
safety reasons, the JDOG may place reasonable limits | place reasonable limits on the wear of religious | |||
on the wear of items of religious apparel. | apparel. | |||
6-24. Personal Hygiene and Appearance | 6-24. Detainees with Prosthetics | |||
a. Detainees are required to maintain good daily | a. The medical staff is responsible for the | |||
hygiene and a clean and groomed appearance at all | following: | |||
times. Detainees will shower. The detainee will ensure | (1) Fitting detainees for prosthetic devices. | |||
that their clothing is clean, neat and in good repair. | (2) Acquiring proper footwear for detainees with | |||
b. Fingernails will be kept clean and neatly | prosthetic legs. | |||
trimmed. Fingernails will not extend past the end of the | (3) Training each amputee utilizing prosthetics. | |||
fingertips. | b. The guards are responsible for monitoring | |||
c. Detainee’s hair will be clean and neatly groomed | detainees with prosthetics for potential misuse or | |||
at all times. Extreme or fad style haircuts or hairstyles | malicious intent. | |||
are not authorized. | c. Once detainees have met the required capability | |||
d. Detainees are not allowed to color their hair. | level, the detainee will be authorized to keep his | |||
prosthetic leg(s) and/or arms in his cell. | ||||
d. Detainees will be briefed by medical personnel | ||||
on the rules for keeping his prosthetics on his person. | ||||
They will also be briefed on the actions that could | ||||
cause the limb to be taken from him. | ||||
e. Detainees with prosthetic legs will also receive | ||||
shoes for wear. All shoes will be slip-ons and no shoe | ||||
will be given to a detainee with laces. | ||||
f. Detainees with prosthetics will be given a bucket | ||||
to be used to assist in personal hygiene. | ||||
6-25. Detainees Requiring Walker and Bedside | ||||
Commodes | ||||
a. The medical staff is responsible for the | ||||
following: | ||||
(1) Insuring that detainees requiring the use of a | ||||
walker can function unassisted once given the walker | ||||
by a guard. | ||||
(2) Acquiring elevated commodes for detainees | ||||
unable to use the current toilet system. | ||||
(3) Training each detainee to be independent | ||||
within the regular cell. | ||||
b. The guards are responsible for the following: | ||||
(1) Providing walker(s) as needed by detainee | ||||
and retrieving the walker when it is not in use. | ||||
(2) Monitoring detainees with walkers and | ||||
elevated commodes, insuring the items are used | ||||
properly and not with malicious intent. | ||||
c. Each detainee will undergo training to insure that | ||||
he is capable of functioning with a walker and | ||||
unassisted by guards. If a detainee must use a walker | ||||
to get to the elevated commode, he should also be able | ||||
to dispose of the waste into the standard toilet without | ||||
assistance from the guards. If the commodes must be | ||||
confiscated or handled by a guard for any reason, the | ||||
detainee will empty the commode and guards will | ||||
retrieve it with gloves. | ||||
d. Medical personnel will brief detainees using | ||||
special accommodations on the rules for keeping an | ||||
elevated commode and using a walker in the cell. | ||||
e. Detainee hospital staff will provide training on | ||||
the use of the elevated commode. Hospital staff will | ||||
also work with detainees on moving from the bed | ||||
(rack) to the commode using the walker. | ||||
f. The detainee hospital will provide the commodes | ||||
and walkers. Guards will keep the walkers until | ||||
required by the detainee, and then give it to the | ||||
detainee. The guards will collect the walker after the | ||||
detainee is finished with its use. | ||||
6-26. Detainee comfort during inclement weather | ||||
a. During the period form 1 December thru 1 March | ||||
the MID Shift block NCO’s will ensure that all block | ||||
personnel working in camps 1, 2 and 3 place the | ||||
window flaps up at 2300 and bring them back down at | ||||
0500. | ||||
Chapter 7 | Chapter 7 | |||
Sally Port Operations | Sally Port Operations | |||
7-1. Sally Ports | 7-1. Sally Ports | |||
a. Sally Port 1. Sally Port Gate 1 is located in | a. Sally Port 1. Sally Port Gate 1 is located in | |||
Camp #1, next to main roadway and is a | Camp #1, next to main roadway and is the primary | |||
pedestrian/vehicular sally port that will be utilized as | pedestrian entrance into Camp Delta. The primary | |||
the main pedestrian entrance and exit point for Camp | mission is to keep the sally port secure and control | |||
Delta. The primary mission is to keep the sally port | movement through that area for official business only. | |||
secure and control movement through that area for | It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week, | |||
official business only. It is operational 24 hours per | face to badge identification and stripe level access | |||
day and 7 days per week. | required upon entry and exit. | |||
b. Sally Port 3. Sally Port Gate 3 is located in | b. Sally Port 3. Sally Port Gate 3 is located in | |||
Camp #1 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | Camp #1 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | |||
primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | |||
control movement to the DOC and blocks for official | control movement to the DOC and blocks for official | |||
business only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 | business only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 | |||
days per week. | days per week, face to badge identification and stripe | |||
level access required upon entry and exit. The only | ||||
exception is personnel physically escorting a detainee. | ||||
c. Sally Port 4. Sally Port Gate 4 is located in | c. Sally Port 4. Sally Port Gate 4 is located in | |||
Camp #1 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | Camp #1 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | |||
primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | |||
control movement to Camp I blocks for official | control movement to Camp 1 for official business only. | |||
business only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 | It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week. | |||
days per week. | ||||
d. Sally Port 8. Sally Port Gate 8 is located in | d. Sally Port 8. Sally Port Gate 8 is located in | |||
Camp #2, next to the main roadway and is a | Camp 2,3 next to the main roadway and is the | |||
pedestrian/vehicular sally port. When manned, the | primary/vehicular sally port. The primary mission is | |||
primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | to keep the sally port secure and control vehicular | |||
control vehicular movement into and out of Camp | movement into and out of Camp Delta. It is | |||
Delta. It is operational from 0600 – 2200 hours 7 days | operational from 0600 – 1900 hours 7 days per week, | |||
per week. | face to badge identification and stripe level access | |||
required upon entry and exit. | ||||
e. Sally Port 9. Sally Port Gate 9 is located in | e. Sally Port 9. Sally Port Gate 9 is located in | |||
Camp #2 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | Camp 2,3 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | |||
primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | |||
control movement blocks for official business only. It | control movement within blocks for official business | |||
is operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week. | only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per | |||
week, face to badge identification and stripe level | ||||
access required upon entry and exit. The only | ||||
exception is personnel physically escorting a detainee. | ||||
f. Sally Port 10. Sally Port Gate 10 is located in | f. Sally Port 10. Sally Port Gate 10 is located in | |||
Camp #2 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | Camp 2,3 and is a pedestrian/vehicular sally port. The | |||
primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | primary mission is to keep the sally port secure and | |||
control movement to Camp II blocks for official | control movement to Camp 2,3 blocks for official | |||
business only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 | business only. It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 | |||
days per week. | days per week. | |||
g. Detainee Medical Sally. The detainee Medical | g. Detainee Medical Sally. The detainee Medical | |||
Gate is located in Camp #1 and is ONLY a pedestrian | Gate is located in Camp #1 and is ONLY a pedestrian | |||
gate. The primary mission is to control movement into | gate. The primary mission is to control movement into | |||
the detainee Medical Clinic for official business only. | the detainee Medical Clinic for official business only. | |||
It is operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week. | It is operational 7 days a week during detainee sick call | |||
h. JIIF Sally. The JIIF Gate is located in Camp #1, | from 0830-1800 or during emergency conditions, and | |||
directly across from the DOC, and is ONLY a | requires face to badge identification and stripe level | |||
pedestrian gate. The primary mission is to control | access upon entry or exit. | |||
movement into the JIIF for official business only. It is | h. Roving Sally. The Roving Sallies are located in | |||
operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week. | the causeway between the blocks in camps 1,2 and 3. | |||
i. Roving Sally. The Roving Sallys are located in | They are operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per | |||
the causeway between the blocks in both camps. They | week. | |||
are operational 24 hours per day and 7 days per week. | i. A map of Camp Delta is located in Appendix F | |||
j. A map of Camp Delta is located in Appendix F | ||||
that contains the locations of the sally ports. | that contains the locations of the sally ports. | |||
j. When opening the sally port gates for food | ||||
service, contractor, supply, emergency, or military | ||||
vehicles, open both halves of the gate. | ||||
k. All sally ports are responsible for policing the | ||||
area within the sally port. | ||||
l. There is no loitering or socializing permitted in or | ||||
around the sally port. | ||||
7-2. Sally Ports 1 And 8 | 7-2. Sally Ports 1 And 8 | |||
a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 1 and 8 will have two | a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 1 and 8 will have | |||
MPs assigned to each gate, one NCOIC with one other | three guards assigned to each gate, one NCOIC with | |||
MP. | two other guards. | |||
b. Duties and Responsibilities. | b. Duties and Responsibilities. | |||
(1) NCOIC: | (1) NCOIC: | |||
(a) Ensure all assigned personnel are thoroughly | (a) Ensure all assigned personnel are thoroughly | |||
trained and familiar with all JTF-GTMO Regulations, | trained and familiar with all JTF-GTMO Regulations, | |||
SOPs, Policies, and Special Orders/Memorandums | SOPs, Policies and Memorandums concerning Sally | |||
concerning Sally Port activities. Also, oversee all of | Port activities. Also, oversee all of that sally port’s | |||
that sally port’s operations. | operations. | |||
(b) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | (b) Directly responsible to SOG 3 for the | |||
operation of the sally port gate including daily | operation of the sally port gate including daily | |||
functional management of the gates and overall | functional management of the gates and overall | |||
responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | |||
gate. | gate. | |||
(c) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | (c) Keep SOG 3 and PL briefed on events. | |||
(d) Review the pass-on book from the last two | (d) Review DIMS from the last two weeks, and | |||
weeks, and be knowledgeable of all scheduled events | be knowledgeable of all scheduled events (i.e. VIPs, | |||
(i.e. VIPs, chow truck traffic, contractors, | chow truck traffic, contractors, supply/laundry | |||
supply/laundry vehicles, land-bridge missions, etc.). | vehicles, land-bridge missions, etc.). | |||
(e) Supervise pedestrian/vehicle searches. | (e) Supervise pedestrian/vehicle searches. | |||
(f) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | (f) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | |||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | |||
(g) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed into the | (g) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed into the | |||
Sally Port at a time, entering or exiting. | Sally Port at a time, entering or exiting. | |||
c. Special Instructions. | c. Special Instructions. | |||
(1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | (1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | |||
given time during operations unless authorized by the | given time during operations unless authorized by the | |||
CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | |||
opened for vehicles responding to emergency that are | opened for vehicles responding to emergency that are | |||
too long to enter the sally port in the normal manner | too long to enter the sally port in the normal manner | |||
(i.e. fire truck). | (i.e. fire truck). | |||
(2) Sally port personnel will notify the PL and/or | (2) Sally port personnel will notify the PL, DOC | |||
CO of DV/VIP visits. | and CO of DV/VIP visits. Use the following call signs | |||
for the following VIPs: | ||||
(a) Zulu 3 – any DV/VIP not listed here | ||||
(b) Zulu 2 – CJTF-GTMO | ||||
(c) Zulu 1 – DCJTF-GTMO | ||||
(d) Zulu Bravo – CJDOG | ||||
(e) Zulu – DCJDOG. | ||||
e. For all personnel and/or equipment that require | e. For all personnel and/or equipment that require | |||
an escort, log the escort request time the escort and the | an escort, log the escort request time the escort and the | |||
time the escort arrived. | time the escort arrived. | |||
f. Pedestrian entry/exit. | f. Pedestrian entry/exit. | |||
(1) Sally port personnel will: | (1) Sally port personnel will: | |||
(a) Keep the road in front of Sally Port #1 and | (a) Keep the road in front of Sally Port #1 and | |||
#8 clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and large | #8 clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and large | |||
groups of people. | groups of people. | |||
(b) Require identification from all personnel | (b) Require identification and stripe level access | |||
attempting to pass through to verify eligibility to pass | from all personnel attempting to pass through.. | |||
through the sally port. | (c) Require Courier Orders for all personnel | |||
(c) Maintain a visitor’s logbook. Positively | carrying a lock bag, containing classified materials. | |||
identify all visitors, including escorted visitors; and | (d) Maintain a visitor’s logbook and visitor badge | |||
enter into the logbook. The logbook will contain the | inventories. Positively identify all visitors, including | |||
following information: Name, Rank of visitor, | escorted visitors; and enter into the logbook. The | |||
Organization, Escort Name, Rank and Organization, | logbook will contain the following information: Name, | |||
Date/Time In, Date/Time Out. | rank of visitor, organization, escort team, rank and | |||
(d) Conduct a hands-on badge check of all | organization, date and time in, date and time out. | |||
pedestrians entering or exiting the sally port. Deny | (e) Conduct a face to badge check and stripe | |||
access to Camp Delta if badges are expired or not | level access of all pedestrians to include TCN’s | |||
entering or exiting the sally port. Deny access to Camp | ||||
physically present. Reference the badge identification | Delta if badges are expired or not physically present. | |||
sheets in Appendix E to recognize the access level for | Reference the badge identification sheets in Appendix | |||
each individual entering the facility. Call for | E to recognize the access level for each individual | |||
appropriate escorts via Escort Control. | entering the facility. Call for appropriate escorts via | |||
(e) Check all bags entering/exiting the sally port | Escort Control. | |||
(f) Check all bags entering/exiting the sally port | ||||
gate. Ensure all government property has a property | gate. Ensure all government property has a property | |||
pass signed by appropriate personnel prior to exiting | pass signed by appropriate personnel prior to exiting | |||
the facility. Ensure the authorization for the entry of | the facility. Ensure the authorization for the entry of | |||
any device capable of recording/relaying information. | any device capable of recording/relaying information. | |||
Refer to the most updated access roster (i.e. PC | Refer to the most updated access roster (i.e. PC | |||
notebook, cell phone). To request an updated access | notebook, pagers, cell phone or PDA’s). To request an | |||
roster or clarification of authorization, call the DOC. | updated access roster or clarification of authorization, | |||
For an unauthorized item, complete a DA 4137 Chain | call the DOC. For an unauthorized item, complete a | |||
of Custody each item confiscated and kept at the sally | DA 4137 Chain of Custody each item confiscated and | |||
port until the property is claimed upon exiting the | kept at the sally port until the property is claimed upon | |||
facility. | exiting the facility. All classified document pouches | |||
(f) The PL will identify a random number of | will be checked by feeling the bag for prohibited items. | |||
searches at the beginning of each shift. Randomly | If something suspicious is found, request that the | |||
search the person identified by this number as they | individual remove the item from the pouch for | |||
enter the Camp Delta. If the number is 20, then search | inspection. | |||
every 20th | (g) The on-duty CO will identify a random | |||
person through the sally port. This search | number of searches at the beginning of each shift. | |||
will be a pat down search or a hand scanner search. | Randomly search the person identified by this number | |||
The search will be for items prohibited in the camp. | as they enter and exit Camp Delta. If the number is 20, | |||
This is in addition to the mandatory check of all bags | then search every 20th | |||
and carried items. | person through the sally port. | |||
g. There will be a new placard system put in place | This search will be a pat down search or a hand scanner | |||
to ensure efficiency of movement through the sally port | search. The search will be for items prohibited in the | |||
and offset confusion for vehicle access. The placards | camp. This is in addition to the mandatory check of all | |||
will come in four colors, each denoting access, as well | bags and carried items. | |||
as identification and search procedures. The four | (h) Ensure all personnel leaving the facility | |||
categories will be as follows: | remove the tape covering their nametapes. | |||
(1) Green: Use this color to denote military | (i) Sally Port 1. This post is located in Camp I, | |||
vehicles and those used to transport military personnel. | next to the main roadway and is a pedestrian/vehicular | |||
A soldier wearing the military Class A-C duty uniform | Sally Port 1 is the main entrance and exit point for | |||
will drive vehicles with this placard. Proof of | Camp Delta. The primary mission is to keep the sally | |||
identification in the form of the JTF-GTMO | port secure and control movement through that area for | |||
identification card will be the only access media | ||||
required for entry. No escort is required with this | ||||
vehicle. Allow vehicles with this placard access | ||||
through either Sally Port 1 or Sally Port 8. Consider all | ||||
emergency vehicles in this category. Base Security | ||||
will still have to secure their weapons in the pistol | ||||
lockboxes in SP 1. | ||||
(2) Yellow: Use this color to denote non-tactical | ||||
government vehicles used on a regular basis in and out | ||||
of Camp Delta. Examples of these vehicles will be | ||||
chow vehicles as well as Supply/R&U vehicles. JTF- | ||||
GTMO identification as well as a cursory vehicle | ||||
search will be required for all vehicles with this placard | ||||
each time the vehicle enters the Sally Port. No escort | ||||
is required with this vehicle. Allow vehicles with this | ||||
placard access to Camp Delta through Sally Port 8. | ||||
(3) Purple: Use this color to denote contractor | ||||
vehicles. Examples of these vehicles are Kvaerner, | ||||
Brown and Root etc. A systematic search of these | ||||
vehicles is required, encompassing both the underside | ||||
and interior of the vehicle. An escort is required for | ||||
these vehicles before allowing access to Camp Delta. | ||||
Access to Camp Delta will be through Sally Port 8 for | ||||
vehicles with this placard. | ||||
(4) White: This is a temporary placard and will | ||||
have a DTG written on the placard. These placards are | ||||
valid for no longer than 8 hours. The DOC will | ||||
approve any issuance of a temporary placard. Only | ||||
Sally Port 8 will issue temporary placards. A | ||||
systematic search is required, encompassing both the | ||||
underside and interior of the vehicle. An escort is | ||||
required for these vehicles before allowing access to | ||||
Camp Delta. The escorts will ensure that the vehicle is | ||||
out of the camp before the DTG expires on the placard. | ||||
Access to Camp Delta will be through Sally Port 8 for | ||||
vehicles with this placard. | ||||
(5) The DOC will issue all placards except white | ||||
ones. To receive a placard, the OIC of the organization | ||||
requesting a placard will send to the JDOG S-3 a | ||||
memorandum from for approval. The memorandum | ||||
must contain organization, type of vehicle, license plate | ||||
number for civilian vehicles, bumper number for | ||||
military vehicles, and reason for access. | ||||
(6) Placards will be valid for 90 days from date | ||||
of issue. Turn in the expired placard to the DOC | ||||
before issuing a new placard unless it is an initial issue. | ||||
(7) When discovered, report lost placards to the | ||||
JDOG S-3. Send a new request memorandum to the | ||||
JDOG S-3 for approval. | ||||
(8) A red front license plate with a star on it | ||||
denoting a General Officer’s vehicle will be the | ||||
equivalent of a green placard. This access will not | ||||
expire at any time. | ||||
h. Sally Port 1. This post is located in Camp I, next | ||||
to the main roadway and is a pedestrian/vehicular Sally | ||||
Port 1 is the main entrance and exit point for Camp | ||||
Delta. The primary mission is to keep the sally port | ||||
secure and control movement through that area for | ||||
official business only. This post will be manned 24/7. | official business only. This post will be manned 24/7. | |||
(1) The only vehicles allowed past Sally Port 1 | (1) The only vehicles allowed past Sally Port 1 | |||
are those that have a requirement to be inside the camp. | are those that have a requirement and deemed mission | |||
These vehicles will have a green placard. Do not allow | related. The only exceptions will be emergency | |||
vehicles with any other color placard access through | ||||
Sally Port 1. The only exceptions will be emergency | ||||
vehicles (fire, ambulance, police), those transporting | vehicles (fire, ambulance, police), those transporting | |||
VIP (JDOG and higher), and mission specific. Shift | VIP (JDOG and higher), and mission specific or if | |||
Change vehicles will park across the street on the | Sally Port 8 is closed for repairs or an accident. Shift | |||
shoulder, offset from the entrance for loading and | change vehicles may stop and wait along the bus | |||
offloading of personnel, ensuring that the roadway is | turnaround road in front of Sally Port 1. The driver | |||
not blocked. Being a military or government vehicle in | must stay with the vehicle. No vehicle will be left | |||
itself is not a sufficient reason for access into the camp. | unattended on the concrete pad across from sally port 1 | |||
(2) The sentry will keep the road in front of the | or anywhere on the bus turn around area. Report any | |||
violators to the DOC. Being a military or government | ||||
vehicle in itself is not a sufficient reason for access into | ||||
the camp. | ||||
(2) The guard will keep the road in front of the | ||||
sally port clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and | sally port clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and | |||
large groups of people. The sally port sentry will | large groups of people. The sally port guard will | |||
require identification from all personnel attempting to | require face to badge identification and stripe level | |||
gain access to Camp Delta. Sally Port 1 will maintain | access from all personnel attempting to gain access to | |||
Camp Delta. Sally Port 1 will maintain a visitor’s | ||||
a visitor’s logbook. All visitors, including escorted | logbook. All visitors, including escorted visitors; will | |||
visitors; will be positively identified and entered into | be positively identified and entered into the logbook. | |||
the logbook. The logbook will contain the following | The logbook will contain the following information: | |||
information: Name, rank, organization, escort name | Name, rank, organization, escort name and rank, DTG | |||
and rank, DTG in, DTG out, and ID of Block Guard | in, DTG out, and ID of guard entering data. All | |||
entering data. All pedestrian personnel will enter | pedestrian personnel will enter Camp Delta through | |||
Camp Delta through this sally port. | this sally port. No vehicle may be left unattended on | |||
the concrete pad across from Sally Port 1 or anywhere | ||||
on the bus turn around area. Report any violators to | ||||
the DOC. | ||||
(3) Sally Port 1 personnel will contact the DOC | (3) Sally Port 1 personnel will contact the DOC | |||
or SOG if they have questions about Sally Port 1 | or SOG 3 if they have questions about Sally Port 1 | |||
operations. | operations. | |||
(4) The PL will identify a random number of | (4) The on-duty CO will identify a random | |||
persons to be searched at the beginning of each shift. | number of persons to be searched at the beginning of | |||
each shift. | ||||
(5) Contraband IAW Camp Delta SOP will be | (5) Contraband IAW Camp Delta SOP will be | |||
cross-referenced against the access roster for Camp | cross-referenced against the access roster for Camp | |||
Delta. Once checked items still classified as | Delta. Checked items still classified, as contraband | |||
contraband will be stored in the bins located in Sally | will be returned to the individuals vehicle, or place of | |||
Port 1. A chain of custody sheet will be completed | residence. If the entering individual does not have | |||
before MP retains positive control of the item. | access to a vehicle the contraband will be stored in the | |||
Contraband items will be returned upon the visitors | bins located in Sally Port 1. A chain of custody sheet | |||
exit from Camp Delta. The chain of custody sheet will | will be completed before the guard retains positive | |||
be maintained in the custody binder for two months. | control of the item. Contraband items will be returned | |||
upon the visitors exit from Camp Delta. The chain of | ||||
custody sheet will be maintained in the custody binder | ||||
for two months. | ||||
(6) Escort control will provide escorts for | (6) Escort control will provide escorts for | |||
individuals requiring access to Camp Delta who must | individuals requiring access to Camp Delta who must | |||
be escorted. The only exception to this is individuals | be escorted. The only exception to this is individuals | |||
who are traveling with personnel that have unescorted | who are traveling with personnel that have unescorted | |||
access badges will be allowed to sign in and be | access badges will be allowed to sign in and be | |||
escorted by those they are traveling with (if an | escorted by those they are traveling with (if an | |||
interpreter has an escort only badge and is traveling | interpreter has an escort only badge and is traveling | |||
with FBI personnel that have unescorted access; the | with FBI personnel that have unescorted access; the | |||
interpreter will be escorted by the personnel that have | interpreter will be escorted by the personnel that have | |||
unescorted access badges). | unescorted access badges). | |||
(7) All personnel will have access badges | (7) All personnel will have access badges | |||
checked upon entering and exiting Camp Delta. | checked upon entering and exiting Camp Delta. | |||
i. Sally Port 8. This post is located in Camp II, | (8) There will be no loitering or socializing | |||
next to the main roadway and is strictly a vehicular | permitted in or around the sally port. | |||
entrance and exit point. Sally Port 8 is the main | (9) Ensure all personnel leaving Camp Delta | |||
entrance and exit point for contractor and supply | remove the tape from their nametape. | |||
vehicles. The primary mission is to keep the sally port | i. Sally Port 8. This post is located in Camp 2,3, | |||
secure and control movement through that area for | next to the main roadway and is primarily a vehicular, | |||
official business only. This post will be manned from | and contractor entrance and exit point. Sally Port 8 is | |||
0600-2000 seven days a week. This is the only post | the main entrance and exit point for contractor and | |||
where temporary placards will be issued and collected. | supply vehicles. The only vehicles allowed past Sally | |||
(1) The only vehicles allowed access through this | Port 8 are those that have a requirement and deemed | |||
sally port are those with yellow, purple, and temporary | mission related. The primary mission is to keep the | |||
placards. VIPs and emergency vehicles will be | sally port secure and control movement through that | |||
allowed unimpeded access through the sally port after | area for official business only. This post will be | |||
checking for proper access media. | manned from 0600-1900 seven days a week. | |||
(2) The search of the chow vehicle will be a | (1) The search of the chow vehicle will be a quick | |||
quick search of the underside and interior of the | search of the underside and interior of the vehicle. At | |||
vehicle. At no time will the food containers be opened | no time will the food containers be opened and | |||
and searched. All other vehicles will be searched IAW | searched. All other vehicles will be searched IAW | |||
SOP. Refer to paragraphs 7-2.g and 7-2.j. | SOP. Refer to paragraphs 7-2.g and 7-2.j. | |||
(3) Pedestrians will not be allowed access | (2) Pedestrians will not be allowed access | |||
through this sally port. The only exceptions are | through this sally port. The only exceptions are | |||
escorted contractors. | escorted contractors. | |||
(4) All personnel will have access media checked | (3 All personnel will have access media checked | |||
prior to entering and exiting the sally port. All escorted | prior to entering and exiting the sally port. All escorted | |||
badge holders will be searched prior to entering and | badge holders will be searched prior to entering and | |||
exiting Camp Delta. This search will be conducted | exiting Camp Delta. This search will be conducted | |||
using either the hand held metal detector or a pat down | using either the hand held metal detector or a pat down | |||
search. Any contraband found will be returned to the | search. Any contraband found will be returned to the | |||
person and the person will not be allowed access | person and the person will not be allowed access | |||
through Sally Port 8. Personnel with contraband will | through Sally Port 8. Personnel with contraband will | |||
be directed to enter Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | be directed to enter Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | |||
(4) Guards will ascertain the following | ||||
information upon the arrival of vendors and | ||||
contractors: | ||||
(a) Name of individuals in the vehicle | ||||
(b) Company | ||||
(c) Nature of business | ||||
(d) Description of the vehicle and the license | ||||
plate number | ||||
(e) Contents of any freight | ||||
(f) Time of arrival | ||||
(5) Sally Port 8 will contact the DOC for escorts. | (5) Sally Port 8 will contact the DOC for escorts. | |||
Personnel requiring escort will not be allowed access to | Personnel requiring escort will not be allowed access to | |||
Camp Delta until escort arrives. | Camp Delta until escort arrives. | |||
(6) Sally Port 8 will contact DOC or the SOG 2 if | (6) Sally Port 8 will contact DOC or the SOG 2 if | |||
they have questions about Sally Port 8 operations. | they have questions about Sally Port 8 operations. | |||
(7) In the event that Sally Port 8 is closed for | ||||
repairs or due to damage, Sally Port 8 will notify Sally | ||||
Port 1 that they can no longer accept vehicles. Once | ||||
the sally port is put back into operation, Sally Port 8 | ||||
will notify Sally Port 1 that they are back in operation. | ||||
(8) Upon the departure of the vendor or | ||||
contractor, the | ||||
j. Inspections will be conducted upon entry and exit | j. Inspections will be conducted upon entry and exit | |||
of all vehicles as required by placard. Sally port sentry | of all vehicles as required by placard. Sally port | |||
will: | personnel will: | |||
(1) Gain a positive identification of the driver and | (1) Gain a positive identification of the driver and | |||
any passengers prior to opening the gate. | any passengers prior to opening the gate. | |||
(2) Open exterior gate and allow vehicle to enter | (2) Open exterior gate and allow vehicle to enter | |||
the sally port. | the sally port. | |||
(3) Instruct driver to place the vehicle in park, | (3) Instruct driver to place the vehicle in park, | |||
engage the emergency brake, stop engine, and exit the | engage the emergency brake, stop engine, and exit the | |||
vehicle (including passengers). Collect identification | vehicle (including passengers). Collect identification | |||
badge(s). Upon exiting, the MP will instruct the driver | badge(s). Upon exiting, the guard will instruct the | |||
to open all doors, hood, trunk, and tailgate, or any other | driver to open all doors, hood, trunk, and tailgate, or | |||
compartment(s) to be searched. | any other compartment(s) to be searched. | |||
(4) Log vehicle information to include time-in, | (4) Log vehicle information to include time-in, | |||
tag number, driver’s name, organization, destination, | tag number, driver’s name, organization, destination, | |||
and purpose of visit. | and purpose of visit. | |||
(5) MPs will systematically search the vehicle by | (5) MPs will systematically search the vehicle by | |||
examining the interior, exterior, top, underneath hoods, | examining the interior, exterior, top, underneath hoods, | |||
in trunks, and the undercarriage. Search the vehicle | in trunks, and the undercarriage. Search the vehicle | |||
using the following pattern: | using the following pattern: | |||
(a) Behind and under the seats | (a) Behind and under the seats | |||
(b) Under the dashboard | (b) Under the dashboard | |||
(c) Glove and tool compartments | (c) Glove and tool compartments | |||
skipping to change at line 2998 | skipping to change at line 3607 | |||
and items not needed for the incoming personnel to | and items not needed for the incoming personnel to | |||
conduct their business within the facility. If an item is | conduct their business within the facility. If an item is | |||
not authorized or unnecessary, a DA 4137 chain of | not authorized or unnecessary, a DA 4137 chain of | |||
custody will be done for each item confiscated and kept | custody will be done for each item confiscated and kept | |||
at the sally port until the property is claimed upon | at the sally port until the property is claimed upon | |||
exiting the facility. Tools and loose equipment | exiting the facility. Tools and loose equipment | |||
entering the facility in a vehicle must be accounted for | entering the facility in a vehicle must be accounted for | |||
upon exiting. RESOLVE ALL DISCREPANCIES | upon exiting. RESOLVE ALL DISCREPANCIES | |||
BEFORE ALLOWING THE VEHICLE TO EXIT. | BEFORE ALLOWING THE VEHICLE TO EXIT. | |||
When in doubt, call for the SOG, PL, or DOC. | When in doubt, call for the SOG, PL, or DOC. | |||
(7) Upon completion of the vehicle search, the | (7) Upon completion of the vehicle search, the | |||
driver and passenger(s) will re-enter the vehicle. An | driver and passenger(s) will re-enter the vehicle. A | |||
MP will open interior sally port gate and allow vehicle | guard will open interior sally port gate and allow | |||
to access Camp Delta. | vehicle to access Camp Delta. Sally port personnel | |||
will be ensure vehicle operators wear seatbelts and | ||||
adhere to the 5 MPH camp speed limit. | ||||
k. Emergencies will take priority over all other | k. Emergencies will take priority over all other | |||
ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | |||
the sally port guards to stop all traffic though the sally | the sally port guards to stop all traffic though the sally | |||
port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
l. Emergency Vehicles. | l. Emergency Vehicles. | |||
(1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | (1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | |||
such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | |||
brought to the attention of DOC immediately via radio | brought to the attention of DOC immediately via land | |||
or runner. | line or saber radio. | |||
(2) Emergency vehicles will be logged in and out. | (2) Emergency vehicles will be logged in and out. | |||
(3) Vehicles responding to an emergency within | (3) Vehicles responding to an emergency within | |||
Camp Delta will be expeditiously searched upon | Camp Delta will be expeditiously searched upon | |||
entering and exiting the facility. In an expeditious | entering and exiting the facility. In an expeditious | |||
search, guards will quickly verify identification badges | search, guards will quickly verify identification badges | |||
of emergency personnel and allow them to pass | of emergency personnel and allow them to pass | |||
through the Sally Port. They will verify same number | through the Sally Port. They will verify same number | |||
of personnel exiting that came in with the vehicle and | of personnel exiting that came in with the vehicle and | |||
that no additional personnel leave with it. Detainee | that no additional personnel leave with it. Detainee | |||
patients leaving in an ambulance for NAVBASE | patients leaving in an ambulance for NAVBASE | |||
Hospital will be accounted for and verified through | Hospital will be accounted for and verified through | |||
DOC after the ambulance has been allowed to leave. | DOC after the ambulance has been allowed to leave. | |||
Ambulances transporting detainees in and out of Camp | Ambulances transporting detainees in and out of Camp | |||
Delta will not be searched. It is the responsibility of | Delta will not be searched. It is the responsibility of | |||
the MP medical escort teams to conduct searches of the | the medical escort teams to conduct searches of the | |||
ambulances. In cases where there is no MP escort team | ambulances. In cases where there is no escort team | |||
present in the ambulance, sally port guards will search | present in the ambulance, sally port guards will search | |||
the ambulance upon entering or exiting Camp Delta. | the ambulance upon entering or exiting Camp Delta. | |||
Necessary medical treatment instruments will not be | Necessary medical treatment instruments will not be | |||
seized or delay the ambulance’s entry or exit through a | seized or delay the ambulance’s entry or exit through a | |||
sally port. | sally port. | |||
(4) Vehicles responding to an emergency in will | (4) Vehicles responding to an emergency in will | |||
enter Camp Delta through Sally Port 8 and exit Camp | enter Camp Delta through Sally Port 8 and exit Camp | |||
Delta through Sally Port 1. | Delta through Sally Port 1. | |||
(5) In the event that large emergency vehicles | (5) In the event that large emergency vehicles | |||
must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | |||
interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | |||
and exit. | and exit. | |||
(a) When entering, guards will expeditiously | (a) When entering, guards will expeditiously | |||
verify identification badges of emergency personnel | verify identification badges of emergency personnel | |||
and allow them to pass through the sally port. Upon | and allow them to pass through the sally port. Upon | |||
exiting, the vehicle will be searched prior to entering | exiting, the vehicle will be searched prior to entering | |||
the sally port with the exception of escorted | the sally port with the exception of escorted | |||
ambulances. Sentries will verify same number of | ambulances. Guards will verify same number of | |||
personnel exiting that came in with the vehicle and that | personnel exiting that came in with the vehicle and that | |||
no additional personnel leave with it. RESOLVE ALL | no additional personnel leave with it. RESOLVE ALL | |||
DISCREPANCIES BEFORE ALLOWING THE | DISCREPANCIES BEFORE ALLOWING THE | |||
VEHICLE TO EXIT. After search, both gates will | VEHICLE TO EXIT. After search, both gates will be | |||
again be opened to allow the vehicle to exit. | opened to allow the vehicle to exit. | |||
m.Land Bridge missions will take priority over all | m.Detainee Movement Operation (DMO) missions | |||
other ongoing sally port operations except | will take priority over all other ongoing sally port | |||
emergencies. It is the responsibility of the sally port | operations except emergencies. It is the responsibility | |||
guards to stop all traffic though the sally port that will | of the sally port guards to stop all traffic though the | |||
hinder the entry/exit of Land Bridge vehicles. | sally port that will hinder the entry/exit of DMO | |||
n. Upon receipt of a Land Bridge mission, all | vehicles. | |||
direction will be taken from JDOG personnel and the | n. Upon receipt of a DMO mission, all direction | |||
CO. An ETA will be provided to Sally Port 1 as the | will be taken from JDOG personnel and the CO. An | |||
Land Bridge vehicles are enroute to Camp Delta. | ETA will be provided to Sally Port 1, as the DMO | |||
vehicles are enroute to Camp Delta. | ||||
7-3. Sally Ports 3 And 9 | 7-3. Sally Ports 3 And 9 | |||
a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 3 and 9 will have one | a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 3 and 9 will have one | |||
soldier assigned to each gate. Any soldier attached to | soldier assigned to each gate. | |||
JTF-GTMO with a secret security clearance may work | b. . Duties and responsibilities. One soldier | |||
the gate. | assigned will: | |||
b. Duties and responsibilities. One soldier assigned | ||||
will: | ||||
(1) Be directly responsible to the SOG for the | (1) Be directly responsible to the SOG for the | |||
operation of the sally port gate including daily | operation of the sally port gate including daily | |||
functional management of the gates and overall | functional management of the gates and overall | |||
responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | |||
gate. | gate. | |||
(2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | (2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | |||
(3) Conduct hands on ID check of all personnel | (3) Conduct face to badge identification and | |||
entering. | stripe level access check of all personnel entering. The | |||
only exception to this is personnel physically escorting | ||||
a detainee. | ||||
(4) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | (4) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | |||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | |||
(5) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed to enter or | (5) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed to enter or | |||
exit the Sally Port at a time. | exit the Sally Port at a time. | |||
c. Special Instructions. | c. Special Instructions. | |||
(1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | (1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | |||
given time during operations unless authorized by the | given time during operations unless authorized by the | |||
CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | |||
opened for vehicles responding to emergency that are | opened for vehicles responding to emergency that are | |||
too long to enter the sally port in the normal manner | too long to enter the sally port in the normal manner | |||
(i.e. fire truck). | (i.e. fire truck). | |||
(2) Sally port personnel will notify the PL and/or | (2) Sally port personnel will notify the DOC of | |||
CO of DV/VIP visits. | DV/VIP visits. | |||
d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | |||
(1) Keep the alleyway in front of the sally port | (1) Keep the alleyway in front of the sally port | |||
clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups | clear of unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups | |||
of people. | of people. | |||
(2) Require identification from all personnel | (2) Require identification and stripe level access | |||
attempting to pass through to verify eligibility to pass | from all personnel attempting to pass through to verify | |||
through the sally port. | eligibility. | |||
(3) Conduct a hands-on badge check of all | (3) Conduct a hands-on badge check of all | |||
pedestrians entering the sally port. Access to Camp | pedestrians entering the sally port. Access to Camp | |||
Delta is denied if badges are expired or not physically | Delta is denied if badges are expired or not physically | |||
present ensuring that personnel requiring escorts enter | present ensuring that personnel requiring escorts enter | |||
with the escort(s). Reference the badge identification | with the escort(s). Reference the badge identification | |||
sheet to recognize the access level for each individual | sheet to recognize the access level for each individual | |||
entering the facility. | entering the facility. | |||
e. Vehicle entry/exit. All vehicles may enter and | e. Vehicle entry/exit. All vehicles may enter and | |||
exit Camp I and block areas through Sally Ports 3 and | exit Camp 1 and block areas through Sally Ports 3 and | |||
This includes and is not limited to the following: | 9. This includes and is not limited to the following: | |||
(1) Contractor | (1) Contractor | |||
(2) Food service | (2) Food service | |||
(3) Gators and golf carts | (3) Gators | |||
(4) Emergency | (4) Emergency | |||
(5) Fuel | (5) Fuel | |||
(6) Garbage | (6) Garbage | |||
f. Emergencies will take priority over all other | f. Emergencies will take priority over all other | |||
ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | |||
the sally port sentry to stop all traffic though the sally | the sally port sentry to stop all traffic though the sally | |||
port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
g. Emergency Vehicles. | g. Emergency Vehicles. | |||
(1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | (1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | |||
such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | |||
brought to the attention of the DOC immediately via | brought to the attention of the DOC immediately via | |||
radio or runner. | radio or runner. | |||
(2) In the event that large emergency vehicles | (2) In the event that large emergency vehicles | |||
must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | |||
interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | |||
and exit. | and exit. | |||
7-4. Sally Ports 4 And 10 | 7-4. Sally Ports 4 And 10 | |||
a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 4 and 10 will have | a. Manning. Sally Port Gates 4 and 10 will have | |||
one soldier assigned to each gate. Any soldier attached | one soldier assigned to each gate. | |||
to the JTF-GTMO with a secret security clearance may | b. Duties and responsibilities. One soldier | |||
work the gate. | assigned will: | |||
b. Duties and responsibilities. One soldier assigned | ||||
will: | ||||
(1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | (1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | |||
operation of the sally port gate including daily | operation of the sally port gate including daily | |||
functional management of the gates and overall | functional management of the gates and overall | |||
responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | responsibility for their respective Camp Delta sally port | |||
gate. | gate. | |||
(2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | (2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | |||
(3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | (3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | |||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | |||
(4) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed into the | (4) Ensure only one vehicle is allowed into the | |||
sally port at a time, entering or exiting. | sally port at a time, entering or exiting. | |||
(5) Sally Port 4 will be responsible for opening | ||||
and closing the sally port gate to the Brown and | ||||
Yellow buildings. Sally Port 10 will be responsible for | ||||
opening and closing the sally port gate to Gold | ||||
building. | ||||
c. Special Instructions. | c. Special Instructions. | |||
(1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | (1) Only one sally port gate will be open at any | |||
given time during operations unless authorized by the | given time during operations unless authorized by the | |||
CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | CO or JDOG with one exception; both gates will be | |||
opened for vehicles responding to emergency or are too | opened for vehicles responding to emergency or are too | |||
long to enter the sally port in the normal manner (i.e. | long to enter the sally port in the normal manner (i.e. | |||
fire truck, chow truck). | fire truck, chow truck). | |||
(2) Sally port personnel will notify the PL and/or | (2) Sally port personnel will notify the DOC | |||
CO of DV/VIP visits. | DV/VIP visits. | |||
d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will keep | d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will keep | |||
the alleyway in front of the sally port clear of | the alleyway in front of the sally port clear of | |||
unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | |||
people. | people. | |||
e. Vehicle entry/exit. All vehicles may enter and | e. Vehicle entry/exit. All vehicles may enter and | |||
exit Camp I and Camp II block areas through Sally | exit block areas through Sally Ports 4 and 10. This | |||
Ports 4 and 10. This includes and IS limited to the | includes and is limited to the following: | |||
following: | ||||
(1) Contractor | (1) Contractor | |||
(2) Food service | (2) Food service | |||
(3) Gators and golf carts | (3) Gators | |||
(4) Emergency | (4) Emergency | |||
(5) Fuel | (5) Fuel | |||
(6) Garbage | (6) Garbage | |||
f. Emergencies will take priority over all other | f. Emergencies will take priority over all other | |||
ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | ongoing sally port operations. It is the responsibility of | |||
the sally port sentry to stop all traffic though the sally | the sally port sentry to stop all traffic though the sally | |||
port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | port that will hinder the entry/exit of emergency | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
g. Emergency Vehicles. | g. Emergency Vehicles. | |||
(1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | (1) The entry and exit of emergency vehicles | |||
such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | such as Base Security, fire trucks, ambulance will be | |||
brought to the attention of the DOC immediately via | brought to the attention of the DOC immediately via | |||
radio or runner. | radio or runner. | |||
(2) In the event that large emergency vehicles | (2) In the event that large emergency vehicles | |||
must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | must pass through the sally port (i.e. fire truck), both | |||
interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | interior and exterior gates will be opened to allow entry | |||
and exit. | and exit. | |||
7-5. Detainee Medical Clinic Gate | 7-5. Detainee Medical Clinic Gate | |||
a. Manning. The detainee Medical Gate will have | a. Manning. The detainee Medical Gate will have | |||
one soldier assigned. Any soldier attached to JTF- | one soldier assigned. | |||
GTMO with a secret security clearance may work the | b. Duties and responsibilities. One Soldier | |||
gate. | assigned will: | |||
b. Duties and responsibilities. One Soldier assigned | ||||
will: | ||||
(1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | (1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | |||
operation of the gate including daily functional | operation of the gate including daily functional | |||
management of the gate and overall responsibility. | management of the gate and overall responsibility. | |||
(2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | (2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | |||
(3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | (3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | |||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | |||
c. Special Instructions. Gate personnel will notify | c. Special Instructions. Gate personnel will notify | |||
the PL and/or CO of DV/VIP visits to detainee Medical | the DOC of DV/VIP visits to detainee Medical Clinic. | |||
Clinic. | ||||
d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | ||||
(a) Keep the alleyway in front of the gate clear of | ||||
unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | ||||
people. | ||||
(b) Ensure personnel entering have official | ||||
business and/or orders. | ||||
e. Emergencies will take priority over all other | ||||
ongoing gate operations. It is the responsibility of the | ||||
sentry to stop all traffic though the gate that will hinder | ||||
the entry/exit of emergency personnel. | ||||
7-6. JIIF Gate | ||||
a. Manning. The JIIF Gate will have one soldier | ||||
assigned. Any soldier attached to the JTF with a secret | ||||
security clearance may work the gate. | ||||
b. Duties and responsibilities. One Soldier assigned | ||||
will: | ||||
(1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | ||||
operation of the gate including daily functional | ||||
management of the gate and overall responsibility. | ||||
(2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | ||||
(3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | ||||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | ||||
c. Special Instructions. | ||||
(1) Gate sentry will keep a working Staff Duty | ||||
Log annotating all detainees requested by the JIIF | ||||
passing through the gate. Include detainee cell number | ||||
and ISN. | ||||
(2) Gate sentry will notify the PL and/or DFC of | ||||
DV/VIP visits to JIIF. | ||||
d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | |||
(a) Keep the alleyway in front of the gate clear of | (a) Keep the alleyway in front of the gate clear of | |||
unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | |||
people. | people. | |||
(b) Ensure personnel entering have official | (b) Ensure personnel entering have official | |||
business and/or orders. | business and/or orders, face to badge identification | |||
required upon entry or exit. | ||||
e. Emergencies will take priority over all other | e. Emergencies will take priority over all other | |||
ongoing gate operations. It is the responsibility of the | ongoing gate operations. It is the responsibility of the | |||
sentry to stop all traffic though the gate that will hinder | guard to stop all traffic though the gate that will hinder | |||
the entry/exit of emergency personnel. | the entry/exit of emergency personnel. | |||
7-7. Roving Sally | 7-6. Roving Sally | |||
a. Manning. The Roving Sally will have two | a. Manning. The Roving Sally will have two | |||
soldiers assigned. Any soldier attached to the JTF- | soldiers assigned. Any soldier attached to the JTF- | |||
GTMO with a secret security clearance may work the | GTMO with a secret security clearance or that has | |||
gate. | signed a non-disclosure statement may work the gate. | |||
b. Duties and responsibilities. The two soldiers | b. Duties and responsibilities. | |||
assigned will: | ||||
(1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | (1) Directly responsible to the SOG for the | |||
operation of the gates including daily functional | operation of the gates including daily functional | |||
management of the gate and overall responsibility. | management of the gate and overall responsibility. | |||
(2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | (2) Keep SOG and PL briefed on events. | |||
(3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | (3) Ensure an inventory of all sensitive items, | |||
equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | equipment, and keys upon assumption of duties. | |||
(4) Ensure the IRF team equipment is organized | ||||
neatly and maintained. | ||||
c. Special Instructions. | c. Special Instructions. | |||
(1) In the event of an IRF team request, the | (1) In the event of an IRF team request, the | |||
Roving Sally will ensure as IRF team members leave | Roving Sally will ensure as IRF team members leave | |||
the blocks, that they open the gates as quickly as | the blocks, that they open the gates as quickly as | |||
possible. IRF team and support members have priority | possible. IRF team and support members have priority | |||
for gate openings. | for gate openings. | |||
(2) In the event of fire, Roving Sally will ensure | (2) In the event of fire, Roving Sally will ensure | |||
the centrally located fire extinguishers are placed in | the centrally located fire extinguishers are placed in | |||
between the sally port gates of the affected block(s). | between the sally port gates of the affected block(s). | |||
d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | d. Pedestrian entry/exit. Soldier assigned will: | |||
(a) Keep the central causeway clear of | (a) Keep the central causeway clear of | |||
unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | unnecessarily halted vehicles and large groups of | |||
people. | people. | |||
(b) Ensure personnel entering have official | (b) Ensure personnel entering have official | |||
business and/or orders. | business and/or orders. | |||
e. Emergencies will take priority over all other | e. Emergencies will take priority over all other | |||
ongoing gate operations. It is the responsibility of the | ongoing gate operations. It is the responsibility of the | |||
sentry to stop all traffic though the gate that will hinder | guard to stop all traffic though the gate that will hinder | |||
the entry/exit of emergency personnel. | the entry/exit of emergency personnel. | |||
7-8. Weapon Boxes | 7-7. Weapon Boxes | |||
a. Weapon boxes at main entry sally ports will be | a. Weapon boxes located at sally ports 1 and 8 will | |||
used to store handguns, mace, OC, knives, or any other | be used to store handguns, mace, OC, knives, or any | |||
small weapons not authorized to enter the facility. | other small weapons not authorized to enter the facility. | |||
b. Sally port guards will perform the following tasks | b. Sally port guards will perform the following tasks | |||
if an unauthorized weapon is carried into the sally port | if an unauthorized weapon is carried into the sally port | |||
and the personnel who is in possession, needs to enter | and the personnel who is in possession, needs to enter | |||
the facility: | the facility: | |||
(1) Inform the personnel that the unauthorized | (1) Inform the personnel that the unauthorized | |||
item is not allowed into the facility. | item is not allowed into the facility. | |||
(2) Issue a weapon box key to personnel from the | (2) Issue a weapon box key to personnel from the | |||
key box using Form 5513-R. | key box using Form 5513-R. | |||
(3) Inform personnel to place the item(s) in the | (3) Inform personnel to place the item(s) in the | |||
weapon box. | weapon box. | |||
skipping to change at line 3295 | skipping to change at line 3880 | |||
c. When personnel return to the sally port and are | c. When personnel return to the sally port and are | |||
ready to exit the facility, the following steps will take | ready to exit the facility, the following steps will take | |||
place: | place: | |||
(1) Remove weapon box key from their person | (1) Remove weapon box key from their person | |||
and open the appropriate gun box. | and open the appropriate gun box. | |||
(2) Removes item(s) from the weapon box. | (2) Removes item(s) from the weapon box. | |||
(3) Secure item(s) on their person. | (3) Secure item(s) on their person. | |||
(4) Close gun box and remove weapon box key. | (4) Close gun box and remove weapon box key. | |||
(5) Return key to the sally port guard. | (5) Return key to the sally port guard. | |||
d. Sally port guard logs weapon box key back in on | d. Sally port guard logs weapon box key back in on | |||
Form 5513-R, returns key to key box and secures key | Form 5513-R, returns key to the key box and secures | |||
box. | key box. | |||
e. Sally port guard logs personnel out of facility. | e. Sally port guard logs personnel out of facility. | |||
7-8 Camp Delta Badge Identification Procedures | ||||
a. All Camp Delta badges are issued and accounted | ||||
for by the JDOG S-2. | ||||
b. Each incoming unit will forward a copy of their | ||||
unit-manning roster to the JDOG S-2 for badge issue. | ||||
c. JDOG S-2 will produce badges for each soldier | ||||
based upon position and level of access required. | ||||
d. Soldiers will sign for their badge directly from | ||||
the S-2. | ||||
e. It is the soldiers’ responsibility to maintain | ||||
accountability of their badge once issued. | ||||
f. Lost, stolen, destroyed or damaged badges will | ||||
be reported through the soldier’s chain of command | ||||
immediately upon discovery. A DA Form 2823 (sworn | ||||
statement) will be completed by the soldier. JDOG S2 | ||||
is the only re-issue authority for a lost, stolen, | ||||
destroyed and/or damaged badge. | ||||
. g. The default badge will be the RED badge. | ||||
Soldiers and civilians whose primary job is outside | ||||
Camp Delta will be issued a RED badge. RED badges | ||||
will be issued only to soldiers and civilians whose job | ||||
requires they work inside the camp. Soldiers and | ||||
civilians who occasionally visit the camp or perform | ||||
work in the camp on an on-call basis will require a | ||||
visitor badge and must be escorted by the person or | ||||
agency they are visiting. | ||||
h. Soldiers and civilians whose primary mission is | ||||
interrogation support, and/or who maintain an office in | ||||
the administrative buildings inside Camp Delta are | ||||
authorized a YELLOW badge. Linguists who are | ||||
cleared to work inside Camp Delta and detainee | ||||
hospital staff will be issued a YELLOW badge. | ||||
Soldiers and civilians who work on JPJ Hill will also | ||||
be issued a YELLOW badge. | ||||
i. GREEN badges will be issued to soldiers and | ||||
civilians whose primary job is working the blocks | ||||
inside Camp Delta and Camp Echo. All other requests | ||||
for GREEN badges must be approved by the JDOG | ||||
commander | ||||
Badge classification regular issue. | ||||
a. Red: Badges bearing a red square allow access | ||||
through sally ports 1 & 8, Café Carrib, and Guard | ||||
Towers. | ||||
b. Yellow: Badges bearing a yellow square allow | ||||
access through sally ports 1, 3, 8, 9, interrogation | ||||
buildings, DOC and Buildings 7 & 8. | ||||
c. Green: Unescorted access throughout Camp | ||||
Delta. | ||||
d. All other areas not listed require an escort and | ||||
prior coordination through the DOC. | ||||
Badge classification special issue. | ||||
a. Third Country Nationals (TCN’s), and | ||||
Contractors | ||||
(1) TCN’s/Contractors will be issued a photo ID | ||||
Yellow Camp Delta Badge, that can be verified by a | ||||
hole- punch through the Yellow square. | ||||
(2) TCN’s/Contractors will be escorted through | ||||
Sally port 8. | ||||
(3) Sally port 8 maintains accountability of TCN’s | ||||
and Contractors that enter and exit the camp, via head- | ||||
count roster. In the event that a contractor is called to | ||||
the camp after hours for an emergency work-order, the | ||||
contractor will be escorted IAW the current SOP escort | ||||
policy. | ||||
b. Emergency responders (ER’s) | ||||
NAVBASE MCC will be issued non-photo white | ||||
badges identified by a red stripe on the top, bottom, | ||||
and a red cross in the center. The ER’s will have | ||||
unescorted access into the camp for emergency | ||||
purposes only, coordinated through the DOC. | ||||
c. Visitor Access Sally ports 1&8 | ||||
(1) JDOG S-2 will issue 15 Red visitor “V” | ||||
badges each, to Sally Ports 1& 8. SOG 3 will | ||||
inventory, sign-for, and maintain accountability of | ||||
badges. | ||||
(2) Visitors will sign for their badges at Sally | ||||
ports 1 or 8, and await their assigned “Escort authority” | ||||
(EA). Visitors are required to display the badge in | ||||
such a manner that it is noticeable at all times. Visitors | ||||
will turn in their badges at Sally port 1or 8 prior to | ||||
deaprting the camp. | ||||
(3) JDOG S-2 will designate, and assign Escort | ||||
Authorities (EA’s) from the S-2, S-3, DOC, ICE, | ||||
Medical and civilian staff agencies. Designated EA’s | ||||
will carry special badges identifying them as escorts. | ||||
(4) Visitor access will only be allowed through | ||||
Sally port 1; visitors may access Sally port 8 if they are | ||||
a group delegation operating a vehicle. The vehicle | ||||
must be accompanied by a designated EA. Visitors | ||||
will be issued their badge at sally port 8 when the | ||||
vehicle enters. | ||||
d. Infantry Task Force | ||||
(1) 14 non-photo red badges will be issued to the | ||||
IN TOC for the purpose of access into the camp for | ||||
tower rotation. All Infantry soldiers on Amber Cycle | ||||
will be issued a RED badge. Soldiers will keep the | ||||
RED Badge on their person at all times. The RED | ||||
Badge will be presented at Sally port 1 as the soldiers | ||||
rotate from tower to QRF duty. | ||||
e. Quick Reaction Force (QRF) | ||||
(1) 14 non-photo green badges will be issued to the | ||||
QRF for the purpose of responding to an alarm | ||||
activation and/or a camp uprising. The GREEN QRF | ||||
badge will be maintained in the QRF shack. Soldiers | ||||
will not carry the QRF badge when they rotate to tower | ||||
duty. The QRF green badge will only be worn when | ||||
the DOC calls the QRF to respond to the camp. | ||||
(2) The Infantry will follow the Infantry TOC SOP | ||||
for badge issue and turn-in. | ||||
f. Camp Echo | ||||
Personnel requiring access to Camp Echo must | ||||
coordinate through the JDOG S-2, and be placed on the | ||||
access roster. | ||||
Chapter 8 | Chapter 8 | |||
Detainee Behavioral Management | Detainee Behavioral Management | |||
8-1. Purpose To outline requirements and procedures | 8-1. Purpose To outline requirements and procedures | |||
for managing detainee discipline and positive behavior | for managing detainee discipline and positive behavior | |||
rewards programs. This system will protect the health, | rewards programs. This system will protect the health, | |||
safety, and security of all persons within the facility by | safety, and security of all persons within the facility by | |||
providing for a fair and consistent delivery of | providing for a fair and consistent delivery of | |||
consequences for negative behavior and rewards for | consequences for negative behavior and rewards for | |||
positive behavior. | positive behavior. | |||
skipping to change at line 3330 | skipping to change at line 4029 | |||
showers and the availability of soap and water to wash | showers and the availability of soap and water to wash | |||
themselves while in the cell. | themselves while in the cell. | |||
8-3. Discipline Process | 8-3. Discipline Process | |||
a. When a detainee commits a camp rules infraction | a. When a detainee commits a camp rules infraction | |||
or an offense listed in Table 8-1, List of Offenses, the | or an offense listed in Table 8-1, List of Offenses, the | |||
chain of command within the camp will be notified. | chain of command within the camp will be notified. | |||
The priority of notification is the Sergeant of the Guard | The priority of notification is the Sergeant of the Guard | |||
(SOG), Platoon Leader (PL), and on-duty | (SOG), Platoon Leader (PL), and on-duty | |||
Commanding Officer (CO), in that order. | Commanding Officer (CO), in that order. | |||
b. The SOG and/or PL will: | b. The SOG and/or PL will: | |||
(1) Review Table 8-1 and locate the offense on | (1) Instruct the block personnel to remove the | |||
detainees comfort items. | ||||
(2) Review Table 8-1 and locate the offense on | ||||
the list. If the offense is not listed, attempt to locate a | the list. If the offense is not listed, attempt to locate a | |||
similar offense or an offense of equal severity to the | similar offense or an offense of equal severity to the | |||
offense committed by the detainee. Identify the | offense committed by the detainee. Identify the | |||
category level of the most severe offense. | category level of the most severe offense. | |||
(2) Review the discipline record of the detainee | (3) Review the discipline record of the detainee | |||
to determine the detainee’s previous discipline history. | to determine the detainee’s previous discipline history. | |||
(3) Using Table 8-2, Detainee Movement and | (4) Using Table 8-2, Detainee Movement and | |||
Discipline Matrix, cross-reference the category of the | Discipline Matrix, cross-reference the category of the | |||
most severe offense from Table 8-1 with the number of | most severe offense from Table 8-1 with the number of | |||
days between the current offense and the previous | days between the current offense and the previous | |||
offense. This will give you two results. The result | offense. This will give you two results. The result | |||
from the movement section of Table 8-2 is where to | from the movement section of Table 8-2 is where to | |||
move the detainee. The discipline section of Table 8-2 | move the detainee. The discipline section of Table 8-2 | |||
determines the type and length of discipline imposed | determines the type and length of discipline imposed | |||
on the detainee. | on the detainee. | |||
(5) Complete a GTMO Form 508-1 with the | ||||
following information: | ||||
(a) Date, time, ISN, location, and type of offense | ||||
(based off of table 8-1) that was committed. | ||||
(b) List any witnesses. Witnesses must complete | ||||
a DA Form 2823. | ||||
(c) Was medical treatment necessary. | ||||
(d) The date of the last offense | ||||
(e) The discipline to enforce for the detainee. | ||||
(5) Turn the 508-1 into the DOC after | ||||
completion. The 508-1 can be turned in without the | ||||
DA 2823s. | ||||
c. If several offenses were committed at the same | c. If several offenses were committed at the same | |||
time and the resulting discipline does not include time | time and the resulting discipline does not include time | |||
in MSU, move one column to the right on the | in SHU, move one column to the right on the discipline | |||
discipline section of the Table 8-2 to determine | section of the Table 8-2 to determine punishment. If | |||
punishment. If several offenses were committed at the | several offenses were committed at the same time and | |||
same time and the resulting discipline does include | the resulting discipline does include time in SHU, add | |||
time in MSU, add five days to loss of Comfort Items | five days to loss of Comfort Items (CI) and 5 days to | |||
(CI) and 5 days to the time in MSU for each additional | the time in SHU for each additional offense. | |||
offense. | d. The Detention Operations Center (DOC) will be | |||
d. The CJDOG, DCJDOG, or JDOG S-3 must | notified of any moves made to SHU. This notification | |||
approve any discipline that includes movement to | must include ISN number, reason for move, approving | |||
MSU, by signing as the Authenticating Officer on the | authority and length of discipline. The DOC will | |||
DD Form 508. This does not apply to moves to MSU | annotate all moves on the daily blotter. The DOC will | |||
by the JIG (for intelligence purposes). JIG moves will | take the 508-1 and make a copy of it. If the detainee’s | |||
be coordinated through the Detention Operations | discipline does not require movement from the block, | |||
Branch and do not need any further approval; however, | one copy of the 508-1 will be sent to the block for | |||
the Detention Operations Center will not move the | enforcement. If the detainee’s discipline requires | |||
detainee until directed by the Detention Operations | movement from the block, one copy of the 508-1 will | |||
Officer or JDOG S3. | be given to Escort Control to give to the escort team | |||
e. The on-duty CO will approve all discipline | that will escort the detainee to the new block. The 508- | |||
measures except MSU time, will check the | 1 will then be given to the block NCO of the moved to | |||
block for enforcement. | ||||
e. The CJDOG, DCJDOG, or JDOG S-3 must approve | ||||
any discipline that includes movement to SHU, by | ||||
signing as the Authenticating Officer on the DD Form | ||||
508. This does not apply to moves to SHU by the JIG | ||||
(for intelligence purposes). JIG moves will be | ||||
coordinated through the DOC and do not need any | ||||
further approval; however, the Detention Operations | ||||
Center will not move the detainee until directed by the | ||||
Detention Operations Officer or JDOG S3. The | ||||
detainee may be moved immediately prior to the | ||||
authenticating officer signing the paperwork. | ||||
f. The on-duty CO will approve all discipline | ||||
measures except SHU time, will check the | ||||
“recommended” block of the DD Form 508, and sign | “recommended” block of the DD Form 508, and sign | |||
as the Confinement Officer. | as the Confinement Officer. | |||
f. Notification to the chain of command will be | g. Notification to the chain of command will be | |||
made for any situations involving unusual | made for any situations involving unusual | |||
circumstances, and for any use of force beyond verbal | circumstances, and for any use of force beyond verbal | |||
persuasion or show of force. | persuasion or show of force. | |||
g. The Detention Operations Center (DOC) will be | ||||
notified of any moves made to MSU. This notification | ||||
must include ISN number, reason for move, approving | ||||
authority and length of discipline. The DOC will | ||||
annotate all moves on the daily blotter. | ||||
h. When a discipline measure is applied to a | h. When a discipline measure is applied to a | |||
detainee, he will be notified of the reason for the | detainee, he will be notified of the reason for the | |||
discipline, and the type/length of the discipline | discipline, and the type/length of the discipline | |||
measure. | measure. | |||
i. Do not confiscate any item unless it is for | i. Do not confiscate any item unless it is for | |||
discipline purposes or for the prevention of self-harm | discipline purposes or for the prevention of self-harm | |||
or harm to others. | or harm to others. | |||
j. When Comfort Items (CI) are taken from a | j. When Comfort Items (CI) are taken from a | |||
detainee, the items will be inventoried and placed in a | detainee, the items will be inventoried and placed in a | |||
large trash bag or box, and the Block NCO will | large trash bag or box, and the Block NCO will | |||
complete and sign the Detainee Supply Roster. The | complete and sign the Detainee Supply Roster. The | |||
bag will have a “toe tag” tied to it with the detainee’s | bag will have a “toe tag” tied to it with the detainee’s | |||
ISN annotated. The box will be marked with the | ISN annotated. The box will be marked with the | |||
detainee’s ISN. The box or bag will be stored in an | detainee’s ISN. The box or bag will be stored in an | |||
orderly manner on top of the detainee’s cell. Block | orderly manner on top of the detainee’s cell. Block | |||
NCOs will be responsible for ensuring that the storage | NCOs will be responsible for ensuring that the storage | |||
of the CI presents an orderly appearance and that the | of the CI presents an orderly appearance and that the | |||
skipping to change at line 3409 | skipping to change at line 4132 | |||
n. Documentation of any discipline measure will be | n. Documentation of any discipline measure will be | |||
annotated on DD Form 508. DA Forms 2823, Sworn | annotated on DD Form 508. DA Forms 2823, Sworn | |||
Statements from all U.S. personnel involved in the | Statements from all U.S. personnel involved in the | |||
incident will be attached to the DD Form 508, and | incident will be attached to the DD Form 508, and | |||
forwarded to the on-duty CO for disposition. | forwarded to the on-duty CO for disposition. | |||
o. A detainee that has been moved to level 2 or level | o. A detainee that has been moved to level 2 or level | |||
3 for discipline must spend at least 30 days at that level | 3 for discipline must spend at least 30 days at that level | |||
before being considered for movement to the next | before being considered for movement to the next | |||
higher classification level. The detainee will be | higher classification level. The detainee will be | |||
considered for movement 30 days from the end of the | considered for movement 30 days from the end of the | |||
discipline period if the detainee has not had any | discipline period if the detainee has not had any | |||
discipline problems within that time. A detainee that | discipline problems within that time. A detainee that | |||
has been moved to level 4 for discipline will be moved | has been moved to level 4 for discipline will be moved | |||
to level 3 upon completion of the mandated period of | to level 3 upon completion of the mandated period of | |||
time annotated on the DD Form 508 or memorandum | time annotated on the DD Form 508 or memorandum | |||
of approval of extension signed by CJTF. The | of approval of extension signed by CJTF. The | |||
Detention Services Branch (DSB) will conduct the | Detention Services Branch (DSB) will conduct the | |||
review of records for movement from one classification | review of records for movement from one classification | |||
level to a new level. Any exceptions to this procedure | level to a new level. The JDOG S3 must approve any | |||
must be approved by the JDOG S3. | exceptions to this procedure. | |||
p. Many detainee actions that result in disciplinary | p. Many detainee actions that result in disciplinary | |||
measures may also result in future criminal charges. | measures may also result in future criminal charges. | |||
Accurate and complete documentation is always | Accurate and complete documentation is always | |||
required. | required. | |||
q. Any proposed discipline for detainees under the | q. Any proposed discipline for detainees under the | |||
care of the Detention Hospital Psychologist requires | care of the Detention Hospital Psychologist requires | |||
consultation between the senior on-duty psychology | consultation between the senior on-duty psychology | |||
staff member and the on-duty CO prior to imposing | staff member and the on-duty CO prior to imposing | |||
discipline. Detainees being treated as mental health | discipline. Detainees being treated as mental health | |||
patients will only have Basic Issue Items, authorized | patients will only have Basic Issue Items, authorized | |||
CIs, and/or Authorized Activities taken away as a | CIs, and/or Authorized Activities taken away as a | |||
medical necessity; in those cases the senior on-duty | medical necessity; in those cases the senior on-duty | |||
psychology staff member will be cited on the GTMO | psychology staff member will be cited on the GTMO | |||
Form 508-1 as the authority for removing items or | Form 508-1 as the authority for removing items or | |||
prohibiting activities. | prohibiting activities. | |||
8-4. Loss of Recreation | r. Haircuts will never be used as punitive action | |||
a. If a detainee has lost his privilege of recreation | against a detainee. | |||
for the number of recreation periods determined by | 8-4. Loss of Exercise | |||
Table 8-2, the DOC will notify the appropriate Block | a. If a detainee has lost his privilege of exercise for | |||
NCO of the beginning date and the end date. The DOC | the number of exercise periods determined by Table 8- | |||
will annotate this information in the discipline log. | 2, the DOC will notify the appropriate Block NCO of | |||
the beginning date and the end date. The DOC will | ||||
annotate this information in the discipline log. | ||||
b. The Block NCO will annotate the beginning date | b. The Block NCO will annotate the beginning date | |||
and ending date on the discipline log sheet assigned to | and ending date on the discipline log sheet assigned to | |||
each detainee. This form will remain in the detainee | each detainee. This form will remain in the detainee | |||
file. The Block NCO will annotate loss of | file. The Block NCO will annotate loss of | |||
“RECREATION” and write the dates under the | “RECREATION” and write the dates under the | |||
corresponding column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END | corresponding column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END | |||
DATE”. The Block NCO will also make an entry in | DATE”. The Block NCO will also make an entry in | |||
the duty logs. | the duty logs. | |||
c. A copy of the DD Form 508 will be placed into | c. A copy of the DD Form 508 will be placed into | |||
the detainee file on the block and a copy kept in the | the detainee file on the block and a copy kept in the | |||
detainee’s file in the DOC. | detainee’s file in the DOC. | |||
8-5. Loss of Hot Meals | 8-5. Loss of Hot Meals | |||
a. If a detainee has lost his privilege of hot meals | a. Only the JDOG S-3 or higher may authorize the | |||
for the number of days determined by Table 8-2, the | loss of hot meals for a detainee. The DOC will | |||
DOC will notify the appropriate Block NCO of the | annotate this information in DIMS. | |||
beginning date and the end date. The DOC will | ||||
annotate this information in the discipline log. | ||||
b. The Block NCO will annotate the beginning date | b. The Block NCO will annotate the beginning date | |||
and ending date on the discipline log sheet assigned to | and ending date on the discipline log sheet assigned to | |||
each detainee. This form will remain in the detainee | each detainee. This form will remain in the detainee | |||
file. The Block NCO will annotate loss of “HOT | file. The Block NCO will annotate loss of “HOT | |||
MEALS” and write the dates under the corresponding | MEALS” and write the dates under the corresponding | |||
column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END DATE”. The | column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END DATE”. The | |||
Block NCO will also make an entry in the duty logs. | Block NCO will also make an entry in the duty logs. | |||
c. A copy of the DD Form 508 will be placed into | c. A copy of the DD Form 508 will be placed into | |||
the detainee file on the block and a copy kept in the | the detainee file on the block and a copy kept in the | |||
detainee’s file in the DOC. | detainee’s file in the DOC. | |||
skipping to change at line 3495 | skipping to change at line 4217 | |||
number or numbers and the date or dates under the | number or numbers and the date or dates under the | |||
corresponding column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END | corresponding column of “DATE BEGAN” and “END | |||
DATE. The Block NCO will also make an entry in the | DATE. The Block NCO will also make an entry in the | |||
duty logs. | duty logs. | |||
d. When a detainee changes classification level, the | d. When a detainee changes classification level, the | |||
detainee will lose or gain comfort items at the new | detainee will lose or gain comfort items at the new | |||
block based on the block’s classification level. The | block based on the block’s classification level. The | |||
receiving Block NCO must ensure that when a detainee | receiving Block NCO must ensure that when a detainee | |||
is moving to a higher classification level, he is issued | is moving to a higher classification level, he is issued | |||
the required items. The receiving Block NCO must | the required items. The receiving Block NCO must | |||
ensure that when a detainee is moving to a lower | ensure that when a detainee is moving to a lower | |||
classification level, he loses unauthorized items. | classification level, he loses unauthorized items. | |||
e. The Block NCO of a moving detainee must | e. The Block NCO of a moving detainee must | |||
ensure all items on the inventory sheet depart with the | ensure all items on the inventory sheet depart with the | |||
detainee.. The receiving block will confiscate all | detainee. The receiving block will confiscate all | |||
excess items. If the detainee does not have an item | excess items. If the detainee does not have an item | |||
listed on the current inventory sheet, the detainee is | listed on the current inventory sheet, the detainee is | |||
subject to punishment for failure to return property, per | subject to punishment for failure to return property, per | |||
Table 8-1. | Table 8-1. | |||
f. If a detainee refuses a CI, place an R on the | f. If a detainee refuses a CI, place an R on the | |||
inventory sheet in the block that corresponds to the | inventory sheet in the block that corresponds to the | |||
item refused. | item refused. | |||
g. The following items are a one-for-one exchange | ||||
to track who is flushing items: | ||||
(1) All linen items | ||||
(2) Detainee pens | ||||
h. The travel type toothbrush used by Level 1 | ||||
detainees will only be issued once a month unless the | ||||
detainee newly moves to a Level 1 block. | ||||
8-7. Detainee Classification System | 8-7. Detainee Classification System | |||
a. The Detainee Classification System is a five level | a. The Detainee Classification System is a five level | |||
system of rewards based on the premise that a | system of rewards based on the premise that a | |||
detainee’s behavior determines the privileges they are | detainee’s behavior determines the privileges they are | |||
allowed. As the detainee adapts to the rules of the | allowed. As the detainee adapts to the rules of the | |||
camp, his conduct will earn him more privileges. Basic | camp, his conduct will earn him more privileges. Basic | |||
Issue Items, CIs, and Authorized/Unauthorized | Issue Items, CIs, and Authorized/Unauthorized | |||
Activities for detainees are listed in Tables 8-3 thru 8- | Activities for detainees are listed in Tables 8-3 thru 8- | |||
Detainees qualified for Classification Level 1 may | 5. Detainees qualified for Classification Level 1 may | |||
also be eligible for additional items and activities not | also be eligible for additional items and activities not | |||
listed in Tables 8-3 thru 8-5. | listed in Tables 8-3 thru 8-5. | |||
(1) Classification Level 1. Detainees receive a | (1) Classification Level 1. Detainees receive a | |||
higher level of privileges than Level 2, and having | higher level of privileges than Level 2, and having | |||
spent at least 30 days at Level 2. | spent at least 30 days at Level 2. | |||
(2) Classification Level 2. Detainees at this level | (2) Classification Level 2. Detainees at this level | |||
receive a higher level of privileges than Level 3 and | receive a higher level of privileges than Level 3 and | |||
having spent at least 30 days at Level 3. | having spent at least 30 days at Level 3. | |||
(3) Classification Level 3. All detainees start at | (3) Classification Level 3. All detainees start at | |||
this level, following an initial period of segregation | this level, following an initial period of segregation | |||
upon arrival at Camp Delta; the length of time of this | upon arrival at Camp Delta; the length of time of this | |||
initial segregation will be determined by the JIG. This | initial segregation will be determined by the JIG. This | |||
level includes detainees who are on discipline measures | level includes detainees who are on discipline measures | |||
not including MSU. | not including segregation. | |||
(4) Classification Level 4. Detainees normally | (4) Classification Level 4. These detainees are | |||
located in MSU, but also includes detainees who have | normally located in segregation, but it also includes | |||
completed MSU time, but have not yet moved to Level | detainees who could be on a Level 5 block or in a non- | |||
SHU block, that is housing Level 4 detainees. | ||||
Detainees in this status will have their classification | Detainees in this status will have their classification | |||
reevaluated by the Detention Services Branch daily. | reevaluated by the Detention Services Branch daily. | |||
Detainees can be housed in MSU up to 90 days, but | Detainees can be housed in segregation up to 90 days, | |||
their status will be reviewed every 30 days by CJTF. | but their status will be reviewed every 30 days by | |||
CJTF. | ||||
(5) Classification Level 5 (Intel Level). JIG | (5) Classification Level 5 (Intel Level). JIG | |||
directed segregation, for intelligence gathering | directed segregation, for intelligence gathering | |||
purposes. Detainees will be segregated at the direction | purposes. Detainees will be segregated at the direction | |||
of the JIG through the Detention Operations Branch. | of the JIG through the Detention Operations Branch. | |||
(a) Housed in a group on an Intel block. | (a) Housed in a group on an Intel block. | |||
(b) Housed in MSU block for Intel purposes. | (b) Housed in segregation block for Intel | |||
purposes. | ||||
(c) Receive Reward Level (1-4) privileges as | (c) Receive Reward Level (1-4) privileges as | |||
recommended by JIG. | recommended by JIG. | |||
b. Delta Block is designated as the Mental Health | b. Delta Block is designated as the Mental Health | |||
Facility (MHF) for the housing of detainees requiring a | Facility (MHF) for the housing of detainees requiring a | |||
higher level clinical care and monitoring. | higher-level clinical care and monitoring. | |||
c. A qualifying disciplinary event is defined as a | c. A qualifying disciplinary event is defined as a | |||
disciplinary event that has not expired and dropped off | disciplinary event that has not expired and dropped off | |||
their disciplinary record FOR THE PURPOSES OF | their disciplinary record FOR THE PURPOSES OF | |||
THIS PROGRAM ONLY. These offenses will remain | THIS PROGRAM ONLY. These offenses will remain | |||
on their disciplinary records for the purpose of | on their disciplinary records for the purpose of | |||
disciplinary actions. | disciplinary actions. | |||
d. Category III offenses, as listed in Table 8-1 will | d. Category III offenses, as listed in Table 8-1 will | |||
expire on their 30-day anniversary for each step higher | expire on their 30-day anniversary for each step higher | |||
and will not be counted against a detainee for the | and will not be counted against a detainee for the | |||
purposes of this program. 30 days is considered his | purposes of this program. 30 days is considered his | |||
skipping to change at line 3575 | skipping to change at line 4307 | |||
f. Category V offenses will expire on their 60-day | f. Category V offenses will expire on their 60-day | |||
anniversary for each step higher and will not be | anniversary for each step higher and will not be | |||
counted against a detainee for the purposes of this | counted against a detainee for the purposes of this | |||
program. 60 days is considered his required good | program. 60 days is considered his required good | |||
behavior period. | behavior period. | |||
g. A detainee will change levels based on his | g. A detainee will change levels based on his | |||
behavior or meeting other criteria for a level. | behavior or meeting other criteria for a level. | |||
Detainees who do not meet the program based on | Detainees who do not meet the program based on | |||
behavior, may still participate in the program based on | behavior, may still participate in the program based on | |||
JIG directed requests, but will be housed on a separate | JIG directed requests, but will be housed on a separate | |||
block designated as an “intel block.” JIG will | block designated as an “Intel block.” JIG will | |||
determine higher-level privileges on this block. If a | determine higher-level privileges on this block. If a | |||
detainee is moved to a level 4 block, he will spend the | detainee is moved to a level 4 blocks, he will spend the | |||
time required in MSU according to the matrix. At the | time required in segregation according to the matrix. | |||
completion of his time in MSU, he will immediately | At the completion of his time in segregation, he will | |||
move to a level 3 block. The detainee will then stay on | immediately move to a level 3 blocks. The detainee | |||
the level 3 block until the required good behavior | will then stay on the level 3 blocks until the required | |||
period is satisfied and then move to a level 2 block. | good behavior period is satisfied and then move to a | |||
The detainee will then stay on a level 2 block until his | level 2 blocks. The detainee will then stay on a level 2 | |||
required good behavior period is satisfied and then | blocks until his required good behavior period is | |||
move to a level 1 block. A detainee must spend this | satisfied and then move to a level 1 block. A detainee | |||
entire time incident free at his current level to qualify | must spend this entire time incident free at his current | |||
for movement to the next higher level. This is in order | level to qualify for movement to the next higher level. | |||
to prove his ability to function at a higher level of | This is in order to prove his ability to function at a | |||
privileges. If no room is available on a block at the | higher level of privileges. If no room is available on a | |||
next higher level, the detainee will still have his | block at the next higher level, the detainee will still | |||
classification level changed on his current block and | have his classification level changed on his current | |||
will move at the next available opening for that level. | block and will move at the next available opening for | |||
Example: A detainee who is currently on a level 3 | that level. Example: A detainee who is currently on a | |||
block was disciplined for inciting a disturbance. This | level 3 block was disciplined for inciting a disturbance. | |||
offense has a required good behavior period of 30 days. | This offense has a required good behavior period of 30 | |||
Once he has had no discipline for 30 days, he is | days. Once he has had no discipline for 30 days, he is | |||
eligible for level 2. If a cell is open on a level 2 block, | ||||
eligible for level 2. If a cell is open on a level 2 blocks, | ||||
the detainee will be moved there and will be issued the | the detainee will be moved there and will be issued the | |||
additional comfort items for reward level 2. If a cell is | additional comfort items for reward level 2. If a cell is | |||
not open on a level 2 block, the detainee will remain on | not open on a level 2 blocks, the detainee will remain | |||
his current block and receive additional comfort items | on his current block and receive additional comfort | |||
for level 2. Once the detainee has had no discipline for | items for level 2. Once the detainee has had no | |||
an additional 30 days, regardless if on a level 2 or level | discipline for an additional 30 days, regardless if on a | |||
3 block, he will be eligible to be moved to a reward | level 2 or level 3 blocks, he will be eligible to be | |||
level 1 block. If a cell is open on a level 1 block, the | moved to a reward level 1 block. If a cell is open on a | |||
detainee will be moved there and will be issued the | level 1 block, the detainee will be moved there and will | |||
additional comfort items for level 1. If a cell is not | be issued the additional comfort items for level 1. If a | |||
open on a level 1 block, the detainee will remain on his | cell is not open on a level 1 block, the detainee will | |||
current block and receive additional comfort items for | remain on his current block and receive additional | |||
level 1. | comfort items for level 1. | |||
h. If a detainee commits an offense in MSU that | h. If a detainee commits an offense in segregation | |||
requires additional MSU time and will extend his total | that requires additional segregation time and will | |||
time beyond 30 consecutive days, the following | extend his total time beyond 30 consecutive days, the | |||
procedure will be used: | following procedure will be used: | |||
(1) If the detainee has not yet reached 30 days of | (1) If the detainee has not yet reached 30 days of | |||
actual MSU time served, a memorandum will be | actual segregation time served, a memorandum will be | |||
forwarded to CJTF requesting an extension of MSU | forwarded to CJTF requesting an extension of | |||
time. The memorandum will detail how many days the | segregation time. The memorandum will detail how | |||
extension is for, why it is necessary, and will include | many days the extension is for, why it is necessary, and | |||
the DD Form 508 with the punishment on it (see Figure | will include the DD Form 508 with the punishment on | |||
8-1 for example memorandum). If the extension is | it (see Figure 8-1 for example memorandum). If the | |||
granted, the detainee will be removed at the end of the | extension is granted, the detainee will be removed at | |||
total approved MSU period and moved to a Level 3 | the end of the total approved segregation period and | |||
block. If the extension is not granted, the detainee will | moved to a Level 3 block. If the extension is not | |||
be removed after serving 30 days in MSU and moved | granted, the detainee will be removed after serving 30 | |||
to a Level 3 block. | days in SHU and moved to a Level 3 block. | |||
(2) If the detainee has reached 30 days of actual | (2) If the detainee has reached 30 days of actual | |||
MSU time served, the detainee will be removed from | SHU time served, the detainee will be removed from | |||
SHU, placed on a level 3 block, with level 4 CI and | ||||
MSU, placed on a level 3 block, with level 4 CI and | ||||
Authorized Activities (this action will be documented | Authorized Activities (this action will be documented | |||
on a GTMO Form 508-1, signed/approved by the | on a GTMO Form 508-1, signed/approved by the | |||
JDOG S3). A memorandum will be forwarded to | JDOG S3). A memorandum will be forwarded to | |||
CJTF requesting an extension of MSU time. The | CJTF requesting an extension of segregation time. The | |||
memorandum will detail how many days the extension | memorandum will detail how many days the extension | |||
is for, why it is necessary, and will include the DA 508 | is for, why it is necessary, and will include the DA 508 | |||
with the punishment on it (see Figure 8-2 for example | with the punishment on it (see Figure 8-2 for example | |||
memorandum). Upon approval of the extension, the | memorandum). Upon approval of the extension, the | |||
detainee will be moved back to MSU to serve the | detainee will be moved back to segregation to serve the | |||
length of the approved extension. | length of the approved extension. | |||
i. Either the JIG or the JDOG S3 will decide the | i. Either the JIG or the JDOG S3 will decide the | |||
detainee’s classification. Level 5 block assignments | detainee’s classification. Level 5 block assignments | |||
will be determined by the JIG. | will be determined by the JIG. | |||
j. An Order of Merit List (OML) will be created to | j. An Order of Merit List (OML) will be created to | |||
form a waiting list for qualified detainees to get into | form a waiting list for qualified detainees to get into | |||
either a level 1 or level 2 block. The Detention | either a level 1 or level 2 block. The Detention | |||
Services Branch will develop and monitor this OML. | Services Branch will develop and monitor this OML. | |||
Detainees will be chosen from the OML for movement | Detainees will be chosen from the OML for movement | |||
to a higher-level block. If sufficient detainees are on | to a higher-level block. If sufficient detainees are on | |||
the OML, JDOG S3 can direct that a block be | the OML, JDOG S3 can direct that a block be | |||
converted to a higher-level block. | converted to a higher-level block. | |||
k. If a detainee exhibits a positive behavior over and | k. If a detainee exhibits a positive behavior over and | |||
above that of fellow detainees, a Block NCO, SOG, | above that of fellow detainees, a Block NCO, SOG, | |||
PL, or on-duty CO can request to CJDOG to remove | PL, or on-duty CO can request to CJDOG to remove | |||
five days from his period of good behavior to transition | five days from his period of good behavior to transition | |||
to a higher reward level on a GTMO Form 508-1. | to a higher reward level on a GTMO Form 508-1. | |||
Examples include: | Examples include: | |||
(1) A detainee who notifies a Block Guard of a | (1) A detainee who notifies a guard of a cell door | |||
cell door being unlocked | being unlocked | |||
(2) A detainee who acts as an interpreter during a | (2) A detainee who acts as an interpreter during a | |||
critical incident | critical incident | |||
(3) A detainee that finds a welding rod in the | (3) A detainee that finds a welding rod in the | |||
recreation yard and gives it to an MP. | exercise yard and gives it to a guard. | |||
8-8. GTMO Form 508-1 | 8-8. GTMO Form 508-1 | |||
a. The GTMO Form 508-1 is used to determine | a. The GTMO Form 508-1 is used to determine | |||
which rewards the detainee will lose or gain. | which rewards the detainee will lose or gain. | |||
b. Process for issuing a GTMO Form 508-1 for | b. Process for issuing a GTMO Form 508-1 for | |||
discipline: | discipline: | |||
(1) Details about incident phoned to DOC to | (1) Details of incident are phoned to DOC to | |||
begin processing a DD Form 508. | begin processing a DD Form 508. | |||
(2) DA Form(s) 2823 filled out by personnel | (2) DA Form(s) 2823 filled out by personnel | |||
witnessing the incident, detailing the incident. | witnessing the incident, detailing the incident. | |||
(3) PL determines discipline based on matrix and | (3) PL determines discipline based on matrix and | |||
previous record of offenses by detainee, then prepares | previous record of offenses by detainee, then prepares | |||
GTMO Form 508-1 for on-duty CO’s review. The | GTMO Form 508-1 for on-duty CO’s review. The | |||
form must include a brief description of the offense, | form must include a brief description of the offense, | |||
the number of times the detainee has committed | the number of times the detainee has committed | |||
offenses, and the discipline to be imposed. | offenses, and the discipline to be imposed. | |||
(4) If the on-duty CO concurs, the discipline is | (4) If the on-duty CO concurs, the discipline is | |||
skipping to change at line 3709 | skipping to change at line 4441 | |||
(3) Detention Services Branch processes the | (3) Detention Services Branch processes the | |||
GTMO Form 508-1 and forwards through Detention | GTMO Form 508-1 and forwards through Detention | |||
Operations Branch, to JDOG S3. | Operations Branch, to JDOG S3. | |||
(4) If the detainee is in a Level 5 block, the Level | (4) If the detainee is in a Level 5 block, the Level | |||
5 Block Entitlement Form will be used to determine if | 5 Block Entitlement Form will be used to determine if | |||
the detainee is in the correct cell based on his reward | the detainee is in the correct cell based on his reward | |||
level. If he is changing levels, he will be moved to an | level. If he is changing levels, he will be moved to an | |||
area, if possible, on the same block where he will not | area, if possible, on the same block where he will not | |||
be next to detainees with a different reward level. If | be next to detainees with a different reward level. If | |||
the detainee receives a reward outside of the matrix, | the detainee receives a reward outside of the matrix, | |||
that will be annotated on the block diagram. The | ||||
GTMO Forms 508-1 for Level 5 blocks will be | that will be annotated on the block diagram. Detention | |||
maintained by Detention Services Branch and the block | Services Branch will maintain the GTMO Forms 508-1 | |||
diagrams will be distributed to the Level 5 blocks | for Level 5 blocks and the block diagrams will be | |||
within 24 hours of any changes. | distributed to the Level 5 blocks within 24 hours of any | |||
changes. | ||||
(5) If a detainee is not in a Level 5 block, a copy | (5) If a detainee is not in a Level 5 block, a copy | |||
of the GTMO Form 508-1 will be sent to the block to | of the GTMO Form 508-1 will be sent to the block to | |||
be placed in the detainee’s records on the block. The | be placed in the detainee’s records on the block. The | |||
original will be placed in the detainee’s file in the | original will be placed in the detainee’s file in the | |||
DOC. | DOC. | |||
8-9. Level 5 Blocks | 8-9. Level 5 Blocks/Intel | |||
a. Detainees on Level 5 Blocks will be segregated | a. Detainees on Level 5 Blocks will be segregated | |||
based on the individual’s reward level as determined | based on the individual’s reward level as determined | |||
by the JIG. Upon receipt by Detention Services | by the JIG. Upon receipt by Detention Services | |||
Branch of a GTMO Form 508-1, the detainee will be | Branch of a GTMO Form 508-1, the detainee will be | |||
classified by his reward level and placed in an | classified by his reward level and placed in an | |||
appropriate cell in a Level 5 Block. JIG personnel will | appropriate cell in a Level 5 Block. JIG personnel will | |||
issue and confiscate all non-expendable items. Block | issue and confiscate all non-expendable items. Block | |||
personnel will replenish all expendable items after the | personnel will replenish all expendable items after the | |||
initial issue by JIG personnel. Block personnel may | initial issue by JIG personnel. Block personnel may | |||
only confiscate items for discipline purposes and then | only confiscate items for discipline purposes and then | |||
skipping to change at line 3800 | skipping to change at line 4532 | |||
authorized for the detainee’s current discipline level. | authorized for the detainee’s current discipline level. | |||
(4) An approved GTMO Form 508-1 directs | (4) An approved GTMO Form 508-1 directs | |||
otherwise. | otherwise. | |||
e. No linen item, prayer bead, prayer cap, book, flip | e. No linen item, prayer bead, prayer cap, book, flip | |||
flops, ISO mat, mattress, shoes, storage tub, game, or | flops, ISO mat, mattress, shoes, storage tub, game, or | |||
playing cards will be thrown away if damaged. | playing cards will be thrown away if damaged. | |||
f. Deliberate damage is any damage done by the | f. Deliberate damage is any damage done by the | |||
detainee to his property. This does not include tears | detainee to his property. This does not include tears | |||
and holes caused by day-to-day use and living inside of | and holes caused by day-to-day use and living inside of | |||
a metal cell or the wear of footgear used to walk on | a metal cell or the wear of footgear used to walk on | |||
gravel. The MP will use his best judgment to | gravel. The guard will use his best judgment to | |||
determine if the damage was deliberate or not. When | determine if the damage was deliberate or not. When | |||
disciplining a detainee for damage to any item, the | disciplining a detainee for damage to any item, the | |||
damage must be deliberate. | damage must be deliberate. | |||
g. During all inventories and prior to any discipline | g. During all inventories and prior to any discipline | |||
for lost items, the bag and/or box holding items above | for lost items, the bag and/or box holding items above | |||
the cell must be checked for that item. The contents of | the cell must be checked for that item. The contents of | |||
that bag and/or box must also follow the detainee | that bag and/or box must also follow the detainee | |||
whenever he is permanently moved. The Block NCO | whenever he is permanently moved. The Block NCO | |||
of the losing block is responsible to ensure that all of | of the losing block is responsible to ensure that all of | |||
the detainee’s items leave with him. The Block NCO | the detainee’s items leave with him. The Block NCO | |||
skipping to change at line 3840 | skipping to change at line 4573 | |||
damages this item or makes it into a weapon or self- | damages this item or makes it into a weapon or self- | |||
harm device, it will be confiscated and the detainee | harm device, it will be confiscated and the detainee | |||
disciplined for damaging or destroying government | disciplined for damaging or destroying government | |||
property. If the detainee does not have the item during | property. If the detainee does not have the item during | |||
any inventory, ensure the item was not confiscated. If | any inventory, ensure the item was not confiscated. If | |||
it was confiscated and it was issued to him, he will be | it was confiscated and it was issued to him, he will be | |||
disciplined for damaging or destroying government | disciplined for damaging or destroying government | |||
property. Also, consult the damaged property matrix to | property. Also, consult the damaged property matrix to | |||
determine the length of time the detainee loses the | determine the length of time the detainee loses the | |||
item. | item. | |||
(2) Suicide Blanket. If a detainee tears, rips, or | ||||
otherwise damages the suicide blanket or makes it into | ||||
a weapon or self-harm device, it will be confiscated | ||||
and the detainee disciplined for damaging or destroying | ||||
government property. If the detainee does not have the | ||||
suicide blanket during any inventory, ensure it was not | ||||
confiscated. If it was not confiscated and it was issued | ||||
to him, he will be disciplined for damaging or | ||||
destroying government property. A replacement | ||||
suicide blanket will be given to the detainee. | ||||
(3) Suicide Smock. If a detainee tears, rips, or | ||||
otherwise damages the suicide smock or makes it into a | ||||
weapon or self-harm device, it will be confiscated and | ||||
the detainee disciplined for damaging or destroying | ||||
government property. A replacement suicide smock | ||||
will be given to the detainee. Only psychiatry may | ||||
authorize the use of a suicide smock. | ||||
i. Religious Items. These items are distributed in | i. Religious Items. These items are distributed in | |||
coordination with the Chaplain. | coordination with the Chaplain. | |||
(1) Koran. Religious book with special handling | (1) Koran. Religious book with special handling | |||
rules and search rules. Refer to section 6-11 for | rules and search rules. Refer to section 6-11 for | |||
details. | details. | |||
(2) Perfume/Oil. Expendable item. Ensure no | (2) Perfume/Oil. Expendable item. Ensure no | |||
items are hidden inside of container. | items are hidden inside of container. | |||
(3) Prayer Beads. A religious item similar to a | (3) Prayer Beads. A religious item similar to a | |||
rosary. Prayer beads may not be modified in any | rosary. Prayer beads may not be modified in any | |||
fashion. Any modification to prayers will result in the | fashion. Any modification to prayers will result in the | |||
confiscation of the prayer beads and the detainee | confiscation of the prayer beads and the detainee | |||
disciplined. Fill out a form DA 4137 and turn the form | disciplined. Fill out a form DA 4137 and turn the form | |||
and prayer beads into the Evidence Custodian. | and prayer beads into the Evidence Custodian. | |||
(4) Prayer Cap. A black or white item that is | (4) Prayer Cap. A black or white item that is | |||
worn on the head of the detainee. May be searched and | worn on the head of the detainee. May be searched and | |||
handled by an MP wearing gloves. Examine for | handled by a guard wearing gloves. Examine for | |||
damage such as removal of threading. Any damage or | damage such as removal of threading. Any damage or | |||
modification to the prayer cap will result in the | modification to the prayer cap will result in the | |||
detainee being disciplined. Fill out a form DA 4137 | detainee being disciplined. Fill out a form DA 4137 | |||
and turn the form and prayer cap into the Evidence | and turn the form and prayer cap into the Evidence | |||
Custodian. | Custodian. | |||
j. Books. These items are distributed through the | j. Books. These items are distributed through the | |||
Detainee Librarian. Examine all books for writing or | Detainee Librarian. Examine all books for writing or | |||
any hidden items. Any book that contains writing | any hidden items. Any book that contains writing | |||
should be confiscated and turned in immediately for | should be confiscated and turned in immediately for | |||
intelligence purposes. Books will not be left on the | intelligence purposes. Books will not be left on the | |||
skipping to change at line 3911 | skipping to change at line 4626 | |||
(5) Flip Flops. Detainees wear this item. | (5) Flip Flops. Detainees wear this item. | |||
Inspect them for damage. Discipline the detainee for | Inspect them for damage. Discipline the detainee for | |||
damage only, not wear and tear from use. When in | damage only, not wear and tear from use. When in | |||
doubt about what caused the damage to this item, err | doubt about what caused the damage to this item, err | |||
on the side of damage caused by wear. | on the side of damage caused by wear. | |||
(6) ISO Mat. Used by the detainees to sleep on | (6) ISO Mat. Used by the detainees to sleep on | |||
or to screen their bathroom use from others. The ISO | or to screen their bathroom use from others. The ISO | |||
mat will stay with the detainee at all times. Inspect the | mat will stay with the detainee at all times. Inspect the | |||
ISO mat for damage. If there is any damage, the | ISO mat for damage. If there is any damage, the | |||
detainee will be disciplined for damage or destruction | detainee will be disciplined for damage or destruction | |||
of government property. Also, consult the damaged | of government property. | |||
property matrix to determine the length of time the | ||||
detainee loses the ?? the blanket cannot be removed. | ||||
(7) Mask, Surgical Type. This item is used to | (7) Mask, Surgical Type. This item is used to | |||
hold the Koran. Typically, it is tied to the cell wall and | hold the Koran. Typically, it is tied to the cell wall and | |||
the Koran is placed inside. Ensure the strip of metal | the Koran is placed inside. Ensure the strip of metal | |||
that would normally go over the nose when worn is not | that would normally go over the nose when worn is not | |||
present in the mask. | present in the mask. All cells, except those designated | |||
for self-harm or have self-harm detainees in them, will | ||||
have a mask to hold the Koran. | ||||
(8) Mattress. This item will stay with the | (8) Mattress. This item will stay with the | |||
detainee regardless if he loses it for the level he is on or | detainee regardless if he loses it for the level he is on or | |||
not. Inspect the mattress for any damage or items | not. Inspect the mattress for any damage or items | |||
hidden within it. If the mattress is damaged, the | hidden within it. If the mattress is damaged, the | |||
detainee will be disciplined for damage or destruction | detainee will be disciplined for damage or destruction | |||
of government property. Also, consult the damaged | of government property. Also, consult the damaged | |||
property matrix to determine the length of time the | property matrix to determine the length of time the | |||
detainee loses the blanket. | detainee loses the blanket. | |||
(9) Salt Packets. These may be kept by the | (9) Salt Packets. These may be kept by the | |||
detainee and are a consumable supply. These may be | detainee and are a consumable supply. These may be | |||
skipping to change at line 3960 | skipping to change at line 4676 | |||
size cups may be used at anytime. All cups are | size cups may be used at anytime. All cups are | |||
considered equal regardless of size. | considered equal regardless of size. | |||
(13) Toothpaste. This item will only be issued on | (13) Toothpaste. This item will only be issued on | |||
Sundays. Ensure there is nothing hidden inside the | Sundays. Ensure there is nothing hidden inside the | |||
toothpaste. If there is an object hidden inside, | toothpaste. If there is an object hidden inside, | |||
discipline the detainee for contraband, fill out a form | discipline the detainee for contraband, fill out a form | |||
DA 4137 and give the toothpaste and form to the | DA 4137 and give the toothpaste and form to the | |||
Evidence Custodian. | Evidence Custodian. | |||
(14) Toothbrush, Small Travel Type. This is a | (14) Toothbrush, Small Travel Type. This is a | |||
small toothbrush with regular bristles. These will be | small toothbrush with regular bristles. These will be | |||
issued once a month. Inspect for any modification or | issued once a month. Inspect for any modification or | |||
damage to the handle. If found, discipline the detainee | damage to the handle. If found, discipline the detainee | |||
appropriately, fill out a form DA 4137 and give the | appropriately, fill out a form DA 4137 and give the | |||
toothbrush and form to the Evidence Custodian. Also, | toothbrush and form to the Evidence Custodian. Also, | |||
consult the damaged property matrix to determine the | consult the damaged property matrix to determine the | |||
length of time the detainee loses the toothbrush. | length of time the detainee loses the toothbrush. | |||
(15) Toothbrush, Finger. Inspect this item for | ||||
any modifications that could result in injury such as | ||||
attaching a sharp object to it. If any dangerous | ||||
modification is done to the toothbrush, confiscate it, fill | ||||
out a form DA 4137, give the toothbrush and form to | ||||
the Evidence Custodian. | ||||
(16) Water Bottle. The water bottle is not an | (16) Water Bottle. The water bottle is not an | |||
expendable item. The detainee will receive a water | expendable item. The detainee will receive a water | |||
bottle when his reward level is changed to a one or he | bottle when his reward level is changed to a one or he | |||
has completed his discipline for destroying or | has completed his discipline for destroying or | |||
damaging a water bottle. The water bottle needs to be | damaging a water bottle. The water bottle needs to be | |||
inspected for damage or containing hidden objects. If | inspected for damage or containing hidden objects. If | |||
the water bottle is damaged, the detainee will be | the water bottle is damaged, the detainee will be | |||
disciplined for damage or destruction to government | disciplined for damage or destruction to government | |||
property. Also, consult the damaged property matrix to | property. Also, consult the damaged property matrix to | |||
determine the length of time the detainee loses the | determine the length of time the detainee loses the | |||
water bottle. | water bottle. | |||
(17) Games. Games need to be inspected for | (17) Games. Games need to be inspected for | |||
damage or lost pieces. If the game is damaged or has | damage or lost pieces. If the game is damaged or has | |||
lost pieces, the detainee is to be disciplined for damage | lost pieces, the detainee is to be disciplined for damage | |||
or destruction to government property. It is the | or destruction to government property. It is the | |||
detainee’s responsibility to inform the Block Guards if | detainee’s responsibility to inform the guards if a game | |||
a game piece is accidentally lost and will not be | piece is accidentally lost and will not be disciplined if | |||
disciplined if detainee tells the Block Guard. The | detainee tells the guard. The detainee will be informed | |||
detainee will be informed of this responsibility when | of this responsibility when the game is issued. Also, | |||
the game is issued. Also, consult the damaged property | consult the damaged property matrix to determine the | |||
matrix to determine the length of time the detainee | length of time the detainee loses the game. | |||
loses the game. | ||||
(18) Playing Cards. Playing cards need to be | (18) Playing Cards. Playing cards need to be | |||
inspected for damage or lost cards. If the cards are | inspected for damage or lost cards. If the cards are | |||
damaged or have been lost, the detainee is to be | damaged or have been lost, the detainee is to be | |||
disciplined for damage or destruction to government | disciplined for damage or destruction to government | |||
property. It is the detainee’s responsibility to inform | property. It is the detainee’s responsibility to inform | |||
the Block Guards if a card is accidentally lost and will | the guards if a card is accidentally lost and will not be | |||
not be disciplined if detainee tells the Block Guard. | disciplined if detainee tells the guard. The detainee | |||
The detainee will be informed of this responsibility | will be informed of this responsibility when the cards | |||
when the cards are issued. Also, consult the damaged | are issued. Also, consult the damaged property matrix | |||
property matrix to determine the length of time the | to determine the length of time the detainee loses the | |||
detainee loses the playing cards. | playing cards. | |||
l. Mail. Mail personnel distribute this item to the | l. Mail. Mail personnel distribute this item to the | |||
detainees. A piece of mail is a complete letter, | detainees. A piece of mail is a complete letter, | |||
regardless of the number of pages, and the envelope. A | regardless of the number of pages, and the envelope. A | |||
piece of mail may also be a postcard. | piece of mail may also be a postcard. | |||
m.Additional Items and Privileges. | m.Additional Items and Privileges. | |||
(1) Additional Toilet Paper. The detainee | (1) Additional Toilet Paper. The detainee | |||
normally receives a set amount of toilet paper per shift | normally receives a set amount of toilet paper per shift | |||
at specific times. This privilege allows the detainee to | at specific times. This privilege allows the detainee to | |||
get toilet paper as required. The detainee is responsible | get toilet paper as required. The detainee is responsible | |||
for asking for the additional toilet paper. Guards need | for asking for the additional toilet paper. Guards need | |||
to ensure that the detainee doesn’t receive | to ensure that the detainee doesn’t receive additional | |||
toilet paper when the detainee already has it. The | ||||
amount given to the detainee will be the same amount | ||||
as normally distributed to the detainee. | ||||
(2) Pen and Paper Upon Request. The detainee | (2) Pen and Paper Upon Request. The detainee | |||
may request pen and paper from the Block Guards. | may request pen and paper from the guards. The | |||
The detainee may not have more than ten sheets of | detainee may not have more than ten sheets of paper in | |||
paper in his cell at any one time. The paper will not be | his cell at any one time. The paper will not be passed | |||
passed between cells. If the detainee writes any letters | between cells. If the detainee writes any letters and | |||
and request them to be mailed, the will be given to the | request them to be mailed, the will be given to the | |||
detainee mail personnel. Paper will be plain white | detainee mail personnel. Paper will be plain white | |||
paper such as that used in the Xerox machine. Pens | paper such as that used in the Xerox machine. Pens | |||
will be the soft flexible safety version. Block | will be the soft flexible safety version. Block | |||
personnel must document who receives a pen and must | personnel must document who receives a pen and must | |||
collect them prior to shift change. Pens will not be | collect them prior to shift change. Pens will not be | |||
issued on midnight shift. The paper may be obtained | issued on midnight shift. The paper may be obtained | |||
from the supply room or the DOC and the pens will be | from the supply room or the DOC and the pens will be | |||
obtained from supply. When getting pens, they must | obtained from supply. When getting pens, they must | |||
be exchanged on a one for one basis. | be exchanged on a one for one basis. | |||
(3) Intel Directed Reading Material. This | (3) Intel Directed Reading Material. This | |||
material, which may be magazines, books, etc.; will be | material, which may be magazines, books, etc.; will be | |||
labeled with an id that starts with the letter “I”. All | labeled with an id that starts with the letter “I”. All | |||
intelligence reading material will not be counted | intelligence reading material will not be counted | |||
against the number of items that the detainee has from | against the number of items that the detainee has from | |||
the Detainee Library. All intelligence reading material | the Detainee Library. All intelligence reading material | |||
will be turned into the JIG when the detainee is | will be turned into the JIG when the detainee is | |||
disciplined and not the Detainee Library. | disciplined and not the Detainee Library. | |||
(4) Shampoo. Shampoo will be kept in a | (4) Shampoo. Shampoo will be kept in a | |||
container and placed on top of his cell, visible to the | container and placed on top of his cell, visible to the | |||
Block Guard. It will not be kept in the cell. The | guard. It will not be kept in the cell. The detainee may | |||
detainee may ask for shampoo to clean himself in his | ask for shampoo to clean himself in his cell. The | |||
cell. The shampoo will be poured into the detainee’s | shampoo will be poured into the detainee’s hand and | |||
hand and the container placed back on top of the cell. | the container placed back on top of the cell. | |||
n. Authorized Activities. The following are | n. Authorized Activities. The following are | |||
guidelines for activities where the Authorized | guidelines for activities where the Authorized | |||
Activities form is not complete in the description. | Activities form is not complete in the description. | |||
(1) Allowed to Save an MRE for Later. The | (1) Allowed to Save an MRE for Later. The | |||
detainee is allowed to keep one MRE for later use. If | detainee is allowed to keep one MRE for later use. If | |||
the detainee is issued an MRE and already has a saved | the detainee is issued an MRE and already has a saved | |||
MRE, one must be consumed or returned. The | MRE, one must be consumed or returned. The | |||
detainee may not combine the contents of both MREs | detainee may not combine the contents of both MREs | |||
into one MRE in any form. | into one MRE in any form. | |||
(2) Performing Approved Exercises in Cells. | (2) Performing Approved Exercises in Cells. | |||
Approved exercise does not include any type of martial | Approved exercise does not include any type of martial | |||
arts training. | arts training. | |||
(3) Authorized Exercises in Recreation Yard. | (3) Authorized Exercises in Exercise Yard. | |||
Approved exercise does not include any type of martial | Approved exercise does not include any type of martial | |||
arts training. | arts training. | |||
(4) Cold Water (After/During Recreation). A | (4) Cold Water (After/During Exercise). A five- | |||
five-gallon water can/jug will be used to provide the | gallon water can/jug will be used to provide the | |||
detainee with cold water. Put ice in the water can prior | detainee with cold water. Put ice in the water can prior | |||
to the start of the shower and recreation period. The | ||||
to the start of the shower and exercise period. The | ||||
water can/jug will not be the same water source as that | water can/jug will not be the same water source as that | |||
used by the block personnel. The detainee is | used by the block personnel. The detainee is | |||
responsible to take his cup to the recreation yard if he | responsible to take his cup to the exercise yard if he | |||
wants cold water. | wants cold water. | |||
8-11. Special Rewards | 8-11. Special Rewards | |||
a. At times, JIG personnel will give out special | a. At times, JIG personnel will give out special | |||
rewards outside of the normal reward system. | rewards outside of the normal reward system. | |||
b. For the special reward of two detainees in the | b. For the special reward of two detainees in the | |||
same recreation yard, the following procedure will | same exercise yard, the following procedure will apply: | |||
apply: | ||||
(1) Putting the first of two detainees in the | (1) Putting the first of two detainees in the | |||
recreation yard will be conducted according to current | exercise yard will be conducted according to current | |||
methodology. | methodology. | |||
(2) Before placing the second detainee in the | (2) Before placing the second detainee in the | |||
recreation yard, the first detainee must kneel in the | exercise yard, the first detainee must kneel in the | |||
corner opposite the recreation yard door, with his back | corner opposite the exercise yard door, with his back | |||
towards the door, and grab the fence. | towards the door, and grab the fence. | |||
(3) If the detainee refuses to cooperate with the | (3) If the detainee refuses to cooperate with the | |||
MP instructions at any time, the detainee will be | guard’s instructions at any time, the detainee will be | |||
subject to disciplinary measures based on his failure to | subject to disciplinary measures based on his failure to | |||
follow MP instructions. | follow guard instructions. | |||
(4) To take a detainee out when more than one | (4) To take a detainee out when more than one | |||
occupies the cell, reverse the process. | occupies the cell, reverse the process. | |||
c. For the special reward of a roll of toilet paper, the | c. For the special reward of a roll of toilet paper, the | |||
following procedure will apply: | following procedure will apply: | |||
(1) Give the detainee the roll of toilet paper | (1) Give the detainee the roll of toilet paper | |||
(2) If the detainee tries to force the roll into the | (2) If the detainee tries to force the roll into the | |||
toilet or passes it out to other detainees, confiscate the | toilet or passes it out to other detainees, confiscate the | |||
roll of toilet paper. | roll of toilet paper. | |||
d. With any special rewards, immediately notify the | d. With any special rewards, immediately notify the | |||
DOC so that the JIG may be informed of an | DOC so that the JIG may be informed of an | |||
uncooperative detainee. In addition, the detainee | uncooperative detainee. In addition, the detainee will | |||
will be disciplined accordingly. | be disciplined accordingly. | |||
Chapter 9 | Chapter 9 | |||
Maximum Security Units (MSU) Operations | Segregation Operations | |||
Section I – In-Processing | Section I – In-Processing | |||
9-1. In-Processing And Documentation | 9-1. In-Processing And Documentation | |||
a. Before placing a detainee in MSU, the following | a. Before placing a detainee in segregation, the | |||
procedures should be followed: | following procedures should be followed: | |||
(1) New detainees will be placed in MSU for | (1) New detainees will be placed in segregation | |||
processing for up to thirty days. | for processing for up to thirty days. | |||
(2) DOD and military personnel involved with | (2) DOD and military personnel involved with | |||
detainees in a disruptive behavior must write a sworn | detainees in a disruptive behavior must write a sworn | |||
statement describing the offense committed by the | statement describing the offense committed by the | |||
detainee. | detainee. | |||
(3) PL will annotate discipline measures on DD | (3) PL will annotate discipline measures on DD | |||
form 508. | form 508. | |||
(4) The CO or higher must endorse any discipline | (4) The CO or higher must endorse any discipline | |||
that includes movements into MSU. The CO can | that includes movements into segregation. The CO can | |||
recommend a maximum of ten days of discipline. If | recommend a maximum of ten days of discipline. If | |||
exceeding 11 days of discipline, the JDOG S-3, Deputy | exceeding 11 days of discipline, the JDOG S-3, Deputy | |||
JDOG Commander (DCJDOG) or CJDOG must | JDOG Commander (DCJDOG) or CJDOG must | |||
approve. If a detainee, while at MSU commits another | approve. If a detainee, while in segregation commits | |||
offense, the JDOG S-3 or the CJDOG can approve an | another offense, the JDOG S-3 or the CJDOG can | |||
extension over 30 days in the same process used for | approve an extension over 30 days in the same process | |||
Intel detainees. | used for Intel detainees. | |||
(5) When a detainee is sent to MSU, a CD-S341 | (5) When a detainee is sent to segregation, a | |||
must be completed to include offense committed and | DIMS entry must be completed to include offense | |||
discipline imposed. | committed and discipline imposed. | |||
b. If a detainee has committed an offense that | ||||
requires segregation time, even if a segregation cell is | ||||
not available, the detainee will receive a shave and a | ||||
haircut for hygiene and medical reasons. If the | ||||
detainee is IRFed, the haircut and shave will follow the | ||||
decontamination process. | ||||
c. The only segregation blocks available in Camp | ||||
Delta are India, November and Oscar . Other blocks | ||||
may be designated for holding level 4 detainees, but | ||||
they are not segregation blocks. | ||||
9-2. Placement For Intelligence Purposes | 9-2. Placement For Intelligence Purposes | |||
a. Request by interrogation to place detainees will | a. Request by interrogation to place detainees will | |||
be coordinated with the Interrogator Sections Chief and | be coordinated with the Interrogator Sections Chief and | |||
the Interrogation Control Element (ICE) OIC or JIG to | the Interrogation Control Element (ICE) OIC or JIG to | |||
ensure there is a valid reason for detainee placement in | ensure there is a valid reason for detainee placement in | |||
MSU. | SHU. | |||
b. After concurrence by the ICE OIC, requestor or | b. After concurrence by the ICE OIC, requestor or | |||
section chief will indicate on the MSU transfer Request | section chief will indicate on the segregation transfer | |||
Form the specific reasons for placements in the MSU | Request Form the specific reasons for placements in | |||
and the proposal level of detainee’s access allowed to | the segregation and the proposal level of detainee’s | |||
ICRC representatives. The request form is then | access allowed to ICRC representatives. The request | |||
forwarded to the JIG Commander or his designated | form is then forwarded to the JIG Commander or his | |||
representative for approval. The initial period of time, | designated representative for approval. The initial | |||
which a detainee may be placed in the Maximum | period of time, which a detainee may be placed in the | |||
Security unit without ICRC, access or restricted access | Special Housing Unit without ICRC, visual access or | |||
shall be 30 days. Unless the JIG approves of a detainee | restricted access shall be 30 days. Unless the JIG | |||
placement in MSU, such placement is not permitted. | approves of a detainee placement in segregation, such | |||
placement is not permitted. | ||||
c. When a detainee placement is approved, the JIG | c. When a detainee placement is approved, the JIG | |||
Commander, through his representative at the | Commander, through his representative at the | |||
Detention Facility notifies the JDOG to transfer the | Detention Facility notifies the JDOG to transfer the | |||
detainee to MSU. | detainee to segregation. | |||
d. When it is determined that military necessity | d. When it is determined that military necessity | |||
justifies continued detention beyond this initial 30 days | justifies continued detention beyond this initial 30 days | |||
period the J-3 will prepare a notification memorandum | period the J-3 will prepare a notification memorandum | |||
for Commander JTF-GTMO signature to commander | for Commander JTF-GTMO signature to commander | |||
US SOUTHCOM. This notification memorandum will | US SOUTHCOM. This notification memorandum will | |||
be prepared at least five days before the end of the | be prepared at least five days before the end of the | |||
initial segregation period and will include justification | initial segregation period and will include justification | |||
for the extended MSU Detention. | for the extended segregation Detention. | |||
Section II – Operations | Section II – Operations | |||
9-3. Block Operations | 9-3. Block Operations | |||
a. Block personnel will operate MSU blocks IAW | a. Block personnel will operate segregation blocks | |||
chapter 6 except for the provisions as noted in this | IAW chapter 6 except for the provisions as noted in | |||
chapter. | this chapter. | |||
b. Due to behavior, some detainees may be house in | b. Due to behavior, some detainees may be housed | |||
MSU either for their own protection or for security or | in segregation either for their own protection or for | |||
safety reasons. | security or safety reasons. | |||
c. For detainees other than those in Self- | c. For detainees other than those in Self- | |||
Harm/Injured Behavior, guards will walk the block and | Harm/Injured Behavior, two guards will walk the block | |||
document the conducted checks every 10 minutes on | at all times and document the conducted checks every | |||
CD-S341. The Block Guard conducting the checks will | 10 minutes. For detainees in Self Harm/Injured | |||
initial the CD-S341. For detainees in Self | Behavior follow Self Harm/Injured Behavior SOP | |||
Harm/Injured Behavior follow Self Harm/Injured | contained in Section 31-1. | |||
Behavior SOP contained in Section 31-1. | d. Bean hole doors will only be open to pass items | |||
d. Feed tray doors will only be open during meal | through. | |||
times. It will be opened when detainee is issued a meal | ||||
and left open until the meal remnants and trash are | ||||
recovered. Once trash has been collected, the feed tray | ||||
doors will be closed. | ||||
e. The viewing doors will remain open at all times. | e. The viewing doors will remain open at all times. | |||
f. Detainees who are in a MSU block for INTEL | f. Detainees who are in a segregation block for | |||
purposes will be allowed to have their viewing door | INTEL purposes will be allowed to have their viewing | |||
open at their request. | door open at their request. | |||
g. An Alpha Roster will be maintained on the block | g. An Alpha Roster will be maintained on the block | |||
identifying the ISN numbers of all the detainees on the | identifying the ISN numbers of all the detainees on the | |||
block. | block. | |||
h. Maximum Security Log will be maintained on | h. Maximum Security Log will be maintained on | |||
the block with entrance/departure dates of MSU, ICRC | the block with entrance/departure dates of segregation | |||
access. | and ICRC access level. | |||
i. All MSU blocks have a fire alarm system with | i. All segregation blocks have a fire alarm system | |||
electronic control system that can be reset in false | with electronic control system that can be reset in false | |||
alarm. | alarm. | |||
j. All MSU have an air conditioning system. The | j. All segregation have an air conditioning system. | |||
temperature control system is set at a temperature | that will be set and maintained at 85 degrees. | |||
within five degrees of the week’s average high | ||||
temperature. | ||||
k. Detainee comfort items and confiscated property | k. Detainee comfort items and confiscated property | |||
will be stored in box above their cell until time served. | will be stored in box above their cell until time served. | |||
h. Intelligence directed segregation to MSU receive | l. Intelligence directed segregation receive level 1, | |||
level 1, level 2, or level 3 privileges as recommended | level 2, or level 3 privileges as recommended by JIG. | |||
by JIG. | m. Each cell in segregation will have an assigned | |||
l. Each MSU cell will have an assigned suicide | Koran. | |||
prevention blanket. This blanket will stay in the | n. Detainees may only cover the lower half of the | |||
assigned cell. Day shift will check daily all seams of | viewing window while using the bathroom. After the | |||
the blankets for cells 1-12 in India and November | detainee has completed using the bathroom, the object | |||
blocks and cells 1-18 in Oscar block. Swing shift will | covering the window must be removed. | |||
check daily all seems of the blankets for cells 13-24 in | o. During shower and exercise, no razors, or nail | |||
India and November blocks and 19-36 in Oscar block. | clippers will be issued to detainees. | |||
If any seam has been chewed, or otherwise | ||||
compromised, the blanket should be repaired before | p. The uniform for detainees while in segregation | |||
reuse. Use of this blanket is not a substitute for careful | will be shorts and a shirt. | |||
monitoring of individuals on self-harm watch. | q. The only segregation blocks are I, N, and O. | |||
Other blocks may hold level 4 detainees, but they are | ||||
not segregation blocks. Detainees may also be placed | ||||
on a segregation block and have a different reward | ||||
level other than four. | ||||
9-4. Extension Request Processing | ||||
a. If a detainee has discipline or is required to | ||||
remain in a segregation cell for longer than 30 days, an | ||||
extension letter will be submitted. | ||||
(1) ICE Ops will submit all extension requests to | ||||
the J-3 Future Operations for detainees in segregation | ||||
for intelligence purposes. | ||||
(2) JDOG S-3 will submit all extension requests | ||||
to J-3 Future Operations for detainees in segregation | ||||
for discipline purposes. | ||||
b. At the 25-day mark, a memorandum requesting | ||||
the extension will be created and submitted. The | ||||
memorandum will state which detainee and the | ||||
justification for the extension beyond 30 days. DSB | ||||
will create the extension request for detainees on | ||||
discipline and forward to the JDOG S-3. | ||||
c. If the extension is not approved by 1800 hrs on | ||||
the 30th | ||||
day, the detainee will be removed from | ||||
segregation. | ||||
Chapter 10 | Chapter 10 | |||
NAVSTA Brig Operations | NAVSTA Brig Operations | |||
10-1. Purpose | 10-1. Purpose | |||
To establish a policy and procedure for transportation | To establish a policy and procedure for transportation | |||
to and US Army security of detainees housed at the | to and US Army security of detainees housed at the | |||
NAVSTA Brig, Guantanamo Bay, Cuba. | NAVSTA Brig, Guantanamo Bay, Cuba. | |||
10-2. Transport To NAVSTA Brig | 10-2. Transport To NAVSTA Brig | |||
a. Based on the number of detainees to be moved, | a. Based on the number of detainees to be moved, | |||
the following vehicles can be utilized: | the following vehicles can be utilized: | |||
(1) NAVSTA Brig Vehicle | (1) NAVSTA Brig Vehicle | |||
(2) Detention Hospital Ambulance | (2) Detention Hospital Ambulance | |||
(3) Detainee Bus. | (3) Detainee Bus. | |||
b. As needed, medical personnel will accompany | b. As needed, medical personnel will accompany | |||
detainees to the Brig. | detainees to the Brig. | |||
c. Detainee will be escorted to the Brig in three- | c. Detainee will be escorted to the Brig in three- | |||
piece restraints; two MPs will provide security inside | piece restraints; two guards will provide security inside | |||
the transporting vehicle. Escorts will execute duties | the transporting vehicle. Escorts will execute duties | |||
IAW Chapter 11. | IAW Chapter 11. | |||
d. The vehicle will enter the NAVSTA Brig through | d. The vehicle will enter the NAVSTA Brig through | |||
the Vehicle Sally Port. At no time will the detainee be | the Vehicle Sally Port. At no time will the detainee be | |||
outside of the vehicle except when they are inside the | outside of the vehicle except when they are inside the | |||
NAVSTA Brig compound. | NAVSTA Brig compound. | |||
e. The vehicle will pull to the far end of the block | e. The vehicle will pull to the far end of the block | |||
for offloading. | for offloading. | |||
f. Once positioned inside the compound, two MPs | f. Once positioned inside the compound, two | |||
will escort detainee from the vehicle to the cell. The | guards will escort detainee from the vehicle to the cell. | |||
cells nearest the door will be occupied first. The cell | The cells nearest the door will be occupied first. The | |||
will be searched for weapons and contraband before | cell will be searched for weapons and contraband | |||
the detainee is placed into the cell. | before the detainee is placed into the cell. | |||
g. Detainee comfort items will be searched and | g. Detainee comfort items will be searched and | |||
placed into cell before detainee arrives. | placed into cell before detainee arrives. | |||
h. Once detainee is inside the cell, two escorting | h. Once detainee is inside the cell, two escorting | |||
MPs will conduct standard unshackling procedures. | guards will conduct standard unshackling procedures. | |||
10-3. Personnel Support Requirements | 10-3. Personnel Support Requirements | |||
a. JDOG will provide three guards per shift when | a. JDOG will provide three guards per shift when | |||
detainees are confined in the NAVSTA Brig. | detainees are confined in the NAVSTA Brig. | |||
b. JDOG will provide Chaplain and Interpreter | b. JDOG will provide Chaplain and Interpreter | |||
support as needed. | support as needed. | |||
10-4. Medical Support Requirements | 10-4. Medical Support Requirements | |||
Detention Hospital will continue to provide daily | Detention Hospital will continue to provide daily | |||
medical support throughout the duration of | medical support throughout the duration of | |||
confinement within NAVSTA Brig. | confinement within NAVSTA Brig. | |||
10-5. Meals | 10-5. Meals | |||
a. Detainees will have 30 minutes to consume | a. Detainees will have 30 minutes to consume | |||
meals. JDOG will provide meals for detainees as | meals. JDOG will provide meals for detainees as | |||
follows: | follows: | |||
(1) Breakfast: 0715-0745 | (1) Breakfast: 0715-0745 | |||
(2) Lunch: 1100-1130 | (2) Lunch: 1100-1130 | |||
(3) Dinner: 1715-1745. | (3) Dinner: 1715-1745. | |||
10-6. Recreation | 10-6. Exercise | |||
a. Detainees will receive two 20-minute recreation | a. Detainees will receive two 20-minute exercise | |||
periods a week. | periods a week. | |||
b. The recreation period will take place inside the | b. The exercise period will take place inside the | |||
NAVSTA Brig day room or recreation yard. | NAVSTA Brig day room or exercise yard. | |||
c. If the exercise yard is used, one detainee at a time | c. If the exercise yard is used, one detainee at a time | |||
will be allowed to exercise in the yard adjacent to the | will be allowed to exercise in the yard adjacent to the | |||
Brig. In order to accomplish this, the following | Brig. In order to accomplish this, the following | |||
procedures apply: | procedures apply: | |||
(1) There is a 20-minute time limit placed upon | (1) There is a 20-minute time limit placed upon | |||
this exercise period. | this exercise period. | |||
(2) A green Brig uniform will be issued to the | (2) A green Brig uniform will be issued to the | |||
detainee and he will change prior to exiting his cell. | detainee and he will change prior to exiting his cell. | |||
Upon returning, the detainee will change back into his | Upon returning, the detainee will change back into his | |||
orange jumpsuit. | orange jumpsuit. | |||
(3) The detainee will be moved in the following | (3) The detainee will be moved in the following | |||
manner: | manner: | |||
(a) The entry gate will be closed. | (a) The entry gate will be closed. | |||
(b) The detainee will be cuffed and shackled. | (b) The detainee will be cuffed and shackled. | |||
(c) The detainee will be escorted to the yard by | (c) The detainee will be escorted to the yard by | |||
two MPs. | two guards. | |||
(d) The detainee will be uncuffed at the request | (d) The detainee will be uncuffed at the request | |||
of the interrogator. | of the interrogator. | |||
(e) Shackles will not be removed. | (e) Shackles will not be removed. | |||
(4) One MP will be positioned outside the | (4) One guard will be positioned outside the | |||
entrance to the Brig leading into the yard. The other | entrance to the Brig leading into the yard. The other | |||
MP will be positioned in the yard by the exit gate. | guard will be positioned in the yard by the exit gate. | |||
(5) The detainee will be allowed to walk the | (5) The detainee will be allowed to walk the | |||
entire yard however the interrogator must be with him | entire yard however the interrogator must be with him | |||
at all times. | at all times. | |||
(6) Only one detainee will be out of his cell at a | (6) Only one detainee will be out of his cell at a | |||
time. | time. | |||
10-7. Showers And Laundry | 10-7. Showers And Laundry | |||
a. The three MPs on duty are responsible for all | a. The three guards on duty are responsible for all | |||
functions that are required for detainee showers. This | functions that are required for detainee showers. This | |||
includes, but is not limited to: | includes, but is not limited to: | |||
(1) Escort to and from shower | (1) Escort to and from shower | |||
(2) Sanitation and cleanliness of shower point. | (2) Sanitation and cleanliness of shower point. | |||
(3) Detainees will receive two five-minute | (3) Detainees will receive two five-minute | |||
showers a week unless otherwise directed by the | showers a week unless otherwise directed by the | |||
CJDOG. | CJDOG. | |||
(4) The following will be the procedure for | (4) The following will be the procedure for | |||
conducting showers and laundry exchange for the | conducting showers and laundry exchange for the | |||
detainees: | detainees: | |||
skipping to change at line 4390 | skipping to change at line 5129 | |||
JDOG prior to the interrogators arriving at the brig. | JDOG prior to the interrogators arriving at the brig. | |||
(b) One interrogation will be conducted at a time. | (b) One interrogation will be conducted at a time. | |||
At no time will more than one detainee be out of his | At no time will more than one detainee be out of his | |||
cell at a time unless the CJDOG grants approval. | cell at a time unless the CJDOG grants approval. | |||
(c) Detainees will be moved to cell #10 with | (c) Detainees will be moved to cell #10 with | |||
cuffs and shackles secured and the entry gate closed. | cuffs and shackles secured and the entry gate closed. | |||
(d) The interrogators may ask to have the cuffs | (d) The interrogators may ask to have the cuffs | |||
removed prior to the interrogation beginning. This is | removed prior to the interrogation beginning. This is | |||
authorized after the detainee is moved and placed in | authorized after the detainee is moved and placed in | |||
cell #10. The leg shackles will never be removed. | cell #10. The leg shackles will never be removed. | |||
(e) One MP will be stationed outside the door of | (e) One guard will be stationed outside the door | |||
cell #10 observing the detainee. The other MP will | of cell #10 observing the detainee. The other guard | |||
continue to watch the remaining detainees within the | will continue to watch the remaining detainees within | |||
block. | the block. | |||
(f) After the interrogation is completed, the | (f) After the interrogation is completed, the | |||
interrogators will leave cell #10 but remain within the | interrogators will leave cell #10 but remain within the | |||
block. The MPs will re-cuff the detainee and return | block. The guards will re-cuff the detainee and return | |||
him to his cell where he will be secured. At this time, | him to his cell where he will be secured. At this time, | |||
the interrogators will be permitted to leave the brig or | the interrogators will be permitted to leave the brig or | |||
conduct an interrogation with another detainee. | conduct an interrogation with another detainee. | |||
(2) Within the block at a table. Interrogators are | (2) Within the block at a table. Interrogators are | |||
permitted to conduct the interrogation within the | permitted to conduct the interrogation within the | |||
confines of the block. | confines of the block. | |||
(a) The detainee will be removed from his cell | (a) The detainee will be removed from his cell | |||
with handcuffs and shackles on. | with handcuffs and shackles on. | |||
(b) The entry gate will be closed when a detainee | (b) The entry gate will be closed when a detainee | |||
is not in his individual cell. | is not in his individual cell. | |||
skipping to change at line 4421 | skipping to change at line 5160 | |||
(3) Within the confines of the adjacent building. | (3) Within the confines of the adjacent building. | |||
Interrogators and JIIF personnel are authorized to | Interrogators and JIIF personnel are authorized to | |||
interview/interrogate detainees within the confines of | interview/interrogate detainees within the confines of | |||
the building adjacent to the holding/cell area. | the building adjacent to the holding/cell area. | |||
(a) There is no time limit placed upon the | (a) There is no time limit placed upon the | |||
interrogators/JIIF personnel. | interrogators/JIIF personnel. | |||
(b) There will be no limit as to the duration of the | (b) There will be no limit as to the duration of the | |||
interrogation/interview. | interrogation/interview. | |||
(c) The interrogators/JIIF personnel will | (c) The interrogators/JIIF personnel will | |||
coordinate with the JDOG for the support of an | coordinate with the JDOG for the support of an | |||
additional MP to accompany them. | additional guard to accompany them. | |||
(d) The detainee will be moved in the following | (d) The detainee will be moved in the following | |||
manner: | manner: | |||
(-) The entry gate will be closed. | (-) The entry gate will be closed. | |||
(-) The detainee will be cuffed and shackled. | (-) The detainee will be cuffed and shackled. | |||
(-) The detainee will be escorted by two MPs to | (-) Two guards will escort the detainee to the | |||
the adjacent building. | adjacent building. | |||
(-) The small room will be utilized. | (-) The small room will be utilized. | |||
(-) The detainee will be uncuffed at the request | (-) The detainee will be uncuffed at the request | |||
of the interrogator. | of the interrogator. | |||
(-) Shackles will not be removed. | (-) Shackles will not be removed. | |||
(-) One MP will position himself/herself outside | (-) One guard will position himself/herself | |||
the entrance to the room being utilized. The other MP | outside the entrance to the room being utilized. The | |||
will be positioned outside at the rear door of the room | other guard will be positioned outside at the rear door | |||
being utilized. The third MP will remain inside the | of the room being utilized. The third guard will remain | |||
block as security for the detainees remaining within | inside the block as security for the detainees remaining | |||
their cells. | within their cells. | |||
(-) Only one detainee will be out of his cell at a | (-) Only one detainee will be out of his cell at a | |||
time. | time. | |||
(-) If more than one interview is going to be | (-) If more than one interview is going to be | |||
conducted, the first interview will be completed in its | conducted, the first interview will be completed in its | |||
entirety before the second interview commences. | entirety before the second interview commences. | |||
10-10. Use Of The Television | 10-10. Use Of The Television | |||
a. The television is there for the enjoyment of the | a. The television is there for the enjoyment of the | |||
MPs and Brig personnel on duty. | guards and Brig personnel on duty. | |||
b. Between the hours of 2200 and 0600, the | b. Between the hours of 2200 and 0600, the | |||
television will be moved to an area in the vicinity of | television will be moved to an area in the vicinity of | |||
the shower (outside the gate). | the shower (outside the gate). | |||
c. The volume will be at the lowest level possible to | c. The volume will be at the lowest level possible to | |||
be heard by the MP’s and Brig personnel but not loud | be heard by the guards and Brig personnel but not loud | |||
enough to disturb the detainees. | enough to disturb the detainees. | |||
Chapter 11 | Chapter 11 | |||
Escort Operations | Escort Operations | |||
11-1. General | 11-1. General | |||
Escorts provide two missions within Camp Delta. The | a. Escort Operations provide two missions in Camp | |||
first mission is to provide MPs for the movement of | Delta. The first mission provides escorts for the | |||
detainees within Camp Delta for JIIF, Medical, and | movement of detainees for JIIF, Medical and ICRC | |||
ICRC appointments and block transfers. The second | appointments and block transfers. The second mission | |||
mission is to provide MPs for escort of all personnel | provides escorts for all personnel entering Camp Delta | |||
entering Camp Delta who require escorted access to the | who require escorted access. | |||
facility. | b. Those assigned to the escort detail must be | |||
available for the whole shift. | ||||
c. All use of escorts will be coordinated through | ||||
Escort Control. | ||||
d. Any detainee transported outside of Camp Delta | ||||
will have an E-5 assigned, in addition to normal escort | ||||
requirements. | ||||
11-2. Escort Control | 11-2. Escort Control | |||
a. Description: Serves as the central control facility | a. Description: Serves as the central control facility | |||
for all escorts assigned to Camp Delta. All escorts | for all escorts assigned to Camp Delta. All escorts | |||
report movement to Escort Control via secure radio or | report movement to Escort Control via saber radio or | |||
telephone based on the type of escort. | telephone, based on the type/location of escort. | |||
b. Staffing: Escort Control is staffed with a | b. Staffing: Escort Control is staffed with a | |||
minimum of two personnel familiar with Escort | minimum of two personnel familiar with Escort | |||
Operations. However, between the hours of 0700-1800, | Operations. However, between the hours of 0700-1800, | |||
the staff should be augmented by one additional staff | the staff should be augmented by one additional staff | |||
member to assist with heighten daytime escort | member to assist with heighten daytime escort | |||
requirements. | requirements. | |||
c. Escort Management: Escort control is | c. Escort Management: Escort control is responsible | |||
responsible for coordinating all escort operations | for coordinating all escort operations within Camp | |||
within Camp Delta. Escort control will maintain a | Delta except those involving distinguished visitors or | |||
tracking board that displays the status and location of | the media. Escort control will maintain a tracking | |||
all escort teams within Camp Delta. Escort control | board that displays the status and location of all escort | |||
personnel will call for a status check with all escort | teams within Camp Delta. Escort control personnel | |||
teams at least every 30 minutes to verify location and | will call for a status check with all escort teams at least | |||
status of all escort teams. Escort control will | every 30 minutes to verify location and status of all | |||
coordinate the assignment of escort teams to escort | escort teams. Escort control will coordinate the | |||
missions based on current mission requirements and | assignment of escort teams to escort missions based on | |||
ensures that the priority of support doesn’t conflict | current mission requirements and ensures that the | |||
with the CJDOG commander’s intent. With the | priority of support doesn’t conflict with the CJDOG | |||
consent of the on-duty CO, escort control can re-task | commander’s intent. With the consent of the on-duty | |||
escort teams as necessary to support the CJDOG’s | CO, escort control can re-task escort teams as | |||
intent. | necessary to support the CJDOG’s intent. | |||
d. Escort control will receive a schedule from the | ||||
ICE for the next day’s interrogation plan. Escort | ||||
control will review the list for any items outside the | ||||
normal operating parameters. The normal operating | ||||
parameters are no more than five escorts in any one- | ||||
hour block of time and a minimal amount of escorts | ||||
during guard chow times and shift changes. | ||||
e. Escort control will receive any planned escorts | ||||
required for detainee transfer to NAVBASE Hospital | ||||
the day prior from Detention Hospital personnel. | ||||
Escort Control in coordination with DOC personnel | ||||
will ensure that the unit tasked to provide armed | ||||
escorts for this mission report 30 minutes prior and are | ||||
at the designated location on time. | ||||
f. Escort control, when notified by ICRC personnel | ||||
through the DOC, will dispatch escort teams for the | ||||
ICRC to SP 1 to greet the ICRC representative upon | ||||
arrival. | ||||
g. At the beginning of an escort team shift, Escort | ||||
Control personnel will issue out radios and escort team | ||||
call signs. At the end of the escort teams’ shift, Escort | ||||
Control will collect all radios. | ||||
11-3. Priority Of Escorts. | 11-3. Priority Of Escorts. | |||
The CJDOG establishes the priority of escorts based on | The CJDOG establishes the priority of escorts based on | |||
mission and available resources. The normal priority | mission and available resources. The normal priority | |||
for escorts is: | for escorts is: | |||
a. JIIF. | a. JIIF. | |||
b. ICRC. | b. ICRC. | |||
c. Medical. | c. Medical. | |||
d. Contractor. | d. Contractor. | |||
e. Detainee block transfers. | e. Detainee block transfers. | |||
11-4. Escort Teams | 11-4. Escort Teams | |||
a. Escorts are broken into two distinct groups. | a. Escorts are broken into two distinct groups. | |||
Group one provides escort teams typically to detainees | Group one provides escort teams typically to detainees | |||
within Camp Delta involving block transfers or moving | within Camp Delta involving block transfers or moving | |||
to appointments at JIIF or Medical. Group Two | to appointments at JIIF or Medical. Group Two | |||
provides MPs to escort teams who are not authorized | provides guards to escort teams who are not authorized | |||
unaccompanied access to Camp Delta. Typically, these | unaccompanied access to Camp Delta. | |||
escorts involve two groups of people either the | ||||
International Committee of the Red Cross or Contract | ||||
Workers making improvements or repairs within Camp | ||||
Delta. | ||||
GROUP ONE GROUP TWO | GROUP ONE GROUP TWO | |||
Who Detainees Escorted Personnel | Who Detainees Escorted Personnel | |||
Why JIIF | Why JIIF | |||
Medical | Medical | |||
Block Transfers | Block Transfers | |||
ICRC | ICRC | |||
Contractors | Contractors | |||
DV Personnel | DV Personnel | |||
Table 11-1 | ||||
b. Detainee Escorts. Group 1 Escorts typically | b. Detainee Escorts. Group 1 Escorts typically | |||
involve two types of escort missions. Each type of | involve two types of escort missions. Each type of | |||
escort mission is explained below. | escort mission is explained below. | |||
(1) JIIF Escort. These escorts are responsible for | (1) JIIF Escort. These escorts are responsible for | |||
moving detainees for appointments with the Joint | moving detainees for appointments with the Joint | |||
Interrogation Facility. These escorts are staged in the | Interrogation Facility. These escorts are staged in the | |||
Brown Bldg located in the JIIF and are notified by | Brown Bldg located in the JIIF and are notified by | |||
Escort Control when needed to escort a detainee to the | Escort Control when needed to escort a detainee to the | |||
JIIF. The process follows these steps: | JIIF. The escort team is also responsible for | |||
completing the Interrogation Support Form and | ||||
PSYOPS Spot Report when applicable. The process | ||||
follows these steps: | ||||
STEPS: | STEPS: | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
TEAM | TEAM | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
CONTROL | CONTROL | |||
Interrogator reports to escort control and | Interrogator reports to escort control and | |||
STEPS: | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
TEAM | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
CONTROL | ||||
notifies escort control of integration. | notifies escort control of integration. | |||
Escort control assigns the Interrogator an | Escort control assigns the Interrogator an | |||
Interrogation booth based on the | Interrogation booth based on the | |||
Interrogator’s needs and organization. | Interrogator’s needs and organization. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Interrogator departs for interrogation | Interrogator departs for interrogation | |||
booth and prepares for interrogation. | booth and prepares for interrogation. | |||
Escort control assigns a JIIF escort team | Escort control assigns a JIIF escort team | |||
to pickup the detainee and calls the | to pickup the detainee and calls the | |||
escort team to escort control via secure | escort team to escort control via secure | |||
skipping to change at line 4568 | skipping to change at line 5341 | |||
Escort team secures detainee from cell. √ | Escort team secures detainee from cell. √ | |||
Escort team calls escort control and | Escort team calls escort control and | |||
reports beginning of escort. | reports beginning of escort. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the start of escort on | Escort control logs the start of escort on | |||
escort control log. | escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | |||
departure from block and gives new head | departure from block and gives new head | |||
count to DOC. | count to DOC. | |||
STEPS: | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
TEAM | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
CONTROL | ||||
Escort team secures detainee in the | Escort team secures detainee in the | |||
interrogation booth. | interrogation booth. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team reports to escort control | Escort team reports to escort control | |||
completion of escort via secure radio. | completion of escort via secure radio. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team returns to escort control and | Escort team returns to escort control and | |||
turns-in shackles and place detainee ID | turns-in shackles and place detainee ID | |||
card in the appropriate slot on the | card in the appropriate slot on the | |||
interrogation bldg board. | interrogation bldg board. | |||
√ √ | √ √ | |||
Interrogator completes interrogation. | Interrogator completes interrogation. | |||
Interrogator reports to escort control that | Interrogator reports to escort control that | |||
the interrogation is complete. | the interrogation is complete. | |||
Escort control assigns a JIIF escort team | Escort control assigns a JIIF escort team | |||
to pickup the detainee and calls the | to pickup the detainee and calls the | |||
escort team to escort control via secure | escort team to escort control via secure | |||
radio on channel 4. | radio on channel 4. | |||
√ | √ | |||
STEPS: | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
TEAM | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
CONTROL | ||||
The escort team reports to escort control | The escort team reports to escort control | |||
and draws shackles and receives an | and draws shackles and receives an | |||
escort briefing which includes the | escort briefing which includes the | |||
following: | following: | |||
Current location of detainee | Current location of detainee | |||
(interrogation booth) | (interrogation booth) | |||
Location of cell | Location of cell | |||
Special instructions | Special instructions | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team moves to pickup detainee. √ | Escort team moves to pickup detainee. √ | |||
skipping to change at line 4626 | skipping to change at line 5398 | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the completion of | Escort control logs the completion of | |||
escort on escort control log. | escort on escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | |||
arrival from interrogation and gives new | arrival from interrogation and gives new | |||
head count to DOC. | head count to DOC. | |||
Escort team returns to escort control and | Escort team returns to escort control and | |||
turns-in shackles. | turns-in shackles. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Table 11-2 | ||||
(2) Medical Escort. These escorts are responsible | (2) Medical Escort. These escorts are responsible | |||
for moving detainees for appointments with the | for moving detainees for appointments with the | |||
Detainee Clinic located outside Sally Port 3. At 0830 | Detainee Clinic located outside Sally Port 3. At 0830 | |||
hours, one medical escort team will report to the | hours, one medical escort team will report to the | |||
Detention Hospital. At 1000, two more teams will | Detention Hospital. At 1000, two more teams will | |||
report to the Detention Hospital. These teams will be | report to the Detention Hospital. These teams will be | |||
dispatched by the Detention Hospital and will maintain | dispatched by the Detention Hospital and will maintain | |||
contact with Escort Control. These escorts are staged | contact with Escort Control. The escort team will stay | |||
in the Detainee Clinic and are notified by medical | with the detainee at all times unless properly relieved, | |||
personnel when needed to escort a detainee to the | he is returned to the block, or admitted to the Detention | |||
medical. The process typically follows these steps: | Hospital. These escorts are staged in the Detainee | |||
Clinic and are notified by medical personnel when | ||||
needed to escort a detainee to the medical. The process | ||||
typically follows these steps: | ||||
STEPS: | STEPS: | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
TEAM | TEAM | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
CONTROL | CONTROL | |||
Medical personnel notify escort control | Medical personnel notify escort control | |||
STEPS: | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
TEAM | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
CONTROL | ||||
of medical escort requirement via phone. | of medical escort requirement via phone. | |||
Escort control assigns a medical escort | Escort control assigns a medical escort | |||
team to pickup the detainee and calls the | team to pickup the detainee and calls the | |||
escort team via secure radio on channel | escort team via secure radio on channel | |||
4. | ||||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team moves to pickup detainee. √ | Escort team moves to pickup detainee. √ | |||
Escort control notifies DOC of medical | Escort control notifies DOC of medical | |||
escort. | escort. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team secures detainee from cell. √ | Escort team secures detainee from cell. √ | |||
Escort team calls escort control and | Escort team calls escort control and | |||
reports beginning of escort. | reports beginning of escort. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the start of escort on | Escort control logs the start of escort on | |||
skipping to change at line 4685 | skipping to change at line 5467 | |||
Escort team reports to escort control the | Escort team reports to escort control the | |||
completion of escort. | completion of escort. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the completion of | Escort control logs the completion of | |||
escort on escort control log. | escort on escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | Block NCO notifies DOC of detainee | |||
arrival from medical and gives new head | arrival from medical and gives new head | |||
count to DOC. | count to DOC. | |||
Escort team returns to medical. √ | Escort team returns to medical. √ | |||
Table 11-3 | ||||
(3) Block Transfers. The DOC will direct on a | (3) Block Transfers. The DOC will direct on a | |||
regular basis the movement of detainees from one | regular basis the movement of detainees from one | |||
block to another. General escorts will normally be | block to another. The DOC will give the escort control | |||
used to accomplish these escorts. The DOC will give | a list of detainees that require movement during the | |||
the escort control a list of detainees that require | coming shift. The escort NCOIC will ensure the timely | |||
movement during the coming shift. The escort NCOIC | execution of these cells movements by using general | |||
escorts. | ||||
will ensure the timely execution of these cells | ||||
movements by using general escorts. | ||||
c. Accompanied Access Escorts. Group 2 escorts | c. Accompanied Access Escorts. Group 2 escorts | |||
typically involve three types of escort missions. Each | typically involve three types of escort missions. Each | |||
type of escort mission is explained below. | type of escort mission is explained below. | |||
(1) Contractor Escorts. Contractor escorts are | (1) Contractor Escorts. Contractor escorts are | |||
necessary when personnel need access to Camp Delta | necessary when personnel need access to Camp Delta | |||
facilities in order to conduct maintenance or | facilities in order to conduct maintenance or | |||
improvements. Escorts control will work closely with | improvements. Escorts control will work closely with | |||
sally ports in order to understand and manage | sally ports in order to understand and manage | |||
contractor escort requirements. If there is an unused | contractor escort requirements. The escorts will not | |||
contractor escort, they will stage at Sally Port 1. The | allow any vehicle to be left unattended with the motor | |||
escorts will not allow any vehicle to be left unattended | running. The process typically follows these steps: | |||
with the motor running. The process typically follows | ||||
these steps: | ||||
STEPS: | STEPS: | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
TEAM | TEAM | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
CONTROL | CONTROL | |||
Sally port 1 or 8 will notified escort | Sally port 1 or 8 will notified escort | |||
control concerning requirement for | control concerning requirement for | |||
contractor escort over secure radio on | contractor escort over secure radio on | |||
channel 4. | channel 4. | |||
Escort control will assign a general | Escort control will assign a general | |||
skipping to change at line 4746 | skipping to change at line 5525 | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team reports to escort control the | Escort team reports to escort control the | |||
completion of escort. | completion of escort. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the completion of | Escort control logs the completion of | |||
escort on escort control log. | escort on escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team will return to the brown | Escort team will return to the brown | |||
building and wait next mission. | building and wait next mission. | |||
√ | √ | |||
(2) ICRC Escort. ICRC escorts are available to | Table 11-4 | |||
escort ICRC personnel during their visitation and | (a) Contractor escorts will maintain visual | |||
interviews within Camp Delta. ICRC escorts are | contact on all contractors at all times. No contractor is | |||
dedicated to this mission and may not be used for any | allowed to move from one location to another without | |||
other escort mission. ICRC escorts are only required | an escort. | |||
with ICRC personnel are on ground in Cuba. ICRC | (b) Contractors are prohibited from having any | |||
escorts will not be required when ICRC is not present | direct contact with detainees. Immediately report any | |||
in Cuba. ICRC escorts are required are managed | communication between a contractor and detainee to | |||
through escort control. ICRC provides a list of | the SOG and DOC. Identify and detain the | |||
detainees that they would like to visit typically 24 | contractor(s) involved immediately. | |||
hours prior to visit. ICRC escorts are usually staged | (c) Be aware of suspicious activity such as | |||
out of the brown bldg until called upon by escort | drawing maps, non-verbal signals to other individuals, | |||
control. ICRC escort team is composed of three MPs | and leaving tools and other equipment behind. | |||
unlikely most escort teams which are only composed of | Immediately report any suspicious activity to the SOG | |||
two MPs. These escorts should be ready at all times. | and DOC. Identify and detainee the contractor(s) | |||
ICRC escorts typically follow the following process: | involved immediately. | |||
(d) Ensure no equipment, tools, or other items are | ||||
left behind at the work site once work is complete. | ||||
(e) Notify the DOC at the start of the escort the | ||||
destination and then notify the DOC for any change in | ||||
location or the completion of the escort. | ||||
(f) Escorts, when the contractor arrives, will ask | ||||
for the number of separate work locations to ensure the | ||||
proper number of escorts is on hand. | ||||
(g) Contractor escorts will not permit contractors | ||||
to park next to any outside perimeter fence. | ||||
(2) ICRC Escort. Escorts will be designated as | ||||
ICRC escorts and are available to escort ICRC | ||||
personnel during their visitation and interviews within | ||||
Camp Delta. ICRC escorts are dedicated to this | ||||
mission and may not be used for any other escort | ||||
mission. ICRC escorts are only required with ICRC | ||||
personnel are on ground in Cuba. ICRC escorts will | ||||
not be required when ICRC is not present in Cuba. | ||||
ICRC escorts are required are managed through escort | ||||
control. ICRC provides a list of detainees that they | ||||
would like to visit 24 hours prior to visit. ICRC | ||||
escorts are usually staged out of the brown bldg until | ||||
called upon by escort control. ICRC escort team is | ||||
composed of three guards unlikely most escort teams | ||||
which are only composed of two guards. These escorts | ||||
should be ready at all times. ICRC escorts typically | ||||
follow the following process: | ||||
STEPS: | STEPS: | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
TEAM | TEAM | |||
ESCORT | ESCORT | |||
CONTROL | CONTROL | |||
ICRC will call the DOC and notify them | ICRC will call the DOC and notify them | |||
that they are enroute to Sally Port 1. | that they are enroute to Sally Port 1. | |||
DOC will notify Escort Control. | DOC will notify Escort Control. | |||
Escort control will assign an ICRC | Escort control will assign an ICRC | |||
escort team to the mission. | escort team to the mission. | |||
skipping to change at line 4793 | skipping to change at line 5600 | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort control logs the start of escort on | Escort control logs the start of escort on | |||
escort control log. | escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
Escort team conducts escort mission. √ | Escort team conducts escort mission. √ | |||
Escort team returns to Sally Port 1 with | Escort team returns to Sally Port 1 with | |||
ICRC representatives. | ICRC representatives. | |||
√ | √ | |||
ICRC leaves Camp Delta through Sally | ICRC leaves Camp Delta through Sally | |||
Port 1. | Port 1. | |||
Escort team reports to escort control the | Escort team reports to escort control the √ | |||
STEPS: | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
TEAM | ||||
ESCORT | ||||
CONTROL | ||||
completion of escort. | completion of escort. | |||
√ | ||||
Escort control logs the completion of | Escort control logs the completion of | |||
escort on escort control log. | escort on escort control log. | |||
√ | √ | |||
11-5. Vehicle Usage | Table 11-5 | |||
a. Teams will utilize Gators or Golf Carts when | d. Upon the approach of any Distinguished Visitor | |||
moving detainees from Camp II or Camp IV for | (DV), an escort team moving a detainee will stop | |||
movement and face the detainee away from the passing | ||||
DV. Once the DV or DV party has passed, the escort | ||||
team will resume movement of the detainee. | ||||
11-5. Vehicle Usage/Gators | ||||
a. Teams will utilize Gators when transporting | ||||
detainees from Camp II, III or Camp IV for | ||||
appointments in Medical or JIIF. The keys for the | appointments in Medical or JIIF. The keys for the | |||
Gators and Golf Carts will be maintained in escort | Gators will be maintained in escort control. | |||
control. | b. Only escorts for detainees going to reservation | |||
b. Only JIIF escorts will use golf carts. | will use Gators. | |||
c. Gators will be used for any escort mission. The | c. Gators will be used for any escort mission. The | |||
SOG also can use them to move bulk items. | SOG also can use them to move bulk items. | |||
d. Gators and golf carts will be utilized in Camp | d. Gators will be utilized in Camp Delta only. | |||
Delta only. | e. Gators will not be operated in excess of 5 MPH. | |||
e. Gators and golf carts will not be operated in | f. Gator occupancy will not exceed 4 personnel. | |||
excess of 5 MPH. | will be kept clean and free of trash and debris. | |||
g. Gators will be topped off at the end of each shift. | ||||
f. Gators and golf carts will be kept clean and free | h. Sundays from 1400-1700, SOG 3 will ensure | |||
of trash and debris. | Gators have been washed and cleaned of debris and | |||
g. Gators and golf carts will be topped off at the end | trash. | |||
of each shift. | i. Maintenance issues will be brought to the | |||
h. Gator and golf cart keys will be maintained in the | ||||
Escort Control when not in use. | ||||
i. COs will inspect the vehicle logbook at the end | ||||
of the duty week. | ||||
j. Maintenance issues will be brought to the | ||||
attention of the JDOG S-3. | attention of the JDOG S-3. | |||
j. Gators will only be “combat” parked in the | ||||
designated area near the Medical Gate. | ||||
k. To load or unload a detainee, move the Gator to | ||||
loading area. After unloading the detainee and moving | ||||
him to their destination, the escort team will return to | ||||
properly park the Gator. | ||||
l. One member of the team will sit in the rear of the | ||||
Gator with his arm across the detainee and hold onto | ||||
the side of the Gator to secure him in place during | ||||
transport. | ||||
11-6. Equipment Maintenance | 11-6. Equipment Maintenance | |||
Escort teams assigned duty during midnight shift will | Escort teams assigned duty during midnight shift will | |||
conduct PMCS of all escort equipment to include | conduct PMCS of all escort equipment to include | |||
shackles, golf carts and gators. The midnight shift | shackles, Gators. The midnight shift Escort Control | |||
Escort Control NCOIC should be sure that PMCS is | NCOIC should be sure that PMCS is completed and | |||
completed and noted in the DOC Staff Journal. | noted in the DOC Staff Journal. | |||
11-7. Communications | 11-7. Communications | |||
Communications between Escort Control and Escort | Communications between Escort Control and Escort | |||
Teams will management primarily over secure radios | Teams will management primarily over secure radios | |||
on Channel 4. Escort Control Call Sign will be Escort | on Channel 4. Escort Control Call Sign will be Escort | |||
Control. Escort Teams will be assigned a call sign | Control. Escort Teams will be assigned a call sign | |||
based on the following matrix. | based on the following matrix. | |||
Escort Teams: Call Sign: | Escort Teams: Call Sign: | |||
Medical Escorts | ||||
Medical Escort 1 Mike 1 | ||||
Medical Escort 2 Mike 2 | ||||
Medical Escort 3 Mike 3 | ||||
Medical Escort 4 Mike 4 | ||||
Medical Escort 5 Mike 5 | ||||
General Escorts | General Escorts | |||
General Escort 1 Golf 1 | General Escort 1 Golf 1 | |||
General Escort 2 Golf 2 | General Escort 2 Golf 2 | |||
General Escort 3 Golf 3 | General Escort 3 Golf 3 | |||
General Escort 4 Golf 4 | General Escort 4 Golf 4 | |||
General Escort 5 Golf 5 | General Escort 5 Golf 5 | |||
JIIF Escorts | General Escort 6 Golf 6 | |||
JIIF Escort 1 Echo 1 | General Escort 7 Golf 7 | |||
JIIF Escort 2 Echo 2 | General Escort 8 Golf 8 | |||
JIIF Escort 3 Echo 3 | General Escort 9 Golf 9 | |||
JIIF Escort 4 Echo 4 | General Escort 10 Golf 10 | |||
JIIF Escort 5 Echo 5 | General Escort 11 Golf 11 | |||
JIIF Escort 6 Echo 6 | General Escort 12 Golf 12 | |||
JIIF Escort 7 Echo 7 | General Escort 13 Golf 13 | |||
ICRC Escorts | General Escort 14 Golf 14 | |||
ICRC Escort 1 India 1 | General Escort 15 Golf 15 | |||
ICRC Escort 2 India 2 | General Escort 16 Golf 16 | |||
ICRC Escort 3 India 3 | General Escort 17 Golf 17 | |||
General Escort 18 Golf 18 | ||||
General Escort 19 Golf 19 | ||||
General Escort 20 Golf 20 | ||||
Table 11-6 | ||||
11-8. Distinguished Visitors | 11-8. Distinguished Visitors | |||
COs escort all distinguished visitors inside the Camp | COs escort all distinguished visitors inside Camp | |||
Delta complex. If the visitor is military, it will be for | Delta. If the visitor is military, it will be for grade O-5 | |||
grade O-5 and above. This will not include PAO tours. | and above. This will not include PAO tours. | |||
11-9. NAVBASE Hospital Escorts | 11-9. NAVBASE Hospital Escorts | |||
a. A two-man team from day shift will man the | a. A two-person team will escort detainees to the | |||
hospital escorts. This team will be on call for 24 hours. | NAVBASE Hospital Detainee Acute Care Unit | |||
Upon notification, the team will go to Camp Delta to | (DACU) for treatment. These escorts will not exceed | |||
draw equipment and to be briefed. | four hours in length. | |||
b. Escort to the NAVBASE Hospital will be | b. Escorts will consist of one MP armed with a | |||
executed using 2:1 ratio with one MP armed with a | 9mm pistol, 5 rounds of ammunition and OC pepper. | |||
9mm sidearm, and both MPs armed with OC Pepper | The other MP will carry OC pepper and key to | |||
Spray. | restraints. | |||
c. Weapons will be stored at the hospital upon | c. Weapons will be stored at the hospital upon | |||
arrival. | arrival IAW NAVBASE Security Force SOP. | |||
d. MP hospital escort teams will: | d. Escort Responsibilities: | |||
(1) Search the interior of the ambulance prior to | 1. Search the interior, exterior and | |||
the detainee being placed inside. | undercarriage of the ambulance prior to | |||
(2) Check the exterior and under-carriage of the | detainee being placed inside | |||
ambulance prior to the ambulance being moved. | 2. Maintain continuous observation of the | |||
(3) Maintain continuous observation of the | ambulance, following the search until the completion | |||
ambulance following the search until completion of the | of the move. | |||
move. | e. When escorts are traveling to pick up a detainee | |||
e. When the MP hospital escort team is traveling to | already at NAVBASE Hospital, or returning to Camp | |||
pick up a detainee already at the NAVBASE Hospital, | Delta after dropping off a detainee at NAVBASE, it | |||
or returning to Camp Delta after dropping off a | remains the escorts’ responsibility to search the | |||
detainee at the NAVBASE Hospital, it remains the MP | interior, exterior and undercarriage of the ambulance | |||
hospital escort team’s responsibility to search the | prior to entering or exiting Camp Delta. | |||
interior and exterior of the ambulance prior to exiting | f. If a detainee’s appointment or medical treatment | |||
or entering Camp Delta. If continual observation of the | requires them to remain at NAVBASE longer than 4 | |||
ambulance is lost following the search and before | hours, then the Detainee Acute Care Unit (DACU) will | |||
entering or exiting Camp Delta, the MP hospital escort | cover the mission. | |||
team will conduct another full search of the ambulance | g. DACU Security Force will consist of one NCO | |||
before proceeding through any sally port. | and two soldiers. The mission may require this | |||
position to be manned 24 hours 7 days a week or | ||||
however long medical attention is needed at the | ||||
facility, to be determined by competent medical | ||||
authority. Extended stays will be broken down into (3) | ||||
eight-hour shifts and manned accordingly. | ||||
h. DACU Security Force will report to the DOC | ||||
prior to assuming duties to sign for equipment and | ||||
receive briefing. When relieved of duties, DACU | ||||
escorts will report to the DOC and return any | ||||
equipment and turn in any reports required and conduct | ||||
debriefing. | ||||
i. DACU Escort will have security responsibilities for | ||||
the detainee hospital room area, and any areas the | ||||
detainee would receive treatment. One DACU Escort | ||||
will also maintain visual contact inside the area where | ||||
the detainee is located. At a minimum, one DACU | ||||
Escort will be posted at the outside entrance of the | ||||
detainees’ location while in the hospital. The third | ||||
DACU Escort will provide breaks and assist with other | ||||
support for this mission. | ||||
j. For any emergency situations the DACU Escorts will | ||||
follow established SOP’s of NAVBASE Hospital | ||||
Security Force. It is the responsibility of the DACU | ||||
Escorts to review and comply with all postings. | ||||
k. While performing duties at the NAVBASE Hospital | ||||
the DACU Escorts will maintain communication, | ||||
primary long-range saber radio and secondary, landline | ||||
telephone to the DOC. | ||||
Chapter 12 | Chapter 12 | |||
Detainee Property | Detainee Property | |||
12-1. Authorized Personnel | 12-1. Authorized Personnel | |||
a. Personnel authorized to receipt, issue, and store | a. Personnel authorized to receipt, issue, and store | |||
detainee property must be designated on a | detainee property must be designated on a | |||
memorandum from the CJDOG. Personnel designated | memorandum from the CJDOG. Personnel designated | |||
must be in the grade of E-7 or above and shall be the | must be in the grade of E-7 or above and shall be the | |||
only personnel allowed access into the detainee | only personnel allowed access into the detainee | |||
Property Storage Room. | Property Storage Room. | |||
skipping to change at line 4966 | skipping to change at line 5815 | |||
Chapter 13 | Chapter 13 | |||
Detainee Mail Operations | Detainee Mail Operations | |||
13-1. Types Of Mail | 13-1. Types Of Mail | |||
a. Ordinary Mail. Normal incoming mail processed | a. Ordinary Mail. Normal incoming mail processed | |||
through the Washington D.C. postal address not | through the Washington D.C. postal address not | |||
deemed to be from the ICRC or Legal mail. | deemed to be from the ICRC or Legal mail. | |||
b. ICRC Mail. Mail that is written in the presence | b. ICRC Mail. Mail that is written in the presence | |||
of an ICRC representative, handled through the ICRC, | of an ICRC representative, handled through the ICRC, | |||
and delivered by ICRC representatives. The mail | and delivered by ICRC representatives. The mail | |||
section only translates and screens the mail. | section only translates and JDOG S-2 screens the mail. | |||
c. Legal Mail. Mail that is obviously from a | c. Legal Mail. Mail that is obviously from a | |||
lawyer, court, or other legal representative. | lawyer, court, or other legal representative. | |||
d. Incoming. Mail that is sent from an outside party | d. Incoming. Mail that is sent from an outside party | |||
to a detainee. | to a detainee. | |||
e. Outgoing. Mail that a detainee writes. | e. Outgoing. Mail that a detainee writes. | |||
f. Hold/File. Mail that is designated to be placed | 13-2. Definitions | |||
only in a detainee’s mail file and passed on for | a. Highview. The Operating System used to | |||
screening purposes. Will not be sent out or given to | manipulate DOCEX [Possible Document Exploitation] | |||
the detainee. | throughout the detainee mail dissemination process. | |||
13-2. Incoming Mail | This system simplifies the scanning, filing, retrieving, | |||
routing, and processing of Detainee Mail. | ||||
b. DMPC. The Detainee Mail Processing Center. A | ||||
function of JDOG S-1. | ||||
13-3. Incoming Mail | ||||
a. Every time anyone handles ordinary incoming | a. Every time anyone handles ordinary incoming | |||
mail, they should wear latex gloves to protect against | mail, they should wear latex gloves to protect against | |||
any chemical hazard on the envelopes or letters. All | any chemical hazard on the envelopes or letters. All | |||
mail is irradiated against biological hazards, but this | mail is irradiated against biological hazards, but this | |||
may not protect against chemical hazards. | may not protect against chemical hazards. | |||
b. When Incoming mail is received at the JTF APO | b. When Incoming mail is received at the JTF APO | |||
or postal room, the NCOIC of the postal room will call | or postal room, the NCOIC of the postal room will call | |||
the detainee mail section and notify the mail section of | the detainee mail section and notify the mail section of | |||
the arrival of mail. A representative of the detainee | the arrival of mail. A representative of the Detainee | |||
Mail Processing Center (DMPC) will then go to the | Mail Processing Center (DMPC) will then go to the | |||
mailroom to pick up the mail. The representative will | mailroom to pick up the mail. The representative will | |||
count and verify the correct number of incoming mail | count and verify the correct number of incoming mail | |||
items. The representative from the detainee mail | items. The representative from the detainee mail | |||
section will then sign for the incoming mail. Detainees | section will then sign for the incoming mail. Detainees | |||
are not authorized to receive anything other than flat | are not authorized to receive anything other than flat | |||
letters weighing less than one ounce. All postal units | letters weighing less than one ounce. All postal units | |||
have been told any other items will be immediately | have been told any other items will be immediately | |||
returned to the sender. | returned to the sender. | |||
c. The mail will then be entered into the detainee | c. The mail will then be entered into the detainee | |||
mail-tracking database, Mail Management System | mail-tracking database, DOCEX. | |||
(MMS). | ||||
d. The Alpha Numeric Code representing the | d. The Alpha Numeric Code representing the | |||
sequence number of the detainee that the mail is | sequence number of the detainee that the mail is | |||
addressed to is entered into the MMS. As each item is | addressed to is entered into DOCEX. As each item is | |||
entered into the MMS, it is assigned a mail item | entered into DOCEX, it is assigned a mail item number | |||
number. This mail item number will be written on all | (Harmony number). This Harmony number will be | |||
items arriving in the mail and in the envelope. This | labeled on all items arriving in the mail and in the | |||
includes each page of the letter, any enclosures, and the | envelope. This includes each written page of the letter, | |||
envelope. (Example: I-001234) | any enclosures, and the envelope. (Example: | |||
e. After the mail is entered into the MMS, the | GUAN2003I-######DP) | |||
original mail item is copied. The original mail is | e. After the mail is entered into DOCEX, it will | |||
placed in the detainee’s incoming mail pending file. | then go through an Initial Review. A format is made | |||
The copies will be sent to the translators. After the | displaying the Harmony Number, Alpha Numeric | |||
copies of original incoming mail are placed in the | Code, Box Number/ICRC Number, Title, Primary | |||
detainee pending files, all work will be done with | Language, Security Classification, Document type, and | |||
copies of the mail. Any original photographs | Publication Country. After the Initial Review is | |||
accompanying the letters will be stapled to the final | completed, the electronic versions of the mail items are | |||
copy that will be delivered to the detainee. | then forwarded to Translation. The original documents | |||
f. The copy machine and work area must be wiped | are then delivered to Translation with an Incoming | |||
down and cleaned after each batch of incoming mail is | Mail Transmittal Sheet. The transmittal must be signed | |||
copied. This will ensure nothing is transferred from | for by the representative from the document translation | |||
detainee mail to any other items being copied. | section for permanent records (refer to section 13-10). | |||
g. After the mail is copied, it is transferred to | f. The DOCEX scanners and work area must be | |||
translation (refer to section 13-10). | wiped down and cleaned after each batch of incoming | |||
h. After translation, the copy is returned to the | mail is entered into DOCEX. This will ensure nothing | |||
detainee mail-processing center. Four copies of the | is transferred from detainee mail to any other items | |||
translation will be made. One copy of the translated | being scanned. | |||
mail will be placed in the detainee file. Three copies of | g. After translation, the original mail items are | |||
the mail will be transferred to the JDOG S-2 [Possible | returned to the detainee mail-processing center, and | |||
Document Exploitation (DOCEX)]. At this point, the | filed in a temporary file. The electronic version of the | |||
mail is entered into the computer as transferred to both | translation will be forwarded to both the JDOG S-2 for | |||
the JIG and to the JDOG S-2 for screening. | screening in DOCEX. | |||
i. A copy of the incoming mail will be given out to | h. A copy of the incoming mail will be given out to | |||
the detainee five days after screening by the JDOG | the detainee five days after screening by the JDOG S-2 | |||
JDOG S-2 personnel, unless contacted by the JDOG S- | personnel, unless contacted by the JDOG S-2 section to | |||
2 section to hold the mail for a specific reason. If the | hold the mail for a specific reason. The mail must be | |||
mail has been redacted, then a copy of the redacted | ||||
piece will be given to the detainee. The mail must be | ||||
entered into the computer as delivered to the detainee | entered into the computer as delivered to the detainee | |||
on the day it is given out to the detainee. | on the day it is given out to the detainee. | |||
j. The JDOG S-2 section will screen the mail as a | 13-4. Outgoing Mail | |||
group according to the transmittal record it is | ||||
transferred to the JDOG S-2 shop on. After screening, | ||||
a copy of this transmittal record will be given back to | ||||
the detainee Mail Processing section with the date the | ||||
mail is eligible for delivery to the detainee. If any | ||||
items are to be held or redacted, those items will also | ||||
be annotated on that transmittal record. | ||||
13-3. Outgoing Mail | ||||
a. Outgoing mail is collected by the detainee mail | a. Outgoing mail is collected by the detainee mail | |||
section daily IAW the mail collection schedule. This | section daily IAW the mail collection schedule. This | |||
schedule rotates collection between blocks and | schedule rotates collection between blocks and | |||
between types of outgoing mail. This schedule allows | between types of outgoing mail. This schedule allows | |||
the detainees to write four post cards (6” x 4” in size) | the detainees to write four post cards (6” x 4” in size) | |||
and two letters (single side of one piece of paper not | and two letters (single side of one piece of paper not | |||
larger than 8.5” x 11”) per month IAW AR 190-8, | larger than 8.5” x 11”) per month IAW AR 190-8, | |||
Section 3-5, page 7. Note: Per AR 190-8, para 3-5, | Section 3-5, page 7. Note: Per AR 190-8, para 3-5, | |||
sec f. (3), maps, sketches, and drawings are not | sec f. (3), maps, sketches, and drawings are not | |||
permitted in outgoing correspondences. A sample | permitted in outgoing correspondences. A sample | |||
schedule follows: | schedule follows: | |||
B L O C K S | B L O C K S | |||
Day Letters Postcards | Day Letters Postcards | |||
1 Wed | 1 Wed V W Y U | |||
2 Thu A T P Q R K | 2 Thu A T P Q R K | |||
3 Fri B M N O S | 3 Fri B M N O S | |||
4 Sat | 4 Sat W U Y V | |||
5 Sun | 5 Sun | |||
6 Mon C I K L T | 6 Mon C I K L T | |||
7 Tue Q M F G H | 7 Tue Q M F G H | |||
8 Wed R S C D E | 8 Wed R S C D E | |||
9 Thu Det Hosp G A B | 9 Thu | |||
Det | ||||
Hosp G A B | ||||
10 Fri D P Q R | 10 Fri D P Q R | |||
11 Sat | ||||
11 Sat V C U Y | ||||
12 Sun | 12 Sun | |||
13 Mon E M N O S | 13 Mon E M N O S | |||
14 Tue F N I K L T | 14 Tue F N I K L T | |||
15 Wed K O F G H | 15 Wed K O F G H | |||
16 Thu L P C D E | 16 Thu L P C D E | |||
17 Fri M T A B R | 17 Fri M T A B R | |||
18 Sat | 18 Sat V Y U W | |||
19 Sun | 19 Sun | |||
20 Mon G R P Q A S | 20 Mon G R P Q A S | |||
21 Tue H C M N O B | 21 Tue H C M N O B | |||
22 Wed I D K L T | 22 Wed I D K L T | |||
23 Thu N E F G H | 23 Thu N E F G H | |||
24 Fri O F C D | 24 Fri O F C D | |||
25 Sat | 25 Sat Y W V U | |||
26 Sun | 26 Sun | |||
27 Mon P Det Hosp A B I S | 27 Mon P | |||
Det | ||||
Hosp A B I S | ||||
28 Tue K H P Q R C | 28 Tue K H P Q R C | |||
29 Wed A I S M N O D | 29 Wed A I S M N O D | |||
30 Thu B K I L E T | 30 Thu B K I L E T | |||
31 Fri L Q F G H | 31 Fri L Q F G H | |||
Table 13-1 | ||||
b. If there is a situation that involves a security risk, | b. If there is a situation that involves a security risk, | |||
and the block is closed down for that specific time, the | and the block is closed down for that specific time, the | |||
mail clerk will be informed and that block will be | mail clerk will be informed and that block will be | |||
skipped for that rotation. | skipped for that rotation. | |||
c. Detainee mail clerks will take no more than five | c. Detainee mail clerks will take no more than five | |||
pens with black ink to the blocks at a time. The mail | pens with black ink to the blocks at a time. The mail | |||
clerks can allow up to five detainees to write at one | clerks can allow up to five detainees to write at one | |||
time. The mail clerk must closely observe the | time. The mail clerk must closely observe the | |||
detainees while they write the letter/post-card to ensure | detainees while they write the letter/post-card to ensure | |||
the detainee is not using the pen to write anything other | the detainee is not using the pen to write anything other | |||
than the letter/postcard. When leaving the block, the | than the letter/postcard. When leaving the block, the | |||
mail clerk and Block NCO will ensure all pens and | mail clerk and Block NCO will ensure all pens and | |||
materials are accounted for. | materials are accounted for. | |||
(1) Detainee Mail Clerks should attempt to wake | (1) Detainee Mail Clerks should attempt to wake | |||
up sleeping detainees and offer them a chance to write. | up sleeping detainees and offer them a chance to write. | |||
If a detainee refuses to write when he is offered his | If a detainee refuses to write when he is offered his | |||
chance, the mail clerk continues. If a detainee changes | chance, the mail clerk continues. If a detainee changes | |||
his mind after being offered an opportunity to write, he | his mind after being offered an opportunity to write, he | |||
will not be offered a second chance to write. | WILL NOT be offered a second chance to write. | |||
(2) If a detainee is praying, prayer should not be | (2) If a detainee is praying, prayer should not be | |||
interrupted in order to inform the detainee of the | interrupted in order to inform the detainee of the | |||
opportunity to write. However, if the detainee stops | opportunity to write. However, if the detainee stops | |||
praying on his own and the mail clerk is still in the | praying on his own and the mail clerk is still in the | |||
block, then the detainee should be offered the | block, then the detainee should be offered the | |||
opportunity to write. | opportunity to write. | |||
(3) Detainees are given 20 minutes per postcard | (3) Detainees are given 20 minutes per postcard | |||
and 30 minutes per letter. If a detainee takes longer | and 30 minutes per letter. If a detainee takes longer | |||
than this, he should be told to address the item and turn | than this, he should be told to address the item and turn | |||
it in. | it in. If a detainee refuses, he will be instructed to turn | |||
(4) If a detainee refuses, he will be instructed to | in the mail immediately or it will not be sent out. If he | |||
turn in the mail immediately or it will not be sent out. | still refuses, then it is up to the guards to retrieve the | |||
If he still refuses, then it is up to the MPs to retrieve the | ||||
mail and the pen in accordance with their operating | mail and the pen in accordance with their operating | |||
procedures. Mail clerks will complete an incident | procedures. Mail clerks will complete an incident | |||
report if this occurs. | report if this occurs. | |||
d. After the detainee mail clerk allows all detainees | (4) If a detainee declines the opportunity to write, | |||
scheduled to write that day, the mail is taken to the | ||||
detainee mail-processing center and entered into MMS. | ||||
As each letter is entered, the MMS assigns a mail item | ||||
number, an alphanumeric tracking number (Example: | ||||
T-001234). The mail item number must be written on | ||||
the lower left hand corner of both the letter and | ||||
envelope. For postcards, the mail item number will be | ||||
written on the upper left hand corner. | ||||
e. After the mail is processed into MMS, the mail is | ||||
copied and the original is placed into the detainee | ||||
outgoing mail pending file. Then the mail is | ||||
transferred to the linguist section for translation in the | ||||
same manner as incoming mail (refer to section 13-10). | ||||
f. If a detainee declines the opportunity to write, | ||||
this declination is documented on the daily mail | this declination is documented on the daily mail | |||
schedule. The mail schedules are kept in binders to | schedule. The mail schedules are kept in binders to | |||
document when each detainee was given an | document when each detainee was given an | |||
opportunity to write. | opportunity to write. | |||
g. After translation, the mail is transferred back to | d. After the detainee mail clerk allows all detainees | |||
the DMPC. Four copies of the translated mail will be | scheduled to write that day, the mail is taken to the | |||
made. One copy of the translated mail will be placed | detainee mail-processing center and entered into | |||
in the detainee file. Three copies of the mail will be | DOCEX. Each letter or postcard is given an Alpha | |||
transferred to the JDOG S-2 (DOCEX). At this point, | Numeric Code representing the sequence number of the | |||
the mail is entered into the computer as transferred to | detainee that wrote the letter or postcard, and DOCEX | |||
both the JIG and to the JDOG S-2 for screening. | assigns a mail item number (Harmony number) to the | |||
h. Mail is sent to the JTF-GTMO APO or Mail | letter or postcard (Example: GUAN2003T-######DP). | |||
Room (refer to section 13-10) for mailing five days | The Harmony number must be labeled on the lower left | |||
after being screened unless contacted by the JDOG S-2 | hand corner of both the letter and envelope. For | |||
section to hold the mail for a specific reason. The mail | postcards, the mail item number will be written on the | |||
must be entered into the computer as mailed on the day | upper right hand corner. | |||
it is transferred to the JTF Mailroom. | e. After the mail is processed into DOCEX, it will | |||
i. The JDOG S-2 section will screen the mail as a | then go through an Initial Review. A format is made | |||
group according to the transmittal record it is | displaying the Harmony Number, Alpha Numeric | |||
transferred to the JDOG S-2 section on. After | Code, Box Number/ICRC Number, Title, Primary | |||
screening, a copy of this transmittal record will be | Language, Security Classification, Document type, and | |||
given back to the detainee Mail section with the date | Publication Country. After the Initial Review is | |||
the mail is eligible for delivery to the JTF-GTMO mail | completed, the electronic versions of the mail items are | |||
room. If any items are to be held or redacted, those | then forwarded to Translation. The original documents | |||
items will also be annotated on that transmittal record. | are then delivered to Translation with an Outgoing | |||
13-4. ICRC Mail | Mail Transmittal Sheet. The transmittal must be signed | |||
and dated for by the representative from the document | ||||
translation section for permanent records. | ||||
f. After translation, the original mail items are | ||||
returned to the detainee mail-processing center, and | ||||
filed in a temporary file. The electronic version of the | ||||
translation will be forwarded to JDOG S-2 for | ||||
screening in DOCEX. | ||||
g. Mail is sent to the JTF-GTMO APO for mailing | ||||
five days after being screened, unless contacted by the | ||||
JDOG S-2 section to hold the mail for a specific | ||||
reason. The mail must be entered into the computer as | ||||
mailed on the day it is transferred to the JTF Mailroom. | ||||
h. Interrogators will conduct mail collection and | ||||
distribution for detainees on any level 5 blocks for all | ||||
mail except ICRC mail. When mail is received on | ||||
island and has been processed, the mail will be | ||||
forwarded to the JIFF for distribution to the detainee. | ||||
Interrogators will forward mail collected from a | ||||
detainee directly to the mail section for processing and | ||||
screening. | ||||
13-5. ICRC Mail | ||||
a. Ordinarily, ICRC mail is collected by | a. Ordinarily, ICRC mail is collected by | |||
representatives of the ICRC and transferred to the | representatives of the ICRC and transferred to the | |||
detainee mail section by the JDOG’s ICRC liaison. | detainee mail section by the JDOG’s ICRC liaison. | |||
The JDOG representative normally delivers the ICRC | The JDOG representative normally delivers the ICRC | |||
mail to the detainee mail section. | mail to the detainee mail section. | |||
b. If the ICRC Rep wishes to document outgoing | b. The ICRC Rep will document outgoing pieces of | |||
pieces of mail prior to handing them over to the | mail prior to handing them over to the Detainee Mail | |||
detainee Mail Section a non-networked computer that | Section on a non-networked computer that has no | |||
has no sensitive information on it will be provided for | sensitive information on it. This will be done in the | |||
their use in the vicinity of the mail room. Under no | vicinity of the mail room. The ICRC Rep will assign | |||
circumstance may unscreened mail leave the detention | each ICRC mail piece an ICRC mail code. UNDER | |||
facility. Neither the ICRC Rep nor the JDOG liaison is | NO CIRCUMSTANCE MAY UNSCREENED MAIL | |||
LEAVE THE DETENTION FACILITY. Neither the | ||||
ICRC representative nor the JDOG liaison is | ||||
authorized to remove unscreened mail from the facility. | authorized to remove unscreened mail from the facility. | |||
c. When ICRC mail is delivered to the detainee mail | c. When ICRC mail is delivered to the detainee mail | |||
section, the mail must first be entered into MMS. After | section, the mail must first be entered into DOCEX. | |||
the mail is entered into MMS, it is transferred to the | ICRC mail enters DOCEX through the same process as | |||
linguist section for translation in the same manner | ordinary mail with the exception of Initial Review, | |||
ordinary mail is transferred. (Refer to section 13-10) | where the ICRC mail code is included with the format. | |||
d. When ICRC mail is returned from translation, it | After the mail is entered into DOCEX, it is transferred | |||
is forwarded to the JDOG S-2 for screening (DOCEX). | to the linguist section for translation in the same | |||
After screening ICRC mail, the JDOG S-2 will return | manner ordinary mail is transferred (Refer to section | |||
the mail to the detainee Mail Processing Center. | 13-3, 13-4). | |||
13-5. Cleared Mail | d. When ICRC mail is returned from translation, the | |||
Cleared mail will be stamped “Cleared by US Forces” | originals are placed into a temporary hold file and the | |||
on each page of a letter and on the back of | electronic versions are forwarded to the JDOG S-2 for | |||
photographs. Incoming ICRC mail will be returned to | screening [DOCEX]. | |||
the ICRC rep, while inside the detention facility, for | f. ICRC mail originals are returned to the ICRC | |||
delivery to the detainees. Outgoing mail will be | representative 5 days after being screened, unless | |||
returned to the ICRC rep for delivery at their expense. | contacted by the JDOG S-2 section to hold the mail for | |||
13-6. Redacted Mail | a specific reason. The mail must be entered into the | |||
A redacted copy will be stamped “Cleared by US | computer as transferred to ICRC on the day it is | |||
Forces” on each page and given to the ICRC rep for | transferred to the ICRC representative. | |||
them to deliver. A redacted copy, an unredacted | 13-6. Mail Screening | |||
translation, and the original letter will be placed in the | a. All mail will be processed through the DMPC | |||
detainee mail file. Only the redacted copy may be | then forwarded electronically to the JDOG S-2 for | |||
stamped with “Cleared by US Forces”. | screening. | |||
13-7. Held Mail | b. Cleared Mail. Mail that has been screened by | |||
JDOG S2, authorized delivery, and stamped with | ||||
JDOG S2 approved stamp controlled by S2. | ||||
c. Exploited/Forwarded mail. Any mail that has | ||||
been designated to have INTEL/OPSEC value beyond | ||||
the normal mail process will be notated in PINK and | ||||
disseminated appropriately. | ||||
d. Hold Mail. Mail that is deemed undeliverable for | ||||
Intelligence and/or OPSEC standards. Mail that is | ||||
designated to be placed only in a detainee’s mail file. | ||||
Hold Mail will be notated in YELLOW. If JDOG S-2 | ||||
places a permanent Hold on a piece of mail it will NOT | ||||
be sent out or given to the detainee (Refer to section | ||||
13-8). | ||||
e. Redacted mail. A redaction is to strike through, | ||||
cross out, or remove a portion of a letter or message | ||||
that violates Intelligence and/or OPSEC standards. | ||||
Redact Mail will be notated in ORANGE. | ||||
(1).Incoming mail redact. A copy of the original | ||||
mail item and a translation is made from DOCEX. The | ||||
front of the copy is annotated, “REDACT.” The | ||||
translation section to be redacted is noted in orange and | ||||
both the copy of the original mail item and the | ||||
translation are forwarded to translation. Once the | ||||
copies of the mail item return from translation, the | ||||
original mail item is logged out from the DMPC for | ||||
redaction. The redacted sections will be noted in | ||||
orange on the original mail item and a copy will be | ||||
made with the redacted sections marked out in either | ||||
black or blue ink. All ICRC will have the original | ||||
redacted according to policy. Once redaction is | ||||
completed, the mail item will be annotated in DOCEX | ||||
as “CLEARED-Redact Completed,” then logged back | ||||
into the DMPC for further processing (Refer to section | ||||
13-8). | ||||
(2).Outgoing mail redact. The outgoing mail | ||||
redaction process is conducted the same as for | ||||
incoming mail redaction (Refer to section 13-6e1). | ||||
13-7. Cleared Mail (DMPC) | ||||
a. Incoming mail. Cleared incoming mail will be | ||||
stamped “Approved by US Forces”* on each written | ||||
page of the letter and on the back of photographs. A | ||||
copy of the cleared letter will be delivered to the | ||||
detainee while the original letter and/or pictures are | ||||
placed into the detainee’s mail file (Refer to section 13- | ||||
3h). | ||||
b. Outgoing mail. Cleared outgoing mail will be | ||||
stamped “Approved by US Forces”* on each written | ||||
page of the letter or postcard. The original letter or | ||||
postcard will then be delivered to the JTF-GTMO APO | ||||
(Refer to section 13-4g). | ||||
c. ICRC mail. Incoming ICRC mail will be returned | ||||
to the ICRC rep, while inside the detention facility, for | ||||
delivery to the detainees. Outgoing ICRC mail will be | ||||
returned to the ICRC rep for delivery at their expense | ||||
(Refer to section 13-5f). | ||||
* Annotates item controlled by JDOG S-2. Actual | ||||
phrase of the stamp is subject to change as dictated by | ||||
JDOG S-2. | ||||
13-8. Redacted Mail (DMPC) | ||||
a. Incoming mail. For letters, the redacted sections | ||||
will be highlighted on the originals and translations, | ||||
and then filed in the detainee’s mail file. A redacted | ||||
copy will be stamped “Approved by US Forces”* on | ||||
each page and delivered to the detainee (refer to section | ||||
13-3h). | ||||
b. Outgoing mail. A copy of the original letter or | ||||
postcard and translation will be made with the redacted | ||||
sections highlighted, and then filed in the detainee’s | ||||
permanent file. The redacted original letter or postcard | ||||
will be stamped “Approved by US Forces”* on each | ||||
page and then delivered to the JTF-GTMO APO (Refer | ||||
to section 13-4g). | ||||
c. ICRC mail. A redacted copy will be stamped | ||||
“Approved by US Forces”* on each page and given to | ||||
the ICRC rep for them to deliver. An unredacted copy, | ||||
an unredacted translation, and a redacted copy will be | ||||
placed in the detainee mail file. Only the redacted | ||||
original may be stamped with “Cleared by US | ||||
Forces”* (Refer to section 13-5f). | ||||
* Annotates item is controlled by JDOG S-2. | ||||
Actual phrase of the stamp is subject to change as | ||||
dictated by JDOG S-2. | ||||
13-9. Held Mail (DMPC) | ||||
a. If JDOG S-2 determines a letter is to be held they | a. If JDOG S-2 determines a letter is to be held they | |||
will notify the detainee Mail Section. The original | will notify the detainee Mail Section. The original | |||
letter or photo will be placed in the detainee mail file. | letter or photo will be placed in the detainee mail file. | |||
ICRC will be notified that the letter has been held. | In the case of ICRC mail, the ICRC will be notified | |||
Notification to the ICRC will be on a Transmittal Sheet | that the letter has been held. Notification to the ICRC | |||
and will include their tracking number and our MMS | will be on a transmittal Sheet and will include the | |||
ICRC tracking number and the DOCEX Harmony | ||||
identification number. NO COPIES WILL BE | identification number. NO COPIES WILL BE | |||
RETURNED TO THE ICRC. Held mail will be | RETURNED TO THE ICRC. Held mail will be | |||
annotated as CLOSED on the MMS. | annotated as “HOLD” on DOCEX. | |||
b. During absences of ICRC from Guantanamo Bay, | b. During absences of ICRC from Guantanamo Bay, | |||
ICRC mail is handled per directions of the ICRC | ICRC mail is handled per directions of the ICRC liason | |||
representative to the JDOG and the CJDOG. | to the JDOG and the CJDOG. | |||
13-8. Mail Screening | 13-10. Mail Transmittal Records | |||
a. Receive mail from JDOG S-1 for JDOG S-2 and | a. TRANSFER TRANSMITTAL SHEETS WILL | |||
JIG review. A JDOG S-2 representative will sign and | ACCOMPANY ALL MAIL TRANSFERS. The | |||
make a copy of each Transmittal Record (TR) from the | process is as follows: | |||
JDOG S-1 section. The JDOG S-2 copy of the TR is | b. Two copies of a transmittal sheet go with the | |||
filed in the appropriate detainee Mail binder. Binders | mail for signatures; one is a file copy to be provided to | |||
are divided according to the type of mail (ICRC or | the receiving location (translation, RFI, etc.). The | |||
ordinary). Each binder is further sub-divided into the | other will be filed in the DMPC. | |||
step of the mail process the TR represents (received | c. These records will be kept in binders. There | |||
from JDOG S-1, to JIG, etc.) | ||||
b. Deliver mail to JIG and have them sign | ||||
Transmittal Record. Persons delivering the letters will | ||||
inventory all mail with a JIG representative. Mail is | ||||
usually delivered to the JDOG S-2 Admin | ||||
representative. If this person is not available, the JIG | ||||
linguists are the secondary POC for mail delivery. | ||||
After the JIG representative signs for the mail, a copy | ||||
of each TR is made for their record keeping. Original | ||||
Transmittal Sheet s is filed in the correct detainee Mail | ||||
binders. | ||||
c. JDOG S-2 review of detainee mail. Pull out any | ||||
redacted, hold/file, rewrites, or INTSUM mail. | ||||
d. Redacted mail. This is mail that is not appropriate | ||||
to be mailed out or given to the detainee. This would | ||||
include: | ||||
(1) Mail containing complaints or criticism of | ||||
any governmental agency or official. | ||||
(2) Refer to events or circumstances of capture. | ||||
(3) Comparing camps. | ||||
(4) Containing numbers, ciphers, codes, music | ||||
symbols, shorthand marks, or signs other than those | ||||
used for normal punctuation. | ||||
(5) Containing military information on numbers | ||||
of detainees. This also includes the use of ISN number. | ||||
(6) Location of the camps. This includes maps, | ||||
sketches, and drawings. | ||||
(7) Any item that could be used against the | ||||
camps as a force protection issue. | ||||
(8) Any item that has intelligence value. | ||||
e. Incoming mail. All mail selected for redaction | ||||
will be copied and the copy will be redacted and copied | ||||
again. The second redacted copy will go to the | ||||
detainee in the incoming envelope. The unblemished | ||||
original and redacted copy will go into the detainee | ||||
file. Redacts need to be completely marked through | ||||
and be unable to read. | ||||
f. Outgoing mail. There are two types of outgoing | ||||
correspondence: letters and postcards. Letters will be | ||||
copied and redacted and the second redacted copy will | ||||
be mailed out. The original and redacted copy will be | ||||
filed in detainee file. Postcards will be redacted on | ||||
originals and then copied. The copy of the redaction | ||||
will go into the detainee file and the original will be | ||||
mailed out. | ||||
g. Hold/File mail. Any detainee mail that is not | ||||
addressed to family (incoming and outgoing)(to | ||||
include mail addressed to fellow detainees) needs to be | ||||
held/filed IAW SECDEF guidance. The JDOG S-2 rep | ||||
will build a Transmittal sheet and pull the originals | ||||
from the JDOG S-1 files. The originals are then | ||||
appropriately marked as Hold/File and the transfer is | ||||
annotated in MMS computer database. | ||||
h. Rewrites. Any mail that needs to be rewritten | ||||
will need to be marked with the reason why. A | ||||
Transmittal Record will be made in MMS for JDOG S- | ||||
1 to take the original and reasons why back to the | ||||
detainee for rewrite. Mail that violates the provisions | ||||
of AR 190-8 (listed under Redacted Mail) can be sent | ||||
back to the JDOG S-1 and the detainee to be rewritten. | ||||
i. Intrep mail. This category describes any mail | ||||
that contains information pertinent to the intelligence | ||||
community. These items may contain suicidal threats, | ||||
capture information, known acquaintances, etc. The | ||||
copy of the designated letter is marked for inclusion in | ||||
the daily INTREP and then shredded if the mail is | ||||
cleared for delivery. Once noted, the mail will | ||||
continue through the detainee mail process. If | ||||
required, the original piece of mail can be pulled from | ||||
the JDOG S-1. | ||||
j. If the mail clears screening, the JDOG S-2 copy | ||||
is shredded, as there is no further need for this | ||||
document. The JDOG S-1 will automatically deliver | ||||
the remaining mail that has not been pulled or marked | ||||
for non-delivery. | ||||
13-9. Mail Transmittal Records | ||||
a. Transfer Transmittal sheets will accompany all | ||||
mail transfers. In all cases the process is as follows: | ||||
b. Print three Mail Transmittal sheets; one is | ||||
immediately filed in the appropriate binder in the | ||||
DMPC, this copy is kept only until a signed copy can | ||||
replace it. | ||||
c. Two copies go with the mail for signatures; one | ||||
is a file copy to be provided to the receiving location | ||||
(translation, JDOG S-2, etc.). The other will replace | ||||
the unsigned copy that has been filed in the DMPC. | ||||
d. These records will be kept in binders. There | ||||
should be a separate binder for each category of mail as | should be a separate binder for each category of mail as | |||
follows: | follows: | |||
(1) LETTERS & POST CARDS | (1) LETTERS & POST CARDS | |||
(a) Ordinary incoming mail to translation | (a) Ordinary incoming mail to translation | |||
(b) Ordinary outgoing mail to translation | (b) Ordinary outgoing mail to translation | |||
(c) Ordinary Incoming mail to JDOG S-2/JIG | (c) Ordinary outgoing mail to post office | |||
(d) Ordinary Outgoing mail to JDOG S-2/JIG | ||||
(e) Ordinary Incoming mail to redact/hold | ||||
(f) Ordinary Outgoing mail to redact/hold | ||||
(g) Ordinary outgoing mail to post office | ||||
(2) ICRC | (2) ICRC | |||
(a) ICRC incoming mail to translation | (a) ICRC incoming mail to translation | |||
(b) ICRC outgoing mail to translation | (b) ICRC outgoing mail to translation | |||
(c) ICRC Incoming mail to JDOG S-2/JIG | (e) ICRC Incoming mail to ICRC Rep* | |||
(d) ICRC Outgoing mail to JDOG S-2/JIG | (f) ICRC outgoing mail to ICRC Rep* | |||
(e) ICRC Incoming mail to redact/hold | (3)REQUESTS FOR INFORMATION (RFI) | |||
(f) ICRC Outgoing mail to redact/hold | d. These are the permanent history of each item that | |||
(g) ICRC Incoming mail to ICRC Rep* | ||||
(h) ICRC outgoing mail to ICRC Rep* | ||||
e. These are the permanent history of each item that | ||||
has been transferred through the system. | has been transferred through the system. | |||
f. Within the MMS database, ICRC may be referred | 13-11. Requests for Information | |||
to as BLD or BLD may be linked to ICRC files, such | a. Any requests for information (RFI) from a | |||
as: ICRC outgoing mail to ICRC Rep/BLD. This is an | detainee’s mail file, either hardcopy or from DOCEX | |||
organic feature of the current software. | must have prior authorization from the JDOG S-2 OIC | |||
13-10. Mail For detainees Held At Locations Other | or NCOIC and notification to the JDOG S-1 Postal | |||
OIC or NCOIC. Only copies of items from a detainee’s | ||||
mail file will be furnished and a transmittal sheet must | ||||
accompany the RFI from the DMPC to the requesting | ||||
party (Refer to section 13-10). | ||||
13-12. Foreign Delegations | ||||
a. Periodically, Foreign Delegations will conduct a | ||||
visitation to the detainees. A representative of the | ||||
Foreign Delegation must check in with the JDOG S-2 | ||||
and DMPC if they have correspondence for a detainee | ||||
or vice versa. | ||||
b. The Foreign Delegation must be accompanied by | ||||
a representative of the DMPC and an M.P. when | ||||
visiting a detainee. | ||||
c. Correspondence from a Foreign Delegation to a | ||||
detainee or from a detainee to a Foreign Delegation | ||||
must go through the same processes as ordinary mail, | ||||
unless given authorization from the JDOG S-2 to | ||||
assign the correspondence a higher priority to complete | ||||
than ordinary mail. | ||||
d. Cleared Correspondence. A copy of the original | ||||
and translation will be placed in the detainee’s mail | ||||
file. The original will be stamped “Approved by US | ||||
Forces”* on each written page and given to the Foreign | ||||
Delegation. | ||||
e. Redacted Correspondence. A copy of the original | ||||
correspondence and translation with the redacted | ||||
sections highlighted will be placed in the detainee’s | ||||
mail file. The original will be redacted, then stamped | ||||
with “Approved by US Forces”* and given to the | ||||
Foreign Delegation (Refer to section 13-8). | ||||
f. Held Correspondence. A copy of the original | ||||
correspondence and translation will be placed in the | ||||
detainee’s mail file. The Foreign Delegation will be | ||||
notified that the correspondence cannot be delivered to | ||||
the detainee and the original correspondence is | ||||
returned to the Foreign Delegation. The electronic | ||||
version of the correspondence will be annotated as | ||||
“HOLD – Returned to Delegation” on DOCEX. | ||||
* Annotates item is controlled by JDOG S-2. | ||||
Actual phrase of the stamp is subject to change as | ||||
dictated by JDOG S-2. | ||||
13-13. Mail For detainees Held At Locations Other | ||||
Than GTMO | Than GTMO | |||
a. In accordance with Joint Chief of Staff guidance, | a. In accordance with Joint Chief of Staff guidance, | |||
mail for detainees not held at the Camp Delta facility | mail for detainees not held at the Camp Delta facility | |||
will also be processed and screened by the detainee | will also be processed and screened by the detainee | |||
mail section. | mail section. | |||
b. Incoming mail for the detainee should be sent to | b. Incoming mail for the detainee should be sent to | |||
the Camp Delta detainee mail section through the | the Camp Delta detainee mail section through the | |||
Washington DC address. This ensures the mail is | Washington DC address. This ensures the mail is | |||
properly cleared of hazardous materials before | properly cleared of hazardous materials before | |||
handling. If the mail is sent directly to the other | handling. If the mail is sent directly to the other | |||
skipping to change at line 5378 | skipping to change at line 6266 | |||
and emailed over secure email to the OIC of the | and emailed over secure email to the OIC of the | |||
detainee mail section or to the JDOG S-2. This mail | detainee mail section or to the JDOG S-2. This mail | |||
will then be processed and screened. Once the mail has | will then be processed and screened. Once the mail has | |||
been screened, instructions for the handling of the mail | been screened, instructions for the handling of the mail | |||
will be emailed back to the Detention Facility. | will be emailed back to the Detention Facility. | |||
d. The Washington DC Address is: | d. The Washington DC Address is: | |||
Detainee: XXXXXX (Alpha Numeric Code) | Detainee: XXXXXX (Alpha Numeric Code) | |||
Camp Delta | Camp Delta | |||
Washington, D.C. 20355 | Washington, D.C. 20355 | |||
USA | USA | |||
13-11. Mail Sent Directly To detainees | 13-14. Mail To Be Returned To Sender | |||
a. Any mail containing a return address and sent | a. Any mail containing a return address and sent | |||
directly to detainees without processing through the | directly to detainees without processing through the | |||
Washington, DC postal address will be returned to the | Washington, DC postal address will be returned to the | |||
sender. The mail should under no circumstances be | sender. The mail should under no circumstances be | |||
opened. The postal room, at their discretion, can write | opened. The postal room, at their discretion, can write | |||
the proper address somewhere on the envelope for | the proper address somewhere on the envelope for | |||
future reference of the sender. | future reference of the sender. | |||
b. If the mail does not have a return address, the | b. If the mail does not have a return address, the | |||
mail will be handled IAW with postal room procedures | mail will be an immediate HOLD and directed to the | |||
for processing undeliverable mail without a return | JDOG S-2 for dissemination. | |||
address. | 13-15. Incorrectly Addressed Mail | |||
13-12. Incorrectly Addressed Mail | ||||
a. Mail without a detainee alpha code or return | a. Mail without a detainee alpha code or return | |||
address will be processed and screened as any other | address will be processed and screened as any other | |||
piece of mail. After the mail has been cleared, a | piece of mail. After the mail has been cleared, a | |||
reasonable effort will be made to determine the | reasonable effort will be made to determine the | |||
detainee to whom the mail is addressed. If the detainee | detainee to whom the mail is addressed. If the detainee | |||
cannot be determined, the mail will be placed in a hold | cannot be determined, the mail will be placed in a hold | |||
file. | file. | |||
b. Mail arriving in the detainee mail bag, clearly not | b. Mail arriving in the detainee mail bag, clearly not | |||
belonging to a detainee will be returned to the postal | belonging to a detainee will be returned to the postal | |||
room unopened. | room unopened. | |||
skipping to change at line 5413 | skipping to change at line 6299 | |||
be determined if it belongs to a detainee or not, will be | be determined if it belongs to a detainee or not, will be | |||
opened and processed. If at some point during the | opened and processed. If at some point during the | |||
process or screening it becomes evident that the mail is | process or screening it becomes evident that the mail is | |||
not for a detainee, it will be returned to the postal room | not for a detainee, it will be returned to the postal room | |||
with an explanation of why the mail was opened. | with an explanation of why the mail was opened. | |||
d. Outgoing mail returned for lack of a country | d. Outgoing mail returned for lack of a country | |||
name in English will be corrected and sent out again. | name in English will be corrected and sent out again. | |||
A new transmittal sheet will be created to transfer it to | A new transmittal sheet will be created to transfer it to | |||
the post office. File the transmittal sheet under | the post office. File the transmittal sheet under | |||
outgoing mail for the current day. | outgoing mail for the current day. | |||
13-13. Mail For Released detainees | 13-16. Mail For Released Detainees | |||
a. Detainees that are released may have mail in the | a. Detainees that are released may have mail in the | |||
system. When determination is made to repatriate a | system. When determination is made to repatriate a | |||
detainee, the JDOG S-2 should notify the detainee mail | detainee, the JDOG S-2 should notify the detainee mail | |||
section, through the JDOG S-1. | section, through the JDOG S-1. | |||
b. The detainee mail section should search the mail | b. The detainee mail section should search the mail | |||
database and determine if the detainee has any mail in | database and determine if the detainee has any mail in | |||
the system. If there is mail in the system, the mail | the system. If there is mail in the system, the mail | |||
NCOIC should determine where in the process the mail | NCOIC should determine where in the process the mail | |||
is. The NCOIC should then notify that part of the | is located. A list of all mail items for the detainee in | |||
process that the detainee is scheduled for repatriation. | the system will be printed with the Harmony numbers | |||
The mail should then be treated as priority to complete | highlighted. JDOG S-2 should annotate in red the | |||
the screening process. After screening, the mail should | action next to the Harmony number of each mail item: | |||
be given to the detainees so it can be carried back with | C – Cleared, H – Hold, R – Redacted. Any mail items | |||
all other items returned to the detainee. | still in the screening process should be treated as | |||
c. Only mail that has been stamped “Cleared by US | priority to complete | |||
Forces” will be returned to a detainee upon his release. | c. After screening, the mail should be given to the | |||
d. When a detainee is released all original mail that | detainees so it can be carried back with all other items | |||
has been stamped “Cleared by US Forces” and a copy | returned to the detainee. | |||
of all redacted items that have been stamped “Cleared | d. Only mail that has been stamped “Approved by | |||
by US Forces” that are in their detainee mail file will | US Forces” by JDOG S-2 will be returned to a detainee | |||
be given to them. | upon his release. | |||
e. Mail coming in after the detainee has left the | e. When a detainee is released all original mail that | |||
detention facility should be automatically returned to | has been stamped “Approved by US Forces” by JDOG | |||
the sender. | S-2 and a copy of all redacted items that have been | |||
13-14. Detainees In Isolation | stamped “Approved by US Forces” that are in their | |||
Mail for detainees in MSU will be handled in | detainee mail file will be released to the detainee. | |||
f. Incoming mail for a released detainee should be | ||||
automatically returned to the sender. | ||||
13-17. Detainees In Special Housing | ||||
Mail for detainees in segregation will be handled in | ||||
accordance with the most current approved discipline | accordance with the most current approved discipline | |||
matrix. It is up to the JDOG S-3 to ensure the detainee | matrix. It is up to the JDOG S-3 to ensure the detainee | |||
mail section is aware of current discipline matrix | mail section is aware of current discipline matrix | |||
procedures. | procedures. Mail delivery and collection will be | |||
13-15. Detainees With More Than 12 Items Of Mail | conducted on a schedule constructed by the DMPC | |||
a. When the Mail NCOIC notices a detainee who | NCOIC and the segregation NCOIC. | |||
has received a total amount of mail greater than 12 | 13-18. Detainees With More Than 12 Items Of Mail | |||
pieces, the NCOIC should notify the JDOG S-3 section | a. When a Block NCOIC notices a detainee who has | |||
in writing of the detainee number and the total amount | received a total amount of mail greater than 12 pieces, | |||
of mail he has received. This will assist the JDOG S-3 | the Block NCOIC should notify JDOG S-3 who will | |||
and MPs in controlling the amount of mail in the cells. | notify the DMPC NCOIC in writing of the detainee | |||
number and the total amount of mail he has received. | ||||
b. If a detainee does accumulate more than 12 mail | b. If a detainee does accumulate more than 12 mail | |||
items, the excess mail will be collected by the MPs and | items, the excess mail will be collected by the guards | |||
sent to the detainee Mail Section for storage. | and sent to the Detainee Mail Section for storage. | |||
c. The detainee is allowed to choose which 12 | c. The detainee is allowed to choose which 12 | |||
letters to keep in his possession. He is also allowed to | letters to keep in his possession. He is also allowed to | |||
exchange one letter in his possession for a letter held in | exchange one letter in his possession for a letter held in | |||
the detainee mail section. When the detainee requests | the detainee mail section. When the detainee requests | |||
a letter held in the mail section, the MPs should notify | a letter held in the mail section, the guards should | |||
the detainee mail section. | notify the detainee mail section. | |||
d. The detainee mail section will bring the letter out | d. The detainee mail section will bring the letter out | |||
to the detainee. The mail clerk will bring exchange the | to the detainee. The mail clerk will bring exchange the | |||
new letter for one already in the detainee’s possession. | new letter for one already in the detainee’s possession. | |||
e. If the mail clerk knows a detainee has 12 mail | e. If the mail clerk knows a detainee has 12 mail | |||
items in his possession, the clerk should exchange any | items in his possession, the clerk should exchange any | |||
new mail items for one already in the detainee’s | new mail items for one already in the detainee’s | |||
possession. | possession. | |||
f. For those detainees in a Level 2 block, this | f. For those detainees in a Reward Level 2 block, | |||
number for section 13-16 paragraphs a-e will be 15. | this number for section 13-18 paragraphs a-e will be | |||
For those detainees in a Level 1 block, this number for | 15, upgradeable upon request from the detainee. For | |||
section 13-16 paragraphs a-e will be 20. | those detainees in a Reward Level 1 block, this number | |||
13-16. Detainees Passing Mail Between Cells | for section 13-18 paragraphs a-e will be 20. | |||
a. At no time should anyone from the detainee mail | 13-19. Detainees Passing Mail Between Cells | |||
section pass mail or any other items from one detainee | a. AT NO TIME should anyone from the detainee | |||
to another. | mail section pass mail or any other items from one | |||
detainee to another. | ||||
b. Items can only be passed between detainees with | b. Items can only be passed between detainees with | |||
prior approval from the JDOG S-3, or other specified | prior approval from the JDOG S-3, or other specified | |||
individuals for intelligence purposes. The MP Block | individuals for intelligence purposes. The Block NCO | |||
NCO does not have the authority to tell the mail clerks | does not have the authority to tell the mail clerks to | |||
to pass items between detainees. | pass items between detainees. | |||
c. If a detainee is passing, attempting to pass or | c. If a detainee is passing, attempting to pass or | |||
requesting to pass items amongst each other this should | requesting to pass items amongst each other this should | |||
be documented on a Significant Activity Report and | be documented on a Significant Activity Report and | |||
forwarded to the JDOG S-2 shop including, if possible, | forwarded to the JDOG S-2 shop including, if possible, | |||
the detainees involved and the type of item being | the detainees involved and the type of item being | |||
passed. | passed. | |||
d. At no time should ICRC reps pass any mail | d. AT NO TIME should ICRC reps pass any mail | |||
between detainees. | between detainees. | |||
Chapter 14 | Chapter 14 | |||
Intelligence Operations | Intelligence Operations | |||
14-1. General The JDOG S-2 is tasked with | 14-1. General The JDOG S-2 is tasked with | |||
maintaining records for the following information: | maintaining records for the following information: | |||
a. Force Protection | a. Force Protection | |||
b. Significant activities reports | b. Significant activities reports | |||
c. Disturbance matrix | c. Disturbance matrix | |||
d. Communication matrix and link diagram | d. Communication matrix and link diagram | |||
skipping to change at line 5517 | skipping to change at line 6410 | |||
o. Source operation reports | o. Source operation reports | |||
p. JIG directed observation reports | p. JIG directed observation reports | |||
q. Counterintelligence Information Reports (CIIR) | q. Counterintelligence Information Reports (CIIR) | |||
r. Counter reconnaissance support for detainee | r. Counter reconnaissance support for detainee | |||
movements. | movements. | |||
14-2. Force Protection Information collected within | 14-2. Force Protection Information collected within | |||
Camp Delta utilized for the protection of US forces and | Camp Delta utilized for the protection of US forces and | |||
detained persons at NAVSTAGTMO. This | detained persons at NAVSTAGTMO. This | |||
information will be provided to the JDOG S-2 OIC, | information will be provided to the JDOG S-2 OIC, | |||
who will then disseminate it to the JDOG commander, | who will then disseminate it to the JDOG commander, | |||
appropriate Military Police (MP) COs, and the JTF- | appropriate COs, and the JTF-GTMO J-2. The | |||
GTMO J-2. The information will be applied to all | information will be applied to all operational levels to | |||
operational levels to provide maximum security and | provide maximum security and safety of personnel | |||
safety of personnel under the respective commands. | under the respective commands. | |||
14-3. Significant Activity Report A report generated | 14-3. Significant Activity Report A report generated | |||
by Camp Delta Block Guards on a shift-by-shift basis, | by Camp Delta guards on a shift-by-shift basis, which | |||
which details the activities of the detainees on each | details the activities of the detainees on each block. | |||
block. These reports are to include a date time group | These reports are to include a date time group of any | |||
of any incident, the Internment Serial Number (ISN) of | incident, the Internment Serial Number (ISN) of the | |||
the detainee(s) involved, a description of events, and an | detainee(s) involved, a description of events, and an | |||
evidentiary custody chain of any items with | evidentiary custody chain of any items with | |||
intelligence value collected. This report is turned into | intelligence value collected. This report is turned into | |||
the DOC at the end of each shift, where the PL and the | the DOC at the end of each shift, where the PL and the | |||
CO review it. The JDOG S-2 Counter Intelligence (CI) | CO review it. The JDOG S-2 Counter Intelligence (CI) | |||
agents will then collect and screen the reports for | agents will then collect and screen the reports for | |||
pertinent force protection information. The Significant | pertinent force protection information. The Significant | |||
Activity Report will then be entered into the Internee | Activity Report will then be entered into the Internee | |||
Management Database (IMD) for production of the | Management Database (IMD) for production of the | |||
daily Intelligence Report (INTREP). | daily Intelligence Report (INTREP). | |||
14-4. Disturbance Matrix This is a comprehensive | 14-4. Disturbance Matrix This is a comprehensive | |||
skipping to change at line 5577 | skipping to change at line 6470 | |||
discernable acts of leadership that occur within Camp | discernable acts of leadership that occur within Camp | |||
Delta. The individual matrices report various types of | Delta. The individual matrices report various types of | |||
leadership. These types include: religious, | leadership. These types include: religious, | |||
secular/block, communication, block lookouts, and | secular/block, communication, block lookouts, and | |||
teachers. Each instance of leadership will be recorded | teachers. Each instance of leadership will be recorded | |||
on a spreadsheet. This system will allow the JDOG S- | on a spreadsheet. This system will allow the JDOG S- | |||
2 CI section to readily identify the primary leadership | 2 CI section to readily identify the primary leadership | |||
structure on the blocks and within Camp Delta as a | structure on the blocks and within Camp Delta as a | |||
whole. The data is obtained by screening the | whole. The data is obtained by screening the | |||
Significant Activity reports, Staff Journal Logs | Significant Activity reports, Staff Journal Logs | |||
maintained on each block, CI debriefing of Block | maintained on each block, CI debriefing of guards | |||
Guards working in Camp Delta, debriefing of JDOG | working in Camp Delta, debriefing of JDOG linguists, | |||
linguists, and from interrogation packet review. The | and from interrogation packet review. The last being | |||
last being coordinated through appropriate CI | coordinated through appropriate CI personnel assigned | |||
personnel assigned to the JIG. | to the JIG. | |||
14-7. Items Of Intelligence Value All items of | 14-7. Items Of Intelligence Value All items of | |||
intelligence value collected from detainees will be | intelligence value collected from detainees will be | |||
reviewed by JDOG S-2 CI agents and translated by | reviewed by JDOG S-2 CI agents and translated by | |||
JDOG linguists if necessary. The JDOG S-2 will then | JDOG linguists if necessary. The JDOG S-2 will then | |||
provide storage for the items. All such items will be | provide storage for the items. All such items will be | |||
stored for the duration of the individual’s detention at | stored for the duration of the individual’s detention at | |||
Camp Delta. | Camp Delta. | |||
14-8. Detainee Mail Screening All incoming and | 14-8. Detainee Mail Screening All incoming and | |||
outgoing detainee correspondence will be translated by | outgoing detainee correspondence will be translated by | |||
JDOG linguists and screened by CI personnel. The | JDOG linguists and screened by CI personnel. The | |||
skipping to change at line 5678 | skipping to change at line 6571 | |||
Significant Activities Report | Significant Activities Report | |||
(d) Monitor blocks on a rotating basis | (d) Monitor blocks on a rotating basis | |||
(e) Screen detainee mail | (e) Screen detainee mail | |||
(f) Conduct end of day security procedures | (f) Conduct end of day security procedures | |||
d. Monthly Operations | d. Monthly Operations | |||
(1) Compilation of matrices and diagrams | (1) Compilation of matrices and diagrams | |||
(2) Briefings for appropriate intelligence sections | (2) Briefings for appropriate intelligence sections | |||
and commanders | and commanders | |||
e. All other products, listed above, will be done on | e. All other products, listed above, will be done on | |||
an as needed basis. | an as needed basis. | |||
14-12. JIIF MP Personnel | 14-12. JIIF Guard Personnel | |||
a. The JIIF will require personnel to monitor and to | a. The JIIF will require personnel to monitor and to | |||
react in the event of an altercation between detainee | react in the event of an altercation between detainee | |||
and Interrogator. | and Interrogator. | |||
b. A JIIF monitor will be located either in a monitor | b. A JIIF monitor will be located either in a monitor | |||
room that is equipped with two-way mirrors and CCTV | room that is equipped with two-way mirrors and CCTV | |||
or in a CCTV only room. | or in a CCTV only room. | |||
c. A roving MP will be present in the hallways of | c. A roving guard will be present in the hallways of | |||
all buildings that have interrogations being conducted. | all buildings that have interrogations being conducted. | |||
This MP will respond to any problems in an | This guard will respond to any problems in an | |||
interrogation room. | interrogation room. | |||
d. Detainees will be secured to the eyebolt in the | d. Detainees will be secured to the eyebolt in the | |||
floor of the interrogation room. Detainees may be | floor of the interrogation room. Detainees may be | |||
unshackled at the request of the Interrogators. | unshackled at the request of the Interrogators. | |||
e. JIIF monitors will observe all interrogations. | e. JIIF monitors will observe all interrogations. | |||
They will NOT listen to any interrogations. They will | They will NOT listen to any interrogations. They will | |||
NOT discuss any events that occur inside an | NOT discuss any events that occur inside an | |||
interrogation room. If a JIIF monitor observes a | interrogation room. If a JIIF monitor observes a | |||
perceived security threat by a detainee, the JIIF | perceived security threat by a detainee, the JIIF | |||
monitor will alert the roving MP. The roving MP will | monitor will alert the roving guard. The roving guard | |||
enter the room and alert the Interrogators by note. | will enter the room and alert the Interrogators by note. | |||
f. Guards must physically inspect each room prior | ||||
to and after a detainee occupies the room. | ||||
g. Guards are responsible for clearing the hallway | ||||
prior to the detainee arriving and departing from their | ||||
assigned room. | ||||
h. Guards are responsible for the detainee being | ||||
restrained in their assigned room. | ||||
14-13. SCIF Security | 14-13. SCIF Security | |||
a. The following personnel are needed to man full | a. The following personnel are needed to man full | |||
Sensitive Compartmented Information Facility (SCIF) | Sensitive Compartmented Information Facility (SCIF) | |||
Operations per shift: | Operations per shift: | |||
(1) One SOG (E-5 or above) | (1) One SOG (E-5 or above) | |||
(2) One soldier for the Access Control Point | (2) One soldier for the Access Control Point | |||
(3) One soldier for Roving Patrol | (3) One soldier for Roving Patrol | |||
b. SOG: SOG is responsible for the total operation | b. SOG: SOG is responsible for the total operation | |||
of the SCIF for their shift. He/She is directly | of the SCIF for their shift. He/She is directly | |||
responsible to the MP Duty Officer. The SOG will be | responsible to the CO. The SOG will be responsible | |||
responsible for the following: | for the following: | |||
(1) Posting of the oncoming guard section. | (1) Posting of the oncoming guard section. | |||
(2) Disorders and actions taken. | (2) Disorders and actions taken. | |||
(3) Ensure the duties of shift are carried out. | (3) Ensure the duties of shift are carried out. | |||
Notify higher authority of any discrepancies or | Notify higher authority of any discrepancies or | |||
alterations to the approved schedule. | alterations to the approved schedule. | |||
(4) Inspect the on-coming shift of escort guards | (4) Inspect the on-coming shift of escort guards | |||
and pass any information required to maximize | and pass any information required to maximize | |||
efficiency and control. | efficiency and control. | |||
(5) Inspect the entire facility to ensure security of | (5) Inspect the entire facility to ensure security of | |||
locks, doors, gates, and fences on their shift. This will | locks, doors, gates, and fences on their shift. This will | |||
be completed at once per shift. Any discrepancies will | be completed at once per shift. Any discrepancies will | |||
be noted and reported to the Duty Officer. | be noted and reported to the Duty Officer. | |||
(6) Be responsible for the supervision, discipline, | (6) Be responsible for the supervision, discipline, | |||
and performance of the guard section. | and performance of the guard section. | |||
(7) Ensure all Military Police Roving Patrols are | (7) Ensure all Roving Patrols are alert and | |||
alert and appropriately conducting their duties. | appropriately conducting their duties. | |||
c. Access Control Point: Access to the SCIF will | c. Access Control Point: Access to the SCIF will | |||
be restricted to a single entrance point, which will be | be restricted to a single entrance point, which will be | |||
guarded on a continuous 24-hour basis. | guarded on a continuous 24-hour basis. | |||
(1) Only personnel displaying a JTF-GTMO | (1) Only personnel displaying a JTF-GTMO | |||
Level 5 access badge will be allowed to enter the SCIF | Level 5 access badge will be allowed to enter the SCIF | |||
unescorted. Those personnel displaying a Level 3 or 4 | unescorted. Those personnel displaying a Level 3 or 4 | |||
JTF-GTMO access badge must have an escort and | JTF-GTMO access badge must have an escort and | |||
must be signed in with the SSO in room 2226. All | must be signed in with the SSO in room 2226. All | |||
other personnel with a Level 1 or 2 access badge must | other personnel with a Level 1 or 2 access badge must | |||
be escorted at all times by an individual with a Level 5 | be escorted at all times by an individual with a Level 5 | |||
skipping to change at line 5759 | skipping to change at line 6659 | |||
(a) Transmitters or receivers (i.e. Cell phones, | (a) Transmitters or receivers (i.e. Cell phones, | |||
Pagers, Handheld radios of any kind) | Pagers, Handheld radios of any kind) | |||
(b) Cameras and film (video and photo) | (b) Cameras and film (video and photo) | |||
(c) Firearms of any kind | (c) Firearms of any kind | |||
(d) Ammunition | (d) Ammunition | |||
(e) Pyrotechnics (smoke grenades, flares, | (e) Pyrotechnics (smoke grenades, flares, | |||
fireworks, etc.) | fireworks, etc.) | |||
The access control point will allow transmitters in the | The access control point will allow transmitters in the | |||
compound but not in the SCIF area. Any individual | compound but not in the SCIF area. Any individual | |||
with prohibited items will leave those items with the | with prohibited items will leave those items with the | |||
access control point MP guard. These items may be | access control point guard. These items may be | |||
retrieved upon leaving the compound. MP guards may | retrieved upon leaving the compound. Guards may | |||
search bags for these items, as they feel necessary. | search bags for these items, as they feel necessary. | |||
(3) The access control point is also responsible | (3) The access control point is also responsible | |||
for maintaining the keys to all of the gate entrances to | for maintaining the keys to all of the gate entrances to | |||
the SCIF. These gates will remained locked at all | the SCIF. These gates will remained locked at all | |||
times with the exception of the one access point unless | times with the exception of the one access point unless | |||
otherwise directed by JTF-GTMO personnel displaying | otherwise directed by JTF-GTMO personnel displaying | |||
a Level 5 access badge. All keys will be kept at the | a Level 5 access badge. All keys will be kept at the | |||
access control point desk in a key box and will be | access control point desk in a key box and will be | |||
signed out in the key log. | signed out in the key log. | |||
(4) The access control point is responsible for | ||||
monitoring the camera console. | ||||
(5) The volume of the television at the access | ||||
control point will be kept at a moderate level at all | ||||
times and shall be tuned in to the CNN station. | ||||
(6) The appropriate flag will be displayed when a | ||||
General is in the building. The SCIF staff will provide | ||||
notification of a Flag Officer arriving and provide the | ||||
appropriate flag. | ||||
d. Roving Patrol: The roving guard is responsible | d. Roving Patrol: The roving guard is responsible | |||
for identifying and monitoring all possible exterior | for identifying and monitoring all possible exterior | |||
access points to the SCIF for evidence of unauthorized | access points to the SCIF for evidence of unauthorized | |||
access. During daylight hours, the roving patrol will | access. During daylight hours, the roving patrol will | |||
perform his/her duties at least once every hour. After | perform his/her duties at least once every hour. After | |||
hours of darkness, the SCIF perimeter will be | hours of darkness, the SCIF perimeter will be | |||
monitored at least twice hourly by the roving patrol. | monitored at least twice hourly by the roving patrol. | |||
When not performing his/her duties as a roving guard, | When not performing his/her duties as a roving guard, | |||
this patrol will assist the access control point with their | this patrol will assist the access control point with their | |||
duties. | duties. | |||
skipping to change at line 5795 | skipping to change at line 6704 | |||
followed in order to safely and effectively assess and | followed in order to safely and effectively assess and | |||
deal with the situation: | deal with the situation: | |||
(a) Assess the situation and notify the Special | (a) Assess the situation and notify the Special | |||
Security Officer (SSO) (see paragraph q) of the current | Security Officer (SSO) (see paragraph q) of the current | |||
situation. The SSO will advise the guard of any further | situation. The SSO will advise the guard of any further | |||
action necessary. | action necessary. | |||
(b) Once action has been taken, notify the SOG | (b) Once action has been taken, notify the SOG | |||
of the situation. | of the situation. | |||
(c) If necessary, and upon direction from either | (c) If necessary, and upon direction from either | |||
the SOG or SSO, call 911. | the SOG or SSO, call 911. | |||
(2) In the event of an emergency, caused by a | (2) In the event of an emergency, caused by a | |||
hostile entity (armed or unarmed), the guard will: | hostile entity (armed or unarmed), the guard will: | |||
(a) Use Rules of Force IAW paragraph p. | (a) Use Rules of Force IAW paragraph p. | |||
(b) Do not leave SCIF unsecured in any attempt | (b) Do not leave SCIF unsecured in any attempt | |||
to stop a hostile entity. | to stop a hostile entity. | |||
(c) Immediately notify the Naval Security Police, | (c) Immediately notify the Naval Security Police, | |||
Fire Department, or EMS (ambulance) (911) for further | Fire Department, or EMS (ambulance) (911) for further | |||
instructions. | instructions. | |||
(d) Notify the SSO of the situation. | (d) Notify the SSO of the situation. | |||
(e) Contact the Military Police SOG. | (e) Contact the SOG. | |||
(3) In the event of an extreme emergency (severe | (3) In the event of an extreme emergency (severe | |||
threat to national security or imminent personal | threat to national security or imminent personal | |||
casualties or fatalities): | casualties or fatalities): | |||
(a) Use Rules of Force IAW paragraph p. | (a) Use Rules of Force IAW paragraph p. | |||
(b) Keep SCIF as priority for security while | (b) Keep SCIF as priority for security while | |||
reacting to the threat. | reacting to the threat. | |||
(c) The SCIF guard will call 911 for further | (c) The SCIF guard will call 911 for further | |||
instructions. | instructions. | |||
(d) They will then notify the SSO of the situation. | (d) They will then notify the SSO of the situation. | |||
(4) In the event of a gate found unsecured, the | (4) In the event of a gate found unsecured, the | |||
guard will: | guard will: | |||
(a) Take the appropriate action to secure the gate. | (a) Take the appropriate action to secure the gate. | |||
(b) Notify the SSO of the unsecured gate. | (b) Notify the SSO of the unsecured gate. | |||
(c) Notify the MP SOG of the security violation. | (c) Notify the SOG of the security violation. | |||
f. Communications. | f. Communications. | |||
(1) Primary communications will be by hand- | (1) Primary communications will be by hand- | |||
held radio. The SOG will carry one long-range saber | held radio. The SOG will carry one long-range saber | |||
radio. The access control point will have one long- | radio. The access control point will have one long- | |||
range radio for communications with the SOG. Both | range radio for communications with the SOG. Both | |||
the access control point and the roving patrol will carry | the access control point and the roving patrol will carry | |||
one short-range saber radio. In addition to these hand- | one short-range saber radio. In addition to these hand- | |||
held radios, the SCIF access control point will have | held radios, the SCIF access control point will have | |||
communications with the MP Duty Officer and | communications with the DOC and Commanding | |||
Commanding Officer at all times via land line at | Officer at all times via land line at x3102. | |||
x3102. | ||||
(2) Secondary communications will be by | (2) Secondary communications will be by | |||
landline at extension 3102. | landline at extension 3102. | |||
(3) Tertiary communications will be by | (3) Tertiary communications will be by | |||
messenger. | messenger. | |||
g. Uniform. All soldiers will wear garrison MP | g. Uniform. . The access control point and roving | |||
brassard. The access control point and roving patrol | patrol will each carry one 9mm pistol and wear their | |||
will each carry one 9mm pistol and wear their law | law enforcement gear. | |||
enforcement gear. | ||||
h. Facility Equipment Requirements. The following | h. Facility Equipment Requirements. The following | |||
is a list of all equipment necessary to operate the T- | is a list of all equipment necessary to operate the T- | |||
SCIF: | SCIF: | |||
(1) Four SABER Radios | (1) Four SABER Radios | |||
(2) Two 9mm Pistols | (2) Two 9mm Pistols | |||
i. Cleanliness Of The Facility. All those who work | i. Cleanliness Of The Facility. All those who work | |||
in the SCIF must clean up after themselves. MPs are | in the SCIF must clean up after themselves. Guards are | |||
responsible for cleaning the access control point desk | responsible for cleaning the access control point desk | |||
and the area around the desk. MPs are to be security | and the area around the desk. Guards are to be | |||
focused during shift. They are not responsible for any | security focused during shift. They are not responsible | |||
janitorial duties such as sweeping stairwells, emptying | for any janitorial duties such as sweeping stairwells, | |||
trashcans, or picking up trash outside the compound. | emptying trashcans, or picking up trash outside the | |||
In addition, MPs will not monitor cell phones for any | compound. In addition, guards will not monitor cell | |||
JTF-GTMO personnel, with the exception of general | phones for any JTF-GTMO personnel, with the | |||
officers. Any unreasonable requests such as these | exception of general officers. Any unreasonable | |||
made by personnel that work in the SCIF will be | requests such as these made by personnel that work in | |||
directed toward the SOG. | the SCIF will be directed toward the SOG. | |||
j. Smoking Policy. Smoking inside the facility is | j. Smoking Policy. Smoking inside the facility is | |||
prohibited. The only smoking authorized will be done | prohibited. The only smoking authorized will be done | |||
outside the facility doors. | outside the facility doors. | |||
k. Entertainment Policy. Security of the facility is | k. Entertainment Policy. Security of the facility is | |||
the primary focus during guard shift. Any distractions | the primary focus during guard shift. Any distractions | |||
that prohibit guards from carrying out their duties are | that prohibit guards from carrying out their duties are | |||
prohibited. | prohibited. | |||
l. MP Documentation. DA Form 1594 (Daily Staff | l. Documentation. DA Form 1594 (Daily Staff | |||
Journal), DA 5513-R (Key Control Register) and any | Journal), DA 5513-R (Key Control Register) and any | |||
other form used at the T-SCIF will be held at the SCIF | other form used at the T-SCIF will be held at the SCIF | |||
for the month and then turned in to the JDOG | for the month and then turned in to the JDOG | |||
Administration Section on the 1st | Administration Section on the 1st | |||
of every month. | of every month. | |||
Midnight shift is responsible to turn in these forms to | Midnight shift is responsible to turn in these forms to | |||
appropriate office at the end of the their shift. | appropriate office at the end of the their shift. | |||
m.MP Meals. SOG will coordinate with his/her | m.Guard Meals. SOG will coordinate with his/her | |||
company’s CP for providing meals to MP personnel. | company’s CP for providing meals to guard personnel. | |||
n. Transportation. SOG and Access Control Point | n. Transportation. SOG and Access Control Point | |||
Guard will have transportation while at the SCIF. | Guard will have transportation while at the SCIF. | |||
Transportation will be coordinated between the SOG | Transportation will be coordinated between the SOG | |||
and his/her company. | and his/her company. | |||
o. When an incident happens at the SCIF, the | o. When an incident happens at the SCIF, the | |||
Access Control Point notifies the following personnel | Access Control Point notifies the following personnel | |||
via phone in the below order IAW paragraph: | via phone in the below order IAW paragraph: | |||
(1) JTF-GTMO Special Security Officer (SSO) | (1) JTF-GTMO Special Security Officer (SSO) | |||
(2) JTF-GTMO Assistant Special Security | (2) JTF-GTMO Assistant Special Security | |||
Officer | Officer | |||
skipping to change at line 5976 | skipping to change at line 6883 | |||
of shift members, both on and off duty. The shift NCO | of shift members, both on and off duty. The shift NCO | |||
will forward and administrative and/or disciplinary | will forward and administrative and/or disciplinary | |||
issues that warrant NCOIC or OIC involvement up the | issues that warrant NCOIC or OIC involvement up the | |||
chain of command. As in any military organization, | chain of command. As in any military organization, | |||
shift NCOs have full authority to make on the spot | shift NCOs have full authority to make on the spot | |||
corrections. | corrections. | |||
d. Interpreter. Interpreters will carry out | d. Interpreter. Interpreters will carry out | |||
interpreter/translator duties as directed by the chain of | interpreter/translator duties as directed by the chain of | |||
command. Interpreter section members will maintain | command. Interpreter section members will maintain | |||
their military bearing and will conduct themselves in a | their military bearing and will conduct themselves in a | |||
professional manner at all times. They will present for | professional manner at all times. Civilian Interpreters | |||
duty as directed and will utilize the chain of command | will be dressed in appropriate civilian attire and | |||
beginning with the shift NCO to address and | military will be dressed in BDU’s. They will present | |||
for duty as directed and will utilize the chain of | ||||
command beginning with the shift NCO to address and | ||||
requests/concerns. Should the concern lie within the | requests/concerns. Should the concern lie within the | |||
immediate chain of command, the member may go | immediate chain of command, the member may go | |||
directly to the NCOIC or OIC for resolution. In all | directly to the NCOIC or OIC for resolution. In all | |||
cases, issues should be resolved at the lowest level | cases, issues should be resolved at the lowest level | |||
possible. | possible. | |||
e. Assigned Driver. Personnel the NCOIC | e. Assigned Driver. Personnel the NCOIC | |||
designates as drivers are responsible for the transport | designates as drivers are responsible for the transport | |||
of section members to and from their assigned duty | of section members to and from their assigned duty | |||
locations. Additionally, the assigned driver will | locations. Additionally, the assigned driver will | |||
conduct scheduled and unscheduled | conduct scheduled and unscheduled | |||
skipping to change at line 6186 | skipping to change at line 7095 | |||
noted in the Interpreter’s Comments section on the | noted in the Interpreter’s Comments section on the | |||
DTF. | DTF. | |||
i. Determine whether the letter is addressed to a | i. Determine whether the letter is addressed to a | |||
family member or not and annotate the DTF | family member or not and annotate the DTF | |||
appropriately. | appropriately. | |||
j. Ensure the translator has included his/her name | j. Ensure the translator has included his/her name | |||
on the DTF. | on the DTF. | |||
15-9. Detainee Library | 15-9. Detainee Library | |||
a. The Detainee Library (DL) is established to | a. The Detainee Library (DL) is established to | |||
support the approved Rewards/Punishment guidelines | support the approved Rewards/Punishment guidelines | |||
as set by the JTF GTMO commander. | set by the JTF GTMO Commander. | |||
b. The DL is presently staffed, maintained by, and | b. The DL is presently staffed by, maintained by, and | |||
responsible to the JDOG. It is tasked with supporting | responsible to the ICE. The DL is tasked with | |||
the joint interrogation process and assisting in | supporting the joint interrogation process and assisting | |||
maintaining order in the Camp with emphasis placed | with maintaining order in the Camp with an emphasis | |||
on Force Protection and fostering maximum | placed on fostering maximum cooperation from the | |||
cooperation from the detainees. | detainees. | |||
c. The DL will have two full-time service members | c. The DL will have a full-time librarian designated | |||
drawn from the JDOG Interpreter Cell to perform | or hired by the ICE Chief and/or JIG Director. The | |||
duties as librarians during hours of operation. One of | librarian will be a full time position, and will be | |||
these personnel will serve as the NCO Supervisor/ | supported by linguists on an on-call basis, to assist the | |||
Librarian and the other as the Assistant Librarian. Two | librarian cataloguing new reading material. The | |||
more interpreters will assist the librarians in the actual | librarian will be responsible for issue / return of | |||
distribution and return of the reading materials. These | reading materials from the DL. The librarian will | |||
designated personnel will be the sole POCs authorized | ensure that all reading materials are issued / returned in | |||
for issue / return of reading materials from the DL. | accordance with this SOP. No current periodicals will | |||
The librarians will ensure that all reading materials are | come into the camp. All interrogators will bring any | |||
issued / returned in accordance with this SOP. In | and all materials they want to distribute to detainees to | |||
special situations, other federal agencies may wish to | the librarian for screening and for confirmation that the | |||
issue reading material to detainees for reading outside | detainee is authorized a book. At no time will | |||
interview sessions (in their cells). These special | detainees receive or return reading materials through a | |||
circumstances must be coordinated with library | third party. In particular, guards must not engage in | |||
personnel. This would include cases where the | unaccounted book exchange. | |||
interrogators need to deliver books personally to | d. ICE will provide an appropriate location for | |||
detainees. At no time will detainees receive or return | storage of all library reading materials and issuance | |||
reading materials through a third party. In particular, | ||||
military police must not engage in unaccounted book | ||||
exchange. | ||||
d. The JDOG will provide an appropriate location | ||||
for storage of all library reading materials and issuance | ||||
documentation. This location will provide physical | documentation. This location will provide physical | |||
security (lock and key) to prevent unauthorized access. | security (lock and key) to prevent unauthorized access. | |||
The DOC will maintain a contingency spare key. One | The DOC will maintain a contingency spare key. One | |||
computer will be designated for library operations. | computer will be designated for library operations. | |||
e. Hours of operation for book issue / return are | The library computer will be a stand-alone system, | |||
0800-1530 (Monday-Friday). The circulation schedule | with a database to track and manage all library | |||
is subject to change. A typical circulation schedule will | business. | |||
be as follows: | e. All reading materials that have been approved for | |||
Day of | distribution among detainees must be stamped by the | |||
Week | S-2 with the official U.S. Forces stamp. Any reading | |||
Cell | materials found in the camp without that stamp is | |||
Bloc | subject to confiscation by JDOG and will not be | |||
k | returned. | |||
Lev | f. Detainees at levels 1 through 3 are allowed a | |||
el | Koran either in Arabic or in their native language. | |||
Monday A, | Detainees at levels 4 and 5 do not normally receive | |||
D, | reading material, but may receive books by exception | |||
1 | at the interrogator’s request. Detainees in Camps 1 and | |||
H | 4 who are listed as level 1 detainees, at the discretion | |||
Tuesday K, R 1 | of the interrogator, will receive one book for one week, | |||
Wednesd | with no option for renewal. Camp 2 detainees may | |||
ay | receive one book for one week at the discretion of the | |||
Q, P 1 | interrogator, with no option of renewal. Book | |||
Thursday B, F 2 | distribution is subject to supply. | |||
Friday E, G 3 | g. Books issued to Camp1 will not be issued to | |||
f. Cells at level 1 are allowed a Koran, and six | Camp 4 to minimize opportunities for communication | |||
books. Cells at level 2 are allowed one Koran, and four | through the books. Books will be purchased in | |||
books. Cells at level 3 are allowed one Koran, and two | duplicate in order to accommodate this requirement. | |||
books. Native Arab speakers are allowed one Arabic | h. Book issue procedures | |||
Koran only, while non-native Arabic speakers are | ||||
allowed one Arabic Koran and a translation of the | ||||
Koran in their native language. Cells at level 4 (I and | ||||
N) and at level 5 (M, T, and O) do not normally receive | ||||
reading material. Cells at level 4 and level 5 may | ||||
receive books by exception. | ||||
g. The following procedure will be used for every | ||||
issue of reading material: | ||||
(1) Confirm detainee is authorized reading | (1) Confirm detainee is authorized reading | |||
material privileges. | material privileges by the interrogator. | |||
(2) Confirm detainee is authorized that particular | (2) Confirm detainee is authorized that particular | |||
title (category). | title (category) by the interrogator. | |||
(3) Examine the reading material for damage or | (3) Examine the reading material for damage or | |||
markings (report any evidence of covert messages to | markings (report any evidence of covert messages to | |||
JDOG S-2 immediately). | JDOG S-2 immediately). | |||
(4) Annotate on the issue sheet: date, ISN, | (4) Log the book into the database, noting ID | |||
publication ID, and title. For publications requested by | number of book, ISN number of detainee to receive it, | |||
interrogators, annotate requesting person and | and the dates of issue and return. | |||
publication pull date. | i. Book return procedures | |||
h. The following procedure will be used for each | (1) Log the book into the database, confirming the | |||
return of reading material: | ISN number of the detainee returning the book. | |||
(1) Examine the reading material for damage or | Correlate the due date with date of return. | |||
markings (report any evidence of covert messages to | (2) Each book will be inspected for damage upon | |||
JDOG S-2 immediately). | return. Damage to books will result in disciplinary | |||
(2) Annotate on the issue sheet (enclosure) DTG | action determined by Chief, ICE and administered by | |||
of return and name of person returning the reading | CJDOG. Evidence of covert messages will be reported | |||
material. | to JDOG S-2 immediately. Library guidelines: | |||
i. General library guidelines: | (1) Approved materials will be catalogued prior to | |||
(1) All approved materials will be cataloged prior | circulation. | |||
to circulation. | (2) Detainees are authorized reading material | |||
(2) Selected detainees are authorized reading | according to level of cooperation as reading material | |||
material according to level of cooperation and as the | supply allows, unless otherwise directed by Director | |||
reading material supply allows, unless otherwise | JIG. | |||
directed by camp officials. | (3) Requests for books must be through the | |||
(3) Dictionaries may be issued in addition to the | interrogator, and must be approved by the interrogator. | |||
reading materials listed above (to include English | The interrogator must communicate to the librarian the | |||
dictionaries if desired by the interrogators). | type of book to be issued, particularly the languages | |||
(4) Two interpreters distribute reading material. | the detainee is able to read.(4) Each selected detainee is | |||
Reading material may be issued or returned during | offered reading material once a week in exchange for a | |||
unscheduled days, at the discretion of the Library | publication already in the detainee’s possession. A new | |||
personnel within the Interpreter Section. | book will not be issued until the previous publication | |||
(5) Each selected detainee is offered reading | has been returned. | |||
material once a week in exchange for a publication | (5) Reading material provided by the interrogators | |||
already in the detainee’s possession. A new book will | will be screened and approved by the librarian before | |||
not be issued until the previous publication has been | they enter the library system for cataloguing. Materials | |||
returned. | should be presented for approval 48 hours in advance | |||
(6) With the exception of the Interrogators, the | of when needed. For these additions, the letter “I” will | |||
Chaplain and library section members will issue | be included in the ID number of the publication. The | |||
reading materials. The Chaplain will issue Korans and | materials then become property of the library, and will | |||
other reading materials. | be managed as are all other reading materials managed | |||
(7) The Chaplain has unrestricted access to | by the librarian. | |||
library materials in the performance of his duties; | (6) If the librarian cannot make a decision on the | |||
however, reading material presented to the detainees by | distribution of specific reading materials based upon | |||
the Chaplain should be performed using the guidelines | the SOP, the librarian will take the material to the | |||
as prescribed in this SOP. Library personnel will | Library Working Group for approval/disapproval. The | |||
accompany the Chaplain during the reading material | Working Group will respond within 24 hours. | |||
exchange as needed. | (7) No English instructional materials, | |||
(8) Reading material provided by the JIG during | ||||
interrogation should be screened and approved by | ||||
interrogators and coordinated with the librarian before | ||||
they enter the library system for cataloging. For these | ||||
additions, the letter “I” will be included in the ID | ||||
number of the publication. | ||||
(9) No English instructional materials, | ||||
dictionaries, or other related reading material will be | dictionaries, or other related reading material will be | |||
distributed unless requested by the JIG. These | distributed. | |||
materials will be kept in a separate section in the | (8) The librarian will submit to DIMS a report | |||
library. | each week of the detainees who have books, and the ID | |||
(10) A copy of the reading material distribution | number of the book each detainee has, as a reference | |||
process and number of approved publications will be | for the guards. Documentation in DIMS should include | |||
included in the binder at each block as a reference to | an updated list of any detainees who have lost reading | |||
the MPs. Documentation should include an updated list | privileges and the date the privilege may be restored. | |||
of any detainees who have lost reading privileges due | Guards are not allowed to distribute or exchange | |||
to discipline problems. MPs are not allowed to | reading material from one detainee to another. | |||
distribute or exchange reading material from one | (9) Interrogators are the final approval authority | |||
detainee to another. | ||||
(11) On order, the DL will implement a | ||||
distribution process in support of the JIIF Reward or | ||||
Incentive Program which presently allows levels 1, 2, | ||||
and 3 detainees to receive Korans and other reading | ||||
materials, while detainees in level 4 (discipline hold) | ||||
and level 5 (intelligence hold) will not receive Korans | ||||
or any other reading material unless specified by the | ||||
interrogators. | ||||
(12) Interrogators are the final approval authority | ||||
for the issuance of reading material. It is their duty to | for the issuance of reading material. It is their duty to | |||
assist the librarian in updating the issuance database. | assist the librarian in updating the issuance database. | |||
Library personnel will submit a weekly summary to the | Library personnel will submit a weekly summary to the | |||
J-2 Analysis commander to include detainee ISN, book | Chief, ICE or his/her designee and J-2 Analysis | |||
title, and date checked out / in. | commander to include detainee ISN, book title, and | |||
j. Reading Material Purchases / Screening. | date checked out / in. | |||
Funding for new reading material purchases will be | k. Distribution process. | |||
requested through normal J-4 process. A “Non- | (1) The librarian will pull the book out, check it | |||
expendable / consumable request form” (enclosure 2) | out and distribute the books on Monday afternoons. | |||
will be completed and forwarded through J-4 JTF- | (2) The librarian will hand the book to the Block | |||
GTMO. Qualified interpreters will screen new | NCOIC who will hand the book to the detainee. The | |||
publication titles. Any books, which include the | MP will confirm that the book and ISN have been | |||
content listed below, will not be circulated and will be | entered into DIMS. | |||
immediately returned to the source (e.g. ICRC, private | (3) Books will be returned to the library on | |||
donor, etc…): | Monday mornings, with the Block NCOIC collecting | |||
(1) Extremism (Modernist writing that incites | the books from the detainees, and documenting the | |||
Jihad) | return in DIMS. The Block NCOIC should conduct a | |||
cursory search of the books for obvious marks and | ||||
notes. | ||||
(4) The librarian collects the books from the Block | ||||
NCOIC, returns them to the library, and checks them | ||||
in. | ||||
(5) By Tuesday, noon, the librarian must report on | ||||
the accountability for return of books to DOC and ICE. | ||||
Detainees who have not returned a book from last | ||||
week, must return the old book as well as one that may | ||||
have been distributed this week. The Interrogator must | ||||
retrieve the book and submit a 508, which will result in | ||||
35 days of loss of privilege for taking out books. | ||||
(6) By Thursday, noon, the librarian will check | ||||
each returned book for damage, checking for writing, | ||||
indentation marks, notes, codes, and torn pages. A | ||||
report will be sent to each interrogator of a detainee | ||||
who has damaged a book. The interrogator will then | ||||
submit a 508, which will result in 35 days of loss of | ||||
privilege for taking out books. Damaged books will be | ||||
sent to JDOG S-2 for review and submission to MPI as | ||||
necessary, and may be removed from distribution | ||||
permanently. | ||||
(7) New requests for books for detainees must be | ||||
submitted by noon the Friday prior to the desired | ||||
distribution day. Books may not be duplicated to a | ||||
detainee unless specifically requested by an | ||||
interrogator. | ||||
(8) Until the library is fully restocked, the librarian | ||||
will deliver approximately 10 books to each of the | ||||
Blocks in Camp Four for detainees to share for the | ||||
week. Failure to return a book or damage found in a | ||||
book will result in the entire block losing library | ||||
privileges for 35 days. When supply permits, more | ||||
books can be distributed to the detainees in Camp Four, | ||||
with a maximum of one book per detainee. | ||||
(9) Because books are not to be passed from one | ||||
detainee to another, if a book is not returned on time, or | ||||
if damage is found in a book, the original detainee who | ||||
checked out the book will be denied the library | ||||
privilege. If the book is found in a second cell, that | ||||
second detainee will also lose library privileges. | ||||
l. Reading Material Purchases / Screening. Funding | ||||
for new reading material purchases will be requested | ||||
through normal J-4 process. A “Nonexpendable / | ||||
consumable request form” will be completed and | ||||
forwarded through J-4 JTF-GTMO. Qualified | ||||
interpreters will screen new publication titles. Any | ||||
books, which include the content listed below, will not | ||||
be circulated and will be immediately returned to the | ||||
source (e.g. ICRC, private donor, etc…): | ||||
(1) Extremism (Modernist writing that incites Jihad) | ||||
(2) Militant Islam / Militant Jihad | (2) Militant Islam / Militant Jihad | |||
(3) Anti-American topics | (3) Anti-American topics | |||
(4) Anti-Semitic topics | (4) Anti-Semitic topics | |||
(5) Anti-Western topics | (5) Anti-Western topics | |||
(6) Any military topic | (6) Any military topic | |||
(7) Sexual situations. | (7) Sexual situations. | |||
k. Library Working Group. The Library Working | (8) Dictionaries. | |||
Group will meet bi-weekly to review library operations | (9) Language Instruction | |||
and forward recommendations to the JIIF commander. | (10) Technology/Medical Updates | |||
This group will consist of the Chaplain’s office, JDOG, | (11) Geography | |||
J-2 (JIG and CI), J-3 (IO and PSYOP), CTC, CITF, | m. Library Working Group. The Library Working | |||
and others as needed. This SOP is subject to change by | Group will meet bi-weekly to review library | |||
recommendation and approval of the Library Working | Operations and forward recommendations to the JIG | |||
Group. | commander. This group will consist of the ICE, | |||
15-10. Passive Collection Of CI Information | JDOG, J-2 (JIG and CI), J-3 (IO and PSYOP), and | |||
a. Collaboration between Interpreter and JDOG S-2 | others as needed. | |||
provides a framework within which interpreters can | ||||
materially contribute to the intelligence mission. | ||||
b. Each Interpreter is allowed to loiter in blocks and | ||||
be drawn into conversations with detainees. | ||||
c. The interpreter notes what the detainees say, ask | ||||
for, and the overall mental climate of the block. | ||||
d. The interpreter maintains radio contact with the | ||||
dispatcher and is subject to recall or redirection. | ||||
e. When the Interpreter leaves the block, he/she | ||||
immediately records findings on Standard Intelligence | ||||
Reporting Form (SIRF; see section 4.6.d.) | ||||
f. JDOG S-2 collects SIRFs from Interpreter Shift | ||||
NCO daily. | ||||
g. JDOG S-2 digests information gleaned from the | ||||
SIRFs. | ||||
h. JDOG S-2 directs further interpreter sorties. | ||||
i. The Standard Intelligence Reporting Form | ||||
(SIRF). | ||||
15-11. Intelligence Reference Guide For Linguists | ||||
a. Interpreters are to use the following list as a | ||||
reference when walking the blocks. They are to make | ||||
casual observations on the following detainee behavior: | ||||
(1) Communication | ||||
(2) Hostile actions | ||||
(3) Reverence to other detainees | ||||
(4) Wanting to give the other detainee an item | ||||
(book, etc…) | ||||
(5) Cheering when the other detainee says | ||||
something or passes by to the shower, etc… | ||||
(6) Leading Prayer | ||||
(7) Teachers | ||||
(8) Lookouts | ||||
(9) Any type of leadership behavior | ||||
(10) Instigators | ||||
(11) Anything suspicious or out of the ordinary | ||||
(12) Alliances those detainees have formed with | ||||
their neighboring detainees | ||||
(13) General attitude of the block | ||||
(14) If they’re angry, why? | ||||
15-12. Security Considerations | 15-12. Security Considerations | |||
a. Interpreters will practice good OPSEC and | a. Interpreters will practice good OPSEC and | |||
COMSEC both on and off duty; essential elements of | COMSEC both on and off duty; essential elements of | |||
friendly information (EEFIs) will be protected at all | friendly information (EEFIs) will be protected at all | |||
times; operations within the camp are not to be | times; operations within the camp are not to be | |||
discussed outside the JTF-GTMO channels. | discussed outside the JTF-GTMO channels. | |||
b. Interpreters are ordered to guard their personal | b. Interpreters are ordered to guard their personal | |||
information from disclosure to detainees. Nametapes | information from disclosure to detainees. Nametapes | |||
will be covered by duct tape. In addition, | will be covered by duct tape. In addition, | |||
recommended practices include the concealing of | recommended practices include the concealing of | |||
service affiliation, rank, and unit patches. | service affiliation, rank, and unit patches. | |||
Chapter 16 | Chapter 16 | |||
Religious Support | Religious Support | |||
Section I – Accommodation of Religion | Section I – Accommodation of Religion | |||
16-1. Chaplain | 16-1. Chaplain | |||
a. The chaplain is responsible for administering the | a. The chaplain is responsible for administering the | |||
religious program for the facility and shall be directly | religious program for the facility and shall be directly | |||
responsible to the CJDOG for providing religious | responsible to the CJDOG for providing religious | |||
coverage and pastoral care to all detainees. The | coverage and pastoral care throughout the camp. The | |||
chaplain is the principal advisor to the CJDOG on the | chaplain is the principal advisor to the CJDOG on | |||
religious needs of detainees. | religious issues. | |||
b. The chaplain is authorized unaccompanied access | b. The chaplain is authorized access to the detainee | |||
to the detainee holding areas and will be allowed to | holding areas and will be allowed to speak with | |||
speak freely with detainees. The chaplain is allowed to | detainees. A linguist and/or a chaplain assistant may | |||
distribute books and religious items to detainees in | accompany the chaplain. The chaplain will be assigned | |||
accordance with the detainee Library SOP. Block | an escort . | |||
Guards will give as much privacy to the chaplain as | c. The chaplain will provide observation and | |||
possible. A linguist and/or a chaplain assistant may | recommendations to the CJDOG and appropriate staff | |||
often accompany the chaplain. The chaplain may | officers. | |||
request an MP escort in circumstances where personal | ||||
security is of concern. | ||||
c. The chaplain provides the CJDOG an additional | ||||
resource by detainee issues and concerns can be | ||||
addressed. The chaplain will provide observation and | ||||
recommendations pertaining to both the general | ||||
detainee population and to individual detainee | ||||
treatment requirements to the CJDOG and appropriate | ||||
staff officers. | ||||
16-2. Religious Practices | 16-2. Religious Practices | |||
a. All detainees regardless of religious | a. Detainees will be given liberty in the exercise of | |||
denomination will be given complete liberty in the | their religion within the bounds of JDOG in a manner | |||
exercise of their religion on the condition that they | consistent with the articles of the Geneva Conventions | |||
comply with the disciplinary routine prescribed by | to the extent allowed by military necessity. | |||
JDOG in a manner consistent with the articles of the | b. The religious practices listed in sections 17-3 and | |||
Geneva Conventions to the extent allowed by military | ||||
necessity. | ||||
b. JDOG may choose to accommodate certain | ||||
detainee religious rites and observances when mission | ||||
requirements and military necessity permit. | ||||
c. The religious practices listed in sections 17-3 and | ||||
17-4 will be considered for accommodation when | 17-4 will be considered for accommodation when | |||
military necessity allows. | military necessity allows. | |||
d. At no time will personnel working at Camp Delta | c. Personnel working at Camp Delta act in a | |||
will not say or act in a manner that disrespectful to any | manner that is disrespectful to any religion or religious | |||
religion or religious practice. | practice. | |||
16-3. Chaplain Requests | 16-3. Chaplain Requests | |||
a. Any requests to see the chaplain by the detainees | a. Any requests to see the chaplain by detainees | |||
will be called into the DOC by the block. | will be entered into DIMS. | |||
b. The DOC will annotate all requests to see the | b. The JDOG Unit Ministry Team (UMT) | |||
chaplain on the Chaplain Requests form and placed in | Chaplain Assistant will monitor such requests and | |||
the chaplain distribution box. | report them to the JDOG Chaplain who will evaluate | |||
c. If the detainee requests to see a Christian | the request and forward the information to the | |||
chaplain, this will be annotated on the request form. | appropriate parties. | |||
c. Once the Chaplain has been notified of the | ||||
request, it will be marked as complete in DIMS. | ||||
16-4. Fasting Requests | 16-4. Fasting Requests | |||
a. Detainees will be given the opportunity to | a. Detainees will be given the opportunity to | |||
identify themselves as wanting to fast per week. | identify themselves as wanting to fast each week. | |||
b. For reoccurring fasting periods, such as the every | b. For reoccurring fasting periods, such as the every | |||
Monday and Thursday fasting, the following procedure | Monday and Thursday fasting, the following procedure | |||
will be used: | will be used: | |||
(1) The day shift on the Friday before the week | (1) The day shift on Friday will ask the detainees | |||
of Friday will ask the detainees if they want to fast. | if they want to fast. Detainees will not be added to or | |||
Detainees will not be added to or removed from the list | removed from the list after the end Friday day shift. | |||
after the Friday day shift ends. | ||||
(2) Each block will list the fasting detainees by | (2) Each block will list the fasting detainees by | |||
ISN and cell number. | ISN and cell number. | |||
(3) This list will be forwarded to the DOC by the | (3) This list will be forwarded to the DOC by the | |||
end of the shift. | end of the shift. | |||
(4) All lists will be consolidated into a single list, | (4) All lists will be consolidated into a single list, | |||
which contains the ISN and cell number. | which contains the ISN and cell number. | |||
(5) The list will be marked as “Monday and | (5) The list will be marked as “Monday and | |||
Thursday Fasting” and distributed to all MP | Thursday Fasting” and distributed to all blocks on | |||
companies. | Sunday. | |||
(6) Detainees on this list will not be removed | (6) Detainees on this list will not be removed | |||
unless directed by a medical professional. | unless directed by a medical professional. | |||
(7) The count will be forwarded through the | (7) The count will be forwarded through the | |||
supply room personnel to the JDOG S-4 so the MREs | supply room personnel to the JDOG S-4 so the MREs | |||
will be available. | will be available. | |||
(8) The list of fasting detainees will be | ||||
distributed to the blocks on the day of fasting. | ||||
c. For other fasting periods, such as Ramadan or | c. For other fasting periods, such as Ramadan or | |||
Eid, the following procedure will be used: | Eid, the following procedure will be used: | |||
(1) The chaplain will write an announcement to | (1) The chaplain will write an announcement to | |||
be read over the camp PA system. The announcement | be read over the camp PA system. The announcement | |||
will include at the minimum what the fasting period is | will include at the minimum what the fasting period is | |||
for, that the MPs will be asking if the detainees want to | for, that the guards will be asking if the detainees want | |||
fast, and once they are on the fasting list, the detainee | to fast, and once they are on the fasting list, the | |||
will stay on the fasting list. | detainee will stay on the fasting list. | |||
(2) JDOG will approve the announcement and it | (2) JDOG will approve the announcement and it | |||
will then be translated. | will then be translated. | |||
(3) The chaplain will read the English version | (3) An Interpreter will read the English version | |||
followed by the other translated text three days prior to | followed by the other translated text three days prior to | |||
the start of the fasting period. The announcement will | the start of the fasting period. The announcement will | |||
be completed NLT 1000 hours in all camps. | be completed NLT 1000 hours in all camps. | |||
(4) Block personnel will then ask the detainees | (4) Block personnel will then ask the detainees | |||
who wants to fast. | who wants to fast. | |||
(5) Each block will list the fasting detainees by | (5) Each block will list the fasting detainees by | |||
ISN and cell number. | ISN and cell number. | |||
(6) This list will be forwarded to the DOC by the | (6) This list will be forwarded to the DOC by the | |||
end of the shift. | end of the shift. | |||
(7) All lists will be consolidated into a single list, | (7) All lists will be consolidated into a single list, | |||
which contains the ISN and cell number. | which contains the ISN and cell number. | |||
(8) The list will be marked with the special | (8) The list will be marked with the special | |||
fasting period and date and distributed to all MP | fasting period and date and distributed to all blocks. | |||
companies. | ||||
(9) Detainees on this list will not be removed | (9) Detainees on this list will not be removed | |||
unless directed by a medical professional. | unless directed by a medical professional. | |||
(10) The count will be forwarded through the | (10) The count will be forwarded through the | |||
supply room personnel to the JDOG S-4 so the MREs | supply room personnel to the JDOG S-4 so the MREs | |||
will be available. | will be available. | |||
Section II - Muslim Detainee Religious | ||||
(11) The list of fasting detainees will be | Practices | |||
distributed to the blocks on the day of fasting. | ||||
Section II - Muslim Detainee Religious Practices | ||||
16-5. The Muslim Prayer | 16-5. The Muslim Prayer | |||
a. Muslim detainees perform prayer at least five | a. Muslim detainees perform prayer at least five | |||
times daily according to a specific prayer schedule. | times daily according to a specific prayer schedule. | |||
The chaplain will provide prayer times and are | Call to prayer will be announced over the PA. | |||
announced by camp personnel. | ||||
b. The Muslim Prayer requires the detainee to wash | b. The Muslim Prayer requires the detainee to wash | |||
with water his/her face, hands, arms, head, and feet | before prayer. A source of running water should be | |||
before prayer. In addition to the washing, the | provided. | |||
detainee’s body must also be free of filth. A source of | ||||
running water should be provided. | ||||
c. The Muslim prayer requires the detainee to pray | c. The Muslim prayer requires the detainee to pray | |||
towards the direction of Mecca, Saudi Arabia. Prayer | towards the direction of Mecca, Saudi Arabia. | |||
direction should be predetermined with the assistance | d. The Muslim prayer requires a clean place if | |||
of a subject matter expert in the Islamic faith. | possible. . An ISO mat and large towel is provided for | |||
d. The Muslim prayer requires that the prayer be | this purpose. | |||
made in a place free of filth. An ISO mat and large | e. Muslim prayer requires that the male detainee | |||
towel is provided for this purpose. | pray in clothing that covers at minimum the area | |||
e. The Muslim prayer requires that the male | between the navel and knees. Clothing issued to | |||
detainee pray in clothing that covers at minimum the | ||||
area between the navel and knees. At a minimum, | detainees should meet this requirement. Detainee | |||
clothing issued to detainees should meet this | issued orange suit meets this requirement. Muslim | |||
requirement. Detainee issued orange suit meets this | prayer requires that the female pray in clothing that | |||
requirement. The Muslim prayer requires that the | modestly covers all except the hands and face. An | |||
female pray in clothing that modestly covers all except | additional headscarf should be provided to Muslim | |||
the hands and face. An additional headscarf should be | females to cover the hair, head, and neck areas. | |||
provided to Muslim females to cover the hair, head, | ||||
and neck areas. | ||||
f. It is preferable according to Islamic doctrine that | f. It is preferable according to Islamic doctrine that | |||
the Muslim prayer is prayed in congregation. This | the Muslim prayer is prayed in congregation. This | |||
aspect of prayer is accommodated based on operational | aspect of prayer is accommodated based on operational | |||
conditions of the camp. | conditions of the camp. | |||
16-6. Friday Prayer Service | 16-6. Friday Prayer Service | |||
a. According to Islamic law, the weekly Friday | a. According to Islamic law, the weekly Friday | |||
Prayer Service is traditionally held on Fridays during | Prayer Service is traditionally held on Fridays during | |||
the time of the noon (2nd | the time of the noon (2nd | |||
daily) prayer time. | daily) prayer time. | |||
b. The congregational Friday Prayer Service | b. The congregational Friday Prayer Service | |||
includes a message or sermon and a shortened noon | includes a message or sermon and a shortened noon | |||
prayer. The Friday Prayer Service can be lead by any | prayer. The Friday Prayer Service can be lead by any | |||
male Muslim knowledgeable in the requirements of | male Muslim knowledgeable in the requirements of | |||
conducting the Friday Prayer. | conducting the Friday Prayer. | |||
c. Muslim requirements for participating and | c. Muslim requirements for participating and | |||
attending the Friday Prayer Service are the same as in | attending the Friday Prayer Service are the same as in | |||
paragraph 17-4.b through 17-4.e listed above. | paragraph 17-4.b through 17-4.e listed above. | |||
d. The Muslim Friday Prayer Service is | d. The Muslim Friday Prayer Service is | |||
accommodated by providing an open room or place | accommodated by providing an open room or place | |||
with a clean area free of filth, and spacious enough for | with a clean area, in addition, Muslim detainees will | |||
a congregation of Muslims to perform the prayer in | be provided the opportunity to perform the Friday | |||
straight rows facing a specific direction of prayer. In | Prayer Service to the extent allowed by military | |||
addition, Muslim detainees will be provided the | necessity. | |||
opportunity to perform the Friday Prayer Service to the | ||||
extent allowed by military necessity. | ||||
16-7. Muslim Fasting | 16-7. Muslim Fasting | |||
a. Ramadan | a. Ramadan | |||
(1) A month long fast in which a Muslim abstains | (1) A month long fast in which a Muslim abstains | |||
from food, drink, sexual relations, smoking, and in | from food, drink, sexual relations, smoking, and in | |||
general taking anything into the body from the hours of | general taking anything into the body from the hours of | |||
dawn (time of the 1st | dawn (time of the 1st | |||
daily prayer) until sunset (time of | daily prayer) until sunset (time of | |||
4th | 4th | |||
daily prayer). Ramadan is the ninth lunar month of | daily prayer). Ramadan is the ninth lunar month of | |||
the Islamic calendar. | the Islamic calendar. | |||
(2) Muslim detainees are provided a pre-dawn | (2) Muslim detainees are provided a pre-dawn | |||
meal to be served no later that 45 minutes prior to the | meal to be served prior to the time of the 1st | |||
time of the 1st | daily | |||
daily prayer (dawn). | prayer (dawn). | |||
(3) Dates and honey is provided for Muslim | (3) Dates and honey is provided for Muslim | |||
detainees to break their fast at time of the 4th | detainees to break their fast at time of the 4th | |||
prayer | prayer | |||
(sunset). | (sunset). | |||
(4) Muslim detainees are served a full meal 15 | (4) Muslim detainees are served a full meal | |||
minutes following sunset (4th | following sunset (4th | |||
prayer). | prayer). | |||
(5) The Chaplain will provide scheduled prayer | (5) The Chaplain will provide scheduled prayer | |||
times, which includes projected times for dawn (1st | times, which includes projected times for dawn (1st | |||
prayer) and sunset (4th | prayer) and sunset (4th | |||
prayer). | prayer). | |||
(6) Special Ramadan prayers (called Ta-ra-weeh) | (6) Special Ramadan prayers (called Ta-ra-weeh) | |||
are performed after the evening (5th | are performed after the evening (5th | |||
prayer) daily | prayer) daily | |||
during the month of Ramadan. These prayers could | during the month of Ramadan. These prayers could | |||
last approximately 1-2 hours. | last approximately 1-2 hours. | |||
skipping to change at line 6644 | skipping to change at line 7509 | |||
c. The manner of fasting these prescribed days is | c. The manner of fasting these prescribed days is | |||
performed in the same manner as one would fast a day | performed in the same manner as one would fast a day | |||
of Ramadan. | of Ramadan. | |||
d. Muslims detainees desiring to maintain this | d. Muslims detainees desiring to maintain this | |||
practice of fasting these prescribed days are | practice of fasting these prescribed days are | |||
accommodated in the same manner as in | accommodated in the same manner as in | |||
accommodating a day of fasting in Ramadan. | accommodating a day of fasting in Ramadan. | |||
16-8. Muslim Holiday - Eid | 16-8. Muslim Holiday - Eid | |||
a. Islam has two major religious holidays: Eid Al- | a. Islam has two major religious holidays: Eid Al- | |||
Fitr (Feast of Breaking the Fast) and Eid Al-Adha | Fitr (Feast of Breaking the Fast) and Eid Al-Adha | |||
(Feast of Sacrifice). Eid Al-Fitr celebrates completing | (Feast of Sacrifice). Eid Al-Fitr celebrates completing | |||
the month long fast of Ramadan. Projected dates will | the month long fast of Ramadan. Projected dates will | |||
be provided by the chaplain or by a subject matter | be provided by the chaplain or by a subject matter | |||
expert in Islam. | expert in Islam. | |||
(1) Eid Al-Fitr (Feast of Breaking the Fast) | (1) Eid Al-Fitr (Feast of Breaking the Fast) | |||
celebrates completing the month long fast of Ramadan. | celebrates completing the month long fast of Ramadan. | |||
It occurs on the first day immediately following | ||||
Ramadan and is traditionally determined by the | ||||
sighting of the new moon. | ||||
(2) Eid Al-Adha (Feast of Sacrifice) | (2) Eid Al-Adha (Feast of Sacrifice) | |||
commemorates the Biblical and Quranic sacrifice of | commemorates sacrifice of Abraham. It occurs on the | |||
Abraham. It occurs on the 10th | 10th | |||
day of the twelfth lunar | day of the twelfth lunar month of the Islamic | |||
month of the Islamic calendar (Dhu Hijjah), which is | calendar, which is approximately 69 days following the | |||
approximately 69 days following the Eid Al-Fitr. | Eid Al-Fitr. | |||
b. On both Eid holidays, an Eid Prayer Service is | b. On both Eid holidays, an Eid Prayer Service is | |||
held in the morning after sunrise but before the noon | held in the morning after sunrise but before the noon | |||
(2nd | (2nd | |||
) prayer. The Eid Prayer Service is congregational | ) prayer. The Eid Prayer Service is congregational | |||
and consists of a group prayer followed by a message | and consists of a group prayer followed by a message | |||
or sermon. | or sermon. | |||
c. The Eid Prayer Service is accommodated in the | c. The Eid Prayer Service is accommodated in the | |||
same manner as in accommodating the Friday Prayer | same manner as in accommodating the Friday Prayer | |||
Service. Eid holiday meals with traditional Arabic | Service. Eid holiday meals with traditional Arabic | |||
sweets are provided to detainees on the day of Eid Al- | sweets are provided to detainees on the day of Eid Al- | |||
skipping to change at line 6728 | skipping to change at line 7590 | |||
detainee enough privacy to ensure that the area | detainee enough privacy to ensure that the area | |||
between her shoulders and her knees is not exposed to | between her shoulders and her knees is not exposed to | |||
another female individual. | another female individual. | |||
d. All detainee showers will allow the Muslim | d. All detainee showers will allow the Muslim | |||
detainee complete privacy from members of the | detainee complete privacy from members of the | |||
opposite sex. | opposite sex. | |||
e. Islamic guidelines for health and hygiene dictate | e. Islamic guidelines for health and hygiene dictate | |||
the practice of shaving the body hair of armpit and | the practice of shaving the body hair of armpit and | |||
pubic areas. Periodically, razors will be provided for | pubic areas. Periodically, razors will be provided for | |||
Muslim detainees desiring to maintain this practice | Muslim detainees desiring to maintain this practice | |||
unless the detainee is in a MSU block. | unless the detainee is in a segregation block or Delta | |||
16-13. Religious Items | Block on self-harm watch. | |||
a. The chaplain will provide specific religious | 16-13. Religious Accommodation | |||
items to Muslim detainees to facilitate worship and | a. Any other religious faith traditions will be | |||
religious practices. Those items include but are not | considered on a case-by-case basis and will be | |||
limited to the following: | provided for appropriately. | |||
(1) Koran | b. Religious items will distributed in accordance | |||
(2) Prayer Cap | with the detainee current reward level. | |||
(3) Prayer Beads | ||||
(4) Islamic Oils | ||||
(5) Religious Books (Provided by detainee | ||||
Library personnel). | ||||
b. Religious items are distributed in accordance | ||||
with the detainee Rewards Program. | ||||
Section III – Islam | Section III – Islam | |||
16-14. Cultural Considerations | 16-14. Cultural Considerations | |||
a. Do not disrespect the Koran (let it touch the floor, | a. Do not disrespect the Koran (let it touch the floor, | |||
kick it, step on it). | kick it, step on it). | |||
(1) Muslims even wash their hands before | (1) Muslims even wash their hands before | |||
touching the Koran; non-Muslims should avoid | touching the Koran; non-Muslims should avoid | |||
touching a detainee’s Koran whenever possible. | touching a detainee’s Koran whenever possible. | |||
(2) Anyone disrespecting the Koran most likely | (2) Anyone disrespecting the Koran most likely | |||
will get no cooperation and could provoke a violent | will get no cooperation and could provoke a violent | |||
reaction from detainees. | reaction from detainees. | |||
b. Friday is the Islamic holy day; prayer time is | b. Friday is the Islamic holy day; prayer time is | |||
most sacred on this day. | most sacred on this day. | |||
c. Do not talk, play loud music in front of, or | c. Do not talk, play loud music in front of, or | |||
otherwise interrupt detainees during prayer or the call | otherwise interrupt detainees during prayer or the call | |||
to prayer. | to prayer. | |||
(1) Interrupting a Muslim during prayer is | (1) Interrupting a Muslim during prayer is | |||
considered inappropriate and he is unlikely to respond. | considered inappropriate and he is unlikely to respond. | |||
skipping to change at line 6767 | skipping to change at line 7622 | |||
to prayer. | to prayer. | |||
(1) Interrupting a Muslim during prayer is | (1) Interrupting a Muslim during prayer is | |||
considered inappropriate and he is unlikely to respond. | considered inappropriate and he is unlikely to respond. | |||
(2) Avoid mocking or imitating detainee’s prayer. | (2) Avoid mocking or imitating detainee’s prayer. | |||
d. Do not eat or drink in front of detainees during | d. Do not eat or drink in front of detainees during | |||
the Islamic holy month of Ramadan. | the Islamic holy month of Ramadan. | |||
(1) Ramadan has significant religious | (1) Ramadan has significant religious | |||
importance. | importance. | |||
(2) Detainees will be fasting during daylight | (2) Detainees will be fasting during daylight | |||
hours. | hours. | |||
(3) During Ramadan, the detainees will for the | e.Do not ask about female members of a | |||
most part be non-argumentative and non- | Muslim’s family (e.g., wife, daughter, mother, sister, | |||
confrontational as to not upset their fast. | etc.); it is culturally unsuitable. Do not insist on asking | |||
e. Do not ask about female members of a Muslim’s | the names of the women. | |||
family (e.g., wife, daughter, mother, sister, etc.); it is | ||||
culturally unsuitable. Do not insist on asking the | ||||
names of the women. | ||||
f. Do not use the left hand to give a detainee food. | f. Do not use the left hand to give a detainee food. | |||
Muslims use their left hand to clean themselves and it | Muslims use their left hand to clean themselves and it | |||
is culturally inappropriate to offer food with the left | is culturally inappropriate to offer food with the left | |||
hand. | hand. | |||
g. Do not relate terrorism to Islam. It is | g. Do not relate terrorism to Islam. It is | |||
inappropriate to equate any religion to such heinous | inappropriate to equate any religion to such activity. | |||
activity. | ||||
h. Do not point a finger at detainees as it is | h. Do not point a finger at detainees as it is | |||
considered very disrespectful and derogatory. | considered very disrespectful and derogatory. | |||
i. Avoid using foul language as it displays a lack of | i. Avoid using foul language as it displays a lack of | |||
composure. | composure. | |||
j. Female Block Guards and interpreters should not | j. Female guards and interpreters should not insist | |||
insist that the detainees make eye contact with them | that the detainees make eye contact with them during | |||
during interactions. Close contact with unrelated | interactions. Close contact with unrelated females is | |||
females is culturally inappropriate. | culturally inappropriate. | |||
k. Detainees might cover their eyes or not talk to | k. Detainees might cover their eyes or not talk to | |||
female Block Guards. Such actions are not considered | female guards. Such actions are not considered | |||
disrespectful but instead are considered a form of | disrespectful but instead are considered a form of | |||
modesty by the detainee. | modesty by the detainee. | |||
l. The loudspeakers should not be covered nor any | l. The loudspeakers should not be covered nor any | |||
form of music be played through the unit block | form of music be played through the unit block | |||
speakers. The playing of the call to prayer should not | speakers. The playing of the call to prayer should not | |||
have the volume adjusted up or down. | have the volume adjusted up or down. | |||
m.If you do not understand what is going on or have | m.Communicating Through An Interpreter | |||
questions about some cultural practice, ask the Islamic | ||||
Chaplain. | ||||
n. Communicating Through An Interpreter | ||||
(1) Interpreters are tasked to facilitate the | (1) Interpreters are tasked to facilitate the | |||
communication process between camp personnel and | communication process between camp personnel and | |||
the detainees. Interpreters will relay detainee | the detainees. Interpreters will relay detainee | |||
questions/requests to the Block NCO or other authority | questions/requests to the Block NCO or other authority | |||
as appropriate for follow up. | as appropriate for follow up. | |||
(2) Direct your statement to the detainee and then | (2) Direct your statement to the detainee and then | |||
pause for the interpreter to translate. | pause for the interpreter to translate. | |||
(3) Avoid using slang (e.g., “…we’re in the same | (3) Avoid using slang (e.g., “…we’re in the same | |||
boat.”) when utilizing an interpreter. Slang is difficult | boat.”) when utilizing an interpreter. Slang is difficult | |||
to translate and often loses its meaning during | to translate and often loses its meaning during | |||
skipping to change at line 6857 | skipping to change at line 7706 | |||
(d) November 1—the solemnity of All Saints | (d) November 1—the solemnity of All Saints | |||
(e) December 8—the solemnity of the | (e) December 8—the solemnity of the | |||
Immaculate | Immaculate | |||
d. Christian detainees (to include those who follow | d. Christian detainees (to include those who follow | |||
the beliefs of the Roman Catholic Church) should be | the beliefs of the Roman Catholic Church) should be | |||
allowed to celebrate these special days in accordance | allowed to celebrate these special days in accordance | |||
with their personal faith. | with their personal faith. | |||
e. The Christian chaplain can be used to provide | e. The Christian chaplain can be used to provide | |||
additional information relating to the celebration of | additional information relating to the celebration of | |||
these days. | these days. | |||
16-17. Religious Items: | 16-17. Religious Items: | |||
a. The chaplain may provide specific religious items | The JDOG Unit Ministry Team (UMT) will provide | |||
to Christian detainees to facilitate worship and | or oversee the supply of specific items to Muslim | |||
religious practices. Those items include but are not | detainees to facilitate worship and religious practices. | |||
limited to the following: | Those items include but are not limited to the | |||
(1) The Holy Bible | following: | |||
(2) A Crucifix | (1) Koran | |||
(3) Rosary Beads | (2) Prayer Cap | |||
(4) Religious Books (Provided by detainee | (3) Prayer Beads | |||
Library personnel) | (4) Islamic Prayer Oils | |||
b. Religious items are distributed in accordance | b. Korans will not be supplied by the JDOG | |||
with the detainee Rewards Program. | UMT. All Koran requests entered into DIMS as a | |||
Chaplain request are to be changed to Librarian | ||||
requests. The completed date will be erased before the | ||||
request is saved as a Librarian request. | ||||
c. The JDOG UMT Chaplain Assistant will | ||||
oversee the supply, preparation, and delivery of the | ||||
prayer beads and prayer caps. These items are to be | ||||
handled as follows: | ||||
(1) Prayer beads and Prayer Caps will be | ||||
obtained through the S-4. They will be requested and | ||||
picked up by the JDOG UMT Chaplain Assistant. | ||||
(2) New prayer beads are to have the tassels | ||||
cut off and the remaining ends burned. This process | ||||
will be followed to prevent detainees from using the | ||||
tassel string as contraband. Prayer beads that have | ||||
been prepared for the detainees will be stored in the | ||||
Camp Delta JDOG UMT office. | ||||
(3) All prayer caps are to be inspected for tears | ||||
or holes after being received from S4. Any prayer caps | ||||
with such defects are to be disposed of. Prayer caps | ||||
are to have all stickers removed from them before | ||||
distribution to the detainees. Inspected and approved | ||||
prayer caps will be stored in the JDOG UMT Religious | ||||
Items filing cabinet, upper drawer. Caps will only be | ||||
stored clean and will be folded and neat. | ||||
(4) All requests for replacement prayer beads | ||||
or prayer caps must be entered into DIMS by the MP | ||||
guards. Chaplain Assistants will not accept requests | ||||
directly from any detainee. Detainees must request | ||||
prayer beads or prayer caps through the MP guards. | ||||
(5) Deliveries of requested items will be made | ||||
on Tuesday and Friday. Requests entered into DIMS | ||||
on Tuesday, Wednesday, or Thursday will be supplied | ||||
on Friday. Requests entered into DIMS on Friday, | ||||
Saturday, Sunday, or Monday will be supplied on | ||||
Tuesday. | ||||
(6) Prayer caps and beads are to be exchanged | ||||
on a one-for-one basis. The only exception should be | ||||
when prayer beads are broken and confiscated by the | ||||
MP guards. | ||||
(7) Prayer caps collected from the detainees | ||||
will be inspected for holes or wear and tear. | ||||
Serviceable prayer caps will be turned in to S-4 to be | ||||
laundered. Laundered prayer caps will be re-entered | ||||
into the normal supply chain. | ||||
(8) Prayer beads collected from the detainees | ||||
are to be inspected to see if they are still serviceable. | ||||
Prayer beads with visible string extending beyond the | ||||
length of two beads are not serviceable. Prayer beads | ||||
that are missing beads or appear to be discolored are | ||||
not serviceable. Non-serviceable prayer beads will be | ||||
disposed of. | ||||
d. The supply and distribution of pray oil is to be | ||||
handled as follows: | ||||
(1) Prayer oil will be obtained through the S-4. | ||||
It will be requested and picked up by the JDOG UMT | ||||
Chaplain Assistant. There are two varieties of prayer | ||||
oil available: | ||||
i) Sandalwood, white in color. | ||||
ii)Egyptian Musk, yellow in color. | ||||
(2) Oil will be divided into plastic baggies. | ||||
There will be thirteen white oils and seven yellow oils | ||||
in each baggie. Prayer Oil will be stored only after it | ||||
has been packaged in baggies. The oil baggies will be | ||||
stored in the JDOG UMT Religious Items filing | ||||
cabinet, lower drawer. The oil baggies will be kept in a | ||||
large plastic bag which will be tied closed. | ||||
(3) Chaplain Assistants will supply each block | ||||
with a baggie of oils. Chaplain Assistants will monitor | ||||
the supply at least once a week to ensure each block | ||||
has an adequate supply of oils to meet the requests of | ||||
the detainees. | ||||
(4) All requests for replacement prayer oil will | ||||
be processed through the MP guards. Requests for | ||||
prayer oil should not be entered into DIMS. Chaplain | ||||
Assistants will not provide oil directly to the detainees. | ||||
MP guards should respond to oil requests and distribute | ||||
oil accordingly. | ||||
e. All requests for items will be monitored | ||||
through DIMS. The requests report will be printed | ||||
prior to delivering supplies to the blocks. The report | ||||
will be printed on the day of delivery. After supplying | ||||
requests to the blocks, requests are to be marked in | ||||
DIMS as complete. Updates will be made the same | ||||
day as delivery to keep DIMS current at all times. | ||||
f. Camp 4 and any other facilities needing a | ||||
regular supply of religious items will be stocked on a | ||||
periodic basis. MP guards working in these facilities | ||||
will meet the detainee requests. Detainee requests for | ||||
these facilities do not need to be entered into DIMS. | ||||
Chaplain Assistants will monitor the supply at least | ||||
once a month to ensure an adequate supply is available | ||||
to meet the requests of the detainees. | ||||
Section V – Muslim Funerals | Section V – Muslim Funerals | |||
16-18. Muslim Funeral and Burial Rites | 16-18. Muslim Funeral and Burial Rites | |||
a. The chaplain will perform or provide for the | a. The chaplain will perform or provide for the | |||
honorable burial of a deceased detainee in a manner | honorable burial of a deceased detainee in a manner | |||
consistent with Article 120 of the Geneva Convention | consistent with Article 120 of the Geneva Convention | |||
to the extent allowed by military necessity. | to the extent allowed by military necessity. | |||
b. Funeral and burial rites according to Islamic law | b. Funeral and burial rites according to Islamic law | |||
necessitate that 4 actions be performed. All four | necessitate that 4 actions be performed. Persons of the | |||
actions must be performed by persons of the Muslim | Muslim faith must perform all four actions. Muslims | |||
faith. Muslims performing these actions must be | performing these actions must be knowledgeable in the | |||
knowledgeable in the requirements of Islamic | requirements of Islamic purification and Muslim | |||
purification and Muslim funeral/burial rites. The 4 | funeral/burial rites. The 4 necessary actions are to be | |||
necessary actions are to be performed in the following | performed in the following order: | |||
order: | ||||
(1) Washing the body | (1) Washing the body | |||
(2) Shrouding the body | (2) Shrouding the body | |||
(3) Funeral prayer (Janaza prayer) | (3) Funeral prayer (Janaza prayer) | |||
(4) Burial. | (4) Burial. | |||
16-19. Washing the Body | 16-19. Washing the Body | |||
a. Protect the nakedness of the deceased by keeping | a. Protect the nakedness of the deceased by keeping | |||
the body clothed while the washing is performed. In | the body clothed while the washing is performed. In | |||
addition, if the deceased is male, then only a Muslim | addition, if the deceased is male, then only a Muslim | |||
male should wash the body of the deceased. Likewise, | male should wash the body of the deceased. Likewise, | |||
if the deceased is a female, then a Muslim female will | if the deceased is a female, then a Muslim female will | |||
skipping to change at line 6912 | skipping to change at line 7852 | |||
body, however at no time will the area between the | body, however at no time will the area between the | |||
naval and the knees of the deceased be uncovered. | naval and the knees of the deceased be uncovered. | |||
d. Any waste from the stomach should be forced | d. Any waste from the stomach should be forced | |||
out, and private parts of the deceased by cleansed of | out, and private parts of the deceased by cleansed of | |||
filth. | filth. | |||
e. The washer performs the usual ablution before | e. The washer performs the usual ablution before | |||
prayer (in Arabic “wudu”) for the deceased and on the | prayer (in Arabic “wudu”) for the deceased and on the | |||
deceased. | deceased. | |||
f. The washer then performs the purificatory bath | f. The washer then performs the purificatory bath | |||
(in Arabic “ghusl”) with religious intention. The | (in Arabic “ghusl”) with religious intention. The | |||
purifcatory bath consists of washing the head, beard, | purificatory bath consists of washing the head, beard, | |||
and body each three times. The washer begins each | and body each three times. The washer begins each | |||
repetition by washing the right side of the deceased, | repetition by washing the right side of the deceased, | |||
front and back, to the feet. The repetition is completed | front and back, to the feet. Doing the same to the left | |||
by doing the same to the left side. The washer ensures | side completes the repetition. The washer ensures that | |||
that water reaches and covers every external part of the | water reaches and covers every external part of the | |||
body and that the body is free of all filth. The hair and | body and that the body is free of all filth. The hair and | |||
beard if matted is gently combed with a wide-tooth | beard if matted is gently combed with a wide-tooth | |||
comb being careful not to extract any hair. The final | comb being careful not to extract any hair. The final | |||
washing should be performed with water containing | washing should be performed with water containing | |||
some camphor or perfume. | some camphor or perfume. | |||
g. The washer and the assistant should utilize hand | g. The washer and the assistant should utilize hand | |||
towels, wash cloths and gloves. | towels, wash cloths and gloves. | |||
h. The place of washing should be on an incline | h. The place of washing should be on an incline | |||
allowing the water to flow from the head downward | allowing the water to flow from the head downward | |||
and away. The assistant helps in pouring abundant | and away. The assistant helps in pouring abundant | |||
water. | water. | |||
i. Incense should be burned during the washing. | i. Incense should be burned during the washing. | |||
j. Upon completion of the washing, the body of the | j. Upon completion of the washing, the body of the | |||
deceased is dried with a clean towel, laid on his back | deceased is dried with a clean towel, laid on his back | |||
with his feet towards the direction of prayer, and | with his feet towards the direction of prayer, and | |||
skipping to change at line 6953 | skipping to change at line 7894 | |||
and laid on his back on the top sheet. Some scent or | and laid on his back on the top sheet. Some scent or | |||
perfume should be applied with cotton on the parts of | perfume should be applied with cotton on the parts of | |||
body upon which one rests during prayer prostration, | body upon which one rests during prayer prostration, | |||
i.e. forehead, nose, hands, knees and feet. Also include | i.e. forehead, nose, hands, knees and feet. Also include | |||
the eyes, mouth, nostrils, and ears. | the eyes, mouth, nostrils, and ears. | |||
d. If possible, the deceased left hand is placed on | d. If possible, the deceased left hand is placed on | |||
the chest, and then the deceased right hand is place on | the chest, and then the deceased right hand is place on | |||
the left – similar to the position of the hands in the | the left – similar to the position of the hands in the | |||
form of the Muslim prayer. Each shroud covers the | form of the Muslim prayer. Each shroud covers the | |||
whole body. The edge of the top sheet is folded over | whole body. The edge of the top sheet is folded over | |||
the deceased right side, then the other edge is folded | the deceased right side, and then the other edge is | |||
over the deceased left side. The second sheet is folded | folded over the deceased left side. The second sheet is | |||
in the same manner, and then the third sheet is folded | folded in the same manner, and then the third sheet is | |||
in the same manner. If the deceased is male, the body | folded in the same manner. If the deceased is male, the | |||
is wrapped without the ankle-length shirt or | body is wrapped without the ankle-length shirt or | |||
turban/prayer cap. If the deceased is female, the | turban/prayer cap. If the deceased is female, the | |||
following is done before wrapping of the sheets: | following is done before wrapping of the sheets: | |||
(1) Two approx 4ft x 1 ft loin cloths are first | (1) Two approx 4ft x 1 ft loin cloths are first | |||
wrapped around the upper legs acting as underwear | wrapped around the upper legs acting as underwear | |||
(2) One approx 6ft x 3 ½ ft sheet is used to wrap | (2) One approx 6ft x 3 ½ ft sheet is used to wrap | |||
the lower portion of the body | the lower portion of the body | |||
(3) The body dressed in a full, loose fitting | (3) The body dressed in a full, loose fitting | |||
sleeveless shirt, full length and long enough to cover | sleeveless shirt, full length and long enough to cover | |||
from shoulders to feet | from shoulders to feet | |||
(4) The head is veiled with a Muslim headscarf | (4) The head is veiled with a Muslim headscarf | |||
e. The sheets are then fastened with four cloth strips | e. The sheets are then fastened with four cloth strips | |||
or tie ropes above the head, under the feet, and two | or tie ropes above the head, under the feet, and two | |||
around the body. | around the body. | |||
f. Materials used to wrap and dress the body of the | f. Materials used to wrap and dress the body of the | |||
deceased should be cotton. | deceased should be cotton. | |||
g. The washed, white cotton shrouds are scented | g. The washed, white cotton shrouds are scented | |||
with incense or aloes and sprinkled with an aromatic | with incense or aloes and sprinkled with an aromatic | |||
compound of camphor, scented oils and/or perfumes. | compound of camphor, scented oils and/or perfumes. | |||
h. Procedures for funeral prayer. | h. Procedures for funeral prayer. | |||
skipping to change at line 7017 | skipping to change at line 7957 | |||
(e) The Prayer for the Prophet | (e) The Prayer for the Prophet | |||
(f) Supplication for the deceased, the minimum | (f) Supplication for the deceased, the minimum | |||
being “O Allah, forgive this deceased.” | being “O Allah, forgive this deceased.” | |||
(g) Ending the prayer by saying “As-Salaamu | (g) Ending the prayer by saying “As-Salaamu | |||
‘Alaykum” (Peace be upon you ) – the first of two | ‘Alaykum” (Peace be upon you ) – the first of two | |||
mentioning. | mentioning. | |||
16-21. Procedures for the Burial. | 16-21. Procedures for the Burial. | |||
a. The deceased will be buried in a cemetery, and | a. The deceased will be buried in a cemetery, and | |||
not in a grave where another person is previously | not in a grave where another person is previously | |||
buried. Muslims should not be buried beside non- | buried. Muslims should not be buried beside non- | |||
Muslims, nor non-Muslims beside Muslims. Muslims | Muslims, or non-Muslims beside Muslims. Muslims | |||
should have their own graveyard. | should have their own graveyard. | |||
b. The burial should be done as soon as possible | b. The burial should be done as soon as possible | |||
after death, and within 24 hours. | after death, and within 24 hours. | |||
c. The burial should take place immediately after | c. The burial should take place immediately after | |||
the funeral prayer. | the funeral prayer. | |||
d. The deceased is not buried in a coffin, but one | d. The deceased is not buried in a coffin, but one | |||
may be used to transport the body of the deceased to | may be used to transport the body of the deceased to | |||
the grave. | the grave. | |||
e. The grave must be dug deep enough to totally | e. The grave must be dug deep enough to totally | |||
hide the body of the deceased. A recommendation is to | hide the body of the deceased. A recommendation is to | |||
skipping to change at line 7066 | skipping to change at line 8007 | |||
forgiveness of the deceased. | forgiveness of the deceased. | |||
MUSLIM BURIAL | MUSLIM BURIAL | |||
(Side View) | (Side View) | |||
Figure 16-1 | Figure 16-1 | |||
Chapter 17 | Chapter 17 | |||
International Committee Of The Red Cross (ICRC) | International Committee Of The Red Cross (ICRC) | |||
17-1. Personnel | 17-1. Personnel | |||
a. There will be four ICRC escort teams consisting | a. There will be four ICRC escort teams consisting | |||
of two MPs. | of two guards. | |||
b. There will be one ICRC monitor located in Juliet | b. There will be one ICRC monitor located in Juliet | |||
block. | block. | |||
c. ICRC escort teams or the ICRC monitor will | c. ICRC escort teams or the ICRC monitor will | |||
escort all ICRC personnel at all times while in Camp | escort all ICRC personnel at all times while in Camp | |||
Delta. | Delta. | |||
d. Escort Control will control all ICRC escorts and | d. Escort Control will control all ICRC escorts and | |||
the ICRC monitor. | the ICRC monitor. | |||
e. The Juliet Block monitor will escort all ICRC | e. The Juliet Block monitor will escort all ICRC | |||
personnel If the visit is an individual interview, the | personnel If the visit is an individual interview, the | |||
Juliet Block monitor will escort the ICRC personnel to | Juliet Block monitor will escort the ICRC personnel to | |||
Juliet block. One MP will stay with the ICRC | Juliet block. One escort will stay with the ICRC | |||
personnel while the other two get the detainee and | personnel while the other two get the detainee and | |||
return with him. If it is a cell visit, the three-man team | return with him. If it is a cell visit, the three-man team | |||
will escort the ICRC personnel to and throughout the | will escort the ICRC personnel to and throughout the | |||
block visit. | block visit. Escort Control will attempt to move | |||
detainees from Camp 2/3 to Juliet block by Gator | ||||
whenever practical. | ||||
17-2. Operations | 17-2. Operations | |||
a. The physical security of U.S. Forces and | a. The physical security of U.S. Forces and | |||
detainees in U.S. care is paramount. Safety and | detainees in U.S. care is paramount. Safety and | |||
security of U.S. Forces and detainees will not be | security of U.S. Forces and detainees will not be | |||
compromised in an effort to conform to the wishes and | compromised in an effort to conform to the wishes and | |||
requests of the ICRC that are not covered in this SOP. | requests of the ICRC that are not covered in this SOP. | |||
b. The ICRC will provide the JDOG a list of | b. The ICRC will provide the JDOG a list of | |||
detainees on the ICRC Request form. This list will | detainees on the ICRC Request form. This list will | |||
stipulate either individual interviews or cell visits. | stipulate either individual interviews or cell visits. | |||
c. All ICRC personnel and detainees will be | c. All ICRC personnel and detainees will be | |||
escorted by MPs and detainees will be in three-piece | escorted by guards and detainees will be in three-piece | |||
suites while they are out of their cell. At no time will | suites while they are out of their cell. At no time will | |||
the detainee be unaccompanied by MPs. | the detainee be unaccompanied by guards. | |||
d. If any interviews by ICRC are conducted on the | d. If any interviews by ICRC are conducted on the | |||
blocks, the MPs will remain with the ICRC far enough | blocks, the guards will remain with the ICRC far | |||
away as to not interfere with the interviews. This is to | enough away as to not interfere with the interviews. | |||
ensure the safety of the ICRC personnel and the | This is to ensure the safety of the ICRC personnel and | |||
detainee. | the detainee. The guards will not stand within earshot | |||
of the ICRC representative and detainee. | ||||
e. ICRC personnel must collect any item, such as a | e. ICRC personnel must collect any item, such as a | |||
pen to write with, that they give to a detainee prior to | pen to write with, that they give to a detainee prior to | |||
moving on to the next detainee. | moving on to the next detainee. No pen can be passed | |||
from one detainee to another. | ||||
f. While in the interview block, only one hand may | f. While in the interview block, only one hand may | |||
be unshackled to allow the detainee to write. | be unshackled to allow the detainee to write. | |||
g. ICRC personnel are allowed access to all blocks. | g. ICRC personnel are allowed access to all blocks. | |||
ICRC visit lists should be scrubbed to insure there are | ICRC visit lists should be scrubbed to insure there are | |||
no discrepancies such as disciplinary actions or | no discrepancies such as disciplinary actions or | |||
restricted ICRC access. There is no time limit for | restricted ICRC access. There is no time limit for | |||
ICRC visits. | ICRC visits. | |||
h. JDOG will also provide an alternate place for | h. JDOG will also provide an alternate place for | |||
ICRC so that the ICRC may conduct interviews | ICRC so that the ICRC may conduct interviews | |||
without other detainees present. This location is | without other detainees present. This location is | |||
currently Juliet block. | currently Juliet block. | |||
i. Guards will identify any detainee that poses a | ||||
security risk to the ICRC representative. | ||||
j. Block NCOs must know the access privileges for | ||||
all detainees on their block. | ||||
k. ICRC has access to all blocks within Camp Delta. | ||||
The ICRC is restricted from all buildings | ||||
without prior approval from JDOG operations | ||||
except the Detention Clinic and the Detention | ||||
Hospital. | ||||
l. ICRC will be aware of scheduled guard feeding | ||||
times and the need to adjust their schedule accordingly | ||||
so guards have an opportunity to eat. | ||||
17-3. ICRC Visitation Rules | 17-3. ICRC Visitation Rules | |||
The following rules apply to ICRC personnel while | The following rules apply to ICRC personnel while | |||
they are at any part of Camp Delta. | they are at any part of Camp Delta. | |||
a. ICRC personnel are allowed to talk to detainees | a. ICRC personnel are allowed to talk to detainees | |||
on all blocks at the detainee’s cell as long as there is no | on all blocks at the detainee’s cell as long as there is no | |||
interference with the safeguard of U.S. Forces or | interference with the safeguard of U.S. Forces or | |||
detainees, except for detainees placed at the Maximum | detainees, except for detainees placed segregation. | |||
Security Units (MSU). | ||||
b. ICRC personnel are allowed to talk to detainees | b. ICRC personnel are allowed to talk to detainees | |||
who are placed in MSU for disciplinary reasons only | who are placed in segregation for disciplinary reasons | |||
with the exception of the following: | only with the exception of the following: | |||
(1) Detainees placed in MSU by the JIG will be | (1) Detainees placed in segregation by the JIG | |||
listed on the MSU log. Their level of allowable contact | will be listed on the segregation log. Their level of | |||
with ICRC will be listed on the MSU log. | allowable contact with ICRC will be listed on the | |||
segregation log. | ||||
(2) If the log is unavailable, the PL or SOG will | (2) If the log is unavailable, the PL or SOG will | |||
contact the JIG during duty hours for clearance. They | contact the JIG during duty hours for clearance. They | |||
will also receive from the JIG what visitation level the | will also receive from the JIG what visitation level the | |||
ICRC has with the detainee. | ICRC has with the detainee. | |||
(3) Detainees will not be allowed to leave the | (3) Detainees will not be allowed to leave the | |||
MSU block for ICRC visits. | segregation block for ICRC visits. | |||
c. ICRC representatives may visit other detainees | ||||
on a block after visiting a specific detainee. They may | ||||
visit any detainee on the block as long as that | ||||
detainee’s level of visitation permits the visit. | ||||
17-4. Levels of Visitation | 17-4. Levels of Visitation | |||
All detainees will have a level of ICRC contact | All detainees will have a level of ICRC contact | |||
designated for them. These different levels are as | designated for them. These different levels are as | |||
follows: | follows: | |||
a. No Access: No contact of any kind with the | a. No Access: No contact of any kind with the | |||
ICRC. This includes the delivery of ICRC mail. | ICRC. This includes the delivery of ICRC mail. | |||
b. Restricted: ICRC is allowed to ask the detainee | b. Restricted: ICRC is allowed to ask the detainee | |||
about health and welfare only. No prolonged | about health and welfare only. No prolonged | |||
questions. | questions. | |||
c. Unrestricted: ICRC is allowed full access to talk | c. Unrestricted: ICRC is allowed full access to talk | |||
to the detainee. | to the detainee. | |||
d. Visual: Access is restricted to visual inspection | d. Visual: Access is restricted to visual inspection | |||
of the detainee’s physical condition. No form of | of the detainee’s physical condition. No form of | |||
communication is permitted. No delivery of ICRC | communication is permitted. No delivery of ICRC | |||
mail. | mail. | |||
Chapter 18 | Chapter 18 | |||
Food Service | Food Service | |||
18-1. Responsibilities | 18-1. Responsibilities | |||
a. J-4 Food Service Personnel are responsible for | a. Block personnel will serve the meals to the | |||
delivering, serving and providing all necessary supplies | ||||
to feed the detainees. | ||||
b. Block personnel will serve the meals to the | ||||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
18-2. Operations | 18-2. Operations | |||
a. Detainees will be provided with three meals per | a. Detainees will be provided with three meals per | |||
day according to the meal time needs of the facility. | day according to the meal time needs of the facility. | |||
For camps 1-3, this will usually this will be at the | For camps 1-3, this will usually this will be at the | |||
following times: | following times: | |||
(1) Breakfast at 0630 | (1) Breakfast at 0630 | |||
(2) Lunch at 1200 | (2) Lunch at 1200 | |||
(3) Dinner at 1930. | (3) Dinner at 1930. | |||
b. For camps 1-3, the rations schedule consist of | b. For camps 1-3, the rations schedule will consist | |||
two hot meals a day for breakfast and dinner and a | of three hot meals a day, except under inclement | |||
MRE for lunch, except under inclement weather in | weather/hurricane in which case it shall be MREs for | |||
which case it shall be MREs for all meals until the | all meals until the weather passes. For Camp IV, the | |||
weather passes. For Camp IV, the ration schedule will | ration schedule will consist of three hot meals. | |||
consist of three hot meals. | ||||
c. For camps 1-3, all meals will be served through | c. For camps 1-3, all meals will be served through | |||
the bean hole in the cell gate and consumed inside the | the bean hole in the cell gate and consumed inside the | |||
cell. For Camp IV, all meals will be served through the | cell. For Camp IV, all meals will be served through the | |||
bean hole in the block gate and consumed in the bay. | bean hole in the block gate and consumed in the bay. | |||
d. For camps 1-3, Food Service Section will provide | d. For Camp IV, Food Service personnel will | |||
cooks to deliver and portion all food in the correct | provide cooks to deliver and portion all food in the | |||
portions while the MPs issue the food to the detainee | correct portions while the guards issue the food to the | |||
through the bean hole in the cell gate. For Camp IV, | detainee through the bean hole in the block gate. The | |||
Food Service personnel will provide cooks to deliver | food service personnel shall ensure that also any dirty | |||
and portion all food in the correct portions while the | dishes are returned to the contractor for cleaning. | |||
MPs issue the food to the detainee through the bean | ||||
hole in the block gate. The food service personnel | ||||
shall ensure that also any dirty dishes are returned to | ||||
the contractor for cleaning. | ||||
e. Meals will be served on all blocks | e. Meals will be served on all blocks | |||
simultaneously. Serving and consumption of meals | simultaneously. Serving and consumption of meals | |||
will be allowed a maximum of 30 minutes per detainee. | will be allowed a maximum of 30 minutes per detainee. | |||
f. MPs on duty are responsible for providing escort | f. MPs on duty are responsible for providing escort | |||
to the cooks, directing the detainees in an orderly | to the cooks, directing the detainees in an orderly | |||
fashion and ensuring that all required items are issued, | fashion and ensuring that all required items are issued, | |||
returned, and accounted for. MPs are also responsible | returned, and accounted for. Guards are also | |||
for the removal of trash from all compounds and | responsible for the removal of trash from all | |||
placing it in the designated dumpsters per the waste | compounds and placing it in the designated dumpsters | |||
disposal SOP in chapter 33. | per the waste disposal SOP in chapter 33. | |||
g. During inclement weather, all meals will be | g. During a hurricane, all meals will be MREs. | |||
MREs. | h. Detainees will have 30 minutes in which to | |||
h. The PL is responsible to the Commanding | consume their meals. | |||
Officer for the adequate quality and quantity of food | ||||
served to detainees and U.S personnel and that | ||||
sanitation, preparation, handling and servicing of food | ||||
meet established criteria. Detainees will have 30 | ||||
minutes in which to consume their meals. | ||||
i. During times of fasting or religious requirements | i. During times of fasting or religious requirements | |||
for the detainees, modifications to this portion of the | for the detainees, modifications to this portion of the | |||
SOP will be directed as appropriate. | SOP will be directed as appropriate. | |||
j. At any time there is large pieces of construction | j. At any time there is large pieces of construction | |||
equipment such as portable generators in the roving | equipment such as portable generators in the roving | |||
sally area of Camp 1, the food service truck will stop at | sally area of Camp 1, the food service truck will stop at | |||
Sally Port 4. | Sally Port 4. | |||
18-3. Duties | 18-3. Duties | |||
a. JDOG S-4. The JDOG S-4 will be responsible | a. JDOG S-4. The JDOG S-4 will be responsible | |||
for coordinating the hours of all meals with the needs | for coordinating the hours of all meals with the needs | |||
of the facility. | of the facility. | |||
b. PL. PLs will coordinate meals for those | b. SOG. The SOG for each camp will sign for | |||
detainees who are on discipline measures that include | meals delivered form the Food Service Shift Leader, | |||
loss of hot meals. | noting the quality and quantity at the end of each meal. | |||
c. SOG. The SOG will keep the PL informed of all | The SOG will ensure the meal hours are in accordance | |||
issues pertaining to the meal feeding times. The SOG | with the Schedule of Calls. If the meals arrive late, the | |||
will ensure the meal hours are in accordance with the | SOG will notify JDOG S-4. | |||
Schedule of Calls. If the meals arrive late, the SOG | c. Block NCO. The Block NCO will accept and | |||
will notify JDOG S-4. | ||||
d. Block NCO. The Block NCO will accept and | ||||
account for the utensils used for eating from mess | account for the utensils used for eating from mess | |||
personnel. In Camp I-3, while the Block Guards are | personnel. In Camp I-3, while the guards are serving | |||
serving the meal to the detainees, the Block NCO will | the meal to the detainees, the Block NCO will pass out | |||
pass out the utensils to each detainee. In Camp IV, the | the utensils to each detainee. In Camp IV, the Block | |||
Block NCO will serve the meal and distribute the | NCO will serve the meal and distribute the utensils at | |||
utensils at the same time. Once the mealtime is | the same time. Once the mealtime is completed, the | |||
completed, the Block NCO will account for all utensils | Block NCO will account for all utensils that were | |||
that were passed out. The SOG will be notified if | passed out. The SOG will be notified if utensils are not | |||
utensils are not returned and a search will be conducted | returned and a search will be conducted to locate the | |||
to locate the missing spoon. | missing spoon. | |||
e. Block Guards. In camps 1-3, they will issue | d. Guards. In camps 1-3, they will issue meals to | |||
meals to the detainees and monitor them during chow. | the detainees and monitor them during chow. At the | |||
At the conclusion of the meal, the Block Guards will | conclusion of the meal, the guards will collect the trash | |||
collect the trash from the detainees. Block Guards will | from the detainees. Guards will inventory the return of | |||
inventory the return of all packaging, plates, spoons, | all packaging, plates, spoons, and Styrofoam cups. If | |||
and Styrofoam cups. If items are not returned and | items are not returned and cannot be found, the | |||
cannot be found, the detainee will receive his meals | detainee will receive his meals poured onto a paper | |||
poured onto a paper plate for the next three days. This | plate for the next three days. This is done with the | |||
is done with the intention of reducing the amount of | intention of reducing the amount of trash being flushed | |||
trash being flushed down the toilet. In Camp IV, the | down the toilet. In Camp IV, the guards will only be | |||
Block Guards will only be able to observe the detainees | able to observe the detainees eating from their | |||
eating from their observation location. | observation location. | |||
Chapter 19 | Chapter 19 | |||
Detainee Health Services | Detainee Health Services | |||
Section I – Procedures | Section I – Procedures | |||
19-1. Restraint Procedures | 19-1. Restraint Procedures | |||
a. Restraints will be used at all times when | a. Restraints will be used at all times when | |||
detainees are moved from their cell, as a precaution | detainees are moved from their cell, as a precaution | |||
against escape; for medical reasons as directed by a | against escape; for medical reasons as directed by a | |||
medical officer; or to prevent self-injury, injury to | medical officer; or to prevent self-injury, injury to | |||
others, or property damage. | others, or property damage. | |||
skipping to change at line 7270 | skipping to change at line 8216 | |||
detainee when the detainee is secured in his cell, or | detainee when the detainee is secured in his cell, or | |||
other secure area. Any deviation of this policy must be | other secure area. Any deviation of this policy must be | |||
authorized by the CO, PL, or the on duty SOG with | authorized by the CO, PL, or the on duty SOG with | |||
prior approval of the JDOG CDR, and will never be | prior approval of the JDOG CDR, and will never be | |||
applied as punishment. | applied as punishment. | |||
c. Restraint types: | c. Restraint types: | |||
(1) Three-piece Suit: Hand-irons, Leg-irons, | (1) Three-piece Suit: Hand-irons, Leg-irons, | |||
connecting chain, and belly chains. | connecting chain, and belly chains. | |||
(2) Four/Five Point Position: Arms, head, and | (2) Four/Five Point Position: Arms, head, and | |||
legs are secured. | legs are secured. | |||
d. Emergency use of special restraints: | d. Routine use of restraints: | |||
(1) The SOG will obtain advanced approval from | ||||
the CO and a Psychologist prior to placing four/five- | ||||
point restraints on a detainee. | ||||
(2) If four/five point restraints are applied to a | ||||
detainee, the CO will contact the CJDOG and on-duty | ||||
medical officer or designated representative. | ||||
(3) Direct visual observation by Block Guard will | ||||
be continuous until on-duty medical officer or | ||||
designated representative arrive and assess the | ||||
situation. | ||||
(4) The medical officer will assess the detainee’s | ||||
physical condition and psych evaluate mental health, | ||||
and advise the CO on the necessity of further medical | ||||
treatment. | ||||
(5) If the detainee is not transferred to a | ||||
medical/mental health facility and is restrained in a | ||||
four/five point position, the block personnel will | ||||
continuously observe the detainee and document | ||||
activity every 15 minutes until the restraints are | ||||
removed. This will be recorded on a CD-S319. | ||||
e. Routine use of restraints: | ||||
(1) To ensure safety and prevent injury, guard | (1) To ensure safety and prevent injury, guard | |||
will maintain positive control of all detainees being | will maintain positive control of all detainees being | |||
escorted while wearing restraints. | escorted while wearing restraints. | |||
(a) When a detainee is in full restraints, the guard | (a) When a detainee is in full restraints, the guard | |||
will grasp the belly chain behind the detainee with | will grasp the belly chain behind the detainee with | |||
his/her strong hand. | his/her strong hand. | |||
(b) When a detainee is restrained with their hands | (b) When a detainee is restrained with their hands | |||
in the rear, the guard will grasp the detainee’s upper | in the rear, the guard will grasp the detainee’s upper | |||
arm just below the armpit with his/her strong hand. | arm just below the armpit with his/her strong hand. | |||
(2) If there is an injury that could be aggravated, | (2) If there is an injury that could be aggravated, | |||
guards should seek guidance through the chain of | guards should seek guidance through the chain of | |||
command before applying restraints (time permitting). | command before applying restraints (time permitting). | |||
Sound judgment applies in emergencies. | Sound judgment applies in emergencies. | |||
f. Only medical personnel will authorize the use of | ||||
suicide prevention smocks. Only medical personnel | ||||
will authorize discontinuing the use of the smocks. | ||||
19-2. Dispensing of Medications | 19-2. Dispensing of Medications | |||
a. The assigned hospital corpsman shall review | a. The assigned hospital corpsman shall review | |||
NAVMED 6550/8 Medication Administration Record | NAVMED 6550/8 Medication Administration Record | |||
(MAR) and compare detainee ISN number and location | (MAR) and compare detainee ISN number and location | |||
against current alpha roster. If necessary make | against current alpha roster. If necessary make | |||
appropriate changes in individual MAR folders and | appropriate changes in individual MAR folders and | |||
move medications to appropriate place in medicinal | move medications to appropriate place in medicinal | |||
locker. | locker. | |||
b. Gather appropriate medicinals from Camp Delta | b. Gather appropriate medicines from Camp Delta | |||
Clinic. Notify security personnel of each block which | Clinic. Notify security personnel of each block which | |||
detainees require meds. | detainees require meds. | |||
c. The hospital corpsman will dispense the | c. The hospital corpsman will dispense the | |||
medication at each cell’s bean hole. The hospital | medication at each cell’s bean hole. The hospital | |||
corpsman will verify the following prior to dispensing | corpsman will verify the following prior to dispensing | |||
any medications. | any medications. | |||
(1) Have orders and MAR been verified by | (1) Have orders and MAR been verified by | |||
nursing staff? | nursing staff? | |||
(2) Are you authorized to give this medication? | (2) Are you authorized to give this medication? | |||
(3) Is it the correct patient? Verify against ISN | (3) Is it the correct patient? Verify against ISN | |||
skipping to change at line 7340 | skipping to change at line 8262 | |||
(6) Is it the correct route of administration? | (6) Is it the correct route of administration? | |||
(7) Is it the correct time to give the medication? | (7) Is it the correct time to give the medication? | |||
d. Document the administration of all medications | d. Document the administration of all medications | |||
and or refusals on the MAR and notify nursing staff of | and or refusals on the MAR and notify nursing staff of | |||
any concerns. | any concerns. | |||
e. Transcribe any changes to medications on MAR. | e. Transcribe any changes to medications on MAR. | |||
The nursing staff will verify accuracy on a regular | The nursing staff will verify accuracy on a regular | |||
basis. | basis. | |||
f. Medication types and frequencies will determine | f. Medication types and frequencies will determine | |||
when medications are dispensed. | when medications are dispensed. | |||
19-3. Self-Harm Blankets and Smocks | g. Detainees may not refuse to take their daily TB | |||
a. Prior to completion of the psychiatric unit use of | medications, if being treated for active TB. | |||
the seclusion cell/suicide prevention smocks and | ||||
blankets for a psychiatric patient on self harm | ||||
precautions or in administrative or disciplinary | ||||
segregation will be at the discretion of the psychiatric | ||||
nurse or licensed independent practitioner and | ||||
documented in the patients chart. | ||||
b. After completion of the psychiatric unit medical | ||||
use of the seclusion cell/suicide prevention smocks and | ||||
blankets will be as follows: | ||||
(1) Required use for a psychiatric patient on self- | ||||
harm precautions or in medical seclusion, unless | ||||
clinically not indicated and documented by a licensed | ||||
independent practitioner, in the patient’s chart. | ||||
(2) For a psychiatric patient in administrative or | ||||
disciplinary segregation use will be at the discretion of | ||||
the psychiatric nurse or licensed independent | ||||
practitioner and documented in the patients chart. | ||||
c. For non-psychiatric detainees recommend that | ||||
the use of seclusion cell/suicide prevention smocks and | ||||
blankets be utilized on a case-by-case basis in | ||||
administrative or disciplinary segregation cells. | ||||
Strongly recommend consultation with a psychiatric | ||||
nurse or licensed independent provider at the Detention | ||||
Hospital. The reason for case-by-case use is that, like | ||||
being stripped, smocks can be humiliating for some | ||||
and may actually increase the risk of suicide. | ||||
Additionally, the anticipated humiliation may deter a | ||||
detainee from voicing their psychological concerns. | ||||
d. Detainees should not be transported in smocks | ||||
except within the psychiatric unit or in an emergency. | ||||
19-4. Sick Call | 19-4. Sick Call | |||
a. Both medical and dental sick calls are conducted | a. Both medical and dental sick calls are conducted | |||
in accordance with the same procedures. Detainees | in accordance with the same procedures. Detainees | |||
needing to see a dentist will be screened at normal sick | needing to see a dentist will be screened at normal sick | |||
call and referred, if necessary, to the Dental Clinic | call and referred, if necessary, to the Dental Clinic | |||
b. The medic will screen all detainees while | b. The medic will screen all detainees while | |||
conducting rounds. If the medic is able to treat the | conducting rounds. If the medic is able to treat the | |||
detainee’s ailment, he/she will do so and advise the | detainee’s ailment, he/she will do so and advise the | |||
detainee that he does not need to see a doctor. If the | detainee that he does not need to see a doctor. If the | |||
detainee still wishes to see a doctor, he or will not be | detainee still wishes to see a doctor, he will not be | |||
denied that right. | denied that right. | |||
c. The medic will compile a list of all detainees and | c. The medic will compile a list of all detainees and | |||
detainees who were seen each day. The list will be | detainees who were seen each day. The list will be | |||
turned into the front office before the medic leaves the | turned into the front office before the medic leaves the | |||
facility. | facility. | |||
d. In the event the Medical Officer/Designated | ||||
Representative deems it necessary to evaluate a | ||||
detainee in his cell, the medic or representative shall be | ||||
accompanied by two guards after the detainee has been | ||||
restrained in a three-piece suit. Freeing of one limb at | ||||
a time may be permitted for the purpose of conducting | ||||
a medical exam. | ||||
Section II – Emergencies | Section II – Emergencies | |||
19-5. Emergency Sick Call | 19-5. Emergency Sick Call | |||
a. Detainees who have a medical emergency will be | a. Detainees who have a medical emergency will be | |||
seen immediately at any time. | seen immediately at any time. | |||
b. During duty hours, all medical/dental problems | b. All medical/dental problems deemed a possible | |||
deemed a possible “emergency” will be referred to the | “emergency” will be referred to the Delta Clinic for | |||
Health Clinic for evaluation as to whether or not a real | evaluation as to whether or not a real emergency exists. | |||
emergency exists. | ||||
c. After duty hours, the SOG will determine | c. After duty hours, the SOG will determine | |||
whether an emergency condition exists. He will | whether an emergency condition exists. He will | |||
consult via telephone with the Detention Hospital as | consult via telephone with the Detention Hospital as | |||
needed to assist in making the determination. | needed to assist in making the determination. | |||
19-6. Emergency Condition Responses | 19-6. Emergency Condition Responses | |||
a. The International Color Codes for triage will be | a. The International Color Codes for triage will be | |||
utilized to conduct triage of a patient to convey the | utilized to conduct triage of a patient to convey the | |||
seriousness of a patient’s medical condition. The | seriousness of a patient’s medical condition. The | |||
following criteria are examples of medical conditions | following criteria are examples of medical conditions | |||
indicating a specific triage: | indicating a specific triage: | |||
(1) Code Green: Utilized for non-serious, non- | (1) Code Green: Utilized for non-serious, non- | |||
life threatening medical condition (cut hand, scrape, | life threatening medical condition (cut hand, scrape, | |||
broken arm, nausea, and headache with no other | broken arm, nausea, and headache with no other | |||
indicators) does not require immediate medical | indicators) does not require immediate medical | |||
attention. | attention. | |||
(2) Code Yellow: Utilized for potentially life- | (2) Code Yellow: Utilized for potentially life- | |||
threatening medical condition (decreased level of | threatening medical condition (decreased level of | |||
skipping to change at line 7481 | skipping to change at line 8378 | |||
(d) Supervise reporting of the incident. | (d) Supervise reporting of the incident. | |||
(4) Sally Ports: | (4) Sally Ports: | |||
(a) Be prepared for medical personnel to need | (a) Be prepared for medical personnel to need | |||
immediate access through the sally port. This includes | immediate access through the sally port. This includes | |||
vehicle access to the area and departing from Delta. | vehicle access to the area and departing from Delta. | |||
(b) Stop other traffic through sally port if it | (b) Stop other traffic through sally port if it | |||
impedes with the movement of personnel associated | impedes with the movement of personnel associated | |||
with the Code Blue situation. | with the Code Blue situation. | |||
(c) Be prepared to implement a Lockdown if | (c) Be prepared to implement a Lockdown if | |||
called by the CO/PL/SOG. | called by the CO/PL/SOG. | |||
(5) Block NCOs/Block Guards/Other duty | (5) Block NCOs/guards/Other duty positions: | |||
positions: | ||||
(a) Monitor the situation by radio and be | (a) Monitor the situation by radio and be | |||
prepared to take action as directed (Lockdown, etc.) | prepared to take action as directed (Lockdown, etc.) | |||
(b) Be prepared for reaction by other detainees as | (b) Be prepared for reaction by other detainees as | |||
they learn about the situation. | they learn about the situation. | |||
19-7. Combat Lifesavers | 19-7. Combat Lifesavers | |||
a. Combat Lifesavers will be permitted to provide | a. Combat Lifesavers will be permitted to provide | |||
medical care in accordance with the Combat Lifesaver | medical care to friendly forces in accordance with the | |||
curriculum. | Combat Lifesaver curriculum in an emergency | |||
situation. | ||||
b. Combat Lifesavers will not treat any detainee for | b. Combat Lifesavers will not treat any detainee for | |||
any medical problem. | any medical problem. | |||
c. Medical tasks taught to Combat Lifesavers that | c. Medical tasks taught to Combat Lifesavers that | |||
they may perform without restriction on the | they might perform without restriction on the | |||
installation. | installation. | |||
(1) Monitor a pulse | (1) Monitor a pulse | |||
(2) Monitor respirations | (2) Monitor respirations | |||
(3) Apply a Splint, Aluminum, Malleable splint | (3) Apply a Splint, Aluminum, Malleable | |||
(4) Insert an oropharyngeal airway | (4) Evaluate a casualty. | |||
(5) Evaluate a casualty. | ||||
d. Combat Lifesavers must fill out a Field Medical | d. Combat Lifesavers must fill out a Field Medical | |||
Card at the time of incident and transfer this to the | Card at the time of incident and transfer this to the | |||
receiving medical unit with a complete patient report. | receiving medical unit with a complete patient report. | |||
e. Medical tasks taught to Combat Lifesavers that | ||||
they may perform with the below restrictions, on the | ||||
installation: | ||||
(1) Administer Acetaminophen and | ||||
Pseudoephedrine tablets. The purpose of these | ||||
medications in the Combat Lifesaver bag is to | ||||
eliminate minor complaints until the soldier can be | ||||
seen at sick call by medical personnel. | ||||
(a) While in garrison, Combat Lifesavers may | ||||
not dispense these medications. | ||||
(b) While on the installation, but not in garrison | ||||
(i.e., field training exercises), Combat Lifesavers may | ||||
dispense these medications IAW the Medical Tasks | ||||
subcourse of the Combat Lifesaver course. They are | ||||
not to dispense more than eight tablets per individual. | ||||
(c) A medical officer must see all individuals | ||||
who receive these medications from a Combat | ||||
Lifesaver within 24 hours. | ||||
(2) Administer intravenous solution. | ||||
(a) Before attempting to start an intravenous (IV) | ||||
infusion, 911 must be called. | ||||
(b) Combat Lifesavers who determine a casualty | ||||
needs an IV solution may administer it. | ||||
(c) No more than two attempts will be made on | ||||
any one patient to initiate an IV. | ||||
(d) No more than one 1000 ml bag will be given | ||||
to any one patient. | ||||
(e) Upon initiation of an IV, the patient must be | ||||
seen by a medical officer and cleared for duty. | ||||
f. Medical Supplies (Class VIII) Combat Lifesavers | ||||
are authorized to carry: | ||||
NSN Nomenclature QTY Description | ||||
651 0009268882 2 | ||||
Adhesive tape, surgical, | ||||
1 in 1 SP | ||||
651 5006878052 1 | ||||
Airway pharyngeal, | ||||
large adult | ||||
651 5009582232 1 | ||||
Airway pharyngeal, | ||||
small adult | ||||
651 0009137909 18 | ||||
Bandage adhesive ¾ X 3 | ||||
inches flesh | ||||
651 0000583047 2 Bandage gau4- ½” | ||||
651 0002011755 2 | ||||
Bandage muslin | ||||
compressed brown 37 X | ||||
37 X 52” triangular | ||||
w/pins | ||||
651 5013156227 2 | ||||
Catheter & needle unit, | ||||
d12 I.V. 18ga | ||||
651 0001594883 4 | ||||
Dressing first aid field | ||||
camouflaged 4”w X | ||||
-7.25”Ig, abs | ||||
651 0002017425 1 Dress FLD 11-3/4IN | ||||
651 5002267692 3 pr Gloves, exam lrg | ||||
651 5014721863 2 | ||||
Intravenous inj set, 7 | ||||
comp macrodrip 10 | ||||
drops/ml 2 | ||||
651 0010100307 12 | ||||
Pad povidone-iodine | ||||
impre, ster 2 X 1.375” | ||||
brown | ||||
651 0007863736 12 Pad isopropyl alcohol | ||||
651 0014640826 12 Sponge Surg 2X2 | ||||
651 5009357138 1 | ||||
Scissors bandage | ||||
”Cut lg. 7.25” O/a lg | ||||
both blades blunt crs | ||||
651 5012254681 1 | ||||
Splint universal 36 X | ||||
” malleable alum | ||||
radiolucent ltwt | ||||
g. Resupply for Combat Lifesaver Class VIII items | ||||
will be the JTF-Joint Aid Stations (JAS). | ||||
h. POC for Combat Lifesavers is the JAS XO. | ||||
Section III – Medical Problems | Section III – Medical Problems | |||
19-8. Hunger Strike | 19-8. Voluntary Total Fasting and Re-Feeding | |||
a. A detainee is considered to be on a hunger strike | a. A detainee is considered to be on a Voluntary | |||
when he refuses to eat nine consecutive meals as a | Total Fast, (VTF), when he refuses to eat nine | |||
form of protest or refuses fluids for 48 hours. The | consecutive meals as a form of protest or refuses fluids | |||
protest may or may not be verbalized. Detainee’s who | for 48 hours. The protest may or may not be | |||
eat portions of the meals are not normally considered to | verbalized. Detainee’s who eat portions of the meals | |||
be on a hunger strike. | are not normally considered to be on a VTF. | |||
b. The hunger strike is terminated when the | b. The VTF is terminated when the following occur: | |||
following occur: | ||||
(1) The detainee eats a meal or portion of a meal | (1) The detainee eats a meal or portion of a meal | |||
(excluding liquids). | (excluding liquids). | |||
(2) A Medical Officer or Physician’s Assistant | (2) A Medical Officer or Physician’s Assistant | |||
(PA), after examining the detainee, recommends that | (PA), after examining the detainee, recommends that | |||
the Hunger Strike Protocol be terminated. | the VTF Protocol be terminated. | |||
(3) The CO or DOC will terminate the Hunger | ||||
Strike Protocol. | ||||
c. Initial Monitoring Procedures. | c. Initial Monitoring Procedures. | |||
(1) Submit an Observation Report to DOC | (1) Submit an Observation Report to DOC | |||
recording a detainee’s refusal to consume a meal. | recording a detainee’s refusal to consume a meal. | |||
(2) Make a blotter entry. | (2) Make a blotter entry. | |||
(3) Continue to monitor the detainee during meal | (3) Continue to monitor the detainee during meal | |||
times to see if he refuses to consume any other meals. | times to see if he refuses to consume any other meals. | |||
(4) Continue to inspect the detainee’s food tray to | (4) Continue to inspect the detainee’s food tray to | |||
see if any portion of the meal was consumed. Check | see if any portion of the meal was consumed. Check | |||
the tray before and after each mealtime. | the tray before and after each mealtime. | |||
(5) Record any subsequent refusal to consume | (5) Record any subsequent refusal to consume | |||
meals and number them sequentially. | meals and number them sequentially. | |||
(6) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and | (6) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and | |||
record/report anything out of the ordinary to DOC. | record/report anything out of the ordinary to DOC. | |||
(7) Notify DOC when a detainee refuses to | (7) Notify DOC when a detainee refuses to | |||
consume nine consecutive meals. | consume nine consecutive meals. | |||
(8) After the Hunger Strike Protocol has been | (8) After the VTF Protocol has been initiated, | |||
initiated, ensure that the detainee does not receive any | ensure that the detainee does not receive any caffeine | |||
caffeine products (coffee, tea, hot chocolate) because | products (coffee, tea, hot chocolate) because of its | |||
of its diuretic affect. Only water is provided during the | diuretic affect. Only water is provided during the | |||
hunger strike. | VTF. | |||
d. Close Confinement Procedures. | d. Close Confinement Procedures. | |||
(1) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and meal | (1) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and meal | |||
consumption. | consumption. | |||
(2) Notify the SOG who will then notify DOC, | (2) Notify the SOG who will then notify DOC, | |||
the CO, and the Health Clinic when a detainee refuses | the CO, and the Delta Clinic when a detainee refuses to | |||
to consume nine consecutive meals. | consume nine consecutive meals. | |||
(3) Segregate the detainee for better observation | (3) Segregate the detainee for better observation | |||
by moving them to Delta Block. | by moving them to Delta Block. | |||
e. DOC Procedures. | e. DOC Procedures. | |||
(1) Brief the CO. | ||||
(2) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and meal | (2) Monitor the detainee’s behavior and meal | |||
consumption. | consumption. | |||
(3) After a detainee has refused to consume nine | (3) After a detainee has refused to consume nine | |||
consecutive meals, ensure the Health Clinic begins the | consecutive meals, ensure the Delta Clinic begins the | |||
Hunger Strike Protocol. | VTF Protocol. | |||
f. As directed by the DOC, the admin section will: | f. As directed by the DOC, the admin section will: | |||
(1) Make a blotter entry recording when a | (1) Make a blotter entry recording when a | |||
detainee was placed on the Hunger Strike Protocol, and | detainee was placed on the VTF Protocol, and how | |||
how many consecutive meals were refused at that time. | many consecutive meals were refused at that time. | |||
(2) Make a blotter entry recording when the | (2) Make a blotter entry recording when the Delta | |||
Health Clinic Medical Officer of the Day (MOD) | Clinic Medical Officer of the Day (MOD) conducts | |||
conducts checks with IAW paragraph f. | checks. | |||
(3) Make a blotter entry recording when a | (3) Make a blotter entry recording when a | |||
detainee was removed from the Hunger Strike | detainee was removed from the VTF Protocol, and | |||
Protocol, and which medical officer conducted the | which medical officer conducted the examination and | |||
examination and recommended the termination of the | recommended the termination of the VTF Protocol. | |||
Hunger Strike Protocol. | g. The Delta Clinic will ensure that the following | |||
g. The Health Clinic will ensure that the following | ||||
occur: | occur: | |||
(1) The CO is briefed daily on the detainee’s | (1) The CO is briefed daily on the detainee’s | |||
condition. | condition. | |||
(2) During duty hours, a Physician Assistant (PA) | (2) During duty hours, a Medical Officer or | |||
will examine the detainee. | Physician Assistant (PA) will examine the detainee. | |||
(3) After duty hours, the Medical Officer of the | (3) After duty hours, the Medical Officer of the | |||
Day (MOD) will examine the detainee. | Day (MOD) will examine the detainee. | |||
h. Immediately after the Hunger Strike Protocol has | h. Immediately after the VTF Protocol has been | |||
been initiated, the following procedures will occur: | initiated, the following procedures will occur: | |||
(1) A blood sample (CBC, SMA-20, Albumin, | (1) A blood sample (CBC, SMA-20, Albumin, | |||
and Iron Panel) will be drawn from the detainee. | and Iron Panel) will be drawn from the detainee. | |||
(2) A urine sample (24-hour urine for Creatinine | (2) A urine sample (24-hour urine for Creatinine | |||
and Protein) will be taken from the detainee. | and Protein) will be taken from the detainee. | |||
(3) An electrocardiograph will be conducted (a | (3) An electrocardiograph will be conducted (a | |||
12 lead EKG). | 12 lead EKG). | |||
i. Consider supplemental feeding when the | i. Consider supplemental feeding when the | |||
detainee’s body weight reaches 85-90% of ideal body | detainee’s body mass index is below 16, when | |||
weight, when incapacitated, or ordered by a Medical | incapacitated, or ordered by a Medical Officer. The | |||
Officer. The detainee will be admitted to Naval Station | detainee will be admitted to the Detention Hospital if | |||
Hospital if supplemental feeding is necessary. | supplemental feeding is necessary. The JTF | |||
Commander is the only person who can authorize | ||||
forced feeding. | ||||
j. Consult with the Command Judge Advocate | j. Consult with the Command Judge Advocate | |||
before force treatment is initiated. The legal opinion | before force treatment is initiated. The legal opinion | |||
should be noted in the detainee’s medical chart. | should be noted in the detainee’s medical chart. | |||
k. The Duty Investigator will take the photographs | k. The Duty Investigator will take the photographs | |||
required for the Hunger Strike Protocol. | required for the VTF Protocol. | |||
l. The CO will review the situation and ensure it | l. The CO will review the situation and ensure it | |||
meets the criteria required for the Hunger Strike | meets the criteria required for the VTF Protocol. | |||
Protocol. Coordinate with medical authorities for | Coordinate with medical authorities for detainee health | |||
detainee health considerations. | considerations. | |||
19-9. Bodily Fluids | 19-9. Bodily Fluids | |||
a. Protective equipment is available in each block, | a. Protective equipment is available in each block, | |||
and a resupply is on hand in the supply room. A | and a re-supply is on hand in the supply room. | |||
Biohazard Spill Care Kit includes: | ||||
(1) A protective polypropylene gown. | ||||
(2) One pair of shoe covers. | ||||
(3) Eye shield and mask. | ||||
(4) One Red Biohazard bag. | ||||
(5) One pair of vinyl gloves. | ||||
(6) ¾ oz. pouch absorbent. | ||||
(7) Scoop shovel. | ||||
(8) Sani-Cloth surface disinfectant. | ||||
(9) Two anti-microbial hand wipes. | ||||
(10) Two paper towels. | ||||
(11) Bleach. | ||||
(12) Hand soap. | ||||
b. The Guard Force will always carry disposable | b. The Guard Force will always carry disposable | |||
gloves and a CPR physical barrier. | gloves. | |||
c. The staff will make sure their own open wounds | c. The staff will make sure their own open wounds | |||
and sores are covered with clean dry bandages to | and sores are covered with clean dry bandages to | |||
prevent possible exchange of blood and other body | prevent possible exchange of blood and other body | |||
fluids. Change wet bandages frequently. | fluids. Change wet bandages frequently. | |||
d. The staff will assume that all detainees and any | d. The staff will assume that all detainees and any | |||
exposed body fluids carry an infectious disease. | exposed body fluids carry an infectious disease. | |||
e. The staff will remain aware of the fact that a | e. The staff will remain aware of the fact that a | |||
respirator mask is required to protect against airborne | respirator mask is required to protect against airborne | |||
infectious diseases. | infectious diseases. | |||
f. The staff members who conduct a forced move of | f. The staff members who conduct a forced move of | |||
skipping to change at line 7754 | skipping to change at line 8554 | |||
a disinfectant solution of hot water and household | a disinfectant solution of hot water and household | |||
bleach. | bleach. | |||
(4) Place contaminated disposable items such as | (4) Place contaminated disposable items such as | |||
gloves, mask, prongs, rags, or other material in red | gloves, mask, prongs, rags, or other material in red | |||
plastic biohazard bags. If red biohazard bags are not | plastic biohazard bags. If red biohazard bags are not | |||
available, use other strong plastic bags and label with | available, use other strong plastic bags and label with | |||
“BIOHAZARD” markings. | “BIOHAZARD” markings. | |||
j. Disposal of contaminated items. | j. Disposal of contaminated items. | |||
(1) The staff will: | (1) The staff will: | |||
(a) Take any bags containing contaminated items | (a) Take any bags containing contaminated items | |||
to the Delta Medical Center. | to the Delta Clinic. | |||
(b) Inform the Health Clinic personnel that the | (b) Inform the Delta Clinic personnel that the | |||
bags contain contaminated items. | bags contain contaminated items. | |||
(2) The Navy Health Clinic will: | (2) The Delta Clinic will: | |||
(a) Take bags containing contaminated material | (a) Take bags containing contaminated material | |||
to Delta Medical Center. | to the Detention Hospital for ultimate disposal at Naval | |||
Hospital Guantanamo. | ||||
(b) Ensure that all disposable contaminated | (b) Ensure that all disposable contaminated | |||
material is placed in red biohazard bags before | material is placed in properly labeled red biohazard | |||
transporting it. | bags before transporting it. | |||
k. Suspected Exposure. Staff who suspect exposure | k. Suspected Exposure. Staff who suspect exposure | |||
to body fluids will: | to body fluids will: | |||
(1) Wash the area with warm water and soap. | (1) Wash the area with warm water and soap. | |||
When mucous membranes may have been exposed, | When mucous membranes may have been exposed, | |||
flush the areas with warm water for 10 minutes. | flush the areas with warm water for 10 minutes. | |||
(2) Report the incident to the SOG and seek | (2) Report the incident to the SOG and seek | |||
medical attention at the Navy Health Clinic. | medical attention at the Delta Clinic. | |||
l. Bodily Fluid Exposures. | ||||
(1) Splash of urine / feces / saliva to clothing or | ||||
intact skin: | ||||
(a) Change clothing and shower / wash affected | ||||
skin area | ||||
(b) No immunizations or blood draws required | ||||
(2) Splash of urine / feces / saliva to eyes / nose / | ||||
mouth / non-intact skin: | ||||
(a) Change clothing and shower / wash affected | ||||
nose / mouth / non-intact skin areas IMMEDIATELY | ||||
(b) Affected eye(s) should be irrigated | ||||
IMMEDIATELY via the nearest clean water source | ||||
(c) The soldier's immunization record needs to be | ||||
reviewed to determine his/her immunization status with | ||||
respect to Hepatitis A | ||||
(d) Contact the Delta Clinic to determine the | ||||
infectious disease status of the detainee(s) involved if | ||||
possible. | ||||
(e) Occupational Injury or Illness Report | ||||
(NHGTMO Form-5100/02) is to be completed by the | ||||
JAS medical staff and forwarded to the Guantanamo | ||||
Bay Naval Hospital Occupational Health Officer (ext. | ||||
7-2013) if treatment is required | ||||
(3) Splash of BLOODY urine / feces / saliva to | ||||
eyes / nose / mouth / non-intact skin: | ||||
(a) Treat and manage as Blood-Borne Pathogen | ||||
Exposure. | ||||
m.Blood-Borne Pathogen Exposures | ||||
(1) Blood-blood contact/ human bites that break | ||||
the skin/ lacerations, abrasions, puncture wounds/blood | ||||
splash to the eyes, nose, mouth, and non-intact skin: | ||||
(a) Change clothing and shower/ wash affected | ||||
area IMMEDIATELY. Affected eye(s) should be | ||||
irrigated IMMEDIATELY with at least 250cc normal | ||||
saline solution | ||||
(b) Soldier MUST be transported to Guantanamo | ||||
Bay Naval Hospital EMD IMMEDIATELY for further | ||||
evaluation and treatment by medical staff | ||||
(c) Contact the Delta Clinic to determine the | ||||
infectious disease status of the detainee(s) involved if | ||||
possible and have the information forwarded to the E/R | ||||
immediately with the patient | ||||
(d) Contact the Camp America or TK JAS to | ||||
review the soldier's Hepatitis B immunization status | ||||
and have the information forwarded to the EMD | ||||
immediately | ||||
(e) Occupational Injury or Illness Report | ||||
(NHGTMO Form-5100/02) is to be completed by the | ||||
USNH medical staff and forwarded to the Guantanamo | ||||
Bay Naval Hospital Occupational Health Officer (ext | ||||
7-2013) if treatment is required | ||||
(2) Recommend the 2x2 rule. If it is a couple of | ||||
cc's and can be contained by a 2x2, then regular wash | ||||
is recommended. Can use the troop washer. | ||||
(a) If greater than 10 cc's you can either discard | ||||
the items or send to NEX laundry as the hospital does. | ||||
19-10. Heat Category Measures | 19-10. Heat Category Measures | |||
a. The following are the heat categories and flag | a. The following are the heat categories and flag colors | |||
colors being utilized at Guantanamo Bay, Cuba. | being utilized at Guantanamo Bay, Cuba. | |||
(1) Green Flag: Heat Stress Index 75F-85F. | (1) Green Flag: Heat Stress Index 75F-85F. | |||
Discretion required in heavy exercise for new | Discretion required in heavy exercise for new | |||
personnel during the first weeks of heat exposure. | personnel during the first weeks of heat exposure. | |||
Acclimated personnel who participate in regular | Acclimated personnel who participate in regular | |||
physical exercise are unrestricted. | physical exercise are unrestricted. | |||
(2) Yellow Flag: Heat Stress Index 86F-100F. | (2) Yellow Flag: Heat Stress Index 86F-100F. | |||
Strenuous exercise should be curtailed for new | Strenuous exercise should be curtailed for new | |||
personnel during the first weeks of heat exposure. | personnel during the first weeks of heat exposure. | |||
Acclimated personnel who participate in regular | Acclimated personnel who participate in regular | |||
physical exercise are unrestricted. | physical exercise are unrestricted. | |||
skipping to change at line 7798 | skipping to change at line 8656 | |||
(4) Black Flag: Heat Stress Index above 115F. | (4) Black Flag: Heat Stress Index above 115F. | |||
All strenuous activity should be halted. | All strenuous activity should be halted. | |||
b. Due to the demands of the mission, it is not | b. Due to the demands of the mission, it is not | |||
possible to stop all strenuous activity at Black Flag. | possible to stop all strenuous activity at Black Flag. | |||
Reduction in workloads at lesser heat categories will be | Reduction in workloads at lesser heat categories will be | |||
balanced with the mission requirements. It will be | balanced with the mission requirements. It will be | |||
necessary for shifts to perform relief of their own | necessary for shifts to perform relief of their own | |||
personnel. Suggested relief measures include using | personnel. Suggested relief measures include using | |||
ICRC, medical escorts, and IRF Team members to | ICRC, medical escorts, and IRF Team members to | |||
periodically relieve Sally Port guards, escorts, and | periodically relieve Sally Port guards, escorts, and | |||
Block Guards. | guards. | |||
c. The following actions will be taken at each heat | c. The following actions will be taken at each heat | |||
stress index: | stress index: | |||
(1) Green Flag: No special actions taken. | (1) Green Flag: No special actions taken. | |||
(2) Yellow Flag: Increase water intake to ¾ | (2) Yellow Flag: Increase water intake to ¾ | |||
quarts/hour for easy and moderate work and 1 | quarts/hour for easy and moderate work and 1 | |||
quart/hour for hard work. | quart/hour for hard work. | |||
(3) Red Flag: Increase water intake to ¾ | (3) Red Flag: Increase water intake to ¾ | |||
quarts/hour for easy and moderate work and 1 | quarts/hour for easy and moderate work and 1 | |||
quart/hour for hard work. Leaders monitor the | quart/hour for hard work. Leaders monitor the | |||
condition of soldiers and take any additional | condition of soldiers and take any additional | |||
appropriate actions on an individual basis. | appropriate actions on an individual basis. | |||
(4) Black Flag: Increase water intake to NLT 1 | (4) Black Flag: Increase water intake to NLT 1 | |||
quart/hour. Un-blouse boots and implement relief for | quart/hour. Un-blouse boots and implement relief for | |||
skipping to change at line 7824 | skipping to change at line 8681 | |||
turned on. | turned on. | |||
d. BDU blouses will not be removed. | d. BDU blouses will not be removed. | |||
e. If wearing body armor, add 5o | e. If wearing body armor, add 5o | |||
F to WBGT index. | F to WBGT index. | |||
If wearing MOPP overgarment, add 10o | If wearing MOPP overgarment, add 10o | |||
F. | F. | |||
f. Hourly fluid intake should not exceed 1-½ quarts. | f. Hourly fluid intake should not exceed 1-½ quarts. | |||
Section IV – Facilities | Section IV – Facilities | |||
19-11. Detention Hospital | 19-11. Detention Hospital | |||
a. MP personnel have been tasked to provide a | a. MP personnel have been tasked to provide a | |||
security force to the United States Navy Fleet Hospital | security force to the Detention Hospital. Primary | |||
(“Detention Hospital”). Primary responsibilities of the | responsibilities of the security force are: | |||
security force are: | ||||
b. Ensure the secure custody and control of all | b. Ensure the secure custody and control of all | |||
detainees being quartered and treated at the Detention | detainees being quartered and treated at the Detention | |||
Hospital. | Hospital. | |||
c. Ensure the safety of all hospital staff | c. Ensure the safety of all hospital staff | |||
administering medical care to the detainees. | administering medical care to the detainees. | |||
d. Detention Hospital Guard Detail NCOIC: | d. Detention Hospital Guard Detail NCOIC: | |||
(1) Attend Detention Hospital daily staff meeting | (1) Attend Detention Hospital daily staff meeting | |||
at 0900. | at 0900, and each Thursday at 1500 NAVBASE | |||
Hospital. | ||||
(2) Communicate JDOG and Hospital concerns | (2) Communicate JDOG and Hospital concerns | |||
to Military Police personnel working in the Hospital. | to guards working in the Hospital. | |||
(3) Identify, and reduce mission deficiencies. | (3) Identify, and reduce mission deficiencies. | |||
(4) Overseeing all shift operation and will report | (4) Oversee all shift operation and report all | |||
all feedback to the Camp Operations. | feedback to the Detention Operations Center. | |||
(5) Report any information between detainees to | (5) Report any information exchanged between | |||
the CI Intel personnel. | detainees to the CI Intel personnel. | |||
e. Shift NCOIC: | e. Shift NCOIC: | |||
(1) One per shift | (1) One per shift | |||
(2) Supervise, inspect and train the security force. | (2) Supervise, inspect and train the security force. | |||
(3) Maintain Daily Staff Journal (DA 1594) and | (3) Maintain Daily Staff Journal in DIMS. | |||
turn in weekly to Camp Delta DOC. | ||||
(4) Coordinate with hospital staff for changes in | (4) Coordinate with hospital staff for changes in | |||
staffing requirements and duty positions. | staffing requirements and duty positions. | |||
(5) Maintain communications between the Fleet | (5) Maintain communications between the Fleet | |||
security force and Delta DOC, making radio checks | security force and Delta DOC, making radio or landline | |||
every hour. | checks every hour. | |||
(6) Ensure accountability of all security force | (6) Ensure accountability of all security force | |||
equipment (radios, keys, batteries, charger, and | equipment (radios, keys, batteries, charger, and | |||
restrains). | restrains). | |||
(7) Escort, brief and monitor all visitors. | (7) Escort, brief and monitor all visitors. | |||
(8) Brief the on-coming NCOIC. | (8) Brief the on-coming NCOIC. | |||
(9) Report any information between detainees to | (9) Report any information exchanged between | |||
the JDOG S-2. | detainees to the JDOG S-2. | |||
(10) Perform security check with Detention | (10) Perform security check with Detention | |||
Hospital staff and advise of security deficiencies and | Hospital staff and advise of security deficiencies and | |||
concerns. | concerns. | |||
(11) Attend the daily Detention Hospital staff | (11) Assist with the clean up in the break area. | |||
meeting. | (12) Conduct a daily assessment of personnel. | |||
(12) Assist with the clean up in the break area. | (13) Maintain a record of security force shift. | |||
(13) Conduct a daily assessment of personnel. | (14) Maintain SIGACT sheets and turn in at the | |||
(14) Maintain a record of security force shift. | end of shift if needed. | |||
(15) Maintain SigAct sheets and turn in at the end | ||||
of shift. | ||||
f. Escort Team: | f. Escort Team: | |||
(1) Two teams per shift | (1) Two teams per shift | |||
(2) Escort detainee through the Detention | (2) Escort detainee through the Detention | |||
Hospital (operating room, recovery ward, therapy, and | Hospital (operating room, recovery ward, therapy, and | |||
radiology). | radiology). | |||
(3) Escort team will apply, modify, and maintain | (3) Escort team will apply, modify, and maintain | |||
the appropriated level of restraints of each detainee | the appropriated level of restraints of each detainee | |||
while being escorted through the Detention Hospital. | while being escorted through the Detention Hospital. | |||
(4) Escort team will search detainees prior to and | (4) Escort team will search detainees prior to and | |||
after any movements. | after any movements. | |||
(5) Report any information between detainees to | (5) Report any information between detainees to | |||
the JDOG S-2. | the JDOG S-2. | |||
g. Operating Room Escort: | g. Operating Room Escort: | |||
(1) Two escorts as needed | (1) Two escorts as needed | |||
(2) Inside OR MP (One MP scrubbed) will | (2) One inside OR guard, scrubbed; will provide | |||
provide security support to the OR staff inside the OR. | security support to the OR staff inside the OR. | |||
(3) Outside OR MP (One MP) will provide | ||||
security support and access control to the OR and apply | (3) One outside OR guard will provide security | |||
& maintain appropriate level of restraints to the | support and access control to the OR and apply & | |||
detainee. | maintain appropriate level of restraints to the detainee. | |||
h. Ward Security: | h. Ward Security: | |||
(1) Number dependant on detainee patient | (1) Number dependant on detainee patient | |||
population. | population, minimum 4 MP’s every shift up to 6 | |||
detainees. | ||||
(2) Monitor detainee behavior & movements. | (2) Monitor detainee behavior & movements. | |||
(3) Provide direct security to hospital staff | (3) Provide direct security to hospital staff | |||
administering care to the detainees. | administering care to the detainees. | |||
(4) Search detainees as appropriate. | (4) Search detainees as appropriate. | |||
(5) Report any information discussed between | (5) Report any information discussed between | |||
detainees to the JDOG S-2. | detainees to the JDOG S-2. | |||
(6) Check, apply and maintain appropriate level | (6) Check, apply and maintain appropriate level | |||
of restraints. | of restraints and comfort items. | |||
(7) Accountability of the keys and restraints. | (7) Accountability of the keys and restraints. | |||
i. Escort & Security Force Special Instructions. | i. Escort & Security Force Special Instructions. | |||
(1) All detainees will be properly restrained prior | (1) All detainees will be properly restrained prior | |||
to being escorted. Exceptions will be made at the | to being escorted. Exceptions will be made at the | |||
discretion of the security force Shift NCOIC. | discretion of the security force Detention Hospital | |||
NCOIC with input from the medical staff regarding the | ||||
detainee’s medical condition. | ||||
(2) All escorts will be executed using 2:1 ratio | (2) All escorts will be executed using 2:1 ratio | |||
(MP:detainee). | (MP:detainee). | |||
(3) MPs will not allow detainees to talk to each | (3) MPs will not allow detainees to talk to each | |||
other during any escort. | other during any escort. | |||
(4) Upon completion of escort, detainees will be | (4) Upon completion of escort, detainees will be | |||
properly restrained to their gurneys. Padded leather | properly restrained to their gurneys. Padded leather | |||
restraints will be utilized. | restraints will be utilized. | |||
(5) Report any unusual activity or conditions to | (5) Report any unusual activity or conditions to | |||
the shift NCOIC. | the Detention Hospital NCOIC for the morning report. | |||
(6) For escort to the Base Naval Hospital, see | (6) For escort to the Base Naval Hospital, see | |||
Section 11-10 Hospital Escorts. | Section 11-10 Hospital Escorts. | |||
(7) If normal restraints interfere with a procedure, | (7) If normal restraints interfere with a procedure, | |||
detainees may be restrained with flex-cuffs. | detainees may be restrained with flex-cuffs. | |||
(8) While in the OR, detainee will remain | (8) While in the OR, detainee will remain | |||
restrained until the sedative takes effect. Detainees | restrained until the sedative takes effect. Detainees | |||
will be unrestrained during surgery. | will be unrestrained during surgery. | |||
(9) After surgery, detainee(s) will again be fully | (9) After surgery, detainee(s) will again be fully | |||
restrained and secured. | restrained and secured unless directed by medical | |||
officer. | ||||
(10) When detainees are sitting in the chair, they | (10) When detainees are sitting in the chair, they | |||
will remain in full restraints. | will remain in full restraints. | |||
(11) During latrine escorts, one hand of the | (11) During latrine escorts, one hand of the | |||
detainee will be unsecured while the detainee is using | detainee will be unsecured while the detainee is using | |||
the latrine. Detainee will be in full restraints prior to | the latrine. Detainee will be in full restraints prior to | |||
escorting the detainee back. | escorting the detainee back. | |||
(12) NCOIC should consider medical condition & | (12) NCOIC should consider medical condition & | |||
background of the detainee when determining level & | background of the detainee when determining level & | |||
method of restraint. If there are questions about the | method of restraint. If there are questions about the | |||
level of restraint, the Shift NCOIC will make the final | level of restraint, the NCOIC will make the final | |||
determination regarding the level of restraint necessary. | determination regarding the level of restraint necessary. | |||
j. Communications & Coordination. | j. Communications & Coordination. | |||
(1) Shift NCOIC will conduct radio check with | (1) Shift NCOIC will conduct radio check with | |||
the DOC. | the DOC. | |||
(2) Radio checks will be conducted once per hour | (2) Radio checks will be conducted once per hour | |||
and logged in the Daily Staff Journal (DA1594). | and logged in DIMS. | |||
(3) At the start of the new shift, the briefing | (3) At the start of the new shift, the briefing | |||
should include, but is not limited to, the following: # of | should include, but is not limited to, the following: # of | |||
detainees, losses or gains, visitors to the hospital, | detainees, losses or gains, visitors to the hospital, | |||
special cases, any incident on the previous shift. | special cases, any incident on the previous shift. | |||
(4) Shift MPs will maintain a Significant | (4) Shift guards will maintain a Significant | |||
Information (SigAct) sheet, for Intel purpose only. This | Information (SIGACT) sheet, for Intel purpose only. | |||
record will be use for intelligence record, should | This record will be use for intelligence record, should | |||
include: Conversation between detainees, personal | include: Conversation between detainees, personal | |||
information between detainees and hospital staff, | information between detainees and hospital staff, | |||
personal information detainees may relate to MP or | personal information detainees may relate to guard or | |||
translator. | translator. | |||
k. Log Entries. Shift NCOIC will maintain a daily | k. Log Entries. Shift NCOIC will maintain DIMS | |||
staff journal DA 1594 detailing all activities at the | entries detailing all activities at the Detention Hospital. | |||
Detention Hospital. The journal will be continuous and | The journal will be continuous and will be passed on to | |||
will be passed on to the next shift. The staff journal | the next shift. The staff journal should include the | |||
should include the following: | following: | |||
(1) Shift changes | (1) Shift changes | |||
(2) Detainees head count and ISN | (2) Detainees head count and ISN | |||
(3) Detainee movement within the facility | (3) Detainee movement within the facility | |||
(4) Communication check with DOC | (4) Communication check with DOC | |||
(5) Any radio or phone communication between | (5) Any radio or phone communication between | |||
Detention Hospital, DOC, and Camp Operations | Detention Hospital, DOC, and Camp Operations | |||
(6) Visitors to the Detention Hospital | (6) Visitors to the Detention Hospital | |||
(7) Feed times | (7) Feed times | |||
(8) Searches of gurneys | (8) Searches of gurneys | |||
(9) Injuries or illness of members of the security | (9) Injuries or illness of members of the security | |||
skipping to change at line 7981 | skipping to change at line 8838 | |||
guard mount. | guard mount. | |||
(2) NCOIC will assign personnel to their post | (2) NCOIC will assign personnel to their post | |||
prior of taking over the shift. | prior of taking over the shift. | |||
(3) Upon arrival at the hospital, all personnel will | (3) Upon arrival at the hospital, all personnel will | |||
be posted without delay and will conduct a “relief-in- | be posted without delay and will conduct a “relief-in- | |||
place.” | place.” | |||
(4) Out-going NCOIC would collect all keys and | (4) Out-going NCOIC would collect all keys and | |||
turn them over to the in-coming shift. | turn them over to the in-coming shift. | |||
(5) NCOIC should ensure that security force is | (5) NCOIC should ensure that security force is | |||
given frequent rest. (10-15 minutes every two hours, at | given frequent rest. (10-15 minutes every two hours, at | |||
least). MPs should be rotated from post to post to | least). Guards should be rotated from post to post to | |||
combat fatigue and complacency. | combat fatigue and complacency. | |||
(6) The desk guard, stationed at a desk near the | (6) The desk guard, stationed at a desk near the | |||
front door, will know who key medical personnel are | front door, will know who key medical personnel are | |||
and their location so that they can direct entering | and their location so that they can direct entering | |||
people to the proper individual. | people to the proper individual. | |||
m.TB patient procedures. | ||||
(1) Only guards who have been fit tested by the | ||||
NAVHOSP GTMO Preventive Medicine department to | ||||
wear a N-95 Respirator will be assigned to work with | ||||
detainees residing in the TB isolation rooms. | ||||
(2) Consult with the nurse on duty regarding | ||||
these detainees. | ||||
n. Medical Orders. Instructions for medical staff | ||||
are written in medical orders will be complied with | ||||
provided they do not cause a security violation that has | ||||
not been approved by the Detention Hospital guard | ||||
NCOIC. Valid instructions that would counter normal | ||||
guard operating procedure include items such as | ||||
serving extra meals. | ||||
(2) Interior guards notify exterior guard. | ||||
(3) Exterior guard ensures that the main entrance | ||||
of the unit is locked (unless otherwise directed no | ||||
personnel are authorized to exit or enter this area). | ||||
(4) Exterior guard then moves to Female Latrine | ||||
(Head) and checks latrine (head) and shower area. | ||||
Upon completion, exterior guard then goes to side door | ||||
of the unit. | ||||
(5) Upon notification by the medical personnel | ||||
that the detainee is ready to move the exterior guard | ||||
will then open the side door of the unit. | ||||
(6) Once the unit is open one of the interior | ||||
guards and the exterior guard will escort the detainee to | ||||
the female latrine (head) for showering (exterior guard | ||||
ensuring that the side door of the unit is locked prior to | ||||
moving to the female latrine (head)). | ||||
(7) Interior guard will ensure detainee is | ||||
showered and exterior guard will post outside of the | ||||
female latrine (head). | ||||
(8) Upon completion of showering interior guard | ||||
will notify exterior guard who will in turn notify the | ||||
medical unit that the detainee is ready to return. | ||||
(9) Upon confirmation from medical that they are | ||||
ready to accept detainee, exterior guard will assist | ||||
interior guard with escorting the detainee back to the | ||||
unit. Exterior guard will unlock the unit, interior guard | ||||
will escort detainee into unit with assistance from the | ||||
2nd | ||||
interior guard. Exterior guard will then lock the | ||||
side door of the unit and return to original post in front | ||||
of the unit. | ||||
(10) At this point normal entry and exit of the | ||||
unit may begin. | ||||
Chapter 20 | Chapter 20 | |||
Repair And Utility | Repair And Utility | |||
20-1. Work Orders | 20-1. Work Orders | |||
a. Procedures for repair work and modifications to | a. Procedures for repair work and modifications to | |||
Camp Delta and other areas designated by the CJDOG. | Camp Delta and other areas designated by the CJDOG. | |||
The primary goal of the R&U section is to significantly | The primary goal of the R&U section is to significantly | |||
reduce the number of work orders being submitted to | reduce the number of work orders being submitted to | |||
contractors for work inside Camp Delta. | contractors for work inside Camp Delta. | |||
b. Priorities of Work. | b. Priorities of Work. | |||
skipping to change at line 8023 | skipping to change at line 8928 | |||
assign a number, and call the appropriate contractor to | assign a number, and call the appropriate contractor to | |||
perform the repairs. All emergency work orders have a | perform the repairs. All emergency work orders have a | |||
30-minute response time unless told otherwise. | 30-minute response time unless told otherwise. | |||
Emergency work orders can be called in with time | Emergency work orders can be called in with time | |||
periods such as one, two or eight hours. | periods such as one, two or eight hours. | |||
d. Procedures (Camp Delta/Detention Operations). | d. Procedures (Camp Delta/Detention Operations). | |||
Repair & Utility (R&U) will pick up sanctioned work | Repair & Utility (R&U) will pick up sanctioned work | |||
orders from the DOC each morning NLT 0800 hours. | orders from the DOC each morning NLT 0800 hours. | |||
They may pick up subsequent work orders (post-0800 | They may pick up subsequent work orders (post-0800 | |||
hours) from the DOC as time and missions permit. | hours) from the DOC as time and missions permit. | |||
MPs will remove detainees from requisite cells prior to | Guards will remove detainees from requisite cells prior | |||
any work being done. At no time will work be done in | to any work being done. At no time will work be done | |||
a cell with a detainee present in said cell. | in a cell with a detainee present in said cell. | |||
(1) Prevent further damage and establish a safe | (1) Prevent further damage and establish a safe | |||
environment. This will ALWAYS be done with | environment. This will ALWAYS be done with | |||
personal safety, safety of detainees, and good judgment | personal safety, safety of detainees, and good judgment | |||
in mind. | in mind. | |||
(2) Attempt to correct the problem if within your | (2) Attempt to correct the problem if within your | |||
means/ability (i.e. plunging a clogged drain). | means/ability (i.e. plunging a clogged drain). | |||
(3) If you cannot, or it fails, individual initially | (3) If you cannot, or it fails, individual initially | |||
reporting item will complete the work request order. | reporting item will complete the work request order. | |||
(4) Notify the Block NCO who will in turn log | (4) Notify the Block NCO who will in turn log | |||
the problem in their pass-along logbook. | the problem in their pass-along logbook. | |||
skipping to change at line 8194 | skipping to change at line 9099 | |||
provisions had been taken. | provisions had been taken. | |||
21-3. Fire Prevention Precautions | 21-3. Fire Prevention Precautions | |||
a. The JDOG commander will appoint a Fire | a. The JDOG commander will appoint a Fire | |||
Marshal in writing. This will be an additional duty for | Marshal in writing. This will be an additional duty for | |||
a senior NCO. This NCO will coordinate fire | a senior NCO. This NCO will coordinate fire | |||
prevention activities with the Fire Department. | prevention activities with the Fire Department. | |||
b. All personnel working at Camp Delta should be | b. All personnel working at Camp Delta should be | |||
familiar with the Fire Response and Evacuation Plans. | familiar with the Fire Response and Evacuation Plans. | |||
c. The only smoking areas at Camp Delta are the | c. The only smoking areas at Camp Delta are the | |||
break area to the rear of DOC and the break area | break area to the rear of DOC and the break area | |||
between the JIG and QRF building. | between the JIG and DOC building. | |||
d. It is responsibility of all personnel working at | d. It is responsibility of all personnel working at | |||
Camp Delta turn the cigarettes butts off and put them | Camp Delta turn the cigarettes butts off and put them | |||
inside the specific container. | inside the specific container. | |||
e. Do not smoke 50 meters close to a container | e. Do not smoke 50 meters close to a container | |||
and/or any flammable and combustible liquids, grease, | and/or any flammable and combustible liquids, grease, | |||
material or gases. | material or gases. | |||
f. Fire extinguishers will be available in all | f. Fire extinguishers will be available in all | |||
structures except blocks. For blocks, the fire | structures except blocks. For blocks, the fire | |||
extinguishers will be centrally located in the central | extinguishers will be centrally located in the central | |||
causeway. All personnel should know how to operate | causeway. All personnel should know how to operate | |||
skipping to change at line 8237 | skipping to change at line 9142 | |||
implement other tasks under each measure as needed | implement other tasks under each measure as needed | |||
IAW the ROE. They should coordinate these | IAW the ROE. They should coordinate these | |||
additional implementations with the JOC. | additional implementations with the JOC. | |||
FPCON ALPHA | FPCON ALPHA | |||
This condition is declared when there is a general | This condition is declared when there is a general | |||
threat of possible terrorist activity against personnel | threat of possible terrorist activity against personnel | |||
and facilities, the nature, and extent of which are | and facilities, the nature, and extent of which are | |||
unpredictable, and circumstances do not justify full | unpredictable, and circumstances do not justify full | |||
implementation of FPCON BRAVO measures. | implementation of FPCON BRAVO measures. | |||
However, it may be necessary to implement selected | However, it may be necessary to implement selected | |||
measures from FPCON BRAVO (this would be called | measures from FPCON BRAVO and this would be | |||
FPCON ALPHA +). The measures in this FPCON | called FPCON ALPHA +. The measures in this | |||
must be capable of being maintained indefinitely. | FPCON must be capable of being maintained | |||
(1) Measure 1. At regular intervals, remind all | indefinitely. | |||
personnel to be suspicious and inquisitive about | 1. At regular intervals, remind all personnel and | |||
dependents to be suspicious and inquisitive about | ||||
strangers, particularly those carrying suitcases or other | strangers, particularly those carrying suitcases or other | |||
containers. Watch for unidentified personnel on or in | containers. Watch for unidentified on or in the vicinity | |||
the vicinity of JTF or NAVBASE facilities. Watch for | of U.S. installations. Watch for abandoned parcels or | |||
abandoned parcels or suitcases and any unusual | suitcases and any unusual activity. | |||
activity. | ||||
(a) All JTF personnel shall be particularly | (a) All JTF personnel shall be particularly | |||
suspicious of strangers carrying parcels, suitcases, or | suspicious of strangers carrying parcels, suitcases or | |||
other containers. | other containers. | |||
(1) Be alert to scantily clad individuals as | (1) Be alert to scantily clad individuals as they | |||
they may be Cuban Asylum Seekers (CAS) or | may be Cuban Asylum Seekers (CAS) or detainees | |||
detainees who have escaped and are trying to hide their | who have escaped and are trying to hide their identity. | |||
identity. | ||||
(2) Be inquisitive of strangers/persons taking | (2) Be inquisitive of strangers/persons taking | |||
photographs or video of sensitive items and areas such | photographs or video of sensitive items and areas such | |||
as; Magazines, Antennas, JTF HQ, detainee | as; Magazines, Antennas, JTF HQ, Detainee | |||
Operations, Detention Facilities, Radio Range Site, etc. | Operations, Radio Range Site, etc. Report all incidents | |||
Report all incidents to the JTF Joint Operations Center | to the JTF Joint Operations Center (JOC) Watch | |||
(JOC) Watch Officer at 5010/5038/5037, tactical | Officer at 5010/5038/5037, tactical telephone at (411) | |||
telephone at (411) 2219-954, or in person immediately. | 2219-954, or in person immediately. | |||
(3) Review unit-level terrorism awareness | 2. The duty officer or personnel with access to | |||
training. | building plans as well as the plans for area evacuations | |||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer, ensure the | must be available at all times. Key personnel should be | |||
able to seal off area immediately. Key personnel | ||||
required to implement security plans should be on call | ||||
and readily available | ||||
(a) JTF AT/FP Officer, ensure that | ||||
(1) All JTF Headquarters buildings exercise area | ||||
evacuation plans monthly. | ||||
implementation of all steps for FPCON Alpha IAW | (2) Floor wardens conduct refresher briefings of | |||
this PLAN. | all personnel concerning fire and bomb evacuation | |||
(2) Measure 2. All personnel with access to | procedures monthly. | |||
building plans/area evacuation plans must be available | ||||
at all times. Key personnel should be able to seal off | ||||
an area immediately. Key personnel required to | ||||
implement security plans should be on call and readily | ||||
available. | ||||
(a) JDOG AT/FP Officer ensure that: | ||||
(1) All Camp Delta evacuation plans are | ||||
exercised monthly. | ||||
(2) Conduct refresher briefings of all | ||||
personnel concerning fire, bomb, and terrorist threat | ||||
evacuation procedures monthly. | ||||
(3) Radio and telephone communications are | (3) Radio and telephone communications are | |||
tested daily. | tested daily. | |||
(4) All JDOG and Company CQs are familiar | (4) All JOC watch standers are familiar with Blue | |||
with Blue Dart and White Pinnacle procedures. | Dart and White Pinnacle procedures. | |||
(3) Measure 3. Secure buildings, rooms, and | 3. Secure buildings, rooms & storage areas not in | |||
storage areas not in regular use. | regular use. | |||
(a) JDOG AT/FP Officer ensures that all | (a) HHC, ensure that all outbuildings in vicinity | |||
outbuildings in vicinity of Camp America not being | of JTF Headquarters are secured. Ensure that floor | |||
used are secured. | wardens/building watches in JTF Headquarters | |||
(b) Commanders or 1SG conduct daily | buildings secure all rooms and storage areas not in | |||
regular use. | ||||
(b) Commander, JDOG, conduct daily | ||||
inspections of common troop areas (messing facilities, | inspections of common troop areas (messing facilities, | |||
troop billeting, latrines, recreation sea huts, etc.) for | latrines, recreation sea huts, etc.) for | |||
suspicious/abandoned packages. If assistance/guidance | suspicious/abandoned packages. If assistance/guidance | |||
is required, contact the JTF JOC Watch Officer at | is required, contact the JTF JOC Watch Officer at | |||
5010/5038/5037, tactical telephone at (411) 2219-954, | 5010/5038/5037, tactical telephone at (411) 2219-954, | |||
or in person immediately. | or in person immediately. | |||
(c) Subordinate Commanders/OICs ensure | (c) Subordinate Commanders/OICs ensure | |||
vehicle accountability daily. Ensure vehicle drivers | vehicle accountability daily. Ensure vehicle drivers | |||
conduct daily searches of vehicles for tampering before | conduct daily searches of vehicles for tampering before | |||
operating. | operating. | |||
(4) Measure 4. Increase security spot checks of | 4. Increase security spot checks of vehicles and | |||
vehicles and persons entering the JTF areas. | persons entering the installation and unclassified areas | |||
under the jurisdiction of the United States. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, conduct | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, conduct | |||
security spot checks during normal work hours. | security spot checks during normal work hours. | |||
(1) Ensure that classified materials are | (1) Ensure that classified materials are not left | |||
secured. | unsecured. | |||
(2) Ensure that personnel assigned to conduct | (2) Ensure that personnel assigned to conduct | |||
I.D. checks at access points are briefed and understand | I.D. checks at access points are briefed and understand | |||
their responsibilities. | their responsibilities. | |||
(3) Ensure that all personnel have required | (3) Ensure that all personnel have required | |||
identification cards in their possession at all times. | identification cards in their possession at all times. | |||
(4) Ensure guard force members conduct a | (4) Ensure guard force members on all personnel | |||
100% I.D. check on all personnel entering restricted | entering restricted areas (i.e., Camp Delta, JTF | |||
areas (i.e., Camp Delta I, Camp Delta II). | Headquarters, etc.) conduct a 100% I.D. check. | |||
(b) JDOG S-2, coordinate with JTF AT/FP | (b) JTF Counterintelligence Officer, coordinate | |||
Officer to conduct weekly after hours | with JTF AT/FP Officer to conduct weekly after hours | |||
counterintelligence inspections of all JTF Headquarters | counterintelligence inspections of all JTF Headquarters | |||
spaces (including garbage dumpsters, etc). | spaces (including garbage dumpsters, etc). | |||
(5) Measure 5. Limit access points for vehicles | (c) Commander, Naval Base, Guantanamo Bay | |||
and personnel commensurate with a reasonable flow of | (COMNAVBASE), conduct random maritime patrols | |||
traffic. | of the Joint Operations Area (JOA). | |||
(6) Measure 6. As a deterrent, apply measures 14, | 5. Limit access points for vehicles and personnel | |||
15, 17, or 18 from FPCON Bravo, either individually | commensurate with a reasonable flow of traffic. | |||
or in combination with each other. | 6. As a deterrent apply measures 14,15,17, or 18 | |||
(7) Measure 7. Review all plans, orders, | from FPCON Bravo, either individually on in | |||
personnel details, and logistic requirements related to | combination with each other. | |||
the introduction of higher FPCONs. | 7. Review all plans, orders, personnel details, and | |||
(a) Commanders, review all watch stander | logistic requirements related to the introduction of | |||
procedures and ensure each watch station is aware of | higher FPCONs. | |||
their duties and responsibilities. | (a) JTF JOC Watch Officer, review all watch | |||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer attend Force | stander procedures and ensure each watch station is | |||
Protection Committee meetings and ensure subordinate | aware of their duties and responsibilities. | |||
units understand their responsibilities and can | (b) JTF Communications Officer, ensure phone | |||
effectively respond to threats in all FPCON levels. | listings are up to date and passed out to all sections | |||
(c) JDOG RTO, ensure phone listings are up to | within the JTF. Ensure that the JOC is briefed on the | |||
date and passed out to all sections and companies | security communication system frequencies/call signs | |||
within the JDOG. Ensure that the companies are | utilized by the JTF. | |||
briefed on the security communication system | (c) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure key | |||
frequencies/call signs utilized by the JTF. | ||||
(d) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure key | ||||
personnel understand they are subject to immediate | personnel understand they are subject to immediate | |||
recall. | recall. | |||
(1) Inform all personnel to fuel all | (1) Inform all personnel to fuel all government | |||
vehicles, and keep them full at all times. | ||||
government vehicles, and keep them full at all times. | (d) Staff Judge Advocate, ensure that existing | |||
(e) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure | Rules of Engagement (ROE) and Use of Force (UOF) | |||
policies are applicable. | ||||
(1) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure | ||||
approved ROE and UOF policies are passed down to | approved ROE and UOF policies are passed down to | |||
the lowest levels so that all personnel understand it’s | the lowest levels so that all personnel understand it’s | |||
application. | application. | |||
(8) Measure 8. Review and implement, as | 8. Review and implement security measures for | |||
appropriate, security measures for high-risk personnel | high-risk personnel as appropriate. | |||
(HRP). | (a) JTF Provost Marshal, coordinate with NCIS | |||
(9) Measure 9. As appropriate consult with | and be prepared to provide a qualified Personal | |||
NAVBASE Security and NAVBASE N2 on the threat | Security Detail (PSD) for designated High-Risk | |||
and mutual antiterrorism measures. | Personnel (HRP) and JTF visitors as | |||
(10) Measure 10. Review nuclear, biological, | Directed by CJTF. | |||
chemical (NBC) threat and mission oriented protective | (b) Aide de Camp, ensure that yourself and the | |||
posture (MOPP) level. | CJTF’s driver possess current qualification with the | |||
(a) JDOG Operations Officer, consult with | M9 Service Pistol. | |||
JDOG Intelligence Officer concerning the | (1) Ensure that a radio and alternate means of | |||
chemical/biological threat; be prepared to raise MOPP | communication (Cell Phone) are maintained with the | |||
levels as necessary. | CJTF and CJTF’s driver at all times. Review HRP | |||
(b) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, review | procedures. | |||
NBC measures with all personnel. | 9. As appropriate, consult local authorities on the | |||
threat and mutual antiterrorism measures. | ||||
(a) JTF Intelligence Officer, consult daily with | ||||
NCIS, NAVBASE Security, and NAVBASE N-2 to | ||||
discuss threat levels and emerging threat information | ||||
pass appropriate information to personnel affected, as | ||||
required. | ||||
(b) JTF AT/FP Officer, conduct Force Protection | ||||
Working Group meetings to discuss emerging / | ||||
emergency force protection requirements as required. | ||||
10. Review all plans and be prepared to implement | ||||
higher FPCON. | ||||
(a) JTF Operations Officer, consult with JTF | ||||
Intelligence Officer concerning the chemical/biological | ||||
threat; be prepared to raise MOPP levels as necessary. | ||||
(b)Subordinate Commanders/OICs, review NBCD | ||||
measures with all hands. | ||||
FPCON BRAVO | FPCON BRAVO | |||
This condition is declared when there is an increased | This condition is declared when there is an increased | |||
and more predictable threat of terrorist activity even | and more predictable threat of terrorist activity even | |||
though no particular target has been identified. | though no particular target has been identified. | |||
However, it may be necessary to implement selected | However, it may be necessary to implement selected | |||
measures from FPCON CHARLIE (this would be | measures from FPCON CHARLIE (this would be | |||
called FPCON BRAVO +). Measures in this FPCON | called FPCON BRAVO +). Measures in this FPCON | |||
must be maintainable for weeks without causing undue | must be maintainable for weeks without causing undue | |||
hardship or affecting operational capability. | hardship or affecting operational capability. | |||
(1) Measure 11. Repeat measure 1 and warn | 11. Repeat measure 1 and warn personnel of any | |||
personnel of any other potential form of terrorist attack. | other potential form of terrorist attack. | |||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure | |||
antiterrorism awareness briefing for all personnel, | antiterrorism awareness briefing for all personnel, | |||
including mail procedures and vehicle searches for all | including mail procedures and vehicle searches for all | |||
hands. | hands. | |||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer, ensure the | (b) AT/FP Officer, ensure the implementation all | |||
implementation all steps for FPCON Bravo IAW this | steps for FPCON Bravo IAW this PLAN. Ensure that | |||
PLAN. Ensure that NAVBASE Security Police are | NAVBASE Security Police are briefed on additional | |||
briefed on additional security measures implemented in | security measures implemented in this FPCON. | |||
this FPCON. | 12. Keep all personnel involved in implementing | |||
(3) Measure 12. Check plans for implementation | antiterrorist contingency plans on call. | |||
of next FPCON. | 13. Check plans for implementation of next | |||
(4) Measure 13. Move cars and such objects as | FPCON. | |||
trash containers, etc., from vicinity of all buildings. | 14. Move cars and objects (e.g., crates, trash | |||
Consider the application of centralized parking. | containers) at least 25 meters from buildings, | |||
(a) JDOG AT/FP Officer, coordinate with the | particularly buildings of a sensitive or prestigious | |||
Public Works Officer and affected department heads to | nature. Consider centralized parking. | |||
remove all dumpsters, cars, etc. away from all JDOG | (a) AT/FP Officer, coordinate with the | |||
Headquarters buildings and areas. Reference (a) | NAVBASE AT/FP Officer and affected department | |||
requires a minimum 100-foot standoff from high- | heads to remove all dumpsters, cars, etc. away from all | |||
density soft targets. | JTF Headquarters buildings and areas a minimum 100- | |||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer coordinate with JTF | foot standoff from high-density soft targets. | |||
AT/FP Officer to have all dumpsters, cars, etc, | 15. Secure and regularly inspect all buildings, | |||
removed from vicinity of Camp Delta and guard force | rooms, and storage areas not in regular use. | |||
billeting areas. | (a) HHC, ensure that all abandoned structures in | |||
(5) Measure 14. Secure and regularly inspect all | vicinity of JTF Headquarters previously secured in | |||
buildings, rooms, and storage areas not in regular use. | FPCON Alpha are inspected daily. | |||
(a) JDOG AT/FP Officer ensure all abandoned | (b) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, immediately | |||
structures in vicinity of Camp America previously | conduct inspections of all secured buildings and areas | |||
secured in FPCON Alpha are inspected daily. | and report any discrepancies or abnormalities to the | |||
(b) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, | JOC Watch Officer via telephone at ext. 5010 / 5038 / | |||
immediately conduct inspections of all secured | 5037, tactical telephone at (411) 2219-954, or in person | |||
buildings and areas and report any discrepancies or | immediately. | |||
abnormalities to the JOC Watch Officer via telephone | 16. At the beginning and end of each workday, as | |||
at ext. 5010/5038/5037, tactical telephone at (411) | well as at other regular and frequent intervals, inspect | |||
2219-954, or in person immediately. | the interior and exterior of buildings in regular use for | |||
(6) Measure 15. At the beginning and end of each | suspicious packages. | |||
workday, and at other regular and frequent intervals, | ||||
inspect for suspicious activity or packages of the | ||||
interior and exterior of buildings in regular use. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, at the | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, at the | |||
beginning and end of each workday, and at four-hour | beginning and end of each workday, and at four-hour | |||
intervals during the workday, inspect the interior and | intervals during the workday, inspect the interior and | |||
exterior of buildings in regular use under your control | exterior of buildings in regular use under your control | |||
for suspicious activity or packages. Report your | for suspicious activity or packages. Report your | |||
findings, positive or negative to the JTF JOC watch | findings, positive or negative to the JTF JOC watch | |||
officer at ext. 5010/5058/5037, tactical telephone at | officer at ext. 5010/5058/5037, tactical telephone at | |||
(411) 2219-954, or in person immediately. | (411) 2219-954, or in person immediately. | |||
(7) Measure 16. Examine all mail (above the | 17. Examine mail (above the regular examination | |||
regular examination process) for letter or parcel bombs. | process) for letter or parcel bombs. | |||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure USPS | |||
USPS Poster 26 is distributed throughout office spaces, | Poster 26 is distributed throughout office spaces, | |||
billeting, and unit mailrooms. Review mail-handling | billeting, and unit mailrooms. Review mail-handling | |||
procedures with all unit mail personnel. | procedures with all unit mail personnel. | |||
18. Check all deliveries to messes, clubs, etc. | ||||
(8) Measure 17. Inspect all deliveries (including | Advise dependents to check home deliveries. | |||
soda, vending machines, etc) to facilities. | (a) JTF AT/FP Officer, ensure that JTF | |||
(a) AT/FP Officer, ensure that interior building | Headquarters, Pink Palace, and JIIF interior building | |||
guards conduct inspections of all deliveries to their | sentries conduct inspections of all deliveries to their | |||
respective buildings. All delivery personnel are to be | respective buildings. All delivery personnel are to be | |||
escorted while in JDOG AOR. | escorted while in JTF Headquarters buildings. | |||
(b) Delta Shift OIC, ensure that all civilian | (b) Commander, JDOG, commence inspection of | |||
one of every ten civilian commercial or contractor | ||||
vehicles entering Radio Range ECP. | ||||
(c) Commander, JDOG, ensure that all civilian | ||||
contractor vehicles (waste removal trucks, etc) that | contractor vehicles (waste removal trucks, etc) that | |||
need access to the inner perimeter of the Camp Delta | need access to the inner perimeter of Camp Delta and | |||
detention facilities are searched prior to entry. | Camp America facilities are searched prior to entry. | |||
Commence inspection of one of every ten civilian | 19. Increase surveillance of domestic | |||
commercial or contractor vehicles entering Camp Delta | ||||
TAOR. | ||||
(9) Measure 18. Increase surveillance of domestic | ||||
accommodations, schools, messes, clubs, and other soft | accommodations, schools, messes, clubs, and other soft | |||
targets to improve deterrence and defense and to build | targets to improve deterrence and defense and to build | |||
confidence among JTF personnel. | confidence among staff and dependents. | |||
(a) JDOG S-2 Intelligence Officer, as far as | (a) JTF Intelligence Officer, as far as resources | |||
resources allow, increase surveillance of all soft | allow, increase surveillance of all soft JTF targets. | |||
targets. | (b) JTF Provost Marshal, coordinate with | |||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | NAVBASE Security Police for increased NAVBASE | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | security patrols of JTF headquarters and housing areas. | |||
(c) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | (c) COMNAVBASE, conduct maritime patrols in | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | JOA 24 hrs/day, 7 days/week. | |||
(d) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | 20. Make staff and dependents aware of the general | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | situation in order to stop rumors and prevent | |||
(e) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | unnecessary alarm. | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(10) Measure 19. Make JDOG and Company | ||||
staffs and personnel aware of the general situation in | ||||
order to stop rumors and prevent unnecessary alarm. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, inform | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, inform | |||
personnel of general situation as it progresses or | personnel of general situation as it progresses or | |||
regresses. | regresses. | |||
(11) Measure 20. At an early stage, inform | 21. At an early stage, inform members of local | |||
members of local security committees/of any action | security committees of actions being taken. Explain | |||
being taken and why. | reason for actions. | |||
(a) JDOG OPNS inform subordinate elements | (a) JTF AT/FP Officer, inform the Force | |||
as soon as elevated FPCON is set and all action being | Protection Working Group (FPWG) as soon as elevated | |||
taken. | FPCON is set and of all action being taken. | |||
(12) Measure 21. Operate random patrols to | 22. Physically inspect visitors and randomly | |||
check vehicles, people, and buildings. | inspect their suitcases, parcels, and other containers. | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | Ensure that proper dignity is maintained and if | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | possible, ensure that soldiers conduct physical | |||
(13) Measure 22. Remind drivers to lock parked | inspections of members of the same sex. | |||
vehicles and to institute a positive system of checking | 23. Operate random patrols to check vehicles, | |||
before they entering or exit the vehicle. | people, and buildings. | |||
(14) Measure 23. Implement additional security | (a) Provost Marshal, Coordinate with NAVBASE | |||
measures for high-risk personnel, as appropriate. | security vehicle patrols are conducted of JTF housing | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not apply to units located | areas. | |||
at RRDF. | 24. Protect off-base military personnel and military | |||
(15) Measure 24. Brief personnel who may | vehicles in accordance with prepared plans. Remind | |||
augment guard forces on the use of Deadly Force. | drivers to lock vehicles and check vehicle before | |||
Ensure that there is no misunderstanding of these | entering or exiting the vehicle. | |||
instructions. | 25. Implement additional security measures fro | |||
(16) Measure 25. Pre-stage materials for any | high-risk personnel as appropriate. | |||
additional barriers that may be needed in elevated | ||||
FPCON. | (a) JTF Provost Marshal, ensure the following | |||
(a) AT/FP Officer, coordinate with JTF AT/FP | actions occur: | |||
Officer and JTF Intelligence Officer to design and pre- | (1) CJTF driver, conduct thorough search of | |||
stage the necessary Class IV construction materials and | CJTF vehicle prior to each use for tampering or | |||
pre-constructed barriers at designated access points to | explosive devices. | |||
the JDOG TAOR (VH897015) commensurate with the | (2) CJTF driver, maintain constant | |||
current threat indications and warnings. Assist JTF- | communication with JTF JOC when transporting CJTF | |||
GTMO, as required. | to destinations. Inform JTF JOC via radio upon arrival | |||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | at destination, and upon departure, next destination and | |||
GTMO FPCON measures | ETA. | |||
(17) Measure 26. JDOG AT/FP Officer attends | (3) CJTF Aide-de-Camp, personally inform JTF | |||
increased frequency of AT/FP Working Group | JOC Watch Officer of CJTF departure from JTF | |||
Meetings as necessary. | Headquarters, destination(s), and ETA. Ensure that | |||
CJTF driver carries out measure 25a and 25b. | ||||
26. Brief personnel who may augment guard forces | ||||
on the use of deadly force. Ensure that there is no | ||||
misunderstanding of these instructions. | ||||
27. As appropriate, consult local authorities on the | ||||
threat and mutual antiterrorism measures. | ||||
28. Pre-stage materials for any additional barriers | ||||
that may be needed in elevated FPCON. | ||||
(a) JTF Engineer Officer, coordinate with JTF | ||||
AT/FP Officer and JTF Intelligence Officer to design | ||||
and pre-stage the necessary Class IV construction | ||||
materials and pre-constructed barriers at designated | ||||
access points to the JTF Headquarters complex | ||||
(north/south ends of Huntington Hill Road), Camp | ||||
Delta (Sherman Road access control point), JTF | ||||
housing areas (main entrances of Windward Loop and | ||||
East Caravella) and Radio Range (VH897015) | ||||
commensurate with the current threat indications and | ||||
warnings. | ||||
(b) Commander, JDOG, be prepared to institute | ||||
vehicle checkpoint and emplace pre-staged barriers | ||||
along Kittery Beach Road (grid VH897015) to deny | ||||
and slow traffic access to the Radio Range area. | ||||
(c) JTF Headquarters Commandant, be prepared | ||||
to emplace pre-staged barriers to deny/slow traffic into | ||||
JTF housing areas (Windward Loop, East Caravella | ||||
and Villamar housing area). | ||||
29. JTF AT/FP Officer, increase the frequency of | ||||
AT/FP Working Group Meetings as necessary. | ||||
FPCON CHARLIE | FPCON CHARLIE | |||
This condition is declared when an incident occurs or | This condition is declared when an incident occurs or | |||
intelligence is received indicating that some form of | intelligence is received indicating that some form of | |||
terrorist action is imminent. However, it may be | terrorist action is imminent. However, it may be | |||
necessary to implement selected measures from | necessary to implement selected measures from | |||
FPCON DELTA (this would be called FPCON | FPCON DELTA (this would be called FPCON | |||
CHARLIE +). Implementation for more than a short | CHARLIE +). Implementation for more than a short | |||
period will probably create hardship and affect the | period will probably create hardship and affect the | |||
NAVBASEGTMO peacetime operations. | NAVBASEGTMO peacetime operations. | |||
30. Continue, or introduce, all measures listed in | ||||
(1) Measure 27. Inform all personnel of the | FPCON Bravo. | |||
increased FPCON and continue all FPCON BRAVO | (a) JTF JOC Watch Officer, inform all personnel | |||
measures. | listed in the recall list of this PLAN to remain at their | |||
(a) JTF JOC Watch Officer and JDOG OPNS | place of duty/billeting in the event of a recall. | |||
inform all personnel listed in the recall list of this | (b) JTF AT/FP Officer, ensure the | |||
PLAN to remain at their place of duty/billeting in the | ||||
event of a recall. | ||||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer, ensure the | ||||
implementation all steps for FPCON Charlie are IAW | implementation all steps for FPCON Charlie are IAW | |||
this PLAN. | this PLAN. Ensure that NAVBASE Security Police | |||
(c) All JTF personnel have body armor, helmet, | are briefed on additional security measures | |||
load-bearing equipment (LBE/LBV), protective mask, | implemented in this FPCON. | |||
and weapon readily accessible. All JTF personnel on | (c) All JTF personnel, based on threat, BPT have | |||
duty/at work will wear body armor, helmet, LBE/LBV, | body armor, helmet, load-bearing equipment (LBE), | |||
and protective mask (in carrier) while outdoors, and | gasmask, and weapon readily accessible. | |||
carry a Condition Three weapon. | 31. Keep all personnel responsible for | |||
(2) Measure 28. Keep all personnel responsible | implementing antiterrorism plans at their places of | |||
for implementing antiterrorist plans at their places of | ||||
duty. | duty. | |||
(a) Subordinate commanders/OICs, institute | (a) Subordinate commanders/OICs, institute | |||
check out log for personnel on liberty status. | check out log for personnel on liberty status. | |||
(3) Measure 29. Limit access points to | 32. Limit access points to absolute minimum. | |||
vital/restricted areas to an absolute minimum. | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, limit access | |||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/ OICs, limit | points to an absolute minimum. All contractor | |||
access points to an absolute minimum. All contractor | ||||
personnel will be escorted while conducting business | personnel will be escorted while conducting business | |||
around Camp America, Camp Bulkeley, Camp Delta I, | around JTF activities. | |||
and Camp Delta II, if personnel permit. | (b) HHC, ensure that all access roads leading to | |||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | JTF Headquarters are blocked with obstacles, with only | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | a single access point available for vehicle traffic. | |||
(c) Shift OIC, Camp Delta, ensures 100% | Ensure that an armed two-man sentry post is in place | |||
(24 hour post) to control access to the JTF | ||||
Headquarters complex. Sentries will be in weapons | ||||
condition three (M16A2), with 60 rounds of | ||||
ammunition, and briefed on the proper use of Deadly | ||||
Force and Rules of Engagement. The only vehicles | ||||
permitted access to the JTF Headquarters complex are | ||||
the CJTF, JTF Chief of Staff, and JTF JOC Watch | ||||
Officer vehicles. Sentries will contact JTF JOC Watch | ||||
Officer via Motorola to request permission should | ||||
additional vehicles desire entry into the JTF | ||||
Headquarters complex. | ||||
(c) Commander, JDOG, conduct 100% | ||||
inspection of civilian commercial and contractor | inspection of civilian commercial and contractor | |||
vehicles entering Delta Detention Facilities. | vehicles entering Camp Delta Detention Facility. | |||
(d) JDOG AT/FP Officer ensures that no | (d) HHC, as manpower allows, implement a | |||
vehicles are parked near occupied buildings. All non- | vehicle checkpoint at entrance to JTF housing areas | |||
military vehicles will be parked in the lot by the bus | (Windward Loop and East Caravella). Checkpoint will | |||
stop located near Seaside Galley. All military vehicles | be manned 24 hours a day until directed to stand down. | |||
will be parked in the parking lot West of Evacuation | Only personnel with government identification | |||
Route #1. | card/JTF identification will be permitted into the | |||
(e) JDOG S-4 coordinate with JTF Logistics | housing areas. Ensure that checkpoint has accurate | |||
Officer to cancel all non-mission essential deliveries | rosters of personnel residing in JTF housing. Allow no | |||
(soda, vending machines) to JDOG AOR and Camps | civilian or contractor vehicles into housing areas. | |||
Delta. JDOG S-4 coordinate with JTF Logistics Officer | Ensure that vehicle checkpoint has proper | |||
to stop aerial spraying of insecticide from truck. | communications with JTF JOC Watch Officer. | |||
(f) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | Checkpoint will be armed with T/O weapons, | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ammunition (60 rounds 5.56mm, 30 rounds 9mm) and | |||
(4) Measure 30. Enforce control of base entry of | in weapons condition three | |||
residents/visitors. | (e) JTF Logistics Officer, coordinate with | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | NAVBASE Navy Exchange to cancel all non-mission | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | ||||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(5) Measure 31. Enforce centralized parking of | ||||
vehicles away from sensitive buildings. | ||||
(a) Ensure that all non-military vehicles not | ||||
necessary for the operation of the JDOG AOR are | ||||
parked in the parking lot next to Seaside Galley. | ||||
(b) Ensure that all non-military vehicles | ||||
(contractor, government sedans, etc) are parked at least | ||||
100 meters from military work areas (parked in parking | ||||
lot next to Seaside Galley) and no non-military | ||||
vehicles are permitted to approach or park within 100 | ||||
meters of Camp Delta I, Camp Delta II, or Detention | ||||
Hospital. | ||||
(6) Measure 32. Issue weapons to guards. Local | ||||
orders should include specific orders on issue of | ||||
ammunition. | ||||
(a) JDOG S-4 coordinates for issue of weapons | ||||
and ammunition to subordinate units. | ||||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | ||||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(c) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | ||||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(7) Measure 33. Increase patrolling of JDOG | ||||
areas of responsibility. | ||||
(a) JDOG OPNS establishes a 24-hour roving | ||||
patrol of Camp America and Camp Bulkeley. | ||||
(b) JDOG OPNS utilizes Infantry to increase | essential deliveries (soda, vending machines) to JTF | |||
patrols of likely avenues of approach/observation | Headquarters buildings. | |||
points to Camp Delta. | (f) JTF Provost Marshal, coordinate with CJTF | |||
(8) Measure 34. Protect all designated vulnerable | Aide-de-Camp for HRP security detail to be posted | |||
points. Give special attention to vulnerable points | with CJTF after hours (CJTF billeting). | |||
outside of military establishment. | 33. Strictly enforce control of base entry. | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | Randomly search vehicles. | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | (a) JTF Operations Officer, immediately | |||
(b) Increase frequency of roving patrols of | coordinate with higher headquarters to review/delay | |||
guard force billeting areas | any inbound detainee transfers to Guantanamo Bay. | |||
(9) Measure 35. Erect barriers and obstacles to | (b) JTF Operations Officer, coordinate with Joint | |||
control traffic flow. | Information Bureau COMNAVBASE to restrict non- | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | essential visitors on base. All non-essential visitors | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | will be held at the Leeward air terminal until they are | |||
(b) Emplace barriers in front of or inside sally | able to obtain a flight off NAVBASEGTMO. | |||
ports for Detention Hospital and Delta II. | (c) JDOG, Randomly search all vehicle entering | |||
(c) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | Radio Range ECP | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | 34. Enforce centralized parking of vehicles away | |||
(10) Measure 36. Consult local authorities about | from sensitive buildings. | |||
closing public roads and facilities that might make sites | (a) HHC, immediately implement the parking of | |||
all vehicles visiting/assigned to JTF Headquarters at | ||||
McCalla Airfield. Only vehicles allowed to park in | ||||
vicinity of JTF Headquarters are CJTF, JTF Chief of | ||||
Staff, COMNAVBASE, NAVBASE XO and JTF JOC | ||||
Watch Officer vehicles (personal or official). | ||||
(b) Commander, JDOG, ensure that all non- | ||||
military vehicles (contractor, government sedans, etc) | ||||
are parked at least 100 meters from guard force | ||||
billeting. Ensure that no non-military vehicles are | ||||
permitted to approach or park within the 100 meters of | ||||
the Delta detention facility without being thoroughly | ||||
searched beforehand. | ||||
35. Issue weapons to guards. Local orders should | ||||
include specific orders on issue of ammunition. | ||||
(a) JTF Logistics Officer, be prepared to issue | ||||
weapons and ammunition (60 rounds (M16A2), 30 | ||||
rounds (M9)) to all identified personnel. | ||||
(b) CJTF, CJTF Aide-de-Camp, CJTF Driver, | ||||
draw T/O weapon and ammunition (30 rounds 9mm, | ||||
60 rounds 5.56mm). Maintain weapons condition | ||||
three. | ||||
(c) HHC, ensure that JTF Headquarters interior | ||||
building sentry is armed with T/O weapon and | ||||
ammunition (30 rounds 9mm, 60 rounds 5.56mm). | ||||
Maintain weapons condition three | ||||
36. Increase patrolling of JTF areas of | ||||
responsibility. | ||||
(a) Commander, JDOG, increase patrols of likely | ||||
avenues of approach/observation points to JTF | ||||
Facilities/Radio Range. | ||||
37. Protect all designated vulnerable points. Give | ||||
special attention to vulnerable points outside of | ||||
military establishment. | ||||
(a) JTF Provost Marshal, coordinate with | ||||
NAVBASE Security Police for increased patrolling of | ||||
JTF housing areas | ||||
(b) Commander, JDOG, increase frequency of | ||||
roving patrols of guard force billeting areas. Conduct | ||||
100% identification checks of all individuals entering | ||||
guard force billeting area. | ||||
38. Erect barriers and obstacles to control traffic | ||||
flow. | ||||
(a) HHC, ensure that all access roads leading to | ||||
JTF Headquarters are blocked with obstacles, with only | ||||
a single access point available for vehicle traffic. | ||||
39. Consult local authorities about closing public | ||||
(and military) roads and facilities that might make sites | ||||
more vulnerable to attacks. | more vulnerable to attacks. | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | (a) JTF AT/FP Officer, coordinate with | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | NAVBASE Security Police to close all public access to | |||
(11) Measure 37. The CJTF will institute a | Skyline Drive. Coordinate with NAVBASE Security | |||
mandatory curfew for all JTF personnel not on duty. | Police to close access to Kittery Beach and Windmill | |||
The curfew time will be determined by the CJTF. | Beach to all personnel. | |||
40. The CJTF will institute a mandatory curfew for | ||||
all JTF personnel not on duty. The curfew time will be | ||||
determined by the CJTF. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, institute | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, institute | |||
buddy system for individuals in liberty status. | buddy system for individuals in liberty status. | |||
FPCON DELTA | FPCON DELTA | |||
This condition applies in the immediate location where | This condition applies in the immediate location where | |||
a terrorist attack has occurred or when intelligence is | a terrorist attack has occurred or when intelligence is | |||
received that terrorist action against a specific location | received that terrorist action against a specific location | |||
is likely. Normally this FPCON is declared as a | is likely. Normally this FPCON is declared as a | |||
localized warning. | localized warning. | |||
(1) Measure 38. Inform all personnel of the | 41. Inform all personnel of the upgraded FPCON | |||
upgraded FPCON and continue to introduce all | and continue or introduce all measures listed for | |||
measures listed for FPCON BRAVO and CHARLIE. | FPCON BRAVO and CHARLIE. | |||
(a) All JDOG personnel (both on and off duty) | (a) Based on local threat, JTF personnel BPT | |||
draw weapons and ammunition (30 rounds 9mm, 60 | draw weapons and ammunition (30 rounds 9mm, 60 | |||
rounds 5.56). Maintain weapons condition four | rounds 5.56mm). Maintain weapons condition four | |||
(M16A2 and M9) for off duty personnel; weapons | (M16A2 and M9) for off duty. Personnel, weapons | |||
condition three for on duty/at work personnel when | condition three for on duty/at work personnel. All JTF | |||
outdoors. All JDOG personnel will wear body armor, | personnel will wear body armor, helmet, and gasmask | |||
helmet, protective mask (in carrier), and weapon | (in carrier) while outdoors. | |||
readily available. All JDOG personnel will wear body | (b) AT/FP Officer, based on CG’s guidance, | |||
armor, helmet, and protective mask (in carrier) while | ensure the implementation all steps for FPCON Delta | |||
outdoors. | IAW this PLAN. Ensure that NAVBASE Security | |||
(b) JDOG AT/FP Officer, ensure the | Police are briefed on all additional security measures in | |||
implementation of all steps for FPCON Delta IAW this | this FPCON. | |||
APPENDIX. Ensure that the JDOG’s FPCON status is | 42. Augment guards as necessary. | |||
reported to higher headquarters. | (a) Commander JDOG, BPT arm and deploy | |||
(c) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | eight-man security element around JTF Headquarters. | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | All sentries will have weapons in condition three | |||
(2) Measure 39. Augment guards as necessary. | (M16A2); weapons condition three (M9). | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | (b) Commander, JDOG, increase size of exterior | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | roving patrols of Radio Range from four-man to eight- | |||
(b) JDOG OPNS increase size of internal | man elements. Increase size of internal guards and | |||
guards force as manpower allows. | tower sentries, as manpower will allow. All sentries | |||
(3) Measure 40. Identify all vehicles in | will have weapons in condition three M16A2; weapons | |||
operational or mission-support areas. | condition three (M9). | |||
(4) Measure 41. Search all vehicles and their | 43. Identify all vehicles in operational or mission- | |||
contents before allowing entrance to JTF TAORs. | support areas. | |||
(a) Camp Delta will search all vehicles | ||||
entering the camp. | ||||
(b) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | ||||
GTMO FPCON measures. | ||||
(5) Measure 42. Control access and implement | ||||
positive identification of all personnel – no exceptions. | ||||
(a) Camps Delta will conduct 100% ID check | ||||
of all personnel entering the camps. Any personnel not | ||||
necessary for the operation or command and control of | ||||
the camps will not be allowed access. Any personnel | ||||
inside the camps who are not necessary for the | ||||
operation or command and control of the camps will be | ||||
escorted out of the camps. JIG personnel will be given | ||||
to option of leaving or staying IAW their own SOP. | ||||
Any non-military or non-JIG personnel that must enter | ||||
the camps will be searched and escorted at all times. | 44. Search all vehicles and their contents before | |||
(6) Measure 43. Search all suitcases, briefcases, | allowing entrance to JTF TAORs. | |||
packages, etc, brought into all JTF buildings, facilities, | (a) Commander, JDOG, conduct 100% vehicle | |||
and areas. | search of all commercial/privately owned vehicles | |||
(a) Delta OIC and SOGs will ensure all items | entering Radio Range, through the Kittery Beach | |||
brought through the sally port are searched. | Infantry Checkpoint. | |||
(7) Measure 44. Be prepared to displace JDOG | (b) Commander, JDOG, Conduct 100% vehicle | |||
OPS and company operations to alternate DOC. | search of all vehicles entering Camp Delta. | |||
(Buildings West of Camp Bulkeley.) | 45. Control access and implement positive | |||
(a) JDOG OPNS ensures that all staff sections | identification of all personnel – no exceptions. | |||
have identified primary personnel and essential | (a) JTF AT/FP Officer, consider canceling all | |||
materials that would need to be moved on short notice | non-essential deliveries (vending machines, etc). All | |||
to an alternate DOC. | contractor/NAVBASE workers not on JTF access list | |||
(8) Measure 45. Make frequent checks of the | will be escorted at all times. | |||
exterior of buildings and parking lots. | 46. Search all suitcases, briefcases, packages, etc, | |||
brought into all JTF buildings, facilities, and areas. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OIC’s, ensure that | ||||
all suitcases, briefcases, packages, etc, brought into | ||||
your HQ/buildings are searched. | ||||
47. Control access and implement positive | ||||
identification of all personnel-on exceptions. | ||||
(a) Be prepared to displace JTF Headquarters on | ||||
short notice to alternate command post (Wine Cellar). | ||||
(b) JTF Operations Officer, ensure that all JTF | ||||
staff sections have identified primary personnel and | ||||
essential materials that would need to be moved on | ||||
short notice to the alternate command post. | ||||
48. Make frequent checks of the exterior of | ||||
buildings and parking lots. | ||||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure that | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, ensure that | |||
designated personnel conduct frequent inspections of | designated personnel conduct frequent inspections of | |||
building exteriors and parking areas. | building exteriors and parking areas. | |||
(9) Measure 46. Minimize all administrative | 49. Minimize all administrative journeys and visits. | |||
journeys and visits. | (a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs, cancel | |||
(a) Subordinate Commanders/OICs cancel pass | liberty for all hands. All hands will be at place of duty, | |||
and days off for all personnel. All personnel will be at | dining facilities, or billeting. | |||
place of duty, dining facilities, billeting or staging area. | (b) JTF Logistics Officer, be prepared to provide | |||
(b) JDOG S-4 will be prepared to provide field | field rations/MREs to JTF units should dining facilities | |||
rations/MREs to JDOG units should dining facilities be | be declared off limits due to threat. | |||
declared off limits due to threat. JDOG S-4 should | 50. Consult intelligence authorities about closing | |||
anticipate the need to provide rations for the detainees | public (and military) roads and facilities that might | |||
being held at Camp Delta I, Camp Delta II, and | ||||
Detention Hospital. | ||||
(10) Measure 47. Consult intelligence authorities | ||||
about closing public roads and facilities that might | ||||
make sites vulnerable to terrorist attack. | make sites vulnerable to terrorist attack. | |||
(a) Not Used. Does not correspond with JTF- | (a) JTF AT/FP Officer, JTF Intelligence Officer, | |||
GTMO FPCON measures. | coordinate with NAVBASE Security Police and | |||
(11) Measure 48. CJTF-GTMO will consider | NAVBASE N2 regarding threat and restricting all non- | |||
NBC threat and increase in MOPP level. | military vehicular traffic from McCalla Hill Road. | |||
51. CJTF-GTMO will consider NBC threat and | ||||
increase in MOPP level. | ||||
21-5. Alert Roster/Recall Roster | 21-5. Alert Roster/Recall Roster | |||
Commanders will implement an alert roster/recall | Commanders will implement an alert roster/recall | |||
roster for the members of their unit to be implemented | roster for the members of their unit to be implemented | |||
in the event of an increase in FPCON. Initial contact | in the event of an increase in FPCON. Initial contact | |||
attempt will be by telephone. Secondary will be by | attempt will be by telephone. Secondary will be by | |||
radio and/or cellular phone. Notifications of units at | radio and/or cellular phone. Notifications of units at | |||
Camp America/Camp Bulkeley will be by runner if | Camp America/Camp Bulkeley will be by runner if | |||
necessary. JDOG S-1 section will maintain and | necessary. JDOG S-1 section will maintain and | |||
distribute the Alert Roster/Recall Roster. | distribute the Alert Roster/Recall Roster. | |||
21-6. Brevity Codes For Implementation Of FPCON | 21-6. Brevity Codes For Implementation Of FPCON | |||
skipping to change at line 8724 | skipping to change at line 9691 | |||
001 IMPLEMENT FPCON | 001 IMPLEMENT FPCON | |||
CHARLIE MEASURES | CHARLIE MEASURES | |||
Preakness | Preakness | |||
Stakes | Stakes | |||
002 IMPLEMENT FPCON | 002 IMPLEMENT FPCON | |||
DELTA MEASURES | DELTA MEASURES | |||
Belmont Stakes | Belmont Stakes | |||
003 IMPLEMENT FPCON | 003 IMPLEMENT FPCON | |||
BRAVO MEASURES | BRAVO MEASURES | |||
Kentucky Derby | Kentucky Derby | |||
Table 21-1 | ||||
The radio traffic to send the brevity code will be: | The radio traffic to send the brevity code will be: | |||
“(Receiving Unit) this is (Sending Unit) I have FLASH | “(Receiving Unit) this is (Sending Unit) I have FLASH | |||
traffic…(BREAK)…I send (Brevity Code). | traffic…(BREAK)…I send (Brevity Code). | |||
Acknowledge receipt of code. OVER.” | Acknowledge receipt of code. OVER.” | |||
Section III – Alert Systems | Section III – Alert Systems | |||
21-7. Duress Condition | 21-7. Duress Condition | |||
a. Can be indicated by Block Guard utilizing a | a. Can be indicated by a guard utilizing a duress | |||
duress code, yelling for help, using a radio, blowing a | code, yelling for help, using a radio, blowing a whistle, | |||
whistle, or other means. | or other means. | |||
(1) Guards on the affected block attempt to DOC | (1) Guards on the affected block attempt to DOC | |||
the situation and call for assistance as necessary. | the situation and call for assistance as necessary. | |||
(2) If a call for assistance is made, one Block | (2) If a call for assistance is made, one guard | |||
Guard from each of the neighboring blocks will | from each of the neighboring blocks will respond to the | |||
respond to the affected block. A Block Guard from a | affected block. A guard from a non-affected block will | |||
non-affected block will contact the DOC to notify them | contact the DOC to notify them of the situation. | |||
of the situation. | ||||
(3) Roving sally port guard will let responding | (3) Roving sally port guard will let responding | |||
Block Guards out of their block and into the affected | guards out of their block and into the affected block. | |||
block. Roving sally port guard will not enter the | Roving sally port guard will not enter the affected | |||
affected block with the sally port keys. | block with the sally port keys. | |||
(4) As the situation continues, Block Guards will | (4) As the situation continues, guards will advise | |||
advise when the situation is under DOC or if additional | when the situation is under DOC or if additional guards | |||
Block Guards are needed. | are needed. | |||
(5) RTO will establish emergency traffic radio | (5) RTO will establish emergency traffic radio | |||
conditions by stating “EMERGENCY TRAFFIC | conditions by stating “EMERGENCY TRAFFIC | |||
ONLY” and stating the location and type of | ONLY” and stating the location and type of | |||
emergency. Only personnel with radio traffic about the | emergency. Only personnel with radio traffic about the | |||
situation or another emergency will use the radio until | situation or another emergency will use the radio until | |||
emergency traffic is cleared. | emergency traffic is cleared. | |||
(6) PL and SOG will respond and/or assist as | (6) PL and SOG will respond and/or assist as | |||
necessary. | necessary. | |||
21-8. NAVBASE Siren System | 21-8. NAVBASE Siren System | |||
a. The NAVBASE tests the siren system at 1200 | a. The NAVBASE tests the siren system at 1200 | |||
skipping to change at line 8999 | skipping to change at line 9966 | |||
Block NCO on DA Form 5513-R maintained in the | Block NCO on DA Form 5513-R maintained in the | |||
binder located on that particular block. | binder located on that particular block. | |||
(2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | (2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | |||
completely, the NCOIC for that block will submit it to | completely, the NCOIC for that block will submit it to | |||
the PL or SOG who will submit the completed forms to | the PL or SOG who will submit the completed forms to | |||
the DOC for filing. | the DOC for filing. | |||
(3) The Block NCO will have positive control of | (3) The Block NCO will have positive control of | |||
the block keys at all times. At no time will the Block | the block keys at all times. At no time will the Block | |||
NCO go beyond the steps leading out to the shower | NCO go beyond the steps leading out to the shower | |||
and recreation while detainees are in these areas. If the | and exercise while detainees are in these areas. If the | |||
Block NCO is needed in the aforementioned areas, the | Block NCO is needed in the aforementioned areas, the | |||
most senior block personnel will take control of the | most senior block personnel will take control of the | |||
keys until the Block NCO completes his/her assigned | keys until the Block NCO completes his/her assigned | |||
task. | task. | |||
(4) The Block NCO will maintain physical | (4) The Block NCO will maintain physical | |||
control of the block(s) keys at all times. At no time | control of the block(s) keys at all times. At no time | |||
will the block door be pushed open with the key | will the block door be pushed open with the key | |||
located in it and unsecured. | located in it and unsecured. | |||
c. Senior Block Guard. | c. Senior Guard. | |||
(1) The most Senior Block Guard will take | (1) The most senior guard will take possession of | |||
possession of any block or sally port keys while the | any block or sally port keys while the Block NCO is | |||
Block NCO is not present. | not present. | |||
(2) The Senior Block Guard will maintain | (2) The senior guard will maintain physical | |||
physical custody of the shower and recreations keys. If | custody of the shower and exercises keys. If not | |||
not present, the keys will be given to a Block Guard | present, the keys will be given to a guard other than the | |||
other than the Block NCO. | Block NCO. | |||
(3) When unlocking a cell or sally port the Block | (3) When unlocking a cell or sally port the Block | |||
NCO and/or Senior Block Guard will maintain physical | NCO and/or senior guard will maintain physical | |||
control of the keys. At no time will the door be pushed | control of the keys. At no time will the door be pushed | |||
open with the key in it and unsecured. | open with the key in it and unsecured. | |||
d. Sally Port Operators. | d. Sally Port Operators. | |||
(1) During shift change the off going sally port | (1) During shift change the off going sally port | |||
operator will sign over the sally port keys to the on- | operator will sign over the sally port keys to the on- | |||
coming sally port operator on DA Form 5513-R | coming sally port operator on DA Form 5513-R | |||
maintained in a binder/clipboard located at that sally | maintained in a binder/clipboard located at that sally | |||
port. | port. | |||
(2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | (2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | |||
completely, the forms will be turned over to the PL or | completely, the forms will be turned over to the PL or | |||
SOG who will submit the completed forms to the | SOG who will submit the completed forms to the | |||
respective DOC for filing. | respective DOC for filing. | |||
(3) The sally port operator will maintain physical | (3) The sally port operator will maintain physical | |||
custody of sally port keys at all times unless relieved | custody of sally port keys at all times unless relieved | |||
by the proper authority or another Block Guard. | by the proper authority or another guard. | |||
(4) When unlocking the sally port gate, the sally | (4) When unlocking the sally port gate, the sally | |||
port operator will maintain physical control of the keys | port operator will maintain physical control of the keys | |||
and at no time will the door be pushed open with the | and at no time will the door be pushed open with the | |||
key still in it and unsecured. | key still in it and unsecured. | |||
e. Roving Sally Port Operators. | e. Roving Sally Port Operators. | |||
(1) During shift change the off going Roving | (1) During shift change the off going Roving | |||
Sally Port Operator will sign over the sally port keys to | Sally Port Operator will sign over the sally port keys to | |||
the oncoming Roving Sally Port Operator on DA Form | the oncoming Roving Sally Port Operator on DA Form | |||
5513-R maintained in a binder/clipboard in their | 5513-R maintained in a binder/clipboard in their | |||
respective camp. | respective camp. | |||
(2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | (2) When DA Form 5513-R is filled out | |||
completely, the Roving Sally Port Operator for that | completely, the Roving Sally Port Operator for that | |||
camp will submit it to the respective DOC for filing. | camp will submit it to the respective DOC for filing. | |||
(3) The Roving Sally Port Operator will maintain | (3) The Roving Sally Port Operator will maintain | |||
physical control of the sally port keys at all times | physical control of the sally port keys at all times | |||
unless relieved by the proper authority or another | unless relieved by the proper authority or another | |||
Block Guard. | guard. | |||
(4) When unlocking the roving sally port gate, | (4) When unlocking the roving sally port gate, | |||
the Roving Sally Port Operator will maintain physical | the Roving Sally Port Operator will maintain physical | |||
control of the keys and at no time will the door be | control of the keys and at no time will the door be | |||
pushed open with the key still in it and unsecured. | pushed open with the key still in it and unsecured. | |||
22-7. Emergency Procedures | 22-7. Emergency Procedures | |||
a. Upon loss of control of a detainee, (i.e., detainee | a. Upon loss of control of a detainee, (i.e., detainee | |||
is out of cell and unrestrained) the Block NCO will | is out of cell and unrestrained) the Block NCO will | |||
immediately transfer custody of all keys to the Roving | immediately transfer custody of all keys to the Roving | |||
Sally Port Operator through the block sally port. | Sally Port Operator through the block sally port. | |||
b. If a key is misplaced or lost, the following | b. If a key is misplaced or lost, the following | |||
skipping to change at line 9076 | skipping to change at line 10043 | |||
(3) The IRF team will be notified and be ready in | (3) The IRF team will be notified and be ready in | |||
the event of compromise. | the event of compromise. | |||
(4) An immediate search of the block area will | (4) An immediate search of the block area will | |||
begin; this search will include but is not limited to, any | begin; this search will include but is not limited to, any | |||
one area within Camp Delta. | one area within Camp Delta. | |||
(5) All blocks are searched or are subject to | (5) All blocks are searched or are subject to | |||
search. The search will be conducted and supervised | search. The search will be conducted and supervised | |||
by the PL and/or SOG. | by the PL and/or SOG. | |||
(6) If keys are still compromised, a 100% lock | (6) If keys are still compromised, a 100% lock | |||
down of Camp Delta will occur and all shower, | down of Camp Delta will occur and all shower, | |||
recreation, and appointments are cancelled until the | exercise, and appointments are cancelled until the keys | |||
keys are located. | are located. | |||
(7) The PL will notify the CO if, after step 23- | (7) The PL will notify the CO if, after step 23- | |||
b.4 above has been completed and the key(s) are still | 7.b.4 above has been completed and the key(s) are still | |||
missing. | missing. | |||
Chapter 23 | Chapter 23 | |||
External Security Operations | External Security Operations | |||
23-1. Conduct Of Infantry Soldiers | 23-1. Conduct of Infantry Soldiers | |||
a. Platoons will rotate in the following order: | a. Platoons will rotate in the following order: | |||
towers, QRF, patrols/TCPs/OPs, reserve (rearm/refit/ | towers, QRF, patrols/TCPs/OPs, reserve (rearm/refit/ | |||
training cycle). | training cycle). | |||
b. Soldiers will stay in the designated uniform while | b. Soldiers will stay in the designated uniform while | |||
on duty. All soldiers are required to follow the uniform | on duty. All soldiers are required to follow the uniform | |||
policy established by the CSM. | policy established by the CSM. | |||
c. The reserve forces will conduct detainee | c. The reserve forces will conduct detainee | |||
movement operations. The focus of this force is | movement operations. The focus of this force is | |||
training and rearm/refit. Detainee movement | training and rearm/refit. Detainee movement | |||
operations are an O/O mission. The reserve forces will | operations are an O/O mission. The reserve forces will | |||
skipping to change at line 9144 | skipping to change at line 10111 | |||
for securing the Camp Delta Area of Operations (AO) | for securing the Camp Delta Area of Operations (AO) | |||
at the appropriate FPCON level. | at the appropriate FPCON level. | |||
c. FPCON BRAVO. | c. FPCON BRAVO. | |||
(1) The platoon with the tower security mission | (1) The platoon with the tower security mission | |||
will man six towers, with one soldier per tower. | will man six towers, with one soldier per tower. | |||
(2) The platoon with the dismounted/mounted | (2) The platoon with the dismounted/mounted | |||
patrols, LP/OPs, TCPs, and the blocking position will | patrols, LP/OPs, TCPs, and the blocking position will | |||
establish a mobile reaction force. | establish a mobile reaction force. | |||
(3) The platoon with the QRF mission will | (3) The platoon with the QRF mission will | |||
remain at a high alert status capable of responding to a | remain at a high alert status capable of responding to a | |||
disturbance within five minutes. The QRF will be | disturbance within 10 minutes. The QRF will be | |||
positioned inside Camp Delta. This QRF Element will | positioned adjacent to Camp Echo. This QRF Element | |||
have riot gear staged with non-lethal munitions. Its | will have riot gear staged with non-lethal munitions. Its | |||
primary function is to assist the MP IRF Teams inside | primary function is to assist the IRF Teams inside | |||
Camp Delta. During detainee arrival missions, this | Camp Delta. During detainee arrival missions, this | |||
element will be on standby if needed to provide | element will be on standby if needed to provide | |||
additional support to the QRF assigned to the detainee | additional support to the QRF assigned to the detainee | |||
movement operation. | movement operation. | |||
(4) The company in reserve will perform the | (4) The company in reserve will perform the | |||
detainee movement operations and provide security | detainee movement operations and provide security | |||
details on main post. The soldiers of this company will | details on main post. The soldiers of this company will | |||
conduct individual and collective tasks training IAW | conduct individual and collective tasks training IAW | |||
the METL and mission specific tasks. This company | the METL and mission specific tasks. This company | |||
will also provide details around the Radio Range area | will also provide details around the Radio Range area | |||
skipping to change at line 9299 | skipping to change at line 10266 | |||
Forces and detainees. Examples include: routine | Forces and detainees. Examples include: routine | |||
conversations with same detainee, prolonged | conversations with same detainee, prolonged | |||
conversations outside interrogation areas, etc. | conversations outside interrogation areas, etc. | |||
f. Any unusual behavior of civilian contract | f. Any unusual behavior of civilian contract | |||
workers. Examples include: attempting to map the | workers. Examples include: attempting to map the | |||
area, attempting to communicate with detainees, | area, attempting to communicate with detainees, | |||
attempting to hide contraband, etc. | attempting to hide contraband, etc. | |||
23-6. External Positions | 23-6. External Positions | |||
a. The mission consists of one rifle platoon. | a. The mission consists of one rifle platoon. | |||
b. There is one LP/OP (Richmond), two TCPs | b. There is one LP/OP (Richmond), two TCPs | |||
(Lexington and Harrisonburg), and one blocking | (Worcester and Gardner), and one blocking position | |||
position (Staunton). | (blocker). | |||
c. The patrol platoon mans OP Richmond during all | c. The patrol platoon mans OP Richmond during all | |||
FPCON levels (This OP is further discussed under the | FPCON levels (This OP is further discussed under the | |||
mounted security section). The platoon with this | mounted security section). The platoon with this | |||
mission will man one HMMWV w/ 50 Cal MG during | mission will man one HMMWV w/ 50 Cal MG during | |||
FPCON C. During all FPCON levels, this Platoon | FPCON C. During all FPCON levels, this Platoon | |||
mans the two TCPs, the Blocking Position, conducts | mans the two TCPs, the Blocking Position, conducts | |||
Dismounted/Mounted Patrols, and conducts any | Dismounted/Mounted Patrols, and conducts any | |||
published/scheduled RAM. | published/scheduled RAM. | |||
d. Traffic Control Point “TCP” (Lexington): Three | d. Traffic Control Point “TCP” (Lexington): Three | |||
skipping to change at line 9365 | skipping to change at line 10332 | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
h. Dismounted Patrols: These patrols will move | h. Dismounted Patrols: These patrols will move | |||
IAW the patrol order published by the BN TOC. The | IAW the patrol order published by the BN TOC. The | |||
TOC will identify Sectors and named areas of interest | TOC will identify Sectors and named areas of interest | |||
(NAI), which will be the focus of the Patrols. The | (NAI), which will be the focus of the Patrols. The | |||
FRAGO will be published 48 hours in advance. COs | FRAGO will be published 48 hours in advance. COs | |||
will back-brief the Battalion Commander the day of the | will back-brief the Battalion Commander the day of the | |||
mission cycle changes. | mission cycle changes. | |||
(1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, kneepads, | (1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, kneepads, | |||
ICOM radio, protective mask (carried), assigned | ICOM radio, protective mask (carried), assigned | |||
weapon, Camelback, ID card and dog tags, | weapon, Camelback, ID card and dog tags, JTF-GTMO | |||
JTF_GTMO ID Card, and ROE / RUF card (dated 30 | ID Card, and ROE / RUF card (dated 30 Nov 02) in left | |||
Nov 02) in left breast pocket. At FPCON C and D, the | breast pocket. At FPCON C and D, the uniform will | |||
uniform will include Kevlar helmet and body armor. | include Kevlar helmet and body armor. The Squad | |||
The Squad Leader will carry a SABER radio. | Leader will carry a SABER radio. | |||
(2) Information to report: The squad will report | (2) Information to report: The squad will report | |||
any unusual activity, which may include unauthorized | any unusual activity, which may include unauthorized | |||
personnel and vehicles in the obscure areas of the | personnel and vehicles in the obscure areas of the | |||
routes, any unusual activity in the Contactors Labor | routes, any unusual activity in the Contactors Labor | |||
Camp, personnel taking photographs within the AOR, | Camp, personnel taking photographs within the AOR, | |||
unexploded ordinance, and unidentified boats and | unexploded ordinance, and unidentified boats and | |||
aircraft. EOD personnel will handle unexploded | aircraft. EOD personnel will handle unexploded | |||
ordnance. Patrols will mark, provide a grid, and notify | ordnance. Patrols will mark, provide a grid, and notify | |||
the BN TOC. | the BN TOC. | |||
i. Additional instructions: The following additional | i. Additional instructions: The following additional | |||
skipping to change at line 9513 | skipping to change at line 10480 | |||
HMMWVs with .50-caliber MGs and LRAS. The | HMMWVs with .50-caliber MGs and LRAS. The | |||
primary means of communication is FM and the | primary means of communication is FM and the | |||
alternate is SABER. The patrols call signs are their | alternate is SABER. The patrols call signs are their | |||
designated Platoon call signs. The patrols will move | designated Platoon call signs. The patrols will move | |||
along the designated routes and report the status of | along the designated routes and report the status of | |||
each check point to the CP. When the patrols are | each check point to the CP. When the patrols are | |||
complete, the crews will report all clear to the CP. The | complete, the crews will report all clear to the CP. The | |||
crews will patrol the AO once every three hours IAW | crews will patrol the AO once every three hours IAW | |||
with the schedules below. | with the schedules below. | |||
(1) Patrol schedule 1: Per the published patrol | (1) Patrol schedule 1: Per the published patrol | |||
order. The BN TOC will provide a FRAGO 48 hours in | order. The BN TOC will provide a FRAGO 48 hours | |||
advance of mission assumption. The COs will back- | in advance of mission assumption. The COs will back- | |||
brief the Battalion Commander the day of the mission | brief the Battalion Commander the day of the mission | |||
cycle change. | cycle change. | |||
b. Weapons Control Status: | b. Weapons Control Status: | |||
(1) .50 caliber machine guns: Each .50 Cal MG | (1) .50 caliber machine guns: Each .50 Cal MG | |||
will have 100 rounds. The gunner will NOT insert the | will have 100 rounds. The gunner will NOT insert the | |||
ammunition belt. The ammunition belt will remain in | ammunition belt. The ammunition belt will remain in | |||
the container at all times unless instructed otherwise. | the container at all times unless instructed otherwise. | |||
(2) M16A2: Each M16A2 will have two 30- | (2) M16A2: Each M16A2 will have two 30- | |||
round magazines. The soldier will insert the magazine | round magazines. The soldier will insert the magazine | |||
into the weapon, and ensure NO round is chambered. | into the weapon, and ensure NO round is chambered. | |||
c. Soldiers will wear the following uniform: BDU, | c. Soldiers will wear the following uniform: BDU, | |||
Kevlar helmet, LBV, protective mask (carried), | Kevlar helmet, LBV, protective mask (carried), | |||
assigned weapon, NVDs, Camelback, ID card and dog | assigned weapon, NVDs, Camelback, ID card and dog | |||
tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF Card (dated | tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF Card (dated | |||
30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. Soldiers will | 30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. Soldiers will | |||
have their body armor in the HMMWV with them, | have their body armor in the HMMWV with them, | |||
except for the gunner who will wear his as a Force | except for the gunner who will wear his as a Force | |||
Protection Measure. During black flag conditions, the | Protection Measure. At no time will any patrolling | |||
gunner may remove his blouse. At FPCON C and D, | soldier be out of the prescribed uniform. At FPCON C | |||
all soldiers will wear body armor. | and D, all soldiers will wear body armor. | |||
23-9. Listening Posts (LP)/Observation Posts (OP) | 23-9. Listening Posts (LP)/Observation Posts (OP) | |||
a. Each LP/OP will consist of two personnel. The | a. Each LP/OP will consist of two personnel. The | |||
primary means of communication is FM per the BN | primary means of communication is FM per the BN | |||
SOI. The alternate means of communication is | SOI. The alternate means of communication is | |||
SABER radio. The LP/OP will report and record any | SABER radio. The LP/OP will report and record any | |||
suspicious activity or unauthorized personnel, | suspicious activity or unauthorized personnel, | |||
boats/ships, or vehicles in the JOA. | boats/ships, or vehicles in the JOA. | |||
b. Weapons Control Status: | b. Weapons Control Status: | |||
(1) .50 caliber machine gun: Each LP/OP will | (1) .50 caliber machine gun: Each LP/OP will | |||
have 400 rounds. The gunner will NOT insert the | have 400 rounds. The gunner will NOT insert the | |||
skipping to change at line 9601 | skipping to change at line 10568 | |||
notify the XO or First Sergeant (1SG). Notify the TOC | notify the XO or First Sergeant (1SG). Notify the TOC | |||
immediately. An investigation will follow. | immediately. An investigation will follow. | |||
(6) Taped over magazines or coloring the last | (6) Taped over magazines or coloring the last | |||
round in a magazine is not a sufficient means for | round in a magazine is not a sufficient means for | |||
conducting an accurate round count. This method may | conducting an accurate round count. This method may | |||
be used for periodic leader checks, but a by-round | be used for periodic leader checks, but a by-round | |||
count must be completed after each mission cycle. | count must be completed after each mission cycle. | |||
(7) When entering the cantonment area clear | (7) When entering the cantonment area clear | |||
weapons at the ammunition transfer point (ATP), rod | weapons at the ammunition transfer point (ATP), rod | |||
the weapon, and put weapon on safe. | the weapon, and put weapon on safe. | |||
23-11. Lexington TCP | 23-11. Worcester TCP | |||
a. Three soldiers (one NCO) will man TCP | a. Three soldiers (one NCO) will man TCP | |||
Lexington at all times. This TCP will validate that all | Lexington at all times. This TCP will validate that all | |||
personnel who attempt to enter the Camp Delta AO are | personnel who attempt to enter the Camp Delta AO are | |||
authorized to enter. The soldiers are responsible for | authorized to enter. The soldiers are responsible for | |||
thoroughly inspecting badges, to include the front and | thoroughly inspecting badges, to include the front and | |||
back of the badge. If an individual attempts to show a | back of the badge. If an individual attempts to show a | |||
badge thru the window the soldier should ask the | badge thru the window the soldier should ask the | |||
individual to roll the window down and visually and | individual to roll the window down and visually and | |||
physically inspect the badge for authorization. The | physically inspect the badge for authorization. The | |||
TCP will use the JTF-GTMO policy letter on badges to | TCP will use the JTF-GTMO policy letter on badges to | |||
determine who has access. Soldiers shall carry | determine who has access. Soldiers shall carry | |||
flashlights at night to inspect the interior of vehicles. | flashlights at night to inspect the interior of vehicles. | |||
b. All soldiers operating the TCP and controlling | b. All soldiers operating the TCP and controlling | |||
the flow of traffic must wear a road guard vest and will | the flow of traffic must wear a road guard vest and will | |||
carry their assigned weapon. The only exception is for | carry their assigned weapon. The only exception is for | |||
the soldier in the soldier guard house monitoring the | the soldier in the soldier guard house monitoring the | |||
radio. The weapon will be at the ready at all times and | radio. The weapon will be at the ready at all times and | |||
within arms length. | within arms length. | |||
c. The interior/exterior area of the soldier guard | c. The interior/exterior area of the soldier | |||
house will be kept clean and organized at all times. | guardhouse will be kept clean and organized at all | |||
Trash will be discarded properly at each shift change. | times. Trash will be discarded properly at each shift | |||
change. | ||||
d. All soldiers checking badges to enter the area will | d. All soldiers checking badges to enter the area will | |||
also visually look inside all vehicles, to include the bed | also visually look inside all vehicles, to include the bed | |||
of trucks, opening the back and/ or side doors of vans. | of trucks, opening the back and/ or side doors of vans. | |||
e. Marine Corps Vehicles: Do not have to produce | e. Marine Corps Vehicles: Do not have to produce | |||
a JTF-GTMO badge to pass thru the TCP. The | a JTF-GTMO badge to pass thru the TCP. The | |||
Marines are only authorized to pass through the | Marines are only authorized to pass through the | |||
checkpoint with prior coordination. Coordination will | checkpoint with prior coordination. Coordination will | |||
be a call to the TOC, over the react net, stating the | be a call to the TOC, over the react net, stating the | |||
approximate time the vehicle will arrive at the TCP, the | approximate time the vehicle will arrive at the TCP, the | |||
first phonetic alphabet letter of the day of the week and | first phonetic alphabet letter of the day of the week and | |||
the numeric date of the arrival. Example: 15 minutes, | ||||
the numeric date of the arrival. Example: 15 minutes, | ||||
Foxtrot 10 equates to 15 minutes on Friday the 10th | Foxtrot 10 equates to 15 minutes on Friday the 10th | |||
. | ||||
Their vehicle will also be identified with a red placard | Their vehicle will also be identified with a red placard | |||
on the front bumper with the acronym MCSFC in white | on the front bumper with the acronym MCSFC in white | |||
lettering. If a vehicle reaches the TCP without prior | lettering. If a vehicle reaches the TCP without prior | |||
coordination, they will be detained at the TCP until | coordination, they will be detained at the TCP until | |||
they communicate the above requirement over the net | they communicate the above requirement over the net | |||
to the TOC. | to the TOC. | |||
f. All JTF-GTMO soldiers with lost badges may | f. All JTF-GTMO soldiers with lost badges may | |||
enter through the TCP with an E-8 or above to vouch | enter through the TCP with an E-8 or above to vouch | |||
for their identity. | for their identity. | |||
g. Contractors are allowed to bring alcohol through | g. Contractors are allowed to bring alcohol through | |||
skipping to change at line 9777 | skipping to change at line 10745 | |||
(1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, ICOM radio | (1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, ICOM radio | |||
(if applicable), protective mask, assigned weapon, road | (if applicable), protective mask, assigned weapon, road | |||
guard vest, Camelback, ID card and dog tags, JTF | guard vest, Camelback, ID card and dog tags, JTF | |||
GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card (dated 30 Nov 02) | GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card (dated 30 Nov 02) | |||
in their left breast pocket. At FPCON C and D, the | in their left breast pocket. At FPCON C and D, the | |||
uniform will include Kevlar helmet and body armor. | uniform will include Kevlar helmet and body armor. | |||
(2) Common equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | (2) Common equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | |||
logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. The TCP will | logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. The TCP will | |||
also have mirrors to inspect the undercarriage of | also have mirrors to inspect the undercarriage of | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
23-12. Harrisonburg TCP | 23-12. Gardner TCP | |||
a. Two soldiers will man this TCP twenty-four | a. Two soldiers will man this TCP twenty-four | |||
hours a day. This TCP will not allow anyone to pass | hours a day. This TCP will not allow anyone to pass | |||
who does not have the JTF-GTMO badge. All others, | who does not have the JTF-GTMO badge. All others, | |||
to include contractors, must come through TCP | to include contractors, must come through TCP | |||
Lexington. Windmill Beach is closed from 1900 to | Lexington. Windmill Beach is closed from 1900 to | |||
The TCP closes to traffic at 1930. Beginning at | 0500. The TCP closes to traffic at 1930. Beginning at | |||
2100 and ending at 0500, it’s acceptable to have | 2100 and ending at 0500, it’s acceptable to have | |||
entrance traffic only for Physical Training (PT) and | entrance traffic only for Physical Training (PT) and | |||
will be allowed to pass through the TCP. This TCP | will be allowed to pass through the TCP. This TCP | |||
will validate that all personnel who attempt to enter the | will validate that all personnel who attempt to enter the | |||
Camp Delta AO are authorized to enter. The soldiers | Camp Delta AO are authorized to enter. The soldiers | |||
are responsible for thoroughly inspecting badges, to | are responsible for thoroughly inspecting badges, to | |||
include the front and back of the badge and ensuring | include the front and back of the badge and ensuring | |||
the picture on the badge matches the soldier. If ever in | the picture on the badge matches the soldier. If ever in | |||
doubt, ask for a second form of ID or call the TOC. If | doubt, ask for a second form of ID or call the TOC. If | |||
an individual attempts to show a badge thru the | an individual attempts to show a badge thru the | |||
skipping to change at line 9892 | skipping to change at line 10860 | |||
assigned weapon, road guard vest, Camelback, ID card | assigned weapon, road guard vest, Camelback, ID card | |||
and dog tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card | and dog tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card | |||
(dated 30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. When the | (dated 30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. When the | |||
FPCON level changes to C and D, the uniform will | FPCON level changes to C and D, the uniform will | |||
include Kevlar helmet and body armor. Each soldier | include Kevlar helmet and body armor. Each soldier | |||
will have a flashlight. | will have a flashlight. | |||
(2) Common Equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | (2) Common Equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | |||
logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. The TCP will | logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. The TCP will | |||
also have mirrors to inspect the undercarriage of | also have mirrors to inspect the undercarriage of | |||
vehicles. | vehicles. | |||
23-13. Staunton Blocking Position (BP) | 23-13. Blocker Position (BP) | |||
a. Two soldiers man this position. The position will | a. Two soldiers man this position. The position will | |||
allow no one, regardless of unit, to pass through this | allow no one, regardless of unit, to pass through this | |||
point in a vehicle. There shall be no traffic allowed | point in a vehicle. There shall be no traffic allowed | |||
thru this TCP, dismounted or otherwise from 0500 to | thru this TCP, dismounted or otherwise from 0500 to | |||
The only exception (per J2) is that military unit | 2100. The only exception (per J2) is that military unit | |||
members perform Physical Training (PT) thru the TCP | members perform Physical Training (PT) thru the TCP | |||
beginning at 2100. The blocking position is an exit | beginning at 2100. The blocking position is an exit | |||
only for PT participants; that means they cannot re- | only for PT participants; that means they cannot re- | |||
enter thru the BP. Advise PT participants that they | enter thru the BP. Advise PT participants that they | |||
must pass thru the Windmill Beach Road or Kittery | must pass thru the Windmill Beach Road or Kittery | |||
Beach Road TCPs to re-enter the area. The BP is | Beach Road TCPs to re-enter the area. The BP is | |||
blocked with an obstacle consisting of rolls of | blocked with an obstacle consisting of rolls of | |||
concertina wire with pickets and barbed wire. | concertina wire with pickets and barbed wire. | |||
b. Uniform and Common Equipment: Soldiers at | b. Uniform and Common Equipment: Soldiers at | |||
this position will wear the following uniform and have | this position will wear the following uniform and have | |||
skipping to change at line 9919 | skipping to change at line 10887 | |||
(1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, ICOM | (1) Uniform: BDU, patrol cap, LBV, ICOM | |||
radio (if applicable), protective mask (carried), | radio (if applicable), protective mask (carried), | |||
assigned weapon, road guard vest, Camelback, ID card | assigned weapon, road guard vest, Camelback, ID card | |||
and dog tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card | and dog tags, JTF-GTMO ID card, and ROE/RUF card | |||
(dated 30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. When the | (dated 30 Nov 02) in their left breast pocket. When the | |||
FPCON level changes to C and D, the uniform will | FPCON level changes to C and D, the uniform will | |||
include Kevlar helmet and body armor. Each soldier | include Kevlar helmet and body armor. Each soldier | |||
will have a flashlight. | will have a flashlight. | |||
(2) Common Equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | (2) Common Equipment: One PRC-119 radio, a | |||
logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. | logbook, and a 5-gallon water cooler. | |||
c. The BP will survey Camp Bulkeley and report | c. The BP will survey Camp Bukeley and report any | |||
any suspicious activity observed in the empty billeting | suspicious activity observed in the empty billeting near | |||
near Camp Bulkeley and the hardball road, which leads | Camp Bulkeley and the hardball road, which leads to | |||
to Windmill Beach. | Windmill Beach. | |||
d. Soldiers must maintain communication with the | d. Soldiers must maintain communication with the | |||
company CP. If ever in doubt about any issue or | company CP. If ever in doubt about any issue or | |||
occurrence immediately contact the company CP. | occurrence immediately contact the company CP. | |||
e. Soldiers are responsible for signing the hand | e. Soldiers are responsible for signing the hand | |||
receipt for the equipment located at the BP and | receipt for the equipment located at the BP and | |||
maintaining 100% accountability at all times. No | maintaining 100% accountability at all times. No | |||
exceptions. It is also the responsibility of the soldiers | exceptions. It is also the responsibility of the soldiers | |||
to ensure the equipment is signed for by the next shift | to ensure the equipment is signed for by the next shift | |||
reporting to the BP. | reporting to the BP. | |||
f. When crew-served weapons are employed at the | f. When crew-served weapons are employed at the | |||
skipping to change at line 9944 | skipping to change at line 10912 | |||
rehearse actions for the employment of the crew- | rehearse actions for the employment of the crew- | |||
served weapon systems. All personnel will know their | served weapon systems. All personnel will know their | |||
weapon systems sector of fire. | weapon systems sector of fire. | |||
Chapter 24 | Chapter 24 | |||
Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) Operations | Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) Operations | |||
Section I – Preparation | Section I – Preparation | |||
24-1. Team Organization | 24-1. Team Organization | |||
a. There will be primary and alternate IRF team | a. There will be primary and alternate IRF team | |||
designated for each camp. | designated for each camp. | |||
b. IRF teams consist of five MPs. The following | b. IRF teams consist of five guards. The following | |||
are the team positions and their responsibilities: | are the team positions and their responsibilities: | |||
(1) Number One Man. The Number One Man is | (1) Number One Man. The Number One Man is | |||
also the shield man. His responsibility is to give the | also the shield man. His responsibility is to give the | |||
conditions of the cell along with the location and | conditions of the cell along with the location and | |||
activity of the detainee is the team. Upon entry, the | activity of the detainee is the team. Upon entry, the | |||
number one man is responsible to pin the detainee with | number one man is responsible to pin the detainee with | |||
the shield with the minimal amount of force necessary. | the shield with the minimal amount of force necessary. | |||
The number one man is also responsible for securing | The number one man is also responsible for securing | |||
the head. | the head. | |||
(2) Number Two Man. The Number Two Man is | (2) Number Two Man. The Number Two Man is | |||
skipping to change at line 10172 | skipping to change at line 11140 | |||
fails to comply, the PL or SOG may administer another | fails to comply, the PL or SOG may administer another | |||
burst of OC into the face of the detainee. The detainee | burst of OC into the face of the detainee. The detainee | |||
will be asked to comply again after a short period of | will be asked to comply again after a short period of | |||
time (15 to 30 seconds) that will allow the OC to work. | time (15 to 30 seconds) that will allow the OC to work. | |||
If he fails to comply, the Block NCO will open the cell | If he fails to comply, the Block NCO will open the cell | |||
door to allow the IRF Team entry into the cell. Upon | door to allow the IRF Team entry into the cell. Upon | |||
entry into the cell the IRF Team will use the minimum | entry into the cell the IRF Team will use the minimum | |||
amount of force necessary to subdue the detainee and | amount of force necessary to subdue the detainee and | |||
order the detainee to stop resisting. | order the detainee to stop resisting. | |||
h. Once the detainee is shackled, he will be brought | h. Once the detainee is shackled, he will be brought | |||
to the recreation area of the affected block or taken to | to the exercise area of the affected block or taken to the | |||
the decontamination location and decontaminated. The | decontamination location and decontaminated. The | |||
medical personnel on site will conduct a medical | medical personnel on site will conduct a medical | |||
evaluation of the detainee to check for any injuries | evaluation of the detainee to check for any injuries | |||
sustained during the IRF. Once decontamination is | sustained during the IRF. Once decontamination is | |||
complete and medical personnel clear the detainee, he | complete and medical personnel clear the detainee, he | |||
will be moved to his new block or placed into his | will be moved to his new block or placed into his | |||
previous cell. Prior to movement back into the | previous cell. Prior to movement back into the | |||
previous cell, the MPs on that block will decontaminate | previous cell, the guards on that block will | |||
that cell of any residual effects of the OC spray by | decontaminate that cell of any residual effects of the | |||
using the hose. | OC spray by using the hose. | |||
Section III – Documentation | Section III – Documentation | |||
24-8. Verbal Reporting | 24-8. Verbal Reporting | |||
a. Within fifteen minutes of the use of OC, the JOC | a. Within fifteen minutes of the use of OC, the JOC | |||
will be notified by secured telephone by DOC | will be notified by secured telephone by DOC | |||
personnel that an event is occurring. | personnel that an event is occurring. | |||
b. The CO will call the JOC after the detainee has | b. The CO will call the JOC after the detainee has | |||
been secured and provide all details available. | been secured and provide all details available. | |||
c. The CO will notify the CJDOG of the incident. | c. The CO will notify the CJDOG of the incident if | |||
the IRF results in an injury to either the detainee or a | ||||
soldier involved in the IRF. | ||||
24-9. Written Reporting | 24-9. Written Reporting | |||
a. The CO will initiate a SPOTREP to be sent up | a. The CO will initiate a SPOTREP to be sent up | |||
via SIPRNET computer to the JOC Watch Officer | via SIPRNET computer to the JOC Watch Officer | |||
within a half an hour of the completion of the IRF use. | within a half an hour of the completion of the IRF use. | |||
b. The CO will complete an unclassified Serious | b. The CO will complete an unclassified Serious | |||
Incident Report (SIR) IAW AR 190-40 and submit it to | Incident Report (SIR) IAW AR 190-40 and submit it to | |||
the JDOG S-3. The SIR will list all personnel and | the JDOG S-3. The SIR will list all personnel and | |||
detainees involved and will be forwarded within two | detainees involved and will be forwarded within two | |||
hours of the completion of the IRF use. | hours of the completion of the IRF use. | |||
c. The PL and/or SOG will complete a DD Form | c. The PL and/or SOG will complete a DD Form | |||
2823 Sworn Statement concerning the use of OC. The | 2823 Sworn Statement concerning the use of OC. The | |||
PL will also complete a DD 508 to document the | PL will also complete a DD 508 to document the | |||
discipline measures taken. | discipline measures taken. | |||
d. All MPs involved in the original incident that | d. All guards involved in the original incident that | |||
precipitated the use of the IRF will submit a completed | precipitated the use of the IRF will submit a completed | |||
DD Form 2823 on the incident. The PL will review | DD Form 2823 on the incident. The PL will review | |||
these sworn statements for completeness. | these sworn statements for completeness. | |||
e. All IRF Team members are required to submit | e. All IRF Team members are required to submit | |||
sworn statements. | sworn statements. | |||
f. All paperwork related to the IRF must be | f. All paperwork related to the IRF must be | |||
completed and turned in prior to end of shift. | completed and turned in prior to end of shift. | |||
g. The SIR, video, checklists, and copies of all | g. The SIR, video, checklists, and copies of all | |||
statements will be forwarded to the JDOG S-3 to be | statements will be forwarded to the JDOG S-3 to be | |||
kept as evidence. | kept as evidence. | |||
Chapter 25 | Chapter 25 | |||
Quick Response Force (QRF) Operations | Quick Response Force (QRF) Operations | |||
25-1. Mission | 25-1. Mission | |||
a. Company secures Camp Delta with a QRF | a. O/O secures Camp Delta to facilitate Detainment | |||
element in order to facilitate Detainment Facility | Facility Operations. This element has the following | |||
Operations. This element has the following planning | planning priorities: | |||
priorities: | ||||
(1) Provides a Show-of-force within the detention | (1) Provides a Show-of-force within the detention | |||
facility to deter all errant behavior from unruly | facility to deter all errant behavior from unruly | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
(2) Follow and assume military police IRF duties | (2) Follow and assume IRF duties to control | |||
to control unruly detainees. | unruly detainees. | |||
(3) React to unauthorized intrusion into the | (3) React to unauthorized intrusion into the | |||
compound to protect U.S. forces and detainees. | compound to protect U.S. forces and detainees. | |||
25-2. Requirements | 25-2. Requirements | |||
a. The QRF must be able to react to a disturbance in | a. The QRF must be able to react to a disturbance in | |||
the Detention Facility within five minutes. | the Detention Facility within 10 minutes. | |||
b. The section will maintain a Command Post (CP) | b. The QRF will maintain a Command Post (CP) | |||
within the QRF building and must man this CP 24 | adjacent to Camp Echo and must man this CP 24 hours | |||
hours per day. | per day, 7 days per week. | |||
c. This QRF will maintain radio communication | c. This QRF will maintain radio communication | |||
with the Infantry SOG (ISOG) and the Company CP. | with the DOC via Long Range SABER and/or | |||
d. Either the PL or the Platoon Sergeant will be | SINCGARS. | |||
prepared to lead the QRF at all times. | d. The PL or Platoon Sergeant will be prepared to | |||
e. The DOC will contact the QRF CP via landline | lead the QRF at all times. | |||
or runner when the QRF is required. | e. The DOC will contact the QRF CP via Long | |||
Range SABER (primary) and/or SINCGARS when the | ||||
QRF is required. | ||||
25-3. Notification Procedures | 25-3. Notification Procedures | |||
a. If deemed necessary, the Detention Facility DOC | a. The DOC will notify the QRF CP to respond to a | |||
will notify the QRF CP to react to a threat within the | threat within the camp. | |||
compound. | b. The PL or the Platoon Sergeant, will immediately | |||
b. The soldier who receives this message will | report to the Company CP that the QRF has been | |||
immediately notify the PL or Platoon Sergeant and | alerted. | |||
then alert the QRF element. | c. Upon being notified by the DOC to respond, the | |||
c. The PL or the Platoon Sergeant, whomever is not | QRF will don the riot control gear and secure assigned | |||
leading the reaction squad, will immediately report to | ||||
the Company CP that the QRF has been alerted. | ||||
d. Once notified to react, the QRF reaction squad | ||||
will don the riot control gear and secure assigned | ||||
weapons for non-lethal delivery. | weapons for non-lethal delivery. | |||
e. Once prepared, the QRF squad will stand in | d. The DOC will notify the on-duty CO, and sally | |||
formation and prepare to enter the Detention Facility. | port 1 that the QRF is inbound. The DOC will direct | |||
f. The MP IRF representative will provide the QRF | SOG 3 to meet the QRF and guide them to a designated | |||
element a SITREP of the disturbance before entering | parking location. | |||
the compound. | e. O/O, the QRF will deploy to the effected area. | |||
f. The On-duty CO will provide the QRF element a | ||||
SITREP of the disturbance before entering the effected | ||||
area. | ||||
g. Once the disturbance is quelled, the QRF will | g. Once the disturbance is quelled, the QRF will | |||
relinquish command back to the MP IRF Team and re- | relinquish command back to the IRF Team and re- | |||
deploy to the QRF building to conduct a back brief. | deploy to the QRF CP to conduct a back brief. | |||
25-4. Ammunition Numbers and Accountability | 25-4. Ammunition Numbers and Accountability | |||
a. The Platoon Sergeant of the QRF will visually | a. The Platoon Sergeant of the QRF will visually | |||
inspect and count for the following ammunition prior | inspect and count for the following ammunition prior | |||
to his element assuming duty as the QRF. | to his element assuming duty as the QRF. | |||
b. The Platoon Sergeant will also conduct a physical | b. The Platoon Sergeant will also conduct a physical | |||
count of all ammunition daily while assigned to the | count of all ammunition daily while assigned to the | |||
QRF. | QRF. | |||
c. The QRF will have the following ammunition on | c. The QRF will have the following ammunition on | |||
hand at all times: | hand at all times: | |||
(1) 48 12-gauge area non-lethal rounds. | (1) 48 12-gauge area non-lethal rounds. | |||
(2) 48 40-millimeter point non-lethal rounds. | (2) 48 40-millimeter point non-lethal rounds. | |||
(3) 48 40-millimeter area non-lethal rounds. | (3) 48 40-millimeter area non-lethal rounds. | |||
(4) 48 M84 stun grenades. | (4) 48 M84 stun grenades. | |||
25-5. Uniform | 25-5. Uniform: lethal/Non lethel | |||
a. BDU, Kevlar, Body Armor, Protective Mask | a. Lethal: BDUs, Kevlar, Body Armor, Protective | |||
(carried), Assigned Weapon (if designated), | Mask (carried), Assigned Weapon (if designated), | |||
Camelback, ID Card and Dog Tags, JTF GTMO ID | Camelback, ID Card and Dog Tags, Camp Delta | |||
Card, and the ROE card in left breast pocket (dated 30 | Badge, and the ROE card in left breast pocket (dated | |||
Nov 02). | 30 Nov 02). | |||
b. In addition, QRF soldiers will don riot control | b. Non lethal: BDUs, riot control gear consisting of | |||
gear consisting of: face shields attached to the Kevlar, | face shields attached to the Kevlar, non-ballistic shin | |||
non-ballistic shin guards, a shield, and a baton. | guards, body shield, baton, Camelback, ID Card and | |||
Dog Tags, Camp Delta Badge, and the ROE card in left | ||||
breast pocket (dated 30 Nov 02). | ||||
Chapter 26 | Chapter 26 | |||
Military Working Dogs (MWD) | Military Working Dogs (MWD) | |||
26-1. Responsibilities | 26-1. Responsibilities | |||
a. The CJDOG is responsible for ensuring MWD | a. The CJDOG is responsible for ensuring MWD | |||
are used to enhance physical security and as a | are used to enhance physical security and as a | |||
psychological deterrence. | psychological deterrence. | |||
b. The MWD Section Kennel master is responsible | b. The MWD Section Kennel master is responsible | |||
for the following: | for the following: | |||
(1) Recommendations for the deployment and | (1) Recommendations for the deployment and | |||
proper use of MWD teams | proper use of MWD teams | |||
(2) Assisting in planning and deployment of | (2) Assisting in planning and deployment of | |||
MWD teams and planning/conducting proficiency | MWD teams and planning/conducting proficiency | |||
training | training | |||
(3) Personnel needs and maintenance of MWD | (3) Personnel needs and maintenance of MWD | |||
Section | Section | |||
(4) Ensuring MWD teams are properly cared for | (4) Ensuring MWD teams are properly cared for. | |||
26-2. Operations | 26-2. Operations | |||
a. The JDOG currently has three MWD teams. | a. The JDOG currently has three MWD teams. | |||
Each team is composed of a dog handler and one dog. | Each team is composed of a dog handler and one dog. | |||
The three MWD teams consist of an explosive | The three MWD teams consist of patrol dogs only | |||
detection/patrol dog, narcotics detection/patrol dog, | The teams (one per shift) will be employed as follows: | |||
and a single purpose patrol dog. The joint manning | ||||
document (JMD) for future rotations authorizes five | ||||
MWD teams. The teams (one per shift) will be | ||||
employed as follows: | ||||
(1) Psychological deterrence. MWD will walk | (1) Psychological deterrence. MWD will walk | |||
“Main Street” in Camp Delta during shift to | “Main Street” in Camp Delta during shift to | |||
demonstrate physical presence to detainees. MWD | demonstrate physical presence to detainees. MWD on | |||
will not be walked through the blocks unless directed | mid-shift will conduct random exterior checks of | |||
by the JDOG. | blocks. MWD will not walk through blocks unless | |||
directed by the JDOG. | ||||
(2) Dismounted patrols. MWD will augment | (2) Dismounted patrols. MWD will augment | |||
Infantry dismounted patrols during hours of limited | Infantry dismounted patrols during hours of limited | |||
visibility and at higher THREATCONs. Additionally, | visibility and during THREATCONs. Additionally, | |||
patrols will include the following areas: | patrols will include the following areas: | |||
(a) Detention Hospital | (a) Detention Hospital | |||
(b) Camp Delta Fence Perimeter | (b) Camp Delta Fence Perimeter | |||
(c) Contractor Work Sites | (c) Contractor Work Sites | |||
(d) Camp Bulkeley | (d) Camp Bulkeley | |||
(e) Camp America | (e) Camp America | |||
(3) Explosives detection. MWD will be used at | (3) Explosives detection. MWD from | |||
Sally Port 1 and Kittery Beach Checkpoint in | NAVBASE Security will be utilized in the event of a | |||
conjunction with random antiterrorist measures to aid | bomb threat. | |||
in explosives detection. | (4) Detainee Movement Operations. MWD team | |||
(4) Detainee Transfer Missions. MWD team will | will accompany (DMO) IAW JDOG Reception | |||
accompany detainee transfer missions from Leeward | OPORD. | |||
Airfield IAW JTF-160 FRAGO. | ||||
b. Shift Requirements. MWD teams are an asset | b. Shift Requirements. MWD teams are an asset | |||
available 24 hours /7 days per week. The MWD teams | available 24 hours /7 days per week. The MWD teams | |||
are OPCON to the JDOG while in Camp Delta. When | are OPCON to the JDOG while in Camp Delta. When | |||
outside Camp Delta, movements will be coordinated | outside Camp Delta, movements will be coordinated | |||
with the TOC of the unit responsible for the security of | through DOC as directed by IN BN TOC. | |||
the exterior area of the camp. | ||||
(1) NCOIC: | (1) NCOIC: | |||
(a) Check on the status of each team on duty | (a) Check on the status of each team on duty | |||
twice per shift (via visitation or telephonically). MWD | twice per shift (via visitation or telephonically). MWD | |||
NCOIC is overall responsible to ensure the team is | NCOIC is overall responsible to ensure the team is | |||
equipped for the day’s mission. | equipped for the day’s mission. | |||
(b) Ensure that MWD on shift maintain a DA | (b) Ensure that MWD on shift maintain a DA | |||
1594 (Staff Duty/PL Journal). NCOIC will be | 1594 (Staff Duty/PL Journal). NCOIC will be | |||
responsible for maintaining a record of each shift. | responsible for maintaining a record of each shift. | |||
Ensures coordination for each mission or change of | Ensures coordination for each mission or change of | |||
mission is planned, resourced, and executed. | mission is planned, resourced, and executed. | |||
skipping to change at line 10359 | skipping to change at line 11326 | |||
time and document the same. | time and document the same. | |||
(d) Report any significant or serious incidents to | (d) Report any significant or serious incidents to | |||
higher. | higher. | |||
(e) NCOIC will report to JDOG Operations when | (e) NCOIC will report to JDOG Operations when | |||
a MWD team is down due to illness, injury etc. | a MWD team is down due to illness, injury etc. | |||
NCOIC will maintain an internal tracking report and | NCOIC will maintain an internal tracking report and | |||
forward to JDOG Operations on the status of each | forward to JDOG Operations on the status of each | |||
MWD team. | MWD team. | |||
(2) MWD Team: | (2) MWD Team: | |||
(a) Will not escort detainee(s) unless specified by | (a) Will not escort detainee(s) unless specified by | |||
the CO | JDOG. | |||
(b) Assist Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) with | (b) Assist Immediate Reaction Force (IRF) with | |||
detainee(s) upon the request of the CO. | detainee(s) upon the request of the CO. | |||
(c) MWDs can be used to scout for escaped, | (c) MWDs can be used to scout for escaped, | |||
missing, or lost detainee(s) | missing, or lost detainee(s) | |||
(d) MWD handlers are overall responsible for the | (d) MWD handlers are overall responsible for the | |||
proper use of their assigned MWD while on duty and | proper use of their assigned MWD while on duty and | |||
ensuring all Military Police/personnel are aware of the | ensuring all guards/personnel are aware of the | |||
capabilities of their MWD | capabilities of their MWD | |||
(e) Draw weapon for external perimeter patrols | (e)Confirm call sign and conduct communication | |||
from the RFI Armory at Camp America; the weapon | check | |||
will be maintained with the QRF weapons while MWD | (f) Coordinate movements with CO and Infantry | |||
are within Camp Delta perimeter. | ||||
(f) Report to the DOC to draw a Saber Radio | ||||
battery. | ||||
(g) Confirm call sign and conduct | ||||
communication check | ||||
(h) Coordinate movements with CO and Infantry | ||||
TOC | TOC | |||
(i) Conduct four-hour checks on MWD | (g) Conduct four-hour checks on MWD | |||
(j) MWDs will only be released to pursue, | (h) MWDs will only be released to pursue, | |||
attack, and hold detainee(s) attempting to escape | attack, and hold detainee(s) attempting to escape | |||
c. Safety Procedures. All personnel are responsible | c. Safety Procedures. All personnel are responsible | |||
for ensuring that all safety procedures and rules are | for ensuring that all safety procedures and rules are | |||
followed at all times: | followed at all times: | |||
(1) While on duty, no person is to feed or be | (1) While on duty, no person is to feed or be | |||
allowed to befriend a MWD. | allowed to befriend a MWD. | |||
(2) Whenever entering or leaving a site with a | (2) Whenever entering or leaving a site with a | |||
MWD a loud verbal warning will be made. (DOG | MWD a loud verbal warning will be made with “DOG | |||
COMING IN/OUT). | COMING IN/OUT”. | |||
(3) All running and/or playing are strictly | (3) All running and/or playing are strictly | |||
prohibited in or near the kennel areas. | prohibited in or near the kennel areas. | |||
(4) Dog teams always have the right of way. | (4) Dog teams always have the right of way. | |||
(5) When staking out a dog a collar and stakeout | (5) When staking out a dog a collar and stakeout | |||
chain will be used. | chain will be used. | |||
(6) Only the dog handler will be permitted to | (6) Only the dog handler will be permitted to | |||
work with their assigned dog. | work with their assigned dog. | |||
(7) Each handler will learn to recognize the | (7) Each handler will learn to recognize the | |||
warning signs that a dog has the intent to attack/bite. | warning signs that a dog has the intent to attack/bite. | |||
(8) Loose Dog Procedures: | (8) Loose Dog Procedures: | |||
(a) First person to notice a loose dog will call | (a) First person to notice a loose dog will call | |||
out: LOOSE DOG! | out: LOOSE DOG! | |||
(b) Everyone in the area will stop movement and | (b) Everyone in the area will stop movement and | |||
remain still. | remain still. | |||
(c) The assigned handler will attempt to take | (c) The assigned handler will attempt to take | |||
control of their dog. | control of their dog. | |||
(d) In the absence of the assigned handler, the | (d) In the absence of the assigned handler, the | |||
skipping to change at line 10408 | skipping to change at line 11368 | |||
warning signs that a dog has the intent to attack/bite. | warning signs that a dog has the intent to attack/bite. | |||
(8) Loose Dog Procedures: | (8) Loose Dog Procedures: | |||
(a) First person to notice a loose dog will call | (a) First person to notice a loose dog will call | |||
out: LOOSE DOG! | out: LOOSE DOG! | |||
(b) Everyone in the area will stop movement and | (b) Everyone in the area will stop movement and | |||
remain still. | remain still. | |||
(c) The assigned handler will attempt to take | (c) The assigned handler will attempt to take | |||
control of their dog. | control of their dog. | |||
(d) In the absence of the assigned handler, the | (d) In the absence of the assigned handler, the | |||
person nearest the dog will attempt to restrain it. | person nearest the dog will attempt to restrain it. | |||
(e) When the dog is secured, the handler that | (e) When the dog is secured, the handler that | |||
does so will call out: DOG SECURED! | does so will call out: DOG SECURED! | |||
26-3. Training | 26-3. Training | |||
a. Training will habitually be conducted with | a. Training will be conducted IAW AR 190-12. | |||
NAVBASE Security Forces MWD. Both an | Any training planned outside the JTF AOR will be | |||
explosives kit and narcotics kit are available to | jointly coordinated through JDOG and NAVBASE | |||
NAVBASE MWD on Guantanamo Bay. | MWD. | |||
b. MWD Kennel master will coordinate training | b. MWD Kennel master will coordinate training | |||
schedules with NAVBASE MWD personnel for | schedules through JDOG Operations. Training | |||
submission to JDOG Operations. Training schedules | schedules will reflect, at a minimum: | |||
will reflect, at a minimum: | ||||
(1) 60 days out, required proficiency training to | (1) 60 days out, required proficiency training to | |||
maintain qualification | maintain qualification | |||
(2) Weekly training conducted with NAVBASE | (2) Weekly training to be conducted with MWD | |||
section. | ||||
(3) Suggested RAMs for monthly implementation | (3) Suggested RAMs for monthly implementation | |||
(4) Transition training for follow-on MWD | (4) Transition training for follow-on MWD | |||
teams. | teams. | |||
26-4. Logistics | 26-4. Logistics | |||
a. Billeting. Both handlers and MWDs are housed | a. Billeting. Handlers, and MWDs are housed at | |||
at TK89 until a permanent MWD facility is completed. | TK89. | |||
b. Support Facilities. MWD teams work out of | b. Support Facilities. MWD teams work out of | |||
office space in Bldg 8 at Camp Delta until completion | office space in Bldg 8A in Camp Delta until | |||
of the proposed kennel facility. Support facility and | completion of the proposed kennel facility. Support | |||
kennel requirements are as follows: | facility and kennel requirements are as follows: | |||
(1) NIPR computer access | (1) NIPR computer access | |||
(2) Refrigerator for meds/food | (2) Refrigerator for meds/food | |||
(3) Food storage area | (3) Food storage area | |||
(4) Sink | (4) Sink | |||
(5) Six dog kennel | (5) Six dog kennel | |||
c. Transportation. MWD teams will be provided | c. Transportation. MWD teams will be provided | |||
vehicle support (1 vehicle) for the team on shift from | vehicle support (2 vehicles) for the team on | |||
J4. The vehicle must be dispatched IAW J4 | shift from J4. The vehicle must be dispatched | |||
Dispatching procedures. | IAW J4 Dispatching procedures. | |||
d. The veterinarian must inspect MWD Vehicles | ||||
before MWD can be transported. | ||||
d. Supplies. All supplies must be requested through | d. Supplies. All supplies must be requested through | |||
the JDOG S-4. | the JDOG S-4. | |||
e. Weapons and Ammo. Weapons will be stored in | ||||
the RFI Armory at Camp America when not in use. | ||||
During shift, weapons can be maintained with the QRF | ||||
weapons inside Camp Delta. While conducting | ||||
perimeter patrols outside the fence line, weapons will | ||||
be worn. Ammunition will be provided by JDOG and | ||||
stored inside the RFI Armory. During shift, two ten | ||||
round magazines will be drawn. The ammunition and | ||||
weapon will be maintained with the QRF weapons | ||||
while inside Camp Delta. | ||||
Chapter 27 | Chapter 27 | |||
Operation Security (OPSEC) and Deceptive | Operation Security (OPSEC) and Deceptive | |||
Lighting Plan | Lighting Plan | |||
27-1. Purpose | 27-1. Purpose | |||
a. To prohibit conduct that is prejudicial to the good | a. To prohibit conduct that is prejudicial to the good | |||
order and discipline of JTF-GTMO that may threaten | order and discipline of JTF-GTMO that may threaten | |||
the national security of the United States or its allies, | the national security of the United States or its allies, | |||
and is of a nature likely to bring discredit upon the | and is of a nature likely to bring discredit upon the | |||
Armed Forces. | Armed Forces. | |||
skipping to change at line 10654 | skipping to change at line 11607 | |||
drawings of camp facilities or personnel working in | drawings of camp facilities or personnel working in | |||
and around Camp Delta, Camp X-Ray, or any other | and around Camp Delta, Camp X-Ray, or any other | |||
part of the NAVBASE that is a photography-prohibited | part of the NAVBASE that is a photography-prohibited | |||
area. This prohibition also includes taking photographs | area. This prohibition also includes taking photographs | |||
or video recordings of personnel movements or | or video recordings of personnel movements or | |||
operations at NAVBASE GTMO without the | operations at NAVBASE GTMO without the | |||
appropriate authorization, and transmitting or | appropriate authorization, and transmitting or | |||
displaying any information relating to JTF-GTMO | displaying any information relating to JTF-GTMO | |||
operations on any website or other shared medium | operations on any website or other shared medium | |||
without the proper written authorization. | without the proper written authorization. | |||
27-6. Deceptive Lighting Plan | 27-6. OPSEC Guidelines and Violations | |||
a. There cannot be any confusion on the part of | ||||
JDOG personnel as to the importance of maintaining | ||||
professional, appropriate communication to prevent | ||||
OPSEC violations. | ||||
b. Some of our biggest OPSEC violations are things | ||||
that do not increase our probability of attack from an | ||||
external enemy, but instead make it more difficult for | ||||
guards, interrogators, linguist, and medical personnel to | ||||
complete our missions. These infractions will be | ||||
addressed with increasing severity if corrections are not | ||||
made. | ||||
c. You are responsible to hold yourself and your | ||||
fellow service members to use OPSEC in your mission. | ||||
More so than anyone else in JTF, we have the ability to | ||||
hurt the intelligence-gathering mission. Do not: | ||||
(1) Discuss current world events or history with | ||||
detainees, or within earshot of detainees, that could | ||||
upset or influence detainee actions or attitudes, such as | ||||
the situation in the Middle East, the destruction of the | ||||
Space Shuttle, or information concerning terrorist | ||||
groups or personnel. | ||||
(2) Discuss company, operational, or personal | ||||
information that will lead the detainees to spread | ||||
rumors, stir up other detainees, or attempt to use the | ||||
information for manipulative purposes. | ||||
(3) Share opinions or initiate discussions with | ||||
detainees regarding information that is not relevant to | ||||
the carrying out of essential duties. This includes | ||||
teaching detainees songs, phrases in English, Spanish, | ||||
or other languages. | ||||
(4) Discuss future missions, inbound or outbound | ||||
missions, additional missions such as Camp Echo or | ||||
the General’s Cottage, etc, unless specifically directed | ||||
to do so by JDOG through coordination with JIG | ||||
personnel. | ||||
(5) Attempt to listen in on, or influence, | ||||
interrogation activities on the block or in one of the | ||||
JIIF buildings. If you are requested to be present by the | ||||
interrogator or linguist, please accommodate them | ||||
appropriately. However, unless authorized to do so, do | ||||
not participate in an active manner. Only monitor and | ||||
conduct security as ordered. Do not monitor the audio | ||||
of the interrogation unless specifically requested to do | ||||
so. | ||||
(6) Allow detainees or other unauthorized | ||||
personnel to see the uncovered sign-in roster at brown | ||||
and yellow JIIF building entrance. Use a cover sheet or | ||||
turn face down when not actively using. This has led to | ||||
a detainee knowing names of several US personnel. | ||||
(7) Conduct conversations critical of another unit, | ||||
the chain of command, or other soldiers with detainees. | ||||
This also has happened, and will not be tolerated. | ||||
(8) Talk with other guards or US personnel not | ||||
assigned to special missions such as Camp Echo, DMO | ||||
Operations bus escort, General’s Cottage, etc, about | ||||
specific incidents or actions at those sites. | ||||
d. These OPSEC limitations do not preclude you | ||||
from talking to detainees in the conduct of your daily | ||||
assignment. Maintain your professionalism, be firm but | ||||
fair, and you will be able to build rapport with | ||||
detainees. OPSEC does not preclude a guard from | ||||
asking a detainee how he is doing, telling the detainee | ||||
what actions need to be conducted, being directive with | ||||
your commands, or answering routine questions. Being | ||||
firm, but polite, will not compromise OPSEC and will | ||||
promote detainee compliance. | ||||
e. General Order #2 has been disseminated to all | ||||
company commanders and sections, and all soldiers are | ||||
responsible to be familiar with its provisions. | ||||
Prohibited activities include: | ||||
(1) Discussing matters of a personal or | ||||
operational nature in the presence of detainees need not | ||||
be discussed in their presence. | ||||
(2) Communicating with detainees (verbal or | ||||
nonverbal) or assisting others and/or allowing others to | ||||
communicate with detainees without the proper | ||||
authorization. Also prohibited is failing to report any | ||||
unauthorized attempt at communication, whether a | ||||
detainee trying to communicate with an unauthorized | ||||
person, or an unauthorized person (a TCN, an ICRC | ||||
person, a soldier who is not authorized to talk to | ||||
detainees) attempting to communicate with a detainee. | ||||
(3) Leaving any tools, keys, weapons, or other | ||||
work related materials necessary to perform your | ||||
mission unattended or within the reach of persons | ||||
unauthorized to possess them, or bringing any | ||||
materials not necessary for the performance of the | ||||
mission into a sensitive area or detainee area. | ||||
(4) Bringing any type of camera or other | ||||
recording device without getting proper authorization | ||||
into any detainee or sensitive area. | ||||
(5) Taking any visual or audio recordings of | ||||
detainees, detainee facilities, personnel working in or | ||||
around Camp Delta, Echo, the Cottage, Camp X-Ray, | ||||
or any other photography prohibited areas. Use | ||||
common sense – If you have to question if something | ||||
is a possible violation, don’t take the chance. Ask if | ||||
necessary. | ||||
(6) Wearing unsanitized uniforms in the presence | ||||
of detainees. | ||||
(7) Discussing classified matters, work related | ||||
matters, or JTF operational matters with anyone who | ||||
does not have the appropriate clearance or in the | ||||
presence of anyone without the necessary clearance. | ||||
(8) Marking down of information, taking | ||||
classified materials to a housing unit, keeping or | ||||
recording classified material in an unauthorized area, | ||||
or keeping/leaving personnel rosters, whether detainee | ||||
or US personnel, unattended or in an unauthorized | ||||
area. For us, this means that we do not record | ||||
operational or detainee information anywhere but | ||||
inside Camp Delta (or other authorized area such as | ||||
NAVBASE Hospital, Camp Echo, etc), or keep | ||||
personal journals with specific Camp Delta records and | ||||
information. | ||||
f. Beyond what is listed in General Order #2, you | ||||
must also be aware of the JDOG and JTF Essential | ||||
Elements of Friendly Information, and protect this | ||||
information accordingly. All soldiers are responsible to | ||||
be aware of these items, and your chain of command | ||||
will re-disseminate these if needed. Included in these | ||||
EEFIs are: | ||||
(1) Any information pertaining to the movement | ||||
of detainees to and from GTMO, or detainee movement | ||||
while at GTMO. | ||||
(2) Any reference to the identity of a detainee | ||||
other than his ISN. If using non-secure radio channel or | ||||
telephone, only the last 3 of detainees ISN are to be | ||||
used. | ||||
(3) Any reference to specific detainee | ||||
interrogations or methods of interrogation. This | ||||
includes talking to other guards or US personnel who | ||||
do not have a need to know regarding the specific | ||||
information. | ||||
(4) Any references to a detainee’s medical | ||||
condition, any references to our daily schedules, or to | ||||
specific incidents that have occurred at Camp Delta. | ||||
(5) Discussion of Distinguished visitor travel | ||||
information, such as specifics on when they will be | ||||
visiting at what time, etc. Use common sense! | ||||
(6) Access procedures for entry into Camp Delta | ||||
or through Infantry checkpoints. | ||||
g. Violations of any of the above may result in | ||||
UCMJ action under article 92, violation of a general | ||||
order. | ||||
h. This list was not inclusive of all aspects of | ||||
General Order #2, or JTF/JDOG EEFIs. All of us are | ||||
responsible to meet the standards in these documents. | ||||
i. OPSEC is not just keeping secret the big picture | ||||
information like how many troops we have, what our | ||||
defense plans are, or when we are redeploying. Many | ||||
JDOG, JIG, and JMG service members have | ||||
information that could be detrimental to our mission if | ||||
the media knew of it or detainees became aware of it. | ||||
Don’t be the one who sparks something that makes it | ||||
difficult for the next shift, another company, the | ||||
interrogators, or any other fellow soldier to accomplish | ||||
our mission. If you see or hear a fellow service | ||||
member, guard, linguist, medical, or other, violate | ||||
OPSEC; make the correction. If the person(s) refuses, | ||||
and it occurs within Camp Delta, call the JDOG S-3 | ||||
ASAP. It will be investigated. If outside of Delta, | ||||
report it to the assistant S-3 and OPSEC coordinator for | ||||
JDOG. More importantly though, be aware of what | ||||
you and your coworkers are saying and doing. We | ||||
would much rather stop OPSEC violations than punish | ||||
anyone for committing one. | ||||
27-7. Deceptive Lighting Plan | ||||
a. All military and civilian personnel working in | a. All military and civilian personnel working in | |||
Camp Delta will be familiar with and conform to the | Camp Delta will be familiar with and conform to the | |||
procedure prescribed by this policy. Unit leaders and | procedure prescribed by this policy. Unit leaders and | |||
shift OICs and NCOICs are responsible for ensuring | shift OICs and NCOICs are responsible for ensuring | |||
that their personnel are familiar with and comply with | that their personnel are familiar with and comply with | |||
this procedure. Personnel may be held accountable | this procedure. Personnel may be held accountable | |||
under the UCMJ for failing to follow the guidelines set | under the UCMJ for failing to follow the guidelines set | |||
forth under this SOP. | forth under this SOP. | |||
b. In the event of a threat either by sea or air, the | b. In the event of a threat either by sea or air, the | |||
following procedure will be followed. | following procedure will be followed. | |||
skipping to change at line 10669 | skipping to change at line 11792 | |||
that their personnel are familiar with and comply with | that their personnel are familiar with and comply with | |||
this procedure. Personnel may be held accountable | this procedure. Personnel may be held accountable | |||
under the UCMJ for failing to follow the guidelines set | under the UCMJ for failing to follow the guidelines set | |||
forth under this SOP. | forth under this SOP. | |||
b. In the event of a threat either by sea or air, the | b. In the event of a threat either by sea or air, the | |||
following procedure will be followed. | following procedure will be followed. | |||
(1) The JOC will notify the Camp Delta DOC of | (1) The JOC will notify the Camp Delta DOC of | |||
an impending threat in two stages. | an impending threat in two stages. | |||
(a) The first notification occurs when a potential | (a) The first notification occurs when a potential | |||
threat has been identified. | threat has been identified. | |||
(b) The second notification occurs when the | (b) The second notification occurs when the | |||
threat is confirmed and the decision is made to turn off | threat is confirmed and the decision is made to turn off | |||
all lights in the Camp Delta area. | all lights in the Camp Delta area. | |||
(2) When JOC calls with the first notification: | (2) When JOC calls with the first notification: | |||
(a) Camp Delta CO will have one of the | (a) Camp Delta CO will have one of the | |||
Administrative NCOs, working in Camp-1, using | Administrative NCOs, working in Camp-1, using | |||
whatever means available (i.e. golf cart, HMMWV) | whatever means available (i.e. Gator, HMMWV) move | |||
move to the power substation adjacent to the water | to the power substation adjacent to the water tanks by | |||
tanks by Camp Bulkeley. Admin NCO will carry a | Camp Bulkeley. Admin NCO will carry a SABRE | |||
SABRE radio. | radio. | |||
(b) Upon arrival will enter the gate by entering | (b) Upon arrival will enter the gate by entering | |||
the number (1998) in the combination lock. | the number (1998) in the combination lock. | |||
(c) Proceed to the junction box with the number | (c) Proceed to the junction box with the number | |||
(7012-83) Breaker Box and open the box. The number | (7012-83) Breaker Box and open the box. The number | |||
for the lock on the breaker box is (224). | for the lock on the breaker box is (224). | |||
(d) Call Power Station #4 and advise them that | (d) Call Power Station #4 and advise them that | |||
they are getting ready to shut down power to Radio | they are getting ready to shut down power to Radio | |||
Range. All phone numbers are posted inside the door | Range. All phone numbers are posted inside the door | |||
of the phone box. | of the phone box. | |||
(e) Call the JOC (5010/5038) from the phone box | (e) Call the JOC (5010/5038) from the phone box | |||
skipping to change at line 10767 | skipping to change at line 11889 | |||
28-3. Detainee International Public Information | 28-3. Detainee International Public Information | |||
Themes | Themes | |||
a. Detaining these people in Guantanamo Bay | a. Detaining these people in Guantanamo Bay | |||
supports the smooth transition to a stable and secure | supports the smooth transition to a stable and secure | |||
environment in Afghanistan. | environment in Afghanistan. | |||
b. Guantanamo Bay affords a safe facility to secure | b. Guantanamo Bay affords a safe facility to secure | |||
and provide appropriate care for detainees. | and provide appropriate care for detainees. | |||
c. All detainees will be treated humanely and | c. All detainees will be treated humanely and | |||
consistent with the principles of the Geneva | consistent with the principles of the Geneva | |||
Conventions. | Conventions. | |||
d. These detainees are the most dangerous of the al- | d. These detainees are the most dangerous of the Al- | |||
Qaida and Taliban. They continue to pose a threat and | Qaida and Taliban. They continue to pose a threat and | |||
must be under tight control. | must be under tight control. | |||
e. Guantanamo Bay and the detention facilities are | e. Guantanamo Bay and the detention facilities are | |||
secure and well-defended. | secure and well defended. | |||
Chapter 29 | Chapter 29 | |||
Transitions | Transitions | |||
Section I – To Camp IV | Section I – To Camp IV | |||
29-1. Preparation | 29-1. Preparation | |||
a. The transition procedure from Camp I to Camp | a. The transition procedure from Camp I to Camp | |||
IV will allow the detainee over a period of time to | IV will allow the detainee over a period of time to | |||
acclimatize to a different security environment with its | acclimatize to a different security environment with its | |||
own set of rules and operating procedures. | own set of rules and operating procedures. | |||
b. The detainees to be moved from Camp I to Camp | b. The detainees to be moved from Camp I to Camp | |||
skipping to change at line 10823 | skipping to change at line 11945 | |||
f. The detainee will be shackled using handcuffs | f. The detainee will be shackled using handcuffs | |||
and waist belt. | and waist belt. | |||
g. The detainee, the tub, the mattress, and ISO mat | g. The detainee, the tub, the mattress, and ISO mat | |||
will be taken to Tango Block. | will be taken to Tango Block. | |||
h. Combat Camera will film the transition from the | h. Combat Camera will film the transition from the | |||
detainee’s current cell to his cell in Tango Block. | detainee’s current cell to his cell in Tango Block. | |||
i. During the transition phase, the following | i. During the transition phase, the following | |||
activities will occur: | activities will occur: | |||
(1) An increase in food portions. | (1) An increase in food portions. | |||
(2) One shower allowed per day. | (2) One shower allowed per day. | |||
(3) Longer recreation periods allowed. | (3) Longer exercise periods allowed. | |||
(4) Group recreation time with up to three | (4) Group exercise time with up to three | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
(5) ISO mats placed in the recreation yard to | (5) ISO mats placed in the exercise yard to | |||
facilitate board games and prayer time. | facilitate board games and prayer time. | |||
(6) Classes on Camp IV and its associated rules | (6) Classes on Camp IV and its associated rules | |||
and privileges. | and privileges. | |||
(7) A tour of Camp IV and description of the | (7) A tour of Camp IV and description of the | |||
facilities. | facilities. | |||
29-3. Movement to Camp IV | 29-3. Movement to Camp IV | |||
a. On the movement day, the detainee will have his | a. On the movement day, the detainee will have his | |||
comfort items inventoried and packed in the storage | comfort items inventoried and packed in the storage | |||
tub. The green mattress will stay in the cell. | tub. The green mattress will stay in the cell. | |||
b. The detainee will be placed in handcuffs. | b. The detainee will be placed in handcuffs. | |||
skipping to change at line 10910 | skipping to change at line 12032 | |||
detainee will meet with the designated representatives; | detainee will meet with the designated representatives; | |||
JDOG, chaplain, medical, etc. | JDOG, chaplain, medical, etc. | |||
i. JDOG/JIG will give an overview of the | i. JDOG/JIG will give an overview of the | |||
Transition Location along with rules to follow during | Transition Location along with rules to follow during | |||
transition. | transition. | |||
j. JIG will be responsible to provide all comfort | j. JIG will be responsible to provide all comfort | |||
items to the detainee as D-Day approaches. | items to the detainee as D-Day approaches. | |||
k. Detainee will utilize this time to adjust himself to | k. Detainee will utilize this time to adjust himself to | |||
a more lenient life style including such items as | a more lenient life style including such items as | |||
follows: | follows: | |||
(1) More recreation | (1) More exercise | |||
(2) More showers | (2) More showers | |||
(3) Different meals | (3) Different meals | |||
(4) Items provided by the JIG. | (4) Items provided by the JIG. | |||
29-6. Transition Location Rules | 29-6. Transition Location Rules | |||
Designated detainees will follow the following | Designated detainees will follow the following | |||
guidelines: | guidelines: | |||
(1) Follow all directions given to them by staff. | (1) Follow all directions given to them by staff. | |||
(2) Keep their area clean. | (2) Keep their area clean. | |||
(3) Will request use of the latrine and one at a | (3) Will request use of the latrine and one at a | |||
time. | time. | |||
skipping to change at line 10945 | skipping to change at line 12067 | |||
custody. The Detainee Hospital’s former physical | custody. The Detainee Hospital’s former physical | |||
therapy room is designated as the current transition | therapy room is designated as the current transition | |||
location. Detainees identified for transfer will be given | location. Detainees identified for transfer will be given | |||
a period of “decompression” and will have increased | a period of “decompression” and will have increased | |||
privileges as they prepare for their transfer. | privileges as they prepare for their transfer. | |||
b. These detainees will be moved from their current | b. These detainees will be moved from their current | |||
cells to the transition location in waist belt and | cells to the transition location in waist belt and | |||
handcuffs only. Unless the detainee exhibits behavior | handcuffs only. Unless the detainee exhibits behavior | |||
that would require increased restraints, they will only | that would require increased restraints, they will only | |||
be moved with the use of the waist belt and handcuffs. | be moved with the use of the waist belt and handcuffs. | |||
There will be an MP stationed outside the entry to the | There will be a guard stationed outside the entry to the | |||
Transition Location and in a position to observe the | Transition Location and in a position to observe the | |||
room and control access to the Transition Location. | room and control access to the Transition Location. | |||
c. The door leading outside will be secured utilizing | c. The door leading outside will be secured utilizing | |||
a padlock and hasp. | a padlock and hasp. | |||
d. There will be two MP’s stationed inside the room | d. There will be two guards stationed inside the | |||
near the latrine area. This position will be by the entry | room near the latrine area. This position will be by the | |||
door leading to the Detainee Hospital. | entry door leading to the Detainee Hospital. | |||
e. The middle doors leading into the dental area will | e. The middle doors leading into the dental area will | |||
always remain secured except for emergency | always remain secured except for emergency | |||
situations. There will an MP at this location in order to | situations. There will a guard at this location in order | |||
observe the detainees. | to observe the detainees. | |||
f. The door leading into the hospital area will be | f. The door leading into the hospital area will be | |||
secured. If there is only one MP there, that one MP | secured. If there is only one guard there, that one | |||
will stand on the Detainee Hospital side of the door and | guard will stand on the Detainee Hospital side of the | |||
observe the detainees through the window of the door | door and observe the detainees through the window of | |||
until the second MP returns. | the door until the second guard returns. | |||
g. Inspections will be performed daily on the | g. Inspections will be performed daily on the | |||
detainee’s area by the day shift. | detainee’s area by the day shift. | |||
h. Shakedowns will be performed as designated. | h. Shakedowns will be performed as designated. | |||
i. MPs will ensure that the latrine and shower area | i. Guards will ensure that the latrine and shower | |||
are cleaned at least once per shift on days and swings. | area are cleaned at least once per shift on days and | |||
j. MPs will ensure that the detainee’s area is | swings. | |||
j. Guards will ensure that the detainee’s area is | ||||
cleaned each morning and also at any other time during | cleaned each morning and also at any other time during | |||
the day as needed. | the day as needed. | |||
k. Detainees may stack up their mattresses or beds | k. Detainees may stack up their mattresses or beds | |||
for storage. If this is done, bedding will be neatly | for storage. If this is done, bedding will be neatly | |||
placed on their storage bin. | placed on their storage bin. | |||
l. Detainees will not be allowed in prohibited areas | l. Detainees will not be allowed in prohibited areas | |||
(taped areas) without authorization. | (taped areas) without authorization. | |||
m.MPs will notify the D.O.C. via the phone, any | m.Guards will notify the D.O.C. via the phone, any | |||
counts that are conducted. | counts that are conducted. | |||
n. MPs will monitor all foot traffic from Detainee | n. Guards will monitor all foot traffic from Detainee | |||
Hospital to the Transition Location for utilizing the | Hospital to the Transition Location for utilizing the | |||
latrine. | latrine. | |||
o. If one of the MPs stationed by the latrine area | o. If one of the guards stationed by the latrine area | |||
needs to take a break, the roving MP will replace that | needs to take a break, the roving guard will replace that | |||
MP until that MP returns. | guard until that guard returns. | |||
p. MPs at the Transition Location need to | p. Guards at the Transition Location need to | |||
coordinate with the Detainee Hospital MP’s for getting | coordinate with the Detainee Hospital guards for | |||
meals for both detainees and themselves. | getting meals for both detainees and themselves. | |||
q. MPs on duty will remain vigilant. | q. Guards on duty will remain vigilant. | |||
r. MPs will not have any unauthorized items while | r. Guards will not have any unauthorized items | |||
in the performance of their duties. | while in the performance of their duties. | |||
s. MPs will wear latex gloves while performing | s. MPs will wear latex gloves while performing | |||
searches. | searches. | |||
t. MPs will wear “sanitized” uniforms with their | t. MPs will wear “sanitized” uniforms with their | |||
names covered up. | names covered up. | |||
u. MPs will document in a log book all significant | u. MPs will document in a log book all significant | |||
events that would include but not limited to the | events that would include but not limited to the | |||
following: shift change, chow times, authorized and | following: shift change, chow times, authorized and | |||
unauthorized visitors, medical staff, medical staff, | unauthorized visitors, medical staff, medical staff, | |||
interrogators, translators, and count times. | interrogators, translators, and count times. | |||
v. MPs will perform preventive measures and | v. MPs will perform preventive measures and | |||
accountability on all equipment. | accountability on all equipment. | |||
w. Whistles are provided to each MP for duress. | w. Whistles are provided to each guard for duress. | |||
MPs will keep whistles with lanyards on their person at | Guards will keep whistles with lanyards on their person | |||
all times while on duty. The whistles will be | at all times while on duty. The whistles will be | |||
transferred from MPs coming off shift to those coming | transferred from guards coming off shift to those | |||
on shift. | coming on shift. | |||
x. Detainees will be provided the opportunity to | x. Detainees will be provided the opportunity to | |||
participate with recreation per the schedule provided. | participate with exercise per the schedule provided. | |||
Showers will be allowed after recreation or as | Showers will be allowed after exercise or as | |||
authorized. | authorized. | |||
y. Recreation schedule: One MP will escort the | y. Exercise schedule: One guard will escort the | |||
detainee utilizing the hospital entrance doorway of the | detainee utilizing the hospital entrance doorway of the | |||
transition location (by the latrine). The detainee, along | transition location (by the latrine). The detainee, along | |||
with the escort, will exit out the rear entrance to the | with the escort, will exit out the rear entrance to the | |||
designated recreation location. The remaining three | designated exercise location. The remaining three | |||
MPs will observe the other detainees from three points: | guards will observe the other detainees from three | |||
points: | ||||
(1) Outside the access door looking in. | (1) Outside the access door looking in. | |||
(2) At the middle doors looking in from the | (2) At the middle doors looking in from the | |||
physical training room. | physical training room. | |||
(3) Sitting at the table by the latrine. | (3) Sitting at the table by the latrine. | |||
Chapter 30 | Chapter 30 | |||
Delta Block Mental Health Facility (MHF) | Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block | |||
30-1. Operations | 30-1. Overview | |||
a. Any attempt at self-harm will cause the cell to be | Delta Behavioral Health Block is constructed in two | |||
considered a crime scene. This cell will be sealed and | sections. The front Non-Acute section has 22 cells that | |||
not used until JDOG S-3 gives the approval. | have been modified with additional safety | |||
b. No detainee is to be moved from this section to | considerations to house detainees on Behavioral | |||
MSU for behavioral reasons. | Healthcare Service that are clinically stable but because | |||
c. Any move for temporary reasons, the Koran must | of their mental illness and/or limited coping skills, are | |||
follow the detainee. | at increased risk of self-harm and are more difficult to | |||
d. All blankets in use in this section will be of the | manage in the general population. | |||
self-harm prevention type. This blanket will stay in the | The rear section, Delta Acute, houses detainees who | |||
assigned cell. Periodically check all seams of the | are at imminent risk of serious self-harm, suicide or | |||
blanket. If any seam has been chewed, or otherwise | require seclusion or restraint to regain internal control, | |||
compromised, the blanket should be repaired before | under medical supervision. The section has nine acute | |||
reuse. Use of this blanket is not a substitute for careful | cells, four restraint cells, and two seclusion cells. A | |||
monitoring of individuals on self-harm watch. | nurse’s station, two secure restraint monitoring rooms | |||
e. All security aspects with this section of Delta | and two secure interview areas have also been | |||
Block must by coordinated with the Psychologists. | constructed. Video monitoring is available for all cells | |||
in the Delta Acute section and in the passageway. | ||||
A lockable sally port style door covered with thick | ||||
plexi-glass divides the Block. This door can be closed | ||||
to control the flow of traffic, to reduce noise level and | ||||
control communication between acute and non-acute | ||||
detainees. This door will be locked only in the most | ||||
extreme of emergencies. | ||||
A ramp was constructed on the side of the Facility for | ||||
the ease of removing a detainee by litter. This ramp | ||||
slopes both the front and rear of the block and accesses | ||||
a side door. The side door is lockable and is used as a | ||||
general access/egress point from the non-acute section | ||||
near the middle of the Facility. | ||||
The Facility is also equipped with a rear sally port. | ||||
This gate accesses the dead-zone around Delta MHF | ||||
and allows access to the Block via Sally Port 4. The | ||||
rear gate is intended for ranking officers and dignitaries | ||||
to minimize detainee contact while still allowing access | ||||
to the Facility. This gate is for emergency, dignitary, | ||||
and ranking officers only, and general day-to-day | ||||
operational use would take away for its intended | ||||
purpose. The green wind screening has been doubled | ||||
to reduce the ability of detainee to see into the dead- | ||||
zone. | ||||
Camp Delta SOP will guide all Delta Behavioral | ||||
Health Block operations unless specifically expressed | ||||
otherwise in this chapter. | ||||
30-2. Staffing | ||||
a. Behavioral Healthcare Service Manager, in | ||||
conjunction with the Delta Block NCOIC, will have | ||||
overall responsibility for the daily operations of Delta | ||||
Block. Accountability will be to CJDOG and to the | ||||
Chief, Behavioral Healthcare Services. The Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare Service Chief is a credentialed provider | ||||
who is responsible for mental healthcare, operations | ||||
and resource management. | ||||
b. Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block staffing: | ||||
1 Psychiatric Registered Nurse | ||||
3-4 Behavioral Healthcare Technicians on days | ||||
and 2 Technicians on nights (24/7 | ||||
coverage, 12 hour shifts) | ||||
c. The Facility is manned 24/7 by a permanent guard | ||||
force (GF) of 27 MP’s; 1 senior NCO (NCOIC), 4 | ||||
junior NCO’s (block sergeants), and 22 enlisted MP’s. | ||||
The MPs work 12-hour shifts. | ||||
e. MPs assigned to Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block | ||||
will not be assigned to Camp Delta IRF teams due to | ||||
the high acuity of the detainees housed here. Because | ||||
of this high acuity and higher risk of acting out | ||||
behavior, consistency in staffing levels is paramount. | ||||
GF personnel are all volunteers and are selected by the | ||||
Delta Behavioral Healthcare Providers and the Delta | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare Block NCOIC from a list | ||||
provided by their chain of command through JDOG S3. | ||||
f. The MPs assigned to Delta Behavioral Healthcare | ||||
Block will be expected to manage most routine | ||||
situations of acting out behavior. The Delta Block | ||||
NCO will determine when additional staff support is | ||||
indicated and will notify the DOC and On-Duty CO as | ||||
per Camp Delta SOP. | ||||
g. JDOG S3 will identify candidates for permanent | ||||
NCO MP staff assignment to Delta Block; candidates | ||||
will be interviewed and recommendations for | ||||
assignment made by Behavioral Healthcare Staff to the | ||||
JDOG S3. | ||||
h. The Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block NCO is the | ||||
supervisor for all MPs assigned to the block. The Unit | ||||
Nurse will brief the oncoming block NCO on relevant | ||||
behavioral and safety issues and any special behavioral | ||||
treatment plans in effect. The NCO will be responsible | ||||
for briefing all oncoming shifts prior to the start of the | ||||
shift on the operational specifics of the Delta | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare Block and normal guard mount | ||||
information. Any significant changes in treatment | ||||
plans or a detainee’s mental health condition will be | ||||
briefed to the Block NCO as they arise. | ||||
30-3. Watch | ||||
a. There will be a minimum of one behavioral health | ||||
staff present on the block at all times. The guard force | ||||
should direct all questions regarding the behavior or | ||||
status of a detainee to them. | ||||
b. A credentialed mental health provider will be | ||||
designated daily for on-call purposes after normal | ||||
working hours. | ||||
30-4. Crisis/Mass Casualty Response | ||||
a. Mass casualty situations can arise at any time and | ||||
are rarely foreseen. The primary consideration in any | ||||
crisis or mass casualty situation is security and safety. | ||||
b. During a mass casualty situation not involving Delta | ||||
Block detainees, one psychiatric technician will remain | ||||
on the block and the remainder of unit behavioral | ||||
healthcare personnel will respond to their assigned | ||||
positions per the mass casualty plan. The guard staff | ||||
and remaining psychiatric technician will exercise | ||||
additional vigilance in detainee observation during this | ||||
time. | ||||
c. While a mass suicide attempt may occur anywhere | ||||
in the camp; detainees housed in the Delta Unit may be | ||||
at higher risk due to the potential severity of their | ||||
illness (e.g. psychosis) or the reckless or planned | ||||
actions due to a severe personality disorder. The | ||||
immediate action plan for a mass suicide attempt will | ||||
be to sweep from one end of the Unit to the other and | ||||
secure the extremities of detainees engaged in | ||||
imminent self harm behaviors, with flexi cuff | ||||
restraints, to points of their cells that would prevent | ||||
acute acts of suicide. This is done as quickly as | ||||
possible, however, the safety of the guard and medical | ||||
staff is paramount as these coordinated behaviors may | ||||
also indicate a clandestine plan to overpower staff. | ||||
The JDOG S-3 will ensure that adequate flexi cuff | ||||
restraints are readily available for this contingency. | ||||
d. In the event of a crisis/mass casualty on Delta Block | ||||
the following immediate action plan will be followed: | ||||
(1) The Video Monitoring MP will issue the | ||||
brevity code to alert DOC and the On-Duty CO. | ||||
(2) The Block NCO will organize the MP’s into 2- | ||||
3 soldier teams. | ||||
(3) The spare keys from behind the monitoring | ||||
room door, radios, and spare trauma sheers in nurses | ||||
office will be secured to aid in entering cells. | ||||
(4) Video Monitoring MP will contact the DOC | ||||
via landline to ensure proper response is in route. | ||||
(5) The block NCO coordinates operations on the | ||||
block in a sweeping motion from one end of the tier to | ||||
the other, prioritizing the detainees by the level of | ||||
distress then directing MP teams to the appropriate | ||||
detainee cell. | ||||
(6) The Block NCO utilizes OC to stop detainees | ||||
engaged in imminent self-harm behavior. | ||||
(7) MP team enters the cell with flexi-cuff | ||||
restraints and the detainees will be secured to the inside | ||||
of the cell, on the floor, laying on their back with flexi | ||||
cuffs to at least 2 points of the cell. | ||||
(8) The minimum amount of force will be used to | ||||
maintain complete control over the detainee. | ||||
(9) In the event a detainee is cut down, one MP | ||||
will stabilize the detainee’s head while he is cut down. | ||||
Then the detainee will be lowered to the floor and | ||||
placed on his back, then secured. | ||||
(10)The door to the detainees cell must be locked. | ||||
Remember the primary concern is soldier safety. | ||||
(11)If additional manning is required, the On-Duty | ||||
CO will call Camp One IRF teams. If the On-Duty CO | ||||
is not on the block the DOC will be notified to call for | ||||
the IRF teams. | ||||
(12)The Block NCO coordinates all activities on | ||||
the block, ensuring un-necessary personnel and | ||||
observers are not allowed on the tier and required | ||||
personnel are being properly directed. | ||||
(13)The Behavioral Healthcare Service Manager | ||||
and Delta MHF NCOIC will be notified as soon as | ||||
possible. | ||||
(14) All personnel must be vigilant to a clandestine | ||||
plan to overpower the guard and psych staff. | ||||
(15) All GF personnel file DA 2823, original with | ||||
DOC, copy to GF NCOIC. | ||||
30-5. Non-Acute Section | ||||
a. The non-acute section is for detainees with severe | ||||
mental illnesses that require an increased level of | ||||
monitoring/care, detainees at increased risk for self- | ||||
injurious behavior, and those detainees whose behavior | ||||
is so maladaptive as to create a significant disturbance | ||||
if housed in the general or segregated housing units. | ||||
b. The section’s guard force provides security and first | ||||
line observation of detainees with ready back up of | ||||
behavioral health staff. Detainees who are at a | ||||
particularly high risk of self-harm, (e.g. detainees who | ||||
have had repeated suicide attempts or detainees who | ||||
have just returned from the acute section), will have | ||||
their cells marked with a red tag. The purpose of the | ||||
red tag is to alert guard and behavioral health staff of | ||||
detainees to be particularly observant of and have a | ||||
lower threshold for further inquiry. These individuals | ||||
can or have demonstrated a propensity to be very | ||||
secretive or resourceful in their attempts to do self- | ||||
harm. During times of crisis or other times of potential | ||||
distraction, particular attention to cells marked with red | ||||
tags is paramount. During these times of crisis, the | ||||
Delta Block NCO will verbally and immediately assign | ||||
either a guard to assume the responsibility of | ||||
monitoring cells with red tags or task the Unit Nurse or | ||||
Unit Psychiatric Technician to immediately assign a | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare staff member to this task. | ||||
c. Cells with red tags will not have sheets. Large | ||||
shower type towels will be provided only for shower | ||||
purposes and will under no circumstances be allowed | ||||
inside any cells. Detainees assigned to Delta MHF, | ||||
both acute and non-acute, are issued small hand towels | ||||
for use in their cells. These restrictions should help | ||||
guard and behavioral health staff to quickly identify | ||||
high-risk detainees who have these unauthorized and | ||||
potentially dangerous items in their cell. | ||||
d. Behavioral health staff will conduct a visual check | ||||
of detainees housed with red tags every two hours and | ||||
document the detainee’s activity utilizing the High | ||||
Risk Observation form. | ||||
e. When the guard force is not able to redirect a | ||||
detainee from behavior that is potentially self-injurious, | ||||
e.g. head banging or scratching, or creating a | ||||
significant disturbance, the guard force will contact the | ||||
Unit Psychiatric Technician or Unit Nurse. If the Unit | ||||
Psychiatric Technician is unable to redirect the | ||||
detainee from potentially self-injurious behavior, the | ||||
Unit Nurse will be notified. | ||||
30-6 Delta Acute Section and Self-Harm | ||||
Precautions | ||||
The Acute Section is for those detainees at very high | ||||
risk for self-harm and who require Self-Harm | ||||
Precautions. A detainee on self-harm precautions is | ||||
at high risk for suicide or other self-injury. They may | ||||
suffer from poor self-control or a lack of coping | ||||
abilities. They often deal poorly with anger and stress. | ||||
Many try to manipulate others and their environment | ||||
by threats of suicide and self-harm. They often engage | ||||
in threats or actual self-injurious behavior, threats or | ||||
actual harm toward others, anti-social and aggressive | ||||
behaviors, and inappropriate sexual behaviors. Their | ||||
behavior can be dramatic and highly unpredictable. | ||||
The risk with these detainees is varying degrees of self- | ||||
injurious behaviors, including suicide. | ||||
a. Only Behavioral Healthcare providers, nurses and | ||||
psychiatric technicians, or another credentialed medical | ||||
provider can order Self-Harm Precautions. Only | ||||
credentialed behavioral healthcare providers can | ||||
discontinue Self-Harm Precautions. | ||||
b. Detainees placed on self-harm precautions will be | ||||
transferred into an acute cell on the Delta Acute Unit. | ||||
If space is not available, the detainee will be placed | ||||
into a restraint cell; if a restraint cell is not available the | ||||
detainee will be placed on constant observation in cell | ||||
1 or 22 of the Delta Non-Acute section. | ||||
c. Self-harm precautions will be in effect until the | ||||
detainee is clinically stable, as determined by a | ||||
credentialed provider, and safe to return to a less | ||||
restrictive environment. | ||||
d. Detainees who are on self-harm precautions that are | ||||
scheduled for interrogation will have their clinical | ||||
status and risk assessment verified by the licensed | ||||
Behavioral Health staff prior to leaving the block. | ||||
Detainees on self-harm precautions are generally not | ||||
clinically stable enough to leave the block. | ||||
e. All items are normally removed from the cell. | ||||
Exceptions may be made by the Behavioral Health | ||||
staff on a case-by-case basis. These exceptions will be | ||||
documented on the Self-Harm Guidelines form. | ||||
f. Detainee is to be given no items at any time that | ||||
may be used for self-harm (such as razors, sharp | ||||
objects, pens, pencils, nail cutters, etc.). | ||||
g. Detainee will not be placed in the Segregation Unit. | ||||
h. Return nothing to the detainee unless directed by | ||||
Behavioral Health staff. | ||||
i. Serve meals on Styrofoam plate with plastic spoon. | ||||
j. MP staff on Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block will | ||||
maintain a 1 staff to 3-detainee ratio while observing | ||||
detainees on Self-Harm Precautions. The MP assigned | ||||
to the video monitoring room on the “Observation of | ||||
Self-Injurious Behavior Form”, every 15 minutes will | ||||
complete documentation of the detainee’s behavior. | ||||
k. Unless actively aggressive, detainees may shower | ||||
per normal routine. | ||||
SELF-HARM PRECAUTIONS GUIDELINES | ||||
(1) Behavioral Health staff may recommend the | ||||
removal of Jumpsuit tops and pants, depending on the | ||||
nature of the self-harm behavior. | ||||
(2) Items may be given if approved by Behavioral | ||||
Health Staff, and in accordance with the Authorized | ||||
Items for Detainee Possession. | ||||
ITEM LEVEL INITIALS | ||||
Regular Blanket, No ribbon 1-4 | ||||
ISO mat 1-4 | ||||
Orange jumpsuit top 1-4 | ||||
Orange jumpsuit pants 1-4 | ||||
Orange shorts 1-4 | ||||
Flip-Flops 1-4 | ||||
Camp rules 1-4 | ||||
Finger toothbrush 1-4 | ||||
Toothpaste 1-4 | ||||
Mattress 1-3 | ||||
Koran 1-3 | ||||
Religious books 1-3 | ||||
Styrofoam cups 1-3 | ||||
Prayer cap 1-3 | ||||
Washcloths 1-3 | ||||
Prayer beads 1-3 | ||||
Perfume/oil from Chaplain 1-3 | ||||
30–7. Interview Cells | ||||
(1) These cells were designed to provide security, | ||||
increased monitoring and improved privacy. They | ||||
allow detainees from the acute unit, non-acute unit or | ||||
general population to be transported and turned over to | ||||
Delta Block, Acute Unit and Behavioral Healthcare | ||||
staff for new or ongoing mental health evaluations. | ||||
(2) Detainees will be locked inside the cell but not | ||||
shackled while in the cell. | ||||
(3) The Unit Nurse will coordinate the use of escort | ||||
teams with Escort Control. The escort teams will report | ||||
to the Unit Nurse to ensure the teams understand any | ||||
standing limitations on the block and that local and | ||||
Camp SOP’s are followed. | ||||
(4) Detainees from Delta block MHF will be | ||||
escorted to the interview rooms by way of the rear | ||||
Sally Gate. The escort team will remain with the | ||||
detainee and ensure his safety and welfare. | ||||
(5) The Video Monitoring Room MP will make the | ||||
appropriate journal entry and monitor the interview | ||||
cells to alert the Block NCO and escort teams to any | ||||
possible problem. The Video Monitoring Room is not | ||||
a substitute for vigilance on the part of the escort team. | ||||
30-8. Restraints and Seclusion | ||||
I. PURPOSE | ||||
To publish policy and guidelines for use of medical | ||||
restraint and seclusion as a means of assisting a | ||||
detainee in regaining control of his behavior to protect | ||||
self, other detainees, guards and other staff. | ||||
II. BACKGROUND | ||||
a. It is the policy of Detention Hospital, JTF GTMO to | ||||
deliver proper and humane patient care to all detainees | ||||
while observing basic human rights. Use of restraint | ||||
temporarily restricts these rights. Restraint is used only | ||||
for detainees who are at imminent risk of harming | ||||
themselves or others. Restraint is to be used only after | ||||
other less restrictive interventions have proven | ||||
unsuccessful in efforts to control behavior. | ||||
b. Restraint cannot be ordered PRN (as needed). | ||||
c. When healthcare staff notes what they consider to | ||||
be improper use of restraints, jeopardizing the health of | ||||
a detainee, they communicate their concerns as soon as | ||||
possible to the Detention Hospital Officer in Charge | ||||
and the Detention Operations Center. | ||||
d. The Chief of Behavioral Health Services is to be | ||||
NOTIFIED/PAGED IMMEDIATELY ANY TIME A | ||||
DETAINEE IS RESTRAINED, in order to obtain a | ||||
formal order for restraints. | ||||
III. DEFINITIONS | ||||
a. Restraint: any method of physically restricting a | ||||
person’s movement, physical activity, or normal access | ||||
to his or her body. Restraint is considered involuntary | ||||
and is used as part of an approved protocol or as | ||||
indicated by an individual’s orders. | ||||
(1) Clinically-ordered restraints refer to measures | ||||
taken as part of a medical or mental health treatment, | ||||
which are designed to confine a patient’s bodily | ||||
movements, such as the use of leather cuffs and | ||||
anklets. | ||||
(2) Custody-ordered restraints are to be used only by | ||||
custody staff for security reasons. The health care staff | ||||
does not participate in the restraint of detainees ordered | ||||
by custody staff except for monitoring their health | ||||
status. | ||||
b. Seclusion: refers to the placement (by health | ||||
workers) of a patient in a bare room for the purpose of | ||||
containing a clinical situation (e.g. extreme agitation, | ||||
threatening behavior, assaultive behavior) that may | ||||
result in harm to self or others. | ||||
c. Observation. | ||||
(1) Close observation. Staff should observe such a | ||||
detainee at staggered intervals not to exceed every 15 | ||||
minutes. | ||||
(2) Constant observation. Staff should observe such a | ||||
detainee on a continuous, uninterrupted basis. Closed- | ||||
circuit television can be used as a supplement to, but | ||||
never a substitute for, such observation. | ||||
d. The standards do not apply to restraints imposed for | ||||
correctional reasons or seclusion used for involuntary | ||||
confinement for legally mandated but non-clinical | ||||
purposes, such as confining a person facing serious | ||||
criminal charges or serving a criminal sentence in a | ||||
locked room. | ||||
e. Licensed Independent Practitioner (LIP). For the | ||||
purposes of this directive, a clinician that is permitted | ||||
by law and by the hospital to provide detainee care | ||||
services without direction or supervision, within the | ||||
scope of the individual’s license and consistent with | ||||
individually granted clinical privileges. | ||||
IV. INDICATIONS | ||||
a. Restraint is indicated in the following situations: | ||||
(1) When a detainee is in imminent risk of injuring | ||||
self or others. | ||||
(2) A setting where the actions of such a detainee | ||||
impede timely and adequate delivery of necessary or | ||||
vital medical treatment. | ||||
b. Efforts must be made to determine and treat the | ||||
cause of the patient’s behavior necessitating restraint. | ||||
Restraint is not to be used as a substitute for direct | ||||
care, observation, or medical intervention. Restraint or | ||||
seclusion is not a form of discipline. | ||||
c. Prior to application of restraint appropriate | ||||
alternatives or less restrictive means must be | ||||
considered or attempted. Less restrictive measures | ||||
may include increasing detainee-to-staff interaction, | ||||
special watches, closer supervision, distraction, | ||||
medications, negotiation, problem solving, redirection, | ||||
removal from the area, and social conversation. At no | ||||
time will less restrictive measures justify endangering | ||||
other detainees, staff, guards or delay timely medical | ||||
treatment. | ||||
d. Removal of restraints is done in an orderly sequence, | ||||
4 point -> 3 point -> 2 point -> release, which allows | ||||
the detainee opportunity to regain and maintain internal | ||||
control. At no time will a detainee be restrained by | ||||
only one limb. Behavior to be evaluated for release | ||||
from restraints may include: | ||||
(1) The detainee is able to listen and follow directions | ||||
(2) The detainee agrees not to harm self or others | ||||
(3) There is no further verbal abuse or profanity | ||||
(4) The detainee exhibits calm behavior with no | ||||
attempts to fight or pull restraints | ||||
(5) There is clinical evidence that sedation has taken | ||||
effect | ||||
(6) There are visible and verbal signs that demonstrate | ||||
that agitation is resolved or greatly diminished | ||||
e. When restraint is terminated early and the same | ||||
behavior re-emerges, restraint may be reapplied under | ||||
the original order within the time limits of the order if | ||||
alternative means are not effective in controlling the | ||||
behavior. | ||||
V. PRACTICE AUTHORITY | ||||
A licensed independent practitioner orders the use of | ||||
medical restraints or seclusion. When the LIP is not | ||||
immediately available, a psychiatric nurse, a registered | ||||
nurse or a psychiatric technician may initiate the use of | ||||
restraint or seclusion before an order is obtained from | ||||
the LIP. As soon as possible, but no longer than one | ||||
hour after the initiation of restraint or seclusion, a | ||||
qualified registered nurse notifies and obtains an order | ||||
(verbal or written) from the LIP and consults with the | ||||
LIP about the patient’s physical and psychological | ||||
condition. | ||||
a. Attending Physician/Psychologist. The LIP who is | ||||
primarily responsible for the patient’s ongoing care, or | ||||
another LIP when the primary LIP is not available, | ||||
conducts an in-person evaluation of the patient within 4 | ||||
hours of the initiation of restraint or seclusion for | ||||
patients ages 16 and older and within 2 hours of | ||||
initiation for adolescents ages 15 and under. | ||||
At the time of the in-person evaluation, the LIP: | ||||
(1) Works with the patient and staff to identify ways to | ||||
help the patient regain control; | ||||
(2) Makes any necessary revisions to the patient’s | ||||
treatment plan; and | ||||
(3) If necessary, provides a new written order. | ||||
a. The LIP conducts an in-person evaluation of the | ||||
patient within 24 hours of the initiation of restraint or | ||||
seclusion, if the patient is no longer in restraint or | ||||
seclusion when an original verbal order expires. | ||||
b. Registered Nurse. Responsible for ongoing | ||||
observation of a restrained or secluded detainee, | ||||
assessment of the physical and emotional needs of the | ||||
detainee, re-evaluation of the need for continuation of | ||||
restraint or seclusion, documentation, and supervision | ||||
of hospital corps staff. | ||||
VI. CRITICAL ELEMENTS | ||||
a. Assessment of the detainee before, during and after | ||||
application of restraint must include the following: | ||||
(1) Behavioral Factors. | ||||
(a) Contrast observed behavior to previous | ||||
behavior. Compare to baseline if known. | ||||
(b) Evaluate for specific behaviors such as | ||||
impulsiveness, high energy levels, and self-neglect. | ||||
(2) Mental Status Factors. | ||||
(a) Look for cognitive impairments such as deficits | ||||
in attention, memory, or ability to follow simple one, | ||||
two, or three-step commands. | ||||
(b) Evaluate comprehension and ability to follow | ||||
instructions and treatment plan. | ||||
(c) Consider ability to interpret the environment | ||||
accurately and the level of perceptual or sensory | ||||
distortion. | ||||
(d) Assess for the presence of psychotic symptoms, | ||||
such as hallucinations or delusions. | ||||
(e) Assess judgment to determine if it is adequate, | ||||
limited, or impaired. | ||||
(3) Biological Factors. | ||||
(a) Consider medication. | ||||
(b) Consider the potential side effects or potentiation | ||||
of adverse effects when medications are combined. | ||||
(c) Consider electrolyte disturbances, hematological | ||||
deficits, hypoxia, dehydration, liver or kidney failure, | ||||
thyroid dysfunction or other metabolic disturbances. | ||||
(d) Consider extreme physical debilitation with age | ||||
or illness. | ||||
(4) Environmental Factors. | ||||
(a) Consider noise level, inadequate or excessive | ||||
light, over stimulation from multiple strangers in the | ||||
patient’s environment, and changes in diet. | ||||
b. Application of restraint is done in a humane manner | ||||
that affords the detainee as much dignity and safety as | ||||
possible. Guard staff applying the restraint will be | ||||
knowledgeable in the use of this intervention, familiar | ||||
with the equipment and trained in the application, | ||||
monitoring and release protocols. Detainees will be | ||||
restrained for medical purposes in specially designed | ||||
cells located on the Delta Behavioral Healthcare | ||||
Service unit. When these are not available, for | ||||
example if all available safety cells are occupied, then | ||||
detainees requiring restraint or seclusion will be | ||||
restrained in other cells located in the BHS unit. If in | ||||
extreme circumstances, no cells are available on the | ||||
BHS unit, detainees will be restrained in cells 1 and 48, | ||||
of the closest available cellblocks. All detainees who | ||||
are in restraints will be placed on constant observation | ||||
by medical personnel who have been trained on | ||||
restraint monitoring procedures. Medical personnel | ||||
will document the detainee’s behavior every 15 | ||||
minutes. All detainees placed in seclusion will be | ||||
placed on close observation and observed by medical | ||||
personnel; after the first hour, guard personnel using | ||||
video equipment may continuously monitor a detainee | ||||
in seclusion. . When considering restraints always: | ||||
(1) Attempt less restrictive measures first. | ||||
(2) If less restrictive measures are ineffective, assemble | ||||
adequate staff and guards to complete the restraint. | ||||
(3) Restraints will be used per manufacturer’s | ||||
instructions. | ||||
(4) Apply restraint to the appropriate body part. Do not | ||||
apply restraint to only the lower limbs or to only one | ||||
limb due to risk of injury. Allow whatever freedom of | ||||
movement is possible while achieving the desired | ||||
effect. Maintain proper body alignment and ensure | ||||
patient comfort. | ||||
(5) When placing a compliant/cooperative detainee in | ||||
4-point restraints the following plan will be closely | ||||
adhered to: | ||||
The detainee is escorted to the restraint room in a | ||||
three-piece suit. | ||||
The detainee is placed in the prone position on the | ||||
restraint table. | ||||
Soft restraints are applied to the legs first. The legs are | ||||
restrained to the end of the restraint table, not the sides. | ||||
This limits the detainee’s ability to injure himself or | ||||
others. Do not remove the shackles yet. | ||||
The left hand is restrained next. The detainee is rolled | ||||
on his right side and the hand is un-shackled. A soft | ||||
restraint is applied and the hand is secured to the | ||||
restraint table at the detainee’s waist level. | ||||
The right hand is restrained next. The detainee is | ||||
rolled slightly on his left side and the shackle removed. | ||||
The soft restraint is applied and the right hand is | ||||
secured to the restraint table above the detainee’s | ||||
head/shoulder level. | ||||
The restraints are double locked. | ||||
Leg shackles are then removed. | ||||
The belly chain is unlocked, and then removed. | ||||
Behavior Healthcare Staff must evaluate the detainee to | ||||
ensure proper circulation and correct detainee body | ||||
alignment prior to securing the restraint room door. | ||||
If the detainee continues to act out or continues to be a | ||||
danger to himself, a fifth-point can be applied. The | ||||
canvas belt is run under the restraint table and under | ||||
the left arm of the detainee then through hard point on | ||||
the table. The wide canvas portion of the fifth-point is | ||||
aligned over the detainee’s shoulder blades and then | ||||
“snugged.” Be very cautious not to restrict the | ||||
detainees breathing. The fifth-point functions to stop | ||||
the detainee from striking his head on the restraint | ||||
table. | ||||
It is understood that an uncooperative detainee will be | ||||
placed in restraints in the most expeditious and safety | ||||
conscious manner. Soldier safety is paramount. But | ||||
the above listed steps should be followed as closely as | ||||
possible while restraining a combative detainee. | ||||
c. Monitoring and Patient Care. | ||||
(1) The monitoring process addresses physical and | ||||
emotional needs of the detainee. This monitoring | ||||
includes simple observation, vital signs, circulation | ||||
checks, observation of the extremities, range of motion, | ||||
emotional and physical response to restraint, food, | ||||
hydration, and toileting needs. Other monitoring will | ||||
be done, as needed based on individual needs. | ||||
(2) Detainee Care Minimum Intervals. | ||||
(a) Constant Observation. Medical personnel will | ||||
constantly observe a detainee in restraints. | ||||
(b) Every 15 minutes. Medical personnel will | ||||
monitor detainees in seclusion every 15 minutes for the | ||||
first hour of seclusion, thereafter, if clinically indicated | ||||
the detainee, in medical seclusion, can be monitored | ||||
via video by guard personnel. | ||||
(c) Every One Hour. Circulation Checks of each | ||||
restrained limb. | ||||
(d) Every Two Hours. | ||||
-Fluids must be offered, or more frequently as | ||||
requested. | ||||
-Restroom use must be offered, or more frequently | ||||
as indicated. If the detainee is combative or | ||||
unpredictable, a plastic bedpan and/or urinal must be | ||||
provided for use. | ||||
-Restraints must be removed from each limb, one at | ||||
a time, to perform range of motion exercises at least | ||||
this frequently. | ||||
-For detainees in seclusion, medical personnel will | ||||
physically observe the detainee. | ||||
(e) Every Four Hours. | ||||
-Vital Signs | ||||
-Meals must be served at regular meal times using | ||||
paper and plastic products. | ||||
(f) Detainees will not be removed from restraints to | ||||
go to shower and exercise call. Do to the unique nature | ||||
and dynamic situation, taking a detainee out of | ||||
restraints for shower and exercise then returning to | ||||
restraints is counter productive. The intent of | ||||
restraining the detainee is to secure him from further | ||||
self-injurious behavior or until he can gain control of | ||||
himself, placing a detainee in a shower or exercise yard | ||||
would only serve to further exacerbate the situation. | ||||
(g) Other Interventions. | ||||
-Extra staff and security can be called to assist with | ||||
detainee care, as needed to maintain detainee and staff | ||||
safety. | ||||
-An RN or Psychiatric Technician will assess the | ||||
detainee’s behavior for release from restraint as soon as | ||||
the detainee demonstrates that internal control has been | ||||
regained. | ||||
-The OIC, Detention Hospital, will be notified | ||||
when detainees are restrained or secluded for longer | ||||
than 12 hours. Thereafter the OIC will be notified | ||||
every 24 hours if the restraint or seclusion continues. | ||||
Detainees remaining in restraint or seclusion for 72 | ||||
continuous hours or more than four times in any seven- | ||||
day period will be monitored through a meeting of the | ||||
responsible LIP, nursing, and corps staff to consider | ||||
alternative approaches, such as: changing clinical | ||||
treatment plan, changing medications or doses; and/or | ||||
utilizing different behavioral interventions. | ||||
d. Documentation. | ||||
(1) The documentation requirement for a detainee | ||||
requiring restraint must incorporate the critical | ||||
elements of assessment, application and monitoring, | ||||
and reflect concern for the detainee’s human needs and | ||||
preservation of dignity. | ||||
(2) Each time a restraint is applied or seclusion | ||||
initiated the following will be documented by an RN or | ||||
Corpsman: | ||||
(a) Time and date restraint is applied. | ||||
(b) The detainee’s behavior, verbalization or actions | ||||
that lead to the need for external control. | ||||
(c) The types of less restrictive intervention that | ||||
were attempted before restraint was applied and the | ||||
detainee’s response to these less restrictive measures. | ||||
(d) The detainee’s response to the restraint. | ||||
(e) The name and rank/rate of the staff member who | ||||
placed the detainee into restraint or seclusion. | ||||
(3) A note by an RN or Corpsman must be | ||||
documented every 2 hours containing the following: | ||||
(a) The detainee’s condition and continued need for | ||||
restraint or seclusion. | ||||
(b) The plan for assisting the detainee to regain | ||||
control and move to a less restrictive environment. | ||||
(c) The detainee status of hygiene, nutrition and | ||||
safety maintenance. | ||||
VII. DOCTOR’S ORDER | ||||
a. THE USE OF PRN ORDERS WHETHER | ||||
INDIVIDUAL OR AS PART OF A | ||||
PROTOCOL FOR DETAINEES WITH | ||||
PRIMARY BEHAVIORAL HEALTH | ||||
NEEDS IS PROHIBITED. | ||||
b. A doctor’s order for restraint or seclusion must be | ||||
written or verbally obtained from the LIP within one | ||||
hour of initiating restraint, and if verbal, must be | ||||
signed within 4 hours. All orders for restraint are “time | ||||
limited.” The LIP who is primarily responsible for the | ||||
patient’s ongoing care, or another LIP when the | ||||
primary LIP is not available, conducts an in-person | ||||
evaluation of the patient within 4 hours of the initiation | ||||
of restraint or seclusion for patients ages 16 and older | ||||
and within 2 hours of initiation for adolescents ages 15 | ||||
and under. | ||||
(1) Restraint and Seclusion orders for detainees with | ||||
primary behavioral health needs are valid for 4 hours | ||||
for patients 16 and older, 2 hours for adolescents 15 or | ||||
under. | ||||
(2) Reevaluation of the patient in Restraint or | ||||
Seclusion. By the time the order for restraint or | ||||
seclusion expires, the patient receives an in-person | ||||
reevaluation conducted by the LIP primarily | ||||
responsible for the patient, another LIP when the | ||||
primary LIP is not readily available or a registered | ||||
nurse. In conjunction with the reevaluation of the | ||||
patient, a new written or verbal order is given by the | ||||
LIP and is time limited per paragraph VII, b. (1). A | ||||
LIP conducts an in-person reevaluation at least every 8 | ||||
hours for patients 16 and older and every 4 hours for | ||||
adolescents 15 and under. | ||||
(3) The initial Doctor’s Note detailing the use of | ||||
restraints can reflect: | ||||
(a) The behavior the detainee displayed necessitating | ||||
restraint. | ||||
(b)All lower level interventions attempted prior to | ||||
the detainee being restrained. | ||||
(c) The detainee’s response to restraint. | ||||
(d)Plans for assisting the detainee to regain control. | ||||
VIII. TRAINING | ||||
a. Initial and ongoing training on restraint and | ||||
seclusion for block personnel will be conducted as | ||||
needed by the Behavioral Healthcare Service and | ||||
Block NCOIC. | ||||
IX. PERFORMANCE IMPROVEMENT. | ||||
Seclusion and Restraint is a difficult, high-risk patient | ||||
care intervention. Review of policies and procedures | ||||
should occur no less than annually. After each incident | ||||
an After Action Review will take place. This is the | ||||
ideal forum to address issues and resolve shortcomings. | ||||
30-9. Video Monitoring Station | ||||
a. The video monitoring station will be manned by one | ||||
guard at all times when there is a least one detainee on | ||||
the acute section of delta block, this includes detainees | ||||
in the acute, restraint, seclusion or interview cells. | ||||
b. The guard on video monitoring duty will not be | ||||
given any other tasks nor distracted from his or her | ||||
primary duty of video observation. | ||||
c. The guard on video monitoring will have a means of | ||||
communication (e.g. radio) readily available to contact | ||||
the guards standing duty or watch on the acute section | ||||
floor regarding any concerning behavior. | ||||
d. Documentation of behavior for those detainees on | ||||
Self-Harm Precautions will be completed by the guard | ||||
assigned to the video monitoring station, every 15 | ||||
minutes. | ||||
e. Guards on video monitoring will be rotated at an | ||||
interval not to exceed every two hours. They must be | ||||
taken off monitoring duty for a minimum of 30 minutes | ||||
before being allowed to return to duty at the monitoring | ||||
station. | ||||
f. The Video Monitoring Position will not be used as a | ||||
place to employ soldiers on profile, or those otherwise | ||||
unable to perform the regular duties of a block guard. | ||||
30-10. Detainee Behavioral Management Matrix | ||||
Detainees with mental illnesses often present | ||||
behaviors that are very difficult to manage. They often | ||||
have poor impulse control, ineffective coping skills and | ||||
may be at an increased risk for self-injurious behaviors. | ||||
The Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block Behavior | ||||
Management Matrix takes this into consideration. The | ||||
matrix is intended to assist the detainee in maintaining | ||||
appropriate behavior and to facilitate consistency | ||||
between the MP’s and Behavioral Healthcare Service | ||||
staff. | ||||
a. When a detainee assigned to Delta Block commits a | ||||
camp rule infraction, or an offense listed in Delta | ||||
Block Behavior Management matrix, the Block NCO | ||||
and the Behavioral Healthcare Staff will be notified. | ||||
b. The Block NCO in conjunction with Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare staff will: | ||||
(1) Review Delta Block Behavior Management matrix | ||||
and locate the offense on the list. If the offense is not | ||||
listed, attempt to categorize a similar offense, or an | ||||
offense of comparable severity to the offense | ||||
committed by the detainee. | ||||
(2) Review the discipline record of the detainee to | ||||
determine the detainee’s previous discipline history. | ||||
(3) Behavioral Healthcare Service staff will review | ||||
the detainee’s medical and psych history. | ||||
(4) General population behavioral management. | ||||
a. Once a detainee has been accessed by Psych | ||||
personnel and the behavior is determined to be | ||||
manuptilutive, and/or malingering in nature, Psych | ||||
personnel may or may not transfer the detainee to Delta | ||||
block. In the event the detainee remains in general | ||||
population, Psych personnel will make the | ||||
determination to remove items specified in MFR for a | ||||
minimum of 5 days. | ||||
b. If Comfort items and/or Basic issue items are | ||||
removed and the detainee remains in general | ||||
population, Psych personnel will submit an MFR | ||||
through the DOC, in order to track the date for return | ||||
of it in DIMS. | ||||
c. Psych personnel will monitor detainee’s condition | ||||
during the Basic issue and/or Comfort item removal | ||||
period. | ||||
(5) Block NCO, in conjunction with Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare Service staff, will formulate a plan of | ||||
corrective action based on the Delta Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare Block Behavior Management Matrix that | ||||
addresses the detainee’s behavior. Mental Health | ||||
considerations will be taken into account when the | ||||
detainee’s clinical state has affected the detainee’s | ||||
judgment to the extent that disciplinary measures | ||||
would be felt inappropriate or would be contradictory | ||||
to the detainees written clinical treatment plan. | ||||
(a) If several offenses were committed at the same | ||||
time, do not add all discipline measures together to | ||||
determine the discipline. Instead, use the severity level | ||||
of the highest severity level offense committed to | ||||
determine the discipline number on the grid. | ||||
(b) When a behavior management measure is applied | ||||
to a detainee, he will be notified of the reason for the | ||||
measure, the type of behavior management measure | ||||
and the length of time this is to be in effect. | ||||
(c) The Block NCO is responsible for updating the | ||||
Delta Block Status Report when changes are made in a | ||||
detainee’s status (i.e. loss/reward of Comfort Items or | ||||
change in level). The Delta Block Status Report will | ||||
be posted at both ends of Delta Block and in the | ||||
Nurse’s Station. | ||||
Delta Block Behavior Management Matrix | ||||
Offense Category | ||||
Provoking words or gestures I | ||||
Possession of contraband (i.e. food, etc) I | ||||
Unauthorized communication (i.e. | ||||
Yelling or disturbing the block) | ||||
I | ||||
Flooding cellblock I | ||||
Failure to follow camp rules (i.e. | ||||
Tampering with the cameras) | ||||
II | ||||
Failure to follow MP instructions II | ||||
Conveying a threat II | ||||
Damage to property II | ||||
Tampering with locks or restraints III | ||||
Possession of a key III | ||||
Throw/spit at/on another person * III | ||||
Exposure of self for sexual gratification III | ||||
Assault (i.e. Hostile act or threat) IV | ||||
Inciting a riot IV | ||||
Possession of dangerous contraband (i.e. | ||||
Shank, club, other dangerous item) | ||||
IV | ||||
Fighting IV | ||||
Bribery/attempted bribery IV | ||||
Sexual relations IV | ||||
Attempted escape IV | ||||
Throw urine/feces at/on another * V | ||||
Aggravated assault (object or weapon | ||||
used) | ||||
V | ||||
Battery (aggravated or otherwise) V | ||||
Escape V | ||||
* MP and Behavioral Health staff that have had saliva, | ||||
urine or feces spit/thrown to non-intact skin or in the | ||||
eyes/mouth will complete a Blood/Body Fluids | ||||
Exposure (SF600 overprint) located in the Delta Block | ||||
nurse’s station and report to the JAS within 24 hours | ||||
for further evaluation and treatment as per Detention | ||||
Hospital SOP. Blood to blood exposure requires the | ||||
individual to immediately report to the JAS with the | ||||
Blood/Body Fluids Exposure form. | ||||
Behavioral Health staff will evaluate the clinical need | ||||
for Seclusion / Restraint. If indicated, the on-call | ||||
provider will be notified. See Section 30-7. | ||||
Category Behavior Management Measure | ||||
I Loss of Comfort Items x 1 day (except for | ||||
basic issue items listed on the comfort | ||||
items sheet.) | ||||
II Loss of Comfort Items x 2 days (except for | ||||
basic issue items listed on the comfort | ||||
items sheet.) | ||||
III Loss of Comfort Items x 3 days (except for | ||||
basic issue items listed on the comfort | ||||
items sheet.) Drop of one level. | ||||
IV Loss of Comfort Items x 10 days (except | ||||
for basic issue items listed on the comfort | ||||
items sheet.) Drop of two levels. | ||||
V Loss of Comfort Items x 15 days (except | ||||
for basic issue items listed on the comfort | ||||
items sheet.) Automatic drop to Level IV. | ||||
Category I – III offenses will be documented on a | ||||
GTMO 508 and maintained by the Block NCO. If a | ||||
drop in level is indicated, the new level will be in effect | ||||
for 30 days. Increases in level may be earned after 30 | ||||
days with no infractions. | ||||
If a weapon or other items were used in the offense, | ||||
they will be documented on the Evidence/Property | ||||
Custody document (DA 4137) and forwarded to DOC. | ||||
The on-call Behavioral Health provider will be notified | ||||
of the offense and will determine whether the clinical | ||||
state of the detainee has affected his judgment to the | ||||
extent that disciplinary measures would be | ||||
inappropriate or contradictory to the detainee’s written | ||||
clinical treatment plan. | ||||
(d) The determination of behavior management | ||||
measure and a plan for its implementation will be | ||||
completed in a timely manner, not to exceed three | ||||
hours from the time of the infraction. | ||||
(e) Detainees assigned to Delta MHF will not be | ||||
transferred to segregation. The Segregation Units are | ||||
currently not capable of meeting the unique needs of | ||||
Delta Block detainees. | ||||
(f) The Block NCO, in conjunction with On-Duty | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare Service Officer, will approve all | ||||
discipline measures and will check the “recommended” | ||||
block of the GTMO Form 508, and sign as witness and | ||||
individual notifying detainee. | ||||
(g) Notification to the chain of command will be made | ||||
for any situations involving unusual circumstances, and | ||||
for any use of force beyond use of verbal direction or | ||||
show of force. | ||||
(h) Do not confiscate or provide any comfort item | ||||
unless it is for discipline, self-harm, or at the direction | ||||
of Behavioral Healthcare Service staff, per SOP, or at | ||||
the direction of the Block NCO. | ||||
h. When comfort items are taken from a detainee they | ||||
will be placed in a box over the detainee’s cell. Wet | ||||
items will not be placed in the detainees box until they | ||||
are dry. The outside of the box will be marked with the | ||||
detainee’s ISN. Items will not be returned to the | ||||
detainee until the length of discipline is completed or at | ||||
the written direction of Behavioral Healthcare Service | ||||
staff. | ||||
30-11. Oleoresin Capsicum (OC) Use | ||||
a. Due to the unique nature and requirements of the | ||||
Delta Behavioral Healthcare Block, the permanently | ||||
assigned Delta Block NCOs are authorized to carry and | ||||
utilize OC to intervene in acts of self-harm. | ||||
b. The use of OC will only be used to stop a detainee | ||||
committing acts deemed to be an immediate threat to | ||||
the detainee’s well being. | ||||
c. Prior to utilizing OC, coordination will be made | ||||
with Behavioral Health Staff whenever feasible so that | ||||
a follow on plan is established for the detainee. This | ||||
will normally consist of decontamination and | ||||
movement to a restraint or seclusion cell within the | ||||
Delta Acute Block. | ||||
d. Should prior coordination not be feasible due to | ||||
exigent circumstances, the Block NCO will notify the | ||||
Behavioral Health staff at the earliest opportunity. | ||||
e. Detainees will be secured and decontaminated | ||||
following any use of OC. The detainee will be secured | ||||
in a three-piece suit and escort to the exercise yard for | ||||
decontamination. | ||||
f. The use of OC will be reported to the on-duty CO. | ||||
g. The Block NCO will complete a sworn statement | ||||
concerning the use of OC spray. The company | ||||
commander will subsequently complete actions as | ||||
required in the notification matrix (SPOTREP to JOC, | ||||
blotter entry, and Incident Report completed). | ||||
h. If feasible, prior to the use of OC, the brevity code | ||||
should be transmitted via radio communication to the | ||||
DOC and ON-Duty CO. If the situation dictates, the | ||||
brevity codes will be called IMMEDIATELY after OC | ||||
is used and the detainee is out of imminent danger. | ||||
30-12. Shower and Exercise | ||||
a. Delta Block will utilize the following schedule for | ||||
shower and exercise. | ||||
MORNING AFTERNOON | ||||
SUNDAY NONE NONE | ||||
MONDAY D1-D8 D9-D16 | ||||
TUESDAY D17-D22 DA1-DA17 | ||||
WEDNESDAY D1-D8 D9-D16 | ||||
THURSDAY D17-D22 DA1-DA17 | ||||
FRIDAY D1-D8 | ||||
LEVEL I | ||||
D9-D16 | ||||
LEVEL I | ||||
SATURDAY D17-D22 | ||||
LEVEL I | ||||
DA1-DA17 | ||||
LEVEL I | ||||
b. Shower and exercise call will be conducted in | ||||
conjunction with each other. The Block NCO will be | ||||
responsible for ensuring all Level 1 detainee’s receive | ||||
shower and exercise three times per week and each | ||||
Level 2, 3, and 4 detainees receive shower and exercise | ||||
twice per week, unless the detainee is on disciplinary | ||||
measures that include no exercise. | ||||
c. Allow each detainee 30 minutes for exercise. Allow | ||||
five minutes to shower immediately after exercise. | ||||
d. Delta Block detainees on self-harm precautions | ||||
WILL NOT be given a razor to remove body hair. If it | ||||
is determined the detainee is authorized use of a razor | ||||
the below guideline will be followed. | ||||
(1) The detainee will receive a safety razor. | ||||
(2) The guard will monitor “eyes on” the detainee at | ||||
all times while in possession of the razor. Block | ||||
personnel will ensure the razor is returned, intact as | ||||
soon as the detainee has completed shaving. | ||||
(3) An additional five minutes will be given for the | ||||
detainee to remove body hair. | ||||
(4) Only allow shaving of body hair on the first | ||||
rotation of each week (Monday and Tuesday). | ||||
(5) At no time will a detainee be in possession of both | ||||
a razor and nail clippers. Nail clippers will be given in | ||||
the shower only. | ||||
(6) All detainees are authorized the use of a comb. | ||||
Combs will be issued during shower and accounted for | ||||
and returned prior to the detainee returning to his cell. | ||||
The comb will be placed in a zip-lock bag and | ||||
maintained in the detainees cell file. The detainees | ||||
ISN will be printed on the outside of the plastic bag. | ||||
Detainees are not permitted to share a comb as this | ||||
presents a hygiene issue. | ||||
(7) Ensure the razor is returned, intact, as soon as the | ||||
detainee has completed shaving. | ||||
(8) In the event the detainee has damaged the razor | ||||
the Block NCO will immediately be notified. A | ||||
thorough search of the shower area and the detainee | ||||
will be conducted. The supervising guard will | ||||
complete a DA 2823; Sworn Statement, for | ||||
disciplinary measures. The damaged razor will be | ||||
collected and a DA 4137; Evidence/Property Custody | ||||
Document, will be completed by the supervising guard. | ||||
The Block NCO will be responsible for ensuring the | ||||
proper forms are filed out correctly. | ||||
(9) At not time will a detainee, with a razor, be | ||||
permitted to overly obstruct the view of the supervising | ||||
guard (i.e. towel, shirt) beyond the detainee’s cultural | ||||
need for modesty. This will be a judgment decision for | ||||
the block guard. | ||||
(10) In the event the detainee refuses to return the | ||||
razor, or the razor is returned damaged and the blade, | ||||
or part of the blade, is missing the DOC, CO, and | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare Service staff will immediately | ||||
be notified. The minimum amount of force will be | ||||
used to regain possession of the razor. | ||||
e. During shower and exercise, female MP’s can | ||||
escort detainees to the rear of the block., However, | ||||
female MP will not enter the shower and exercise area. | ||||
In the event of an emergency, the Block OIC, NCOIC, | ||||
or senior MP can over ride this policy on the block at | ||||
the time of the emergency. | ||||
f. Track refusals in DIMS. | ||||
g. Search the refusing detainee’s cell. | ||||
h. No detainee may perform hand-to-hand combat or | ||||
martial arts type PT, either organized or individually, | ||||
in the exercise yard or their cell. | ||||
i. Amputees will receive their normal exercise time | ||||
and any additional time if prescribed by a doctor. | ||||
Detainees who use a walker may take the walker with | ||||
them to the exercise yard. | ||||
j. Level 1 detainees will be taken to and from the | ||||
shower and exercise yard in handcuffs secured by a | ||||
waist belt (Velcro restraints). They will not have leg | ||||
irons placed on them. | ||||
k. Detainees may be shackled in the standing position. | ||||
In the event a detainee is not shackled in the standing | ||||
position the Block NCO will be responsible to ensure | ||||
the incident is documented by DA Form 2823 and | ||||
entered into DIMS. | ||||
l. Fingernail length will not exceed the finger-tip. In | ||||
the event a detainee on self-harm precautions is in | ||||
violation of this policy the following procedure will be | ||||
followed: | ||||
(1) The detainee will be shackled in a three- piece | ||||
suit. | ||||
(2) 2 MP escort team will escort he detainee to a | ||||
restraint room. | ||||
(3) The detainee will be issued the nail clippers by | ||||
the Block NCO, while the 2 person MP escort team | ||||
maintains positive control of the detainee. The Three- | ||||
piece suit will not be removed until the detainee is | ||||
returned to his cell. | ||||
30-13. Dispensing of Prescribed Medication and | ||||
Medical Sick call Procedures | ||||
a. Detainees on Delta Block who have prescribed | ||||
medications will have those medications dispensed to | ||||
them by Behavioral Healthcare Service staff certified | ||||
in medication administration. BHS staff will ensure | ||||
appropriate actions are taken to prevent cheeking of | ||||
medications. All medication refusals will be | ||||
documented and brought to the attention of the Unit | ||||
Nurse. In the case of psychotropic medications the | ||||
psychiatrist will be contacted within two days of the | ||||
initial refusal; for non-psychiatric medications the unit | ||||
nurse will contact the medical clinic nurse or physician | ||||
for further guidance. | ||||
b. The Block NCO will ensure that all detainees with | ||||
medical/physical complaints are placed on the Medical | ||||
Sick call List in DIMS by 0600 each morning. | ||||
Detainees may be evaluated/treated either in their cell | ||||
or transported to the Delta Medical Clinic at the | ||||
discretion of the Medical staff. | ||||
c. For medical issues of a non-routine nature the Unit | ||||
Nurse may contact the psychiatrist. | ||||
d. For medical issues of an acute or potentially serious | ||||
nature the Unit Nurse will coordinate transfer to the | ||||
medical clinic where adequate medical triage can be | ||||
performed. | ||||
e. Under no circumstances will GF personnel dispense | ||||
any form of medication. | ||||
30-14. Medical Records | ||||
a. Medical Records for detainees housed on Delta | ||||
Behavioral Healthcare Block will be kept in the | ||||
Nurse’s Station. | ||||
(1) If a particular detainee requires medical care at | ||||
Delta Medical Clinic or Detention Hospital, the | ||||
Medical Record will be delivered to the clinic by BHS | ||||
staff. | ||||
(2) The Medical Record will be returned to Delta | ||||
Block by BHS or Medical staff. The Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare RN will transcribe any necessary doctor’s | ||||
orders. | ||||
b. Medical Records for detainees on Behavioral | ||||
Healthcare Service, but not housed on Delta Block, | ||||
will remain at the Delta Medical Clinic. | ||||
(1) All Behavioral Healthcare documentation will be | ||||
kept in a convenience record on Delta Block. | ||||
(2) The Medical Record will be annotated, on the | ||||
Summary of Care form, to indicate that a particular | ||||
detainee is on Behavioral Healthcare Service and that a | ||||
convenience record exists on Delta Block. | ||||
(3) Behavioral Healthcare Service staff will obtain the | ||||
Medical Record from the Delta Medical Clinic if | ||||
needed for Psychological evaluations or for Treatment | ||||
Team meetings. | ||||
30-15. Combat Stress Reactions | ||||
Guard or behavioral healthcare staff exhibiting signs | ||||
or symptoms of combat stress reactions will be referred | ||||
to the Combat Stress Control team. DH behavioral | ||||
healthcare staff will provide no treatment beyond | ||||
normal unit leadership. | ||||
After a Serious Incident, leadership on the block | ||||
should evaluate the circumstances surrounding the | ||||
situation to determine if Combat Stress should be | ||||
notified for soldier counseling. | ||||
30-16. Interpreters | ||||
Every effort will be made to consolidate visits by | ||||
interpreters through coordination between guard and | ||||
behavioral healthcare staff. | ||||
Intentionally left blank | ||||
Chapter 31 | Chapter 31 | |||
Supply Operations | Supply Operations | |||
31-1. Waste Disposal | 31-1. Waste Disposal | |||
a. Kvaerner is scheduled to pick up trash seven days | a. Kvaerner is scheduled to pick up trash seven days | |||
a week. Dumpsters for Camps 1 and 2 are located next | a week. Dumpsters for Camps 1 and 2 are located next | |||
to Sally Port 7. Dumpsters for Camp IV are located | to Sally Port 7. Dumpsters for Camp IV are located | |||
near the Detention Hospital. If trash is not picked up | near the Detention Hospital. If trash is not picked up | |||
according to schedule, report it to the JDOG S-4 or call | according to schedule, report it to the JDOG S-4 or call | |||
the contractor helpdesk at X-4424. | the contractor helpdesk at X-4424. | |||
skipping to change at line 11117 | skipping to change at line 13360 | |||
will forward the request on to the JDOG S-4. | will forward the request on to the JDOG S-4. | |||
b. The OIC of each section must sign each request | b. The OIC of each section must sign each request | |||
before it is submitted to the JDOG S-4. | before it is submitted to the JDOG S-4. | |||
c. When a supply requests is filled for the JDOG S- | c. When a supply requests is filled for the JDOG S- | |||
3, the supplies will be brought to the Camp Delta | 3, the supplies will be brought to the Camp Delta | |||
supply room. The Detention Services Branch will be | supply room. The Detention Services Branch will be | |||
notified when the supplies are delivered. | notified when the supplies are delivered. | |||
31-4. Computer Requests | 31-4. Computer Requests | |||
All requests for computers will follow the same | All requests for computers will follow the same | |||
process as supplies. | process as supplies. | |||
31-5. MRE Sanitization | ||||
a. Supply personnel will sanitize MREs prior to | ||||
delivery to Camp Delta. Each MRE will have items | ||||
removed from them that are considered harmful to the | ||||
waste disposal system of Camp Delta. | ||||
b. Detainees will be fed one of four MREs. The | ||||
MREs are numbers 11, 12, 13, and 14. | ||||
c. Below is a list of the contents of the MREs that | ||||
must remain in each MRE. | ||||
(1) For MRE #11, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers (wrapped) | ||||
(b) Pound Cake (wrapped) | ||||
(c) Spoon (without plastic wrapper) | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter (wrapped) | ||||
(e) Pasta with Vegetables in Tomato Sauce | ||||
(wrapped in packet, no cardboard) | ||||
(f) Peaches (wrapped) | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix (wrapped) | ||||
(h) Toilet paper with brown wrapper | ||||
(i) Salt packet | ||||
(j) Moist Towelette | ||||
(2) For MRE #12, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers (wrapped) | ||||
(b) Pound Cake (wrapped) | ||||
(c) Spoon (without plastic wrapper) | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter (wrapped) | ||||
(e) Black Bean and Rice Burrito (wrapped) | ||||
(f) Pears (wrapped) | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix (wrapped) | ||||
(h) Toilet paper with brown wrapper | ||||
(i) Salt packet | ||||
(j) Moist Towelette | ||||
(k) Fruit Bar | ||||
(3) For MRE #13, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers (wrapped) | ||||
(b) Pound Cake (wrapped) | ||||
(c) Spoon (without plastic wrapper) | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter (wrapped) | ||||
(e) Cheese Tortellini in Tomato Sauce (wrapped) | ||||
(f) Applesauce (wrapped) | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix (wrapped) | ||||
(h) Toilet paper with brown wrapper | ||||
(i) Salt packet | ||||
(j) Moist Towelette | ||||
(4) For MRE #14, the following items will be in | ||||
the MRE pouch: | ||||
(a) Crackers (wrapped) | ||||
(b) Pound Cake (wrapped) | ||||
(c) Spoon (without plastic wrapper) | ||||
(d) Peanut Butter (wrapped) | ||||
(e) Pasta with Vegetables in Alfredo Style Sauce | ||||
(wrapped) | ||||
(f) Peaches (wrapped) | ||||
(g) Ice tea drink mix (wrapped) | ||||
(h) Toilet paper with brown wrapper | ||||
(i) Salt packet | ||||
(j) Moist Towelette | ||||
(k) Fruit Bar | ||||
(j) Peanuts, shelled roasted (wrapped). | ||||
31-6. Equipment Turn-In | ||||
a. All items on the DA 3161 must be turned-in and | ||||
may not be discarded. If discarded without | ||||
documenting the disposal, the individual will become | ||||
financially liable for the equipment. | ||||
b. Turn-in of equipment on the DA 3161 will follow | ||||
the this procedure if no replacement is readily available | ||||
from the supply room: | ||||
(1) The individual turning in the equipment | ||||
creates a DA 2062 with the item to be turned in on it. | ||||
(2) The individual takes the DA 2062 and the | ||||
item to the turn-in point and the turn-in point signs for | ||||
receipt of the equipment. | ||||
(3) The supply room will direct where to place | ||||
put the inoperable equipment. | ||||
(4) The DA 2062 is then copied. The original | ||||
will go with the DA 3161 for that post and the soldier | ||||
responsible for the post will keep the copy in the event | ||||
the original is lost. | ||||
(5) When a replacement arrives, the supply room | ||||
will be given the original DA 2062. If the original does | ||||
not exist, the copy must be given to them. | ||||
c. Turn-in of equipment on the DA 3161 will follow | ||||
the this procedure if a replacement is readily available | ||||
from the supply room: | ||||
(1) The item to be turned in will be taken to the | ||||
supply room. | ||||
(2) The supply room will give an equivalent item | ||||
to the individual. | ||||
(3) No paperwork is required. | ||||
d. The following is a list of special equipment that | ||||
is on a DA 3161 that will not be turned in to the supply | ||||
room: | ||||
(1) Computers | ||||
(2) Mag-lites | ||||
(3) Power Supply | ||||
(4) Pass-on Books | ||||
(5) Locks | ||||
(6) Metal Detectors | ||||
(7) Radios | ||||
(8) Surge Protector | ||||
(9) Radio Batteries | ||||
(10) Air Conditioner Remotes | ||||
(11) Radio Battery Charger | ||||
(12) Shackles | ||||
(13) Hand Cuffs | ||||
(14) Waist Belts | ||||
(15) Keys | ||||
e. All locks, shackles, handcuffs, waist belts, and | ||||
keys will be turned into the Detention Operations | ||||
NCO. | ||||
f. All computers will be left in place if inoperable. | ||||
DOC is to file a trouble ticket with the SysAdmin of | ||||
the JDOG DSB. If the SysAdmin position is not filled, | ||||
the request will be sent to J-6. | ||||
g. All Mag-Lites, power supplies, pass-on books, | ||||
metal detectors, radios, surge protectors, radio | ||||
batteries, air conditioner remotes, and radio battery | ||||
chargers will be turned in to the DSB. | ||||
Chapter 32 | Chapter 32 | |||
Emergency Action Plans (EAPs) | Emergency Action Plans (EAPs) | |||
32-1. Attempted/Actual Suicide | 32-1. Attempted/Actual Self -Harm | |||
a. Detainees who exhibit behavior that is or could | a. The brevity code for a self-harm incident is | |||
be harmful to them will be classified by medical staff | “SNOWBALL”. The block NCO of the affected | |||
as having one of the following: | block will call the code three times over the radio with | |||
(1) Self-injurious behavior: behaviors that would | the block and cell number. | |||
clearly be non-lethal, or behaviors that are aimed at | b. The block guard who first identifies a detainee | |||
taunting or manipulating security or medical staff. | attempting a self-harm act or a detainee who is in the | |||
(2) Suicidal Ideation behavior: thoughts of | midst of a self-harm act will immediately notify the | |||
harming oneself, ranging from vague ideation to | block NCO. | |||
having a plan. Intent, means, and mental state are all | c. The roving sally of the effected camp will secure | |||
factors commonly considered by mental health | (1) pair of bolt cutters for the block NCO from the | |||
personnel in classifying suicidal ideation from | causeway guard shack. Additionally, the Roving sally | |||
manipulation and taunting behavior. | will open the outer gate of the effected block for access | |||
(3) Suicidal: self-harm behaviors that are | of emergency personnel. All personnel on the block | |||
potentially fatal and only prevented secondary to | will cease current operations and movements, move | |||
intervention or happenstance (e.g. the rope broke.) | detainees back to their cells, exercise yard, shower or | |||
b. Occasionally, some detainees will require a | closest available empty cell and secure them. The | |||
higher level of control and observation since they are | personnel assigned to that block will move to the cell | |||
believed to be a danger to themselves. The following | where the incident is occurring. All non-essential | |||
guidelines will be utilized, in conjunction with efforts | personnel, i.e., Escorts, VIP’s, Chaplains, etc., will | |||
made by Detention Hospital to protect the detainee. | immediately move off the block into the causeway to | |||
c. When a Block Guard suspects that a detainee | ease foot traffic through the block during the incident. | |||
may pose a danger to himself, the Block Guard will | d. If the detainee's condition is or becoming life | |||
notify the DOC who will contact medical and request | threatening, and only two to three block guards are | |||
an evaluation. If a medical emergency exists, the | available, they will form an entry team and enter the | |||
Block Guard will take appropriate immediate action in | cell to secure and attend to the detainee. The guards do | |||
accordance with use of force policy and contact | not have to wait for the IRF team, they can take | |||
medical directly. The IRF team is utilized “for the | immediate action if the block NCO, according to | |||
extraction of a detainee who is combative or resistive | his/her best judgment, deems he/she can control the | |||
to being removed from the cell”. If a detainee attempts | situation to secure and safeguard the detainee. | |||
self-harm and his condition is or will imminently | e. Block NCO responsibilities: | |||
become life threatening, and the detainee is otherwise | (1) safety and security of the MP’s is the number one | |||
not combative or a threat to the safety of MP personnel, | consideration. Most instances the threat will be | |||
three MPs assigned to the block will enter the cell to | minimal; however the block NCO must make a | |||
immediately secure and attend to the detainee. The | competent decision when determining the risk to MP | |||
MPs will not wait for an IRF team to respond under | personnel. | |||
these conditions, but will take immediate action to | (2) ensure all other detainees are secured in their | |||
protect the detainee from death or serious bodily injury. | respective cells, the exercise yard, shower and/or any | |||
d. Medical will conduct an evaluation of the | available cell. Note if a detainee is placed in a cell | |||
detainee and decide if he is indeed a risk to himself. | other than his own and notify DOC when the situation | |||
Action based on this determination will be coordinated | permits. | |||
through JDOG OPNS or in their absence, the DOC. | (3) ensure the interior gate of the block sally port is | |||
e. Once a detainee has been identified as a risk, he | open to allow the expeditious entry of any emergency | |||
will be placed on either self-harm watch or suicide | personnel. The Block guard walking the block will | |||
watch. Items in his cell that he could use to harm | have keys and shears on him/her while walking the | |||
himself will be removed by the Block Guards (sheet, | block. The Block NCO will obtain the “Snowball Kit” | |||
blanket, etc.) These items will be returned to the | and proceed to the affected cell. | |||
detainee once he is believed to no longer pose a danger | (4) ensure that at least one person is still walking the | |||
to himself. The detainee will be given a self-harm | block and maintaining observation of the rest of the | |||
blanket and smock IAW Section 20-11, Self-Harm | block. | |||
Blankets and Smocks. Detainees classified as on self- | (5) assess the situation, assume the position of the | |||
harm watch will be moved to either cell #1 or cell #48 | entry team leader, provide a quick brief to his/her team | |||
on a non-MSU block. Only one self-harm watch | on his/her course of action to stop the self-harm | |||
detainee will be on each block. Block Guards will | incident IAW the ROE and RUF policies for Camp | |||
constantly watch the detainee during the self-harm | Delta. If Block NCO is not available, first Guard on | |||
watch period. This is in addition to the Block Guard | scene has to be able to assess the situation and make | |||
walking the block. The block table will be moved so it | quick decision. Cell entry will follow Operation | |||
will face the front of the block and the MP will face | Snowball Training Guideline. | |||
and observe the self-harm cell when sitting behind it. | (6) ensure the detainee is safe and secure until | |||
f. Guards will complete an “Observation of Self- | medical personnel arrive. | |||
Injurious Behavior” Form on all detainees on suicide | (7) provide the SOG/PL/CO with the SITREP upon | |||
watch. When this form is completed, it will be turned | their arrival. | |||
in to the DOC for filing in the detainee’s file. A Block | (8) secure the cell where the incident has occurred to | |||
Guard will continuously monitor an individual on self- | prevent tampering of potential evidence until BHS and | |||
harm watch and document activity every 15 minutes. | MPI have released the cell back to the control of the | |||
g. Detainees who are deemed to be in need of self- | block NCO. | |||
harm procedures should not be placed in MSU only for | (9) ensure any detainees who were temporarily | |||
their protection. They can be in MSU for disciplinary | placed in cells other than their own are returned to their | |||
reasons, but should not be placed in MSU only for self- | appropriate cell. | |||
harm procedures. | (10) complete a DA Form 2823 regarding the | |||
h. COs will make required notifications in the event | incident, supervise and review the DA Form 2823s of | |||
of an incident involving either self-injurious behavior | the guards on the block directly involved in the | |||
or suicide attempts. Documentation will be made of | incident and submit these to the SOG/PL. | |||
the event, whether self-injurious behavior or (Incident | (11) annotate the incident in DIMS. | |||
Report). This documentation will include the name | e. DOC responsibilities: | |||
and rank of the medical personnel determining whether | (1) repeat the brevity code and incident block. | |||
the incident is a self-injurious behavior or suicide | (2) alert all personnel that radio communications in | |||
attempt and the notifications made by the CO. | Camp Delta are for emergency use only, all non- | |||
i. Refer to section 20-1 for further guidance on | emergency communications will occur via landline | |||
restraint procedures. | where possible. | |||
j. The DOC will contact the Combat Stress Team | (3) ensure medical and BHS personnel have been | |||
and provide them with the unit of the soldier’s involved | dispatched to the incident site to assist in stabilizing the | |||
and the unit POC. The Combat Stress Team will | detainee. | |||
conduct a session with the soldiers within 72 hours of | (4) dispatch the admin personnel with the camera, | |||
the incident. Upon completion of the session, the | extra disks and extra battery to the incident site. | |||
Combat Stress Team will notify the DOC. | (5) dispatch escort team to assist with transport of | |||
k. The DOC will maintain a list of detainees that | detainee to medical. | |||
have a self-harm history. Prior to each shift change, | (6) notify the roving sally personnel to stop all | |||
DOC personnel will highlight these individuals on the | movement within the effected Camp. | |||
block alpha rosters. | (7) check DIMS and dispatch an interpreter who | |||
speaks a language understood by the detainee to the | ||||
incident site. | ||||
(8) if necessary, coordinate to have the ambulance | ||||
escorts and NAVBASE hospital guards mobilized. | ||||
(9) have all blocks conduct a headcount at the | ||||
resolution of the incident. | ||||
(10) process all forms and reports as necessary. | ||||
f. IRF team member’s responsibilities (if needed as | ||||
determined by SOG or higher): | ||||
(1) upon receipt of the brevity code from their | ||||
respective block NCOs, dress in their gear and report to | ||||
the causeway adjacent to the incident block. | ||||
(2) only to be used if the detainee is combative or | ||||
resistive as deemed necessary by the on scene | ||||
commander. | ||||
(3) conduct operations IAW normal IRF procedures. | ||||
g. CO responsibilities: | ||||
(1) ensure soldiers are walking the block. | ||||
(2) receive brief on situation from PL/SOG. | ||||
(3) ensure paperwork is initiated. SOG to follow up. | ||||
(4) conduct an AAR upon resolution of the incident. | ||||
(5) notify Combat Stress Team, if necessary. | ||||
(6) brief CJDOG or DCJDOG on situation. | ||||
(7) complete SIR upon receipt of AAR and 2823’s. | ||||
h. PL responsibilities: | ||||
(1) immediately report to the scene. | ||||
(2) assume duties as on scene commander, ensuring | ||||
appropriate level of supervision and observation to | ||||
unaffected cells and directing all emergency personnel | ||||
as indicated. | ||||
(3) once detainee has been moved to medical, ensure | ||||
all personnel are physically and psychologically ok. | ||||
(4) provide coverage for the block to allow CO to | ||||
conduct AAR with guards directly involved in the | ||||
incident. | ||||
(5) ensure sworn statements are done. | ||||
(6) ensure the cell is secured until BHS and MPI | ||||
personnel have released it back to the block NCO. | ||||
i. SOG responsibilities: | ||||
(1) immediately report to the scene. | ||||
(2) assist PL with command and control of scene. | ||||
(3) ensure all litters are centrally located in the | ||||
causeway at all times. | ||||
(4) supervise all camp personnel and ensure all | ||||
gates, sally’s, and other blocks, are conducting duties | ||||
to best support the efforts of safety, security, and | ||||
immediate access of emergency personnel. | ||||
j. Behavioral Healthcare Service (BHS) | ||||
responsibilities: | ||||
(1) upon hearing the brevity code “SNOWBALL” | ||||
immediately report to the scene. | ||||
(2) assess the detainee. | ||||
(3) assist the MPs/medical staff in stabilizing/ | ||||
securing the detainee. | ||||
(4) assess the scene, paying particular attention to | ||||
items/materials used in the self-harm attempt. | ||||
(5) interview guard personnel to help determine the | ||||
specific facts pertaining to the self-harm incident. | ||||
(6) talk with other detainees, assessing their mental | ||||
status with respect to the self-harm incident. | ||||
(7) notify the on-call BHS provider. | ||||
(8) BHS provider will make determination and | ||||
classify the self-harm behavior as either Self-Injurious | ||||
Behavior (SIB) or Suicide Attempt (SA). This | ||||
information will be relayed to the CO via the DOC | ||||
within three (3) hours of the incident. | ||||
k. Medical staff responsibilities: | ||||
(1) upon hearing the brevity code SNOWBALL, | ||||
immediately dispatch two (2) corpsmen with IRF bag | ||||
and spine board to the scene. (Spine boards are | ||||
centrally located in the causeway of each Camp). | ||||
(2) on arrival, assess the detainee, stabilize injuries | ||||
and report status via radio to Delta Medical Clinic. | ||||
(3) escort the detainee to the Delta Medical Clinic | ||||
for further evaluation and treatment. | ||||
l. All blocks not affected in the incident camp are to | ||||
continue operations within their block. No movements | ||||
will occur out of and into their respective block (i.e., all | ||||
reservation and medical moves will cease until further | ||||
notice). | ||||
m. One roving sally personnel will locate a litter and | ||||
place the litter in the causeway outside the incident | ||||
block. | ||||
n. The other roving sally personnel will open gates to | ||||
allow the IRF team out into the causeway if necessary, | ||||
and facilitate expeditious entry of emergency personnel | ||||
to the scene. | ||||
o. Upon the order of the SOG; sally 4 and/or sally 10, | ||||
depending on camp, will open the interior gate and | ||||
man the exterior gate to allow the expeditious | ||||
movement of emergency personnel and vehicles. They | ||||
will secure the interior gate once the detainee is | ||||
evacuated out of the camp or on order from | ||||
SOG/PL/CO. | ||||
p. Once the situation is resolved and the detainee is | ||||
safely evacuated, all personnel directly involved in the | ||||
incident will complete a DA Form 2823 regarding the | ||||
incident and submit it to the SOG or PL. | ||||
32-2. Mass Disturbance | 32-2. Mass Disturbance | |||
a. In the event of any type of disorder, immediately | a. In the event of any type of disorder, immediately | |||
lock down the facility. No one will exit the facility | lock down the facility. No one will exit the facility | |||
until the situation is resolved, or unless order to do so | until the situation is resolved, or unless order to do so | |||
by the CO. | by the CO. | |||
b. The uniform for response personnel will be BDU; | b. The uniform for response personnel will be BDU; | |||
riot helmet with face shield; protective mask; Kevlar | riot helmet with face shield; protective mask; Kevlar | |||
vest, elbow, knee and shin pads; riot baton; and a radio. | vest, elbow, knee and shin pads; riot baton; and a radio. | |||
In extreme situations, selected marksmen will be armed | In extreme situations, selected marksmen will be armed | |||
with M-16 or M-4 rifles and M-12 shotguns (by order | with M-16 or M-4 rifles and M-12 shotguns (by order | |||
skipping to change at line 11229 | skipping to change at line 13693 | |||
with M-16 or M-4 rifles and M-12 shotguns (by order | with M-16 or M-4 rifles and M-12 shotguns (by order | |||
of the CJDOG only). Weapons will not enter the | of the CJDOG only). Weapons will not enter the | |||
facility exterior fence line under any circumstances. | facility exterior fence line under any circumstances. | |||
c. The primary staging area for response personnel | c. The primary staging area for response personnel | |||
is Camp IV main Sally Port Gate causeway. | is Camp IV main Sally Port Gate causeway. | |||
d. During tests of the Mass Disturbance Emergency | d. During tests of the Mass Disturbance Emergency | |||
Plan, all procedures herein will be followed, except for | Plan, all procedures herein will be followed, except for | |||
the use of detainees or the actual notification of outside | the use of detainees or the actual notification of outside | |||
agencies (unless previously coordinated by the | agencies (unless previously coordinated by the | |||
commander or his representative). | commander or his representative). | |||
e. Minor Disturbances: | e. Minor Disturbances: | |||
(1) Upon detection or notification of a | (1) Upon detection or notification of a | |||
disturbance, the senior Block Guard present will take | disturbance, the senior guard present will take the | |||
the following actions using all available guard | following actions using all available guard personnel in | |||
personnel in the area of the disturbance: | the area of the disturbance: | |||
(a) Initiate an immediate facility lockdown. | (a) Initiate an immediate facility lockdown. | |||
(b) Notify the DOC and request assistance. | (b) Notify the DOC and request assistance. | |||
(c) Segregate the non-participants from the | (c) Segregate the non-participants from the | |||
participants. | participants. | |||
(d) Identify and segregate the leaders and | (d) Identify and segregate the leaders and | |||
principle participants. If all bean hole doors are closed, | principle participants. If all bean hole doors are closed, | |||
open a bean hole door for each participant in the | open a bean hole door for each non-participant in the | |||
disturbance. If all bean hole doors are open, close the | disturbance. If all bean hole doors are open, close the | |||
bean hole doors for each non-participant. Open bean | bean hole doors for each participant. Open bean hole | |||
hole doors will signify participants and closed ones | ||||
will signify non-participants. | doors will signify non-participants and closed ones will | |||
signify participants. | ||||
(e) Use only the force necessary and practical | (e) Use only the force necessary and practical | |||
under the circumstances to disburse the participants. | under the circumstances to disburse the participants. | |||
Guards should not enter a situation that they do not | Guards should not enter a situation that they do not | |||
have the force available to resolve. When in doubt, | have the force available to resolve. When in doubt, | |||
wait for backup. | wait for backup. | |||
(2) Guard personnel in other areas will secure | (2) Guard personnel in other areas will secure | |||
their area, notify the SOG, and remain at their posts | their area, notify the SOG, and remain at their posts | |||
unless otherwise directed by the SOG. | unless otherwise directed by the SOG. | |||
(3) The SOG will take the following immediate | (3) The SOG will take the following immediate | |||
actions: | actions: | |||
skipping to change at line 11284 | skipping to change at line 13748 | |||
Procedures for using the IRF Team can be found in | Procedures for using the IRF Team can be found in | |||
Chapter 25 of this SOP. The CO must authorize this. | Chapter 25 of this SOP. The CO must authorize this. | |||
Guards will use the minimum amount of force | Guards will use the minimum amount of force | |||
necessary to subdue the detainee. Once the detainee | necessary to subdue the detainee. Once the detainee | |||
has been subdued, he will be placed in an individual | has been subdued, he will be placed in an individual | |||
cell. All items that might be used by the detainee to | cell. All items that might be used by the detainee to | |||
cause damage to property, themselves, or others will be | cause damage to property, themselves, or others will be | |||
removed. | removed. | |||
f. Major Disturbances: | f. Major Disturbances: | |||
(1) In the event of an attempted group or mass | (1) In the event of an attempted group or mass | |||
break out, riot, or other general disorder, the Block | break out, riot, or other general disorder, the guard | |||
Guard discovering or receiving notification of the | discovering or receiving notification of the incident | |||
incident will immediately notify all other members of | will immediately notify all other members of the guard | |||
the guard force. | force. | |||
(2) The DOC RTO will immediately notify the | (2) The DOC RTO will immediately notify the | |||
chain of command and, on order, initiate a recall of all | chain of command and, on order, initiate a recall of all | |||
guard personnel. | guard personnel. | |||
(3) Guards will move all nonparticipating | (3) Guards will move all nonparticipating | |||
detainees to their cells or away from the scene of the | detainees to their cells or away from the scene of the | |||
disturbance, segregating the rioters from the other | disturbance, segregating the rioters from the other | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
(4) Guards will immediately secure all gates and | (4) Guards will immediately secure all gates and | |||
ensure detainees under their supervision are secure and | ensure detainees under their supervision are secure and | |||
cannot join the area of the disturbance. | cannot join the area of the disturbance. | |||
skipping to change at line 11448 | skipping to change at line 13912 | |||
generator to come up to speed and voltage. | generator to come up to speed and voltage. | |||
g. Press the button twice to close the generator | g. Press the button twice to close the generator | |||
breaker. Allow 40 seconds for the breaker to close. If | breaker. Allow 40 seconds for the breaker to close. If | |||
the breaker fails to close, press the green “Close” | the breaker fails to close, press the green “Close” | |||
button on the breaker for the Generator Control Panel. | button on the breaker for the Generator Control Panel. | |||
h. Verify power has been restored to the facility. | h. Verify power has been restored to the facility. | |||
i. If the generator fails to start automatically, or | i. If the generator fails to start automatically, or | |||
power is not restored to the facility, place an | power is not restored to the facility, place an | |||
emergency work order with R&U and conduct | emergency work order with R&U and conduct | |||
operations with flashlights and lanterns. | operations with flashlights and lanterns. | |||
j. All detainees in the interrogation booth will be | ||||
secured. | ||||
k. If the generators fail to start or they breakdown, | ||||
all detainees in transit to a location will be returned to | ||||
their cells and secured. | ||||
32-4. Hostage Situation | 32-4. Hostage Situation | |||
a. During duty hours, the CO will direct all hostage | a. During duty hours, the CO will direct all hostage | |||
operations. The PL and SOG will conduct all | operations. The PL and SOG will conduct all | |||
operations | operations | |||
b. The DOC will make notification to outside | b. The DOC will make notification to outside | |||
agencies and supply support to the CO when needed. | agencies and supply support to the CO when needed. | |||
c. Staff will route all information through the active | c. Staff will route all information through the active | |||
operations center. | operations center. | |||
d. CO will maintain DOC of situation while keeping | d. CO will maintain DOC of situation while keeping | |||
in contact with all JTF staff. | in contact with all JTF staff. | |||
e. Staff will: | e. Staff will: | |||
(1) Notify DOC by telephone or messenger when | (1) Notify DOC by telephone or messenger when | |||
a hostage/barricaded subject incident occurs. | a hostage/barricaded subject incident occurs. | |||
(2) Isolate the area. Evacuate non-participating. | (2) Isolate the area. Evacuate non-participating. | |||
Monitor detainees that cannot be evacuated due to the | Monitor detainees that cannot be evacuated due to the | |||
hostage situation. | hostage situation. | |||
(3) Keep the hostage taker and hostage under | (3) Keep the hostage taker and hostage under | |||
observation from a safe area, if it does not jeopardize | observation from a safe area, if it does not jeopardize | |||
the hostage’s safety. | the hostage’s safety. | |||
(4) Verification of the presence of all assigned | (4) Verification of the presence of all assigned | |||
present for duty, staff, and/or volunteers/visitors for | present for duty, staff, and/or volunteers/visitors for | |||
personnel accountability will be critical. | personnel accountability will be critical. | |||
f. DOC will: | f. DOC will: | |||
skipping to change at line 11726 | skipping to change at line 14195 | |||
needed to escort the detainee to the medical facility. | needed to escort the detainee to the medical facility. | |||
Inform DOC which guards were selected. | Inform DOC which guards were selected. | |||
(4) Notify the Camp Commander before any | (4) Notify the Camp Commander before any | |||
detainee is taken outside the facility. | detainee is taken outside the facility. | |||
(5) Ensure that all security procedures are used | (5) Ensure that all security procedures are used | |||
Camp Delta SOPs. | Camp Delta SOPs. | |||
i. Sally Port 1 will contact DOC and verify the | i. Sally Port 1 will contact DOC and verify the | |||
authorization for any detainee to depart the facility for | authorization for any detainee to depart the facility for | |||
a medical emergency/transport. This will be done | a medical emergency/transport. This will be done | |||
before the detainee is allowed through the gate. | before the detainee is allowed through the gate. | |||
32-6a. Radio Range Ambulance access | ||||
(1) Ambulances are dispatched by the NAVBASE | ||||
Security Forces or by the NAVBASE Hospital. | ||||
(2) Individual Ambulances will be marked on the | ||||
outside with numbers. (If there are four ambulances, | ||||
they will be marked 1 through 4.) | ||||
a. These ID's must be clearly marked on the | ||||
outside front of the vehicle. Preferably in Block letters | ||||
12 inches tall, | ||||
permanently affixed to the ambulance. | ||||
(3) In addition, emergency responder badges will be | ||||
issued to | ||||
the personnel responding in the ambulance. | ||||
(4) Upon dispatch: | ||||
a. The NAVBASE Hospital will call the JOC and | ||||
let them know which ambulance is responding by | ||||
number. | ||||
b. The JOC will inform the IN TOC | ||||
c. The IN TOC will in turn, informs the Traffic | ||||
Control Point (TCP). | ||||
i. To be effective, this process must | ||||
happen within three minutes of dispatch. | ||||
(5) The Ambulance will run with its emergency lights | ||||
on down the | ||||
hill approaching the TCP. | ||||
(6) When the soldiers at the TCP identify the | ||||
ambulance coming | ||||
down the hill they will: | ||||
a. Identify that the ambulance number matches | ||||
that which was communicated from the JOC. | ||||
b. Provide priority of travel through the | ||||
checkpoint to the Ambulance. | ||||
i. Stop all traffic through the TCP - | ||||
Traffic lights both ways placed on red. | ||||
ii. Clear the existing traffic in the | ||||
TCP inspection point. If there is a vehicle in the in- | ||||
bound lane, they will | ||||
ensure the out-bound lane is clear. | ||||
(7) To facilitate safe passage through the TCP, | ||||
a. The Ambulance will stop at the Traffic | ||||
Control Point and establish face-to-face contact with | ||||
the soldiers at the | ||||
TCP. The TCP will confirm to the ambulance that | ||||
access has been | ||||
pre-coordinated. This coordination should be minimal | ||||
(10 to 15 seconds) and | ||||
is critical to ensure safe passage through the TCP. | ||||
b. The soldiers at the TCP will identify for | ||||
the Ambulance the fastest way through the TCP. | ||||
Either through the regular inbound lane, or the | ||||
outbound lane. | ||||
(8) If the ambulance arrives prior to the TCP getting | ||||
notice of | ||||
its dispatch, the ambulance will wait at the TCP until | ||||
clearance is granted | ||||
through the JOC. | ||||
32-7. Fratricide | 32-7. Fratricide | |||
a. If the incident involves Infantry personnel or | a. If the incident involves Infantry personnel or | |||
Infantry and non-MPs, the Infantry unit will conduct all | Infantry and non-MPs, the Infantry unit will conduct all | |||
actions. If the incident involves MPs or MP and non- | actions. If the incident involves guards or guard and | |||
Infantry personnel, the MPs will conduct all actions. If | non-Infantry personnel, the guards will conduct all | |||
the incident involves both MPs and Infantry and the | actions. If the incident involves both guards and | |||
injured or shooter are inside the wire, the MPs will take | Infantry and the injured or shooter are inside the wire, | |||
lead on all actions and coordinate with their Infantry | the guards will take lead on all actions and coordinate | |||
counterparts. If the incident involves both MPs and | with their Infantry counterparts. If the incident | |||
Infantry and the injured and shooter are outside the | involves both guards and Infantry and the injured and | |||
wire, the Infantry will take lead on all actions and | shooter is outside the wire, the Infantry will take lead | |||
coordinate with their MP counterparts. | ||||
on all actions and coordinate with their guard | ||||
counterparts. | ||||
a. The Infantry will perform the following steps: | a. The Infantry will perform the following steps: | |||
(1) Unit on the scene will perform the following: | (1) Unit on the scene will perform the following: | |||
(a) Once the situation is under control, contact | (a) Once the situation is under control, contact | |||
higher headquarters and report that weapons have been | higher headquarters and report that weapons have been | |||
discharged and individuals have been wounded or | discharged and individuals have been wounded or | |||
killed. Provide the number of casualties, types of | killed. Provide the number of casualties, types of | |||
wounds, names and social security numbers. | wounds, names and social security numbers. | |||
(b) Conduct a nine-line MEDEVAC request | (b) Conduct a nine-line MEDEVAC request | |||
directly with the medical unit. | directly with the medical unit. | |||
(c) Evacuate the casualties, ensuring wounded | (c) Evacuate the casualties, ensuring wounded | |||
skipping to change at line 11785 | skipping to change at line 14312 | |||
(SIR) to the JOC NLT 30 minutes after receipt of the | (SIR) to the JOC NLT 30 minutes after receipt of the | |||
report. | report. | |||
(d) The JDOG S-1 will track the status of the | (d) The JDOG S-1 will track the status of the | |||
casualties. | casualties. | |||
(e) Supervise that a unit replaced the unit | (e) Supervise that a unit replaced the unit | |||
involved in the situation. | involved in the situation. | |||
(f) Prepare a U.S. Army Accident Report in | (f) Prepare a U.S. Army Accident Report in | |||
accordance with AR 15-6, AR 385-40, and DA | accordance with AR 15-6, AR 385-40, and DA | |||
Pamphlet 385-40. Use DA Form 285-A-R as a | Pamphlet 385-40. Use DA Form 285-A-R as a | |||
checklist. | checklist. | |||
(g) Request guidance from JTF with regard to | (g) Request guidance from JTF with regard to | |||
responding to the media. | responding to the media. | |||
b. The MPs perform the following steps: | b. The guards perform the following steps: | |||
(1) Unit on the scene will perform the following: | (1) Unit on the scene will perform the following: | |||
(a) Once the situation is under control, contact | (a) Once the situation is under control, contact | |||
the DOC and report that weapons have been discharged | the DOC and report that weapons have been discharged | |||
and individuals have been wounded or killed. Provide | and individuals have been wounded or killed. Provide | |||
the number of casualties, types of wounds, names and | the number of casualties, types of wounds, names and | |||
social security numbers. | social security numbers. | |||
(b) Conduct a nine-line MEDEVAC request | (b) Conduct a nine-line MEDEVAC request | |||
directly with the medical unit. | directly with the medical unit. | |||
(c) Evacuate the casualties, ensuring wounded | (c) Evacuate the casualties, ensuring wounded | |||
and killed are not transported together. | and killed are not transported together. | |||
skipping to change at line 11892 | skipping to change at line 14419 | |||
d. If a fire presents itself in a block, perform the | d. If a fire presents itself in a block, perform the | |||
following steps: | following steps: | |||
(1) Alert the DOC | (1) Alert the DOC | |||
(2) Shut off power to the block | (2) Shut off power to the block | |||
(3) Roving Sally will bring fire extinguishers to | (3) Roving Sally will bring fire extinguishers to | |||
the block gate for use | the block gate for use | |||
(4) Two block personnel will use a hose and fire | (4) Two block personnel will use a hose and fire | |||
extinguishers to fight the fire | extinguishers to fight the fire | |||
(5) Two block personnel will start moving | (5) Two block personnel will start moving | |||
detainees from affected areas to the showers and | detainees from affected areas to the showers and | |||
recreation yards as a temporary holding area if needed. | exercise yards as a temporary holding area if needed. | |||
(6) All available escort teams will respond to the | (6) All available escort teams will respond to the | |||
block to help evacuate detainees if needed. | block to help evacuate detainees if needed. | |||
(7) Medical will respond to the block to treat any | (7) Medical will respond to the block to treat any | |||
injuries. | injuries. | |||
(8) SOG or PL, depending on the size of the fire, | (8) SOG or PL, depending on the size of the fire, | |||
may activate the IRF team to assist in removing | may activate the IRF team to assist in removing | |||
detainees and moving them to empty cells in adjoining | detainees and moving them to empty cells in adjoining | |||
blocks or the shower and recreation areas. | blocks or the shower and exercise areas. | |||
32-9. Bomb Threat / Discovery / Explosion | 32-9. Bomb Threat / Discovery / Explosion | |||
a. Telephonic bomb threat. Staff members who | a. Telephonic bomb threat. Staff members who | |||
receive a telephonic bomb threat will: | receive a telephonic bomb threat will: | |||
(1) Cease all radio communications. | (1) Cease all radio communications. | |||
(2) Without alerting the caller, signal another | (2) Without alerting the caller, signal another | |||
staff member about the telephonic bomb threat. Have | staff member about the telephonic bomb threat. Have | |||
him/her notify DOC. | him/her notify DOC. | |||
(3) Keep the caller on the line, as long as | (3) Keep the caller on the line, as long as | |||
possible, so the call may be traced. | possible, so the call may be traced. | |||
(4) Complete JTF GTMO Bomb Threat Data | (4) Complete JTF GTMO Bomb Threat Data | |||
skipping to change at line 11993 | skipping to change at line 14520 | |||
(c) Help control fires or any damage that was | (c) Help control fires or any damage that was | |||
created by the detonation. | created by the detonation. | |||
(d) If possible, remove important administrative | (d) If possible, remove important administrative | |||
files from the area. | files from the area. | |||
(e) Secure the area and do not allow anyone to | (e) Secure the area and do not allow anyone to | |||
disturb the debris/crime scene. | disturb the debris/crime scene. | |||
(f) Assume that there is more than one bomb. | (f) Assume that there is more than one bomb. | |||
(2) The DOO will not allow anyone to reenter an | (2) The DOO will not allow anyone to reenter an | |||
evacuated area without his approval. | evacuated area without his approval. | |||
32-10. Mass Casualty Incident (MCI) | 32-10. Mass Casualty Incident (MCI) | |||
a. In the event of a Mass Casualty Incident (MCI) in | In the event of a reported Mass Casualty Incident | |||
or around Camp Delta involving members of the Joint | (MCI) in Camp Delta, the On-Duty Company | |||
Task Force or detainees, the following will apply: | Commander assumes duties as On-scene Commander. | |||
Camp Delta Detention Operations Center (DOC) will | A designated Platoon Leader assumes command and | |||
be notified immediately on SABER Channel-3. | control of the Camp. Information reported to the | |||
b. Incident Location: | Detainee Operations Center (DOC) by the On-scene | |||
(1) Inform Company Commander/Platoon | Commander drives the operation. | |||
Leader/Sergeant of the Guard, that they have a Mass | Priority is to safeguard and secure the scene. Medical | |||
Casualty Incident. | triage and transport of casualties only occurs after the | |||
(2) The Company Commander, Platoon Leader or | scene is secure. A Manpower pool will be established | |||
senior JDOG representative will have DOC initiate | to dispatch soldiers as needed. The Manpower pool | |||
MCI procedures. | will consist of JIIF Monitors and escort personnel, | |||
c. DOC: | assembly area for Manpower pool will be located in | |||
(1) The RTO will announce that a MCI has | back of the DOC. Infantry mobile patrols will secure | |||
occurred over the radio in the following format: | any exterior breach and the QRF will secure the | |||
interior scene. Military Working Dog (MWD) will | ||||
report to On-scene Commander and provide security | ||||
augmentation where directed. The MP Company in | ||||
training, if available, will execute the security mission | ||||
of Camp Delta. | ||||
Once the site is secured, the On-scene Commander will | ||||
contact the DOC to request that the Medical response | ||||
teams be dispatched to the site. The Medical On-scene | ||||
Coordinator is responsible for all medical operations at | ||||
the site. He will determine if external ambulance | ||||
support is needed and, if so, will request them through | ||||
the medical LNO at the DOC. | ||||
Medical and Infantry LNO’s will be assigned to the | ||||
DOC, at REDCON Level 3 until the JDOG returns to | ||||
REDCON Level 5 and they are released by CJDOG. | ||||
A. On-Scene Company Commander: | ||||
1. Picks up road guard vest, (On-Scene | ||||
Commander) additional SABER (for IN external | ||||
Security Element) and receives any additional | ||||
instructions from the Battle Captain. | ||||
2. Establish COC, designating the following | ||||
positions from on-shift MP’s: | ||||
(a)On-Scene PL. | ||||
(b) On-Scene SOG. | ||||
(c)Camp OIC. | ||||
(d) Traffic Coordinator. | ||||
(e)Manpower Pool Coordinator. | ||||
3. Responds to MCI site to assume command and | ||||
control. | ||||
4. Establishes and maintains security. | ||||
5. Assumes C2 of Camp Delta QRF to provide | ||||
interior security of the site. | ||||
6. Requests IRF Teams as needed from the DOC. | ||||
7. Assumes C2 of all responding units at the site. | ||||
8. Notifies DOC when scene is secured, via | ||||
SABER Channel 3 and calls for medical response | ||||
teams using proword “STAT.” | ||||
9. Coordinates with Medical On-Scene Coordinator | ||||
in establishing triage/treatment zones. | ||||
B. On-Scene PL: | ||||
1. Reports to the On-Scene CO. | ||||
2. Conduct assessment of available strength, | ||||
makes recommendations to On-scene Commander for | ||||
additional assets. | ||||
3. Liaisons between incident scene and | ||||
manpower pool. | ||||
C. On-Scene SOG: | ||||
1. Reports to the On-Scene Commander. | ||||
2. Track number of wounded being transported | ||||
by ISN (detainees) or last name and SSN (US | ||||
Personnel). | ||||
D. Camp OIC: | ||||
1. Reports to the Battle Captain in the DOC. | ||||
2. Assumes C2 for Camp Operations. | ||||
E. Traffic Coordinator: | ||||
1. Reports to On-scene Commander. | ||||
2. Picks up Road guard vest (Traffic Coordinator) | ||||
from DOC, to direct emergency traffic in and around | ||||
MSA site. | ||||
F. Manpower pool coordinator: | ||||
1. Reports to the On-scene Commander. | ||||
“ATTENTION CAMP DELTA, ATTENTION CAMP | 2. Provide the following positions from Manpower | |||
DELTA, AN MASS CASUALTY INCIDENT HAS | Pool: | |||
OCCURRED | a. Litter bearers (identified by white engineer | |||
(Location), INITIATE MCI PROCEDURES. ALL | tape on Kevlar). | |||
NON-EMERGENCY COMMUNICATION WILL BE | b. NAVBASE hospital escorts (Carry one can of | |||
BY LANDLINE.” This announcement will be | OC, drawn from DOC). | |||
repeated two times. This will be “ATTENTION | c. Tower relief. | |||
CAMP DELTA, ATTENTION CAMP DELTA, A | G.Infantry QRF: | |||
TRAINING MASS CASUALTY INCIDENT HAS | 1. Respond to MCI site and provide security. | |||
OCCURRED _______________(Location), INITIATE | 2. Reports to On-scene Commander. | |||
MCI PROCEDURES. ALL NON-EMERGENCY | 3 Change SABER frequency to DOC frequency. | |||
COMMUNICATION WILL BE BY LANDLINE” | H.Infantry TF: | |||
during a training MCI. | 1. Dispatches security element to establish security | |||
(2) The RTO will activate the Primary IRF team | outside any breach in the fence. | |||
for the camp affected for an immediate response to the | 2. Establish face-to-face coordination with On- | |||
MCI location by using the IRF brevity code. | scene Commander. | |||
Depending upon the type of MCI, the Camp Delta | 3. Receives SABER radio on channel 3 from On- | |||
Company Commander will make the determination to | scene Commander. | |||
activate the Primary IRF team in the other camp. If the | 4. Maintains security until released by On-scene | |||
situation warrants a larger response the alternate IRF | Commander. | |||
teams in both camps may also be activated. | 5. Returns SABER radio to On-scene Commander | |||
(3) The DOC NCOIC will use the Mass Casualty | prior to departure. | |||
Checklist in Appendix B. | I. Military Working Dog (MWD): | |||
(4) The RTO will order a lockdown and | 1. Reports to On-scene Commander. | |||
headcount over the radio. All headcounts will be | J. Detainee Operations Center (DOC): | |||
phoned in. | RTO: | |||
(5) The DOC NCO will initiate a DA Form 1594, | 1. Notify camp operations to stay off SABER, | |||
Staff Journal to record all activities during the MCI. | use Landline or courier for all camp traffic. | |||
(6) The DOC NCO will issue a WARNORD to | 2.Maintain SABER net discipline and | |||
the nearest standby unit. The phone numbers for the | information flow from SINCGARS. | |||
unit’s CP, Cdr, or 1SG will be called. If no contact is | 3.Announces via SABER channel 3 of the | |||
made, move on to the next unit. If contact is made, tell | following: | |||
the unit: “A Mass Casualty Incident has occurred. | “ATTENTION CAMP DELTA, | |||
Begin preparations to respond. Do not respond to | ATTENTION CAMP DELTA, A MASS | |||
Camp Delta until contacted.” The unit called will be | CASUALTY INCIDENT HAS | |||
based on the following: | OCCURRED (Location/MSA), | |||
(a) Unit in training at Camp America | INITIATE MCI PROCEDURES. ALL | |||
(b) Unit off duty at Camp America | NON-EMERGENCY | |||
(c) Unit in training | COMMUNICATION WILL BE BY | |||
(d) Unit off duty at Tierra Kay | LANDLINE.” This announcement will | |||
(7) Ensure Interpreter OIC is notified and | be repeated two times. | |||
provides enough interpreter support. | “ATTENTION CAMP DELTA, A | |||
d. The Admin NCO: | TRAINING MASS CASUALTY | |||
(1) The Admin NCO will take the video camera, | INCIDENT HAS OCCURRED | |||
two disks, and power cord to the MCI location. | _______________(Location/MSA), | |||
(2) The Admin NCO will state his name, last | INITIATE MCI PROCEDURES. ALL | |||
four, unit, date, time, site of MCI, and “Beginning of | NON-EMERGENCY | |||
Recording”. | COMMUNICATION WILL BE BY | |||
(3) The Admin NCO will capture as best as | LANDLINE” during a training MCI. | |||
possible the following scenes: | NCOIC: | |||
(a) Detainees at the MCI site. | 1. Reports to Battle Captain. | |||
(b) MPs assisting victims. | 2. Activates QRF team via Long Range SABER | |||
(c) Initial medical evaluations of detainees. | (primary),channel 3 and/or Land line (secondary) to | |||
(d) Transport of detainees to triage. | respond using QRF brevity code “Game Day” and | |||
(e) Triage location. | location of MSA. | |||
(4) The Admin NCO will only leave the MCI | 3. Orders lockdown of the camp and requests | |||
location and film the transport of detainees and the | headcount over the radio. (Confirmed via block-runner | |||
triage location after all detainees involved are shackled. | or landline). | |||
If the disk is nearing the ends, it will be flipped over | 4. Initiates Mass Casualty Notification Checklist | |||
and reinserted to continue filming. Another disk will | (See Appendix 1) MCI DOC Checklist. | |||
also be requested from the DOC. | 5. Initiates DA Form 1594, Staff Journal to record | |||
(5) At the conclusion of the video, the Admin | all activities during the MCI. | |||
NCO will state “End of Recording”. | 6. Initiate unit recall roster notification | |||
(6) Turn in the disks to the Detention Services | procedures “A Mass Casualty Incident has occurred | |||
Branch. | begin preparations to respond according | |||
e. Company Commander: | to”REDCON’s.” | |||
(1) Will make the mass casualty incident | Unit recall will be in the following order: | |||
determination. | a. Unit in training | |||
(2) Will pick up road guard vest labeled “ON | b. Unit(s) which are scheduled for upcoming | |||
SCENE CDR” and the green light from DOC and will | shift | |||
respond to MCI site. | c. Unit(s) which came off of shift | |||
(3) Will assume role as the On Scene | Battle Captain/Field Grade In The Wire | |||
Commander and will coordinate with the Medical | (FGITW): | |||
Commander (MC). | 1. Directs DOC to initiate MCI via SABER channel | |||
(4) At the MCI site, coordinate with Block | 3. | |||
NCOIC, Platoon Leader (PL) and Sergeant of the | 2. Directs DOC to coordinate for exterior | |||
Guard (SOG). | security (IN TF). | |||
(5) Company Commander will request MP | DOC Admin NCO: | |||
assistance at MCI site in following order: | 1. Monitor C2PC | |||
(a) Primary IRF team from camp affected. | 2. Monitor DIMS | |||
(b) Primary IRF team from camp not affected. | 3. Any additional duties as directed by the DOC | |||
Each member will bring a three-piece suit. | NCOIC. | |||
(c) Alternate IRF team from camp affected. Each | DOC Admin Specialist: | |||
member will bring a three-piece suit. | 1. Report to MCI with video camera, two discs and | |||
(d) Alternate IRF team from camp not affected. | power cord. | |||
Each member will bring a three-piece suit. | 2. Records as much of the following information as | |||
(6) Determine additional manpower requirements | possible: | |||
if needed. Notify the DOC of the requirements and | a. Name, date, time and location of MCI | |||
have the DOC forward to the alerted stand-by | b. Detainees at MCI site | |||
company. | c. MP’s assisting victims | |||
f. Platoon Leaders. | d. Medical evaluations and transport of | |||
(1) The Platoon Leader of the unaffected camp | detainees/US troops | |||
will assume command and control for their respective | e. Triage location | |||
camps for all areas not affected by the MCI. | 3. Return to DOC upon completion of filming, | |||
(2) The Platoon Leader will pickup road guard | turn discs into Detention Services Branch. | |||
vest labeled “Traffic Coordinator” and respond to the a | 4. Any other duties as directed by the Admin | |||
location as to best direct emergency traffic. The | NCOIC. | |||
Platoon Leader of the affected camp will control and | Escort Control NCOIC: | |||
direct all incoming and outgoing emergency vehicle | 1. Maintain accountability of escorts. | |||
traffic. | 2. Ensures any remaining detainees in JIIF are | |||
g. Sergeants of the Guard: | accounted for and secured. | |||
(1) The SOG from camp affected by MCI will | 3. Direct assistant Escort Control NCOIC to obtain | |||
report to MCI location and assume control until the | “Litter Bearer NCOIC” orange vest from DOC and | |||
Company Commander arrives. | report to manpower pool to facilitate C2 of litter | |||
(a) Go to the block NCO and get a briefing. | bearers. | |||
(b) Monitor the activities of the Block NCO and | 4. Directs escort personnel to report to the MCI | |||
IRF Team Leader | connex and stage signs for the at the MSA site (See | |||
(c) Brief the Company Commander and all other | MCI triage Map). | |||
personnel as they arrive on the scene. | ||||
(d) Ensure additional IRF teams, if required, are | ||||
integrated into three man teams. | ||||
(2) The SOG from the camp not affected by MCI | K.If MCI occurs on a block in camps 1,2 or 3, | |||
will continue to monitor and exercise command and | military casualties will be transported before | |||
control of his/her camp. | detainees with the same triage category. | |||
h. Block NCO: | Block NCOIC: | |||
(1) Will ensure bean holes are closed and secured | 1. Ensure bean holes are closed/secured. | |||
on non-MSU blocks and bean holes are secured on | 2. Open block gate. | |||
MSU blocks. | 3. Direct IRF team leader to get block alpha | |||
(2) Will ensure the block gate is open and stays | ||||
open. | ||||
(3) Will ensure the IRF team leader gets the alpha | ||||
roster. | roster. | |||
(4) Will unlock the cell door for three man entry | 4. Unlocks the cell door, one at a time, for | |||
teams. | detainees being evacuated by three man entry teams. | |||
(5) Will relock the lock and drop on the floor | 5. Re-locks all cells after detainees are removed. | |||
next to the cell. | 6. Tag each cell as “Do Not Enter” from which a | |||
(6) Will relock all cells after all detainees are | detainee was removed. | |||
removed from their cells. | 7. Accounts for all locks/keys before, during and | |||
(7) Will tag each cell as “Do Not Enter” from | ||||
which a detainee was removed. | ||||
(8) Will ensure block paperwork is completed | ||||
after all detainees are removed. | after all detainees are removed. | |||
(9) Will ensure all block personnel will write | Block Personnel: | |||
sworn statements after all detainees are removed. | 1. Form three-man teams to enter cell to search | |||
(10) Will account for all locks and keys after all | detainees and evacuate on a litter in 3-piece suit. | |||
detainees are removed. | 2. Ensure keys, detainee I.D card and I.D bracelet | |||
i. Block Personnel: | (worn) are sealed in an envelope duck-taped to the | |||
(1) Will form their own three-man team to enter | detainees left shoulder, prior to being transported. | |||
and secure detainees. | IRF Team Leader: | |||
(2) Will follow the same procedure as the IRF | 1. Obtains alpha roster for cellblock from block | |||
team. | personnel. | |||
(3) If there are not sufficient people on the block | 2. Tracks initial triage category given by ERT on | |||
to make a three-man team, they will be supplemented | alpha roster. | |||
by IRF team personnel. | 4. Ensures that all detainees leave their cell with | |||
(4) Will write sworn statements after all detainees | wristband or ISN and cell written on forehead. | |||
are removed. | 5. Ensures that the litter team searches all | |||
j. Escort Control: | detainees. | |||
(1) Will ensure all escort teams utilize channel | 7. Monitors detainees while in their three-piece | |||
three. | suits in their cells. | |||
(2) Will contact all JIIF escorts to halt escorts and | 8. Maintains accountability of which detainees | |||
prepare to support an MCI. | leave the block and time left on alpha roster. | |||
(3) Will direct JIIF escorts with a detainee to | L. Interpreter OIC: | |||
move that detainee to nearest open cell, their assigned | 1. Reports to Battle Captain with assigned | |||
cell, or open interview room dependent on distance and | interpreter strength. | |||
MCI location. | 2. Recalls and directs all available interpreters to the | |||
(4) If Sally Port 8 is not currently manned, will | manpower pool (See MCI Map Appendix 2) for | |||
send the first available escort team to man it. It must | ||||
be manned within five minutes of the MCI | ||||
announcement. On mid night shift, Platoon Leader 2 | ||||
must take the Sally Port 8 key to the Sally Port for the | ||||
escort team that is going to man it. | ||||
(5) Will contact all contractor escorts to escort | ||||
contractors out of Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | ||||
(6) Will contact all 2-man ICRC escorts to escort | ||||
ICRC out of Camp Delta through Sally Port 1 or move | ||||
the escorted detainee to nearest open cell, their | ||||
assigned cell, or open interview room dependent on | ||||
distance and MCI location. | ||||
(7) Will contact Juliet Block and have the ICRC | ||||
monitor escort ICRC personnel out of Camp Delta | ||||
through Sally Port 1. | ||||
(8) Will contact all medical escorts to return any | ||||
detainee enroute to the Detainee Clinic or enroute to | ||||
the Detainee Hospital to their assigned cell or the | ||||
nearest open cell, dependent on distance and MCI | ||||
location. Any detainee currently being treated at the | ||||
Detainee Clinic or Detainee Hospital will return to | ||||
their cell if the Medical Staff approves of it based on | ||||
the detainee’s condition. | ||||
(9) Will coordinate with the DOC to ensure golf | ||||
carts and Gators are available to move personnel and | ||||
equipment to the MCI site. | ||||
(10) Will coordinate the consolidation or | ||||
movement of detainees in JIIF buildings to minimize | ||||
guard force required. The first non-JIIF escort team | ||||
with a three-piece suit that is available will be used to | ||||
perform this task. | ||||
k. Escort Control NCOIC(Litter Bearer NCOIC): | ||||
(1) Upon notification Escort Control NCOIC will | ||||
halt all JIIF operations and immediately notify MPs | ||||
working as JIIF monitors to support an MCI. | ||||
(2) Obtain “Litter Bearer NCOIC” orange vest | ||||
from the DOC. | ||||
(3) Report to the manpower pool to act as “Litter | ||||
Bearer NCOIC” and coordinate the use of MP litter | ||||
bearers with the medical transportation OIC and | ||||
Medical Litter Bearer Team Leader. | ||||
l. JIIF Escorts(litter bearers): | ||||
(1) Will ensure all detainees in interrogation are | ||||
secured with three-piece suit to eyebolt in floor. | ||||
(2) Will respond to the manpower pool location | ||||
with three-piece suits. If they do not have a three-piece | ||||
suit, they will get one from Escort Control. | ||||
(3) Will work as litter bearers and provide | ||||
security for the triage locations as directed by the Litter | ||||
Bearer NCOIC. | ||||
(4) Will mark their headgear with a white label | ||||
from medical staff to identify them as a litter bearer. | ||||
Medical personnel will provide the labels. | ||||
(5) Will search detainee prior to removal from | ||||
the cell. | ||||
(6) When moving a detainee out of their cell, | ||||
they will ensure he is identified by worn wristband or | ||||
his cell and ISN are clearly marked on forehead. They | ||||
will also note the cell number he was taken from. | ||||
(7) Prior to leaving the block, the escort team will | ||||
obtain the key for the shackle from the IRF team | ||||
leader. | ||||
(8) After arriving at the triage location, they will | ||||
give the Hospital Escort NCOIC the key for the shackle | ||||
along with ISN and cell number. | ||||
m.JIIF Monitors(ambulance Escorts): | ||||
(1) Two JIIF monitors in each large JIIF Building | ||||
will act as security for the remaining detainees. | ||||
(2) Each pair of JIIF monitors will draw a can of | ||||
O/C will be drawn from the DOC. | ||||
(3) Each pair of JIIF monitors will report to | ||||
manpower pool for duty as ambulance escorts. | ||||
(4) Will ensure they receive shackle keys from | ||||
the Hospital Escort NCOIC when detainee is loaded | ||||
into the ambulance. | ||||
n. ICRC Escorts (if available)(litter bearers): | ||||
(1) Two personnel will move detainee to | ||||
locations as directed by Escort Control while one MP | ||||
will escort ICRC personnel out of Camp Delta through | ||||
Sally Port 1. | ||||
(2) Will respond to the manpower pool location | ||||
with three-piece suits. | ||||
(3) Will work as litter bearers and provide | ||||
security for the triage locations as directed by the Litter | ||||
Bearer NCOIC (Escort Control NCOIC). | ||||
(4) Will mark their headgear with a white label | ||||
from medical staff to identify them as a litter bearer. | ||||
Medical personnel will provide the labels. | ||||
(5) Will search detainee prior to removal from | ||||
the cell. | ||||
(6) When moving a detainee out of their cell, | ||||
they will ensure he is identified by worn wristband or | ||||
his cell and ISN are clearly marked on forehead. They | ||||
will also note the cell number he was taken from. | ||||
(7) Prior to leaving the block, the escort team will | ||||
obtain the key for the shackle from the IRF team | ||||
leader. | ||||
(8) After arriving at the triage location, they will | ||||
give the Hospital Escort NCOIC (alternate IRF team | ||||
leader) the key for the shackle along with ISN and cell | ||||
number. | ||||
o. ICRC Monitor (if available): | ||||
(1) Will escort ICRC personnel as quickly as | ||||
possible out of Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | ||||
(2) Will assist the Hospital Escort NCOIC | ||||
(alternate IRF team leader) as required. | ||||
p. General Escorts(ambulance escorts): | ||||
(1) Will escort all contractor personnel as quickly | ||||
as possible out of Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | ||||
(2) Each pair of general escorts will draw a can of | ||||
O/C will be drawn from the DOC. | ||||
(3) Each pair of general escorts will report to | ||||
manpower pool for duty as ambulance escorts or | ||||
additional security as directed by the Hospital Escort | ||||
NCOIC (Escort Control NCOIC). | ||||
(4) Will ensure they receive shackle keys from | ||||
the Hospital Escort NCOIC (alternate IRF team leader) | ||||
when detainee is loaded into the ambulance. | ||||
q. Medical Escorts(ambulance escorts): | ||||
(1) Will move detainees to locations as directed | ||||
by Escort Control. | ||||
(2) Will respond to the manpower pool location | ||||
with three-piece suits. | ||||
(3) Will work as litter bearers and provide | ||||
security for the triage locations as directed by the Litter | ||||
Bearer NCOIC (Escort Control NCOIC). | ||||
(4) Will mark their headgear with a white label to | ||||
identify them as a litter bearer. Medical personnel will | ||||
provide the labels. | ||||
(5) Will search detainee prior to removal from | ||||
the cell. | ||||
(6) When moving a detainee out of their cell, | ||||
they will ensure he is identified by wearing a wristband | ||||
or his cell and ISN are clearly marked on forehead. | ||||
They will also note the cell number he was taken from. | ||||
(7) Prior to leaving the block, the escort team will | ||||
obtain the key for the shackle from the IRF team | ||||
leader. | ||||
(8) After arriving at the triage location, they will | ||||
give the Hospital Escort NCOIC (alternate IRF team | ||||
leader) the key for the shackle along with ISN and cell | ||||
number. | ||||
r. IRF Team Leader of affected camp: | ||||
(1) Will obtain the alpha roster for the cellblock | ||||
from block personnel. | ||||
(2) Will track which shackle key belongs to | ||||
which detainee on the alpha roster. | ||||
(3) Will track initial triage category given by | ||||
ERT on alpha roster. | ||||
(4) Will hold all shackle keys and give them to | ||||
the litter bearer teams as they move detainees from the | ||||
block. | ||||
(5) Will direct the litter bearer teams based on | ||||
triage category. IMMEDIATE first, followed by | ||||
DELAYED, then MINIMAL, and finally | ||||
EXPECTANT. Military casualties will be transferred | ||||
before detainees with the same triage category. | ||||
(6) Will ensure no detainee leaves his cell | ||||
without wristband or ISN and cell written clearly on | ||||
the forehead. | ||||
(7) Will ensure no detainee leaves his cell | ||||
without the litter bearer team searching him. | ||||
(8) Will monitor detainees while in their three- | ||||
piece suits in their cells. | ||||
(9) Will track which detainees leave the block | ||||
with what key and what time on alpha roster. | ||||
s. IRF MPs: | ||||
(1) Upon notification, each primary IRF team | ||||
member from the camp affected by the MCI will secure | ||||
one three-piece suit with key from the block that they | ||||
are responding from. | ||||
(2) IRF team members will respond to the | ||||
affected block as is without putting on any IRF | ||||
equipment. | ||||
(3) Number 4 man will get the (2) two-piece suits | ||||
from the IRF equipment box. | ||||
(3) IRF team members will report to the Block | ||||
NCOIC or SOG of the affected block. | ||||
(4) IRF team members will enter and secure | ||||
detainees in three man teams. | ||||
(5) After each detainee is shackled, will ensure | ||||
all cuffs are double locked and will close the door and | ||||
secure it by sliding the bolt to latch the door. The door | ||||
will not be locked. | ||||
(6) Will give the shackle key to the IRF team | ||||
leader. | ||||
(7) The number 1, 2 and 3 man will form an entry | ||||
team. | ||||
(8) The number 4 man will act as a third team | ||||
member for the block personnel. If there is already | ||||
enough block personnel not including the block | ||||
NCOIC, to make up a three-man team; the number 4 | ||||
man will be security at the block gate. | ||||
t. Alternate IRF Team Leader of affected | ||||
camp(Hospital Escort NCOIC): | ||||
(1) Will track which detainees and ambulance | ||||
escorts are leaving Camp Delta by ISN and the medical | ||||
victim tag number. | ||||
(2) Will receive all keys for detainees brought | ||||
into the triage location and track which key belongs to | ||||
which detainee. | ||||
(3) Will ensure ambulance escorts have the keys | ||||
they are required to have. | ||||
u. Sally Port Guards: | ||||
(1) Upon notification of an MCI, Sally Port 8 will | ||||
open both of the outer sally port gates. The inner sally | ||||
port gate will be opened only as required. Emergency | ||||
vehicles will only be allowed entry into Camp Delta | ||||
through Sally Port 8. No vehicles may exit through | ||||
Sally Port 8. | ||||
(2) Upon notification of an MCI, Sally Port 1 will | ||||
open both of the inner sally port gates. All emergency | ||||
vehicles will exit Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. No | ||||
vehicles may enter through Sally Port 1. | ||||
(3) If the affected camp is Camp 1, Sally Port 3 | ||||
and Sally Port 4 will completely open both of the sally | ||||
port gates. If the affected camp is Camp 2, Sally Port 9 | ||||
and Sally Port 10 will completely open both of the | ||||
sally port gates. | ||||
(4) Soldiers assigned to sally ports will remain at | ||||
position. | ||||
v. Roving Sally: | ||||
(1) Priority is to get all IRF team members off of | ||||
their blocks. | ||||
(2) One roving sally will be stationed next to the | ||||
affected block’s gate. That roving sally will not leave | ||||
the affected block’s gate until the MCI is complete. | ||||
The roving sally will ensure their gate is closed unless | ||||
personnel need to enter or exit the block. | ||||
(3) The other roving sally will collect three-piece | ||||
suits from non-affected blocks as directed by the SOG | ||||
and take them to the affected block. | ||||
w. Interpreter OIC: | ||||
(1) Upon notification of an MCI the Interpreter | ||||
OIC will have all interpreters from every available | ||||
language respond to the man power pool. | ||||
(2) Interpreters will report to the On-Scene | ||||
Commander or SOG for further instructions. | ||||
(3) Interpreters will be required at the Naval | ||||
Hospital and will ride in the ambulance taking the | ||||
detainees to the Naval Base Hospital as needed. | ||||
(4) Initiate recall of interpreters as determined by | ||||
On-Scene Commander. | ||||
(5) Interpreters will be required at the Detainee | ||||
Hospital. | ||||
x. Infantry Support: | ||||
(1) Upon notification, Infantry QRF will respond | ||||
to the MCI site to enhance security. | ||||
(a) Infantry SOG will report to the On-Scene | ||||
Commander for further instructions. | ||||
(b) QRF will provide additional security at Sally | ||||
Port 1 and Sally Port 8 until relieved by mobile patrols. | ||||
(c) Once relieved, will return to the QRF | ||||
location. | location. | |||
(2) Lexington TCP will facilitate emergency | M. NAV BASE Emergency Vehicle Response to | |||
vehicle traffic: | Camp Delta: | |||
(a) All emergency vehicles leaving Camp Delta | 1. On-scene Medical Coordinator requests | |||
and heading towards NAVBASE Hospital have priority | ambulance through medical LNO in DOC. | |||
of passage through the TCP. | 2. Medical LNO in DOC contacts NAVBASE | |||
(b) All emergency vehicles traveling toward | hospital requesting ambulance support to Camp Delta, | |||
Camp Delta have the next highest priority. | to include entry and exit points. | |||
(c) All other vehicles will proceed through the | 3. NAVBASE Hospital will contact the JOC and let | |||
orange barricades from either end, one vehicle at a time | them know which ambulance is responding by bumper | |||
under the direction of TCP personnel. The stop/go sign | number. | |||
will not be used to direct traffic. | 4. License plate bumpers numbers in red identify | |||
(d) If any emergency vehicle approaches | ambulances. (NAVBASE 1-20/Detention hospital 20- | |||
Lexington TCP from either direction and a non- | 25). | |||
emergency vehicle is in the orange barricade zone, the | 5. DOC NCOIC notifies Camp Delta Sally ports of | |||
vehicle will be stopped next to the guard shack, the | inbound ambulances. | |||
emergency vehicle directed around to the opposite side | 6. JOC informs the Infantry TOC. | |||
of the guard shack, and then the non-emergency | 7. Infantry TOC informs Traffic control point (TCP). | |||
vehicle may proceed. | 8. Ambulances arrive at sally port 8, sally port | |||
(3) Infantry mobile patrols will respond to help | personnel verify license plate number. | |||
direct traffic. | 9. Traffic coordinator inside Camp Delta facilitates | |||
(a) A mobile patrol will respond to Lexington | movement of ambulances to MSA site. | |||
TCP to assist in handling traffic. | N. NAV BASE Explosives Military Working Dog | |||
(b) A mobile patrol will take up position outside | (MWD) Vehicle Response procedures: | |||
of Sally Port 8. They will ensure all traffic is stopped | 1. Any JDOG elements may request NAVBASE | |||
only when an emergency vehicle is arriving to enter | Explosives MWD through DOC. | |||
Camp Delta. | 2. DOC NCOIC contacts NAVBASE MWD | |||
(c) A mobile patrol will take up position outside | dispatch center at 4105 requesting Explosives | |||
of Sally Port 1. They will ensure all traffic is stopped | MWD support to incident scene. DOC | |||
only when an emergency vehicle is leaving Camp | NCOIC will keep an open line with | |||
Delta. | NAVBASE until confirmation is received of | |||
y. Guards on Unaffected Blocks: | the responding MWD call sign: K-1, K-2, K-3 | |||
(1) Will ensure all detainees are put back into | or K-4 and location of the incident scene. | |||
their cells. Any shower and recreation will end and | 3. NAVBASE MWD dispatch center will | |||
those detainees will be moved to their cell. | contact the JOC and let them know which | |||
MWD call sign: K-1, K-2, K-3 or K-4 is | ||||
(2) Headcount will be conducted and reported via | responding and location of incident scene. | |||
landline to the DOC. | 4. White Jeep Grand Cherokee with blue | |||
(3) Any detainee additions to block due to MCI | strobe mounted in dash identifies responding | |||
will be reported by ISN via landline. | MWD; emergency equipment will be | |||
(4) Increase presence on block to two MPs | activated upon dispatch from NAVBASE. | |||
walking the block at all times for the duration of the | 5. DOC NCOIC notifies Camp Delta Sally | |||
MCI or until directed otherwise. | ports and Infantry TOC of inbound | |||
z. Critical Locations (See Annex E for map): | NAVBASE MWD, the location of incident | |||
(1) Sally Port 8 will be used as the entrance for | scene and MWD call sign. | |||
all emergency vehicles responding to an MCI at Camp | 6. JOC informs the Infantry TOC. | |||
7. Infantry TOC informs Traffic control point (TCP), | ||||
MWD cleared, responds to incident scene. | ||||
8. NAVBASE MWD arrives at incident scene. | ||||
Note: If the incident scene is within Camp Delta, Sally | ||||
port personnel notified by DOC NCOIC will conduct | ||||
face-to-face identification and authenticate vehicle | ||||
description. A "Traffic coordinator" inside Camp Delta | ||||
will facilitate movement of NAVBASE MWD to | ||||
incident scene. | ||||
O.Sally Ports 1& 8: | ||||
SP #1 | ||||
1. Upon notification of an MCI, Sally Port 1 will | ||||
open both of the inner sally port gates. | ||||
2. Emergency vehicles will be allowed entry into | ||||
Camp Delta through Sally Port 1. | ||||
3. If MCI is located in Camp 1, Sally Port 3 and | ||||
Sally Port 4 will open both sally port gates. | ||||
SP #8 | ||||
1. Upon notification of an MCI, Sally Port 8 will | ||||
open both of the outer sally port gates. | ||||
2. Conduct bumper check (Red license plate | ||||
numbered) of emergency vehicles responding to Camp | ||||
Delta. | Delta. | |||
(2) Sally Port 1 will be used as the exit for all | 3. Emergency vehicles will be allowed entry into | |||
emergency vehicles leaving Camp Delta. | Camp Delta through Sally Port 8. | |||
(3) Camp 1 triage area will be in the area between | ||||
the fenceline running east from Sally Port 2 and the | ||||
fenceline running east from Sally Port 3. Military | ||||
triage will be on the south side running from Sally Port | ||||
3 and east towards where the golf cart parking is | ||||
located. Detainee triage will be on the north side | ||||
running from Sally Port 2 and east towards the | ||||
Detainee Clinic gate. It will be marked by an orange | ||||
flag. | ||||
(4) Camp 1 immediate patients will be located | ||||
along the orange barricades around building four | ||||
starting at the easternmost corner and going west. It | ||||
will be marked by a red flag. | ||||
(5) Camp 1 delayed patients will be located along | ||||
the orange barricades around building four starting | ||||
where the immediate patients end and continuing west. | ||||
Will be marked by a yellow flag. | ||||
(6) Camp 1 minimal patients will be placed in the | ||||
in-process holding area to the east of building 5. Will | ||||
be marked by a green flag. | ||||
(7) Ambulances responding to Camp 1 will park | ||||
just to the north of the immediate patient area at a 45 | ||||
degree angle with the front pointing towards Sally Port | ||||
(8) If no fire is present, fire trucks responding to | ||||
Camp 1 will park in the area between the Camp 1 | ||||
generators and the building 5 holding area. | ||||
(9) Camp 2 military triage will be located to the | ||||
south of building 7. It will be marked with an orange | ||||
flag. | ||||
(10) Camp 2 detainee triage will be located at the | ||||
base of the west steps of building 7. It will be marked | ||||
with an orange flag. | ||||
(11) Camp 2 immediate patients will be placed | ||||
near the CONEX located near Sally Port 9. It will be | ||||
marked with a red flag. | ||||
(12) Camp 2 delayed patients will be placed to | ||||
the west of Sally Port 9. It will be marked with a | ||||
yellow flag. | ||||
(13) Camp 2 minimal patients will be placed to | ||||
the west of building 9 within the fence enclosing | ||||
building 9. It will be marked by green flag. | ||||
(14) Ambulances responding to Camp 2 will park | ||||
side by side starting at the northwest corner of the mess | ||||
tent and moving out towards Sally Port 8. The front of | ||||
the vehicle will face Sally Port 7. | ||||
(15) If no fire is present, fire trucks responding to | ||||
Camp 2 will park in the area between the Camp 2 | ||||
generators and the mess tent. | ||||
(16) Military expectant patients from any camp | ||||
will be placed in the mess tent. | ||||
(17) Detainee expectant patients from any camp | ||||
will be placed under the tree located near the flag pole. | ||||
aa.Medical personnel will: | ||||
(1) Perform initial triage at the scene and send | ||||
victims by litter to the triage area (marked by an orange | ||||
flag) where the Triage Officer (wearing an orange vest) | ||||
will triage each victim into one of the four categories: | ||||
IMMEDIATE, DELAYED, MINIMAL, | ||||
EXPECTANT. | ||||
(2) The Duty Delta Officer (DDO) will send out | ||||
the Emergency Response Team (ERT), consisting of | ||||
two corpsman and a response bag. The ERT will not | ||||
enter any cell until the detainee is secured by the MPs. | ||||
(3) The ERT will assess the situation and provide | ||||
immediate feedback to the DDO regarding the number | ||||
of military/detainee casualties and their status. | ||||
(4) The on scene corpsman or ERT will | ||||
coordinate casualty transport to designated triage area | ||||
based on location of MCI. | ||||
(5) Should the Emergency Response Team (ERT) | ||||
find multiple casualties or one casualty in imminent | ||||
danger of losing life or limb, they will report this | ||||
immediately to the DDO at Delta Medical Clinic. | ||||
(6) The DDO will: | ||||
(a) If less than five casualties, contact the DOC at | ||||
#3239, the Detention Hospital OIC and the Detention | ||||
Hospital Senior Medical Officer (SMO). | ||||
(b) If greater than five casualties, contact DOC at | ||||
#3239 and the Detention Hospital Command Duty | ||||
Officer (CDO) by dialing their home phone number or | ||||
by pager by dialing 7-2090 and entering pager #062. | ||||
IMPORTANT: 1) The CDO must be contacted, if | ||||
contact cannot be made with the CDO, the OIC should | ||||
then be notified. 2) The DDO will coordinate all | ||||
emergency response activities until a more senior | ||||
officer arrives. | ||||
(7) The CDO will contact: | ||||
(a) #911 | ||||
(b) The Naval Hospital Emergency Department | ||||
at #3200 and state “This is the Command Duty Officer | ||||
for the Detention Hospital at Camp Delta, we have had | ||||
a Mass Casualty Incident beyond the scope of our | ||||
capabilities and require Naval Hospital Assistance, | ||||
please activate your Mass Casualty Recall Roster”. | ||||
Provide as much information as possible such as the | ||||
number of suspected deaths, wounded, etc. | ||||
(c) OIC, Detention Hospital (pager #068). | ||||
(d) SMO to have them to report immediately | ||||
(pager #038). | ||||
(e) Detention Hospital Duty Driver (pager #937). | ||||
(f) Activate the Mass Casualty Recall Roster. | ||||
(8) Recalled Personnel. Arriving recalled | ||||
personnel will muster in Delta Medical Clinic and | ||||
report to the Duty Delta Officer (DDO) for assignment | ||||
until OIC on scene. | ||||
(9) Medical personnel at Camp Delta will: | ||||
Perform initial triage at the scene and send victims by | ||||
litter to the triage area based on the location of the MCI | ||||
where the Triage Officer will triage each victim into | ||||
one of the four categories: IMMEDIATE, DELAYED, | ||||
MINIMAL, or EXPECTANT. | ||||
(a) After being triaged, the victims will be moved | ||||
to one of four areas to await transport. The immediate | ||||
area will be marked with a red flag and the Immediate | ||||
Category Leader will be wearing a red vest. The | ||||
delayed area will be marked with a yellow flag and the | ||||
Delayed Category Leader will be wearing a yellow | ||||
vest. The minimal area will be marked with a green | ||||
flag and the Minimal Category Leader will be wearing | ||||
a green vest. The expectant area will be marked with a | ||||
black flag and the Chaplain will be in this area. | ||||
(b) Once triaged, designated treatment teams, | ||||
locations and transportation modes are outlined as | ||||
follows: | ||||
(-) Military IMMEDIATE casualties will be sent | ||||
to the Naval Hospital GTMO via Naval Hospital | ||||
GTMO ambulance. | ||||
(-) Military DELAYED casualties will be sent to | ||||
the Naval Hospital GTMO via Naval Hospital GTMO | ||||
ambulance. | ||||
(-) Military MINIMAL casualties will be sent to | ||||
the Camp America Joint Aid Station via any available | ||||
military vehicle. | ||||
(-) Military EXPECTANT casualties will be sent | ||||
to the Camp Delta Mess Hall via litter bearer or | ||||
Detention Hospital ambulance. | ||||
(-) Detainee IMMEDIATE casualties will be sent | ||||
to the Naval Hospital GTMO for the first six and the | ||||
balance will be sent to the Detention Hospital via | ||||
Detention Hospital ambulance or litter bus. | ||||
(-) Detainee DELAYED casualties will be sent to | ||||
the Detention Hospital via Detention Hospital | ||||
ambulance or litter bus. | ||||
(-) Detainee MINIMAL casualties will be sent to | ||||
the Delta Medical Clinic via walked MP escort or | ||||
available carts. | ||||
(-) Detainee EXPECTANT casualties will be | ||||
sent to the tree near the Camp Delta Mess Hall via | ||||
Detention Hospital ambulance or litter bearer. | ||||
(10) Ambulance Transportation: | ||||
(a) After triage by the Triage Officer, victims are | ||||
tagged with their corresponding category and tracked | ||||
by the Medical Regulator. The Litter Bearer and | ||||
Transportation Coordinator then direct transportation to | ||||
treatment team locations as indicated in the chart | ||||
above. | ||||
(b) The Medical Regulator then radios Command | ||||
and Control with the victim’s category; detainee or | ||||
military. | ||||
(c) Two Detention Hospital Ambulances will be | ||||
pre-positioned outside of Delta Medical Clinic. | ||||
(d) All IMMEDIATE victims will take | ||||
precedence over DELAYED, MINIMAL, or | ||||
EXPECTANT. Initial triage is conducted as the | ||||
Emergency Response Team (ERT) removes victims | ||||
from the incident scene and then litter bearers take | ||||
casualties to the Triage Area. | ||||
(11) Litter Teams: | ||||
(a) Additional litter bearer support can be | ||||
obtained through Escort Control. | ||||
(b) The Litter Bearer Team Leader will | ||||
coordinate all litter teams to and from triage with the | ||||
MP Litter Bearer NCOIC. The Litter Bearer Team | ||||
Leader will communicate directly with the | ||||
Transportation Coordinator to keep casualty flow | ||||
uninterrupted. | ||||
(c) MPs: During initial triage, MPs will act as | ||||
litter bearers and assist the triage officer as required. | ||||
(12) Staging Areas: | ||||
(a) Staging areas for an MCI occurring in Camp | ||||
Delta 1 are located on the north side of the to the east | ||||
of Sally Port 1 along the north perimeter fence for | ||||
Delta-1. | ||||
(b) Staging areas for an MCI occurring in Delta 2 | ||||
are located adjacent to the triage area at Delta-2. | ||||
(13) Responsibilities. Job Action Sheets will be | ||||
found in the Mass Casualty Admin box. These sheets | ||||
are designed to be used by responding personnel as a | ||||
quick reference or checklist of primary duties for a | ||||
specific mass casualty job, but are not all inclusive of | ||||
the duties/actions that will be required during a mass | ||||
casualty incident. | ||||
(14) Teams. | ||||
(a) Command and control team will consist of | ||||
one officer and one administration assistant. | ||||
(b) Medical Commander (MC) will wear a blue | ||||
vest and consist of one officer. If an administration | ||||
assistant is available, they will assist the MC. | ||||
(c) Emergency Response Team (ERT) will | ||||
consist of two corpsmen responders and corpsmen | ||||
ambulance drivers. | ||||
(d) Triage team will consist of one Triage Officer | ||||
(MD/IDC/PA – first to arrive), one Medical Regulator, | ||||
one Litter Bearer Team Leader, one Transportation | ||||
Coordinator, one Transportation Administration | ||||
Corpsman. | ||||
(e) Staging Team for Military and Detainee | ||||
Immediate Casualties will consist of two nurses and | ||||
two corpsman. Casualties in this staging area are | ||||
awaiting transportation. Team to be supplemented by | ||||
MD/IDC/PA if needed as they arrive from NH GTMO. | ||||
(f) Staging Team for Military and Detainee | ||||
Delayed Casualties will consist of two nurses and two | ||||
corpsman. Casualties in this staging area are awaiting | ||||
transportation. Team to be supplemented by | ||||
MD/IDC/PA if needed as they arrive from NH GTMO. | ||||
(g) Staging Team for Military and Detainee | ||||
Minimal Casualties will consist of one nurse. | ||||
(h) Transportation to the Naval Hospital GTMO | ||||
will consist of Naval Hospital drivers using Naval | ||||
Hospital ambulances and Detention Hospital drivers | ||||
using Detention Ambulance Litter Bus for the first six | ||||
IMMEDIATE detainees. Transportation to the | ||||
Detention Hospital will consist of Detention Hospital | ||||
drivers, corpsman, MPs, and other available personnel | ||||
using Detention Hospital ambulances, pick-ups, gators, | ||||
golf carts, and other vehicles. | ||||
(i) Detention Hospital Teams will consist of an | ||||
Immediate Team with one MD, two nurses, and four | ||||
corpsman (including rad tech, RT) and a Delayed Team | ||||
with one MD, two nurses, and four corpsman. | ||||
(j) Staging Team for Military and Detainee | ||||
Expectant Casualties will consist of the Muslim | ||||
chaplain and one corpsman in the Detainee area and at | ||||
least one chaplain and one corpsman in the military | ||||
area. | ||||
(k) Litter Bearer Team will consist of one | ||||
corpsman as the team leader. Bearers will be | ||||
designated MP escort teams. | ||||
(l) Manpower Coordinator will be a corpsman or | ||||
any Detention Hospital staff member. | ||||
(m) Traffic Coordinator will be any available | ||||
personnel. | ||||
(15) Psychiatric Services. | ||||
(a) During the event of a mass casualty, all | ||||
personnel who are assigned to Psychiatric Services, | ||||
Detention Hospital, will be contacted and expected to | ||||
report to the Delta Medical Clinic immediately for | ||||
muster. They will be utilized for their medical | ||||
expertise initially until otherwise directed. These | ||||
personnel include one Psychologist, two Psychiatric | ||||
Nurse Corps Officers and six Psychiatric Techs. | ||||
(b) Mental Health / Psychiatric providers will | ||||
also be available after initial emergency response and | ||||
treatment. | ||||
(16) Supply. | ||||
(a) IMMEDIATE Mass Casualty Kit. One kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box at Delta Medical | ||||
Clinic for use at the Camp 1 MCI scene and one kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box near Sally Port 9 | ||||
for use at the Camp 2 MCI scene. | ||||
(b) DELAYED Mass Casualty Kit. One kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box at Delta Medical | ||||
Clinic for use at the Camp 1 MCI scene and one kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box near Sally Port 9 | ||||
for use at the Camp 2 MCI scene. | ||||
(c) MINIMAL Mass Casualty Kit. One kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box at Delta Medical | ||||
Clinic for use at the Camp 1 MCI scene and one kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box near Sally Port 9 | ||||
for use at the Camp 2 MCI scene. | ||||
(d) STAGING Area Mass Casualty Kit. One kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box at Delta Medical | ||||
Clinic for use at the Camp 1 MCI scene and one kit | ||||
staged in Mass Casualty CONEX box near Sally Port 9 | ||||
for use at the Camp 2 MCI scene. | ||||
(e) ADMIN Mass Casualty Box. One kit staged | ||||
inside the supply room at Delta Medical Equipment. | ||||
This kit contains: | ||||
(-) Triage signs/flags | ||||
(-) Bullhorns | ||||
(-) Patient tracking forms | ||||
(-) Flashlights | ||||
(-) Additional triage tags | ||||
(-) Job action sheets | ||||
(-) Identification vests | ||||
(f) Additional Emergency Response Supplies. | ||||
Additional emergency response supplies are located in | ||||
a CONEX box designated for bulk mass casualty | ||||
supplies. | ||||
(17) Colored Mass Casualty Boxes/Signs/Flags. | ||||
If any predetermined site is determined unsafe, the MC | ||||
and the On Scene Commander will designate an | ||||
alternate safe site. Triage category sites will be marked | ||||
by color coded medical response boxes. The boxes are | ||||
colored as follows: | ||||
(a) Triage - orange | ||||
(b) Immediate - red | ||||
(c) Delayed - yellow | ||||
(d) Minimal – green | ||||
(e) Expectant - black | ||||
(18) Radios. Radios will be utilized to facilitate | ||||
communication between all team-leaders: | ||||
(a) OIC | ||||
(b) ERT | ||||
(c) Triage Team Medical Regulator | ||||
(d) Litter Bearer Team Leader | ||||
(e) Transportation Coordinator | ||||
(f) Immediate Category Leader | ||||
(g) Delayed Category Leader | ||||
(19) Bullhorns. Bullhorns can also be utilized by | ||||
team leaders to facilitate communication between team | ||||
leaders and team members. | ||||
(20) Telephones. Telephones will be used to | ||||
relay information between Delta Medical Clinic, Joint | ||||
Aid Station, Detention Hospital and Naval Hospital | ||||
GTMO and to communicate to any other appropriate | ||||
facility. Use of phones for purposes other than | ||||
immediate victim/patient care is highly discouraged | ||||
during the incident. | ||||
(21) Safety. Safety is the priority, whether it be | 4. If MCI is located in Camp 2, Sally Port 9 and | |||
during an actual mass casualty response or a practice | Sally Port 10 will open both sally port gates. | |||
exercise. Prior to any Mass Casualty Exercise, a Safety | Note: In the event that one of the Sally ports is | |||
Officer must be appointed and has the authority to stop | rendered inoperative, emergency traffic flow will enter | |||
the drill if they feel that unsafe conditions exist. | and exit from the operational Sally port. The On-scene | |||
Additionally, any personnel or observer can stop the | Commander will make this decision and inform the | |||
exercise if they determine an unsafe environment | DOC. | |||
exists. | P. R&U: | |||
(22) Additional Resources. In the event that the | 1. Repair team reports to the On-scene | |||
resources of the Naval Hospital GTMO are overcome, | Commander | |||
the Wine Cellar can be used to house up to eight | 2. Immediately repairs any damage which | |||
additional victims. The local fire department maintains | compromises security | |||
four additional mass casualty medical supply boxes | 3. On order from the DOC, implements deceptive | |||
that can be utilized as necessary. | lighting plan. | |||
a. On-scene Commander directs R&U NCOIC | ||||
to the power substation adjacent to the water tanks | ||||
by Camp Bulkeley. | ||||
b. Enters the gate entering number “1998” in | ||||
the combination lock. | ||||
c. Proceed to the junction box with the | ||||
number “7012-83” the number for the lock on the | ||||
breaker box is “224”. | ||||
d. Call the JOC (5010/5038) from the phone | ||||
box and await second notification. | ||||
e. On-scene Commander directs the SOG for | ||||
each Camp to stand by the generators and prepare to | ||||
shut down generators when directed. | ||||
4. JOC issues second notification (confirmed | ||||
threat). | ||||
a. R&U NCOIC will go to the breaker box | ||||
and turn the switch that is labeled with | ||||
“TRIP/CLOSED”. The switch will be turned in | ||||
the direction of “TRIP”. This will shut down all | ||||
the power to all of Camp Delta. | ||||
b. R&U NCOIC will notify the JOC (5010/5038) | ||||
and confirm that the power is out, noting the time. | ||||
c. Camp Delta personnel will evacuate Camp | ||||
Delta IAW the Camp Delta Evacuation SOP. | ||||
32-11. Evacuation Routes | 32-11. Evacuation Routes | |||
a. The Detention Operations Officer, and in his | a. The Detention Operations Officer, and in his | |||
absence, the on-duty CO will direct an evacuation of | absence, the on-duty CO will direct an evacuation of | |||
US personnel and detainees when he believes that to be | US personnel and detainees when he believes that to be | |||
the most prudent course of action given the known | the most prudent course of action given the known | |||
situation. | situation. | |||
b. Evacuations will be made only to those areas | b. Evacuations will be made only to those areas | |||
required to assure the safety of US personnel and | required to assure the safety of US personnel and | |||
detainees. | detainees. | |||
c. DOC will remain manned unless absolutely | c. DOC will remain manned unless absolutely | |||
skipping to change at line 12836 | skipping to change at line 14883 | |||
movement security procedures. Security of detainees | movement security procedures. Security of detainees | |||
and safety of US personnel remains the top concern | and safety of US personnel remains the top concern | |||
when it becomes necessary to contravene established | when it becomes necessary to contravene established | |||
procedures because of the necessity of the situation. | procedures because of the necessity of the situation. | |||
(1) The following categories of detainees warrant | (1) The following categories of detainees warrant | |||
high security precautions: Level 4, Level 5, and | high security precautions: Level 4, Level 5, and | |||
detainees with a past history for violence or mental | detainees with a past history for violence or mental | |||
illness. | illness. | |||
(2) If evacuated from Camp Delta to another | (2) If evacuated from Camp Delta to another | |||
location, detainees will be shackled with three-piece | location, detainees will be shackled with three-piece | |||
suits and have an escort of at least two MPs each. | suits and have an escort of at least two guards each. | |||
(3) Detainees will be moved to the closest | (3) Detainees will be moved to the closest | |||
assembly area from their block consistent with a | assembly area from their block consistent with a | |||
minimum standoff distance of 300 ft from any | minimum standoff distance of 300 ft from any | |||
suspected explosive device. | suspected explosive device. | |||
e. Evacuation Routes and Assembly Areas. | e. Evacuation Routes and Assembly Areas. | |||
(1) Camp I admin buildings (JIG, SCIF, | (1) Camp I admin buildings (JIG, SCIF, | |||
Medical/In-Processing, CTC, DOC, JIIF). | Medical/In-Processing, CTC, DOC, and JIIF). | |||
(a) US personnel will evacuate through Sally Port | (a) US personnel will evacuate through Sally Port | |||
1 to AA RAT. | 1 to AA RAT. | |||
(b) Any detainees being interrogated will be | (b) Any detainees being interrogated will be | |||
escorted to AA IGUANA. Once all detainees are | escorted to AA IGUANA. Once all detainees are | |||
evacuated, MP escort will remain at AA IGUANA to | evacuated, escorts will remain at AA IGUANA to | |||
provide additional security. | provide additional security. | |||
(c) DOC personnel will remain at DOC until | (c) DOC personnel will remain at DOC until | |||
directed to evacuate by the DOO. | directed to evacuate by the DOO. | |||
(2) Camp I detainee blocks (A – I). | (2) Camp I detainee blocks (A – I). | |||
(a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | (a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | |||
Port 6 to AA BUZZARD. | Port 6 to AA BUZZARD. | |||
(b) Block MPs and roving sally port MPs will | (b) Block guards and roving sally port guards | |||
move with their detainees through Sally Port 6 and | will move with their detainees through Sally Port 6 and | |||
provide security at AA BUZZARD. | provide security at AA BUZZARD. | |||
(c) During an isolated incident involving one of | (c) During an isolated incident involving one of | |||
more blocks in Camp I but not blocks A, E, or I, | more blocks in Camp I but not blocks A, E, or I, | |||
detainees can be evacuated to AA SNAKE, which is | detainees can be evacuated to AA SNAKE, which is | |||
located in block J. | located in block J. | |||
(3) Camp II and III admin buildings (JDOG | (3) Camp II and III admin buildings (JDOG | |||
Intel/Interpreters, and JIIF). | Intel/Interpreters, and JIIF). | |||
(a) US personnel will evacuate through Sally Port | (a) US personnel will evacuate through Sally Port | |||
9 to AA MOUSE. | 9 to AA MOUSE. | |||
(b) Any detainees being interrogated will be | (b) Any detainees being interrogated will be | |||
escorted to AA ANT. Once all detainees are evacuated, | escorted to AA ANT. Once all detainees are evacuated, | |||
MP escort will remain at AA ANT to provide | escorts will remain at AA ANT to provide additional | |||
additional security. | security. | |||
(4) Camp II and III detainee blocks (K – T). | (4) Camp II and III detainee blocks (K – T). | |||
(a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | (a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | |||
Port 10 then Sally Port 9 to AA ANT. | Port 10 then Sally Port 9 to AA ANT. | |||
(b) Block MPs and roving sally port MPs will | (b) Block guards and roving sally port guards | |||
move with their detainees through Sally Port 10 then | will move with their detainees through Sally Port 10 | |||
Sally Port 9 to AA ANT. Block and roving sally port | then Sally Port 9 to AA ANT. Block and roving sally | |||
MPs will provide security at AA ANT. | port guards will provide security at AA ANT. | |||
(5) Camp IV detainee blocks (U – Y). | (5) Camp IV detainee blocks (U – Y). | |||
(a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | (a) Detainees will be evacuated through Sally | |||
Port 14, Sally Port 12, and Sally Port 5 to AA | Port 14, Sally Port 12, and Sally Port 5 to AA | |||
IGUANA. | IGUANA. | |||
(b) Block and roving patrol MPs will provide for | ||||
security enroute and will remain with their detainees at | (b) Block and roving patrol guards will provide | |||
AA IGUANA to provide security. | for security enroute and will remain with their | |||
detainees at AA IGUANA to provide security. | ||||
f. Evacuation of Camp Delta. The destructive | f. Evacuation of Camp Delta. The destructive | |||
weather plan K-span buildings located at Camp | weather plan K-span buildings located at Camp | |||
Bulkeley will be used for temporary housing in event | Bulkeley will be used for temporary housing in event | |||
that Camp Delta must be completely evacuated. | that Camp Delta must be completely evacuated. | |||
Detainees will be staged moving from their blocks to | Detainees will be staged moving from their blocks to | |||
an intermediate assembly area where they will be | an intermediate assembly area where they will be | |||
prepared for movement then to a departure assembly | prepared for movement then to a departure assembly | |||
area for movement. | area for movement. | |||
(1) Camp I (admin areas not directly in contact | (1) Camp I (admin areas not directly in contact | |||
with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 to AA | with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 to AA | |||
skipping to change at line 12903 | skipping to change at line 14951 | |||
with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 to AA | with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 to AA | |||
RAT. Personnel will be given assignments to assist in | RAT. Personnel will be given assignments to assist in | |||
detainee evacuation from Camp Delta. | detainee evacuation from Camp Delta. | |||
(2) Camp I (blocks A – I). Blocks will be | (2) Camp I (blocks A – I). Blocks will be | |||
evacuated one block at a time to AA SNAKE. | evacuated one block at a time to AA SNAKE. | |||
Detainees will be prepared for movement. Detainees | Detainees will be prepared for movement. Detainees | |||
will then be moved to AA IGUANA. Detainees will be | will then be moved to AA IGUANA. Detainees will be | |||
loaded into vehicles for movement to Camp Bulkeley. | loaded into vehicles for movement to Camp Bulkeley. | |||
(3) Camp II and III (admin areas not directly in | (3) Camp II and III (admin areas not directly in | |||
contact with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 | contact with detainees). Evacuate through Sally Port 1 | |||
to AA RAT. Personnel will be given assignments to | to AA RAT. Personnel will be given assignments to | |||
assist in detainee evacuation from Camp Delta. | assist in detainee evacuation from Camp Delta. | |||
(4) Camp II and III (blocks K – T). Blocks will be | (4) Camp II and III (blocks K – T). Blocks will be | |||
evacuated one block at a time to AA ANT. Detainees | evacuated one block at a time to AA ANT. Detainees | |||
will be prepared for movement. Detainees will then be | will be prepared for movement. Detainees will then be | |||
moved to AA MOUSE. Detainees will be loaded into | moved to AA MOUSE. Detainees will be loaded into | |||
vehicles for movement to Camp Bulkeley. | vehicles for movement to Camp Bulkeley. | |||
(5) Camp IV (blocks U – Y). Blocks will be | (5) Camp IV (blocks U – Y). Blocks will be | |||
evacuated to the Camp IV recreation area one block at | evacuated to the Camp IV exercise area one block at a | |||
a time. Detainees will be prepared for movement. | time. Detainees will be prepared for movement. | |||
Detainees will then be moved to AA IGUANA where | Detainees will then be moved to AA IGUANA where | |||
they will be loaded into vehicles for movement to | they will be loaded into vehicles for movement to | |||
Camp Bulkeley. | Camp Bulkeley. | |||
32-12. Destructive Weather | 32-12. Destructive Weather | |||
a. This Emergency Action Plan will be effective | a. This Emergency Action Plan will be effective | |||
unless updated or revised. | unless updated or revised. | |||
b. The Destructive Weather (DxWx) Plan is divided | b. The Destructive Weather (DxWx) Plan is divided | |||
into six phases: | into six phases: | |||
(1) Development | (1) Development | |||
(2) Establish detainee DxWx accommodations | (2) Establish detainee DxWx accommodations | |||
skipping to change at line 12949 | skipping to change at line 14996 | |||
prestaged and/or checked for usability. | prestaged and/or checked for usability. | |||
e. Implement DxWx operations. This phase will | e. Implement DxWx operations. This phase will | |||
entail JDOG will work in 12 hour shifts, Camp | entail JDOG will work in 12 hour shifts, Camp | |||
America preparing for movement, and the preparation | America preparing for movement, and the preparation | |||
for detainee movement. | for detainee movement. | |||
(1) At H-120, with H being the hour of landfall, a | (1) At H-120, with H being the hour of landfall, a | |||
FRAGO will be issued by the J-3. | FRAGO will be issued by the J-3. | |||
(2) At H-96, a Pre-Hurricane Conference/Key | (2) At H-96, a Pre-Hurricane Conference/Key | |||
Leader Rehearsal will be held. | Leader Rehearsal will be held. | |||
(3) At H-72, an alternate DOC will be established | (3) At H-72, an alternate DOC will be established | |||
at Bulkeley Hall. Leave will be cancelled. The | at one of the K-spans or bunkers. Leave will be | |||
breakdown of Detention Hospital, as required, will | cancelled. The breakdown of Detention Hospital, as | |||
commence. A complete accountability of all personnel | required, will commence. A complete accountability of | |||
will occur. | all personnel will occur. | |||
(4) Begin the lock down of Camp America. All | (4) Begin the lock down of Camp America. All | |||
lose items in Camp America, Camp Delta, and all other | lose items in Camp America, Camp Delta, and all other | |||
parts of JTF-GTMO will be secured to prevent them | parts of JTF-GTMO will be secured to prevent them | |||
from becoming projectile weapons. | from becoming projectile weapons. | |||
(5) All soldiers in Camp America will prepare an | (5) All soldiers in Camp America will prepare an | |||
A bag. | A bag. | |||
f. Movement. | f. Movement. | |||
(1) When winds of 64 knots or greater within 48 | (1) When winds of 64 knots or greater within 48 | |||
hours (H-48), commence the movement of detainees | hours (H-48), commence the movement of detainees | |||
from Detention Hospital. All interrogations will cease. | from Detention Hospital. All interrogations will cease. | |||
Camp America will be evacuated to the K-SPANs | Camp America will be evacuated to the K-SPANs | |||
(2) At H-36, internal and external security will be | (2) At H-36, internal and external security will be | |||
established at the shelters. The JDOG DOC will be | established at the shelters. The JDOG DOC will be | |||
established. The QRF at the shelters will be | established. The QRF at the shelters will be | |||
established. | established. | |||
(3) At H-24, all detainees will be moved from the | (3) At H-24, all detainees will be moved from the | |||
Detention Hospital to the Wine Cellar. | Detention Hospital to the Naval Hospital DACU (if | |||
there are 6 or less detainee inpatients) or the Wine | ||||
Cellar (if there are more than 6 detainee inpatients). | ||||
(4) At H-21, all vehicles to be used in the transfer | (4) At H-21, all vehicles to be used in the transfer | |||
will be staged inside Camp Delta next to the Detainee | will be staged inside Camp Delta next to the Detainee | |||
Clinic. All vehicles will have been filled and PMCS | Clinic. All vehicles will have been filled and PMCS | |||
will have been completed. Any mechanical problems | will have been completed. Any mechanical problems | |||
will have been corrected. A contingency bus, | will have been corrected. A contingency bus, | |||
ambulance, and QRF will stage at a central location, | ambulance, and QRF will stage at a central location, | |||
accessible to both the K-SPANs and Magazines. Key | accessible to both the K-SPANs and Magazines. Key | |||
leaders and key drivers will perform a route recon. | leaders and key drivers will perform a route recon. | |||
(5) Each escort will have 36 minutes to complete | (5) Each escort will have 36 minutes to complete | |||
one transfer of 30 detainees. | one transfer of 30 detainees. | |||
(6) At H-18, detainee transport will commence. | (6) At H-18, detainee transport will commence. | |||
Transfer will consist of two escort teams of infantry in | Transfer will consist of two escort teams of infantry in | |||
M1025 and two busses each containing 15 detainees, | M1025 and two busses each containing 15 detainees, | |||
six MPs, one driver, and an interpreter. All detainees | six guards, one driver, one hospital corpsman and an | |||
will be transported in three-piece suits and secured to | interpreter. All detainees will be transported in three- | |||
the eyebolts in the floor of the K-SPANs or magazines. | piece suits and secured to the eyebolts in the floor of | |||
the K-SPANs or magazines. | ||||
(7) At H-12, detainee transfer will be complete. | (7) At H-12, detainee transfer will be complete. | |||
Command and control will be transferred from the | Command and control will be transferred from the | |||
Camp Delta DOC to the Camp Bulkeley DOC. | Camp Delta DOC to the alternate DOC. | |||
(8) At H-6, the last shift rotation will occur. The | (8) At H-6, the last shift rotation will occur. The | |||
QRF will be in place in the K-SPANs and magazines. | QRF will be in place in the K-SPANs and magazines. | |||
Camp Delta and all TCPs and OPs will be secured. | Camp Delta and all TCPs and OPs will be secured. | |||
(9) At H+8, a recon will be conducted of Camp | (9) At H+8, a recon will be conducted of Camp | |||
America and Camp Delta. All items requiring repair | America and Camp Delta. All items requiring repair | |||
will be identified. | will be identified. | |||
(10) At H+12, begin to clear transportation routes | (10) At H+12, begin to clear transportation routes | |||
and initiate repairs of facilities. Stand-up Camp Delta. | and initiate repairs of facilities. Stand-up Camp Delta. | |||
(11) At H+24, Camp Delta will become | (11) At H+24, Camp Delta will become | |||
operational. | operational. | |||
(12) At H+30, begin transfer of detainees back to | (12) At H+30, begin transfer of detainees back to | |||
Camp Delta. | Camp Delta. | |||
(13) At H+48, transfer detainees from the Wine | (13) At H+48, transfer detainees from the Naval | |||
Cellar back to Detention Hospital. | Hospital DACU or Wine Cellar back to Detention | |||
Hospital. | ||||
(14) At H+54, reopen Camp America and begin | (14) At H+54, reopen Camp America and begin | |||
the resupply and repair of the DxWx sites. | the resupply and repair of the DxWx sites. | |||
32-13. Escape and Apprehension (E&A) | ||||
1. In the event of an escape from a facility that holds | ||||
detainees, prompt notification and accurate reporting | ||||
are key to the successfully apprehension of the escaped | ||||
detainee. | ||||
b. The guards at the incident location will | ||||
immediately perform the following actions: | ||||
2. Guards at the incident location will immediately | ||||
perform the following actions: | ||||
a. Notify the DOC of an escaped detainee. Precede | ||||
the message with the term “FLASH.” Then send a | ||||
SALUTE report to the DOC. | ||||
b. All other message traffic will cease on the net | ||||
except that which is pertaining directly to the escaped | ||||
detainee. | ||||
c. Secure the scene where the detainee escaped | ||||
from as a crime scene. | ||||
3. If the detainee is seen fleeing, no more than half of | ||||
the guards assigned to the block from which the escape | ||||
occurred will pursue the detainee(s). All block MP’s | ||||
stay on the blocks and continue detention mission. | ||||
4. The DOC will immediately perform the following | ||||
actions: | ||||
a. Notify and relay all information to both the | ||||
infantry TOC and the MWD team. | ||||
b. Initiate lock-down of the camp: Return all | ||||
detainees to their cells, regardless of their location. | ||||
None will leave the camp unless cleared by the JDOG; | ||||
exceptions are MWD teams, Combat camera team, | ||||
corpsman, and MP escort team assigned to the infantry | ||||
for detainee recovery. | ||||
c. Notify the CO. | ||||
d. Notify the CJDOG, DCJDOG, JDOG Ops, JOC, | ||||
Camp America Commandant’s office, R&U (through | ||||
MP’s on the block) to report to their section area and | ||||
await further instructions, and Combat Camera of the | ||||
escaped detainee. | ||||
e. Initiate a count of all facilities to include matching | ||||
picture ID’s to detainees. | ||||
f. Dispatch a camera operator, from the DOC, to the | ||||
escape location to film the scene and then be prepared | ||||
to move to the capture location if Combat Camera is | ||||
unavailable. | ||||
g. Direct a change to channel 15 to facilitate | ||||
communication with all elements. Monitor SINGAR | ||||
channels with TF-Iguana and JOC. | ||||
h. Notify the unit in training to be prepared to | ||||
supply troops to watch housing areas and other | ||||
facilities. | ||||
5. R&U NCOIC will report to the DOC and wait | ||||
further guidance to repair damages caused by the | ||||
escape. | ||||
6. Escort Control will immediately perform the | ||||
following actions: | ||||
a. Equip three two-man escort teams with OC, | ||||
three-piece suits. | ||||
b. Have teams meet the Detainee Medical Team at | ||||
the DOC, stage outside the wire with the Medical and | ||||
Combat Camera, and apprehend detainee once TF- | ||||
Iguana has located him. | ||||
7. MP Guards/TF-Iguana/MWD pursuing the | ||||
detainee(s): | ||||
a. Inside the wire, MPs have the primary | ||||
responsibility to pursue and apprehend the detainee(s). | ||||
Outside the wire, MWD and TF-Iguana have the | ||||
primary responsibility to pursue and apprehend the | ||||
detainee(s). | ||||
b. Detainee(s) must be apprehended IAW with the | ||||
RUF/ROE and inflicting as little injury as possible. | ||||
c. When possible, corner the detainee and await | ||||
additional assistance before subduing the detainee. | ||||
8. Detainee Medical/MP escort/Combat Camera team | ||||
will meet TF-Iguana escort team in front of the ICRC | ||||
building in the Camp Delta parking lot. | ||||
9. MWD team will: | ||||
a. Take commands from the DOC while inside the | ||||
wire. Outside the wire, take commands from TF- | ||||
Iguana. | ||||
b. Be prepared to take control of the scene after the | ||||
detainee(s) is (are) surrounded and until the detainee is | ||||
shackled. The handler will issue all commands to the | ||||
detainee(s) and friendly forces to ensure their safety | ||||
and the maximum effectiveness of the MWD. | ||||
10. At the point of capture, capturing unit will call | ||||
forward the Medical./MP/Camera team: | ||||
a. Detainee(s) will be shackled and searched by MP | ||||
Escort Teams. | ||||
b. Detainee(s) will be checked by a Corpsmen and | ||||
any immediate treatment will be conducted. | ||||
c. Detainee(s) will be video taped by a camera | ||||
operator from the Combat Camera or DOC camera | ||||
team. | ||||
d. Medical team with MP escort will move detainee | ||||
to Camp Delta detainee clinic for evaluation. | ||||
11. MP unit in training will be prepared to: | ||||
a. Assemble all troops in their housing area. | ||||
b. Become OPCON to TF-Iguana to augment | ||||
search/sweep capabilities. | ||||
12. TF-Iguana will follow their SOP for reaction to | ||||
escaped detainee and maintain continuous | ||||
communications with the DOC. | ||||
13. All actions will be IAW the use of force RUF/ROE | ||||
as outlined in JTF-Guantanamo OPORD. | ||||
32-16 Intrusion Detection System (IDS) Alarm T- | ||||
SCIF | ||||
1. General: Infantry QRF responds from vic Camp | ||||
Echo and secures T-SCIF, Camp Delta upon IDS | ||||
alarm activation. | ||||
2. Requirements: | ||||
a. SOG in Tower # 1 will notify the DOC that an | ||||
audible alarm has been activated at the T-SCIF. | ||||
b. The DOC NCOIC will notify the QRF via Long | ||||
Range Saber (primary), and/or landline (secondary) | ||||
that the IDS alarm has been activated and securing the | ||||
perimeter of the building is required. | ||||
c. Armed QRF respond to Camp Delta through | ||||
Sally Port 1with individually assigned weapons and 1 | ||||
magazine inserted into the magazine well. No soldier | ||||
will lock a round into the chamber of the weapon. | ||||
ROE/RUF, dated 30 Nov 02 applies. | ||||
d. Deploy within 15 minutes of IDS alarm | ||||
activation to secure T-SCIF Bldg #4 Camp Delta. | ||||
3. QRF Procedures: | ||||
a. QRF secures their weapons, ammunition, LBV, | ||||
and Kevlar. | ||||
b. One member of the QRF will remain at the QRF | ||||
building to secure remaining equipment and monitor | ||||
communications. | ||||
c. QRF deploys to T-SCIF. | ||||
d. The DOC will notify sally port 1, JOC, | ||||
DCJDOG, MWD Team and T-SCIF Security Manager | ||||
that an audible alarm has been activated and that the | ||||
QRF has secured the exterior of the building. | ||||
e. Upon arrival at the T-SCIF, the Infantry QRF | ||||
Team Leader will place one soldier at each of the two | ||||
entrances. One soldier will occupy Tower # 2. The | ||||
remaining soldiers will form a perimeter around the | ||||
front of the building, ensuring 100% visibility of the | ||||
structure. | ||||
f. The QRF will secure the building not allowing | ||||
entrance and/or exit of personnel and notify the DOC | ||||
when this is completed. | ||||
g. The DOC will notify the SOG in Tower #1 that | ||||
the T-SCIF Security Manager and WMD are enroute to | ||||
Camp Delta, to facilitate initial contact with the QRF | ||||
Team Leader. | ||||
h. Once the MWD Team and T-SCIF Security | ||||
Manager arrive they will be granted unimpeded access | ||||
to the building. | ||||
i. The MWD Team will sweep both the interior | ||||
and exterior of the building. | ||||
j. In the event unauthorized person/s are located | ||||
within the T-SCIF, NAVBASE Security will respond | ||||
and detain the person/s until J2 advises | ||||
confirmed/unconfirmed access. | ||||
k. Once the building has been cleared, the T-SCIF | ||||
Security Manager will re-secure the building and reset | ||||
the IDS alarm. | ||||
l. The QRF will collapse security and return to the | ||||
QRF CP. | ||||
m. The QRF and SOG will log the event in their | ||||
daily logs IAW SOP. | ||||
Position Name Work | ||||
# | ||||
Cell | ||||
# | ||||
Home | ||||
# | ||||
SCIF | ||||
Special | ||||
Security | ||||
Representati | ||||
ve (SSR) | ||||
SFC Kjosa 3376 8381 | ||||
*alt #1 MSG Park 3209 8383 | ||||
*alt #2 MSG Cater 3458 8381 | ||||
JTF J2 SSO Frank | ||||
Perkins | ||||
3462 7379 | ||||
JTF Security | ||||
Mgr. | ||||
MAJ | ||||
Hodson | ||||
3643 8669 | ||||
Deputy J2 MAJ | ||||
Williams | ||||
3643 84177 8669 | ||||
J2 LTC Mull 3432 84028 8053 | ||||
32-17. Camp Coordinated Contraband Search & | ||||
Seizure | ||||
a. Intent. JDOG Commander may order a full | ||||
search of Camp Delta or any camp or block within. | ||||
The intent of the search is to identify detainees who | ||||
have items of possible intelligence value or items, | ||||
which may pose a security risk to the guard force of | ||||
Camp Delta. During the search, all contraband items | ||||
will be removed from the detainees and placed into | ||||
evidence channels for the intelligence community. End | ||||
state occurs when every cell, bay, and common area | ||||
has been searched, and all contraband has been | ||||
identified and removed. Measures of success are no | ||||
contraband left in the detainee population; detainees of | ||||
intelligence value identified, and heightened level of | ||||
security awareness among the MP’s. | ||||
b. Concept of the Operation. This operation is | ||||
best executed at night, when movements can more | ||||
readily be halted. The operation will normally take 12 | ||||
hours for one company to complete all of Camps 1, 2, | ||||
and 3. An operational pause may then occur. It will | ||||
take an additional 10 hours to complete Camp 4. There | ||||
will be one search and seizure team per “row” of | ||||
cellblocks. Empty cells will be searched in sequence. | ||||
Once the operation has begun, it will continue until | ||||
every area has been searched. S2 provides oversight of | ||||
the operation to ensure that contraband items are | ||||
properly identified and seized and MPI ensures that all | ||||
seized items are properly accounted for. | ||||
c. MP Company in training cycle: | ||||
(1) Establish company/operation CP at CP2. | ||||
(2) Execute the search of Camp Delta. Each | ||||
search teams consist of, as a minimum, 1 MP NCOIC | ||||
to document what is found in each cell and 1 MP to | ||||
conduct the search. | ||||
(3) DO NOT TOUCH THE KORANS. | ||||
(4) Provide 3 IRF teams. | ||||
(5) Provide 2 escort teams per “row” of blocks. | ||||
(6) Conduct a pat-down search (per instructions | ||||
of Camp Delta Superintendent) of detainees prior to | ||||
returning them to their cells. | ||||
(7) Move detainees in and out of their cells in | ||||
support of the search. Detainees will be moved to the | ||||
recreation areas (1 detainee per area) and showers (1 | ||||
detainee per shower) and watched at all times. | ||||
(8) Receive training from S2 on what | ||||
constitutes contraband, MPI on proper documentation | ||||
and handling of contraband, and Camp Delta | ||||
Superintendent on proper search procedures. | ||||
(9) Provide additional manning (1 soldier per | ||||
occupied block) to midnight shift. | ||||
(10) Direct coordination with Delta Block must | ||||
be conducted prior to operation. | ||||
Direct coordination with Camp 4 NCOIC is authorized. | ||||
d. S2: | ||||
(1) Provide training on what types of intelligence | ||||
contraband we are looking for. | ||||
(2) Coordinate for interpreter support to explain | ||||
to detainees that we are conducting a shakedown and to | ||||
move Korans if they are in the way of a search. | ||||
Interpreters will report to Camp Delta Superintendent | ||||
for additional instruction. | ||||
(3) Provide a representative per “row” of cell | ||||
blocks to assist MP search and seizure teams in | ||||
determining if items are contraband. | ||||
(4) Provide a representative in the contraband | ||||
holding area to receive items from S4. | ||||
e. S3: | ||||
(1) Provide Gator(s) to S4 section to move | ||||
contraband from cell blocks to contraband holding | ||||
area. | ||||
(2) Coordinate with QRF for potential emergency | ||||
action procedures. | ||||
(3) Designate a training area that provides for a | ||||
noise-free environment for this training. | ||||
(4) Provide barbers and camera operators to | ||||
accompany/support IRF teams. | ||||
(5) Coordinate with detainee hospital for | ||||
medical/decon personnel. | ||||
f. S4: | ||||
(1) Provide personnel to move evidence from | ||||
blocks to contraband holding area. | ||||
(2) Coordinate for additional rations at Delta | ||||
mess for the MP training company. Have MRE’s | ||||
available in case the MP’s cannot break for chow. | ||||
g. MPI: | ||||
(1) Provide enough evidence envelopes: One for | ||||
each cell in Camps 1, 2, and 3 and two for each bunk in | ||||
Camp 4. Each envelope will be marked with the | ||||
cell/block number or bunk/block number and will have | ||||
an evidence form on the inside. | ||||
(2) Provide training on proper procedures for | ||||
custody paperwork to search teams. | ||||
(3) Designate a contraband holding area. | ||||
(4) Be present throughout operation to provide | ||||
guidance on proper handling of contraband. | ||||
h. MWD: Have two dog teams at Camp Delta | ||||
prepared to respond as determined by the Training MP | ||||
Company Commander. Coordinate directly with | ||||
Training MP Company Commander. | ||||
i. MP’s on the block: Constantly walk the blocks, | ||||
reporting any detainees attempting to pass or conceal | ||||
anything. | ||||
j. Camp 4: | ||||
(1) Bay Leaders will be given a 2-hour window | ||||
of amnesty. Once the 2 hours are over, all bays will be | ||||
searched. If contraband is found, the bay leaders will | ||||
be required to move to Camp 3. CJDOG will be the | ||||
approving authority for any moves out of Camp 4. | ||||
(2) All bays will be locked down. | ||||
(3) The first block to be searched will be | ||||
vacated: One bay will be moved at a time. Detainees | ||||
will be moved, 1 block each to the 3 recreation yards of | ||||
the other blocks and 1 block to the ICRC area. | ||||
(4) Bays will be searched simultaneously; one | ||||
search team per bay. The recreation area will also be | ||||
searched, including under the gravel. | ||||
(5) Detainees will then be moved back to their | ||||
bays. | ||||
(6) The process will be repeated for each of the | ||||
blocks. | ||||
Chapter 33 | ||||
Camp 4 Standard Operating | ||||
Procedures | ||||
33-1. Commanders Intent | ||||
a. Camp 4 conducts medium security detention | ||||
operations in assigned area of Camp Delta in order to | ||||
support intelligence-gathering activities from detainees | ||||
and promote cooperation by providing increased | ||||
privileges and opportunities for social interaction | ||||
thereby increasing the desire of other detainees to be in | ||||
Camp 4. On order, conducts preparatory operations for | ||||
transferring selected detainees for departure from Joint | ||||
Task Force Guantanamo | ||||
b. Camp 4 Focus | ||||
(1) Reinforcement of reward for cooperative | ||||
behavior. | ||||
(2) Enhance intelligence effort through control of | ||||
detainees in a less restrictive environment. | ||||
(3) Medium security setting is an incentive for | ||||
detainees to cooperate with interrogators | ||||
(4) Increased privileges and rewards result in | ||||
more cooperative detainee mind-set, providing further | ||||
opportunity for intelligence exploitation. | ||||
33-2. Manning Requirements | ||||
a. Camp 4 has six main areas of responsibility | ||||
within the Camp to man. There will be one NCOIC in | ||||
the grade of E-7. Each shift at a minimum must man | ||||
one SOG position in the grade of E-5 or higher, one | ||||
Sally Port 14 guard, one Liberty Tower operator, four | ||||
Block NCO’s in the grade E-4 (P) or higher, and 4 | ||||
Block Observers. One block NCO and one block | ||||
observer will be mandatory for each of the four blocks | ||||
within the Camp. | ||||
b. There are two 12-hour shifts at Camp 4 that make | ||||
up the work period. There is a morning shift which | ||||
reports at 0530 for guard mount at Camp 4 and a mid- | ||||
shift that reports at 1730 for guard mount. Each shift | ||||
will be relieved by the oncoming shift within 30 | ||||
minutes of the oncoming shifts guard mount. Each | ||||
shift SOG will conduct a shift AAR immediately after | ||||
being relieved of duty prior to exiting the Camp 4 area. | ||||
Each unit assigned to Camp Delta JDOG will be | ||||
required to release a select amount of soldiers as | ||||
requested by the JDOG S-3 SGM to be assigned to | ||||
Camp 4 Special Missions. These soldiers will be hand | ||||
selected by their command to meet the JDOG S-3 SGM | ||||
guidance for selection. One requirement is the service | ||||
member must volunteer to work at Camp 4. The | ||||
selected soldiers will have the correct mentality, | ||||
physical fitness, military bearing, and be able to work | ||||
well with little or no supervision. Excellent public | ||||
relations (PR) skills are a must. Each soldier will be | ||||
assigned in a temporary manner during their training | ||||
phase, consisting of three 12 hour work periods. If the | ||||
soldier does not meet the required skills required, they | ||||
will be returned to their respective unit, who will then | ||||
provide a replacement body from those soldiers who | ||||
have been interviewed or screened by their command. | ||||
This must be done within 24 hours of a soldier being | ||||
released back to his unit. The JDOG S-3 SGM is in | ||||
charge of Special Missions and may conduct an | ||||
interview prior to assignment to Camp 4. The Camp 4 | ||||
NCOIC will make a report and recommendation to the | ||||
JDOG S-3 SGM after the initial training period as to | ||||
the soldier's performance and potential at Camp 4. | ||||
33-3. Leave Policy | ||||
a. Camp 4 is allowed to have 10% of assigned | ||||
personnel on leave at any given time. Soldiers must | ||||
have 60 days minimum time on island before the Camp | ||||
4 NCOIC can approve ordinary or EML leave. This | ||||
does not apply to emergency leave. If a unit sends a | ||||
Camp 4 assigned soldier on emergency leave, that unit | ||||
will be responsible to furnish a replacement soldier | ||||
until the soldier on emergency leave returns. The | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC cannot approve more than 15 days of | ||||
ordinary or EML leave without the consent of the | ||||
soldiers’ unit commander. Soldiers must acquire an | ||||
exception to policy to take more than one major | ||||
holiday during any one period of leave off the island, | ||||
i.e. Christmas and New Years together (24 December | ||||
thru 2 January) consecutively by order of the JTF | ||||
Commanding General. Exception to policy may be | ||||
obtained through J-1 at the commissions building. | ||||
33-4. Chain of Command (Command and Control) | ||||
a. Chain of Command as follows: | ||||
(1) Current shift SOG of Camp 4 | ||||
(2) Camp 4 NCOIC | ||||
(3) JDOG S-3 SGM | ||||
(4) JDOG S-3 OIC | ||||
(5) JDOG Superintendent | ||||
(6) JDOG Deputy Commander | ||||
(7) JDOG Commander | ||||
b. No Officers, NCOs, outside the Camp 4 chain of | ||||
command will enter the Camp 4 Sally Port without the | ||||
on duty SOG or Camp 4 NCOIC being present. Units | ||||
with soldiers assigned to Camp 4 will not visit with | ||||
soldiers while the soldier is on duty within Camp 4 | ||||
without the Camp 4 NCOIC’s permission or | ||||
acknowledgement, as to not disrupt the ongoing | ||||
mission within Camp 4. | ||||
33-5. Service and Support | ||||
a. The mid shift SOG will inventory all Camp 4 | ||||
supplies on Wednesday night and furnish a copy of | ||||
supply items needed for the NCOIC to order through S- | ||||
4 on Thursday morning by e-mail. Supply items will | ||||
be requested for 7 days of operations at a time. Camp | ||||
4 will not stockpile or overstock supply items. Just | ||||
those items needed to sustain operations within Camp 4 | ||||
will be requested. | ||||
b. Linen will be requested by phone on Thursday | ||||
mornings through the JDOG S-4 laundry service. All | ||||
detainees will receive clean uniforms and linen once a | ||||
week. Blankets will be exchanged once a month on | ||||
Saturday. Blanket exchange will be by designated | ||||
weekend for each block in Camp 4. Water bottles and | ||||
toothbrushes will also be exchanged one- for-one on | ||||
that blocks blanket exchange day. All detainee items | ||||
are a one-for-one exchange. For example, an empty | ||||
toothpaste tube is required for a detainee to receive a | ||||
full toothpaste tube in exchange. Likewise, an empty | ||||
toilet paper roll is required to receive a full roll, an | ||||
empty, damaged or dirty water bottle to receive a new | ||||
water bottle, etc… Dirty linen will be inspected for | ||||
damage, marked and packaged separately from dirty | ||||
linen for laundry service. During linen exchange, the | ||||
soldier conducting linen exchange will inspect the | ||||
clean linen for damage and cleanliness. Any | ||||
deficiencies will be brought to the attention of the SOG | ||||
and NCOIC so they may contact the S-4 laundry | ||||
service personnel. At a maximum, two sets of detainee | ||||
dirty linen will be placed in each brown trash bag and | ||||
tied shut. Dirty linen trash bags will be placed neatly | ||||
in the storage bins located next to the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building for pick-up by the S-4 laundry | ||||
personnel on Monday mornings. | ||||
c. MREs will be dropped off by S-4 weekly for | ||||
detainee fasting. Detainees are given one MRE each | ||||
on Sunday night for Monday fasting and one MRE on | ||||
Wednesday night for Thursday fasting. | ||||
d. Additional supply items to support the Camp 4 | ||||
mission will be e-mailed to the JDOG S-4 along with a | ||||
NSN number or stock number of the item to be | ||||
ordered. These items not normally stocked by the S-4 | ||||
warehouse will be approved through the DOC and S-4 | ||||
prior to ordering or requesting. Some examples of | ||||
these items are fans, brooms, mops, mop buckets, | ||||
storage bins, grey detainee tubs, prayer rugs, etc… | ||||
e. Religious items will be requested through the | ||||
JDOG Islamic chaplain. These items include but are | ||||
not limited to the following: | ||||
(1) Prayer caps | ||||
(2) Prayer oil | ||||
(3) Prayer beads | ||||
(4) Issuing of the Quran to a detainee | ||||
(5) Any other Islamic or Muslim religious | ||||
material | ||||
f. NIPR/SIPR/PDA/DIMMS issues concerning | ||||
operation of or repair with these systems will be | ||||
directed through the S-6 representative. Personal | ||||
account problems with NIPR or SIPR can be handled | ||||
through the J-6 help desk number located in the JTF | ||||
phonebook. Any problems with Camp 4 radios will be | ||||
handled through the DOC communications personnel. | ||||
All radios and electronic communications equipment in | ||||
Camp 4 are hand receipted through the S-3 SGM to the | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC. Any equipment such as radios that | ||||
are turned in for repair will need a turn-in document for | ||||
Camp 4 records. No person in Camp 4, except the | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC, may sign for Camp 4 electronics or | ||||
communications equipment. All hand receipts for | ||||
Camp 4 will be kept on file in the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building. | ||||
(g) K-9/IRF/QRF issues of a non-emergency nature | ||||
will be requested through the S-3 SGM. If the S-3 | ||||
SGM is not available the next higher S-3 staff person | ||||
will be notified of the request. The DOC will always | ||||
be notified of intent to use or use of the QRF and K-9 | ||||
units in a non-emergency situation. IRF teams in non- | ||||
emergency situations will be approved by S-3. In | ||||
emergency situations, where the safety of an MP, or | ||||
any other military or civilian person is in jeopardy, the | ||||
SOG on shift or the Camp 4 NCOIC may give the | ||||
duress code to alert the DOC. In an emergency | ||||
situation involving a riot or Camp wide disturbance | ||||
with Camp 4 personnel inside the Camp 4 perimeter, | ||||
the SOG or NCOIC may use the QRF without prior | ||||
DOC approval only if it is justified. The DOC will be | ||||
notified if IRF teams need to be requested along with | ||||
K-9 support. In situations involving a group of | ||||
detainees refusing to lock down inside their bays after | ||||
recreation or chow, the NCOIC or SOG on duty may | ||||
request K-9 support through the DOC without S-3 | ||||
involvement as a show of force to get the detainees to | ||||
comply. | ||||
33-6. Personnel Responsibilities | ||||
a. The NCOIC areas of responsibility are the daily | ||||
operations within the Camp 4 perimeter, to ensure | ||||
manning requirements are met daily. One of the | ||||
NCOIC’s duties is to conduct periodic inspections of | ||||
Camp 4 security and ensure a safe working | ||||
environment. The NCOIC is responsible for ensuring | ||||
all rules and regulations for Camp 4 are followed and | ||||
enforced by all assigned personnel, MP’s and detainees | ||||
alike. The NCOIC will receive periodic briefings from | ||||
the JDOG S-3 and JIG/ICE personnel as well as the | ||||
JDOG S-2 as mandated. The NCOIC will report any | ||||
maintenance issues to the R&U section for repair. The | ||||
S-3 SGM will receive periodic updates from the Camp | ||||
4 NCOIC on operations at Camp 4 and any issues the | ||||
NCOIC deems necessary to ensure a successful | ||||
mission. On call, the NCOIC will conduct VIP and | ||||
various media tours of Camp 4. The NCOIC will | ||||
receive tour information from the JDOG S-3 office no | ||||
later than one week in advance. | ||||
b. The day shift SOG responsibilities include but are | ||||
not limited to the following: | ||||
(1) Ensure a licensed bus driver is available and | ||||
identified to pick-up personnel scheduled for work | ||||
each morning at the designated housing areas for | ||||
movement to Camp Delta. | ||||
(2) Establish a transportation pick-up time for | ||||
their shift for movement to Camp Delta. | ||||
(3) Cleanliness and care of the Camp 4 | ||||
transportation vehicle while it is under control by their | ||||
shift personnel. | ||||
(4) Ensure the Camp 4 transportation vehicle is | ||||
fueled and always ready for use. | ||||
(5) Conduct the 0530 guard mount formation. | ||||
(6) Complete and maintain a DA-6 manning | ||||
roster for his/her shift to include shift personnel on | ||||
leave, sick call, duty, or pass. | ||||
(7) 100% physical headcount of all assigned | ||||
detainees at shift start. | ||||
(8) Conduct a 100% physical inventory of all | ||||
assigned radios, batteries, Camp 4 keys, and assigned | ||||
equipment before relieving night shift. | ||||
(9) Ensure all MP’s on their shift are trained in | ||||
their assigned area of operations. | ||||
(10) Complete a manning roster to be turned into | ||||
the DOC at the beginning of shift immediately after | ||||
guard mount. | ||||
(11) Make sure all current guard mount messages | ||||
are relayed to the new on coming shift. | ||||
(12) To receive an oncoming briefing from the | ||||
night shift SOG they are relieving. | ||||
(13) To conduct an AAR after being relieved by | ||||
the night shift. | ||||
(14) Account for all detainees assigned to Camp | ||||
4 throughout their shift. | ||||
(15) E-mail or place a message in the NCOIC in- | ||||
box of any issues or concerns that occur during their | ||||
shift. | ||||
(16) In case of emergency, attempt to notify the | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
(17) Maintain cleanliness and keep Camp 4 in an | ||||
orderly fashion throughout their shift. This includes | ||||
taking proactive measures to correct any deficiencies or | ||||
making aware of any work orders that need to be | ||||
submitted through the Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
(18) Enforce Camp 4 rules and regulations and to | ||||
suggest any updates or changes to policy and | ||||
procedures through the Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
c. The night shift SOG responsibilities include but | ||||
are not limited to the following: | ||||
(1) Ensure a licensed bus driver is available and | ||||
identified to pick-up personnel scheduled for work | ||||
each morning at the designated housing areas for | ||||
movement to Camp Delta. | ||||
(2) Establish a transportation pick-up time for | ||||
their shift for movement to Camp Delta. | ||||
(3) Cleanliness and care of the Camp 4 | ||||
transportation vehicle while it is under control by their | ||||
shift personnel. | ||||
(4) Regular maintenance and dispatching of the | ||||
Camp 4 transportation vehicle while it is under control | ||||
by their shift. | ||||
(5) Conduct the 1730 guard mount formation. | ||||
(6) Complete and maintain a DA-6 manning | ||||
roster for his/her shift to include shift personnel on | ||||
leave, sick call, duty, or pass. | ||||
(7) 100% physical headcount of all assigned | ||||
detainees at shift start. | ||||
(8) Conduct a 100% physical inventory of all | ||||
assigned radios, batteries, Camp 4 keys, and assigned | ||||
equipment before relieving night shift. | ||||
(9) Ensure all MP’s on their shift are trained in | ||||
their assigned areas of operations. | ||||
(10) Complete a manning roster to be turned into | ||||
the DOC at the beginning of shift immediately after | ||||
guard mount. | ||||
(11) Make sure all current guard mount messages | ||||
are relayed to the new on coming shift. | ||||
(12) To receive an oncoming briefing from the | ||||
day shift SOG they are relieving. | ||||
(13) To conduct an AAR after being relieved by | ||||
the day shift. | ||||
(14) Account for all detainees assigned to Camp | ||||
4 throughout their shift. | ||||
(15) E-mail or place a message in the NCOIC in- | ||||
box of any issues or concerns that occur during their | ||||
shift. | ||||
(16) In case of emergency, attempt to notify the | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
(17) Maintain cleanliness and keep Camp 4 in an | ||||
orderly fashion throughout their shift. This includes | ||||
taking proactive measures to correct any deficiencies or | ||||
making aware of any work orders that need to be | ||||
submitted through the Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
(18) Nightshift will be responsible for a 100% | ||||
Camp 4 supply inventory on Wednesday nights, and a | ||||
list will be compiled for the Camp 4 NCOIC to order | ||||
from on Thursday mornings through JDOG S-4. | ||||
(19) The night shift SOG will verify, the night | ||||
prior to media and VIP tours that Camp 4 is in a high | ||||
state of readiness for the visits. | ||||
(20) Night shift SOG will verify all lighting | ||||
within the Camp 4 area of operations is functional and | ||||
will note any discrepancies or shortcomings. | ||||
(21) Ensure soldiers working as block observers | ||||
are using headsets with their radios as not to disrupt the | ||||
detainee's sleep. | ||||
(22) Enforce Camp 4 rules and regulations and to | ||||
suggest any updates or changes to policy and | ||||
procedures through the Camp 4 NCOIC. | ||||
d. The Camp 4 Block NCO’s duties vary by nature | ||||
and mission of each individual block depending on | ||||
specific guidance by JIG/ICE, S-2, S-3, or the Camp 4 | ||||
NCOIC. The list below is for general guidance of | ||||
performing duties as a Block NCO and may be subject | ||||
to special considerations as set forth by higher. | ||||
(1) Block NCO’s are responsible for all activities | ||||
scheduled for their assigned block. These include | ||||
compound recreation, feeding, showering, central | ||||
recreation, reservation pick-up and drop-off, medical | ||||
appointments, ICRC visits, interrogator visits, sick call, | ||||
media and VIP tours. | ||||
(2) Ensure all block assigned detainees follow all | ||||
applicable rules and policy within their areas of | ||||
responsibility. All block doors will be secure during | ||||
compound recreation, central recreation, and chow. | ||||
(3) Ensure the Block Observers rotating to their | ||||
assigned block are aware of any special considerations | ||||
affecting the mission of that specific block. | ||||
(4) Conduct a 100% physical headcount upon | ||||
relieving the off going Block NCO. | ||||
(5) Verify all detainee ISN cards are present in | ||||
the Block NCO book for that assigned block. | ||||
(6) Maintain control and discipline within their | ||||
assigned block. | ||||
(7) Notify the Camp 4 SOG on duty of any | ||||
situations requiring assistance or action by the SOG or | ||||
DOC. | ||||
(8) Conduct linen exchange weekly according to | ||||
schedule. | ||||
(9) Ensure all assigned detainees have the basic | ||||
Camp 4 issue items and that they are in serviceable | ||||
condition. | ||||
(10) Log any SIGACTS, messages, actions or | ||||
information into the Block NCO logbook for follow-up | ||||
or guidance to the other Block NCO’s performing duty | ||||
on that block. | ||||
(11) Conduct blanket exchange monthly according | ||||
to schedule. | ||||
(12) Ensure any work orders needed for their | ||||
block are logged into the Block NCO book and passed | ||||
onto the SOG on duty. | ||||
(13) Ensure DIMMS information is accurately | ||||
recorded into DIMMS and the handwritten copies | ||||
turned into the SOG at the end of shift. | ||||
(14) Conduct spot checks on the safety and | ||||
actions off the Block Observer. | ||||
(15) The Block NCO is overall responsible for | ||||
everything that happens on his/her block during their | ||||
shift including the conduct and actions of the Block | ||||
Observer. | ||||
e. The Block Observer is responsible for the | ||||
following: | ||||
(1) Logging SIGACTS, all detainee requests or | ||||
refusals, and keeping the Block NCO informed of all | ||||
detainee actions. | ||||
(2) The Block Observer will randomly rotate to | ||||
both observer areas on the assigned block of operations | ||||
to conduct duties. If two observers per block are | ||||
available, then each observer will stay and perform | ||||
duties in one observer area each on that assigned block. | ||||
(3) Block Observers will log any activities vital | ||||
to the Camp 4 mission into the observer logbook for | ||||
entry into DIMMS. They will also keep in contact by | ||||
radio with the Block NCO as to keep them advised. | ||||
Block | ||||
(4) Observers may contact Liberty Tower to | ||||
submit detainee requests into DIMMS | ||||
(5) Observers on night shift will wear a radio | ||||
headset as not to disrupt detainee sleep. | ||||
(6) The Block Observer will follow all orders of | ||||
the Block NCO and will assist the Block NCO in his | ||||
duties and block responsibilities | ||||
(7) Block Observers will enforce Camp 4 policy | ||||
and procedures and ensure detainees are following | ||||
rules and regulations applying to their assigned block. | ||||
(8) Block Observers rotate blocks based on a | ||||
schedule set by the SOG on duty. | ||||
(9) MP/detainee conversation during normal duty | ||||
hours is authorized but must adhere and be cautious to | ||||
OPSEC. | ||||
(10) Hanging of clothing and trash bags from the | ||||
MP Observer area grate is permitted as long as it does | ||||
not obstruct the MP Observers view or interfere with | ||||
the MP Observers job. | ||||
(11) There is no passing of items between bays | ||||
through the MP Observer area. | ||||
(12) Any questions asked by a detainee to the | ||||
Block Observer that cannot be answered or the | ||||
Observer is unsure of should be directed to the Block | ||||
NCO or SOG. | ||||
(13) Pass-on logbooks will be neat and orderly. | ||||
SIGACT sheets and logbooks will remain closed when | ||||
not in use and out of sight of detainees who may | ||||
attempt to read the entries. | ||||
(14) Information logged into a pass-on logbook | ||||
may be classified or secret in nature and will not be | ||||
discussed with other detainees. Any Observer or Block | ||||
NCO that discusses information written in pass-on | ||||
logbooks or SIGACT sheets with any other detainees | ||||
will be subject to UCMJ action. | ||||
(15) Pass-on logbooks will be kept up to date and | ||||
each MP Observer will log in when assuming duties as | ||||
an Observer even if only temporarily. | ||||
(16) Any unauthorized writing, artwork, drawing, | ||||
doodles, obscenities, or graffiti on the covers, inside | ||||
covers, pages, or binding of the MP Observer pass-on | ||||
logbook will subject the MP Observer to charges of | ||||
destruction of government property and/or | ||||
unauthorized destruction of classified or secret | ||||
government documents. These pass-on logbooks are to | ||||
be treated as a MP notebook and maintained in a | ||||
professional military manner. Pass-on logbooks are | ||||
subject to summoning by a judicial review board, | ||||
tribunal committee or other court proceedings and may | ||||
be used as evidence in a trial, case, or hearing.. | ||||
(17) All Block Observer and Medical access | ||||
gates will remain secure after entry or exit to/from the | ||||
Block Observer fenced in area. Each Block Observer | ||||
will have an Observer key to open the Observer area | ||||
gates. It is the Observers responsibility to ensure | ||||
Observer gates are secure all the time except entry and | ||||
exit from the Observer area. | ||||
(18) All block bay doors will be secure during | ||||
compound recreation, central recreation and chow. | ||||
f. Liberty Tower Operator is responsible for the | ||||
following: | ||||
(1) Control and operation of all magnetic and | ||||
electronically controlled gates within Camp 4. | ||||
(2) Controlling and maintaining radio traffic and | ||||
security of communications on the Camp 4 assigned | ||||
frequency. | ||||
(3) Liberty Tower will conduct morning and | ||||
daily call to prayers over the Camp 4 intercom system | ||||
to all Camp 4 blocks. | ||||
(4) Liberty Tower will monitor all 44 Camp 4 | ||||
camera systems and note any deficiencies in camera or | ||||
monitor operations to the SOG on duty. | ||||
(5) Liberty Tower will conduct random camera | ||||
system monitoring of various bays to check on detainee | ||||
actions. Any actions by detainees monitored on the | ||||
Liberty Tower camera system that may be of safety or | ||||
security concerns will be brought to the Block NCO | ||||
and Block Observers attention of the applicable block | ||||
in question. | ||||
(6) Liberty Tower is the central command center | ||||
of Camp 4, and the security of Liberty Tower is | ||||
extremely important. The Liberty Tower operator will | ||||
maintain 100% positive control of all of their locks and | ||||
gates. | ||||
(7) Liberty Tower houses the Camp 4 camera | ||||
recording equipment and Camp 4 supplies. The | ||||
Liberty Tower Operator will ensure an orderly | ||||
appearance and cleanliness of Liberty Tower will in | ||||
their control. | ||||
(8) Liberty Tower operators rotate on a scheduled | ||||
basis set by the SOG on duty. | ||||
(9) No listening or viewing media, i.e. CD’s, | ||||
DVD’s, VHS tapes, or books and magazines are | ||||
authorized in Liberty Tower due to the sensitive nature | ||||
of Liberty Towers mission and the possibility of being | ||||
a distraction to Liberty Tower operations. | ||||
(10) No food or drinks will be authorized in | ||||
Liberty Tower due to the large amount of electronic | ||||
equipment and electrical circuits housed there. | ||||
(11) Liberty Tower will always remain in a high | ||||
state of police. | ||||
(12) The Liberty Tower Operator is responsible | ||||
for updating and maintaining their logbook and the | ||||
Camp 4 DIMS system while manning that position. | ||||
(13) The Liberty Tower Operator will not allow | ||||
personal phone calls from Liberty that are longer than | ||||
15 minutes in length. Personal phone calls will be at | ||||
least 15 minutes apart to allow work related calls a | ||||
chance to get through. | ||||
(14) Liberty will only open Sally Port 14 electric | ||||
locks when requested by the Sally Port 14 Operator at | ||||
that post at the time the transmission is received. | ||||
e. Sally Port 14 Operator is responsible for the | ||||
following: | ||||
(1) Making sure the sally port is manned at all | ||||
times. If the Sally Port Operator must leave their post, | ||||
they will advise the SOG on duty so he/she may relieve | ||||
them. Sally Port will not leave their post until properly | ||||
relieved. | ||||
(2) Sally Port 14 will maintain in radio contact at | ||||
all times with Liberty Tower. | ||||
(3) Sally Port 14 will be responsible to announce | ||||
to Liberty Tower all escort or medical teams that enter | ||||
or leave Sally Port 14. Sally Port will also advise | ||||
Liberty Tower as to the bed number of the detainee that | ||||
team is picking-up or dropping off. Sally Port 14 will | ||||
log all non-assigned Camp 4 personnel into the Sally | ||||
Port logbook by name/rank or by team number/call | ||||
sign along with the time of arrival, time of departure, | ||||
and nature of business at Camp 4. | ||||
(4) Sally Port 14 will be solely responsible for | ||||
maintaining access to Camp 4 through Sally Port 14 | ||||
and will verify the level of Camp 4 access by checking | ||||
the Camp Delta badge. Camp 4 requires a green badge | ||||
code to enter without escort. All non-assigned Camp 4 | ||||
personnel will be escorted by assigned personnel | ||||
throughout their entire time while inside the Camp 4 | ||||
perimeter. | ||||
(5) Sally Port Operator will open both outer | ||||
vehicle gate doors for vehicle large than a standard size | ||||
pick-up truck. For example, the large ice truck with | ||||
lift-gate will only enter after both vehicle outer gate | ||||
doors or open. | ||||
(6) Sally Port will never have two Sally Port | ||||
locks open at the same time. | ||||
(7) Sally Port Operator is responsible for keeping | ||||
the sally port storage locker stocked with supplies from | ||||
Liberty Tower and maintaining a 5 gallon water cooler | ||||
full of ice and Gatorade at all times. | ||||
(8) The Sally Port 14 Operator will enforce the | ||||
policy of only the Sally Port 14 Operator calling | ||||
Liberty Tower to unlock or release Sally Port 14 locks. | ||||
33-7. General Rules | ||||
a. Detainees will comply with all rules regulations, | ||||
policies, procedures and guidance set forth within the | ||||
Camp 4 SOP as advised to them by Camp 4 assigned | ||||
personnel. Detainees will conduct themselves in a | ||||
manner that is not to offend, threaten, or agitate other | ||||
detainees. Detainees that fear their life is in danger or | ||||
fears physical harm, can and will report this to the | ||||
Camp 4 personnel at any time. Detainees will not | ||||
conduct and/or participate in, but not limited to, any | ||||
form of military drills, hand-to-hand combat, and | ||||
martial arts style training, or shadow boxing. There | ||||
will be no sexual contact between detainees. Detainees | ||||
will walk in an orderly fashion to/from bays when | ||||
moving anywhere within Camp 4. Detainees, bays, | ||||
and all block areas are subject to search at any time by | ||||
Camp 4 assigned personnel. Any violations of these | ||||
rules and/or any other Camp 4 rules, regulations, policy | ||||
or procedures will result in disciplinary action, loss of | ||||
privileges, and/or transfer back to Camp 1, 2, or 3 | ||||
pending approval by higher.b. Camp 4 personnel will | ||||
not allow detainees to violate Camp 4 rules, | ||||
regulations, policy, or procedure. Camp 4 personnel | ||||
will not knowingly cause a detainee to violate the | ||||
governing rules, regulations, policies, or procedures. | ||||
Personnel assigned to Camp 4 will not bring | ||||
unauthorized materials or equipment into Camp 4. | ||||
Assigned personnel will not give detainee’s | ||||
unauthorized items or materials not approved by | ||||
JIG/ICE, S-3, DOC or S-2. Any extra reward or | ||||
incentive items given a detainee will be verified | ||||
through the SOG on duty or NCOIC as to the items or | ||||
material being authorized on the detainee’s form 508. | ||||
Any violations of Camp 4’s rules, regulations, policies, | ||||
or procedures by Camp 4 personnel will subject the | ||||
violator to administrative action and/or removal from | ||||
Camp 4. Camp 4 is a medium security setting | ||||
requiring extra precaution and safety. Any safety | ||||
concerns will be brought to the SOG on duty or | ||||
NCOIC’s attention immediately. Camp 4 personnel | ||||
that commit unsafe acts or physical security risks will | ||||
be subject to UCMJ by their units after review and | ||||
recommendation by the S-3 SGM. Any Camp 4 | ||||
personnel witnessing any violations of Camp 4 rules, | ||||
regulations, policies, or procedures will be asked to | ||||
write a DA-2823 sworn statement to the facts | ||||
surrounding the occurrence or incident. Sworn | ||||
statements must be turned into the Camp 4 SOG on | ||||
duty or Camp 4 NCOIC no later than 48 hours after the | ||||
incident. Sworn statements turned in after 48 hours | ||||
may be less likely to result in detainee discipline or | ||||
loss of privilege. | ||||
c. No personal electronic portable devices, games, or | ||||
media will be brought into Camp 4. | ||||
d. Detainees at a minimum will outside will wear the | ||||
following items: | ||||
(1) Shirt | ||||
(2) Pants and/or shorts | ||||
(3) Shower shoes or soccer shoes | ||||
e. The only detainee headgear authorized for wear | ||||
outside of the bays is the issued prayer cap. | ||||
33-8. Bay Rules | ||||
a. No more than two bay doors will be open at any | ||||
one given time.b. Bay leaders will be chosen by the | ||||
Camp 4 personnel and used to enforce all rules, | ||||
regulations, policies and procedures. Bay leaders will | ||||
be chosen based on respect by other detainees assigned | ||||
in that bay, by ability to communicate with Camp 4 | ||||
personnel, leadership ability, and cooperation with the | ||||
Camp 4 personnel. | ||||
c. Detainees will be given a wake-up/chow call 0600 | ||||
hours daily. Quiet time will be at 2300 hours nightly. | ||||
Detainees are responsible for keeping their areas and | ||||
themselves clean and sanitary. Detainees are not | ||||
allowed to have any item(s) in their possession that | ||||
could be used as a potential weapon. | ||||
d. Detainees are allowed to do physical exercises in | ||||
the bays; however, activities such as sports inside of | ||||
the bays are unauthorized. | ||||
e. Detainees will report medical emergencies to the | ||||
Block Observer, Block NCO, and/or the SOG on duty | ||||
so they may take appropriate action. | ||||
f. Fruit, nuts, honey, and 1 MRE are the only | ||||
authorized food items allowed in the bays. No excess | ||||
amounts of these food items will be allowed. Any | ||||
spoiled, rotten, or unsanitary items will be thrown | ||||
away. MP’s will conduct random bay inspections for | ||||
unauthorized food products. | ||||
g. Detainees are allowed to talk to other detainees | ||||
thru the MP observer area except during the hours of | ||||
2300 – 0430. The only times detainees will not be | ||||
allowed to crosstalk is if it is disruptive, abusive, or | ||||
unproductive to the Camp 4 mission. Detainees are not | ||||
allowed to crosstalk to the other camps in Camp Delta | ||||
to include detainees assigned to Fleet Hospital. | ||||
Detainees may talk to other camp detainees riding in | ||||
gators in route to Fleet Hospital. However, gators will | ||||
not be allowed to stop in front of Camp 4 with Camp 1, | ||||
2, or 3 detainees in route to other areas of Camp Delta. | ||||
Detainees may crosstalk with other blocks within | ||||
Camp 4 as long as it is not disruptive, abusive, or | ||||
unproductive to the Camp 4 mission. At any time, a | ||||
directive may be received from higher to stop all | ||||
crosstalk due to mission requirements. At that point | ||||
the higher order will be explained to the detainees and | ||||
enforced by the Camp 4 personnel. | ||||
h. All rules, regulations, policies and procedures | ||||
concerning Camp 4 are subject to immediate change as | ||||
directed by higher either permanently or temporarily, | ||||
dictated by mission requirements and commanders | ||||
intent. | ||||
i. Bay leaders will ensure that bay doors remain | ||||
closed unless moving to or from recreation, shower, or | ||||
chow. Detainees are not allowed to enter bays that | ||||
they do not reside in. Detainees will not stand on | ||||
bunks, picnic tables, or objects stacked inside of their | ||||
bays or recreation yards. | ||||
j. Detainees are not allowed to sleep or lay together | ||||
with more than one detainee per bunk. | ||||
k. Detainees will not disassemble any Camp 4 | ||||
equipment or property to include bay fans for cleaning. | ||||
Detainees will not touch bay cameras or shower | ||||
cameras. | ||||
l. Detainees will not be allowed to alter any Camp 4 | ||||
issued items. Items altered or damaged by detainees | ||||
will be confiscated by the Block NCO who will then | ||||
write a DA-2823 on the incident along with a DA-4137 | ||||
form. | ||||
m. Sheets, towels, blanket, or any other linen | ||||
besides the white detainee issued uniform will not be | ||||
hung inside the bays or tied off inside the bays. | ||||
n. Detainees may not cover the bay or shower | ||||
cameras as to obstruct the Liberty Tower operators | ||||
view.o. Detainees will not sleep under their bunks with | ||||
a sheet, blanket, or other linen draped over the bunk as | ||||
to hide them from view. Camp 4 personnel must see a | ||||
portion of the detainees uncovered skin when | ||||
conducting a physical headcount in the bays. A Block | ||||
Observer will awaken a sleeping detainee if skin | ||||
cannot be seen. p. Detainees must clean their bays with | ||||
cleaning supplies requested from the Block Observer or | ||||
Block NCO at least twice a week. | ||||
q. Detainees may not tie any form of string, rope, or | ||||
plastic strips to any portion of the overhead electric | ||||
conduit or any portion of the bay doors or windows. | ||||
r. Each Block will secure their bay doors during | ||||
compound recreation, central recreation, and chow. | ||||
s. The shower room door only may be open during | ||||
central recreation and compound recreation for latrine | ||||
use. All other bay doors will be closed while | ||||
recreation and chow is being conducted. | ||||
33-9. Compound Recreation / Central Recreation | ||||
Yard Rules | ||||
a. Detainees will receive recreation time according | ||||
to the separate day and night shift activities schedules. | ||||
The Camp 4 NCOIC will develop a rotating chow, | ||||
shower, compound recreation, and central yard | ||||
recreation schedule for each shift. Two bays will be | ||||
allowed to eat chow and conduct recreation together. | ||||
The only exception to this rule is the bays designated | ||||
by mission requirements or discipline, to eat and | ||||
perform recreation separately. | ||||
b. Normal recreation time for compound recreation | ||||
is two bays out for 30 minutes immediately followed | ||||
by 30 minutes for two bays to shower. Normal | ||||
recreation time for central recreation is two bays out | ||||
for 30 minutes immediately followed by 30 minutes for | ||||
two bays to shower. Normal time for breakfast, lunch, | ||||
and dinner is two bays out on each block for 1 hour at | ||||
each meal. Then the next two bays from each block | ||||
will come out for 1 hour for each meal. There is no | ||||
shower time in conjunction with or associated with | ||||
meal times. | ||||
c. Detainees will proceed directly to the central | ||||
recreation yard when released by the Block NCO from | ||||
their bays. | ||||
d. No more than two bays will be allowed in the | ||||
recreation yard at one time. | ||||
e. Detainees in the central recreation yard must stay | ||||
within the designated fenced in areas, either the soccer | ||||
field or volleyball court. | ||||
f. No detainees will be allowed to run around the | ||||
inside of the outer recreation yard fence. | ||||
g. If a volleyball or soccer ball leaves the designated | ||||
area, a detainee will request permission or receive | ||||
acknowledgement to retrieve the ball. | ||||
h. There will be no contact sports conducted in the | ||||
central recreation yard except minor contact during | ||||
soccer. | ||||
i. Detainees will not climb any fence in Camp 4. | ||||
j. When any emergency siren is sounded in the | ||||
Camp Delta facility, detainees will lay face down on | ||||
the ground, place their hands outstretched to their | ||||
sides, palms up, and await further instructions from the | ||||
Camp 4 personnel. | ||||
k. Detainees will be allowed to take showers after | ||||
recreation according to the recreation, chow and | ||||
shower schedules. | ||||
l. Use of the central recreation yard is a Camp 4 | ||||
award and privilege. Any violations of the central | ||||
recreation rules will result in disciplinary action, loss of | ||||
privileges, and possible transfer back to Camp 1, 2, or | ||||
3. | ||||
m. Central recreation is in addition to compound | ||||
recreation. Loss of central recreation will be at the | ||||
Camp 4 NCOICs discretion and may be taken away | ||||
from a detainee for violation of Camp 4 rules. Loss of | ||||
central recreation does not mean loss of compound | ||||
recreation. The only way a detainee can lose | ||||
compound recreation and central recreation together is | ||||
with a form 508 for disciplinary action. A detainee can | ||||
lose central recreation privileges without loss of | ||||
compound recreation, but cannot lose compound | ||||
recreation and still receive central recreation. Central | ||||
recreation is a privilege and compound recreation is a | ||||
reward/incentive. Camp 4 privileges do not require a | ||||
form 508 to take away. However, rewards/incentives | ||||
do require disciplinary action approval by S-3 and | ||||
possibly JIG/ICE. An example of this would be if a | ||||
detainee refuses to stay inside the designated central | ||||
recreation yard fence area. If the detainee is told more | ||||
than once and refuses to comply, then the Camp 4 | ||||
personnel may take the rest of that detainees remaining | ||||
central recreation yard time away and make them go | ||||
back to their assigned block compound recreation area. | ||||
n. No martial arts or military style training by the | ||||
detainees will take place in the bays, the compound | ||||
recreation yard, or the central recreation yard. | ||||
o. Camp 4 assigned personnel will not allow escort | ||||
teams or medical teams to enter the inner Sally Port | ||||
gate while central recreation is being conducted. If an | ||||
escort or medical team shows up during central | ||||
recreation they may wait in the Sally Port area until the | ||||
central recreation yard is clear of all detainees, or the | ||||
Camp 4 personnel may go retrieve the requested | ||||
detainee and escort them to the Sally Port for | ||||
transportation by the teams. | ||||
p. Camp 4 personnel will remain in a separate | ||||
fenced in area from the detainees during central | ||||
recreation. These areas include the Liberty Tower | ||||
fenced in area, the Block Observer fenced in areas, or | ||||
Sally Port 14. All Block Observer gates will remain | ||||
secured and locked during central recreation. The | ||||
Camp 4 Sally Port 14 inner vehicle gate will remain | ||||
secured and locked during central recreation. The | ||||
Liberty Tower outer main gate will remain secured and | ||||
locked during central recreation. | ||||
q. Detainees at a minimum will wear the following | ||||
while outside at central or compound recreation: | ||||
(1) Shirt | ||||
(2) Pants and /or shorts | ||||
(3) Shower shoes or soccer shoes | ||||
r. The only detainee headgear authorized for wear | ||||
outside of the bays is the issued prayer cap. | ||||
33-10. Central Shower/Bath Rules | ||||
a. Each bay will have 15 minutes of shower time in | ||||
the central bathroom. If two bays are out together at | ||||
recreation, then the shower time doubles to 30 minutes. | ||||
b. There will be no detainee showers for the | ||||
morning prayer wash except in the case of | ||||
uncleanliness caused by dreams. At 0400 hours | ||||
detainees are given an opportunity to wash their hands, | ||||
face, and feet before the morning call to prayer is | ||||
played over the Camp 4 intercom system. This is a | ||||
quick clean up for prayer only. The Block NCO may | ||||
turn the water valve off after the 15 minute period has | ||||
expired to prevent the detainees from taking advantage | ||||
of the 15 minute period.. No more than two bay doors | ||||
will be opened on one block at any given time. | ||||
c. MP Observers and Block NCOs will give one full | ||||
bottle of shampoo per bay for shower. If two bays are | ||||
in shower then two full bottles of shampoo will be | ||||
given. Detainees will give the shampoo bottles back to | ||||
the Block NCO or MP Observer when shower time is | ||||
complete. No shampoo is allowed in the bays. | ||||
d. Detainees will not share shower or toilet stalls | ||||
with other detainees. | ||||
e. Clippers will be issued twice a week during | ||||
evening shower time on Mondays and Thursdays. The | ||||
clippers will be returned to the Block NCO when | ||||
detainees are finished. | ||||
f. Razors will be issued twice a week during day | ||||
shower time on Tuesdays and Fridays. Block NCO’s | ||||
will count and hand out the razors to the detainees | ||||
through the fence as they enter the central | ||||
shower/bathroom. Razors will be returned to the Block | ||||
NCO who will account for and inspect the razors for | ||||
missing or altered blades as soon as the detainees exit | ||||
the latrine. Detainees will hold up the razor so the | ||||
Block NCO may inspect it, then drop the razors | ||||
through the fence into a small trash bag as the Block | ||||
NCO counts to make sure all razors are returned that | ||||
were issued out. | ||||
g. At no time will razors or clippers be permitted | ||||
inside the bays. Clippers may be used in the compound | ||||
recreation area. | ||||
h. Detainees will clean up after themselves upon | ||||
completion of using the central bathrooms. Detainees | ||||
will sweep, mop, police up trash, and clean the central | ||||
bathrooms daily. The bay responsible for cleaning will | ||||
be determined according to the day/night shift shower, | ||||
recreation, and chow rotation activities schedules. | ||||
i. Only clear or partial transparent style shower and | ||||
toilet curtains may be used in Camp 4. This allows the | ||||
cameras and observers to see movement behind the | ||||
curtains for safety and accountability reasons. | ||||
j. The central shower/bathroom may be used as a | ||||
temporary holding area for one bay at a time for block | ||||
or bay searches for contraband or inventory of detainee | ||||
Camp 4 issued items. | ||||
k. The only detainee headgear authorized for wear | ||||
outside of the bays is the issued prayer cap. | ||||
l. At a minimum, detainees will wear the following | ||||
items while outside: | ||||
(1) Shirt | ||||
(2) Pants and/or shorts | ||||
(3) Shower shoes or soccer shoes | ||||
33-11. Mess Yard Rules | ||||
a. After ensuring all detainees on the block are | ||||
secured in their bays, the Camp 4 Block NCO will | ||||
place one set of food service containers and associated | ||||
food items onto the compound yard picnic table or | ||||
folding table. The Block NCO on each block will | ||||
count all sporks for their detainees coming out to eat. | ||||
Block NCOs will also count serving utensils. All bread | ||||
twist ties will be removed from the bread bags. Camp | ||||
4 detainees are not limited to their servings on food | ||||
items and drink. They are authorized to eat every food | ||||
item and drink brought to them by food service. | ||||
b. After the Camp 4 personnel have set up the eating | ||||
area on the block, they will secure the block main gate. | ||||
The Block NCO will call Liberty Tower to open the | ||||
bay doors to the bays designated on the shower, | ||||
recreation, and chow schedule to come out and eat. | ||||
c. Two bays at a time on each block will be given 1 | ||||
hour to eat their meals together at the compound area | ||||
picnic table. They are responsible for cleaning up after | ||||
themselves to include returning all eating utensils, | ||||
serving utensils, and policing up all trash and passing it | ||||
out the block main gate bean hole into the trash can on | ||||
the other side. The Block NCO will account for all | ||||
food service utensils and sporks. | ||||
d. After the first two bays on the block have eaten | ||||
and cleaned up, they will return back to their respective | ||||
bays. The remaining two bays will then be released to | ||||
come out to the block mess area and eat for 1 hour. | ||||
They will also clean up after themselves and return all | ||||
utensils and trash. They will then return to their | ||||
respective bays and secure their bay doors. | ||||
e. After chow has finished and all detainees on the | ||||
block are locked back into their bays, the Block NCO | ||||
will open the block main gate and bring all the food | ||||
service containers and utensils outside of the block area | ||||
to prepare them for pick-up by food service personnel. | ||||
f. A search of the mess area will then be conducted | ||||
for any remaining trash, food, sporks, utensils, or food | ||||
containers. | ||||
g. Chow drop-off times are as follows: | ||||
(1) Breakfast 0615 hours | ||||
(2) Lunch 1200 hours | ||||
(3) Dinner 1800 hours | ||||
h. Chow pick-up times are as follows: | ||||
(1) Breakfast 0830 – 0845 hours | ||||
(2) Lunch 1400 – 1415 hours | ||||
(3) Dinner 2000 – 2015 hours | ||||
i. Special meals for those detainees listed by the | ||||
DOC, will be dropped off by food service personnel | ||||
prior to the Camp 4 scheduled meal times. Any issues | ||||
with special meals should be brought to the DOC’s | ||||
attention or contact food service via cell phone. | ||||
Detainees are placed on a list to receive special meals | ||||
through the recommendation of the base nutritionist. | ||||
j. Detainees at a minimum will wear the following | ||||
items while at mess: | ||||
(1) Shirt | ||||
(2) Pants and/or shorts | ||||
(3) Shower shoes or soccer shoes | ||||
k. The only detainee headgear authorized for wear | ||||
outside of the bays is the issued prayer cap. | ||||
33-12. Bay Leader Duties and Responsibilitiesa. | ||||
Bay leader bed assignment will be the closest to the | ||||
MP observer booth. | ||||
b. Bay leader will receive directions and/or orders | ||||
from the MP observer and/or Block NCO. | ||||
c. The bay leader is responsible to ensure bay doors | ||||
remain secure each time a detainee enters or exits the | ||||
bay. | ||||
d. Bay leaders will ensure all detainees assigned to | ||||
the bay respect each other regardless of culture, | ||||
language, and beliefs. | ||||
e. Bay leaders will explain to the detainees assigned | ||||
to their bay in their native language all of the | ||||
information or orders furnished to them by any Camp 4 | ||||
personnel. | ||||
f. Bay leaders will bring up any detainee issues or | ||||
concerns within the bay or block to the Block NCO or | ||||
Block Observer. | ||||
g. If the bay leader becomes aware of any plans | ||||
and/or actions for detainee disorder in the bay, block, | ||||
Camp 4, or Camp Delta, they will bring this to the | ||||
Block NCO or Block Observers attention. | ||||
h. The bay leader will inform the Block NCO or | ||||
Block Observer of any medical issues or requests. | ||||
i. Bay leaders will greet and explain Camp 4 rules, | ||||
policies, and procedures to all new arriving detainees | ||||
assigned to their bays. | ||||
j. Bay leaders will meet with the Camp 4 NCOIC, | ||||
JDOG Superintendent, and Deputy JDOG Commander | ||||
once a month on a date determined and given to them | ||||
by the Camp 4 NCOIC, to bring up any bay or block | ||||
concerns or issues. | ||||
33-13. Laundry/Linen Exchange | ||||
a. Newly assigned Camp 4 detainees will be issued | ||||
one complete set of white detainee clothing from S-3 | ||||
prior to arrival to Camp 4. One complete set of white | ||||
detainee uniform includes the following: | ||||
(1) One white "smock" style shirt | ||||
(2) One white crew neck T-shirt | ||||
(3) One white pair of pants | ||||
(4) One white pair of shorts | ||||
b. Detainees will also receive the following linen | ||||
and Camp 4 issued items after arriving to Camp 4: | ||||
(1) Two white bed sheets | ||||
(2) Two colored blankets | ||||
(3) One white pillowcase | ||||
(4) One white medium size pillow | ||||
(5) Two white medium size towels | ||||
(6) One white small washcloth | ||||
(7) One" traditional colored and styled" | ||||
prayer rug | ||||
(8) One grey storage tub with lid | ||||
(9) One pair of soccer shoes | ||||
(10) One of the following (chess, | ||||
backgammon, or checkers set) | ||||
(11) One deck of playing cards | ||||
(12) One set of dominoes | ||||
(13) One green "PT" mat | ||||
(14) One set of hygiene items | ||||
(15) Any items listed on the detainee's 508 form | ||||
c. S-4 supply will furnish Camp 4 with the requested | ||||
amounts of pillows, prayer rugs, prayer mats, shower | ||||
shoes, soccer shoes, grey storage tubs, games, and | ||||
other detainee issued items. | ||||
d. S-4 laundry service will furnish Camp 4 with the | ||||
requested amounts of complete white detainee | ||||
uniforms, white towels, colored blankets, white sheets, | ||||
and white washcloths. S-4 laundry service does not | ||||
have a method for cleaning traditional style prayer | ||||
rugs. Traditional style prayer rugs will be an | ||||
expendable item, which may be thrown away after | ||||
determined by the shift SOG to be unserviceable. In | ||||
this case, another traditional style prayer rug will be | ||||
issued to the detainee. | ||||
e. Detainees will be provided clean laundry and | ||||
linen once a week and two clean blankets once a month | ||||
by block according to the following schedule: | ||||
BLANKETS | ||||
(1) 1st Saturday of the month will be | ||||
Victor Block | ||||
(2) 2nd Saturday of the month will be | ||||
Whiskey Block | ||||
(3) 3rd Saturday of the month will be | ||||
Yankee Block | ||||
(4) 4th Saturday off the month will be | ||||
Uniform Block | ||||
(5) If there is a 5th Saturday in the month | ||||
there will be no linen exchange on that day. | ||||
LINEN | ||||
Each block will receive clean linen and | ||||
uniform exchange once a week on Sundays. | ||||
f. Block NCOs will obtain the clean laundry from | ||||
between 0800-0930 the morning of laundry exchange | ||||
from Liberty Tower. | ||||
g. Block NCOs will begin laundry exchange prior to | ||||
detainee lunch. | ||||
h. Block NCOs will ensure all linen is exchange one | ||||
detainee at a time on there block. Block NCOs will | ||||
ensure the linen being turned in is in serviceable | ||||
condition and separated into individual piles of | ||||
serviceable and non-serviceable so non-serviceable | ||||
linen is not washed and redistributed. All linen for | ||||
each detainee is a one-for-one exchange. Block NCOs | ||||
will ensure each detainee receives the proper amount of | ||||
linen being exchanged. Some detainees may wish to | ||||
turn-in only certain items for exchange, therefore it is | ||||
important the Block NCO does not give out more linen | ||||
than is being turned-in. Non-serviceable linen will be | ||||
bagged in large brown trash bags and marked | ||||
appropriately and clearly as "BAD". Serviceable linen | ||||
will be bagged in large brown trash bags as sets. Two | ||||
complete sets of linen per brown trash bag only, unless | ||||
there is an odd number of sets. Serviceable bags of | ||||
linen will be placed neat and orderly inside the marked | ||||
dirty linen storage bins next to the administrative | ||||
building for pick-up on Monday mornings by the S-4 | ||||
laundry service personnel. Non-serviceable bags of | ||||
linen will be stacked neatly outside the administrative | ||||
building for inspection by the Camp 4 NCOIC to | ||||
determine damage extent and cause of damage. The | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC will then notify the JDOG SGM by e- | ||||
mail on his findings as directed by the JDOG SGM. | ||||
i. Any ripped or torn detainee uniforms, sheets, | ||||
blankets, towels, wash cloths, or pillow cases that are | ||||
missing pieces or strips of material will subject the | ||||
entire block to a shakedown search for the missing | ||||
material. | ||||
j. Any left over clean laundry will be accounted for | ||||
and placed in Liberty Tower. | ||||
33-14. Personnel and Detainees Cleaning Duties | ||||
a. MP cleaning responsibilities are to ensure their | ||||
assigned areas of responsibility during shift is free of | ||||
trash, floors are swept and mopped, ice chests are full, | ||||
and water coolers are cleaned out and refilled. | ||||
b. This includes the fenced in observer areas, MP | ||||
Observer booths, Block NCO booths, all internal and | ||||
external areas within Liberty Tower and the Liberty | ||||
Tower fence line, All areas within Sally Port 14, the | ||||
Camp 4 break area, inside the administrative office, the | ||||
fence line surrounding Camp 4, and the area between | ||||
the administrative building and Camp 4 Sally Port. | ||||
c. SOGs will ensure prior to taking over shift and | ||||
prior to being relieved from shift that all areas are | ||||
cleaned up and ready for inspection. Camp 4 receives | ||||
numerous visitors and tours. Camp Delta personnel | ||||
walk past and around the Camp 4 perimeter daily. | ||||
Camp 4 is a high visibility area and draws a lot of | ||||
attention. Therefore, Camp 4 must remain clean and | ||||
ready for inspection at any given time of the day or | ||||
night. The SOG is overall responsible for making sure | ||||
the all areas are cleaned. | ||||
d. Detainee's cleaning responsibilities will be all the | ||||
areas within their compound recreation/mess yards | ||||
fence line. This includes their bays, latrines, block | ||||
central shower and the external block areas within the | ||||
block yard fence. MPs will issue detainees proper | ||||
cleaning supplies and ensure that the detainee's areas | ||||
stay in a high state of cleanliness. Block NCO will | ||||
utilize the bay leaders to make sure this happens. MPs | ||||
will account for all cleaning supplies issued and make | ||||
sure they are returned back to the Block storage locker. | ||||
The last bay to shower for the day according to the | ||||
recreation, shower, and chow rotation schedule will | ||||
clean the central shower room at the end of the day | ||||
prior to 2300 hours. | ||||
33-15. Radio Call Signs | ||||
a. Uniform Block | ||||
(1) Block NCO will be called "Uniform Block" | ||||
(2) Block Observer will be called "Observer 1" | ||||
b. Victor Block | ||||
(1) Block NCO will be called "Victor Block" | ||||
(2) Block Observer will be called "Observer 2" | ||||
c. Whiskey Block | ||||
(1) Block NCO will be called " Whiskey Block" | ||||
(2) Block Observer will be called "Observer 3" | ||||
d. Yankee Block | ||||
(1) Block NCO will be called "Yankee Block" | ||||
(2) Block Observer will be called "Observer 4" | ||||
e. Liberty Tower | ||||
(1) Liberty Tower call sign will be "Liberty" | ||||
f. Sally Port 14 | ||||
(1) Sally Port 14 call sign will be "Sally" | ||||
g. SOG of Camp 4 | ||||
(1) SOG call sign will be "SOG 4" | ||||
33-16. Fire Evacuation Plan | ||||
a. Camp 4 assigned personnel that see smoke and/or | ||||
fire from a block/bay, or hear/observe an activated fire | ||||
alarm will immediately report the incident to the Block | ||||
NCO or SOG. | ||||
b. The Block NCO or SOG will respond to the | ||||
reported location with fire extinguishers and make an | ||||
assessment of the situation from outside the block | ||||
fence with help from the Block NCO, Block Observer, | ||||
and Liberty Tower Operator monitoring the cameras to | ||||
give the SOG spot reports on what they see. | ||||
c. The SOG will make a timely determination as to | ||||
evacuate the whole block or the bay effected. | ||||
d. Liberty Tower will call the DOC by phone and | ||||
keep them informed of the situation. | ||||
e. If the SOG determines the fire can be put out by | ||||
fire extinguisher, then the bay will be evacuated into | ||||
the mess yard area of the block. The Block NCO will | ||||
go into the bay after it has been evacuated while the | ||||
SOG stays by the block main gate. If the fire cannot be | ||||
put out, the entire block will be evacuated one bay at a | ||||
time starting with the closest bay to the fire. Detainees | ||||
will be evacuated to the ICRC yard and secured. | ||||
f. If a fire is determined to be present by the SOG | ||||
and the block needs to be evacuated, all the other | ||||
blocks will go to lock down so the non-effected Block | ||||
NCOs may go assist with the evacuation. The Block | ||||
Observers however, will remain at their posts on the | ||||
non-effected blocks. | ||||
g. In case of a confirmed fire, Liberty will advise the | ||||
DOC to call the JTF fire department and have the | ||||
available QRF respond without gear to assist. | ||||
h. If a fire is detected, the Block Observer of the | ||||
effected block will stand outside the observer booth | ||||
area of the bay with the fire. The observer will relay | ||||
information to the detainees from the SOG about the | ||||
evacuation. The Block Observer will attempt to keep | ||||
the detainees calm. | ||||
i. Sally Port 14 will control access and prepare to | ||||
allow only the necessary personnel inside Camp 4 | ||||
during lock down. These will include the QRF, | ||||
medical personnel, fire department personnel, R&U, | ||||
and DOC personnel. Sally Port will log entries as time | ||||
permits. | ||||
j. Camp 4 has 6 fire extinguishers assigned. One | ||||
water fire extinguisher is to be located in the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building. One water fire extinguisher is | ||||
to be located in the bottom of Liberty Tower. Three | ||||
water fire extinguishers are to be located in Sally Port | ||||
14. One PK chemical fire extinguisher is to be located | ||||
in the top of Liberty Tower. | ||||
33-17. "OPERATION SNOWBALL" | ||||
a. The Infantry QRF / IRF team immediately | ||||
responds to the Camp 4 Sally Port in BDU’s only. No | ||||
equipment, knives, weapons, shields, or ammo will be | ||||
used for self-harm incidents. Response time and speed | ||||
is key to preventing fatality and safety issues within the | ||||
camp. When the Sally Port guard sees the QRF team | ||||
entering the Sally Port area they will immediately open | ||||
the inner main gate allowing timely access to Camp 4. | ||||
The Camp 4 Sally Port guard will direct the infantry to | ||||
the appropriate block of the self-harm incident. The | ||||
Block NCO inside the Block gate will direct the 5-6 | ||||
Infantry soldiers to form a shoulder to shoulder barrier | ||||
between the detainees in block compound rec and the | ||||
block gate. The Infantry will stand there in a “normal, | ||||
relaxed, non-aggressive” posture without saying | ||||
anything as not to make the detainees defensive, angry, | ||||
or aggressive. The Block NCO already standing there | ||||
will talk calmly with the detainees reassuring them that | ||||
the situation is under control and everything is OK. | ||||
The QRF leader will respond to the appropriate block | ||||
bay to assist the three (3) Block NCO’s and the NCOIC | ||||
inside the bay handling the self-harm incident. | ||||
b. A detainee whom is “cut down” for a self-harm | ||||
attempted hanging will be quickly but carefully | ||||
removed from the bay the incident occurred in after | ||||
being properly mobilized against further neck damage. | ||||
The Camp 4 NCOIC will give all commands to the | ||||
three Camp 4 Block NCO’s and Infantry QRF squad | ||||
leader caring the self-harm patient off the block into a | ||||
safe area outside the block gates. They will begin first | ||||
responder medical assessment and first aid for | ||||
responsiveness, pulse, breathing, bleeding, preventing | ||||
shock, head injuries, and mobilizing fractures or | ||||
broken bones until medical personnel arrive in Camp. | ||||
c. When medical personnel arrive, the Sally Port | ||||
guard will open the inner gate and direct them to the | ||||
appropriate block and bay. Only gator(s) with | ||||
stretchers may enter the Camp inner perimeter (one per | ||||
self-harm incident). Gators without stretchers will stay | ||||
outside the Camp 4 Sally Port area, parked out of the | ||||
way of Camp 4 traffic. If an ambulance shows up at | ||||
Camp 4, the Sally Port Guard will direct the driver to | ||||
back into the Sally Port area. The ambulance may not | ||||
go into the Camp 4 inner central area past the inner | ||||
Sally Port gates. Once the ambulance is in the Sally | ||||
Port the Sally Port guard will close both Sally Port | ||||
outer gates and secure the Sally Port area. This will | ||||
allow for the Sally Port guard to maintain security | ||||
while having his 360-degree view obstructed by the | ||||
ambulance being in the Sally Port. It will allow for | ||||
patient loading later without compromising security. | ||||
Once the patient is ready to be loaded into the | ||||
ambulance, the Sally Port guard will open the inner | ||||
Sally Port gates and allow medical personnel with the | ||||
patient access to the rear of the ambulance for loading. | ||||
d. Once medical personnel have the patient loaded | ||||
into the ambulance, the Sally Port guard will secure the | ||||
inner Sally Port gates, walk around the ambulance, | ||||
look under the ambulance, and then open the outer | ||||
Sally Port gates to let the ambulance out of Camp 4. If | ||||
the patient is on a gator with stretcher then have the | ||||
ambulance leave the Sally Port area immediately to | ||||
make room for the gator and then allow the gator with | ||||
stretcher and patient out of Camp 4. Once the | ||||
ambulance is out of the Sally Port, the Sally Port guard | ||||
secures the outer Sally Port gates. Gators without | ||||
patients will be allowed to exit next in a controlled | ||||
manner followed by personnel exiting through the | ||||
walk-in gate after a brief I.D. badge screening to | ||||
maintain security, as not to lose accountability of | ||||
detainees. The Sally Port guard will notify Liberty | ||||
Tower of each detainee ISN that leaves Camp 4 on a | ||||
gator or in an ambulance for self-harm or medical. | ||||
Liberty Tower will write down the ISN’s and notify the | ||||
DOC by landline so they may update the DIMS | ||||
system. | ||||
e. No detainees will be permitted in the Sally Port | ||||
14 during a self-harm incident. Escort Teams trying to | ||||
bring a detainee back to Camp 4 during a self-harm | ||||
incident will be told to stand by until the incident is | ||||
over and a 100% physical detainee head count is | ||||
conducted. | ||||
f. REATION TIME: (a timeline of events) | ||||
(1) R = Block NCO puts out duress code | ||||
“SNOWBALL” and information on | ||||
(a) All detainee movement in or out of Camp | ||||
stops. | ||||
(2) R+10 sec Liberty Tower unlocks appropriate | ||||
Block main gate. | ||||
(a) Liberty Tower verifying other block gates | ||||
are secure. | ||||
(b) Any block in central rec is told to go into | ||||
their block area. | ||||
(3) R+20sec | ||||
(a) All Block NCO’s without central rec grab | ||||
medical shears go to scene of incident. | ||||
(b) Sally Port guard opening both sides of outer | ||||
gate. | ||||
(c) Observers for all blocks watch all bays for | ||||
repeat incident or mass casualty. | ||||
(d) NCOIC notifies QRF / IRF team to respond | ||||
immediately with no gear to Sally Port at Camp 4 | ||||
for self-harm. | ||||
(4) R+25 sec | ||||
(a) Block NCO’s in block going into the | ||||
appropriate block. | ||||
(b) One Block NCO blocking detainees from | ||||
exiting the block area where the self-harm | ||||
occurred. | ||||
(c) NCOIC calls DOC gives details & requests | ||||
medical, K-9. | ||||
(5) R+30 sec | ||||
(a) Block NCO and other Block NCO’s headed | ||||
into the bay. | ||||
(6) R+35 sec | ||||
(a) Infantry QRF / IRF headed into Sally Port. | ||||
(b) Sally Port unlocking inner sally gate. | ||||
(7) R+40 sec | ||||
(a) Block NCO’s cutting down detainee in bay | ||||
or getting non-involved detainees out of bay if not | ||||
a hanging attempt. | ||||
(b) Infantry arriving at block | ||||
(c) NCOIC headed to block with "snowball" kit. | ||||
(8) R+45 sec | ||||
(a) Infantry forming a line in block rec area | ||||
blocking the exit. | ||||
(b) Infantry squad leader going into bay. | ||||
(9) R+50 sec | ||||
(a) Block NCO’s removing self-harm detainee | ||||
from bay. | ||||
(b) NCOIC at block. | ||||
(10) R+55 sec | ||||
(a) Block NCO’s, Infantry squad leader, NCOIC | ||||
carry detainee out of block gate into central area. | ||||
(11) R+1 min | ||||
(a) Start detainee first responder assessment. | ||||
(12) R+65 sec | ||||
(a) QRF and Block NCO start leaving block rec | ||||
area. | ||||
(13) R+70 sec | ||||
(a) All blocks secure, detainee first-aid started. | ||||
(14) R+2 min | ||||
(a) DOC cameraman on site. | ||||
(b) Infantry QRF on-stand down by Sally Port | ||||
14. | ||||
(15) R+2.5 min | ||||
(a) Medical at Sally Port gate | ||||
(16) R+3 min | ||||
(a) Medical takes over detainee self-harm. | ||||
(b) Block NCO’s report back to their blocks and | ||||
continue normal operations and reassure other | ||||
detainees. | ||||
(17) R+4 min | ||||
(a) Ambulance on site at Sally Port backing in. | ||||
(18) R+5 min | ||||
(b) Medics stabilize and move self-harm | ||||
patient to Sally Port for transport to Fleet Hospital. | ||||
33-18. Gator Maintenance | ||||
a. The Camp 4 gator vehicle will be washed and | ||||
cleaned at least three times a week by the night shift | ||||
personnel. | ||||
b. The Camp 4 gator will be checked for an | ||||
adequate supply of fuel nightly by night shift personnel | ||||
and fueled as needed. Diesel fuel is located in the | ||||
yellow hazardous material lockers located by the mess | ||||
facility. | ||||
c. Any damage sustained to the Camp 4 gator will | ||||
be annotated on a sworn statement DA-2823 by the | ||||
person causing or noticing the damage with a detailed | ||||
description of the damage and/or how the damage was | ||||
found or occurred. This statement will be turned into | ||||
the Camp 4 NCOIC within 24 hours of the damage. | ||||
33-19. Logbooks | ||||
a. Camp 4 logbooks will be inspected by each and | ||||
every soldier or NCO assuming responsibility for a | ||||
Camp 4 post. Each logbook will be signed for when | ||||
each Camp 4 personnel assumes duty at each post. | ||||
Any unauthorized markings or drawings on the Camp 4 | ||||
logbooks will be reported to the SOG on duty and | ||||
Camp 4 NCOIC. Camp 4 logbooks are legal | ||||
Government documents subject to summoning for legal | ||||
purposes or inspection. Any unauthorized markings or | ||||
damage to a Camp 4 logbook will be treated as | ||||
destruction of classified and/or secret Government | ||||
documents. Any soldier or NCO assigned to Camp 4 | ||||
who violates this order will be subject to UCMJ. | ||||
b. As logbook sign out/in sheets are completely full | ||||
or filled out, they will be given to the SOG on duty for | ||||
filing inside the Camp 4 logbook sign out/in sheet | ||||
binder. | ||||
33-20. Radio/Telephone Transmissions | ||||
a. Any information transmitted by telephone or | ||||
saber radio will not include classified/secret | ||||
information. This includes, but is not limited to, ISN | ||||
numbers, detainee names, OPSEC information, Camp | ||||
Delta or Camp 4 operations, Camp Delta or Camp 4 | ||||
missions. Secret or classified information may be | ||||
given by telephone if the telephone line is verified by | ||||
the user, to be in secure mode by all/both parties on the | ||||
line. | ||||
33-21. NIPR Account | ||||
a. All Camp 4 personnel are authorized to establish a | ||||
NIPR account through the approval of the Camp 4 | ||||
NCOIC if they meet the J-6 requirements. | ||||
b. Soldiers and NCOs assigned to Camp 4 may use | ||||
the NIPR computer terminal located in the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building with verbal permission from | ||||
the SOG on duty or Camp 4 NCOIC if it does not | ||||
interfere with the Camp 4 mission. This is a Camp 4 | ||||
privilege and not a right. | ||||
c. The same JTF-GTMO and J-6 rules, policies and | ||||
procedures apply. No soldier or NCO may transmit | ||||
classified or secret information over the Camp 4 NIPR | ||||
terminal. | ||||
33-22. Break Area | ||||
a. The Camp 4 break area is located to the north side | ||||
of the Camp 4 administrative building. This is the only | ||||
authorized smoking area in the Camp 4 area of | ||||
responsibility. The Camp 4 break area will be policed | ||||
daily on both shifts to remove any trash, garbage, or | ||||
cigarette butts. | ||||
b. Garbage cans located within the Camp 4 break | ||||
area will be emptied daily as needed. | ||||
c. The Camp 4 break area is not a storage area for | ||||
supplies or any other objects or materials. | ||||
d. The Camp 4 break area may be utilized by other | ||||
soldiers, NCOs, military and civilian personnel. | ||||
However, it is Camp 4s responsibility to ensure the | ||||
break area is clean. | ||||
e. Camp 4 personnel utilizing the Camp 4 break area | ||||
need to be aware of OPSEC when discussing | ||||
information of a sensitive nature. Due to Camp 4s | ||||
proximity to the outer Camp Delta fence, it is possible | ||||
that passers by may hear conversations and information | ||||
being discussed. | ||||
33-23. Block/Sally Port Storage Lockers | ||||
a. There will be one storage locker per Camp 4 | ||||
block and Sally Port. These storage lockers will be the | ||||
responsibility of the Block NCO and Block Observer | ||||
on duty at that block and the Sally Port Operator. | ||||
Block/Sally Port storage lockers will have a supply | ||||
inventory sheet posted on the inside of the locker door | ||||
inside of a document protector. The supply inventory | ||||
sheet will list all necessary supplies utilized by each | ||||
block or Sally Port. Each Block NCO, Block | ||||
Observer, and Sally Port Operator will stock the | ||||
required amounts listed for each supply item by the end | ||||
of each shift. Block cleaning supplies such as mops, | ||||
mop buckets, brooms will be kept inside the block and | ||||
Sally Port storage lockers when not in use. Wet mops | ||||
will hang on the fence next to the storage lockers in a | ||||
neat and orderly appearance until dry, then placed | ||||
inside the storage lockers. For media/VIP tours all | ||||
block supplies and materials around the Block NCO | ||||
booth will be placed inside the block storage lockers. | ||||
33-24. P.A Intercom and Announcement System | ||||
a. The Camp 4 P.A. intercom and announcement | ||||
system located in the top of Liberty Tower will not be | ||||
used to play unauthorized CDs. The only authorized | ||||
materials to be used in the CD player are approved | ||||
"morning call to prayer", "daily call to prayer", and any | ||||
other media approved by S-3 operations to support the | ||||
Camp 4 mission. | ||||
b. The P.A. intercom and announcement system may | ||||
be used by JIG/ICE, S-2, or S-3 approved agencies to | ||||
relay messages to the Camp 4 detainees. | ||||
c. Camp 4 personnel may utilize the P.A. intercom | ||||
and announcement system to relay information to | ||||
individual bays or central baths as needed. | ||||
33-25. Detainee Movement from/To Camp 4 | ||||
a. Detainees assigned to Camp 4 will only be placed | ||||
in a two-piece restraint for normal movement around, | ||||
to, and/or from Camp 4 to other Camp Delta areas, | ||||
except for the following reasons: | ||||
(1) Movement to NAVBASE Hospital will require | ||||
a three-piece suit. | ||||
(2) When a detainee becomes a safety risk for | ||||
movement they will be placed in a three-piece suit. | ||||
(3) If a detainee becomes hostile or non-compliant | ||||
they may be placed in a three-piece suit. | ||||
(4) If a detainee has to be restrained by an IRF team, | ||||
they will be placed in flex cuffs or three piece suit. | ||||
(5) When requested by reservation personnel or | ||||
JIG/ICE. | ||||
b. Escort teams arriving to Camp 4 to pick-up a | ||||
detainee for movement will be asked for the detainee | ||||
destination and reason for movement. If the escort | ||||
team shows up with the improper restraint system they | ||||
will be asked to return to Escort Control to retrieve the | ||||
proper restraints before returning for detainee pick-up. | ||||
33-26. Medical Personnel/Medication Distribution | ||||
a. Corpsman, medical, escort teams and other non- | ||||
Camp 4 personnel arriving at Camp 4 will park their | ||||
gator by backing into an appropriate area not blocking | ||||
access gates, doors, or other gators. | ||||
b. Medication distribution to detainees will take | ||||
place after 0500 hours and before 2230 hours. | ||||
Corpsman that show up for meds pass during the 2230 | ||||
hours to 0500 hours period will not be granted access | ||||
to Camp 4. Corpsman will utilize the Medical access | ||||
gates located behind each block observer area on the | ||||
outer Camp 4 perimeter fence. Corpsman will give the | ||||
Block Observer the following information: | ||||
(1) Team number, call sign, or rank/name | ||||
(2) Meds pass or sick call | ||||
(3) Bed number or ISN (if sick call) | ||||
c. Corpsman and non-Camp 4 personnel will not | ||||
communicate with Liberty Tower on the Camp 4 | ||||
frequency to release a magnetic or electric controlled | ||||
gate. | ||||
d. Corpsman and medical personnel will log in to | ||||
Camp 4 by their appropriate radio call sign or team | ||||
number. If a Corpsman or medical personnel do not | ||||
have a call sign or team number they will log in by | ||||
rank and last name. | ||||
e. Corpsman and medical personnel will not enter or | ||||
be allowed to walk around Camp 4 freely. All non- | ||||
Camp 4 personnel must be escorted everywhere within | ||||
the Camp 4 perimeter by a Camp 4 assigned MP. | ||||
f. MPs will verify a detainee has taken their | ||||
medication, if orally, by making the detainee open their | ||||
mouth and move their tongue around as to check all | ||||
areas for hidden medications. All MPs will make | ||||
detainees open their hands before leaving the meds | ||||
pass bean hole area to ensure no medications that are to | ||||
be taken orally are being hidden. | ||||
g. Psych personnel will be escorted while in the | ||||
Camp 4 perimeter. However, while a psych Corpsman | ||||
is conducting a meeting or interview with a detainee, | ||||
the MP will give enough privacy to allow normal | ||||
conversation but still be close enough to maintain a | ||||
safe environment. | ||||
33-27. Assigned Personnel Duty Uniform | ||||
a. All Camp 4 assigned personnel will wear the | ||||
BDU uniform worn IAW AR 670-1 while on or off | ||||
duty in the Camp 4 area. | ||||
b. The Camp 4 duty uniform is BDU's and soft cap, | ||||
combat boots, trouser belt, brown t-shirt, under | ||||
garments, MP whistle (worn centered with hung by the | ||||
attached clip on the left breast BDU pocket), an | ||||
authorized style watch, authorized style sunglasses | ||||
(optional), camelback hydration system (optional), | ||||
black ink pen, a current JTF badge, a current Camp | ||||
Delta badge, assigned weapons cards (if issued), JTF | ||||
meal card, JTF ROE/RUF card, a current Military I.D., | ||||
and USSOUTHCOM Human Rights Standing Orders | ||||
card. | ||||
c. Backpacks will not be allowed in the Block | ||||
Observer areas. Backpacks may be stored in the Block | ||||
storage lockers, Liberty Tower, and Sally Port storage | ||||
locker. This includes any bags or containers used to | ||||
carry personal gear into the Camp 4 perimeter. | ||||
d. Backpacks and personal equipment will not be | ||||
stored inside the Camp 4 administrative building. This | ||||
includes any TA-50 or military equipment belonging to | ||||
or signed for as individual equipment or gear not | ||||
belonging to Camp 4. | ||||
33-28. Detainee Movement Operations (DMO) | ||||
a. S-2/3 will notify the Camp 4 NCOIC of detainees | ||||
who are outbound. | ||||
b. Outbound detainees will be removed from their | ||||
assigned bays and be placed together in a segregated | ||||
area away from other detainees not listed on the DMO | ||||
list. | ||||
c. Detainees identified for DMO operations will be | ||||
verified by comparing I.D. wristbands and I.D. cards to | ||||
ensure the correct detainee is moved. | ||||
d. Two new wristbands will be issued to each | ||||
detainee on the DMO list, but held by the Camp 4 | ||||
NCOIC for safekeeping. One white wristband with | ||||
detainees ISN number and one green wristband with | ||||
the detainees information and picture. | ||||
e. The Camp 4 NCOIC will request a flexible tape | ||||
measure from the JDOG S-4 to measure each DMO | ||||
detainee for DMO clothing (pants, shirt, shoes). This | ||||
list will be turned into JDOG S-3 operations. | ||||
f. JAG will complete all paperwork requirements, | ||||
voice printing, fingerprinting, and release paperwork. | ||||
The ICRC yard will be used for detainees in Camp 4 | ||||
that need to meet with JAG to complete the necessary | ||||
paperwork. | ||||
g. S-2/JIG/ICE will select one or more DMO | ||||
detainees to go to Camp 1, 2, and 3 to say goodbye to | ||||
the other detainees. | ||||
h. Camp 4 DMO detainees listed for outbound | ||||
operations will receive a feast at Camp 4 (dinner time) | ||||
the night prior to departure. The Camp 4 NCOIC will | ||||
request a list of foods and drinks from the detainees | ||||
selected for DMO. This list will be taken into | ||||
consideration for the items they wish to receive for the | ||||
feast. | ||||
i. Detainees selected for DMO will be awaken 3 | ||||
hours prior to DMO time. Those detainees will be | ||||
allowed to shower/shave at that time. After the | ||||
shower, DMO detainees will be issued their DMO | ||||
clothing and will turn-in all Camp 4 issued linen, | ||||
uniforms, and equipment. DMO detainees will then be | ||||
issued a MRE for breakfast and be given time to eat. | ||||
Camp 4 personnel will assist the DMO detainees in | ||||
proper wear and fitting of the clothing. Any fitment | ||||
issues will be brought up to the S-4 or DMO | ||||
OIC/NCOIC. | ||||
j. The Camp Delta chaplain will visit with the DMO | ||||
detainees to issue new prayer beads, prayer cap, and | ||||
Qurans. | ||||
k. After the DMO bus has arrived, it is backed in | ||||
and parked inside the Camp 4 perimeter and Sally Port | ||||
14 gates are secured. No armed escorts will enter | ||||
Camp 4 with weapons. The DMO detainees will be | ||||
restrained (handcuffs only) and loaded one at a time | ||||
onto the DMO bus by escort teams. Once all the | ||||
detainees are loaded on the bus the bus will enter Sally | ||||
Port 14 and be searched under, over, and around. | ||||
Camp 4 will conduct a 100% physical headcount and | ||||
notify the DOC of the new Camp 4 count. | ||||
33-29. Duress and IRF Codes | ||||
a. The duress code is a simple distinguishable word | ||||
or phrase used during normal conversation to alert | ||||
other Camp Delta personnel that another Camp Delta | ||||
or Camp 4 military or civilian person is under duress. | ||||
This code will be changed as needed to ensure integrity | ||||
of the code or when the code has been compromised. | ||||
The duress code will be listed on the Camp 4 manning | ||||
roster and briefed at each guard mount. The DOC will | ||||
be notified of the Camp 4 duress code word or phrase. | ||||
The duress code will also be written on the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building dry erase board for reference. | ||||
b. The IRF code is a simple distinguishable word or | ||||
phrase used when a detainee issue arises out of non- | ||||
compliance of MP orders or hostile actions by a | ||||
detainee or group of detainees warrants a security force | ||||
to assemble for the safety or protection of any | ||||
personnel to include detainee against detainee. The | ||||
IRF code will be listed on the Camp 4 manning roster | ||||
and briefed at each guard mount. The DOC will be | ||||
notified of the Camp 4 IRF code word or phrase. The | ||||
IRF code will also be written on the Camp 4 | ||||
administrative building dry erase board for reference. | ||||
c. Upon receiving the duress code, the Camp 4 SOG | ||||
will do the following: | ||||
(1) Notify the DOC, identify and give the location | ||||
of the person in duress | ||||
(2) Liberty Tower notify all other Camp 4 | ||||
personnel and a medical team | ||||
(3) Have Liberty Tower notify the Camp 4 NCOIC | ||||
of the situation | ||||
(4) Secure any detainees in the Camp 4recreation | ||||
yard and all other common areas into their bays | ||||
(5) Notify the Infantry SOG to advise the Infantry | ||||
towers and assemble QRF teams at Sally Port 14, give | ||||
the IRF code and location via channel 3 and request K- | ||||
9 units | ||||
(6) Take positive control of the situation until | ||||
QRF, IRF, S-3 OIC and medical teams arrive. | ||||
(7) Take appropriate action with available | ||||
resources to protect life, limb, or government property | ||||
(apply levels of force and ORE/RUF policies and | ||||
procedures) | ||||
Chapter 34 | ||||
Commissions | ||||
Quick Reaction Force (QRF) Teams | ||||
1. MP and Infantry elements secure the commissions | ||||
building. Infantry provides an exterior QRF element. | ||||
a. Infantry provides a Show-of-force around the | ||||
exterior perimeter of the commissions building, to | ||||
prevent unwanted personnel from entering the | ||||
facility. | ||||
b. The MP Reaction Team will provide assistance | ||||
to the MP Security Team when unauthorized | ||||
intrusion occurs in the A/O to protect U.S. forces, | ||||
civilians, and detainees. | ||||
2. Requirements | ||||
a. In the event the MP Reaction team cannot handle | ||||
the situation inside the commissions building The | ||||
INQRF must be able to react to a disturbance in the | ||||
commissions building within three minutes. | ||||
b. The IN element will maintain a Command Post | ||||
(CP) in the bunker next to the commissions building, | ||||
and must man this CP 24 hours per day. | ||||
c. This QRF will maintain radio communication | ||||
with the Infantry PL and the Security Force OIC. | ||||
d. An OIC/NCOIC (E7 or above) will be prepared | ||||
to lead the QRF at all times. | ||||
e. The MP OIC will contact the QRF CP via | ||||
SABRE radio, landline, or runner when the QRF is | ||||
required. | ||||
3. Notification Procedures | ||||
a. Security Force OIC will initiate QRF to react to a | ||||
threat within the commissions building. | ||||
b. The soldier who receives this message will | ||||
immediately notify the QRF OIC/NCOIC and then | ||||
alert the QRF element. | ||||
c. The PL or the Platoon Sergeant, whomever is not | ||||
leading the reaction squad, will immediately report to | ||||
the Company CP that the QRF has been alerted. | ||||
d. Once notified to react, the QRF reaction squad | ||||
will don the riot control gear and secure assigned | ||||
weapons for delivery. | ||||
e. Once prepared, the QRF squad will stand in | ||||
formation and prepare to enter the commissions | ||||
building. | ||||
f. The IRF representative will provide the QRF | ||||
element a SITREP of the disturbance before entering | ||||
the commissions building. | ||||
g. Once the disturbance is quelled, the QRF will | ||||
relinquish command back to the MP OIC and re-deploy | ||||
to the CP to conduct a back brief. | ||||
4. Ammunition Numbers and Accountability | ||||
a. The Platoon Sergeant of the QRF will visually | ||||
inspect and count for the following ammunition prior | ||||
to his element assuming duty as the QRF. | ||||
b. The Platoon Sergeant will also conduct a physical | ||||
count of all ammunition daily while assigned to the | ||||
QRF. | ||||
c. The QRF will have the following ammunition on | ||||
hand at all times: | ||||
(1) 48 12-gauge area non-lethal rounds. | ||||
(2) 48 40-millimeter point non-lethal rounds. | ||||
(3) 48 40-millimeter area non-lethal rounds. | ||||
(4) 48 M84 stun grenades. | ||||
5. Uniform: lethal/Non lethal | ||||
a. Lethal: BDUs, Kevlar, Body Armor, Protective | ||||
Mask (carried), Assigned Weapon (if designated), | ||||
Camelback, ID Card and Dog Tags, Camp Delta | ||||
Badge, and the ROE card in left breast pocket (dated | ||||
30 Nov 02). | ||||
b. Non lethal: BDUs, riot control gear consisting of | ||||
face shields attached to the Kevlar, non-ballistic shin | ||||
guards, body shield, baton, Camelback, ID Card and | ||||
Dog Tags, Camp Delta Badge, and the ROE card in left | ||||
breast pocket (dated 30 Nov 02). | ||||
Disturbance in the courtroom | ||||
a. In the event of any type of disorder, immediately | ||||
lock down the courtroom. No one will exit the facility | ||||
until the situation is resolved, or unless order to do so | ||||
by the presiding judge. | ||||
b. The MP OIC or SOG will notify the MP Reaction | ||||
force | ||||
c. The primary staging area for response personnel | ||||
is outside side the front entrance of the commissions | ||||
building. | ||||
d. Disturbances: | ||||
(1) Upon detection and/or notification of a | ||||
disturbance, the OIC or SOG takes the following | ||||
actions using all available guard personnel in the area | ||||
of the disturbance: | ||||
(a) Immediately handcuffs the detainee. | ||||
(b) Notifies the MP Reaction Force Team and if | ||||
necessary request assistance. | ||||
(c ) Segregate the detainee from the rest of the | ||||
courtroom. | ||||
(d) If order by the presiding judge move the | ||||
detainee-to-detainee holding room. The detainee will | ||||
be placed in a three-piece suit and secured to the floor | ||||
via eyebolt. | ||||
(e) Use only the force necessary and practical | ||||
under the circumstances to subdue the detainee. | ||||
(f) Guard personnel in other areas will secure | ||||
their area, notify the SOG, and remain at their posts | ||||
unless otherwise directed by the SOG. | ||||
(g) All personnel (guards will not leave there | ||||
assigned posts upon receiving the alert unless | ||||
specifically ordered to do so). | ||||
(d) As soon as possible, notify the IN PL, CO, | ||||
DOC, and the JDOG commander. | ||||
(4) In the event that a the detainee becomes | ||||
unruly or fails to comply with orders, the SOG will | ||||
take the following action: | ||||
(a) Isolate the detainee and if directed by the | ||||
presiding judge clears all personnel from the area. | ||||
(b) Immediately handcuff the detainee. | ||||
(c) Attempt to counsel and reason with the | ||||
detainee. If this fails, inform the detainee that | ||||
necessary force will be used to control him/her. | ||||
Guards will use the minimum amount of force | ||||
necessary to subdue the detainee. Once the detainee | ||||
has been subdued, he will be placed in his holding | ||||
room. He will be shackled in a three-piece suit and all | ||||
items that might be used by the detainee to cause | ||||
damage to property, themselves, or others will be | ||||
removed. | ||||
Medical Emergency | ||||
1. A medical emergency is any condition likely to | ||||
result in lasting bodily harm if treatment is delayed | ||||
until Sick Call the next day. Some examples of | ||||
emergencies are severe cuts, burns, broken bones, | ||||
unconsciousness or injuries resulting in temporary | ||||
unconsciousness, asthmatic attacks, repeated vomiting, | ||||
high fever or sudden changes in long standing | ||||
conditions causing intolerable discomfort. | ||||
b. A medical emergency condition does not exist | ||||
when an individual has a cold, flu, headache, single | ||||
episode of vomiting, missed medication call, upset | ||||
stomach or muscle aches (not caused by trauma) | ||||
c. The Detention Hospital will be consulted for | ||||
medical emergencies during the commissions’ process. | ||||
d. A Corpsman along with first responder bag. | ||||
Corpsmen supervising detainees will possess a CPR | ||||
physical barrier for mouth-to-mouth resuscitation and a | ||||
pair of rubber gloves. | ||||
e. OIC/ SOG will: | ||||
(1) Immediately notify corpsman when a detainee | ||||
is in need of medical care. | ||||
(2) Render first aid within their trained | ||||
capability. | ||||
f. OIC will: | ||||
(1) Notify the Detention Hospital and medical | ||||
personnel. | ||||
(2) Notify the DOC. | ||||
g. The corpsman will immediately render treatment | ||||
to the detainee. | ||||
(a) Call 911. | ||||
(b) Treatment will continue until the ambulance | ||||
arrives. | ||||
(c) The courtroom will be cleared of all non- | ||||
security and medical personnel. | ||||
(e) Once the ambulance arrives the detainee will | ||||
be stabilized and prepped for transport. Prior to | ||||
leaving the commissions building the detainee will be | ||||
shackled in a three-piece suit and if possible covered | ||||
with a blanket to hide the three-piece suit. | ||||
(f) The MP escort team will accompany the | ||||
detainee in the back of the ambulance for security | ||||
during the ride to NAVBASE hospital. | ||||
(g) The detainee will be taken to the NAVBASE | ||||
hospital and put into the DACU unit. | ||||
(h) The MP Detainee escort team will stay with the | ||||
detainee during treatment unit relieved by another | ||||
escort team. | ||||
Fire | ||||
a. Fire alarms: | ||||
(1) A person discovering a fire, regardless of type | ||||
or size will immediately alert all personnel by pulling | ||||
the fire alarm or cause to be alerted all personnel in the | ||||
commissions building and adjacent buildings and then | ||||
report the fire. | ||||
(2) The OIC or SOG will then notify the GTMO | ||||
Fire Department by telephone (911). | ||||
(3) Smoke alarms going off shall cause an | ||||
immediate evacuation of the building and reporting to | ||||
the GTMO Fire Department the same as if a fire were | ||||
discovered. | ||||
b. Action after giving a fire alarm: | ||||
(1) Secure the detainee with handcuffs (handcuffs | ||||
will be place behind his back). | ||||
(2) Notify the IN PL of the fire inside the | ||||
commissions building. | ||||
(3) The media, family members, and non-security | ||||
personnel will exit the building first. | ||||
(4) The detainee will then have flexi cuffs put on | ||||
his feet. | ||||
(5) The MP detainee escort team will then pick | ||||
the detainee up one holding the upper part of his body | ||||
and the other holding the feet. The remaining MP force | ||||
will help with the detainee movement to the bunker. | ||||
(6) They will carry him out the front of the | ||||
building to the IN CP (bunker at AV31). | ||||
(7) Once at the bunker he will be placed in a | ||||
three-piece suit and secured. | ||||
(8) MP Escort Team will stay with the detainee | ||||
inside the bunker and the IN will secure the outside of | ||||
the bunker. | ||||
(9) When the OIC receives the all clear, he | ||||
informs the MP Escort team to prep the detainee for | ||||
movement. | ||||
(10) The detainee is taken out of the three-piece | ||||
suit and has his hands handcuffed behind is back. | ||||
(11) The MP Escort Team along with the IN will | ||||
walk the detainee back to the commissions building. | ||||
(12) Once in the commissions building the | ||||
detainee will go directly to the detainee holding area | ||||
where he will be placed in a three-piece suit and | ||||
secured to the eyebolt. | ||||
(13) Detainee will remain secured until the | ||||
presiding judge calls for the detainee to the courtroom. | ||||
(14) In the event that the commissions building is | ||||
on fire or the presiding judge cancels the rest of the | ||||
days presiding the detainee will be taken back to Camp | ||||
Echo. | ||||
Bomb Threat | ||||
1. Staff members who receive a telephonic bomb | ||||
threat will: | ||||
a. Cease all radio communications, signal for | ||||
MP security personnel to verbally communicate the | ||||
bomb threat. | ||||
b. Without alerting the caller, signal another staff | ||||
member about the telephonic bomb threat. Have | ||||
him/her notify Security OIC. | ||||
c. Keep the caller on the line, as long as | ||||
possible. | ||||
d. Complete JTF GTMO Bomb Threat Data | ||||
Card. Obtain as much information as possible on the | ||||
caller and the bomb. | ||||
e. Discuss the incident only with personnel who | ||||
have a need to know (NAVBASE Security). | ||||
2. Staff members who receive a written or verbal | ||||
bomb threat will: | ||||
a. Cease all radio communication, inform | ||||
security personnel to verbally communicate the bomb | ||||
threat to the OIC and the Infantry Platoon Leader. | ||||
b. Security personnel will immediately notify | ||||
OIC. | ||||
c. Protect any written note and/or detain the | ||||
messenger. | ||||
d. Discuss the incident only with personnel who | ||||
have a need to know (NAVBASE Security). | ||||
3. OIC. The OIC will notify the bailiff to notify the | ||||
Presiding Officer of the Bomb Threat/Incident. | ||||
4. Evacuation. If the Presiding Officer determines | ||||
that an evacuation is warranted. | ||||
Security OIC will | ||||
(1) Notify the IN OIC of the bomb threat inside | ||||
the Commissions Building. | ||||
(2) Send one soldier to JTF HQ building to call | ||||
911. | ||||
(3) Supervise evacuation of the media, family | ||||
members, and non-security personnel. They will be | ||||
told to exit the building going out the front door, | ||||
proceeding to the McCalla Hanger. MP’s will control | ||||
the exit to prevent a rush to the doors. MP’s will be the | ||||
last to exit out the front door, providing assistance to | ||||
anyone who may need it. | ||||
a. IN OIC will: | ||||
(1) Orders his forces to provide a corridor of | ||||
security from the south end of the Commissions | ||||
Building to the bunker. | ||||
(2) Empty designated Jersey barriers by pulling | ||||
the water plug, to allow the emergency vehicles access | ||||
to the Commissions Building if they need it. | ||||
(3) Instruct his forces to provide additional | ||||
manning to the MP detainee escort team, all others will | ||||
go down the hill to McCalla hanger. | ||||
b. NAVBASE will send fire truck, ambulance | ||||
and an MWD (Ordinance) team. All vehicles will use | ||||
the Northern entrance (by the JTF HQ) and stage by | ||||
the JTF HQ. | ||||
c. The MP detainee escort team will: | ||||
(1) Secure the detainee with handcuffs (hands | ||||
will be placed behind his back). | ||||
(2) Pick up the detainee one holding the | ||||
upper part of his body and the other holding the feet. | ||||
(3) Carry detainee out the south exit doors of | ||||
the Commissions Building to the Bunker (AV31), | ||||
traveling between the IN forces arrayed as in a | ||||
corridor. | ||||
(4) Once inside the bunker, he will be placed | ||||
in a three-piece suit and secured. | ||||
5. When the OIC receives the all clear from the | ||||
Presiding Officer: | ||||
a. The MP detainee escort team removes the | ||||
three-piece suit and handcuffs the detainees’ hands | ||||
behind his back. | ||||
b. IN and MP’s move the detainee back the same | ||||
way he was moved out. | ||||
c. Once in the Commissions Building, the | ||||
detainee will be taken to the detainee holding area | ||||
where he will be placed in a three-piece suit and | ||||
secured to the eyebolt. | ||||
d. Supervise return of the media, family | ||||
members, and non-security personnel. They will be | ||||
told to return to the building through the front door. | ||||
MP’s will control the movement, screening all | ||||
personnel as they enter the building using the same | ||||
procedures as any other time people enter the building. | ||||
6. In the event that a bomb is discovered in the | ||||
Commissions Building, and/or the presiding officer | ||||
cancels the rest of the days’ proceedings. The detainee | ||||
will be taken back to Camp Echo. The OIC will call for | ||||
the Detainee Transport Vehicle once it is safe to move | ||||
the detainee out of the bunker. | ||||
React to an Ambush along the convoy route | ||||
1. During detainee escort movement to the | ||||
commissions site the following actions will occur if a | ||||
threat presents itself: | ||||
a. OIC immediately notify JOC by primary | ||||
and/or alternate means of communication. JOC will | ||||
notify OIC whether to continue to commissions site or | ||||
return to Camp Echo. | ||||
b. Drivers immediately execute defensive | ||||
driving techniques to get all vehicles out of the ambush | ||||
site. | ||||
c. Lethal weapons carriers immediately place | ||||
well aimed shoots at the hostile threat in accordance | ||||
with the Rules of Engagement. | ||||
d. Detainee escorts move detainee to floor of | ||||
vehicle to minimize risk to the detainee. | ||||
34-7. Information Not Covered By The Camp 4 | ||||
SOP | ||||
a. Any information, rules, regulations, policy, or | ||||
procedures not covered by the Camp 4 SOP will be | ||||
referred to in the current Camp Delta SOP for | ||||
guidance. Any information, rules, regulations, policy, | ||||
or procedures not covered by either Camp 4 SOP or | ||||
Camp Delta SOP will be referred to JDOG S-3 | ||||
Operations for guidance. | ||||
34-8. Camp 4 Forms found in Appendix C of | ||||
Camp Delta SOP | ||||
A. Camp 4 Manning Roster | ||||
B. Camp 4 Dayshift shower, chow, and recreation | ||||
activities schedule (example) | ||||
C. Camp 4 Nightshift shower, chow, and Recreation | ||||
activities schedule (example) | ||||
D. Camp 4 Post Orders | ||||
E. Camp 4 Discipline Matrix | ||||
F. Camp 4 General Rules (detainee copy) | ||||
G. Camp 4 Bay Rules (detainee copy) | ||||
H. Camp 4 Recreation Yard Rules (detainee copy) | ||||
I. Camp 4 Chow Yard Rules (detainee copy) | ||||
J. Camp 4 Central Bath Rules (detainee copy) | ||||
K. Camp 4 Guard Mount Messages Sheet | ||||
L. Bay Leader Responsibilities (detainee copy) | ||||
M. Camp 4 Block NCO checklist | ||||
A.1 | A.1 | |||
Appendix A | Appendix A | |||
References | References | |||
Section I | Section I | |||
Required Publications | Required Publications | |||
Geneva Conventions for the Protection of War | Geneva Conventions for the Protection of War | |||
Victims, 12 August 1949 | Victims, 12 August 1949 | |||
Military Order of November 13, 2001 – Detention, | Military Order of November 13, 2001 – Detention, | |||
Treatment, and Trial of Certain Non-Citizens in the | Treatment, and Trial of Certain Non-Citizens in the | |||
skipping to change at line 13031 | skipping to change at line 17382 | |||
Physical Security of Arms, Ammunition, and | Physical Security of Arms, Ammunition, and | |||
Explosives, 12 FEB 98 | Explosives, 12 FEB 98 | |||
AR 190-12 | AR 190-12 | |||
Military Working Dogs, 30 SEP 93 | Military Working Dogs, 30 SEP 93 | |||
AR 190-13 | AR 190-13 | |||
The Army Physical Security Program, 30 SEP 93 | The Army Physical Security Program, 30 SEP 93 | |||
AR 190-14 | AR 190-14 | |||
Carrying of Firearms and Use of Force for Law | Carrying of Firearms and Use of Force for Law | |||
Enforcement and Security Duties, 12 MAR 93 | Enforcement and Security Duties, 12 MAR 93 | |||
AR 190-16 | AR 190-16 | |||
Physical Security, 31 MAY 91 | Physical Security, 31 MAY 91AR 190-22 | |||
AR 190-22 | ||||
Searches, Seizures, and Disposition of Property, 1 JAN | Searches, Seizures, and Disposition of Property, 1 JAN | |||
83. | ||||
AR 190-29 | ||||
Misdemeanors and Uniform Violation Notices | ||||
Referred to US Magistrates or District Courts, 1 MAR | ||||
84 | ||||
AR 190-30 | AR 190-30 | |||
Military Police Investigations, 1 JUN 78 | Military Police Investigations, 1 JUN 78 | |||
AR 190-40 | AR 190-40 | |||
Serious Incident Report, 30 NOV 93 | Serious Incident Report, 30 NOV 93 | |||
AR 190-45 | AR 190-45 | |||
Law Enforcement Reporting, 20 OCT 00 | Law Enforcement Reporting, 20 OCT 00 | |||
AR 190-47 | AR 190-47 | |||
The Army Corrections System. 15 AUG 96 | The Army Corrections System. 15 AUG 96 | |||
AR 190-51 | AR 190-51 | |||
Security of Unclassified Army Property, 30 SEP 93 | Security of Unclassified Army Property, 30 SEP 93 | |||
AR 195-1 | ||||
Army Criminal Investigation Program, 12 AUG 74 | ||||
AR 195-2 | ||||
Criminal Investigation Activities, 30 OCT 85 | ||||
AR 195-5 | AR 195-5 | |||
Criminal Investigations, Evidence Procedures, 28 AUG | Criminal Investigations, Evidence Procedures, 28 AUG | |||
92 | 92 | |||
AR 210-174 | AR 210-174 | |||
Accounting Procedures for Prisoners’ Personal | Accounting Procedures for Prisoners’ Personal | |||
Property and Funds, 17 SEP 86 | Property and Funds, 17 SEP 86 | |||
AR 385-40 | ||||
Accident Reporting and Records, Army Accident | ||||
Investigation Reporting, 1 NOV 94 | ||||
AR 385-64 | AR 385-64 | |||
Ammunition and Explosive Safety Standards, 1 FEB | Ammunition and Explosive Safety Standards, 1 FEB | |||
00 | 00 | |||
AR 700-81 | AR 700-81 | |||
DOD Dog Program, 5 MAY 71 | DOD Dog Program, 5 MAY 71 | |||
FM 27-10 | ||||
The Law of Land Warfare, 18 JUL 1956, Change-1, | ||||
15 JUL 76 | ||||
FM 3-19.40 | FM 3-19.40 | |||
Military Police Internment/Resettlement Operations, | Military Police Internment/Resettlement Operations, | |||
01 AUG 01 | 01 AUG 01 | |||
FM 19-20 | ||||
Law Enforcement Investigations 27-10 | ||||
The Law of Land Warfare, 18 JUL 1956, Change-1, | ||||
15 JUL 76 | ||||
DA PAM 190-12 | DA PAM 190-12 | |||
Military Working Dog Program, 30 SEP 93 | Military Working Dog Program, 30 SEP 93 | |||
JTF-GTMO ROE/RUF | JTF-GTMO ROE/RUF | |||
30 NOV 02 | 30 NOV 02 | |||
OPNAVINST 5530.13B | OPNAVINST 5530.13B | |||
Department of The Navy Physical Security Instruction | Department of The Navy Physical Security Instruction | |||
For Conventional Arms, Ammunition, and Explosives, | For Conventional Arms, Ammunition, and Explosives, | |||
05 JUL 94 | 05 JUL 94 | |||
GTA 5-8-12 | GTA 5-8-12 | |||
25 FEB 99 | 25 FEB 99 | |||
STP 19-95C14-SM-TG | STP 19-95C14-SM-TG | |||
MOS 95C | MOS 95C | |||
INTERNMENT/RESETTLEMENT SPECIALIST | INTERNMENT/RESETTLEMENT SPECIALIST | |||
26 March 99 | 26 March 99 | |||
Messages, HQDA, DAMO-ODL | Messages, HQDA, DAMO-ODL | |||
14 DEC 94 | 14 DEC 94 | |||
Subject: Review for Legal Review/Opinion—Use of | Subject: Review for Legal Review/Opinion—Use of | |||
Oleoresin Capsicum Pepper Spray for Correctional | Oleoresin Capsicum Pepper Spray for Correctional | |||
Purposes. | Purposes. | |||
MOU Concerning the U.S. Naval Brig at Guantanamo | MOU Concerning the U.S. Naval Brig at | |||
Bay Cuba, 7 MAR 02. | Guantanamo Bay Cuba, 7 MAR 02. | |||
MOU Concerning Investigation Responsibilities of | ||||
the NAVBASE Command Investigations and Joint | ||||
Detention Operation Group, Camp Delta Detention | ||||
Facility MPI Section | ||||
MOU Concerning Naval Criminal Investigative | ||||
Services (NCIS)/Military Police Investigation (MPI) | ||||
Section Investigative Responsibilities at the Joint Task | ||||
Force Guantanamo (JTF GTMO) Camp Delta | ||||
Detention Facility | ||||
Detention Hospital “Care of the detainee With Self- | Detention Hospital “Care of the detainee With Self- | |||
Injurious Behavior” SOP | Injurious Behavior” SOP | |||
Fleet Hospital 20 SOP for Hunger Strikes, Drinking | Fleet Hospital 20 SOP for Hunger Strikes, | |||
Strikes, and Re-Feeding | Drinking Strikes, and Re-Feeding | |||
27 MAY 02. | 27 MAY 02. | |||
Enclosure 1: Enclosure 1-4 (FPCON Alpha-Delta) to | Enclosure 1: Enclosure 1-4 (FPCON Alpha-Delta) to | |||
Tab-D (Random Anti-terrorism Measures) to | Tab-D (Random Anti-terrorism Measures) to | |||
Appendix-2 (Anti-terrorism) to Annex-C (Operations) | Appendix-2 (Anti-terrorism) to Annex-C (Operations) | |||
to JTF-GTMO Anti-terrorism Force Protection Plan | to JTF-GTMO Anti-terrorism Force Protection Plan | |||
(AT/FPP). | (AT/FPP). | |||
E-mail from JDOG CDR re: Policy Guidance, | E-mail from JDOG CDR re: Policy Guidance, | |||
Procedures for Use of Aerosol Restrain (OLEORESIN | Procedures for Use of Aerosol Restrain (OLEORESIN | |||
CAPSICUM) 21 JUN 02. | CAPSICUM) 21 JUN 02. | |||
A.2 | ||||
Map: Map Series, Cuba 1:25000 Guantanamo, TPC | Map: Map Series, Cuba 1:25000 Guantanamo, TPC | |||
Series E824S, Sheet 3025II, Edition 1-DMA | Series E824S, Sheet 3025II, Edition 1-DMA | |||
Guantanamo | Guantanamo | |||
Naval Hospital GTMO Mass Casualty Plan, | Naval Hospital GTMO Mass Casualty Plan, | |||
NAVHOSPGTMOINST 3440.1C | NAVHOSPGTMOINST 3440.1C | |||
Madigan Army Medical Center Emergency | Madigan Army Medical Center Emergency | |||
Preparedness Management Plan, current. | Preparedness Management Plan, current. | |||
Arizona Triage System, Responding to an MCI: EMS | Arizona Triage System, Responding to an MCI: EMS | |||
Guide | Guide | |||
Section II | Section II | |||
skipping to change at line 13118 | skipping to change at line 17491 | |||
Report Of/Or Recommendation For Disciplinary | Report Of/Or Recommendation For Disciplinary | |||
Action | Action | |||
DA Form 509 | DA Form 509 | |||
Inspection Record Of Prisoner In Segregation | Inspection Record Of Prisoner In Segregation | |||
DA Form 1594 | DA Form 1594 | |||
Daily Staff Journal or Duty Officer’s Log | Daily Staff Journal or Duty Officer’s Log | |||
DA Form 2062 | DA Form 2062 | |||
Hand Receipt | Hand Receipt | |||
DA Form 2823 | DA Form 2823 | |||
Sworn Statement | Sworn Statement | |||
A.2 | ||||
DA Form 3997 | DA Form 3997 | |||
Military Police Desk Blotter | Military Police Desk Blotter | |||
DA Form 4137 | DA Form 4137 | |||
Evidence/Property Custody Document | Evidence/Property Custody Document | |||
DA Form 5513 | DA Form 5513 | |||
Key Control Register And Inventory | Key Control Register And Inventory | |||
CD-RU01 | CD-RU01 | |||
Repair And Utility Work Order | Repair And Utility Work Order | |||
CD-S201 | CD-JDOG S-201 | |||
Significant Activities Sheet | Significant Activities Sheet | |||
CD-S301 | CD-S301 | |||
Detainee Behavioral Tracking | Detainee Behavioral Tracking | |||
CD-S302 | CD-S302 | |||
Chaplain Requests | Chaplain Requests | |||
CD-S303 | CD-S303 | |||
Detainee Confiscated Items | Detainee Confiscated Items | |||
CD-S304 | CD-S304 | |||
Detainee Inventory Form | Detainee Inventory Form | |||
CD-S305 | CD-S305 | |||
skipping to change at line 13198 | skipping to change at line 17569 | |||
Discipline Matrix | Discipline Matrix | |||
CD-S329 | CD-S329 | |||
Damage to Property Discipline Matrix | Damage to Property Discipline Matrix | |||
CD-S330 | CD-S330 | |||
Guard Mount Information Message | Guard Mount Information Message | |||
CD-S331 | CD-S331 | |||
Mass Casualty Checklist | Mass Casualty Checklist | |||
CD-S332 | CD-S332 | |||
Triage Checklist | Triage Checklist | |||
CD-S333 | CD-S333 | |||
Shower and Recreation Schedule | Shower and Exercise Schedule | |||
Linen and Uniform Exchange Schedule | Linen and Uniform Exchange Schedule | |||
CD-S334 | CD-S334 | |||
Individual Detainee Refusal Tracking Record | Individual Detainee Refusal Tracking Record | |||
CD-S335 | CD-S335 | |||
Daily Detainee Medical Requests/Complaints | Daily Detainee Medical Requests/Complaints | |||
CD-S336 | CD-S336 | |||
Weekly and Monthly Due Outs | Weekly and Monthly Due Outs | |||
CD-S337 | CD-S337 | |||
Block NCO Checklist | Block NCO Checklist | |||
CD-S338 | CD-S338 | |||
Level 5 and Medical Entitlement Form | Level 5 and Medical Entitlement Form | |||
A.3 | ||||
CD-S339 | CD-S339 | |||
Notification Matrix | Notification Matrix | |||
CD-S340 | CD-S340 | |||
Guard Mount Manning Roster | Guard Mount Manning Roster | |||
CD-S341 | CD-S341 | |||
Inspection Record of Prisoner in Segregation | Inspection Record of Prisoner in Segregation | |||
JTF-GTMO Bomb Threat Data Card | JTF-GTMO Bomb Threat Data Card | |||
Camp Delta Guard Force Shift After Action Review | Camp Delta Guard Force Shift After Action Review | |||
Standard Intelligence Reporting Form | Standard Intelligence Reporting Form | |||
J4/JLSG Warehouse Expendable/Consumable Request | J4/JLSG Warehouse Expendable/Consumable Request | |||
Form | Form | |||
Non-Expendable/Consumable Request Form | Non-Expendable/Consumable Request Form | |||
Section III | Section III | |||
Abbreviations | Abbreviations | |||
AAR | AAR | |||
After Action Review | After Action Review | |||
CI | CI | |||
Comfort Items, Counter Intelligence | Comfort Items, Counter Intelligence | |||
CINC | CINC | |||
Commander in Chief | Commander in Chief | |||
A.3 | ||||
CITF | CITF | |||
Criminal Investigation Task Force | Criminal Investigation Task Force | |||
CJDOG | CJDOG | |||
Commander, Joint Detention Operations Group | Commander, Joint Detention Operations Group | |||
COMSEC | COMSEC | |||
Communications Security | Communications Security | |||
CTC | CTC | |||
Counterterrorism Cell | Counterterrorism Cell | |||
C2 | C2 | |||
Command and Control | Command and Control | |||
skipping to change at line 13324 | skipping to change at line 17695 | |||
MI | MI | |||
Military Intelligence | Military Intelligence | |||
MMS | MMS | |||
Mail Management System | Mail Management System | |||
MOD | MOD | |||
Medical Officer of the Day | Medical Officer of the Day | |||
MPH | MPH | |||
Miles Per Hour | Miles Per Hour | |||
MRE | MRE | |||
Meals Ready to Eat | Meals Ready to Eat | |||
MSU | ||||
Maximum Security Unit | A.4 | |||
MTS | MTS | |||
Mail Transmittal Sheet | Mail Transmittal Sheet | |||
MWD | MWD | |||
Military Working Dog | Military Working Dog | |||
NAI | NAI | |||
Named Areas of Interest | Named Areas of Interest | |||
NAVBASE | NAVBASE | |||
Naval Base | Naval Base | |||
NAVSTA | NAVSTA | |||
Naval Station | Naval Station | |||
NCA | NCA | |||
National Command Authority | National Command Authority | |||
NCIS | NCIS | |||
Naval Criminal Investigation Service | Naval Criminal Investigation Service | |||
NCO | NCO | |||
Non Commissioned Officer | Non Commissioned Officer | |||
NCOIC | NCOIC | |||
Non Commissioned Officer in Charge | Non Commissioned Officer in Charge | |||
A.4 | ||||
NDRC | NDRC | |||
National Detainee Records Center | National Detainee Records Center | |||
NLW | NLW | |||
Non-Lethal Weapons | Non-Lethal Weapons | |||
OML | OML | |||
Order of Merit List | Order of Merit List | |||
OC | OC | |||
Oleoresin/Capsicum: Pepper Spray | Oleoresin/Capsicum: Pepper Spray | |||
OIC | OIC | |||
Officer in Charge | Officer in Charge | |||
skipping to change at line 13388 | skipping to change at line 17757 | |||
ROE | ROE | |||
Rules Of Engagement | Rules Of Engagement | |||
RUF | RUF | |||
Rules for Use of Force | Rules for Use of Force | |||
R&U | R&U | |||
Repair and Utility | Repair and Utility | |||
SBF | SBF | |||
Support-By-Fire | Support-By-Fire | |||
SECDEF | SECDEF | |||
Secretary of Defense | Secretary of Defense | |||
SHU | ||||
Special Housing Unit | ||||
SIGACT | SIGACT | |||
Significant Activity | Significant Activity | |||
SIR | SIR | |||
Serious Incident Report | Serious Incident Report | |||
SIRF | SIRF | |||
Standard Intelligence Reporting Form | Standard Intelligence Reporting Form | |||
SOG | SOG | |||
SOG | SOG | |||
SPOTREP | SPOTREP | |||
Spot Report | Spot Report | |||
End of changes. 737 change blocks. | ||||
4209 lines changed or deleted | 8574 lines changed or added | |||